Medicare Program; Payment Policies Under the Physician Fee Schedule and Other Revisions to Part B for CY 2010, 33520-33825 [E9-15835]
Download as PDF
33520
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
DEPARTMENT OF HEALTH AND
HUMAN SERVICES
Centers for Medicare & Medicaid
Services
42 CFR Parts 410, 411, 414, 415, and
485
[CMS–1413–P]
RIN 0938–AP40
Medicare Program; Payment Policies
Under the Physician Fee Schedule and
Other Revisions to Part B for CY 2010
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
AGENCY: Centers for Medicare &
Medicaid Services (CMS), HHS.
ACTION: Proposed rule.
SUMMARY: This proposed rule would
address proposed changes to Medicare
Part B payment policy. We are
proposing these changes to ensure that
our payment systems are updated to
reflect changes in medical practice and
the relative value of services. This
proposed rule discusses: Refinements to
resource-based work, practice expense
and malpractice relative value units
(RVUs); geographic practice cost indices
(GPCIs); telehealth services; several
coding issues; physician fee schedule
update for CY 2010; payment for
covered part B outpatient drugs and
biologicals; the competitive acquisition
program (CAP); payment for renal
dialysis services; the chiropractic
services demonstration; comprehensive
outpatient rehabilitation facilities;
physician self-referral; the ambulance
fee schedule; the clinical laboratory fee
schedule; durable medical equipment,
prosthetics, orthotics, and supplies
(DMEPOS); and certain provisions of the
Medicare Improvements for Patients and
Providers Act of 2008. (See the Table of
contents for a listing of the specific
issues.)
DATES: To be assured consideration,
comments must be received at one of
the addresses provided below, no later
than 5 p.m. on Monday, August 31,
2009.
ADDRESSES: In commenting, please refer
to file code CMS–1413–P. Because of
staff and resource limitations, we cannot
accept comments by facsimile (FAX)
transmission.
You may submit comments in one of
four ways (please choose only one of the
ways listed):
1. Electronically. You may submit
electronic comments on this regulation
to https://www.regulations.gov. Follow
the instructions under the ‘‘More Search
Options’’ tab.
2. By regular mail. You may mail
written comments to the following
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
address ONLY: Centers for Medicare &
Medicaid Services, Department of
Health and Human Services, Attention:
CMS–1413–P, P.O. Box 8013, Baltimore,
MD 21244–8013.
Please allow sufficient time for mailed
comments to be received before the
close of the comment period.
3. By express or overnight mail. You
may send written comments to the
following address only: Centers for
Medicare & Medicaid Services,
Department of Health and Human
Services, Attention: CMS–1413–P, Mail
Stop C4–26–05, 7500 Security
Boulevard, Baltimore, MD 21244–1850.
4. By hand or courier. If you prefer,
you may deliver (by hand or courier)
your written comments before the close
of the comment period to either of the
following addresses:
a. For delivery in Washington, DC—
Centers for Medicare & Medicaid
Services, Department of Health and
Human Services, Room 445–G, Hubert
H. Humphrey Building, 200
Independence Avenue, SW.,
Washington, DC 20201.
(Because access to the interior of the
Hubert H. Humphrey Building is not
readily available to persons without
Federal government identification,
commenters are encouraged to leave
their comments in the CMS drop slots
located in the main lobby of the
building. A stamp-in clock is available
for persons wishing to retain a proof of
filing by stamping in and retaining an
extra copy of the comments being filed.)
b. For delivery in Baltimore, MD—
Centers for Medicare & Medicaid
Services, Department of Health and
Human Services, 7500 Security
Boulevard, Baltimore, MD 21244–1850.
If you intend to deliver your
comments to the Baltimore address,
please call telephone number (410) 786–
9994 in advance to schedule your
arrival with one of our staff members.
Comments mailed to the addresses
indicated as appropriate for hand or
courier delivery may be delayed and
received after the comment period.
FOR FURTHER INFORMATION CONTACT:
Rick Ensor, (410) 786–5617, for issues
related to practice expense
methodology.
Craig Dobyski, (410) 786–4584, for
issues related to geographic practice
cost indices.
Esther Markowitz, (410) 786–4595, for
issues related to telehealth services.
Ken Marsalek, (410) 786–4502, for
issues related to the physician
practice information survey and the
multiple procedure payment
reduction.
PO 00000
Frm 00002
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
Cathleen Scally, (410) 786–5714, for
issues related to the initial preventive
physical examination or consultation
services.
Regina Walker-Wren, (410) 786–9160,
for issues related to the phasing out of
the outpatient mental health
treatment limitation.
Diane Stern, (410) 786–1133, for issues
related to the physician quality
reporting initiative and incentives for
e-prescribing.
Lisa Grabert, (410) 786–6827, for issues
related to the Physician Resource Use
Feedback Program.
Colleen Bruce, (410) 786–5529, for
issues related to value-based
purchasing.
Sandra Bastinelli, (410) 786–3630, for
issues related to the implementation
of accreditation standards.
Jim Menas, (410) 786–4507, for issues
related to teaching anesthesia
services.
Sarah McClain, (410) 786–2994, for
issues related to the coverage of
cardiac rehabilitation services.
Dorothy Shannon, (410) 786–3396, for
issues related to payment for cardiac
rehabilitation services.
Roya Lofti, (410) 786–4072, for issues
related to the coverage of pulmonary
rehabilitation.
Jamie Hermansen, (410) 786–2064, for
issues related to kidney disease
patient education programs.
Terri Harris, (410) 786–6830 for issues
related to payment for kidney disease
patient education.
Henry Richter, (410) 786–4562, or Lisa
Hubbard, (410) 786–5472, for issues
related to renal dialysis provisions
and payments for end-stage renal
disease facilities.
Cheryl Gilbreath, (410) 786–5919, for
issues related to payment for covered
outpatient drugs and biologicals.
Edmund Kasaitis, (410) 786–0477, or
Bonny Dahm, (410) 786–4006, for
issues related to the Competitive
Acquisition Program (CAP) for Part B
drugs.
Pauline Lapin, (410) 786–6883, for
issues related to the chiropractic
services demonstration budget
neutrality issue.
Monique Howard, (410) 786–3869, for
issues related to CORF conditions of
coverage.
Roechel Kujawa, (410) 786–9111, for
issues related to ambulance services.
Anne Tayloe Hauswald, (410) 786–4546,
for clinical laboratory issues.
Troy Barsky, (410) 786–8873, or Roy
Albert, (410) 786–1872, for issues
related to physician self-referral.
Michelle Peterman, (410) 786–2591, or
Iffat Fatima, (410) 786–6709 for issues
related to the grandfathering
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
provisions of the durable medical
equipment, prosthetics, orthotics, and
supplies (DMEPOS) Competitive
Acquisition Program.
Ralph Goldberg, (410) 786–4870, or
Heidi Edmunds, (410) 786–1781, for
issues related to the damages process
caused by the termination of contracts
awarded in 2008 under the DMEPOS
Competitive Bidding program.
Diane Milstead, (410) 786–3355, or
Gaysha Brooks, (410) 786–9649, for all
other issues.
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION:
Inspection of Public Comments: All
comments received before the close of
the comment period are available for
viewing by the public, including any
personally identifiable or confidential
business information that is included in
a comment. We post all comments
received before the close of the
comment period on the following Web
site as soon as possible after they have
been received: https://
www.regulations.gov. Follow the search
instructions on that Web site to view
public comments.
Comments received timely will also
be available for public inspection as
they are received, generally beginning
approximately 3 weeks after publication
of a document, at the headquarters of
the Centers for Medicare & Medicaid
Services, 7500 Security Boulevard,
Baltimore, Maryland 21244, Monday
through Friday of each week from 8:30
a.m. to 4 p.m. To schedule an
appointment to view public comments,
phone 1–800–743–3951.
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Table of Contents
To assist readers in referencing
sections contained in this preamble, we
are providing a table of contents. Some
of the issues discussed in this preamble
affect the payment policies, but do not
require changes to the regulations in the
Code of Federal Regulations (CFR).
Information on the regulation’s impact
appears throughout the preamble, and
therefore, is not exclusively in section
V. of this proposed rule.
I. Background
A. Development of the Relative Value
System
1. Work RVUs
2. Practice Expense Relative Value Units
(PE RVUs)
3. Resource-Based Malpractice RVUs
4. Refinements to the RVUs
5. Adjustments to RVUs Are Budget
Neutral
B. Components of the Fee Schedule
Payment Amounts
C. Most Recent Changes to Fee Schedule
II. Provisions of the Proposed Regulation
A. Resource-Based Practice Expense (PE)
Relative Value Units (RVUs)
1. Current Methodology
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
a. Data Sources for Calculating Practice
Expense
b. Allocation of PE to Services
c. Facility and Nonfacility Costs
d. Services With Technical Components
(TCs) and Professional Components
(PCs)
e. Transition Period
f. PE RVU Methodology
2. PE Proposals for CY 2010
a. SMS and Supplemental Survey
Background
b. Physician Practice Information Survey
(PPIS)
c. Equipment Utilization Rate
d. Miscellaneous PE Issues
e. AMA RUC PE Recommendations for
Direct PE Inputs
B. Geographic Practice Cost Indices
(GPCIs): Locality Discussion
1. Update—Expiration of 1.0 Work GPCI
Floor
2. Payment Localities
C. Malpractice RVUs
1. Background
2. Proposed Methodology for the Revision
of Resource-Based Malpractice RVUs
D. Medicare Telehealth Services
1. Requests for Adding Services to the List
of Medicare Telehealth Services
2. Submitted Requests for Addition to the
List of Telehealth Services
E. Specific Coding Issues Related to
Physician Fee Schedule
1. Canalith Repositioning
2. Payment for an Initial Preventive
Physical Examination (IPPE)
3. Audiology Codes: Policy Clarification of
Existing CPT Codes
4. Consultation Services
F. Potentially Misvalued Codes Under the
Physician Fee Schedule
1. Valuing Services Under the Physician
Fee Schedule
2. High Cost Supplies
3. Review of Services Often Billed Together
and the Possibility of Expanding the
Multiple Procedure Payment Reduction
(MPPR) to Additional Nonsurgical
Services
4. AMA RUC Review of Potentially
Misvalued Services
a. Site of Service Anomalies
b. ‘‘23-Hour’’ Stay
5. Establishing Appropriate Relative Values
for Physician Fee Schedule Services
G. Issues Related to the Medicare
Improvements for Patients and Providers
Act of 2008 (MIPPA)
1. Section 102: Elimination of
Discriminatory Copayment Rates for
Medicare Outpatient Psychiatric Services
2. Section 131(b): Physician Payment,
Efficiency, and Quality Improvements—
Physician Quality Reporting Initiative
(PQRI)
3. Section 131(c): Physician Resource Use
Measurement and Reporting Program
4. Section 131(d): Plan for Transition to
Value-Based Purchasing Program for
Physicians and Other Practitioners
5. Section 132: Incentives for Electronic
Prescribing (E-Prescribing)—The EPrescibing Incentive Program
6. Section 135: Implementation of
Accreditation Standards for Suppliers
Frm 00003
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33521
Furnishing the Technical Component
(TC) of Advanced Diagnostic Imaging
Services
7. Section 139: Improvements for Medicare
Anesthesia Teaching Programs
8. Section 144(a): Payment and Coverage
Improvements for Patients With Chronic
Obstructive Pulmonary Disease and
Other Conditions—Cardiac
Rehabilitation Services
9. Section 144(a): Payment and Coverage
Improvements for Patients With Chronic
Obstructive Pulmonary Disease and
Other Conditions—Pulmonary
Rehabitation Services
10. Section 152(b): Coverage of Kidney
Disease Patient Education Services
11. Section 153: Renal Dialysis Provisions
12. Section 182(b): Revision of Definition
of Medically-Accepted Indication for
Drugs; Compendia for Determination of
Medically-Accepted Indications for OffLabel Uses of Drugs and Biologicals in an
Anti-Cancer Chemotherapeutic Regimen
H. Part B Drug Payment
1. Average Sales Price (ASP) Issues
2. Competitive Acquisition Program (CAP)
Issues
I. Provisions Related to Payment for Renal
Dialysis Services Furnished by EndStage Renal Disease (ESRD) Facilities
J. Discussion of Chiropractic Services
Demonstration
1. Background
2. Analysis of Demonstration
3. Payment Adjustment
K. Comprehensive Outpatient
Rehabilitation Facilities (CORF) and
Rehabilitation Agency Issues
L. Ambulance Fee Schedule: Technical
Correction to the Rural Adjustment
Factor Regulations (414.610)
M. Clinical Laboratory Fee Schedule:
Signature on Requisition
N. Physician Self-Referral
1. General Background
2. Physician Stand in the Shoes
O. Durable Medical Equipment-Related
Issues
1. Damages to Suppliers Awarded a
Contract Under the Acquisition of
Certain Durable Medical Equipment,
Prosthetics, Orthotics, and Supplies
(Medicare DMEPOS Competitive Bidding
Program) Caused by the Delay of the
Program
2. Notification to Beneficiaries for
Suppliers Regarding Grandfathering
P. Physician Fee Schedule Update for CY
2010
III. Collection of Information Requirements
IV. Response to Comments
V. Regulatory Impact Analysis
Regulation Text
Addendum A—Explanation and Use of
Addendum B
Addendum B—Proposed Relative Value
Units and Related Information Used in
Determining Medicare Payments for CY
2010
Addendum C—[Reserved]
Addendum D—Proposed 2010 Geographic
Adjustment Factors (GAFs)
Addendum E—Proposed 2010 Geographic
Practice Cost Indices (GPCIs) by State
and Medicare Locality
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33522
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
Addendum F—Proposed CY 2010 ESRD
Wage Index for Urban Areas Based on
CBSA Labor Market Areas
Addendum G—Propsoed CY 2010 ESRD
Wage Index Based on CBSA Labor
Market Areas for Rural Areas
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Acronyms
In addition, because of the many
organizations and terms to which we
refer by acronym in this final rule with
comment period, we are listing these
acronyms and their corresponding terms
in alphabetical order below:
AACVPR American Association of
Cardiovascular and Pulmonary
Rehabilitation
ACC American College of Cardiology
ACGME Accreditation Council on Graduate
Medical Education
ACR American College of Radiology
AFROC Association of Freestanding
Radiation Oncology Centers
AHA American Heart Association
AHRQ [HHS’] Agency for Healthcare
Research and Quality
AIDS Acquired immune deficiency
syndrome
AMA American Medical Association
AMP Average manufacturer price
AOA American Osteopathic Association
APA American Psychological Association
APTA American Physical Therapy
Association
ASC Ambulatory surgical center
ASP Average sales price
ASRT American Society of Radiologic
Technologists
ASTRO American Society for Therapeutic
Radiology and Oncology
ATA American Telemedicine Association
AWP Average wholesale price
BBA Balanced Budget Act of 1997 (Pub. L.
105–33)
BBRA [Medicare, Medicaid and State Child
Health Insurance Program] Balanced
Budget Refinement Act of 1999 (Pub. L.
106–113)
BIPA Medicare, Medicaid, and SCHIP
Benefits Improvement Protection Act of
2000 (Pub. L. 106–554)
BLS Bureau of Labor Statistics
BN Budget neutrality
CABG Coronary artery bypass graft
CAD Coronary artery disease
CAH Critical access hospital
CAHEA Committee on Allied Health
Education and Accreditation
CAP Competitive acquisition program
CBSA Core-Based Statistical Area
CCHIT Certification Commission for
Healthcare Information Technology
CEAMA Council on Education of the
American Medical Association
CF Conversion factor
CfC Conditions for Coverage
CFR Code of Federal Regulations
CKD Chronic kidney disease
CLFS Clinical laboratory fee schedule
CMA California Medical Association
CMHC Community mental health center
CMP Civil money penalty
CMS Centers for Medicare & Medicaid
Services
CNS Clinical nurse specialist
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
CoP Condition of participation
COPD Chronic obstructive pulmonary
disease
CORF Comprehensive Outpatient
Rehabilitation Facility
COS Cost of service
CPEP Clinical Practice Expert Panel
CPI Consumer Price Index
CPI–U Consumer price index for urban
customers
CPT [Physicians’] Current Procedural
Terminology (4th Edition, 2002,
copyrighted by the American Medical
Association)
CR Cardiac rehabilitation
CRNA Certified registered nurse anesthetist
CRP Canalith repositioning
CRT Certified respiratory therapist
CSW Clinical social worker
CY Calendar year
DHS Designated health services
DME Durable medical equipment
DMEPOS Durable medical equipment,
prosthetics, orthotics, and supplies
DOQ Doctor’s Office Quality
DRA Deficit Reduction Act of 2005 (Pub. L.
109–171)
DSMT Diabetes self-management training
E/M Evaluation and management
EDI Electronic data interchange
EEG Electroencephalogram
EHR Electronic health record
EKG Electrocardiogram
EMG Electromyogram
EMTALA Emergency Medical Treatment
and Active Labor Act
EOG Electro-oculogram
EPO Erythropoietin
ESRD End-stage renal disease
FAX Facsimile
FDA Food and Drug Administration (HHS)
FEV Forced expiratory volume
FFS Fee-for-service
FR Federal Register
FVC Forced expiratory vital capacity (liters)
GAF Geographic adjustment factor
GAO General Accountability Office
GEM Generating Medicare [Physician
Quality Performance Measurement Results]
GFR Glomerular filtration rate
GPO Group purchasing organization
GPCI Geographic practice cost index
HAC Hospital-acquired conditions
HBAI Health and behavior assessment and
intervention
HCPAC Health Care Professional Advisory
Committee
HCPCS Healthcare Common Procedure
Coding System
HCRIS Healthcare Cost Report Information
System
HDRT High dose radiation therapy
HH PPS Home Health Prospective Payment
System
HHA Home health agency
HHRG Home health resource group
HHS [Department of] Health and Human
Services
HIPAA Health Insurance Portability and
Accountability Act of 1996 (Pub. L. 104–
191)
HIT Health information technology
HITECH Health Information Technology for
Economic and Clinical Health Act (Title IV
of Division B of the Recovery Act, together
with Title XIII of Division A of the
Recovery Act)
PO 00000
Frm 00004
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
HITSP Healthcare Information Technology
Standards Panel
HIV Human immunodeficiency virus
HOPD Hospital outpatient department
HPSA Health Professional Shortage Area
HRSA Health Resources Services
Administration (HHS)
ICD International Classification of Diseases
IACS Individuals Access to CMS Systems
ICF Intermediate care facilities
ICR Intensive cardiac rehabilitation
ICR Information collection requirement
IDTF Independent diagnostic testing facility
IFC Interim final rule with comment period
IMRT Intensity-Modulated Radiation
Therapy
IPPE Initial preventive physical
examination
IPPS Inpatient prospective payment system
IRS Internal Revenue Service
ISO Insurance services office
IVD Ischemic Vascular Disease
IVIG Intravenous immune globulin
IWPUT Intra-service work per unit of time
JRCERT Joint Review Committee on
Education in Radiologic Technology
JUA Joint underwriting association
KDE Kidney disease education
MA Medicare Advantage
MA–PD Medicare Advantage-Prescription
Drug Plans
MCMP Medicare Care Management
Performance
MedCAC Medicare Evidence Development
and Coverage Advisory Committee
(formerly the Medicare Coverage Advisory
Committee (MCAC))
MedPAC Medicare Payment Advisory
Commission
MEI Medicare Economic Index
MIEA–TRHCA Medicare Improvements and
Extension Act of 2006 (that is, Division B
of the Tax Relief and Health Care Act of
2006 (TRHCA) (Pub. L. 109–432)
MIPPA Medicare Improvements for Patients
and Providers Act of 2008 (Pub. L. 110–
275)
MMA Medicare Prescription Drug,
Improvement, and Modernization Act of
2003 (Pub. L. 108–173)
MMSEA Medicare, Medicaid, and SCHIP
Extension Act of 2007 (Pub. L. 110–173)
MNT Medical nutrition therapy
MP Malpractice
MPPR Multiple procedure payment
reduction
MQSA Mammography Quality Standards
Act of 1992 (Pub. L. 102–539)
MRA Magnetic resonance angiography
MRI Magnetic resonance imaging
MS-DRG Medicare Severity-Diagnosis
related group
MSA Metropolitan statistical area
NCD National Coverage Determination
NCH National Claims History
NCPDP National Council for Prescription
Drug Programs
NCQDIS National Coalition of Quality
Diagnostic Imaging Services
NDC National drug code
NF Nursing facility
NISTA National Institute of Standards and
Technology Act
NP Nurse practitioner
NPDB National Practitioner Data Bank
NPI National Provider Identifier
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
NPP Nonphysician practitioner
NPPES National Plan and Provider
Enumeration System
NQF National Quality Forum
NRC Nuclear Regulatory Commission
NTTAA National Technology Transfer and
Advancement Act of 1995 (Pub. L. 104–
113)
NUBC National Uniform Billing Committee
OACT [CMS’] Office of the Actuary
OBRA Omnibus Budget Reconciliation Act
ODF Open door forum
OIG Office of Inspector General
OMB Office of Management and Budget
ONC [HHS’] Office of the National
Coordinator
OPPS Outpatient prospective payment
system
OSA Obstructive Sleep Apnea
OSCAR Online Survey and Certification
and Reporting
P4P Pay for performance
PA Physician assistant
PBM Pharmacy benefit manager
PC Professional component
PCF Patient compensation fund
PCI Percutaneous coronary intervention
PDE Prescription drug event
PDP Prescription drug plan
PE Practice expense
PE/HR Practice expense per hour
PEAC Practice Expense Advisory
Committee
PECOS Provider Enrollment, Chain, and
Ownership System
PERC Practice Expense Review Committee
PFS Physician Fee Schedule
PGP [Medicare] Physician Group Practice
PHP Partial hospitalization program
PIM [Medicare] Program Integrity Manual
PLI Professional liability insurance
POA Present on admission
POC Plan of care
PPI Producer price index
PPIS Physician Practice Information Survey
PPS Prospective payment system
PPTA Plasma Protein Therapeutics
Association
PQRI Physician Quality Reporting Initiative
PRA Paperwork Reduction Act
PSA Physician scarcity areas
PSG Polysomnography
PT Physical therapy
PTCA Percutaneous transluminal coronary
angioplasty
RA Radiology assistant
Recovery Act American Recovery and
Reinvestment Act (Pub. L. 111–5)
ResDAC Research Data Assistance Center
RFA Regulatory Flexibility Act
RIA Regulatory impact analysis
RN Registered nurse
RNAC Reasonable net acquisition cost
RPA Radiology practitioner assistant
RRT Registered respiratory therapist
RUC [AMA’s Specialty Society] Relative
(Value) Update Committee
RVU Relative value unit
SBA Small Business Administration
SGR Sustainable growth rate
SLP Speech-language pathology
SMS [AMA’s] Socioeconomic Monitoring
System
SNF Skilled nursing facility
SOR System of record
SRS Stereotactic radiosurgery
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
TC Technical Component
TIN Tax identification number
TRHCA Tax Relief and Health Care Act of
2006 (Pub. L. 109–432)
TTO Transtracheal oxygen
UPMC University of Pittsburgh Medical
Center
USDE United States Department of
Education
VBP Value-based purchasing
WAMP Widely available market price
I. Background
Since January 1, 1992, Medicare has
paid for physicians’ services under
section 1848 of the Social Security Act
(the Act), ‘‘Payment for Physicians’
Services.’’ The Act requires that
payments under the physician fee
schedule (PFS) be based on national
uniform relative value units (RVUs)
based on the relative resources used in
furnishing a service. Section 1848(c) of
the Act requires that national RVUs be
established for physician work, practice
expense (PE), and malpractice expense.
Before the establishment of the
resource-based relative value system,
Medicare payment for physicians’
services was based on reasonable
charges.
A. Development of the Relative Value
System
1. Work RVUs
The concepts and methodology
underlying the PFS were enacted as part
of the Omnibus Budget Reconciliation
Act (OBRA) of 1989 (Pub. L. 101–239),
and OBRA 1990, (Pub. L. 101–508). The
final rule, published on November 25,
1991 (56 FR 59502), set forth the fee
schedule for payment for physicians’
services beginning January 1, 1992.
Initially, only the physician work RVUs
were resource-based, and the PE and
malpractice RVUs were based on
average allowable charges.
The physician work RVUs established
for the implementation of the fee
schedule in January 1992 were
developed with extensive input from
the physician community. A research
team at the Harvard School of Public
Health developed the original physician
work RVUs for most codes in a
cooperative agreement with the
Department of Health and Human
Services (DHHS). In constructing the
code-specific vignettes for the original
physician work RVUs, Harvard worked
with panels of experts, both inside and
outside the Federal government, and
obtained input from numerous
physician specialty groups.
Section 1848(b)(2)(B) of the Act
specifies that the RVUs for anesthesia
services are based on RVUs from a
uniform relative value guide, with
PO 00000
Frm 00005
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33523
appropriate adjustment of the
conversion factor (CF), in a manner to
assure that fee schedule amounts for
anesthesia services are consistent with
those for other services of comparable
value. We established a separate CF for
anesthesia services, and we continue to
utilize time units as a factor in
determining payment for these services.
As a result, there is a separate payment
methodology for anesthesia services.
We establish physician work RVUs for
new and revised codes based on our
review of recommendations received
from the American Medical
Association’s (AMA) Specialty Society
Relative Value Update Committee
(RUC).
2. Practice Expense Relative Value Units
(PE RVUs)
Section 121 of the Social Security Act
Amendments of 1994 (Pub. L. 103–432),
enacted on October 31, 1994, amended
section 1848(c)(2)(C)(ii) of the Act and
required us to develop resource-based
PE RVUs for each physician’s service
beginning in 1998. We were to consider
general categories of expenses (such as
office rent and wages of personnel, but
excluding malpractice expenses)
comprising PEs.
Section 4505(a) of the Balanced
Budget Act of 1997 (BBA) (Pub. L. 105–
33), amended section 1848(c)(2)(C)(ii) of
the Act to delay implementation of the
resource-based PE RVU system until
January 1, 1999. In addition, section
4505(b) of the BBA provided for a 4-year
transition period from charge-based PE
RVUs to resource-based RVUs.
We established the resource-based PE
RVUs for each physicians’ service in a
final rule, published November 2, 1998
(63 FR 58814), effective for services
furnished in 1999. Based on the
requirement to transition to a resourcebased system for PE over a 4-year
period, resource-based PE RVUs did not
become fully effective until 2002.
This resource-based system was based
on two significant sources of actual PE
data: The Clinical Practice Expert Panel
(CPEP) data; and the AMA’s
Socioeconomic Monitoring System
(SMS) data. The CPEP data were
collected from panels of physicians,
practice administrators, and
nonphysicians (for example, registered
nurses (RNs)) nominated by physician
specialty societies and other groups.
The CPEP panels identified the direct
inputs required for each physician’s
service in both the office setting and
out-of-office setting. We have since
refined and revised these inputs based
on recommendations from the RUC. The
AMA’s SMS data provided aggregate
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33524
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
specialty-specific information on hours
worked and PEs.
Separate PE RVUs are established for
procedures that can be performed in
both a nonfacility setting, such as a
physician’s office, and a facility setting,
such as a hospital outpatient
department. The difference between the
facility and nonfacility RVUs reflects
the fact that a facility typically receives
separate payment from Medicare for its
costs of providing the service, apart
from payment under the PFS. The
nonfacility RVUs reflect all of the direct
and indirect PEs of providing a
particular service.
Section 212 of the Balanced Budget
Refinement Act of 1999 (BBRA) (Pub. L.
106–113) directed the Secretary of
Health and Human Services (the
Secretary) to establish a process under
which we accept and use, to the
maximum extent practicable and
consistent with sound data practices,
data collected or developed by entities
and organizations to supplement the
data we normally collect in determining
the PE component. On May 3, 2000, we
published the interim final rule (65 FR
25664) that set forth the criteria for the
submission of these supplemental PE
survey data. The criteria were modified
in response to comments received, and
published in the Federal Register (65
FR 65376) as part of a November 1, 2000
final rule. The PFS final rules published
in 2001 and 2003, respectively, (66 FR
55246 and 68 FR 63196) extended the
period during which we would accept
these supplemental data through
March 1, 2005.
In the Calendar Year (CY) 2007 PFS
final rule with comment period (71 FR
69624), we revised the methodology for
calculating PE RVUs beginning in CY
2007 and provided for a 4-year
transition for the new PE RVUs under
this new methodology.
3. Resource-Based Malpractice (MP)
RVUs
Section 4505(f) of the BBA amended
section 1848(c) of the Act requiring us
to implement resource-based
malpractice (MP) RVUs for services
furnished on or after 2000. The
resource-based MP RVUs were
implemented in the PFS final rule
published November 2, 1999 (64 FR
59380). The MP RVUs were based on
malpractice insurance premium data
collected from commercial and
physician-owned insurers from all the
States, the District of Columbia, and
Puerto Rico.
4. Refinements to the RVUs
Section 1848(c)(2)(B)(i) of the Act
requires that we review all RVUs no less
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
often than every 5 years. The first 5-Year
Review of the physician work RVUs was
published on November 22, 1996 (61 FR
59489) and was effective in 1997. The
second 5-Year Review was published in
the CY 2002 PFS final rule with
comment period (66 FR 55246) and was
effective in 2002. The third 5-Year
Review of physician work RVUs was
published in the CY 2007 PFS final rule
with comment period (71 FR 69624) and
was effective on January 1, 2007. (Note:
Additional codes relating to the third 5Year Review of physician work RVUs
were addressed in the CY 2008 PFS
final rule with comment period (72 FR
66360).)
In 1999, the AMA’s RUC established
the Practice Expense Advisory
Committee (PEAC) for the purpose of
refining the direct PE inputs. Through
March 2004, the PEAC provided
recommendations to CMS for over 7,600
codes (all but a few hundred of the
codes currently listed in the AMA’s
Current Procedural Terminology (CPT)
codes). As part of the CY 2007 PFS final
rule with comment period (71 FR
69624), we implemented a new
methodology for determining resourcebased PE RVUs and are transitioning
this over a 4-year period. (Note: In
section II.A.2. of this proposed rule, we
are proposing to use new survey data
under the PE methodology.)
In the CY 2005 PFS final rule with
comment period (69 FR 66236), we
implemented the first 5-Year Review of
the MP RVUs (69 FR 66263). (Note: In
section II.C. of this proposed rule, we
are proposing to update the malpractice
RVUs with the use of new data.)
5. Adjustments to RVUs are Budget
Neutral
Section 1848(c)(2)(B)(ii)(II) of the Act
provides that adjustments in RVUs for a
year may not cause total PFS payments
to differ by more than $20 million from
what they would have been if the
adjustments were not made. In
accordance with section
1848(c)(2)(B)(ii)(II) of the Act, if
adjustments to RVUs cause
expenditures to change by more than
$20 million, we make adjustments to
ensure that expenditures do not increase
or decrease by more than $20 million.
As explained in the CY 2009 PFS final
rule with comment period (73 FR
69730), as required by section 133(b) of
the Medicare Improvements for Patients
and Providers Act of 2008 (MIPPA)
(Pub. L. 110–275), the separate budget
neutrality (BN) adjustor resulting from
the third 5-Year Review of physician
work RVUs is being applied to the CF
beginning with CY 2009 rather than the
work RVUs.
PO 00000
Frm 00006
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
B. Components of the Fee Schedule
Payment Amounts
To calculate the payment for every
physicians’ service, the components of
the fee schedule (physician work, PE,
and MP RVUs) are adjusted by a
geographic practice cost index (GPCI).
The GPCIs reflect the relative costs of
physician work, PE, and malpractice
expense in an area compared to the
national average costs for each
component.
RVUs are converted to dollar amounts
through the application of a CF, which
is calculated by CMS’ Office of the
Actuary (OACT).
The formula for calculating the
Medicare fee schedule payment amount
for a given service and fee schedule area
can be expressed as:
Payment = [(RVU work × GPCI work) +
(RVU PE × GPCI PE) + (RVU
malpractice × GPCI malpractice)] ×
CF
C. Most Recent Changes to the Fee
Schedule
The CY 2009 PFS final rule with
comment period (73 FR 69726)
implemented changes to the PFS and
other Medicare Part B payment policies
finalized the CY 2008 interim RVUs and
implemented interim RVUs for new and
revised codes for CY 2009 to ensure that
our payment systems are updated to
reflect changes in medical practice and
the relative value of services.
The CY 2009 PFS final rule with
comment period also addressed other
policies, as well as certain provisions of
the MIPPA.
As required by the statute, and based
on section 131 of the MIPPA, the CY
2009 PFS final rule with comment
period also announced that the PFS
update is 1.1 percent for CY 2009, the
initial estimate for the sustainable
growth rate for CY 2009 is 7.4 percent,
and the conversion factor (CF) for CY
2009 is $36.0666.
II. Provisions of the Proposed
Regulation
A. Resource-Based Practice Expense
(PE) Relative Value Units (RVUs)
Practice expense (PE) is the portion of
the resources used in furnishing the
service that reflects the general
categories of physician and practitioner
expenses, such as office rent and
personnel wages but excluding
malpractice expenses, as specified in
section 1848(c)(1)(B) of the Act.
Section 121 of the Social Security
Amendments of 1994 (Pub. L. 103–432),
enacted on October 31, 1994, required
CMS to develop a methodology for a
resource-based system for determining
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
PE RVUs for each physician’s service.
Until that time, PE RVUs were based on
historical allowed charges. This
legislation stated that the revised PE
methodology must consider the staff,
equipment, and supplies used in the
provision of various medical and
surgical services in various settings
beginning in 1998. The Secretary has
interpreted this to mean that Medicare
payments for each service would be
based on the relative PE resources
typically involved with furnishing the
service.
The initial implementation of
resource-based PE RVUs was delayed
from January 1, 1998, until January 1,
1999, by section 4505(a) of the BBA. In
addition, section 4505(b) of the BBA
required that the new payment
methodology be phased in over 4 years,
effective for services furnished in CY
1999, and fully effective in CY 2002.
The first step toward implementation of
the statute was to adjust the PE values
for certain services for CY 1998. Section
4505(d) of the BBA required that, in
developing the resource-based PE RVUs,
the Secretary must—
• Use, to the maximum extent
possible, generally-accepted cost
accounting principles that recognize all
staff, equipment, supplies, and
expenses, not solely those that can be
linked to specific procedures and actual
data on equipment utilization.
• Develop a refinement method to be
used during the transition.
• Consider, in the course of notice
and comment rulemaking, impact
projections that compare new proposed
payment amounts to data on actual
physician PE.
In CY 1999, we began the 4-year
transition to resource-based PE RVUs
utilizing a ‘‘top-down’’ methodology
whereby we allocated aggregate
specialty-specific practice costs to
individual procedures. The specialtyspecific PEs were derived from the
American Medical Association’s
(AMA’s) Socioeconomic Monitoring
Survey (SMS). In addition, under
section 212 of the BBRA, we established
a process extending through March 2005
to supplement the SMS data with data
submitted by a specialty. The aggregate
PEs for a given specialty were then
allocated to the services furnished by
that specialty on the basis of the direct
input data (that is, the staff time,
equipment, and supplies) and work
RVUs assigned to each CPT code.
For CY 2007, we implemented a new
methodology for calculating PE RVUs.
Under this new methodology, we use
the same data sources for calculating PE,
but instead of using the ‘‘top-down’’
approach to calculate the direct PE
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
RVUs, under which the aggregate direct
and indirect costs for each specialty are
allocated to each individual service, we
now utilize a ‘‘bottom-up’’ approach to
calculate the direct costs. Under the
‘‘bottom up’’ approach, we determine
the direct PE by adding the costs of the
resources (that is, the clinical staff,
equipment, and supplies) typically
required to provide each service. The
costs of the resources are calculated
using the refined direct PE inputs
assigned to each CPT code in our PE
database, which are based on our review
of recommendations received from the
AMA’s Relative Value Update
Committee (RUC). For a more detailed
explanation of the PE methodology, see
the Five-Year Review of Work Relative
Value Units Under the PFS and
Proposed Changes to the Practice
Expense Methodology proposed notice
(71 FR 37242) and the CY 2007 PFS
final rule with comment period (71 FR
69629).
Note: In section II.A.1 of this proposed
rule, we discuss the current methodology
used for calculating PE. In section II.A.2. of
this proposed rule, which contains PE
proposals for CY 2010, we are proposing to
use data from the AMA Physician Practice
Information Survey (PPIS) in place of the
AMA’s SMS survey data and supplemental
survey data that is currently used in the PE
methodology.
1. Current Methodology
a. Data Sources for Calculating Practice
Expense
The AMA’s SMS survey data and
supplemental survey data from the
specialties of cardiothoracic surgery,
vascular surgery, physical and
occupational therapy, independent
laboratories, allergy/immunology,
cardiology, dermatology,
gastroenterology, radiology,
independent diagnostic testing facilities
(IDTFs), radiation oncology, and urology
are used to develop the PE per hour (PE/
HR) for each specialty. For those
specialties for which we do not have
PE/HR, the appropriate PE/HR is
obtained from a crosswalk to a similar
specialty.
The AMA developed the SMS survey
in 1981 and discontinued it in 1999.
Beginning in 2002, we incorporated the
1999 SMS survey data into our
calculation of the PE RVUs, using a 5year average of SMS survey data. (See
the CY 2002 PFS final rule with
comment period (66 FR 55246).) The
SMS PE survey data are adjusted to a
common year, 2005. The SMS data
provide the following six categories of
PE costs:
• Clinical payroll expenses, which
are payroll expenses (including fringe
PO 00000
Frm 00007
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33525
benefits) for nonphysician clinical
personnel.
• Administrative payroll expenses,
which are payroll expenses (including
fringe benefits) for nonphysician
personnel involved in administrative,
secretarial, or clerical activities.
• Office expenses, which include
expenses for rent, mortgage interest,
depreciation on medical buildings,
utilities, and telephones.
• Medical material and supply
expenses, which include expenses for
drugs, x-ray films, and disposable
medical products.
• Medical equipment expenses,
which include depreciation, leases, and
rent of medical equipment used in the
diagnosis or treatment of patients.
• All other expenses, which include
expenses for legal services, accounting,
office management, professional
association memberships, and any
professional expenses not previously
mentioned in this section.
In accordance with section 212 of the
BBRA, we established a process to
supplement the SMS data for a specialty
with data collected by entities and
organizations other than the AMA (that
is, those entities and organizations
representing the specialty itself). (See
the Criteria for Submitting
Supplemental Practice Expense Survey
Data interim final rule with comment
period (65 FR 25664).) Originally, the
deadline to submit supplementary
survey data was through August 1, 2001.
In the CY 2002 PFS final rule (66 FR
55246), the deadline was extended
through August 1, 2003. To ensure
maximum opportunity for specialties to
submit supplementary survey data, we
extended the deadline to submit surveys
until March 1, 2005 in the Revisions to
Payment Policies Under the Physician
Fee Schedule for CY 2004 final rule
with comment period (68 FR 63196)
(hereinafter referred to as CY 2004 PFS
final rule with comment period).
The direct cost data for individual
services were originally developed by
the Clinical Practice Expert Panels
(CPEP). The CPEP data include the
supplies, equipment, and staff times
specific to each procedure. The CPEPs
consisted of panels of physicians,
practice administrators, and
nonphysicians (for example, RNs) who
were nominated by physician specialty
societies and other groups. There were
15 CPEPs consisting of 180 members
from more than 61 specialties and
subspecialties. Approximately 50
percent of the panelists were
physicians.
The CPEPs identified specific inputs
involved in each physician’s service
provided in an office or facility setting.
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33526
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
The inputs identified were the quantity
and type of nonphysician labor, medical
supplies, and medical equipment. The
CPEP data has been regularly updated
by various RUC committees on PE.
b. Allocation of PE to Services
The aggregate level specialty-specific
PEs are derived from the AMA’s SMS
survey and supplementary survey data.
To establish PE RVUs for specific
services, it is necessary to establish the
direct and indirect PE associated with
each service.
(i) Direct costs. The direct costs are
determined by adding the costs of the
resources (that is, the clinical staff,
equipment, and supplies) typically
required to provide the service. The
costs of these resources are calculated
from the refined direct PE inputs in our
PE database. These direct inputs are
then scaled to the current aggregate pool
of direct PE RVUs. The aggregate pool
of direct PE RVUs can be derived using
the following formula: (PE RVUs ×
physician CF) × (average direct
percentage from SMS /(Supplemental
PE/HR data)).
(ii) Indirect costs. The SMS and
supplementary survey data are the
source for the specialty-specific
aggregate indirect costs used in our PE
calculations. We then allocate the
indirect costs to the code level on the
basis of the direct costs specifically
associated with a code and the greater
of either the clinical labor costs or the
physician work RVUs. For calculation of
the 2010 PE RVUs, we use the 2008
procedure-specific utilization data
crosswalked to 2010 services. To arrive
at the indirect PE costs—
• We apply a specialty-specific
indirect percentage factor to the direct
expenses to recognize the varying
proportion that indirect costs represent
of total costs by specialty. For a given
service, the specific indirect percentage
factor to apply to the direct costs for the
purpose of the indirect allocation is
calculated as the weighted average of
the ratio of the indirect to direct costs
(based on the survey data) for the
specialties that furnish the service. For
example, if a service is furnished by a
single specialty with indirect PEs that
were 75 percent of total PEs, the indirect
percentage factor to apply to the direct
costs for the purposes of the indirect
allocation would be (0.75/0.25) = 3.0.
The indirect percentage factor is then
applied to the service level adjusted
indirect PE allocators.
• We use the specialty-specific PE/HR
from the SMS survey data, as well as the
supplemental surveys for cardiothoracic
surgery, vascular surgery, physical and
occupational therapy, independent
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
laboratories, allergy/immunology,
cardiology, dermatology, radiology,
gastroenterology, IDTFs, radiation
oncology, and urology. (Note: For
radiation oncology, the data represent
the combined survey data from the
American Society for Therapeutic
Radiology and Oncology (ASTRO) and
the Association of Freestanding
Radiation Oncology Centers (AFROC)).
As discussed in the CY 2008 PFS final
rule with comment period (72 FR
66233), the PE/HR survey data for
radiology is weighted by practice size.
We incorporate this PE/HR into the
calculation of indirect costs using an
index which reflects the relationship
between each specialty’s indirect
scaling factor and the overall indirect
scaling factor for the entire PFS. For
example, if a specialty had an indirect
practice cost index of 2.00, this
specialty would have an indirect scaling
factor that was twice the overall average
indirect scaling factor. If a specialty had
an indirect practice cost index of 0.50,
this specialty would have an indirect
scaling factor that was half the overall
average indirect scaling factor.
• When the clinical labor portion of
the direct PE RVU is greater than the
physician work RVU for a particular
service, the indirect costs are allocated
based upon the direct costs and the
clinical labor costs. For example, if a
service has no physician work and 1.10
direct PE RVUs, and the clinical labor
portion of the direct PE RVUs is 0.65
RVUs, we would use the 1.10 direct PE
RVUs and the 0.65 clinical labor
portions of the direct PE RVUs to
allocate the indirect PE for that service.
c. Facility and Nonfacility Costs
Procedures that can be furnished in a
physician’s office, as well as in a
hospital or facility setting have two PE
RVUs: Facility and nonfacility. The
nonfacility setting includes physicians’
offices, patients’ homes, freestanding
imaging centers, and independent
pathology labs. Facility settings include
hospitals, ambulatory surgical centers
(ASCs), and skilled nursing facilities
(SNFs). The methodology for calculating
PE RVUs is the same for both facility
and nonfacility RVUs, but is applied
independently to yield two separate PE
RVUs. Because the PEs for services
provided in a facility setting are
generally included in the payment to
the facility (rather than the payment to
the physician under the PFS), the PE
RVUs are generally lower for services
provided in the facility setting.
PO 00000
Frm 00008
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
d. Services With Technical Components
(TCs) and Professional Components
(PCs)
Diagnostic services are generally
comprised of two components: A
professional component (PC) and a
technical component (TC), both of
which may be performed independently
or by different providers. When services
have TCs, PCs, and global components
that can be billed separately, the
payment for the global component
equals the sum of the payment for the
TC and PC. This is a result of using a
weighted average of the ratio of indirect
to direct costs across all the specialties
that furnish the global components, TCs,
and PCs; that is, we apply the same
weighted average indirect percentage
factor to allocate indirect expenses to
the global components, PCs, and TCs for
a service. (The direct PE RVUs for the
TC and PC sum to the global under the
bottom-up methodology.)
e. Transition Period
As discussed in the CY 2007 PFS final
rule with comment period (71 FR
69674), the change to the PE
methodology was implemented over a 4year period. In CY 2010, the transition
period is concluded and PE RVUs will
be calculated based entirely on the
current methodology.
f. PE RVU Methodology
The following is a description of the
PE RVU methodology.
(i) Setup File
First, we create a setup file for the PE
methodology. The setup file contains
the direct cost inputs, the utilization for
each procedure code at the specialty
and facility/nonfacility place of service
level, and the specialty-specific survey
PE per physician hour data.
(ii) Calculate the Direct Cost PE RVUs
Sum the Costs of Each Direct Input
Step 1: Sum the direct costs of the
inputs for each service. The direct costs
consist of the costs of the direct inputs
for clinical labor, medical supplies, and
medical equipment. The clinical labor
cost is the sum of the cost of all the staff
types associated with the service; it is
the product of the time for each staff
type and the wage rate for that staff
type. The medical supplies cost is the
sum of the supplies associated with the
service; it is the product of the quantity
of each supply and the cost of the
supply. The medical equipment cost is
the sum of the cost of the equipment
associated with the service; it is the
product of the number of minutes each
piece of equipment is used in the
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
service and the equipment cost per
minute. The equipment cost per minute
is calculated as described at the end of
this section.
Apply a BN Adjustment to the Direct
Inputs
Step 2: Calculate the current aggregate
pool of direct PE costs. To do this,
multiply the current aggregate pool of
total direct and indirect PE costs (that is,
the current aggregate PE RVUs
multiplied by the CF) by the average
direct PE percentage from the SMS and
supplementary specialty survey data.
Step 3: Calculate the aggregate pool of
direct costs. To do this, for all PFS
services, sum the product of the direct
costs for each service from Step 1 and
the utilization data for that service.
Step 4: Using the results of Step 2 and
Step 3 calculate a direct PE BN
adjustment so that the aggregate direct
cost pool does not exceed the current
aggregate direct cost pool and apply it
to the direct costs from Step 1 for each
service.
Step 5: Convert the results of Step 4
to an RVU scale for each service. To do
this, divide the results of Step 4 by the
Medicare PFS CF.
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
(iii) Create the indirect PE RVUs.
Create indirect allocators.
Step 6: Based on the SMS and
supplementary specialty survey data,
calculate direct and indirect PE
percentages for each physician
specialty.
Step 7: Calculate direct and indirect
PE percentages at the service level by
taking a weighted average of the results
of Step 6 for the specialties that furnish
the service. Note that for services with
TCs and PCs, we are calculating the
direct and indirect percentages across
the global components, PCs, and TCs.
That is, the direct and indirect
percentages for a given service (for
example, echocardiogram) do not vary
by the PC, TC and global component.
Step 8: Calculate the service level
allocators for the indirect PEs based on
the percentages calculated in Step 7.
The indirect PEs are allocated based on
the three components: The direct PE
RVU, the clinical PE RVU, and the work
RVU.
For most services the indirect
allocator is: indirect percentage * (direct
PE RVU/direct percentage) + work RVU.
There are two situations where this
formula is modified:
• If the service is a global service (that
is, a service with global, professional,
and technical components), then the
indirect allocator is: Indirect percentage
* (direct PE RVU/direct percentage) +
clinical PE RVU + work RVU.
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
• If the clinical labor PE RVU exceeds
the work RVU (and the service is not a
global service), then the indirect
allocator is: Indirect percentage * (direct
PE RVU/direct percentage) + clinical PE
RVU.
Note: For global services, the indirect
allocator is based on both the work RVU and
the clinical labor PE RVU. We do this to
recognize that, for the professional service,
indirect PEs will be allocated using the work
RVUs, and for the TC service, indirect PEs
will be allocated using the direct PE RVU and
the clinical labor PE RVU. This also allows
the global component RVUs to equal the sum
of the PC and TC RVUs.
For presentation purposes in the
examples in the Table 1, the formulas
were divided into two parts for each
service. The first part does not vary by
service and is the indirect percentage *
(direct PE RVU/direct percentage). The
second part is either the work RVU,
clinical PE RVU, or both depending on
whether the service is a global service
and whether the clinical PE RVU
exceeds the work RVU (as described
earlier in this step.)
Apply a BN Adjustment to the Indirect
Allocators
Step 9: Calculate the current aggregate
pool of indirect PE RVUs by multiplying
the current aggregate pool of PE RVUs
by the average indirect PE percentage
from the physician specialty survey
data. This is similar to the Step 2
calculation for the direct PE RVUs.
Step 10: Calculate an aggregate pool of
indirect PE RVUs for all PFS services by
adding the product of the indirect PE
allocators for a service from Step 8 and
the utilization data for that service. This
is similar to the Step 3 calculation for
the direct PE RVUs.
Step 11: Using the results of Step 9
and Step 10, calculate an indirect PE
adjustment so that the aggregate indirect
allocation does not exceed the available
aggregate indirect PE RVUs and apply it
to indirect allocators calculated in Step
8. This is similar to the Step 4
calculation for the direct PE RVUs.
Calculate the Indirect Practice Cost
Index
Step 12: Using the results of Step 11,
calculate aggregate pools of specialtyspecific adjusted indirect PE allocators
for all PFS services for a specialty by
adding the product of the adjusted
indirect PE allocator for each service
and the utilization data for that service.
Step 13: Using the specialty-specific
indirect PE/HR data, calculate specialtyspecific aggregate pools of indirect PE
for all PFS services for that specialty by
adding the product of the indirect PE/
HR for the specialty, the physician time
PO 00000
Frm 00009
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33527
for the service, and the specialty’s
utilization for the service.
Step 14: Using the results of Step 12
and Step 13, calculate the specialtyspecific indirect PE scaling factors as
under the current methodology.
Step 15: Using the results of Step 14,
calculate an indirect practice cost index
at the specialty level by dividing each
specialty-specific indirect scaling factor
by the average indirect scaling factor for
the entire PFS.
Step 16: Calculate the indirect
practice cost index at the service level
to ensure the capture of all indirect
costs. Calculate a weighted average of
the practice cost index values for the
specialties that furnish the service.
Note: For services with TCs and PCs, we
calculate the indirect practice cost index
across the global components, PCs, and TCs.
Under this method, the indirect practice cost
index for a given service (for example,
echocardiogram) does not vary by the PC, TC
and global component.
Step 17: Apply the service level
indirect practice cost index calculated
in Step 16 to the service level adjusted
indirect allocators calculated in Step 11
to get the indirect PE RVU.
(iv) Calculate the Final PE RVUs
Step 18: Add the direct PE RVUs from
Step 6 to the indirect PE RVUs from
Step 17.
Step 19: Calculate and apply the final
PE BN adjustment by comparing the
results of Step 18 to the current pool of
PE RVUs. This final BN adjustment is
required primarily because certain
specialties are excluded from the PE
RVU calculation for ratesetting
purposes, but all specialties are
included for purposes of calculating the
final BN adjustment. (See ‘‘Specialties
excluded from ratesetting calculation’’
below in this section.)
(v) Setup File Information
• Specialties excluded from
ratesetting calculation: For the purposes
of calculating the PE RVUs, we exclude
certain specialties such as midlevel
practitioners paid at a percentage of the
PFS, audiology, and low volume
specialties from the calculation. These
specialties are included for the purposes
of calculating the BN adjustment.
• Crosswalk certain low volume
physician specialties: Crosswalk the
utilization of certain specialties with
relatively low PFS utilization to the
associated specialties.
• Physical therapy utilization:
Crosswalk the utilization associated
with all physical therapy services to the
specialty of physical therapy.
• Identify professional and technical
services not identified under the usual
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33528
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
TC and 26 modifiers: Flag the services
that are PC and TC services, but do not
use TC and 26 modifiers (for example,
electrocardiograms). This flag associates
the PC and TC with the associated
global code for use in creating the
indirect PE RVU. For example, the
professional service code 93010 is
associated with the global code 93000.
• Payment modifiers: Payment
modifiers are accounted for in the
creation of the file. For example,
services billed with the assistant at
surgery modifier are paid 16 percent of
the PFS amount for that service;
therefore, the utilization file is modified
to only account for 16 percent of any
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
service that contains the assistant at
surgery modifier.
• Work RVUs: The setup file contains
the work RVUs from this proposed rule.
(vi) Equipment cost per minute
The equipment cost per minute is
calculated as:
(1/(minutes per year * usage)) * price *
((interest rate/(1¥(1/((1 + interest
rate) ** life of equipment)))) +
maintenance)
Where:
minutes per year = maximum minutes per
year if usage were continuous (that is,
usage = 1); 150,000 minutes.
PO 00000
Frm 00010
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
usage = equipment utilization assumption;
0.9 for certain equipment (see section
II.A.2. of this proposed rule) and 0.5. for
others.
price = price of the particular piece of
equipment.
interest rate = 0.11.
life of equipment = useful life of the
particular piece of equipment.
maintenance = factor for maintenance; 0.05.
Note: To illustrate the PE calculation, in
Table 1 we have used the conversion factor
(CF) of $36.0666 which is the CF effective
January 1, 2009 as published in CY 2009 PFS
final rule with comment period.
BILLING CODE 4120–01–P
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00011
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33529
EP13JY09.139
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
33530
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
BILLING CODE 4120–01–C
Note: Proposed PE RVU in Table 1, row 27,
may not match Addendum B due to
rounding.
* The direct adj = [current PE RVUs * CF
* avg dir pct] / [sum direct inputs] = [Step
2] / [Step 3]
** The indirect adj = [current PE RVUs *
avg ind pct] / [sum of ind allocators] = [Step
9] / [Step 10]
2. PE Proposals for CY 2010
a. SMS and Supplemental Survey
Background
Currently, we use PE/HR obtained
from the SMS surveys from 1995–1999.
For several specialties that collected
additional PE/HR data through a more
recent supplemental survey, we
accepted and incorporated these data in
developing current PE/HR values.
While the SMS survey was not
specifically designed for the purpose of
establishing PE RVUs, we found these
data to be the best available at the time.
The SMS was a multi-specialty survey
effort conducted using a consistent
survey instrument and method across
specialties. The survey sample was
randomly drawn from the AMA
Physician Masterfile to ensure national
representativeness. The AMA
discontinued the SMS survey in 1999.
As required by the BBRA, we also
established a process by which specialty
groups could submit supplemental PE
data. In the May 3, 2000 interim final
rule entitled, Medicare Program; Criteria
for Submitting Supplemental Practice
Expense Survey Data, (65 FR 25664), we
established criteria for acceptance of
supplemental data. The criteria were
modified in the CY 2001 and CY 2003
PFS final rules with comment period
(65 FR 65380 and 67 FR 79971,
respectively). We currently use
supplemental survey data for the
following specialties: Cardiology;
dermatology; gastroenterology;
radiology; cardiothoracic surgery;
vascular surgery; physical and
occupational therapy; independent
laboratories; allergy/immunology;
independent diagnostic testing facilities
(IDTFs); radiation oncology; medical
oncology; and urology.
Because the SMS data and the
supplemental survey data are from
different time periods, we have
historically inflated them by the MEI to
help put them on as comparable a time
basis as we can when calculating the PE
RVUs. This MEI proxy has been
necessary in the past due to the lack of
contemporaneous, consistently
collected, and comprehensive
multispecialty survey data.
b. Physician Practice Information
Survey (PPIS)
The AMA has conducted a new
survey, the PPIS, which was expanded
(relative to the SMS) to include
nonphysician practitioners (NPPs) paid
under the PFS. The PPIS, administered
in CY 2007 and CY 2008, was designed
to update the specialty-specific PE/HR
data used to develop PE RVUs.
The AMA and our contractor, The
Lewin Group (Lewin), analyzed the
PPIS data and calculated the PE/HR for
physician and nonphysician specialties,
respectively. The AMA’s summary
worksheets and Lewin’s final report are
available on the CMS Web site at
https://www.cms.gov/
PhysicianFeeSched/. (See AMA PPIS
Worksheets 1–3 and Lewin Group Final
Report PPIS.) Table 2 shows the current
indirect PE/HR based on SMS and
supplemental surveys, the PPIS indirect
PE/HR, and the indirect cost
percentages of total costs.
TABLE 2—INDIRECT PE/HR AND INDIRECT PERCENTAGES
[Current and PPIS]
Current
indirect
PE/HR
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Specialty
All Physicians. ........................................................................
Allergy and Immunology ........................................................
Anesthesiology .......................................................................
Audiology ................................................................................
Cardiology ..............................................................................
Cardiothoracic Surgery ..........................................................
Chiropractor ............................................................................
Clinical Laboratory (Billing Independently) * ..........................
Clinical Psychology ................................................................
Clinical Social Work ...............................................................
Colon & Rectal Surgery .........................................................
Dermatology ...........................................................................
Emergency Medicine ..............................................................
Endocrinology .........................................................................
Family Medicine .....................................................................
Gastroenterology ....................................................................
General Practice ....................................................................
General Surgery .....................................................................
Geriatrics ................................................................................
Hand Surgery .........................................................................
Independent Diagnostic Testing Facilities * ...........................
Internal Medicine ....................................................................
Interventional Pain Medicine ..................................................
Interventional Radiology .........................................................
Medical Oncology ...................................................................
Nephrology .............................................................................
Neurology ...............................................................................
Neurosurgery ..........................................................................
Nuclear Medicine ...................................................................
Obstetrics/Gynecology ...........................................................
Ophthalmology .......................................................................
Optometry ...............................................................................
Oral Surgery (Dentist only) ....................................................
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00012
PPIS
indirect
PE/HR
$59.04
153.29
19.76
59.04
131.02
61.75
49.60
66.46
29.07
29.07
53.93
158.49
36.85
49.60
52.79
101.30
52.79
53.93
49.60
98.56
466.16
49.60
59.04
118.48
141.84
49.60
66.05
89.64
118.48
69.74
103.28
59.04
96.01
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
$86.36
162.68
29.37
72.17
88.04
67.83
65.33
71.01
20.07
17.80
90.85
184.62
38.36
84.39
90.15
96.78
78.59
82.74
54.14
148.78
501.45
84.03
156.79
82.55
129.94
66.00
110.39
115.76
39.80
99.32
170.08
88.02
173.19
Current
indirect
%
PPIS
indirect
%
67
62
56
67
56
68
69
37
90
90
77
70
88
69
62
70
62
77
69
72
50
69
67
58
59
69
74
86
58
67
65
67
71
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
Current crosswalk
74
67
82
85
65
83
86
37
93
97
80
70
94
73
76
75
69
82
74
77
50
76
70
81
56
80
87
87
77
67
70
77
65
13JYP2
All Physicians.
Internal Medicine.
Psychiatry.
Psychiatry.
All Physicians.
Otolaryngology.
33531
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
TABLE 2—INDIRECT PE/HR AND INDIRECT PERCENTAGES—Continued
[Current and PPIS]
Current
indirect
PE/HR
Specialty
Orthopaedic Surgery ..............................................................
Osteopathic Manipulative Therapy ........................................
Otolaryngology .......................................................................
Pain Medicine .........................................................................
Pathology ...............................................................................
Pediatrics ................................................................................
Physical Medicine and Rehabilitation ....................................
Physical Therapy ....................................................................
Plastic Surgery .......................................................................
Podiatry ..................................................................................
Psychiatry ...............................................................................
Pulmonary Disease ................................................................
Radiation Oncology (Hospital Based & Freestanding) ..........
Radiology ...............................................................................
Registered Dieticians .............................................................
Rheumatology ........................................................................
Urology ...................................................................................
Vascular Surgery ....................................................................
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
* Did
PPIS
indirect
PE/HR
98.56
59.04
96.01
59.04
59.80
51.52
84.92
35.17
99.32
59.04
29.07
44.63
114.00
118.48
59.04
84.92
119.57
60.10
Current
indirect
%
131.40
53.93
141.53
122.41
74.98
76.27
110.13
57.26
134.82
74.76
30.09
55.26
126.66
95.60
18.45
98.08
97.02
83.98
PPIS
indirect
%
72
67
71
67
70
62
71
65
67
67
90
76
50
58
67
71
69
63
Current crosswalk
81
93
75
70
74
69
84
84
74
82
94
74
56
71
84
67
73
73
All Physicians.
All Physicians.
not participate in PPIS. Data based on Supplemental Survey.
The PPIS is a multispecialty,
nationally representative, PE survey of
both physician and NPPs using a
consistent survey instrument and
methods highly consistent with those
used for the SMS and the supplemental
surveys. The PPIS has gathered
information from 3,656 respondents
across 51 physician specialty and health
care professional groups. We believe the
PPIS is the most comprehensive source
of PE survey information available to
date.
As noted, the BBRA required us to
establish criteria for accepting
supplemental survey data. Since the
supplemental surveys were specific to
individual specialties and not part of a
comprehensive multispecialty survey,
we had required certain precision levels
be met in order to ensure that the
supplemental data was sufficiently
valid, and to be accepted for use in the
development of the PE RVUs. Because
the PPIS is a contemporaneous,
consistently collected, and
comprehensive multispecialty survey,
we do not believe similar precision
requirements are necessary and are not
proposing to establish them for the use
of the PPIS data.
For physician specialties, the survey
responses were adjusted for nonresponse bias. Non-response bias is the
bias that results when the characteristics
of survey respondents differ in
meaningful ways, such as in the mix of
practice sizes, from the general
population. The non-response
adjustment was developed based on a
comparison of practice size and other
characteristic information between the
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PPIS survey respondents and data from
the AMA Masterfile (for physician
specialties) or information from
specialty societies (for non-physician
specialties). For six specialties (that is,
chiropractors, clinical social workers,
nuclear medicine, osteopathic
manipulative therapy, physical therapy,
and registered dietians) such an
adjustment was not possible due to a
lack of available characteristic data. The
AMA and Lewin have indicated that the
non-response weighting has only a
small impact on PE/HR values.
Under our current policy, various
specialties without SMS or
supplemental survey data have been
crosswalked to other similar specialties
to obtain a proxy PE/HR. For specialties
that were part of the PPIS for which we
currently use a crosswalked PE/HR, we
are proposing instead to use the PPISbased PE/HR. We are proposing to
continue current crosswalks for
specialties that did not participate in
PPIS.
Supplemental survey data on
independent labs, from the College of
American Pathologists, was
implemented for payments in CY 2005.
Supplemental survey data from the
National Coalition of Quality Diagnostic
Imaging Services (NCQDIS),
representing IDTFs, was blended with
supplementary survey data from the
American College of Radiology (ACR)
and implemented for payments in CY
2007. Neither IDTFs nor Independent
Labs participated in PPIS. Therefore, we
are proposing to continue using the
current PE/HR that was developed using
their supplemental survey data.
PO 00000
Frm 00013
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
We are not proposing to use the PPIS
data for reproductive endocrinology,
sleep medicine, and spine surgery since
these specialties are not separately
recognized by Medicare and we do not
know how to blend this data with the
Medicare recognized specialty data. We
seek comment on this issue.
We are not proposing changes to the
manner in which the PE/HR data are
used in the current PE RVU
methodology. We are merely proposing
to update the PE/HR data itself based on
the new survey. We propose to utilize
the PE/HR developed using PPIS data
for all Medicare recognized specialties
that participated in the PPIS for
payments effective January 1, 2010. The
impact of using the new PPIS-based PE/
HR is discussed in the Regulatory
Impact Analysis in section V. of this
proposed rule.
c. Equipment Utilization Rate
As part of the PE methodology
associated with the allocation of
equipment costs for calculating PE
RVUs, we have adopted an equipment
usage assumption of 50 percent. Most
recently, we included a discussion in
the CY 2008 PFS proposed rule on this
equipment usage assumption (72 FR
38132). We noted that if the assumed
equipment usage percentage is set too
high, the result would be an insufficient
allowance at the service level for the
practice costs associated with
equipment. If the assumed equipment
usage percentage is set too low, the
result would be an excessive allowance
for the practice costs of equipment at
the service level. We acknowledged that
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33532
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
the current 50 percent usage assumption
does not capture the actual usage rates
for all equipment, but stated that we did
not believe that we had strong empirical
evidence to justify any alternative
approaches.
The commenters’ recommendations
about making adjustments to the 50
percent utilization rate assumption
varied. Certain commenters
recommended we do nothing until
stronger empirical evidence is available,
while other commenters recommended
a decrease in the utilization assumption,
and some commenters recommended an
increase in the utilization assumption.
The particular changes recommended in
the utilization assumption were, in most
cases, directly related to a specific code.
In the CY 2008 PFS final rule with
comment period (72 FR 66232), we
agreed with commenters that the
equipment utilization rate should
continue to be examined for accuracy.
We reiterated our commitment to
continue to work with interested parties
on this issue. We indicated that we
would continue to monitor the
appropriateness of the equipment
utilization assumption, and evaluate
whether changes should be proposed in
light of the data available.
Since the publication of the CY 2008
PFS final rule with comment period,
MedPAC addressed this issue again in
its March 2009 Report to Congress (see
https://www.medpac.gov/documents/
Mar09_EntireReport.pdf). In part of its
discussion, MedPAC stated:
‘‘In 2006, the Commission sponsored a
survey by NORC of imaging providers in six
markets, which found that MRI and CT
machines are used much more than the 25
hours per week that CMS assumes (Table 2B–
6). According to data from this survey, MRI
scanners are used 52 hours per week, on
average (median of 46 hours), and CT
machines are operated 42 hours per week, on
average (median of 40 hours) (NORC 2006).32
Although the survey results are not
nationally representative, they are
representative of imaging providers in the six
markets included in the survey. We also
analyzed data from a 2007 survey of CT
providers by IMV, a market research firm
(IMV Medical Information Division 2008).
IMV data are widely used in the industry and
have also appeared in published studies
(Baker et al. 2008, Baker and Atlas 2004).
Using IMV’s data on 803 nonhospital CT
providers (imaging centers, clinics, and
physician offices), we calculated that the
average provider uses its CT scanner 50
hours per week, which is twice the number
CMS assumes.33 The IMV survey also found
that nonhospital providers increased the
average number of procedures per CT
machine by 31 percent from 2003 to 2007,
which indicates that providers either used
their machines more hours per day or
performed more scans per hour (IMV Medical
Information Division 2008).’’ (p. 108)
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
We believe the studies cited by
MedPAC strongly suggest that our
current usage rate assumption is
significantly understated, especially
with respect to the types of high cost
equipment that were the subject of the
studies. Our current 50 percent
utilization rate translates into about 25
hours per week out of a 50 hour work
week. The median value of 46 hours for
MRIs from the first study cited by
MedPAC is equivalent to a utilization
rate of 92 percent on a 50-hour week.
For CT scanners, averaging the value
from the first study of 40 hours per
week and the value from the second
study of 50 hours per week yields 45
hours and is equivalent to a 90 percent
utilization rate on a 50 hour work week.
We believe the studies cited by MedPAC
suggest what we have long suspected,
that physicians and suppliers would not
typically make huge capital investments
in equipment that would only be
utilized 50 percent of the time. All of
the equipment cited in the MedPAC
studies is priced over $1 million.
Therefore, we are proposing to change
the equipment usage assumption from
the current 50 percent usage rate to a 90
percent usage rate for equipment priced
over $1 million. We will continue to
explore data sources regarding the
utilization rates of equipment priced at
less than $1 million dollars, but are not
proposing a change in the usage rate for
this less expensive equipment at this
time.
As MedPAC indicated in its report,
we do not believe this proposal would
create access issues in rural areas.
MedPAC noted,
‘‘According to our analysis of data from the
American Hospital Association’s 2006 AHA
annual survey of hospitals, 95% of rural
hospitals provide CT services in their
community (AHA 2007). Therefore, if rural
areas do not have physician offices or
freestanding centers with MRI and CT
machines, most of these communities have
access to such services through a hospital.’’
(p. 110)
However, we welcome any additional
analyses regarding access issues, and, as
in our CY 2008 and CY 2009
rulemaking, we welcome additional
empirical data relating to equipment
utilization rates. Our understanding is
that the PPIS survey did not produce
information that can inform the
utilization rate discussion, but we invite
comments on this or other data sources.
d. Miscellaneous PE Issues
As we have discussed in the past
rulemaking (see the CY 2008 PFS final
rule with comment period (72 FR
66236) and the CY 2007 PFS final rule
with comment period (71 FR 69647)),
PO 00000
Frm 00014
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
we continue to have concerns about the
issue of PE RVUs for services which are
utilized 24 hours a day/7 days a week,
such as certain monitoring systems. For
example, the PE equipment
methodology was not developed with
this type of 24/7 equipment in mind.
We are continuing to analyze the issue
of PEs for services which are utilized 24
hours a day/7 days a week to identify
any modifications to our methodology
that would address the specific
‘‘constant use’’ issues associated with
these services. Services that are
currently contractor priced in CY 2009
would remain contractor priced in CY
2010. Any proposed changes will be
communicated through future
rulemaking.
We also received comments regarding
the PE direct cost inputs (for example,
supply costs and the useful life of the
renewable sources) related to several
high dose radiation therapy (HDRT) and
placement CPT codes. Based on our
review of these codes and comments
received, we are requesting that the
AMA RUC consider these CPT codes for
additional review.
e. AMA RUC Recommendations for
Direct PE Inputs
The AMA RUC provided
recommendations for PE inputs for the
codes listed in Table 3.
TABLE 3—CODES WITH AMA RUC PE
RECOMMENDATIONS
CPT 1
code
37183
47382
50200
55873
93025
...
...
...
...
...
Description
Remove hepatic shunt (tips).
Percut ablate liver rf.
Biopsy of kidney.
Cryoablate prostate.
Microvolt t-wave assess.
1 CPT codes and descriptions are Copyright
2009 American Medical Association.
We are in agreement with the AMA RUC
recommendations for the direct PE
inputs for the codes listed in Table 3
and propose to adopt these for CY 2010.
B. Geographic Practice Cost Indices
(GPCIs): Locality Discussion
1. Update—Expiration of 1.0 Work GPCI
Floor
Section 1848(e)(1)(A) of the Act
requires us to develop separate
Geographic Practice Cost Indices
(GPCIs) to measure resource cost
differences among localities compared
to the national average for each of the
three fee schedule components (that is,
work, PE and malpractice). While
requiring that the PE and malpractice
GPCIs reflect the full relative cost
differences, section 1848(e)(1)(A)(iii) of
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
the Act requires that the physician work
GPCIs reflect only one-quarter of the
relative cost differences compared to the
national average.
Section 1848(e)(1)(C) of the Act
requires us to review and, if necessary,
adjust the GPCIs at least every 3 years.
This section also specifies that if more
than 1 year has elapsed since the last
GPCI revision, we must phase in the
adjustment over 2 years, applying only
one-half of any adjustment in each year.
As discussed in the CY 2009 PFS final
rule with comment period (73 FR
69740), the CY 2009 adjustment to the
GPCIs reflected the fully implemented
fifth comprehensive GPCI update. We
also noted that section 134 of the
MIPPA extended the 1.000 work GPCI
floor from July 1, 2008, through
December 31, 2009. (Note: The 1.000
work GPCI floor was enacted and
implemented for CY 2006, and, prior to
enactment of the MIPPA, was set to
expire on June 30, 2008.) Additionally,
section 1848(e)(1)(G) of the Act, as
amended by section 134(b) of the
MIPPA, set a permanent 1.5 work GPCI
floor in Alaska for services furnished
beginning January 1, 2009. Therefore, as
required by the MIPPA, beginning on
January 1, 2010, the 1.000 work GPCI
floor will be removed. However, the
1.500 work GPCI floor for Alaska will
remain in place. See Addenda D and E
of this proposed rule for the GPCIs and
summarized geographic adjustment
factors (GAFs), respectively.
2. Payment Localities
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
a. Background
As stated above in this section,
section 1848(e)(1)(A) of the Act requires
us to develop separate GPCIs to measure
resource cost differences among
localities compared to the national
average for each of the three fee
schedule components (this is, work, PE,
and malpractice). Payments under the
PFS are based on the relative resources
involved in furnishing physicians’
services, and are adjusted for differences
in relative resource costs among
payment localities using the GPCIs. As
a result, PFS payments vary between
localities.
The current PFS locality structure was
developed and implemented in 1997.
There are currently 89 localities
including 37 higher-cost areas; 16 Rest
of State areas (comprising the remaining
counties not located in a higher-cost
area within a State); 34 Statewide areas;
and Puerto Rico and the Virgin Islands
which are designated as ‘‘territorywide’’ localities. The development of
the current locality structure is
described in detail in the CY 1997 PFS
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
proposed rule (61 FR 34615) and the
subsequent final rule (61 FR 59494).
As we have frequently noted, any
changes to the locality configuration
must be made in a budget neutral
manner. Therefore, any change in
localities can lead to significant
redistributions in payments. For many
years, we have not considered making
changes to localities without the
support of a State medical association in
order to demonstrate consensus for the
change among the professionals whose
payments would be affected (with some
increasing and some decreasing).
However, we have recognized that, over
time, changes in demographics or local
economic conditions may lead us to
conduct a more comprehensive
examination of existing payment
localities.
Payment Locality Approaches Discussed
in the CY 2008 PFS Proposed Rule
For the past several years, we have
been involved in discussions with
California physicians and their
representatives about recent shifts in
relative demographics and economic
conditions among a number of counties
within the current California payment
locality structure. In the CY 2008 PFS
proposed rule and final rule with
comment period, we described three
potential options for changing the
payment localities in California (72 FR
38139 and 72 FR 66245, respectively).
After reviewing the comments on
these options, we decided not to
proceed with implementing any of them
at that time. We explained that there
was no consensus among the California
medical community as to which, if any,
of the options would be most
acceptable. We also received
suggestions from the Medicare Payment
Advisory Commission (MedPAC) for
developing changes in payment
localities for the entire country and
other States expressed interest in having
their payment localities reconfigured as
well. In addition, other commenters
wanted us to consider a national
reconfiguration of localities rather than
just making changes one State at a time.
Because of the divergent views
expressed in comments, we explained
in the CY 2008 PFS final rule with
comment period that we intended to
conduct a thorough analysis of potential
approaches to reconfiguring localities
and would address this issue again in
future rulemaking.
Interim Study of Alternative Payment
Localities Under the PFS
As a follow-up to the CY 2008 PFS
final rule with comment period, we
contracted with Acumen, LLC
PO 00000
Frm 00015
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33533
(Acumen), to conduct a preliminary
study of several options for revising the
payment localities on a nationwide
basis. The contractor’s interim report
was posted on the CMS Web site on
August 21, 2008, and we requested
comments from the public. The report
entitled, ‘‘Review of Alternative GPCI
Payment Locality Structures,’’ is still
accessible from the CMS PFS Web page
under the heading ‘‘Interim Study of
Alternative Payment Localities under
the PFS.’’ The report may also be
accessed directly from the following
link: https://www.cms.hhs.gov/
PhysicianFeeSched/
10_Interim_Study.asp#TopOfPage. We
accepted comments on the interim
report through November 3, 2008. The
alternative locality configurations
discussed in the report are described
briefly below in this section.
Option 1: CMS Core Based Statistical
Area (CBSA) Payment Locality
Configuration
This option uses the Office of
Management and Budget (OMB’s)
Metropolitan Statistical Area (MSA)
designations for the payment locality
configuration. MSAs would be
considered as urban CBSAs.
Micropolitan Areas (as defined by OMB)
and rural areas would be considered as
non-urban (rest of State) CBSAs. This
approach would be consistent with the
inpatient hospital prospective payment
system (IPPS) pre-reclassification CBSA
assignments and with the geographic
payment adjustments used in other
Medicare payment systems. This option
would increase the number of localities
from 89 to 439.
Option 2: Separate High Cost Counties
From Existing Localities (Separate
Counties)
Under this approach, higher cost
counties are removed from their existing
locality structure and they would each
be placed into their own locality. This
option would increase the number of
localities from 89 to 214 using a 5
percent GAF differential to separate
high cost counties.
Option 3: Separate MSAs From
Statewide Localities (Separate MSAs)
This option begins with Statewide
localities and creates separate localities
for higher cost MSAs (rather than
removing higher cost counties from
their existing locality as described in
option 2). This option would increase
the number of localities from 89 to 130
using a 5 percent GAF differential to
separate high cost MSAs.
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33534
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
Option 4: Group Counties Within a State
Into Locality Tiers Based on Costs
(Statewide Tiers)
This option creates tiers of counties
(within each State) that may or may not
be contiguous but share similar practice
costs. This option would increase the
number of localities from 89 to 140
using a 5 percent GAF differential to
group similar counties into Statewide
tiers.
Additionally, as discussed in the
interim locality study report, our
contractor, Acumen, applied a
‘‘smoothing’’ adjustment to the current
PFS locality structure, as well as to each
of the alternative locality configurations
(except option 4: Statewide Tiers). The
‘‘smoothing’’ adjustment was applied to
mitigate large payment differences (or
payment ‘‘cliffs’’) between adjacent
counties. Since large payment
differences between adjacent counties
could influence a physician’s decision
on a practice location (and possibly
impact access to care), the ‘‘smoothing’’
adjustment was applied to ensure that
GAF differences between adjacent
counties do not exceed 10 percent. (For
more information on the ‘‘smoothing’’
adjustment see the interim locality
study report on the PFS Web page via
the link provided above.)
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
b. Summary of Public Comments on
Interim Locality Study Report
In the CY 2009 PFS proposed rule (73
FR 38514), we encouraged interested
parties to submit comments on the
options presented both in the proposed
rule and in the interim report posted on
our Web site. We also requested
comments and suggestions on other
potential alternative locality
configurations (in addition to the
options described in the report).
Additionally, we requested comments
on the administrative and operational
issues associated with the various
options under consideration. We also
emphasized that we would not be
proposing any changes to the current
PFS locality structure for CY 2009 and
that we would provide extensive
opportunities for public comment before
proposing any change. The following is
a summary of the comments received on
the alternative locality options
discussed in the CY 2009 PFS proposed
rule and interim locality study report.
(1) Introduction and General Support for
Change
We received approximately 200
comments on the CY 2009 PFS
proposed rule and locality study report
from various specialty groups, medical
societies, State medical associations,
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
individual practitioners, and
beneficiaries. Commenters generally
commended us for acknowledging the
need to reconfigure PFS payment
localities and expressed support for our
study of alternative locality
configurations. Many commenters urged
us to expedite changes to the current
locality structure in order to accurately
reflect the geographic cost differences of
operating a medical practice. For
example, the Connecticut State Medical
Society commented that the current
locality configuration contributes to
medical access issues and problems
with recruitment and retention of
practitioners (with an emphasis on
access to primary care).
Another commenter stated that Ohio’s
Statewide locality configuration needs
to be changed because a Statewide
locality designation does not account for
the (presumably higher) cost of
operating a medical practice in northern
Ohio. The commenter also objected to
the agency’s approach to requests for
changes to the current locality structure
(which includes an assessment of
support for the changes by the medical
community, including the relevant State
medical associations). The commenter
believes the State medical association
does not represent all of the physicians
in Ohio.
Another commenter stated that a
change in the PFS locality structure is
long overdue. The commenter stated
that San Diego County is the most
underpaid area in the nation and that
grouping that county with the Rest of
California locality is erroneous.
Moreover, several commenters stated
that a timely reassessment is needed
and urged us to update the locality
structure every 3 years. Two
commenters believe that previous
studies completed on the PFS locality
structure by MedPAC, GAO, Urban
Institute, as well as the current study by
Acumen, support immediate reform to
the current PFS locality structure.
We received many comments from
hospitals and physicians located in
Frederick County Maryland (which is
currently grouped with the Rest of
Maryland locality). The commenters
support each of the alternative locality
configurations we presented because
each option results in PFS payment
increases for services furnished in
Frederick County. The commenters
stated that Frederick County is
considered a ‘bedroom community’ for
the DC/Northern Virginia area, has
experienced the highest growth rate in
the State, and noted that the cost of
living has increased significantly.
Additionally, the commenters noted
that the last economic census aligns
PO 00000
Frm 00016
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
costs in Frederick County with those in
Montgomery County (whose doctors
receive higher payment amounts) and
that Frederick County competes with
physician practices in Montgomery
County for professional staff. Moreover,
the commenters believe that because of
inadequate PFS payment amounts,
access to care is becoming a problem
and emergency room visits are on the
rise.
(2) Cautious Approach
Some commenters requested that we
take a cautious approach to
reconfiguring the locality structure. For
instance, the Texas Medical Association
stated that because of the redistributive
impact that results from any locality
reconfiguration, CMS should avoid
making large scale changes at one time.
Additionally, another commenter stated
that ‘‘stakeholders’’ should be given a
long advance notification period (at
least 2 full calendar years) prior to the
effective date of any changes to the PFS
locality configuration. The commenter
also stated that the current locality
structure should remain in place (for
each locality) unless the need for
revision is strongly substantiated
because of a change in practice cost
patterns. A specialty society expressed
support for postponing any adjustments
for at least 1 year to allow for more
discussion between CMS and
‘‘stakeholders’’.
(3) Guiding Principles
We received several comments from
California that suggested a set of goals
for reforming the PFS payment locality
structure. The goals suggested by the
commenters are as follows:
• Improve payment accuracy (as
compared to the current locality
structure);
• Move towards MSA-based
localities;
• Mitigate payment reductions to
rural California areas (and therefore
minimize corresponding negative
impact on access to care in California);
and
• Promote administrative
simplification by aligning physician and
hospital payment localities.
The California Medical Association
(CMA) urged us to apply a consistent
methodology across all payment
localities and requested that any
revision to the localities include a
‘‘formula driven’’ mechanism that can
be applied repeatedly to future
revisions. A California county medical
society stated that more specific
objectives for reforming PFS payment
localities should be developed. For
example, the commenter suggested that
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
payment reductions for practitioners
should not exceed 1.5 percent in any
given year, GAF differentials between
adjacent localities should not exceed 10
percent, and that contiguous localities
with less than a 1 percent difference in
their GAF’s should be combined into a
single locality.
(4) Comments on the Studied
Alternative Locality Options
We received many comments on the
options for reconfiguring PFS payment
localities presented in the interim
locality study report. One commenter
stated that option 1 (the CMS CBSA
locality configuration) is the best option
because it provides the greatest payment
accuracy. The same commenter also
stated that using CBSAs as the PFS
locality definition would be similar to
other Medicare payment systems (for
example, the IPPS). Therefore, the
commenter believed that geographic
payment adjustments for physicians and
hospitals would be consistent for a
given geographic area. The CMA and a
California county medical society stated
that although option 1 would provide
the greatest payment accuracy, it would
also lead to significant payment
reductions for many counties. Those
same commenters expressed concern
with the negative impact of
transitioning directly to the CMS CBSA
locality configuration. If adopted, the
commenters suggested that the CMS
CBSA locality configuration be
implemented in stages over several
years. The Texas Medical Association
echoed this concern and urged us not to
adopt option 1 unless we employ a hold
harmless floor along with ‘‘material’’
increases in the conversion factor.
The Texas Medical Association also
stated that option 2 (Separate High Cost
Counties from Existing Localities)
results in less significant payment
reductions to rural practitioners, as
compared to the reductions seen under
option 1 (CMS CBSA) and option 4
(Statewide Tiers). However, the
commenter did not support option 2
because it would create different
localities within major urban areas and,
therefore, provide incentives for
‘‘border-crossing,’’ (in other words,
incentives for physicians to move their
medical practice to an adjacent
urbanized county to obtain a higher
payment amount). Additionally, the
Texas Medical Association stated that
option 2 increases administrative
complexity due to the additional
number of localities and the need to
reallocate source data into smaller
(county level) areas. The CMA also
stated that option 2 results in less
significant payment reductions (as
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
compared to the other options).
However, the CMA stated that option 2
continues to produce inaccurate
payments because it applies MSA-based
data to county-based localities.
Many commenters from the State of
California expressed support for option
3 (Separate High Cost MSAs from
Statewide Localities) because the
commenters believed it would improve
payment accuracy (over the current
locality configuration) and at the same
time mitigate the payment reductions to
rural areas that would occur under
option 1 (CMS CBSA) and option 4
(Statewide Tiers). The CMA explained
that selecting an MSA-based locality
approach would provide consistency
with the hospital payment system and
enable physicians to better compete
with hospitals for the local work force.
For example, the commenters stated that
hospitals located in the Santa Cruz MSA
are some of the highest paid in the
nation. However, under the PFS locality
structure, Santa Cruz County is grouped
with the Rest of California locality,
which is the lowest paid PFS locality in
the State.
The Texas Medical Association
suggested that we adopt option 3
because it minimizes payment
reductions to lower cost rural areas. For
example, since option 3 results in the
fewest payment localities (as compared
to the other alternative locality
configurations), it reduces the
redistribution effects of separating
higher cost areas from rural ‘‘rest of
State’’ areas. The commenter also stated
that option 3 (Separate MSAs) matches
payment with the underlying data better
than option 2 (Separate Counties) and
option 4 (Statewide Tiers). Some
commenters expressed their belief that
MSAs are better basic locality units than
counties because the cost data is more
reliably derived directly from MSAs
(instead of counties). Several
commenters who supported the
adoption of an MSA-based PFS locality
structure suggested that option 3 could
be used as a transition to the CMS CBSA
locality configuration (option 1).
With regard to option 4 (Statewide
Tiers), the Texas Medical Association
stated that the Statewide Tiers locality
configuration creates payment areas that
are poorly aligned with the underlying
data and results in unacceptable
payment decreases to small urban and
rural areas. The Florida Medical
Association explained that many
localities have experienced a shift in
population and economic development
since the last PFS locality
reconfiguration. The commenter stated
that counties with similar costs should
be grouped together in the same locality
PO 00000
Frm 00017
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33535
regardless of geographic location and
that the Statewide cost tier locality
structure (option 4) would accomplish
this objective. The CMA stated that
under option 4, counties are not
geographically contiguous and noted
that the counties grouped together in a
locality may not be related to one
another economically. The commenter
suggested that noncontiguous counties
may experience more frequent economic
changes than contiguous counties. The
commenter expressed concern that
option 4 would need to be updated
more frequently and therefore payments
to physicians will fluctuate more often.
A California county medical society
stated that option 4 creates payment
errors for counties in seven California
localities that currently have accurate
payments. The Connecticut State
Medical Society stated that New Haven
County would experience an increase
under option 4.
(5) Smoothing Adjustment
Many commenters from the State of
California did not support the concept
of ‘‘smoothing’’ because it would
require payment reductions for higher
cost counties to offset the increases
given to lower cost counties (in order to
achieve budget neutrality).
Additionally, the same commenters
stated that physicians in ‘‘smoothed’’
counties benefit financially from the
smoothing adjustment solely because
they are located adjacent to high cost
areas. They also stated that a
‘‘smoothing’’ adjustment would be
complex to administer, and difficult to
understand. The CMA, a California
county medical society, and another
commenter from California stated that a
‘‘smoothing’’ adjustment would require
a change in the statute and that current
Medicare statute requires GPCIs to
reflect the relative costs differences
among localities for work, PE, and
malpractice expense. Another
commenter recommended that we study
the extent to which a ‘‘smoothing’’
adjustment can be used as a temporary
measure; in order to phase-in significant
changes in payment levels resulting
from a PFS locality reconfiguration.
(6) Other Alternative Options
A few commenters submitted
suggestions on other potential
alternative PFS locality configurations
in addition to those discussed in the
interim report. For example, one
medical clinic suggested a ‘‘marketbased’’ approach instead of the current
‘‘cost-based’’ methodology. Under this
approach, PFS payment would be
geographically adjusted based on the
ratio of Medicare participating
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33536
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
physicians to Medicare beneficiaries.
The commenter suggested that payment
amounts should be increased in
geographic areas with a low physician
to Medicare beneficiary ratio (for
example, 1 physician for every 3,000
beneficiaries) and decreased in areas
with a higher ratio (for example, 1
physician for every 200 beneficiaries).
The commenter stated that ‘‘this process
could be used to bring physician to
patient ratios in the United States to
equilibrium.’’
The CMA and a California county
medical society suggested variations of
option 2 (Separate Counties) with the
intention of reducing the number of
localities that would result under this
option. The commenters suggested
adopting a ‘‘basic locality unit’’ (for
example, MSA) instead of a county
when removing areas from an existing
locality. For example, if 5 counties are
removed from a ‘‘Rest of State’’ locality,
and included within the same MSA, the
5 counties would be grouped into a
single new locality rather than 5
separate new localities. The commenter
also suggested that if removed counties
are contiguous and have similar costs
(even if not part of same MSA); they
should be consolidated into one new
locality instead of separate localities.
The commenters stated that either of
these variations would reduce the
number of new localities created under
option 2.
Additionally, the CMA and a
California county medical society
suggested a variation of option 4
(Statewide Tiers). The commenters
stated that fixed cost tiers be established
for each State using .05 GAF increments
which would lock in the upper and
lower GAF values for each cost tier.
Under this approach, the fixed cost tiers
would not change based on updates to
the GPCIs; however, a county could be
moved to a lower (or higher) cost tier
without the need to define new tiers for
the entire state.
(7) Redistribution of Payment
Many commenters acknowledged that
a significant redistribution of payments
would occur under each alternative
locality configuration option and
requested that we minimize the
payment discrepancy between urban
and rural areas to ensure continued
access to services. Additionally several
commenters stated that any changes to
the locality configuration should not be
unfair to rural practitioners. One
specialty college noted that any new
locality configuration must be budget
neutral, resulting in a shift of resources
from one geographic area to another.
The commenter expressed concern that
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
the requirement for budget neutrality
may help physicians who practice in
certain geographic areas, but will be
costly to others. As such, the
commenters stated that each alternative
PFS locality option could create
problems for medical access in areas
where payments are reduced. As a
method to minimize payment reduction,
a few commenters requested that we
continue the application of the 1.0 work
GPCI floor.
The AMA stated that any proposal to
reconfigure PFS payment localities
should not necessitate budget-neutral
payment redistributions. The
commenter expressed the concern
raised by other commenters that some
localities would receive payment
increases under some options while
other localities would experience
significant payment reductions to offset
these increases. The commenters
requested that if new locality definitions
are proposed, new funding should be
provided to increase payments in
localities that are found to be
underpaid. The commenters also stated
that budget neutral redistributions
would only exacerbate an already
flawed and under-funded Medicare PFS.
The AMA suggested that States with a
Statewide locality should be given the
option of remaining a Statewide locality
and that CMS should continue its policy
of allowing any State the option of
converting to a Statewide locality at the
request of the State Medical
Association.
The Iowa Medical Society stated that
Medicare PFS payment levels in Iowa
are among the lowest in the country and
that the four alternative locality
configurations all appear to further
reduce payments to State physicians. As
such, they requested that Iowa remain a
Statewide locality under any
nationwide locality change.
Because of the redistribution effect of
any locality reconfiguration, some
commenters did not find any of the
potential alternative locality
configurations preferable to the current
payment locality structure. For example,
one physician academy stated that all
four of the alternative locality scenarios
result in disproportionately lower GAFs
for non-MSA counties. Therefore, the
commenter encouraged us to maintain
the current locality structure until we
identify an alternative that decreases the
number of payment localities and
supports practitioners in rural and
underserved areas. The commenter also
expressed support for a locality
reconfiguration that minimizes the
number of payment localities; does not
exceed the current number of 89
localities and eliminates geographic
PO 00000
Frm 00018
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
payment adjustments (except those
designed to encourage physicians to
practice in underserved areas).
Furthermore, the Florida Medical
Association urged us to work with
Congress to remove the application of
budget neutrality when making changes
to the PFS payment locality structure.
The commenter suggested that we use
the current GCPI values as a ‘‘floor’’ to
ensure that future updates to the
localities will not result in payment
reductions.
(8) Methodology
The CMA and a California county
medical society commended the
contractor, Acumen, for the accuracy of
its calculations, modeling of the
options, and observations. However,
they recommended a change in the
iterative methodology used to develop
option 2 and option 3. The commenters
stated that the threshold for removing
high cost counties from existing
localities (option 2) and removing high
cost MSAs from Statewide localities
(option 3) should be equal to or greater
than 5 percent (not just greater than 5
percent) with no rounding up for GAF
differences below 5 percent.
Additionally, with regard to option 2,
the commenters recommended that
counties with identical GAFs to the
county being considered for a new
locality should not be included in the
calculation of the ‘‘Rest of Locality’’
GAF (which is used for comparison to
the higher cost county).
Additionally, the commenters
objected to the methodology used for
the ‘‘smoothing’’ adjustment. The
commenters believe that a new locality
created by smoothing should not have a
significantly lower GAF than it would if
the county was a single locality. For
example, the commenters noted that
San Diego County (which is currently
included in the Rest of California
locality) has a county-level GAF of
1.056. However, when the smoothing
adjustment is applied to the current
locality configuration, the GAF for San
Diego is 1.018.
One research institute questioned
why high cost counties were separated
from existing localities (option 2) and
high cost MSAs were separated from
Statewide localities (option 3); instead
of separating low cost counties and low
cost MSAs. The commenter stated that
the CMS CBSA methodology is not
designed to be sensitive enough to
detect significant geographic differences
in physician compensation and PE. The
commenter questioned whether
compensation and PE costs are
correlated directly with population
density.
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Clarification on Methodology Used To
Develop Alternative Locality
Configurations Discussed in the Interim
Report
With regard to the iterative
methodology used for option 2 and
option 3, the contractor, Acumen,
analyzed these alternative locality
configurations based on its
understanding of the MedPAC ideas. A
threshold of greater than 5 percent was
used to separate high cost counties from
existing localities (option 2) and to
separate high cost MSAs from Statewide
localities (option 3). Additionally, the
contractor compared just one county (or
MSA) at a time against the weighted
average GAF of all the lower-ranked
counties in the Medicare locality.
Counties with the same GAF were not
treated as a group. In ranking counties
by GAF, the contractor used physician
work RVUs to break ‘‘ties.’’ In other
words, when two counties in a Medicare
locality had the same GAF, the county
with the higher physician work RVU
was ranked as if it had the higher GAF.
Keeping counties with identical GAFs
together would be another possible
strategy for developing alternative PFS
payment localities. The high cost
counties and MSAs were removed in the
iterative process to reflect ongoing
concerns regarding individual high cost
counties (usually in ‘‘rest of state’’ areas)
where the GAF is significantly higher
than the norm for the locality. Removing
low cost counties would isolate very
low cost areas leading to further
reductions in PFS payment levels for
physicians and practitioners in these
counties.
With regard to the sensitivity of the
CBSA methodology and whether
compensation and PE cost are correlated
directly to population density; the
CBSA methodology has three types of
areas: MSAs, Metropolitan Divisions
within MSAs, and non-MSA areas.
None of these definitions involve
population density per se, although
MSAs must include core areas with
populations of 50,000 or greater. Given
that the CBSA methodology has more
regions than the other alternative
locality configurations, it could
potentially draw on more detailed levels
of data than the other options, and
therefore, result in a more precise
reflection of geographic cost differences.
(9) Suggested Additional Topics for
Review
One commenter stated that the
interim locality study report should
have addressed how a change in
payment locality structure might impact
a physician’s choice regarding practice
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
location and Medicare beneficiary
access to physician services.
The CMA and a California county
medical society stated that the interim
locality study should have included a
discussion of payment accuracy under
the current locality structure and under
each potential locality configuration.
The commenters stated that a discussion
of the potential negative impact under a
particular option without a discussion
of the accuracy of payment for each
option is misleading. Additionally, they
suggested adding a discussion of
potential methods to mitigate payment
reductions.
(10) Administrative and Operational
Issues
We received few comments on
administrative and operational issues
related to making changes to the PFS
payment locality structure. Some
commenters stated that a locality
revision would impose a minimal
amount of additional administrative
burden. However, the commenters did
not specify whose administrative
burden they were assessing. One
commenter stated that implementing the
CMS CBSA locality configuration
(option 1) would be a significant
administrative burden. Additionally,
one health care plan explained that
many Medicare Advantage Plans are
based on Medicare fees in specific
localities. As such, any fee schedule
locality revision would be a large scale
and costly administrative undertaking
for managed care plans as well as for
‘‘traditional’’ Medicare.
(11) Underlying Data
We also received comments on the
data used to develop GPCI values.
Although we appreciate these
comments, the focus of the interim
locality study was not intended to be a
review of the underlying data sources
used to develop GPCI values. As
discussed earlier, the interim locality
study was a review of potential
approaches for redefining the Medicare
PFS payment localities.
Response to Comments
We would like to thank the public for
the many thoughtful comments on the
interim locality study report entitled,
‘‘Review of Alternative GPCI Payment
Locality Structures’’. As noted by the
commenters and reflected in the report,
significant payment redistribution
would occur if a nationwide change in
the PFS locality configuration were
undertaken. All four of the potential
alternative payment locality
configurations reviewed in the report
would increase the number of localities
PO 00000
Frm 00019
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33537
and separate higher cost, typically urban
areas from lower cost, typically rural
‘‘Rest of State’’ areas. In general,
payments to urban areas would increase
while rural areas would see a decrease
in payment under each of the options
studied because they would no longer
be grouped with higher cost
‘‘urbanized’’ areas. We intend to review
the suggestions made by the
commenters and consider the impact of
each of the potential alternative locality
configurations. We will also explore
whether alternative underlying data
sources are available nationwide. A
final report will be posted to the CMS
Web site after further review of the
studied alternative locality approaches.
We are not proposing changes in the
PFS locality structure at this time. As
explained in the CY 2009 PFS final rule
with comment period, in the event we
decide to make a specific proposal for
changing the locality configuration, we
would provide extensive opportunities
for public input (for example, town hall
meetings or open door forums, as well
as opportunities for public comments
afforded by the rulemaking process).
C. Malpractice Relative Value Units
(RVUs)
1. Background
Section 1848(c) of the Act requires
that each service paid under the PFS be
comprised of three components: work,
PE, and malpractice. From 1992 to 1999,
malpractice RVUs were charge-based,
using weighted specialty-specific
malpractice expense percentages and
1991 average allowed charges.
Malpractice RVUs for new codes after
1991 were extrapolated from similar
existing codes or as a percentage of the
corresponding work RVU. Section
4505(f) of the BBA required us to
implement resource-based malpractice
RVUs for services furnished beginning
in 2000. Initial implementation of
resource-based malpractice RVUs
occurred in 2000. The statute also
requires that we review, and if
necessary adjust, RVUs no less often
than every 5 years. The first review and
update of resource based malpractice
RVUs was addressed in the CY 2005
PFS final rule (69 FR 66263). Minor
modifications to the methodology were
addressed in the CY 2006 PFS final rule
(70 FR 70153). In this current rule, we
are proposing to implement the second
review and update of malpractice RVUs.
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33538
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
2. Proposed Methodology for the
Revision of Resource-Based Malpractice
RVUs
The proposed malpractice RVUs were
developed by Acumen, LLC (Acumen)
under contract to us.
The methodology used in calculating
the proposed second review and update
of resource-based malpractice RVUs
largely parallels the process used in the
CY 2005 update. The calculation
requires information on malpractice
premiums, linked to the physician work
conducted by different specialties that
furnish Medicare services. Because
malpractice costs vary by State and
specialty, the malpractice premium
information must be weighted
geographically and across specialties.
Accordingly, the proposed malpractice
expense RVUs are based upon three data
sources:
• Actual CY 2006 and CY 2007
malpractice premium data.
• CY 2008 Medicare payment data on
allowed services and charges.
• CY 2008 Geographic adjustment
data for malpractice premiums.
Similar to the previous update of the
resource-based malpractice expense
RVUs, we are proposing to revise the
RVUs using specialty-specific
malpractice premium data because they
represent the actual malpractice
expense to the physician. In addition,
malpractice premium data are widely
available through State Departments of
Insurance. We propose to use actual CY
2006 and CY 2007 malpractice premium
data because they are the most current
data available (CY 2008 malpractice
premium data were not consistently
available during the data collection
process). Accounting for market shares,
three fourths of all included rate filings
were implemented in CY 2006 and CY
2007. The remaining rate filings were
implemented in CY 2003 through CY
2005 but still effective in CY 2006 and
CY 2007. Carriers submit rate filings to
their State Departments of Insurance
listing the premiums and other features
of their coverage. The rate filings
include an effective date, which is the
date the premiums go into effect. Some
States require premium changes to be
approved before their effective date;
others just require the rate filings to be
submitted. We try to capture at least 2
companies and at least 50 percent of the
market share, starting with the largest
carriers in a State.
The primary determinants of
malpractice liability costs continue to be
physician specialty, level of surgical
involvement, and the physician’s
malpractice history. We collected
malpractice premium data from 49
States and the District of Columbia for
all physician specialties represented by
major insurance providers. Rate filings
were not available through Departments
of Insurance in Mississippi or Puerto
Rico. Premiums were for $1 million/$3
million, mature, claims-made policies
(policies covering claims made, rather
than services furnished during the
policy term). A $1 million/$3 million
liability limit policy means that the
most that would be paid on any claim
is $1 million and that the most that the
policy would pay for several claims over
the timeframe of the policy is $3
million. We collected data from
commercial and physician-owned
insurers and from joint underwriting
associations (JUAs). A JUA is a State
government-administered risk pooling
insurance arrangement in areas where
commercial insurers have left the
market. Adjustments were made to
reflect mandatory surcharges for patient
compensation funds (PCFs) (funds to
pay for any claim beyond the statutory
amount, thereby limiting an individual
physician’s liability in cases of a large
suit) in States where PCF participation
is mandatory. We sought to collect
premium data representing at least 50
percent of physician malpractice
premiums paid in each State as
identified by State Departments of
Insurance and by the National
Association of Insurance Commissioners
(NAIC).
Rather than select the top 20
physician specialties as when the
malpractice RVU were originally
established and updated, we included
premium information for all physician
and surgeon specialties and risk
classifications available in the collected
rate filings. Most insurance companies
provided crosswalks from insurance
services office (ISO) codes to named
specialties; we matched these
crosswalks to CMS specialty codes. We
also preserved information obtained
regarding surgery classes, which are
categorizations that affect premium
rates. For example, many insurance
companies grouped general practice
physicians into nonsurgical, minorsurgical and major-surgical classes, each
with different malpractice premiums.
Some companies provided additional
surgical subclasses; for example,
distinguishing general practice
physicians that conducted obstetric
procedures, which further impacted
malpractice rates. We standardized this
information to CMS specialty codes.
We could not identify malpractice
premium rates through typical
malpractice rate filings for some
physician specialties, nonphysician
practitioners (NPPs), and other entities
(for example, independent diagnostic
testing facilities (IDTFs)) paid under the
PFS. In the absence of available
premium data for these specialties and
entities, we took a number of steps.
We collected data from one of the
largest association program insurance
brokers and administrators in the
United States providing malpractice
insurance to medical physicists. We
incorporated the data into the
calculation of the proposed update to
the malpractice RVUs for TC services.
(See section II.C.3 of this proposed rule
for a discussion of this issue.)
We also crosswalked 13 specialties for
which there was not significant
collected data available (those in less
than 35 States’ malpractice premium
rate filings) to similar specialties and
risk classes. The unassigned specialties
and the specialty to which we are
proposing to assign them are shown in
Table 4. The remaining four specialties
were dropped, meaning they were not
included in the weighted averages for
calculating the malpractice RVUs.
Note: While we were able to collect data
on many more specialties on this survey than
under the previous one, these four specialties
were also dropped under the previous
version of the survey because of a lack of
available data. This left 44 specialties,
representing 90 percent of Medicare services,
for which we used the malpractice premium
data to develop risk factors.
TABLE 4—CROSSWALK OF SPECIALTIES TO SIMILAR PHYSICIAN SPECIALTIES
Spec.
code
09
19
35
62
65
...........
...........
...........
...........
...........
Crosswalk
specialty code
Specialty name
Interventional Pain Management .......................................................................................
Oral Surgery .......................................................................................................................
Chiropractic ........................................................................................................................
Psychologist .......................................................................................................................
Physical Therapist ..............................................................................................................
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00020
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
72
03
03
03
03
13JYP2
Crosswalk specialty
Pain Management.
Allergy Immunology*.
Allergy Immunology*.
Allergy Immunology*.
Allergy Immunology*.
33539
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
TABLE 4—CROSSWALK OF SPECIALTIES TO SIMILAR PHYSICIAN SPECIALTIES—Continued
Spec.
code
67
68
79
85
86
91
94
98
99
...........
...........
...........
...........
...........
...........
...........
...........
...........
Crosswalk
specialty code
Specialty name
Occupational Therapist ......................................................................................................
Clinical Psychologist ..........................................................................................................
Addiction Medicine .............................................................................................................
Maxillofacial Surgery ..........................................................................................................
Neuropsychiatry .................................................................................................................
Surgical Oncology ..............................................................................................................
Interventional Radiology ....................................................................................................
Gynecological/Oncology ....................................................................................................
Unknown Physician Specialty ............................................................................................
03
03
03
03
26
02
30
90
01
Crosswalk specialty
Allergy Immunology*.
Allergy Immunology*.
Allergy Immunology*.
Allergy Immunology*.
Psychiatry.
General Surgery.
Diagnostic Radiology.
Medical Oncology.
General Practice.
* Lowest Physician Specialty.
The methodology presented in this
proposed rule conceptually follows the
specialty-weighted approach used in the
CY 2000 and CY 2005 PFS final rules
with comment period (63 FR 59383 and
69 FR 66263, respectively) and
incorporates the minor modifications
discussed in the CY 2006 final rule with
comment period (70 FR 70153). We
revised the current specialty-weighted
approach to accommodate additional
data gathered during the malpractice
premium data collection. The specialtyweighted approach bases the
malpractice RVUs upon a weighted
average of the risk factors of all
specialties furnishing a given service.
This approach ensures that all
specialties furnishing a given service are
accounted for in the calculation of the
final malpractice RVUs. Our proposed
methodology is as follows:
(1) Compute a preliminary national
average premium for each specialty.
Insurance rating area malpractice
premiums for each specialty were
mapped to the county level. The
specialty premium for each county is
then multiplied by the total county
RVUs (as defined by Medicare claims
data), which had been divided by the
malpractice GPCI applicable to each
county to standardize the relative values
for geographic variations. If the
malpractice RVUs were not normalized
for geographic variation, the locality
cost differences (as reflected by the
GPCIs) would be counted twice. The
product of the malpractice premiums
and standardized RVUs is then summed
across counties for each specialty. This
calculation is then divided by the total
RVUs for all counties, for each specialty,
to yield a national average premium for
each specialty.
(2) Determine which risk class(es) to
use within each specialty. Many
specialties had premium rates that
differed for major surgery, minor
surgery, and no surgery. These surgery
classes are designed to reflect
differences in risk of professional
liability and the cost of malpractice
claims if they occur. The same concept
applies to procedures; some procedures
carry greater liability risks. Accordingly,
we identified major, minor, nonsurgical,
and obstetric procedures among all
Medicare procedures by established
indicators (Global Surgery Flags). Table
5 shows the surgery class definitions
used in the proposed methodology.
TABLE 5—SURGERY CLASSES BY PROCEDURE CODE
CPT code range
Major Surgery (Maj) ..............................................................
Minor Surgery (Min) ..............................................................
Obstetrics (OB) .....................................................................
No Surgery (NS) ...................................................................
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Surgery class
10000–69999 .......................................................................
10000–69999 .......................................................................
59000–59899 .......................................................................
All other CPT Codes ............................................................
To account for the presence of surgery
classes in the malpractice premium data
and the task of mapping these premiums
to procedures, we sought to calculate
distinct risk factors for major, minor,
and nonsurgical procedures, as well as
a comparable approach for obstetric
premiums and procedures. However,
the availability of data by surgery class
varied across specialties. In light of the
complexity of the surgery class data, we
evaluated both the frequency with
which rate class data were reported and
a preliminary set of normed national
average premiums, calculated for all
classes reported in the data. Because no
single approach accurately addressed
the risk weights and value differences of
various specialty/procedure
combinations, we developed five
strategies for handling the surgical
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
classes and defining specialties. These
strategies are summarized in Table 6.
(a) Substantial Data for Each Class:
For 13 out of 44 specialties, we
determined that there was sufficient
data for each surgical class, as well as
sufficient differences in rates between
classes, to use the surgical class data as
the basis for risk factors by surgical
class.
(b) Major Surgery Dominates: These 8
surgical specialties typically had rate
filings that specified major surgery as
the predominate rate reported. Filings
that distinguished minor surgery or
nonsurgical were relatively rare. For
most of these surgical specialties, we
did not have ‘‘unspecified’’ rate filings.
When we had ‘‘unspecified’’ rate filings,
the unspecified category was sometimes
above and sometimes below the major
PO 00000
Frm 00021
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
Global surgery flag
90 Day.
All Other.
N/A.
N/A.
surgery rate. For these cases, we
assigned the premium for major surgery
to all procedures conducted by this
specialty. (In practice, the major surgery
procedures dominate the services
actually furnished.)
(c) Little or No Data for Major Surgery:
For five other specialties, specific
premiums for major surgery were
uncommon, but most States had rate
filings that represented minor surgery or
nonsurgical coverage. These five
specialties had unspecified rates that
were less common than the minor
surgery-nonsurgery distinction and the
nonsurgery rates. Therefore, for these
five specialties we assigned the minor
surgery rate filings for both major
surgery and minor surgery procedures,
and the nonsurgery filings for
nonsurgical procedures.
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33540
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
(d) Unspecified Dominates: Many
malpractice rate filings did not specify
surgery classes for some specialties; we
refer to these instances as unspecified
malpractice rates. In only two cases, we
choose the unspecified premium as the
premium information to use for the
specialty. For both of these specialties,
fewer than 20 States had rate filings that
distinguished by surgical classes, while
more than 40 had general rate filings for
the specialty.
(e) Blend All Available: For the last 16
specialties, there was wide variation
across the State filings in terms of
whether or not surgical classes were
reported and which categories were
reported. Because there was no clear
strategy for these remaining specialties,
we blended the rate information we
collected into one general premium rate
and applied that rate for all three
premiums (major, minor and
nonsurgical). For these specialties, we
developed a weighted average
‘‘blended’’ premium at the national
level, according to the percentage of
physician work RVUs correlated with
the surgery classes within each
specialty.
TABLE 6—SUMMARY OF APPROACHES TO DEFINING PREMIUMS BY SURGICAL CLASS
Situation
Specialty codes
1. Substantial Data for Each Class (13) ..................................................
2.
3.
4.
5.
Major Surgery Dominates (8) ...............................................................
Little or No Data for Major Surgery (5) ................................................
Unspecified Dominates (2) ...................................................................
Blend All Available (16) ........................................................................
For rarely-billed Medicare
procedures, we did not apply the 5
percent threshold for inclusion of
services or specialties as utilized in
previous MP RVU updates. Rather, we
are proposing to use the risk factor of
the dominant specialty by services for
each procedure for which the number of
allowed services is less than 100. This
approach reflects the risk factors of the
01 (non-OB), 04, 06, 07.
08 (non-OB), 10, 13, 18.
16 (non-OB), 38, 39, 46, 93.
02, 14, 20, 24, 28, 33, 77, 78.
11, 22, 37, 44, 82.
05, 72.
03, 25, 26, 29, 30, 34, 36, 40, 48, 66, 71, 81, 83, 84, 90, 92.
specialty that most frequently furnishes
these low volume procedures.
(3) Calculate a risk factor for each
specialty. Differences among specialties
in malpractice premiums are a direct
reflection of the malpractice risk
associated with the services furnished
by a given specialty. The relative
differences in national average
premiums between various specialties
can be expressed as a specialty risk
factor. These risk factors are an index
calculated by dividing the national
average premium for each specialty by
the national average premium for the
specialty with the lowest average
premium, allergy/immunology. Table 7
shows the risk factors by specialty and
surgery class.
TABLE 7—RISK FACTORS BY SPECIALTY AND SURGERY CLASS
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Medicare
code
Medicare name
1 ..................
2 ..................
3 ..................
4 ..................
5 ..................
6 ..................
7 ..................
8 ..................
10 ................
11 ................
13 ................
14 ................
16 ................
18 ................
19 ................
20 ................
22 ................
24 ................
25 ................
26 ................
28 ................
29 ................
30 ................
33 ................
34 ................
35 ................
36 ................
37 ................
38 ................
39 ................
40 ................
44 ................
46 ................
General Practice ....................................................................................
General Surgery .....................................................................................
Allergy Immunology ................................................................................
Otolaryngology .......................................................................................
Anesthesiology .......................................................................................
Cardiology ..............................................................................................
Dermatology ...........................................................................................
Family Practice ......................................................................................
Gastroenterology ....................................................................................
Internal Medicine ....................................................................................
Neurology ...............................................................................................
Neurosurgery .........................................................................................
Obstetrics Gynecology ...........................................................................
Ophthalmology .......................................................................................
Oral Surgery ...........................................................................................
Orthopedic Surgery ................................................................................
Pathology ...............................................................................................
Plastic and Reconstructive Surgery .......................................................
Physical Medicine and Rehabilitation ....................................................
Psychiatry ...............................................................................................
Colorectal Surgery .................................................................................
Pulmonary Disease ................................................................................
Diagnostic Radiology .............................................................................
Thoracic Surgery ....................................................................................
Urology ...................................................................................................
Chiropractic ............................................................................................
Nuclear Medicine ...................................................................................
Pediatric Medicine ..................................................................................
Geriatric Medicine ..................................................................................
Nephrology .............................................................................................
Hand Surgery .........................................................................................
Infectious Disease ..................................................................................
Endocrinology ........................................................................................
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00022
Non-surgical
RF
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
Minor-surgical
RF
1.50
5.87
1.00
1.44
2.22
1.87
1.14
1.57
2.03
1.72
2.20
9.94
1.67
1.07
1.00
5.46
1.74
5.51
1.14
1.22
3.99
2.08
2.62
6.51
2.64
1.00
1.55
1.49
1.43
1.61
3.49
2.09
1.51
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
2.26
5.87
1.00
2.37
2.22
2.65
2.06
2.23
2.48
2.52
2.90
9.94
2.37
1.68
1.00
5.46
2.26
5.51
1.14
1.22
3.99
2.08
2.62
6.51
2.64
1.00
1.55
2.41
2.23
2.27
3.49
2.52
2.23
Major-surgical
RF
3.56
5.87
1.00
3.55
2.22
6.09
3.96
3.79
4.09
2.52
10.28
9.94
4.64
1.90
1.00
5.46
2.26
5.51
1.14
1.22
3.99
2.08
2.62
6.51
2.64
1.00
1.55
2.41
4.22
4.17
3.49
2.52
4.46
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
33541
TABLE 7—RISK FACTORS BY SPECIALTY AND SURGERY CLASS—Continued
Medicare
code
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
48
62
65
66
67
68
71
72
77
78
79
81
82
83
84
85
86
90
91
92
93
94
98
99
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
................
Podiatry ..................................................................................................
Psychologist ...........................................................................................
Physical Therapist ..................................................................................
Rheumatology ........................................................................................
Occupational Therapist ..........................................................................
Clinical Psychologist ..............................................................................
Registered Dietitian/Nutrition Professional ............................................
Pain Management ..................................................................................
Vascular Surgery ...................................................................................
Cardiac Surgery .....................................................................................
Addiction Medicine .................................................................................
Critical Care (Intensivists) ......................................................................
Hematology ............................................................................................
Hematology/Oncology ............................................................................
Preventive Medicine ...............................................................................
Maxillofacial Surgery ..............................................................................
Neuropsychiatry .....................................................................................
Medical Oncology ..................................................................................
Surgical Oncology ..................................................................................
Radiation Oncology ................................................................................
Emergency Medicine .............................................................................
Interventional Radiology ........................................................................
Gynecological/Oncology ........................................................................
Unknown Physician Specialty ................................................................
One complication in the calculation
of specialty risk factors is technical
component (TC) data. Many procedures
are comprised of professional
components (PC) and TCs. These
components are referred to as global
procedures when billed together. The
TC represents the cost of equipment,
supplies, and technician/staff salaries
involved in furnishing a procedure,
such as the taking of an x-ray by a
technician. The PC represents the
portion of a service that is furnished by
a physician such as the interpretation of
an x-ray by the physician. The
distinction is important because PCs
and TCs have different associated risk
factors and face different malpractice
insurance costs. The previous update of
the malpractice RVUs did not update
the TCs due to the lack of available
malpractice premium data for entities
providing TC services. In the past, we
were unable to obtain data concerning
malpractice costs associated with the
TC, so we based the malpractice RVUs
for TC services and the TC portion of
global services on historical allowed
charges.
We have had ongoing discussions
with the AMA RUC and various
specialty societies about this issue. In
the CY 2008 PFS proposed rule (72 FR
38143), we noted that the Professional
Liability Insurance (PLI) workgroup, a
subset of the AMA RUC brought to our
attention the fact that there are
approximately 600 services that have TC
malpractice RVUs that are greater than
the PC malpractice RVUs. The PLI
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Non-surgical
RF
Medicare name
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
workgroup requested that we make
changes to these malpractice RVUs and
suggested that it is illogical for the
malpractice RVUs for the TC of a service
to be higher than the malpractice RVUs
for the PC.
We responded that we would like to
develop a resource-based methodology
for the technical portion of these
malpractice RVUs; but that we did not
have data to support such a change. We
asked for information about whether,
and if so, how technicians employed by
facilities purchase PLI or how their
professional liability is covered. We also
asked for comments on what types of
PLI are carried by entities that furnish
these technical services.
In the CY 2009 PFS proposed rule (73
FR 38515), we stated that the issue of
assigning malpractice RVUs for the TC
of certain services continues to be a
source of concern for several physician
associations and for CMS. We noted that
we did not receive a response to our CY
2008 request for additional data on this
issue and that this issue is one of
importance to CMS. We also stated that
the lack of available PLI data affects our
ability to make a resource-based
evaluation of the TC malpractice RVUs
for these codes. We indicated that as
part of our work to update the
malpractice RVUs in CY 2010, we
would instruct our contractor to
research available data sources for the
malpractice costs associated with the TC
portion of these codes and that we
would also ask the contractor to look at
what is included in general liability
PO 00000
Frm 00023
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
Minor-surgical
RF
1.98
1.00
1.00
1.56
1.00
1.00
1.54
2.21
6.50
6.89
1.00
2.15
1.59
1.72
1.16
1.00
1.22
1.76
5.87
2.30
2.29
2.62
1.76
1.50
1.98
1.00
1.00
1.56
1.00
1.00
1.54
2.21
6.50
6.89
1.00
2.15
2.03
1.72
1.16
1.00
1.22
1.76
5.87
2.30
3.77
2.62
1.76
2.26
Major-surgical
RF
1.98
1.00
1.00
1.56
1.00
1.00
1.54
2.21
6.50
6.89
1.00
2.15
2.03
1.72
1.16
1.00
1.22
1.76
5.87
2.30
4.87
2.62
1.76
3.56
insurance versus PLI for physicians and
other professional staff. We also stated
that if data sources were available, we
would instruct the contractor to gather
the data so we will be ready to
implement revised malpractice RVUs
for the TC of these codes in conjunction
with the update of malpractice RVUs for
the PCs in CY 2010.
In the CY 2009 PFS final rule (73 FR
69741), we again responded to
comments on this issue. We noted that
one commenter provided us with the
name of a company that provides
liability insurance to imaging facilities.
We stated that we planned to share the
information with our contractor and that
if premium data could be identified; it
would be incorporated into the
malpractice RVU update. Our
contractor, Acumen LLC, contacted the
company suggested by the commenter
and obtained medical physicist
malpractice premium data from one of
the largest association program
insurance brokers and administrators in
the United States providing this type of
malpractice insurance. The premium
data indicate that medical physicists
have very low malpractice premiums
relative to physicians.
Medical physicists are involved in
complex services such as IntensityModulated Radiation Therapy (IMRT).
IMRT is an advanced mode of
radiotherapy that utilizes computercontrolled x-ray accelerators to deliver
radiation doses to a malignant tumor.
Based on the complexity of these
services, we believe that medical
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33542
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
physicists would pay one of the highest
malpractice premium rates of the
entities furnishing TC services and that
using their data as a proxy (in the
absence of actual premium data) to
develop malpractice RVUs for TC
services would be more realistic than
our current approach for these entities.
Moreover, we believe it is unlikely that
actual malpractice premium rates for
these entities would exceed those for
medical physicists. Therefore, based on
this new data collection, we are
proposing to use the medical physicists’
premium data as a proxy for the
malpractice premiums paid by entities
providing TC services. We believe that
the use of this data will better reflect the
level of malpractice premiums paid by
entities providing TC services than the
current charge-based malpractice RVUs
or crosswalks to the malpractice
premium data of physician specialties.
As we have done in the past, we
continue to encourage public
commenters to submit or identify
alternative data that we might use for
the purpose of establishing malpractice
RVUs.
(4) Calculate malpractice RVUs for
each code. Resource-based malpractice
RVUs were calculated for each
procedure. The first step was to identify
the percentage of services furnished by
each specialty for each respective
procedure code. This percentage was
then multiplied by each respective
specialty’s risk factor as calculated in
Step 3. The products for all specialties
for the procedure were then added
together, yielding a specialty-weighted
malpractice RVU reflecting the weighted
malpractice costs across all specialties
for that procedure. This sum was then
multiplied by the procedure’s work
RVUs to account for differences in riskof-service.
Certain codes have no physician work
RVUs. The overwhelming majority of
these codes are the TCs of diagnostic
tests, such as x-rays and cardiac
catheterization, which have a distinctly
separate TC (the taking of an x-ray by a
technician) and PC (the interpretation of
the x-ray by a physician). Examples of
other codes with no work RVUs are
audiology tests and injections. These
services are usually furnished by NPPs,
in this example, audiologists and
nurses, respectively. In many cases, the
NPP or entity furnishing the TC is
distinct and separate from the physician
ordering and interpreting the test. We
believe it is appropriate for the
malpractice RVUs assigned to TCs to be
based on the malpractice costs of the
NPP or entity, not the professional
liability of the physician.
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
Our proposed methodology, however,
would result in zero malpractice RVUs
for codes with no physician work, since
we propose the use of physician work
RVUs to adjust for risk-of-service. We
believe that zero malpractice RVUs for
reasons other than rounding would be
inappropriate because NPPs and entities
such as IDTFs also have malpractice
liability.
Note that the earlier discussion above
in ‘‘(3) Calculate a risk factor for each
specialty’’ addressed the proposed use
of the medical physicist premium data
to develop a TC risk factor. This TC risk
factor is used in (3), as noted above,
along with the global risk factor to
calculate a PC risk factor. Once the
global and PC risk factors are calculated,
they are used here in step (4) to
calculate the global and PC malpractice
RVUs. Once we have calculated the
global and PC malpractice RVUs, we
propose to address the lack of work
RVUs for TC services by setting the TC
malpractice RVUs equal to the
difference between the global
malpractice RVUs and PC malpractice
RVUs.
(5) Rescale for budget neutrality. The
statute requires that changes to fee
schedule RVUs be budget neutral. The
current resource-based malpractice
RVUs and the proposed resource-based
malpractice RVUs were constructed
using entirely different malpractice
premium data. Thus, the last step is to
adjust for budget neutrality by rescaling
the proposed malpractice RVUs so that
the total proposed resource-based
malpractice RVUs equal the total
current resource-based malpractice
RVUs.
We are requesting comments on our
proposed methodology for updating the
malpractice RVUs. We are especially
interested in comments on our proposed
process for revising the malpractice
RVUs of the TC of codes with no
physician work. Additionally, we
intend to post the Acumen report,
‘‘Interim Report on Malpractice RVUs
for the CY 2010 Medicare Physician Fee
Schedule Proposed Rule’’ on the CMS
Web site in conjunction with
publication of this proposed.
D. Medicare Telehealth Services
1. Requests for Adding Services to the
List of Medicare Telehealth Services
Section 1834(m)(4)(F) of the Act
defines telehealth services as
professional consultations, office visits,
and office psychiatry services, and any
additional service specified by the
Secretary. In addition, the statute
requires us to establish a process for
adding services to or deleting services
PO 00000
Frm 00024
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
from the list of telehealth services on an
annual basis.
In the December 31, 2002 Federal
Register (67 FR 79988), we established
a process for adding services to or
deleting services from the list of
Medicare telehealth services. This
process provides the public an ongoing
opportunity to submit requests for
adding services. We assign any request
to make additions to the list of Medicare
telehealth services to one of the
following categories:
• Category #1: Services that are
similar to professional consultations,
office visits, and office psychiatry
services. In reviewing these requests, we
look for similarities between the
requested and existing telehealth
services for the roles of, and interactions
among, the beneficiary, the physician
(or other practitioner) at the distant site
and, if necessary, the telepresenter. We
also look for similarities in the
telecommunications system used to
deliver the proposed service, for
example, the use of interactive audio
and video equipment.
• Category #2: Services that are not
similar to the current list of telehealth
services. Our review of these requests
includes an assessment of whether the
use of a telecommunications system to
deliver the service produces similar
diagnostic findings or therapeutic
interventions as compared with the
face-to-face ‘‘hands on’’ delivery of the
same service. Requesters should submit
evidence showing that the use of a
telecommunications system does not
affect the diagnosis or treatment plan as
compared to a face-to-face delivery of
the requested service.
Since establishing the process, we
have added the following to the list of
Medicare telehealth services:
Psychiatric diagnostic interview
examination; ESRD services with two to
three visits per month and four or more
visits per month (although we require at
least one visit a month to be furnished
in-person ‘‘hands on,’’ by a physician,
clinical nurse specialist (CNS), nurse
practitioner (NP), or physician assistant
(PA) to examine the vascular access
site); individual medical nutrition
therapy; neurobehavioral status exam;
and follow-up inpatient telehealth
consultations.
Requests to add services to the list of
Medicare telehealth services must be
submitted and received no later than
December 31 of each calendar year to be
considered for the next rulemaking
cycle. For example, requests submitted
before the end of CY 2008 are
considered for the CY 2010 proposed
rule. Each request for adding a service
to the list of Medicare telehealth
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
services must include any supporting
documentation you wish us to consider
as we review the request. Because we
use the annual PFS rulemaking process
as a vehicle for making changes to the
list of Medicare telehealth services,
requesters should be advised that any
information submitted is subject to
disclosure for this purpose. For more
information on submitting a request for
an addition to the list of Medicare
telehealth services, including where to
mail these requests, visit our Web site
at https://www.cms.hhs.gov/telehealth/.
2. Submitted Requests for Addition to
the List of Telehealth Services
We received requests in CY 2008 to
add the following services as Medicare
telehealth services effective for CY 2010:
(1) Health and behavior assessment and
intervention (HBAI) procedures; and (2)
nursing facility services. In addition, we
received a number of requests to add
services that we considered previously
and did not approve as Medicare
telehealth services in previous PFS
rules. These requested services include
critical care services; initial and
subsequent hospital care; group medical
nutrition therapy; diabetes selfmanagement training; speech and
language pathology services; and
physical and occupational therapy
services. The following is a discussion
of these requests.
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
a. Health and Behavior Assessment and
Intervention (HBAI)
The American Psychological
Association (APA) submitted a request
to add HBAI services (as described by
HCPCS codes 96150 through 96154) to
the list of approved telehealth services.
The APA asks us to evaluate and
approve HBAI services as Category #1
service because they are comparable to
the psychotherapy services currently
approved for telehealth.
CMS Review
To determine whether to assign a
request to Category #1, we look for
similarities between the service that is
being considered for addition and the
existing telehealth services in the roles
of, and interactions among, the
beneficiary, the physician (or other
practitioner) at the distant site and, if
necessary, the telepresenter.
Clinical psychologists furnish HBAI
services to beneficiaries to help them
manage or improve their behavior in
response to physical problems.
Elements of HBAI services typically
include interviewing, observing, and
counseling beneficiaries to help them
modify their behavior. These elements
are also common to the office psychiatry
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
services currently approved for
telehealth. We believe the interaction
between a practitioner and a beneficiary
receiving individual HBAI services (as
described by HCPCS codes 96150
through 96152) is similar to the
assessment and counseling elements of
the individual office psychiatry services
currently approved for telehealth.
Therefore, we are proposing to revise
§ 410.78 and § 414.65 to include
individual HBAI services as Medicare
telehealth services.
With regard to group HBAI (as
described by HCPCS code 96153) or
family-with-patient HBAI (as described
by HCPCS code 96154), we note that no
group services are currently approved as
Medicare telehealth services. Group
counseling services have a different
interactive dynamic between the
physician or practitioner and his or her
patients as compared to individual
services. No other group counseling or
other group services are approved as
telehealth services. Since the interactive
dynamic for group HBAI services is not
similar to that for individual HBAI
services or any other approved
telehealth services, we do not believe
that group HBAI or family-with-patient
HBAI services are properly considered
as Category #1 requests. To be
considered as a Category #1 request, a
service must be similar to the current
list of Medicare telehealth services. (See
70 FR 45787 and 70157, and 73 FR
38516 and 69743).
Since the interactive dynamic
between practitioner and patient for
group HBAI and family-with-patient
HBAI is not similar to that for office
psychiatry services or any other service
currently approved for telehealth, we
believe that group HBAI and familywith-patient HBAI must be evaluated as
Category #2 services. Because we
consider group HBAI and family-withpatient HBAI to be Category #2 services,
we need to evaluate whether these are
services for which telehealth can be an
adequate substitute for a face-to-face
encounter. The requester did not submit
evidence suggesting that the use of a
telecommunications system to deliver
these services would produce similar
diagnostic findings or therapeutic
interventions as compared to the faceto-face delivery of these services. As
such, we do not propose to add group
HBAI (as described by HCPCS code
96153) or family-with-patient HBAI (as
described by HCPCS code 96154) to the
list of approved telehealth services.
b. Nursing Facility Services
In 2005, we received a request to add
the following nursing facility services to
the list of approved telehealth services:
PO 00000
Frm 00025
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33543
Initial nursing facility care (as described
by HCPCS codes 99304 through 99306);
subsequent nursing facility care (HCPCS
codes 99307 through 99310); nursing
facility discharge services (HCPCS codes
99315 and 99316); and other nursing
facility services (HCPCS code 99318). In
the CY 2007 PFS final rule with
comment period, we did not add these
nursing facility care services to the list
of approved telehealth services because
these procedure codes did not describe
services that were appropriate to add to
the list of available telehealth
originating sites in CY 2007. At that
time, skilled nursing facilities (SNFs)
were not defined in the statute as
originating sites (71 FR 69657).
However, section 149 of the MIPPA
added SNFs as telehealth originating
sites effective for services furnished on
or after January 1, 2009. In light of this
provision, the American Telemedicine
Association (ATA) urged us to add
nursing facility care codes to the list of
telehealth services for CY 2009, as
requested in 2005.
In the CY 2009 PFS final rule with
comment period, we noted that section
149 of the MIPPA did not add any
services to the list of Medicare
telehealth services. In the CY 2009 PFS
final rule with comment period, we also
responded to the ATA’s comment
suggesting that we add nursing facility
care codes to the list of telehealth
services for CY 2009, as requested in
2005. In our response, we noted that
when we received the 2005 request to
consider the addition of nursing facility
care services for telehealth for CY 2007,
we did not include a full review of these
codes in either the CY 2007 PFS
proposed rule or final rule with
comment period since we believed it
was not relevant to add the nursing
facility services codes when the SNFs in
which these services would be
furnished were not eligible originating
sites. In the CY 2009 PFS final rule with
comment period, we responded that we
believe it would be more appropriate to
consider the addition of nursing facility
care services for telehealth through our
existing process, including full notice
and comment procedures. We
committed to revisiting the 2005 request
to add the nursing facility codes in the
CY 2010 PFS proposed rule, and we
noted that we would accept additional
information in support of the 2005
request if we received the information
prior to December 31, 2008 (73 FR
69747).
Subsequent to publication of the CY
2009 PFS final rule with comment
period, the ATA submitted an amended
request to add subsequent nursing
facility care; nursing facility discharge
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33544
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
services; and other nursing facility
services to the list of approved
telehealth services. The Center for
Telehealth and e-Health Law submitted
a request to add the same nursing
facility services and indicated its
support of ATA’s request. We also
received a request from the Marshfield
Clinic to add the same services
requested by the ATA, plus the initial
nursing facility care services. The
requesters drew analogies to the
evaluation and management (E/M)
services currently approved for
telehealth, and they provided evidence
in support of their belief that the use of
telehealth could be a reasonable
surrogate for the face-to-face delivery of
this type of care.
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
CMS Review
The procedure codes included in
these requests are used to report E/M
services furnished onsite to patients in
nursing facilities. In the context of these
codes, ‘‘nursing facility’’ describes
SNFs, NFs, intermediate care facilities,
and psychiatric residential treatment
centers.
Medicare telehealth services can only
be furnished to beneficiaries located at
an originating site authorized by law. A
SNF (as defined in section 1819(a) of the
Act) is the only type of nursing facility
that can also be considered an
originating site for telehealth services.
Therefore, our review of these services
focuses on the potential impact of
adding these services when furnished
via telehealth to a Medicare beneficiary
located in a SNF.
Federally-Mandated Visits in Skilled
Nursing Facilities
In describing our assessment, we first
describe the service requirements of a
Medicare SNF stay. In response to
concerns about inadequate care
provided to residents of nursing homes,
the Omnibus Budget Reconciliation Act
of 1987 (OBRA ’87) (Pub. L. 100–203)
included extensive revisions to the
requirements for Medicare and
Medicaid certified nursing homes.
These provisions were designed to
significantly improve the quality of life
and the quality of care provided to
residents of nursing homes, and were a
high priority for the Department of
Health and Human Services.
Specific requirements for assuring the
quality of care that SNFs must meet to
participate in Medicare are specified in
section 1819 of the Act. In addition,
section 1819(d)(4)(B) of the Act provides
that ‘‘[a] skilled nursing facility must
meet such other requirements relating to
the health, safety, and well-being of
residents or relating to the physical
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
facilities thereof as the Secretary may
find necessary.’’ The provisions of 42
CFR Part 483 codify the requirements
set forth in the statute that long term
care facilities are obligated to meet in
order to participate in the Medicare
and/or Medicaid program.
Section 1819(b)(6)(A) of the Act
requires that the medical care of every
SNF resident must be provided under
the supervision of a physician. The
requirements contained in § 483.40
include a prescribed visit schedule and
specify that the physician must perform
the initial visit personally. Section
483.40(c) requires that the resident of a
SNF must be seen by a physician at least
once every 30 days for the first 90 days
after admission, and at least once every
60 days thereafter. As we indicated in
the preamble to the February 2, 1989
final rule (54 FR 5341), and again in
response to comments in the September
26, 1991 final rule (56 FR 48826), the
wording of the regulation states that the
resident ‘‘must be seen’’ by the
physician and requires an actual, faceto-face contact. Except for certain stated
exceptions, all required physician visits
must be made personally by the
physician. Section 483.40(e)(2) requires
that when personal performance of a
particular task by a physician is
specified in the regulations,
performance of that task cannot be
delegated to anyone else. Section
483.40(c)(4) requires that the physician
must perform the initial visit personally,
and § 483.40(c)(5), allows the physician
the option of alternating with a qualified
NPP (that is, physician assistant, nurse
practitioner, or clinical nurse specialist)
in making the subsequent required
visits. These regulations ensure that at
least a minimal degree of personal
contact between physician or qualified
NPP and resident is maintained, both at
the point of admission to the facility
and periodically during the course of
the resident’s stay (54 FR 5342).
In the CY 2009 PFS final rule with
comment period (73 FR 69747), we
noted that in considering nursing
facility care for telehealth, we would
need to carefully evaluate the use of
telehealth for the personal visits that are
currently required under § 483.40. The
OBRA ’87 and other long-term care
legislation enacted since then require a
SNF to care for its residents ‘‘in such a
manner and in such an environment as
will promote maintenance or
enhancement of the quality of life of
each resident’’ as specified in section
1819(b)(1)(A) of the Act. We believe that
a minimum number of periodic,
comprehensive, hands-on examinations
of a resident by a physician or a
qualified NPP are necessary to ensure
PO 00000
Frm 00026
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
that the resident receives quality care.
We believe that the complexity of care
required by many residents of SNFs
warrants at least a minimal degree of
direct personal contact between
physicians or qualified NPPs and SNF
residents. Therefore, we believe that
these Federally-mandated visits should
be conducted in-person, and not as
telehealth services, in order to provide
direct personal contact between the
resident and the physician or qualified
NPP.
In the MMA, the Congress recognized
the importance of furnishing the
Federally-mandated visits in person,
rather than via telehealth. Section 418 of
the MMA required the Secretary to
submit a Report to Congress evaluating
the use of telehealth in SNFs. If the
Secretary determined that it was
advisable to permit a SNF to be an
originating site for telehealth services,
the MMA provided the Secretary with
the authority to expand telehealth
originating sites to include SNFs. SNFs
were permitted to be added as
originating sites only if the Secretary
could establish a mechanism to ensure
that telehealth does not serve as a
substitute for in-person visits furnished
by a physician, or for in-person visits
furnished by a physician assistant,
nurse practitioner, or clinical nurse
specialist.
On November 9, 2007, the Secretary
provided to Congress the report
specified under section 418 of the
MMA, entitled, ‘‘Permitting Skilled
Nursing Facilities to be Originating
Telehealth Sites.’’ Overall, the Report
noted that evidence concerning the net
impact of allowing SNFs to be
originating telehealth sites was not
conclusive and further analysis was
needed. With respect to Federallymandated visits in SNFs, the Report
stated that the Secretary could use its
authority to add services to and delete
services from the list of Medicare
telehealth services as a mechanism to
ensure that Federally-mandated visits
are not furnished as a Medicare
telehealth service by not adding these
visits to the lists of Medicare telehealth
services.
In consideration of the history of the
OBRA ’87, 42 CFR part 483, and
Congressional concern expressed in
section 418 of the MMA, we do not
propose to add any procedure codes that
are used exclusively to describe E/M
services that fulfill Federal requirements
for personal visits under § 483.40. We
are proposing to revise § 410.78 to
restrict physicians and practitioners
from using telehealth to furnish the
physician visits required under
§ 483.40(c).
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
In the following sections, we will
separately review the use of telehealth
for each of the subcategories of nursing
facility services included in these
requests. In these discussions, we will
also indicate which of these
subcategories are used to describe E/M
services that fulfill Federal requirements
for personal visits under § 483.40.
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Initial Nursing Facility Care
The initial nursing facility care
procedure codes (as described by
HCPCS codes 99304 through 99306) are
used to report the initial E/M visit in a
SNF or NF that fulfills Federallymandated requirements under
§ 483.40(c). For survey and certification
requirements, this initial visit must
occur no later than 30 days after
admission. In a SNF, a physician must
furnish the initial visit.
One of the requesters noted that once
the patient is transferred to the SNF, it
might be days until a physician can see
a resident in-person. The requester
believes a higher quality of care would
be provided if the initial nursing facility
service can be done in an expeditious
manner—via telehealth—rather than
delayed until the physician is on site.
As noted above, we are not proposing
to add any procedure codes that are
used exclusively to describe E/M
services that fulfill Federal requirements
for personal visits under § 483.40. We
believe that these Federally-mandated
visits should be conducted in-person
because this will ensure at least a
minimal degree of direct personal
contact between physicians or qualified
NPPs and residents. Further, we believe
it is particularly important that the
Federally-mandated initial visit should
be conducted in-person because this
will ensure that the physician can
comprehensively assess the resident’s
condition upon admission to the SNF
through a thorough hands-on
examination. We believe that even if the
initial visit is delayed for a few days, it
is necessary for the resident of a SNF to
have a face-to-face visit with the
physician who is developing a plan of
care. Under section 1819(b)(2) of the
Act, a SNF must provide services to
attain or maintain the highest
practicable physical, mental, and
psychosocial well-being of each
resident. We believe that furnishing the
initial visit in a face-to-face encounter,
and not via telehealth, is necessary to
assure quality care. As such, we are not
proposing to add the initial nursing
facility care services (as described by
HCPCS codes 99304 through 99306) to
the list of approved telehealth services.
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
Subsequent Nursing Facility Care
The subsequent nursing facility care
procedure codes (as described by
HCPCS codes 99307 through 99310) are
used to report either a Federallymandated periodic visit under
§ 483.40(c), or any E/M visit, prior to
and after the initial physician visit, that
is reasonable and medically necessary to
meet the medical needs of the
individual resident.
The long-term care regulations at
§ 483.40 require periodic physician
visits for residents of SNFs (and NFs) at
least once every 30 days for the first 90
days after admission and at least once
every 60 days thereafter. After the initial
visit, Federally-mandated periodic visits
in SNFs may, at the option of the
physician, alternate between personal
visits by the physician and visits by a
qualified NPP (who is under the
supervision of a physician, and meets
the other requirements specified at
§ 483.40(e)). As noted above, we are not
proposing to allow the use of telehealth
to furnish these Federally-mandated
personal visits. We believe that these
Federally-mandated periodic visits
should be conducted in-person because
this will ensure at least a minimal
degree of direct personal contact
between physicians or qualified NPPs
and residents. Under section 1819(b)(2)
of the Act, a SNF must provide services
to attain or maintain the highest
practicable physical, mental, and
psychosocial well-being of each
resident. We believe that furnishing the
periodic personal visits in face-to-face
encounters, and not via telehealth, is
necessary to assure quality care.
We considered the possibility of
approving subsequent nursing facility
care for telehealth with specific
limitations, for example, approving
subsequent nursing facility care for
telehealth only when the codes are used
for medically necessary E/M visits that
are in addition to Federally mandated
periodic personal visits. In past years,
we did not add hospital E/M visits to
the list of Medicare approved telehealth
services because of our concern
regarding the use of telehealth for the
ongoing E/M of a high-acuity hospital
inpatient. (See 69 FR 47511, 69 FR
66276, 72 FR 38144, 72 FR 66250, 73 FR
38517, and 73 FR 69745.) Many
residents of SNFs require medically
complex care, and we have similar
concerns about allowing physicians or
NPPs to furnish E/M visits via telehealth
to residents of SNFs.
Because the complexity of care
required by many residents of SNFs may
be significantly greater than the
complexity of care generally associated
PO 00000
Frm 00027
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33545
with patients receiving the office visits
approved for telehealth, we do not
consider E/M visits furnished to
residents of SNFs similar to the office
visits on the current list of Medicare
telehealth services. Therefore, we
believe the use of subsequent nursing
facility care for medically necessary
E/M visits that are in addition to
Federally mandated periodic personal
visits must be evaluated as a Category
#2 service.
Because we consider subsequent
nursing facility care to be a Category #2
request, we evaluate whether these are
services for which telehealth can be an
adequate substitute for a face-to-face
encounter. The requesters submitted
supporting documentation intended to
suggest that the use of telehealth could
be a reasonable surrogate for the face-toface delivery of this type of care.
One study assessed the impact of
videoconferencing (as opposed to
communication by telephone without
video) on nighttime, on-call medical
decision-making in the nursing home.
The comparison of videoconferencing
with telephonic communication of
information by nurses does not provide
a comparative analysis demonstrating
that E/M visits furnished via telehealth
to residents of SNFs is equivalent to the
face-to-face delivery of such services. As
such, this study was not relevant to this
review.
Another study assessed the value of a
monitoring system in reducing falls and
injuries in non-acute late-evening and
nighttime situations in a nursing home
setting. The monitoring system
described in this study was comprised
of sensors to alert caregivers via a silent
pager when a high-risk resident exits his
or her bed, bedroom, or bathroom. This
allows caregivers to aid the resident and
potentially reduce falls. The
technologies utilized in this study do
not correspond with our definitions of
telehealth as specified in § 410.78. In
addition, this type of resident
monitoring is performed typically by
nursing staff and is not an E/M visit. As
such, this study was not relevant to this
review.
A third study presented the savings
achieved through avoiding transport to
emergency departments and physicians’
offices by furnishing visits via telehealth
to residents in nursing facilities. The
study did not provide any comparative
analysis of the services furnished via
telehealth with those furnished in
person.
A fourth study evaluated the impact
of telemedicine as a decision aid for
residents of long-term care SNFs with
chronic wounds. The patients selected
for this study were alert and
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33546
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
intellectually interactive. The study
concluded that furnishing a telehealth
consultation prior to a face-to-face
consultation increased the level of
patient comfort with care-related
decisions made during the face-to-face
consultation. The control group did not
receive an equivalent intermediate
consultation face-to-face that could be
compared to the services furnished to
the test group. We acknowledge the
study’s findings that the intermediate
telehealth consultation was a useful
decision aid, but we do not consider
this a comparative analysis between
delivery of the same type of care via
telehealth versus face-to-face.
We received a pilot study evaluating
the usefulness of E/M services furnished
via telehealth for making routine
medical decisions in the nursing home.
The nursing home residents were
evaluated over videoconferencing and
then evaluated immediately afterward
by the same clinician in person. On a
scale of 1 to 5 (1 being the least ill), the
clinicians assessed the illness level of
these residents at 3 or below, with the
illness level for over 65 percent of the
encounters assessed at ‘‘1.’’
Videoconferencing without a face-toface examination was sufficient for
making medical decisions in most cases
studied in this pilot, although face-toface examinations were preferred.
Clinicians generated orders in 30
percent of these paired encounters, with
a predominance of orders generated
after, rather than before, the face-to-face
examination. The study also noted that
even when nursing home residents were
alert, they had limited participation in
the telemedicine interactions and were
not as involved in making informed
medical decisions with their clinicians,
compared to face-to-face encounters.
The study suggests that remote
examination by video might serve as a
substitute for some routine visits, if
interspersed with face-to-face
examinations. The study concluded that
videoconferencing is feasible for making
routine medical decisions in the nursing
home.
We appreciate the comparative
analysis provided by this study.
However, we note that this study
focused on the usefulness of telehealth
for routine decision-making in the
nursing home, and the reported illness
levels of the residents in these sample
encounters was relatively low to
moderate. We do not consider these
findings persuasive that telehealth can,
more generally, be an adequate
substitute for the face-to-face delivery of
E/M visits to residents of SNFs who
might require more medically complex
care.
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
We considered the possibility of
approving the use of telehealth to
furnish E/M visits to residents of SNFs
who do not require medically complex
care or approving subsequent nursing
facility care for telehealth only for
medically necessary E/M visits with
straightforward or low complexity
medical decision-making (as described
by HCPCS codes 99307 and 99308).
Although this last pilot study concluded
that videoconferencing is feasible for
making routine medical decisions in the
nursing home, we are concerned with
the study’s finding that residents with
low to moderate levels of reported
illness had limited participation in the
telemedicine interactions and less
involvement in making informed
medical decisions with their clinicians,
compared to face-to-face encounters.
Under section 1819(c)(1)(A) of the Act,
a SNF must protect and promote the
rights of each resident, including the
right to be fully informed in advance of
any changes in care or treatment that
may affect the resident’s well-being, and
(except with respect to a resident
adjudged incompetent) to participate in
planning care and treatment or changes
in care or treatment. Under
§ 483.10(b)(3), a resident has the right to
be fully informed in language that he or
she can understand of his or her total
health status, including but not limited
to his or her medical condition. If the
use of telehealth does not elicit from
residents with low to moderate reported
illness adequate participation in making
informed medical decisions with their
clinicians when compared to face-toface encounters, we believe that
telehealth is not an adequate substitute
for the face-to-face delivery of E/M visits
to any residents of SNFs.
After reviewing these studies, we do
not have sufficient comparative analysis
or other compelling evidence to
demonstrate that furnishing E/M visits
via telehealth to residents of SNFs is an
adequate substitute for the face-to-face
encounter between the practitioner and
the resident, especially in cases where
the resident requires medically complex
care. Therefore, we are not proposing to
add subsequent nursing facility care
services (as described by HCPCS codes
99307 through 99310) to the list of
approved telehealth services.
Nursing Facility Discharge Day
Management
The nursing facility discharge day
management codes (as described by
HCPCS codes 99315 and 99316) are
used to report an E/M visit that prepares
a resident for discharge from a nursing
facility. We note that there is no
Medicare Part B requirement to furnish
PO 00000
Frm 00028
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
and bill an E/M visit in preparation for
a resident’s discharge from a SNF.
However, if a physician or qualified
NPP bills a Nursing Facility Discharge
Services code, we believe that a face-toface encounter will better insure that the
resident is prepared for discharge, as we
do not have evidence that nursing
facility discharge services via telehealth
is adequately equivalent to face-to-face
provision. As such, we are not
proposing to add the nursing facility
discharge day management services (as
described by HCPCS codes 99315 and
99316) to the list of approved telehealth
services.
Other Nursing Facility Service
In 2006, CPT added a procedure code
for Other Nursing Facility Service (CPT
code 99318) to describe an annual
nursing facility assessment. An annual
assessment is not one of the required
visits under the long-term care
regulations at § 483.40. For Medicare
purposes, this code can be used in lieu
of a Subsequent Nursing Facility Care
code to report a Federally-mandated
periodic personal visit furnished under
§ 483.40(c). An annual assessment visit
billed using CPT code 99318 does not
represent a distinct benefit service for
Medicare Part B physician services, and
it cannot be billed in addition to the
required number of Federally-mandated
periodic personal visits. Under
Medicare Part B, we cover this
procedure code if the visit fully meets
the CPT code 99318 requirements for an
annual nursing facility assessment and
if such an annual assessment falls on
the 60-day mandated visit cycle. We are
not proposing to add the other nursing
facility care services (as described by
HCPCS code 99318) to the list of
approved telehealth services because
this code is payable by Medicare only if
the visit is substituted for a Federallymandated visit under § 483.40(c). As
explained above, we believe all of the
Federally-mandated periodic visits must
be conducted in person.
Follow-up Inpatient Consultations
Prior to 2006, follow-up inpatient
consultations (as described by CPT
codes 99261 through 99263) were
approved telehealth services. In 2006,
the CPT Editorial Panel of the American
Medical Association (AMA) deleted the
codes for follow-up inpatient
consultations. In the hospital setting,
the AMA advised practitioners to bill
for services that would previously have
been billed as follow-up inpatient
consultations using the procedure codes
for subsequent hospital care (as
described by CPT codes 99231 through
99233). In the nursing facility setting,
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
the AMA advised practitioners to bill
for these services using the procedure
codes for subsequent nursing facility
care (as described by CPT codes 99307
through 99310).
In the CY 2008 PFS proposed rule (72
FR 38144) and subsequent final rule
with comment period (72 FR 66250), we
discussed a request from the ATA to
add subsequent hospital care to the list
of approved telehealth services. Because
there was no method for practitioners to
bill for follow-up consultations
delivered via telehealth to hospital
inpatients, the ATA requested that we
add the subsequent hospital care codes
to the list of Medicare approved
telehealth services. We expressed our
concern that subsequent hospital care
codes describe a broader range of
services than follow-up consultations,
including some services that may not be
appropriate to be furnished via
telehealth. We committed to continue
evaluating the issues.
In the CY 2009 PFS proposed rule (73
FR 38517), we proposed to create a new
series of HCPCS codes for follow-up
inpatient telehealth consultations. In the
CY 2009 PFS final rule with comment
period (73 FR 69745), we finalized our
proposal to create follow-up inpatient
telehealth consultation codes (as
described by HCPCS codes G0406
through G0408) and added these Gcodes to the list of Medicare telehealth
services. These HCPCS codes are
limited to the range of services included
in the scope of the previous CPT codes
for follow-up inpatient consultations,
and the descriptions limit the use of
such services for telehealth. (See the
CMS Internet-Only Medicare Benefit
Policy Manual, Pub. 100–02, Chapter
15, Section 270.2.1 and the Medicare
Claims Processing Manual, Pub. 100–04,
Chapter 12, Section 190.3.1 for the
current definition of follow-up inpatient
telehealth consultations.)
We note that if the former codes for
follow-up consultations (as described by
CPT codes 99261 through 99263) still
existed, these procedure codes would
also be available to practitioners to
submit claims to their Medicare
contractors for payment of follow-up
consultations provided via telehealth to
patients located in SNFs. Although we
did not receive a public request to add
follow-up inpatient consultations for
patients in SNFs to the list of approved
Medicare telehealth services, we
recognize a similar need to establish a
method for practitioners to furnish and
bill for follow-up consultations
delivered via telehealth to patients in
SNFs.
We considered the possibility of
approving subsequent nursing facility
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
care for telehealth with specific
limitations, for example, approving
subsequent nursing facility care for
telehealth only when the codes are used
for follow-up consultations. However, as
discussed above, we do not believe it
would be appropriate for E/M visits to
be furnished via telehealth to treat
residents of SNFs requiring medically
complex care. We are concerned that it
could be difficult to implement
sufficient controls and monitoring to
ensure that the use of the subsequent
nursing facility care codes for telehealth
is limited to the delivery of services that
were formerly described as follow-up
inpatient consultations.
We considered creating new G-codes
to enable practitioners to bill for the
services that were formerly described as
follow-up inpatient telehealth
consultations when furnished to
residents of SNFs. We examined the
feasibility of creating such codes to
parallel the subsequent nursing facility
care services, which are the codes
currently used to bill these follow-up
consultations in a face-to-face
encounter. We found that the elements
of the four levels of subsequent nursing
facility care did not correspond to the
three levels of the deleted CPT codes
previously used for follow-up inpatient
consultations. We believe that it would
be administratively simpler to utilize
the three existing codes for follow-up
inpatient telehealth consultations rather
than add additional G-codes. The use of
the same ‘‘follow-up inpatient telehealth
consultation’’ G-codes for services
furnished in both hospital inpatient and
SNF settings would also correspond to
the use of the previous CPT codes for
services furnished to hospital inpatients
and residents of SNFs.
For CY 2010, we are proposing to
revise § 410.78 to specify that the Gcodes for follow-up inpatient telehealth
consultations (as described by HCPCS
codes G0406 through G0408) include
follow-up telehealth consultations
furnished to beneficiaries in hospitals
and SNFs. The HCPCS codes will
clearly designate these services as
follow-up consultations provided via
telehealth, and not subsequent nursing
facility care used for E/M visits.
Utilization of these codes for patients in
SNFs will facilitate payment for these
services, as well as enable us to monitor
whether the codes are used
appropriately.
As described in the CMS InternetOnly Medicare Benefit Policy Manual,
Pub. 100–02, Chapter 15, Section
270.2.1 and the Medicare Claims
Processing Manual, Pub. 100–04,
Chapter 12, Section 190.3.1, follow-up
inpatient telehealth consultations
PO 00000
Frm 00029
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33547
include monitoring progress,
recommending management
modifications, or advising on a new
plan of care in response to changes in
the patient’s status or no changes on the
consulted health issue. Counseling and
coordination of care with other
providers or agencies is included as
well, consistent with the nature of the
problem(s) and the patient’s needs. The
physician or practitioner who furnishes
the inpatient follow-up consultation via
telehealth cannot be the physician of
record or the attending physician, and
the follow-up inpatient consultation
would be distinct from the follow-up
care provided by a physician of record
or the attending physician. If a
physician consultant has initiated
treatment at an initial consultation and
participates thereafter in the patient’s
ongoing care management, such care
would not be included in the definition
of a follow-up inpatient consultation
and is not appropriate for delivery via
telehealth.
Consistent with our policy for followup telehealth consultations furnished to
hospital inpatients, in order to bill and
receive payment for these services,
physicians and practitioners must
submit the appropriate HCPCS
procedure code for follow-up inpatient
telehealth consultations along with the
‘‘GT’’ modifier (‘‘via interactive audio
and video telecommunications
system’’). By coding and billing the
‘‘GT’’ modifier with the follow-up
inpatient telehealth consultation codes,
the distant site physician or practitioner
certifies that the beneficiary was present
at an eligible originating site when the
telehealth service was furnished. (See
the CMS Internet-Only Medicare Claims
Processing Manual, Pub. 100–04,
Chapter 12, Section 190.6.1 for
instructions for submission of
interactive telehealth claims.)
In the case of Federal telemedicine
demonstration programs conducted in
Alaska or Hawaii, store and forward
technologies may be used as a substitute
for an interactive telecommunications
system. Covered store and forward
telehealth services are billed with the
‘‘GQ’’ modifier, ‘‘via asynchronous
telecommunications system.’’ By using
the ‘‘GQ’’ modifier, the distant site
physician or practitioner certifies that
the asynchronous medical file was
collected and transmitted to him or her
at the distant site from a Federal
telemedicine demonstration project
conducted in Alaska or Hawaii. (See the
CMS Internet-Only Medicare Claims
Processing Manual, Pub. 100–04,
Chapter 12, Section 190.6.2 for
instructions for submission of telehealth
store and forward claims.)
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33548
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
c. Critical Care Services
In the CY 2009 PFS proposed rule (73
FR 38517), we reviewed a request
submitted by the University of
Pittsburgh Medical Center (UPMC) to
add critical care services (as described
by HCPCS codes 99291 and 99292) to
the list of approved telehealth services.
UPMC drew analogies to the E/M
consultation services currently
approved for telehealth and described
how it uses telehealth to give stroke
patients timely access to consultative
input from highly specialized
physicians who are not available to
furnish services face-to-face.
In the CY 2009 PFS final rule with
comment period (73 FR 69744), we did
not add critical care services to the list
of approved telehealth services. This
request was not considered as a category
#1 request because, as we stated, we
believe that remote critical care services
are a different service than the
telehealth delivery of critical care (as
described by HCPCS codes 99291 and
99292). We stated that we had no
evidence suggesting that the use of
telehealth could be a reasonable
surrogate for the face-to-face delivery of
this type of care, and we did not add
critical care services to the list of
Medicare approved telehealth services.
We noted that this decision does not
preclude physicians from providing
telehealth consultations to critically ill
patients.
Following publication of the CY 2009
PFS final rule with comment period,
Philips Healthcare, the maker of a
remote critical care system, submitted
an expanded request to add critical care
services to the list of Medicare approved
telehealth services. The Philips
Healthcare request stated that critical
care services can be approved as a
Category #1 service based on their
similarity to the inpatient consultation
services currently approved for
telehealth. The requester noted that
many of the components of critical care
are similar to a high-level inpatient
consultation service, which is currently
approved for telehealth. Common
components include obtaining a patient
history, conducting an examination, and
engaging in complex medical decisionmaking for patients who may be
severely ill. Because we classified
critical care as a Category #2 service last
year, Philips also submitted evidence to
support its belief that the use of
telehealth could be a reasonable
surrogate for the face-to-face delivery of
this type of care.
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
CMS Review
To determine whether to assign a
request to Category #1, we look for
similarities between the service that is
being considered for addition and
existing telehealth services for the roles
of, and interactions among, the
beneficiary, the physician (or other
practitioner) at the distant site and, if
necessary, the telepresenter. In this case,
we look for such similarities between
critical care and inpatient consultations
and other similar services on the current
list of approved Medicare telehealth
services. Critical care (as described by
HCPCS codes 99291 and 99292) is the
direct delivery by a physician of
medical care for a critically ill or
critically injured patient. It involves
high complexity decision-making to
assess, manipulate, and support vital
system function(s) to treat single or
multiple vital organ system failure and/
or to prevent further life-threatening
deterioration of the patient’s condition.
Within the current standards of practice,
we believe critical care services require
the physical presence of the physician
rendering the critical care services. We
also note that a number of hands-on
interventions (for example, gastric
intubation and vascular access
procedures), when furnished on the day
a physician bills for critical care, are
included in the critical care service and
are not reported separately. Inpatient
consultations generally do not include
hands-on interventions. Because we
believe that critical care services (as
described by HCPCS codes 99291 and
99292) require the physical presence of
a physician who is available to furnish
any necessary hands-on interventions,
we do not consider critical care services
similar to any services on the current
list of Medicare telehealth services.
Therefore, we believe critical care must
be evaluated as a Category #2 service.
In order to evaluate critical care
services as a Category #2 service, we
need to determine whether these are
services for which telehealth can be an
adequate substitute for a face-to-face
encounter. In CPT 2009, the AMA
defined remote critical care services
tracking codes (codes 0188T through
0189T) with cross-references to critical
care services (HCPCS codes 99291
through 99292). CPT directs that only
one physician may report either critical
care services or remote critical care
services for the same period. The
requester cites this as evidence that the
AMA considers the two services
equivalent, and that critical care should
be approved as a Category #2 service.
We do not consider the CPT coding
guidance persuasive evidence that
PO 00000
Frm 00030
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
remote critical care is the telehealth
delivery of critical care, as defined by
HCPCS codes 99291 and 99292. We
believe that if the AMA valued the two
services equally, they would not have
created separate tracking codes for
remote critical care services.
As we noted in the CY 2009 PFS final
rule with comment period, consistent
with the AMA’s creation of tracking
codes, we believe that remote critical
care services are different from the
telehealth delivery of critical care
services (as described by HCPCS codes
99291 and 99292). Category III CPT
codes track utilization of a service,
facilitating data collection on, and
assessment of, new services and
procedures. We believe that the data
collected for these tracking codes will
help provide useful information on how
to best categorize and value remote
critical care services in the future.
The requester also submitted studies
which conclude that remote critical care
services furnished by intensivists
improve mortality rates, decrease length
of stay, reduce per patient costs, and
improve compliance with best practices,
thereby improving patient outcomes.
These studies are similar to the ones we
received and reviewed from the CY
2009 PFS proposed rule. We maintain
that remote critical care services are not
the telehealth delivery of critical care
services (as described by HCPCS codes
99291 and 99292). Therefore, we do not
find the new studies submitted with the
CY 2010 request persuasive that
telehealth can be an adequate substitute
for the face-to-face delivery of critical
care services (as described by HCPCS
codes 99291 and 99292).
We continue to believe that remote
critical care services are different
services than the telehealth delivery of
critical care (as described by HCPCS
codes 99291 and 99292). As such, we
are not proposing to add critical care
services (as described by HCPCS codes
99291 and 99292) to the list of approved
telehealth services. We reiterate that our
decision not to add critical care services
to the list of approved telehealth
services does not preclude physicians
from furnishing telehealth consultations
to critically ill patients.
d. Other Requests
We received a number of requests to
add services that we reviewed and did
not approve in previous PFS Rules. The
following are brief summaries and
references to previous discussions
regarding our decisions not to add these
procedure codes to the list of Medicare
approved telehealth services. As
explained further below, we are not
reconsidering these previous decisions.
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
Initial and Subsequent Hospital Care
We received a request to add initial
hospital care (as described by HCPCS
codes 99221 through 99223) and
subsequent hospital care (as described
by HCPCS codes 99231 through 99233)
to the list of approved telehealth
services. In response to previous
requests, we did not add initial or
subsequent hospital care to the list of
approved telehealth services because of
our concern regarding the use of
telehealth for the ongoing E/M of a highacuity hospital inpatient. (See 69 FR
47510 and 66276, 72 FR 38144 and
66250, and 73 FR 38517 and 69745.) We
did not receive any new information
with this request that would alter our
previous decisions. Therefore, we are
not proposing to add initial hospital
care (as described by HCPCS codes
99221 through 99223) or subsequent
hospital care (as described by HCPCS
codes 99231 through 99233) to the list
of approved telehealth services.
Group Medical Nutrition Therapy
Services
We received a request to add group
medical nutrition therapy (MNT)
services (as described by HCPCS codes
G0271 and 97804) to the list of
approved telehealth services. In
response to a previous request, we did
not add group MNT to the list of
approved telehealth services because we
believe that group services are not
appropriately delivered through
telehealth. (See 70 FR 45787 and
70157.) We did not receive any new
information with this request that
would alter our previous decision.
Therefore, we are not proposing to add
group MNT (as described by HCPCS
codes G0271 and 97804) to the list of
approved telehealth services.
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Diabetes Self-Management Training
(DSMT)
We received a request to add diabetes
self-management training (DSMT) (as
described by HCPCS codes G0108 and
G0109) to the list of approved telehealth
services. In response to previous
requests, we did not add DSMT to the
list of approved telehealth services
because of the statutory requirement
that DSMT include teaching
beneficiaries to self-administer
injectable drugs. Furthermore, DSMT is
often performed in group settings and
we believe that group services are not
appropriately delivered through
telehealth. (See 70 FR 45787 and 70157,
and 73 FR 38516 and 69743.) We did
not receive any new information with
this request that would alter our
previous decisions. Therefore, we are
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
not proposing to add DSMT (as
described by HCPCS codes G0108 and
G0109) to the list of approved telehealth
services.
Speech and Language Pathology
Services
We received a request to add various
speech and language pathology services
to the list of approved telehealth
services. Speech-language pathologists
are not permitted under current law to
furnish and receive payment for
Medicare telehealth services. Therefore,
we do not propose to add any speech
and language pathology services to the
list of Medicare telehealth services. (For
further discussion, see 69 FR 47512 and
66276, and 71 FR 48995 and 69657.)
Physical and Occupational Therapy
Services
We received a request to add various
physical and occupational therapy
services to the list of approved
telehealth services. Physical and
occupational therapists are not
permitted under current law to furnish
and receive payment for Medicare
telehealth services. Therefore, we are
not proposing to add any physical and
occupational therapy services to the list
of approved telehealth services. (For
further discussion, see 71 FR 48995 and
69657.)
E. Coding Issues
1. Canalith Repositioning
In 2008, the CPT Editorial Panel
created a new code for canalith
repositioning (CRP). This procedure is a
treatment for vertigo which involves
therapeutic maneuvering of the patient’s
body and head in order to use the force
of gravity to redeposit the calcium
crystal debris in the semicircular canal
system.
In the CY 2009 PFS final rule with
comment period (73 FR 69896), new
CPT code 95992, Canalith repositioning
procedure(s) (eg, Epley maneuver,
Semont maneuver), per day, was
assigned the bundled status indicator
(B). We explained that this procedure
previously was billed as part of an
evaluation and management (E/M)
service or under a number of CPT codes,
including CPT code 97112, Therapeutic
procedure, one or more areas, each 15
minutes; neuromuscular reeducation of
movement, balance, coordination,
kinesthetic sense, posture, and/or
proprioception for sitting and/or
standing activities. We also explained
that because neurologists and therapists
are the predominant providers of this
service to Medicare patients (each at 22
percent), it was assigned as a
PO 00000
Frm 00031
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33549
‘‘sometimes therapy’’ service under the
therapy code abstract file.
We received comments on this issue
from the American Physical Therapy
Association (APTA), as well as other
organizations expressing opposition to
our decision to bundle the new code.
Commenters stated that they believe
that our decision to bundle CPT code
95992 is flawed since physical
therapists are unable to bill E/M
services. The commenter also stated that
therapists would be precluded from
using another code for billing for this
service because CPT correct coding
instructions require that the provider/
supplier select the procedure that most
accurately defines the service provided.
Commenters also expressed concern
that this could impact beneficiary access
to this service.
Based upon the commenters’
feedback, we realized that we had failed
to address how therapists would bill for
the service since they cannot bill E/M
services. In order to address this
situation so that access to this service
would not be impacted, we included
language in a change request (CR) (the
quarterly update CR for April) and also
released a MedLearn article informing
PTs to continue using one of the more
generally defined ‘‘always therapy’’ CPT
codes (97112) as a temporary measure.
See https://www.cms.hhs.gov/
transmittals/downloads/R1691CP.pdf
and https://www.cms.hhs.gov/
MLNMattersArticles/downloads/
MM6397.pdf.
In response to the concerns raised and
upon additional review of this issue for
CY 2010, we are proposing to change
the status indicator from B (Bundled) to
I (Invalid). We propose that physicians
would continue to be paid for CRP as a
part of an E/M service. Physical
therapists would continue to use one of
the more generally defined ‘‘always
therapy’’ CPT codes (97112). We believe
that this will enable beneficiaries to
continue to receive this service while at
the same time it will address our
concerns about the potential for
duplicate billing for this service to the
extent that this service is paid as a part
of an E/M service. As a result of this
proposal, CPT code 95992 would be
removed as a ‘‘sometimes’’ therapy code
from the therapy code list.
2. Payment for an Initial Preventive
Physical Examination (IPPE)
Beginning January 1, 2010, we
propose to increase the payment for an
initial preventive physical examination
(IPPE) furnished face-to-face with the
patient and billed with HCPCS code
G0402, Initial preventive physical
examination; face-to-face visit, services
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33550
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
limited to new beneficiary during the
first 12 months of Medicare enrollment.
The IPPE service includes a broad array
of components and focuses on primary
care, health promotion, and disease
prevention.
Section 101(b) of the MIPPA changed
the IPPE benefit by adding to the IPPE
visit the measurement of an individual’s
body mass index and, upon an
individual’s consent, end-of-life
planning. Section 101(b) of the MIPPA
also removed the screening
electrocardiogram (EKG) as a mandatory
service of the IPPE.
In order to implement this MIPPA
provision, in the CY 2009 PFS final rule
with comment period (73 FR 69870), we
created HCPCS code G0402 as a new
HCPCS code and retained, on an interim
basis, the work RVUs of 1.34 assigned
to HCPCS code G0344, the code that
was previously used to bill for the IPPE.
While we did not believe the revisions
to the IPPE required by MIPPA
impacted the work RVUs associated
with this service, we solicited public
comments on this issue, as well as
suggested valuations of this service to
reflect resources involved in furnishing
the service.
We received comments from several
medical groups representing primary
care physicians and geriatricians, as
well as comments from the American
Medical Association concerning this
issue. The commenters stated that the
IPPE service was undervalued prior to
the addition of components by the
MIPPA. Commenters also stated that the
current level of work RVUs would
discourage delivery of appropriate endof-life planning with the beneficiary.
One commenter suggested the work
associated with HCPCS code G0402 for
the IPPE, as described in statute, is
captured in existing CPT code 99387,
Preventive Medicine Service, new
patient, Initial comprehensive
preventive medicine, 65 years and older.
(This code is not paid under the PFS.)
The work RVUs for this CPT code are
2.06.
Based on a review of the comments
and upon further evaluation of the
component services of the IPPE, we
believe the services, in the context of
work and intensity, contained in HCPCS
code G0402 are most equivalent to those
services contained in CPT code 99204,
Evaluation and management new
patient, office or other outpatient visit,
and propose increasing the work RVUs
for HCPCS code G0402 to 2.30 effective
for services furnished beginning on
January 1, 2010.
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
3. Audiology Codes: Policy Clarification
of Existing CPT Codes
In the CY 2009 PFS final rule with
comment period (73 FR 69890), we
noted that the RUC reviewed and
recommended work RVUs for 6
audiology codes with which we agreed
(that is, CPT codes 92620, 92621, 92625,
92626, 92627, and 92640). We also
noted that in the Medicare program,
audiology services are provided under
the diagnostic test benefit and that some
of the work descriptors for these
services include ‘‘counseling,’’
‘‘potential for remediation,’’ and
‘‘establishment of interventional goals.’’
We noted that we do not believe these
aspects fit within the diagnostic test
benefit, and therefore, we solicited
comment on this issue.
Since audiology services fall under
the diagnostic test benefit, aspects of
services that are therapeutic or
management activities are not payable
to audiologists. This distinction is of
particular importance since CPT codes
92620, 92621, 92626, 92627, and 92640
are ‘‘timed’’ codes, that is, these codes
are billed based on the actual time spent
furnishing the service. In response to
our request, the society that represents
speech language pathologists,
audiologists, and speech and language
scientists, provided the following
comments.
Comment: With respect to the term
‘‘counseling,’’ the commenter stated that
‘‘counseling’’ as used in the intraservice
work description for CPT code 92640,
Diagnostic analysis with programming
of auditory brainstem implant, per hour,
is used in the context of informational
rather than personal counseling. In this
instance the counseling provides
information and guidance to the patient
on what to expect relative to the service
(application of the electrical
stimulation). This counseling is an
integral part of the diagnostic procedure
and not a means of providing therapy or
active treatment.
Response: We appreciate the
comments related to counseling by the
specialty society, but are not persuaded
that counseling is an integral part of a
diagnostic test. Although we understand
that test results are sometimes conveyed
to the patient during or at the
conclusion of a diagnostic test,
counseling the patient about how to
compensate for a hearing loss is part of
a therapeutic service. As such,
therapeutic and/or management of
disease process counseling are not part
of the diagnostic test benefit and time
attributable to such activities is not
payable to audiologists under the
Medicare program.
PO 00000
Frm 00032
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
Comment: With respect to the term
‘‘potential for remediation,’’ which is
found as part of the intraservice work
descriptor for CPT code 92625,
Assessment of tinnitus (includes pitch,
loudness matching, and masking), the
commenter states that the procedure
evaluates the frequency and intensity
characteristics of the perceived tinnitus
in addition to measuring how the
tinnitus responds to a masking noise.
The response to masking noise is
diagnostic information that audiologists
and physicians refer to as the ‘‘potential
for remediation.’’ This assessment is
thus a part of a complete diagnostic
workup and is not a treatment or
therapeutic service.
Response: The intraservice work for
this service includes informing the
patient of the outcome of the evaluation
and the potential for remediation. As
noted above, although we understand
that test results are sometimes conveyed
to the patient during or at the
conclusion of a diagnostic test,
discussing therapeutic options and/or
providing therapy or management based
on test results are not part of a
diagnostic test. Discussing the potential
for remediation does not appear to be
part of a diagnostic test. While this
service can involve a small amount of
nondiagnostic work, CPT code 92625 is
not a timed code and the bulk of the
work described in the code appears to
be diagnostic in nature.
Comment: With respect to the term
‘‘establishment of interventional goals,’’
this phrase is found in the intraservice
work description of CPT code 92626,
Evaluation of auditory rehabilitation
status; first hour. The commenter states
that this procedure focuses on
diagnostic information relative to the
patient’s ability to use residual hearing
with a hearing aid, a cochlear implant,
or with no electronic device. The
intervention goals may take a variety of
forms, such as the following: Meeting
audiological criteria for cochlear
implantation; a recommendation to
continue use of hearing aids (that is, not
a cochlear implant candidate); and the
need to coordinate with a speechlanguage pathologist for auditory
training. This provides the physician
with a complete diagnostic evaluation of
the patient’s residual hearing status.
There is no element of therapy or
treatment associated with this service.
Response: Diagnostic testing usually
does not involve the establishment of
interventional goals. The test report
usually contains test findings and may
suggest additional tests. While we
appreciate the comments of the
specialty society, we are not persuaded
that establishing interventional goals is
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
part of a diagnostic test under Medicare.
The establishment of interventional
goals is clearly a function of therapeutic
management. As such, establishment of
goals is not part of the diagnostic test
benefit and time attributable to such
activity is not payable to an audiologist
under the Medicare program.
We appreciate the comments we
received on this issue. We want to
emphasize that therapeutic and/or
management activities associated with
these audiology tests are not payable to
audiologists because of the benefit
category under which these tests are
covered. We may also issue instructions
to contractors to monitor these services
to prevent inappropriate payments.
4. Consultation Services
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
a. Background
The current physician visit and
consultation codes were developed by
the American Medical Association
(AMA) Current Procedural Terminology
(CPT) Editorial Panel in November
1990. A consultation service is an
evaluation and management (E/M)
service furnished to evaluate and
possibly treat a patient’s problem(s). It
can involve an opinion, advice,
recommendation, suggestion, direction,
or counsel from a physician or qualified
NPP at the request of another physician
or appropriate source. (See the InternetOnly Medicare Claims Processing
Manual, Pub. 100–04, chapter 12,
§ 30.6.10A for more information.) A
consultation service must be
documented and a written report given
to the requesting professional.
Currently, consultation services are
predominantly billed by specialty
physicians. Primary care physicians
infrequently furnish these services.
The required documentation supports
the accuracy and medical necessity of a
consultation service that is requested
and provided. Medicare pays for a
consultation service when the request
and report are documented as a
consultation service, regardless of
whether treatment is initiated during
the consultation evaluation service. (See
the Internet-Only Medicare Claims
Processing Manual, Pub. 100–04,
chapter 12, § 30.6.10B.) A consultation
request between professionals may be
done orally by telephone, face-to-face,
or by written prescription brought from
one professional to another by the
patient. The request must be
documented in the medical record.
In the Physician Fee Schedule Final
Rule issued June 5, 1991, (56 FR 25828)
we stated that the agency’s goal for the
development of the new visit and
consultation codes was that they meet
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
two criteria: (1) They should be used
reliably and consistently by all
physicians and carriers; that is, the same
service should be coded the same way
by different physicians; and (2) they
should be defined in a way that enables
us to properly crosswalk the new codes
to the relative values for the Harvard
vignettes so valid RVUs for work are
assigned to the new codes.
Based on requests from the physician
community to clarify our consultation
payment policy and to provide
consultation examples, we convened an
internal workgroup of medical officers
within CMS (then called the Health Care
Financing Administration, or HCFA)
and revised the payment policy
instructions in August 1999 in the
Medicare Claims Processing Manual (at
§ 30.6.10 as cited above). We provided
examples of consultation services and
examples of clinical scenarios that did
not satisfy Medicare criteria for
consultation services. Without explicit
instructions for every possible clinical
scenario outlined in national policy
instructions or in AMA coding
definitions or coding instructions, the
local policy interpretations by Medicare
contractors were not universally
equivalent or acceptable to the
physician community and resulted in
denials in different localities. Some
Medicare contractors would consider a
consultation service with treatment to
be an initial visit rather than a
consultation thus resulting in a denial
for the billed consultation. We clarified
in the 1999 revision that Medicare
would pay for a consultation whether
treatment was initiated at the
consultation visit or not. The physician
community has stated that terms such as
referral, transfer and consultation, used
interchangeably by physicians in
clinical settings, confuse the actual
meaning of a consultation service and
that interpretation of these words varies
greatly among members of that
community as some label a transfer as
a referral and others label a consultation
as a referral. Although we clarified the
terms referral and consultation in the
1999 revision, there was disagreement
with our policy by physicians in the
health care community and by AMA
CPT staff. We provided our
documentation guidance so physicians
would be in compliance with our
payment policy. The consultation
definition in the AMA CPT simply
stated that the consultant’s opinion or
other information must be
communicated to the requesting
physician.
Additional manual revisions in both
January and September 2001 (at
§ 30.6.10 as cited above) clarified that
PO 00000
Frm 00033
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33551
NPPs can both request and furnish
consultation services within their scope
of practice and licensure requirements.
We continued to explain our
documentation requirements to the
physician community through our
Medicare contractors and in our
discussions with the AMA CPT staff.
Under our current policy and in the
AMA CPT definition, a consultation
service must have a request from
another physician or other professional
and be followed by a report to the
requesting professional. The AMA CPT
definition does not state the request
must be written in the requesting
physician’s medical record. However,
we require the request to be
documented in the requesting
physician’s plan of care in the medical
record as a condition for Medicare
payment. The E/M documentation
guidelines which apply to all E/M visits
or consultations (https://
www.cms.hhs.gov/MLNEdWebGuide/
25_EMDOC.asp) clearly state that when
referrals are made, consultations are
requested, or advice is sought, the
medical record should indicate to whom
and where the referral or consultation is
made or from whom the advice is
requested. Our Medicare contractors are
responsible for reviewing and paying
consultation claims when submitted.
When there is a question that triggers a
review of a consultation service, our
Medicare contractors will look at both
the requesting physician’s medical
record (where the request should be
noted) and the consultant’s medical
record where the consultation is
reported and at the report generated for
the requesting physician. Medicare
contractors do not look for evidence of
documentation on every claim, only
when there is a concern raised during
random sampling or during a specific
audit performed by a contractor. The
AMA CPT coding manual, which is not
a payment manual, does not specify
these requirements, and, therefore, as
we understand it, many physicians do
not agree with the CMS policy.
In March 2006, the Office of the
Inspector General (OIG) published a
report entitled, ‘‘Consultations in
Medicare: Coding and Reimbursement’’
(OEI–09–02–00030). The purpose of the
report was to assess whether Medicare’s
payments for consultation services were
appropriate. While the OIG study was
being conducted, we continued our
ongoing discussions with the AMA CPT
staff for potential changes to the
consultation definition and guidance in
CPT. The findings in the OIG report
(based on claims paid by Medicare in
2001) indicated that Medicare allowed
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33552
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
approximately $1.1 billion more in 2001
than it should have for services that
were billed as consultations.
Approximately 75 percent of services
paid as consultations did not meet all
applicable program requirements (per
the Medicare instructions) resulting in
improper payments. The majority of
these errors (47 percent of the claims
reviewed) were billed as the wrong type
or level of consultation. The second
most frequent error was for services that
did not meet the definition of a
consultation (19 percent of the claims
reviewed). The third category of
improperly paid claims was a lack of
appropriate documentation (9 percent of
the claims reviewed). The OIG
recommended that CMS, through our
Medicare contractors, should educate
physicians and other health care
practitioners about Medicare criteria
and proper billing for all types and
levels of consultations with emphasis
on the highest levels and follow-up
inpatient consultation services.
We agreed with the OIG findings that
additional education would help
physicians understand the differences
in the requirements for a consultation
service from those for other E/M
services. With each additional revision
from 1999 until the OIG study began, we
continually educated physicians
through the guidance provided by our
Medicare contractors. However, there
remained discrepancies with unclear
and ambiguous terms and instructions
in the AMA CPT consultation coding
definition, transfer of care and
documentation, and the feedback from
the physician community indicated they
disagreed with Medicare guidance.
Prior to the official publication of the
OIG report, we issued a Medlearn
Matters article, effective January 2006,
to educate the physician community
about requirements and proper billing
for all types and levels of consultation
services as requested by the OIG in their
report. The Medlearn Matters article
reflected the manual changes we made
in 2006 and the AMA CPT coding
changes as noted below.
Our consultation policy revisions
continued as a work-in-progress over
several years as disagreements were
raised by the physician community. We
continued to work with AMA CPT
coding staff in an attempt to have
improved guidance for consultation
services in the CPT coding definition. In
looking at physician claims data (for
example, the low usage of confirmatory
consultation services) and in response
to concerns from the physician
community regarding how to correctly
use the follow-up consultation codes,
the AMA CPT Editorial Panel chose to
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
delete some of the consultation codes
for 2006. The Follow-Up Inpatient
Consultation codes (CPT codes 99261
through 99263) and the Confirmatory
Consultation codes (CPT codes 99271
through 99275) were deleted. During
our ongoing discussions, the AMA CPT
staff, maintained that physicians did not
fully understand the use of these codes
and historically submitted them
inappropriately for payment as was
reflected in the OIG study.
We issued a manual revision in the
Medicare Claims Processing Manual (at
§ 30.6.10 as cited above) simultaneously
with the publication of AMA CPT 2006
coding changes removing the follow-up
consultation codes, and instructed
physicians to use the existing
subsequent hospital care code(s) and
subsequent nursing facility care codes
for visits following a consultation
service. The confirmatory consultation
codes (which were typically used for
second opinions) were also removed
and we instructed physicians to use the
existing E/M codes for a second opinion
service. We further clarified the
documentation requirements by making
it easier to document a request for a
consultation service from another
physician and to submit a consultation
report to the requesting professional.
Again, physicians stated that a
consultant has no control over what a
requesting or referring physician writes
in a medical record, and that they
should not be penalized for the behavior
of others. However, our consultation
policy instructions apply to all
physicians, whether they request a
consultation or furnish a consultation.
As noted above, documentation by both
the requesting physician and the
physician who furnishes the
consultation, is required under the E/M
documentation guidelines. The E/M
documentation guidelines have been in
use since 1995. In our discussions with
the AMA CPT staff and physician
groups, and national physician open
door conference calls, we have
emphasized that the requesting
physician medical record is not
reviewed unless there is a specific audit
or random sampling performed. The
physician furnishing the consultation
service should document in the medical
record from whom a request is received.
We continue to hear from the AMA
and from specific national physician
specialty representatives that physicians
are dissatisfied with Medicare
documentation requirements and
guidance that distinguish a consultation
service from other E/M services such as
transfer of care. CPT has not clarified
transfer of care. Therefore, many
physician groups disagree with our
PO 00000
Frm 00034
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
requirements for documentation of
transfer of care. Interpretation differs
from one physician to another as to
whether transfer of care should be
reported as an initial E/M service or as
a consultation service.
Despite our efforts, the physician
community disagrees with Medicare
interpretation and guidance for
documentation of transfer of care and
consultation. The existing consultation
coding definition in the AMA CPT
definition remains ambiguous and
confusing for certain clinical scenarios
and without a clear definition of transfer
of care. The CPT consultation codes are
used by physicians and qualified NPPs
to identify their services for Medicare
payment. There is an absence of any
guidance in the AMA CPT consultation
coding definition that distinguishes a
transfer of care service (when a new
patient visit is billed) from a
consultation service (when a
consultation service is billed). Medicare
does provide guidance although there is
disagreement with our policy from
AMA CPT staff and some members of
the physician community. Because of
the disparity between AMA coding
guidance and Medicare policy some
physicians state they have difficulty in
choosing the appropriate code to bill.
The payment for both inpatient
consultation and office/outpatient
consultation services is higher than for
initial hospital care and new patient
office/outpatient visits. However, the
associated physician work is clinically
similar. Many physicians contend that
there is more work involved with a new
patient visit than a consultation service
because of the post work involvement
with a new patient. The payment for a
consultation service has been set higher
than for initial visits because a written
report must be made to the requesting
professional. However, all medically
necessary Medicare services require
documentation in some form in a
patient’s medical record. Over the past
several years, some physicians have
asked CMS to recognize the provision of
the consultation report via a different
form of communication in lieu of a
written letter report to the requesting
physician so as to lessen any paperwork
burden on physicians. We have eased
the consultation reporting requirements
by lessening the required level of
formality and permitting the report to be
made in any written form of
communication, (including submission
of a copy of the evaluation examination
taken directly from the medical record
and submitted without a letter format)
as long as the identity of the physician
who furnished the consultation is
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
evident. Although preparation and
submission of the consultant’s report is
no longer the major defining aspect of
consultation services, the higher
payment has remained. (See the
Internet-Only Medicare Claims
Processing Manual, Pub. 100–04,
chapter 12, § 30.6.10 F.)
Both AMA CPT coding rules and
Medicare Part B payment policy have
always required that there is only one
admitting physician of record for a
particular patient in the hospital or
nursing facility setting. (AMA CPT
2009, Hospital Inpatient Services, Initial
Hospital Care, p.12) This physician has
been the only one permitted to bill the
initial hospital care codes or initial
nursing facility codes. All other
physicians must bill either the
subsequent hospital care codes,
subsequent nursing facility care codes
or consultation codes. (See the InternetOnly Medicare Claims Processing
Manual, Pub. 100–04, chapter 12,
§ 30.6.9.1 G.)
Beginning January 1, 2008, we ceased
to recognize office/outpatient
consultation CPT codes for payment of
hospital outpatient visits (72 FR 66790
through 66795). Instead, we instructed
hospitals to bill a new or established
patient visit CPT code, as appropriate to
the particular patient, for all hospital
outpatient visits. Regardless of all of our
efforts to educate physicians on
Medicare guidance for documentation,
transfer of care, and consultation policy,
disagreement in the physician
community prevails.
b. Proposal
Beginning January 1, 2010, we
propose to budget neutrally eliminate
the use of all consultation codes
(inpatient and office/outpatient codes
for various places of service except for
telehealth consultation G-codes) by
increasing the work RVUs for new and
established office visits, increasing the
work RVUs for initial hospital and
initial nursing facility visits, and
incorporating the increased use of these
visits into our PE and malpractice RVU
calculations.
We note that section 1834(m) of the
Act includes ‘‘professional
consultations’’ (including the initial
inpatient consultation codes ‘‘as
subsequently modified by the
Secretary’’) in the definition of
telehealth services. We recognize that
consultations furnished via telehealth
can facilitate the provision of certain
services and/or medical expertise that
might not otherwise be available to a
patient located at an originating site.
Therefore, for CY 2010, if we finalize
our proposed policy to eliminate
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
consultations from the PFS, then we
propose to create HCPCS codes specific
to the telehealth delivery of initial
inpatient consultations. The purpose of
these codes would be solely to preserve
the ability for practitioners to provide
and bill for initial inpatient
consultations delivered via telehealth.
These codes are intended for use by
practitioners when furnishing services
that meet Medicare requirements
relating to coverage and payment for
telehealth services. Practitioners would
use these codes to submit claims to their
Medicare contractors for payment of
initial inpatient consultations provided
via telehealth. The new HCPCS codes
would be limited to the range of services
included in the scope of the CPT codes
for initial inpatient consultations, and
the descriptions would be modified to
limit the use of such services for
telehealth. The HCPCS codes would
clearly designate these as initial
inpatient consultations provided via
telehealth, and not initial hospital care
or initial nursing facility care used for
inpatient visits. Utilization of these
codes would allow us to provide
payment for these services, as well as
enable us to monitor whether the codes
are used appropriately.
If we create HCPCS G-codes specific
to the telehealth delivery of initial
inpatient consultations, then we also
propose to crosswalk the RVUs for these
services from the RVUs for initial
hospital care (as described by CPT codes
99221 through 99223). We believe this
is appropriate because a physician or
practitioner furnishing a telehealth
service is paid an amount equal to the
amount that would have been paid if the
service had been furnished without the
use of a telecommunication system.
Since physicians and practitioners
furnishing initial inpatient
consultations in a face-to-face encounter
to hospital inpatients must continue to
utilize initial hospital care codes (as
described by CPT codes 99221 through
99223), we believe it is appropriate to
set the RVUs for the proposed inpatient
telehealth consultation G-codes at the
same level as for the initial hospital care
codes.
We considered creating separate Gcodes to enable practitioners to bill
initial inpatient telehealth consultations
when furnished to residents of SNFs
and crosswalking the RVUs to initial
nursing facility care (as described by
CPT codes 99304 through 99306). For
the sake of administrative simplicity, if
we create HCPCS G-codes specific to the
telehealth delivery of initial inpatient
consultations, they will be defined in
§ 410.78 and in our manuals as
appropriate for use to deliver care to
PO 00000
Frm 00035
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33553
beneficiaries in hospitals or skilled
nursing facilities. If we adopt this
proposal, then we will make
corresponding changes to our
regulations at § 410.78 and § 414.65. In
addition, we will add the definition of
these codes to the CMS Internet-Only
Medicare Benefit Policy Manual, Pub.
100–02, Chapter 15, Section 270 and the
Medicare Claims Processing Manual,
Pub. 100–04, Chapter 12, Section 190.
Outside the context of telehealth
services, physicians will bill an initial
hospital care or initial nursing facility
care code for their first visit during a
patient’s admission to the hospital or
nursing facility in lieu of the
consultation codes these physicians
may have previously reported. The
initial visit in a skilled nursing facility
and nursing facility must be furnished
by a physician except as otherwise
permitted as specified in § 483.40(c)(4).
In the nursing facility setting, an NPP
who is enrolled in the Medicare
program, and who is not employed by
the facility, may perform the initial visit
when the State law permits this. (See
this exception in the Internet-Only
Medicare Claims Processing Manual,
Pub. 100–04, chapter 12, § 30.6.13A).
An NPP, who is enrolled in the
Medicare program is permitted to report
the initial hospital care visit or new
patient office visit, as appropriate,
under current Medicare policy. Because
of an existing CPT coding rule and
current Medicare payment policy
regarding the admitting physician, we
will create a modifier to identify the
admitting physician of record for
hospital inpatient and nursing facility
admissions. For operational purposes,
this modifier will distinguish the
admitting physician of record who
oversees the patient’s care from other
physicians who may be furnishing
specialty care. The admitting physician
of record will be required to append the
specific modifier to the initial hospital
care or initial nursing facility care code
which will identify him or her as the
admitting physician of record who is
overseeing the patient’s care.
Subsequent care visits by all physicians
and qualified NPPs will be reported as
subsequent hospital care codes and
subsequent nursing facility care codes.
We believe the rationale for a
differential payment for a consultation
service is no longer supported because
documentation requirements are now
similar across all E/M services. To be
consistent with OPPS policy, as noted
above, we will pay only new and
established office or other clinic visits
under the PFS.
This proposed change would be
implemented in a budget neutral
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33554
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
manner, meaning it would not increase
or decrease PFS expenditures. We
would make this change budget neutral
for the work RVUs by increasing the
work RVUs for new and established
office visits by approximately 6 percent
to reflect the elimination of the office
consultation codes and the work RVUs
for initial hospital and facility visits by
approximately 2 percent to reflect the
elimination of the facility consultation
codes. We have crosswalked the
utilization for the office consultation
codes into the office visits and the
utilization of the hospital and facility
consultation codes into the initial
hospital and facility visits. This change
would be made budget neutral in the PE
and malpractice RVU methodologies
through the use of the new work RVUs
and the crosswalked utilization. The PE
and malpractice RVU methodologies are
described elsewhere in this proposed
rule.
We are soliciting comments on the
proposal, described more fully above, to
eliminate payment for all consultation
services codes under the PFS and to
allow all physicians to bill, in lieu of a
consultation service code, an initial
hospital care visit or initial nursing
facility care visit for their first visit
during a patient’s admission to the
hospital or nursing facility.
Additionally, we are soliciting
comments on the proposal to create
HCPCS G-codes to identify the
telehealth delivery of initial inpatient
consultations.
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
F. Potentially Misvalued Services Under
the Physician Fee Schedule
1. Valuing Services Under the Physician
Fee Schedule
The American Medical Association’s
(AMA) Relative Value System Update
Committee (RUC) provides
recommendations to CMS for the
valuation of new and revised codes, as
well as codes identified as misvalued.
On an ongoing basis, the AMA RUC’s
Practice Expense (PE) Subcommittee
reviews direct PE (clinical staff, medical
supplies, medical equipment) for
individual services and examines the
many broad and methodological issues
relating to the development of PE
relative value units (RVUs).
To address concerns expressed by
stakeholders with regard to the process
we use to price services paid under the
PFS, the AMA RUC created the FiveYear Review Identification Workgroup.
As we stated in the CY 2009 PFS
proposed rule (73 FR 38582), the
workgroup identified some potentially
misvalued codes through several
vehicles, namely, identifying codes with
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
site of service anomalies, high intraservice work per unit time (IWPUT),
and services with high volume growth.
The IWPUT is derived from components
of the ‘‘building-block’’ approach, as
described in the CY 2007 PFS proposed
rule (71 FR 37172), and is used as a
measure of service intensity. There were
204 services identified as misvalued last
year and we plan to continue working
with the AMA RUC to identify
additional codes that are potentially
misvalued. In the CY 2009 PFS
proposed rule (73 FR 38586), we also
listed approaches for the AMA RUC to
utilize, namely, the review of the fastest
growing procedure codes, review of
Harvard-valued codes, and review of PE
RVUs.
We plan to address the AMA RUC’s
recommendations from the February
and April 2009 meetings for codes with
site of service anomalies in the CY 2010
PFS final rule with comment period in
a manner consistent with the way we
address other AMA RUC
recommendations. Specifically, we
complete our own review of the AMA
RUC recommendations; and then in the
PFS final rule with comment period, we
describe the AMA RUC’s
recommendations, indicate whether or
not we accept them, and provide a
rationale for our decision. The values
for these services will be published as
interim values for the next calendar
year.
We believe that there are additional
steps we can take to help address the
issue of potentially misvalued services.
In the CY 2009 PFS proposed rule, we
identified approaches to address this
issue including reviewing services often
billed together and the possibility of
expanding the multiple procedure
payment reduction (MPPR) to additional
nonsurgical procedures and the update
of high cost supplies.
2. High Cost Supplies
In the CY 2009 PFS proposed rule (73
FR 38582), we proposed a process to
update the prices associated with high
cost supplies over $150 every 2 years.
We explained that we would need the
cooperation of the medical community
in obtaining typical prices in the
marketplace. We also outlined examples
of acceptable documentation. Although
we received many thoughtful comments
on the proposed process for updating
high-cost supplies, as stated in the CY
2009 PFS final rule with comment
period (73 FR 69882), we are continuing
to examine alternatives on the best way
to obtain accurate pricing information
and will propose a revised process in
future rulemaking.
PO 00000
Frm 00036
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
3. Review of Services Often Billed
Together and the Possibility of
Expanding the Multiple Procedure
Payment Reduction (MPPR) to
Additional Nonsurgical Procedures
In the CY 2009 PFS final rule with
comment period (73 FR 69882), we
stated that we plan to perform a data
analysis of nonsurgical CPT codes that
are often billed together. This would
identify whether there are inequities in
PFS payments that are a result of
variations between services in the
comprehensiveness of the codes used to
report the services, or in the payment
policies applied to each (for example,
global surgery and MPPRs). The
rationale for the MPPR is that certain
clinical labor activities, supplies, and
equipment are not performed or
furnished twice when multiple
procedures are performed. We stated
that we would consider developing a
proposal either to bundle additional
services or expand application of the
MPPR to additional procedures.
Several specialty groups noted that
the AMA RUC has already taken action
to identify frequently occurring code
pairs. The commenters support the
AMA RUC’s recommendation that CMS
analyze data to identify nonsurgical CPT
codes that are billed together 90 to 95
percent of the time. Additionally, the
Medicare Payment Advisory Committee
(MedPAC) requested that we consider
duplicative physician work, as well as
PE, in any expansion of the MPPR.
We plan to analyze codes furnished
together more than 75 percent of the
time, excluding E/M codes. We will
analyze both physician work and PE
inputs. If duplications are found, we
will consider whether an MPPR or
bundling of services is most
appropriate. Any proposed changes will
be made through rulemaking and be
subject to public comment at a later
date.
4. AMA RUC Review of Potentially
Misvalued Codes
a. Site of Service Anomalies
The AMA RUC created the Five-Year
Review Identification Workgroup to
respond to concerns expressed by the
MedPAC, the Congress, and other
stakeholders regarding accurate pricing
under the PFS. The workgroup
identified potentially misvalued codes
through several vehicles. For example,
the workgroup focused on codes for
which there have been shifts in the site
of service (site of service anomalies),
codes with a high intra-service work per
unit of time (IWPUT), and codes that
were high volume. There were 204
potentially misvalued services
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33555
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
identified in 2008 (see the CY 2009 PFS
final rule with comment period (73 FR
69883)). These codes were reviewed by
the AMA RUC and recommendations
were submitted to CMS in 2008.
In the CY 2009 PFS final rule with
comment period (73 FR 69883), we
noted that although we would accept
the AMA RUC valuation for these site of
service anomaly codes for 2009, we
recognized that many of them included
deletion or modification of certain
inputs such as hospital days, office
visits, service times, and discharge day
management services in the global
period. We also indicated that we had
concerns about the methodology used
by the AMA RUC to review these
services which may have resulted in
removal of hospital days and deletion or
reallocation of office visits without
extraction of the associated RVUs from
the valuation of the code. However, we
stated that we believed the AMA RUCrecommended valuations were still a
better representation of the resources
used to furnish these services than the
current ones. We also stated that we
would continue to examine these codes
and would consider whether it would
be appropriate to propose additional
changes in future rulemaking.
After further review of these codes,
we believe it would be appropriate to
propose further changes to several of the
codes where the valuation has been
adjusted to reflect changes in the site of
service. Specifically, we are proposing
changes to codes for which the AMA
RUC review process deleted or
reallocated pre-service and post service
times, hospital days, office visits, and
discharge day management services
without the extraction of the associated
RVUs.
We believe the AMA RUCrecommended values do not reflect the
extraction of the RVUs associated with
deleted or reallocated pre-service and
post-service times, hospital days, office
visits, and discharge day management
services. Therefore, we have
recalculated the work RVUs based upon
the AMA RUC-recommended inputs
(that is, changes in pre-service and postservice times and associated E/M
services). The proposed work RVUs for
each CPT code shown in Table 8 were
recalculated using the pre-AMA RUC
review work RVUs as a starting point,
and adjusting them for the addition or
extraction of pre-service and postservice times, inpatient hospital days,
discharge day management services and
outpatient visits as recommended by the
AMA RUC. We used the following
methodology:
1. For each CPT code noted in Table
8, we separated out each component
(that is, pre-service time, intra-service
time, post-service time, inpatient
hospital day, discharge day management
services, and outpatient visits) that
comprised the entire work RVUs for the
service.
2. We calculated the incremental
difference between the pre-service and
post-service time from before and after
the AMA RUC review, and multiplied
that difference by an IWPUT intensity
factor of 0.0224, which is a constant in
the IWPUT equation. For example, if the
pre-service time prior to the AMA RUC
review was 75 minutes and, following
its review, the AMA RUC recommended
an increase in pre-service time to 85
minutes, we multiplied the difference
(10 minutes) by 0.0224 to determine the
RVUs associated with the increase in
pre-service time, and then added that
number of RVUs to the pre-AMA RUC
evaluation work RVU.
3. We then added or removed the
work RVUs associated with the
extraction or reallocation of each
inpatient hospital day, outpatient visit
or discharge day management service as
appropriate. For example, assume that
prior to the AMA RUC review a code
was assigned:
• 1 inpatient hospital day (currently
billed using CPT code 99231 and
assigned 0.76 work RVUs);
• 1 discharge day management
service (currently billed using CPT code
99238 and assigned 1.28 work RVUs);
and
• 2 outpatient visits (currently billed
using 99212 and assigned 0.45 work
RVUs).
After the AMA RUC review, the
inpatient hospital day and discharge
day management service were removed.
To account for the removal of these
services, we would have subtracted 0.76
work RVUs (represents the removal of
the work RVUs for 1 inpatient hospital
day) and 1.28 work RVUs (represents
the removal of the work RVUs for 1
discharge day management service)
from the pre-AMA RUC review work
RVUs in order to develop the CMS
proposed work RVUs.
The methodology discussed above
was used for each code noted in Table
8 and reflects the extraction of the RVUs
associated with deleted or reallocated
hospital days, office visits, discharge
day management services, and preservice and post-service times based
upon the AMA RUC recommendations.
TABLE 8: CY 2010 CMS PROPOSED WORK RVUS
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
CPT code 1
21025
23415
25116
42440
52341
52342
52343
52344
52345
52346
52400
52500
52640
53445
54410
54530
57287
62263
62350
...........
...........
...........
...........
...........
...........
...........
...........
...........
...........
...........
...........
...........
...........
...........
...........
...........
...........
...........
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Pre-AMA RUC
eval. work
RVU
Descriptor
Excision of bone, lower jaw ...............................................................................
Release of shoulder ligament ............................................................................
Remove wrist/forearm lesion .............................................................................
Excise submaxillary gland .................................................................................
Cysto w/ureter stricture tx ..................................................................................
Cysto w/up stricture tx .......................................................................................
Cysto w/renal stricture tx ...................................................................................
Cysto/uretero, stricture tx ..................................................................................
Cysto/uretero w/up stricture ...............................................................................
Cystouretero w/renal strict .................................................................................
Cystouretero w/congen repr ..............................................................................
Revision of bladder neck ...................................................................................
Relieve bladder contracture ...............................................................................
Insert uro/ves nck sphincter ..............................................................................
Remove/replace penis prosth ............................................................................
Removal of testis ...............................................................................................
Revise/remove sling repair ................................................................................
Epidural lysis mult sessions ..............................................................................
Implant spinal canal cath ...................................................................................
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00037
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
11.07
10.09
7.38
7.05
6.11
6.61
7.31
7.81
8.31
9.34
10.06
9.39
6.89
15.21
16.48
9.31
11.49
6.41
8.04
13JYP2
2009 AMA
RUC recommended
work RVU
9.87
9.07
7.38
7.05
5.35
5.85
6.55
7.05
7.55
8.58
8.66
7.99
4.73
15.21
15.00
8.35
10.97
6.41
6.00
2010 CMS
proposed work
RVU
7.23
10.64
4.83
6.88
5.20
5.63
6.55
6.83
8.51
9.02
8.25
8.49
4.28
17.02
16.01
8.65
10.36
6.04
1.29
33556
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
TABLE 8: CY 2010 CMS PROPOSED WORK RVUS—Continued
CPT code 1
63650
63685
64708
64831
65285
1 All
...........
...........
...........
...........
...........
Implant neuroelectrodes ....................................................................................
Insrt/redo spine n generator ..............................................................................
Revise arm/leg nerve .........................................................................................
Repair of digit nerve ..........................................................................................
Repair of eye wound .........................................................................................
7.57
7.87
6.22
10.23
14.43
2009 AMA
RUC recommended
work RVU
7.15
6.00
6.22
9.00
14.43
2010 CMS
proposed work
RVU
4.18
4.27
7.36
9.74
14.43
CPT codes copyright 2008 American Medical Association.
Using the methodology described
above, the adjustments to work RVUs
for CPT codes 62355, 62360, 62361,
62362, and 62365 would result in
negative valuation: 62355 = ¥1.96;
62360 = ¥2.31; 62361 = ¥2.42; 62362
= ¥2.46; and 62365 = ¥1.88. For these
codes, we are requesting that the AMA
RUC re-review the entire family of
associated codes and in the interim will
maintain the AMA RUC recommended
values until a methodology is developed
to address codes that result in negative
valuation when the methodology
described above is utilized.
In addition to the proposed revisions
to the AMA RUC-recommended RVUs
described above, we encourage the
AMA RUC to utilize the building block
methodology as described in the CY
2007 PFS proposed rule (71 FR 37172)
in the future when revaluing codes with
site of service anomalies. We recognize
that the AMA RUC looks at families of
codes and may assign RVUs based on a
particular code ranking within the
family. However, the relative value scale
requires each service to be valued based
on the resources used in furnishing the
service.
We are also seeking public comment
on alternative methodologies that could
be utilized to establish work RVUs for
codes that would have a negative
valuation under the methodology we
used for the proposed revisions to the
AMA RUC-recommended values
described above.
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Pre-AMA RUC
eval. work
RVU
Descriptor
b. ‘‘23-Hour’’ Stay
For services that are performed in the
outpatient setting and require a hospital
stay of less than 24 hours, we consider
this an outpatient service and recognize
the additional time associated with the
patient evaluation and assessment in the
post-service period. We are requesting
that the AMA RUC include the
additional minutes in their
recommendations to CMS. We do not
believe the current minutes assigned in
the post-service period accurately
reflects the total time required for
evaluation and assessment of the
patient. We believe the use of E/M codes
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
5. Establishing Appropriate Relative
Values for Physician Fee Schedule
Services
In MedPAC’s March 2006 Report to
Congress, MedPAC made a number of
recommendations to improve the review
of the relative values for PFS services.
Since that time, we have taken
significant action to improve the
accuracy of the RVUs. As MedPAC
noted in its recent March 2009 Report
to Congress, ‘‘CMS and the AMA RUC
have taken several steps to improve the
review process’’ in the intervening years
since those initial recommendations.
Many of our efforts to improve the
accuracy of RVUs have also resulted in
substantial increases in the payments
for primary care services, which was
one of the motivations for MedPAC’s
recommendations.
• We completed the most recent FiveYear Review of work RVUs, resulting in
an increase in over 25 percent to the
work RVUs for primary care services.
• We significantly revised the
methodology for determining PE RVUs,
resulting in more than a 5 percent
increase for primary care services.
• We improved our processes for
identifying potentially misvalued
services by engaging in an ongoing
review that includes screens for rapidly
growing services and services with
substantial shifts in site of service. We
also identified approaches to address
the issue of potentially misvalued
services including reviewing services
often billed together and the possibility
of expanding the multiple procedure
payment reduction (MPPR) to additional
nonsurgical procedures and the update
of high cost supplies.
• As discussed elsewhere in this
proposed rule, we are proposing a
number of improvements to the
calculation and establishment of the
work, PE, and malpractice RVUs that
would result in overall payment
increases to primary care specialties of
between 6 percent and 8 percent in CY
2010. These changes include a 6 percent
increase in the work RVUs for office
visits as a result of our proposal
regarding consultation services; our
proposed use of more accurate
specialty-specific survey data on
physician practice costs; our proposal to
revise the utilization rate assumption for
certain equipment; and our proposed
use of updated and expanded
malpractice premium data in the
calculation of the malpractice RVUs.
MedPAC has in the past also
recommended the establishment of a
group panel of experts separate from the
AMA RUC to review RVUs. This
original March 2006 recommendation
was summarized in its March 2008
Report to Congress:
‘‘We also recommended that CMS establish
a group of experts, separate from the AMA
RUC, to help the agency conduct these and
other activities. This recommendation was
intended not to supplant the AMA RUC but
to augment it. To that end, the panel should
include members who do not directly benefit
from changes to Medicare’s payment rates,
such as experts in medical economics and
technology diffusion and physicians who are
employed by managed care organizations and
academic medical centers.’’
for services rendered in the post-service
period for procedures requiring less
than a 24-hour hospital stay would
result in overpayment for pre-service
and intraservice work that would not be
provided. Therefore, we will not allow
an additional E/M service to be billed
for care furnished during the post
procedure period when care is
furnished for an outpatient service
requiring less than a 24-hour hospital
stay.
PO 00000
Frm 00038
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
The idea of a group of experts
separate from the AMA RUC, to help the
agency improve the review of relative
values raises a number of issues. We
seek broad public input on the
following questions and other aspects of
such an approach:
• How could input from a group of
experts best be incorporated into
existing processes of rulemaking and
agency receipt of AMA RUC
recommendations?
• What specifically would be the
roles of a group of experts (for example,
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33557
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
identify potentially misvalued services,
provide recommendations on valuation
of specified services, review AMA RUC
recommendations selected by the
Secretary, etc.)?
• What should be the composition of
a group of experts? How could such a
group provide expertise on services that
clinician group members do not
furnish?
• How would such a group relate to
the AMA RUC and existing Secretarial
advisory panels such as the Practicing
Physician Advisory Committee?
Also of interest are comments on the
resources required to establish and
maintain such a group. As MedPAC
noted in its March 2006 Report with
respect to the group of experts ‘‘we
recognize that these recommendations
will increase demands on CMS and urge
the Congress to provide the agency with
the financial resources and
administrative flexibility needed to
undertake them.’’
We welcome comments on these
topics, as well as others of interest to the
stakeholder community. We will
consider these comments as we consider
the establishment of a group of experts
to assist us in our ongoing reviews of
the PFS RVUs.
G. Issues Related to the Medicare
Improvements for Patients and
Providers Act of 2008 (MIPPA)
This section addresses certain
provisions of the Medicare
Improvements for Patients and
Providers Act of 2008 (MIPPA) (Pub. L.
110–275). We are proposing to revise
our policies and regulations as
described below in order to conform
them to the statutory amendments.
1. Section 102: Elimination of
Discriminatory Copayment Rates for
Medicare Outpatient Psychiatric
Services
Prior to the enactment of the MIPPA,
section 1833(c) of the Act provided that
for expenses incurred in any calendar
year in connection with the treatment of
mental, psychoneurotic, and personality
disorders of an individual who is not an
inpatient of a hospital, only 621⁄2
percent of such expenses are considered
to be incurred under Medicare Part B
when determining the amount of
payment and application of the Part B
deductible in any calendar year. This
provision is known as the outpatient
mental health treatment limitation (the
limitation), and has resulted in
Medicare paying only 50 percent of the
approved amount for outpatient mental
health treatment, rather than the 80
percent that is paid for most other
outpatient services.
Section 102 of the MIPPA amends the
statute to phase out the limitation on
recognition of expenses incurred for
outpatient mental health treatment,
which will result in an increase in the
Medicare Part B payment for outpatient
mental health services to 80 percent by
CY 2014. When this section is fully
implemented in 2014, Medicare will
pay for outpatient mental health
services at the same level as other Part
B services. For CY 2010, section 102 of
the MIPPA provides that Medicare will
recognize 683⁄4 percent of expenses
incurred for outpatient mental health
treatment, which translates to a
payment of 55 percent of the Medicareapproved amount. Section 102 of the
MIPPA specifies that the phase out of
the limitation will be implemented as
shown in Table 9 (provided that the
patient has satisfied his or her
deductible).
TABLE 9—IMPLEMENTATION OF SECTION 102 OF THE MIPPA
Recognized
incurred
expenses
(in percent)
Calendar year
CY
CY
CY
CY
CY
2009
2010
2012
2013
2014
and prior calendar years ..............................................................................................
and CY 2011 ................................................................................................................
.......................................................................................................................................
.......................................................................................................................................
.......................................................................................................................................
At present, § 410.155(c) of the
regulations includes examples to
illustrate application of the current
limitation. We are proposing to remove
these examples from our regulations
and, instead, to provide examples in
this proposed rule, in our manual, and
under provider education materials as
needed. The following examples
illustrate the application of the
limitation in various circumstances as it
is gradually reduced under section 102
of the MIPPA. We note that although we
have used the CY 2009 Part B
deductible of $135 for purposes of the
examples below, the actual deductible
amount for CY 2010 and future years
will be subject to change.
Example #1: In 2010, a clinical
psychologist submits a claim for $200 for
62.50
68.75
75.00
81.25
100.00
Patient pays
(in percent)
50
45
40
35
20
Medicare pays
(in percent)
50
55
60
65
80
outpatient treatment of a patient’s mental
disorder. The Medicare-approved amount is
$180. Since clinical psychologists must
accept assignment, the patient is not liable
for the $20 in excess charges. The patient
previously satisfied the $135 annual Part B
deductible. The limitation reduces the
amount of incurred expenses to 683⁄4 percent
of the approved amount. Medicare pays 80
percent of the remaining incurred expenses.
The Medicare payment and patient liability
are computed as shown in Table 10.
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
TABLE 10—EXAMPLE #1—CY 2010
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Actual charges .................................................................................................................................................................................
Medicare-approved amount .............................................................................................................................................................
Medicare incurred expenses (0.6875 × line 2) * .............................................................................................................................
Unmet deductible .............................................................................................................................................................................
Remainder after subtracting deductible (line 3 minus line 4) .........................................................................................................
Medicare payment (0.80 × line 5) ...................................................................................................................................................
Patient liability (line 2 minus line 6) ................................................................................................................................................
* The recognized incurred expenses for 2010 are 683⁄4 percent.
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00039
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
$200.00
180.00
123.75
0.00
123.75
99.00
81.00
33558
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
Example #2: In 2012, a clinical social
worker submits a claim for $135 for
outpatient treatment of a patient’s mental
disorder. The Medicare-approved amount is
$120. Since clinical social workers must
accept assignment, the patient is not liable
for the $15 in excess charges. The limitation
reduces the amount of incurred expenses to
75 percent of the approved amount. The
patient previously satisfied $70 of the $135
annual Part B deductible, leaving $65 unmet
(see Table 11).
TABLE 11—EXAMPLE #2—CY 2012
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Actual charges .................................................................................................................................................................................
Medicare-approved amount .............................................................................................................................................................
Medicare incurred expenses (0.75 × line 2) * .................................................................................................................................
Unmet deductible .............................................................................................................................................................................
Remainder after subtracting deductible (line 3 minus line 4) .........................................................................................................
Medicare payment (0.80 × line 5) ...................................................................................................................................................
Patient liability (line 2 minus line 6) ................................................................................................................................................
$135.00
120.00
90.00
65.00
25.00
20.00
100.00
* The recognized incurred expenses for CY 2012 are 75 percent.
Example #3: In CY 2013, a physician who
does not accept assignment submits a claim
for $780 for services in connection with the
treatment of a mental disorder that did not
require inpatient hospitalization. The
Medicare-approved amount is $750. Because
the physician does not accept assignment,
the patient is liable for the $30 in excess
charges. The patient has not satisfied any of
the $135 Part B annual deductible (see Table
12).
TABLE 12—EXAMPLE #3—CY 2013
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Actual charges .................................................................................................................................................................................
Medicare-approved amount .............................................................................................................................................................
Medicare incurred expenses (0.8125 × line 2) * .............................................................................................................................
Unmet deductible .............................................................................................................................................................................
Remainder after subtracting deductible (line 3 minus line 4) .........................................................................................................
Medicare payment (0.80 × line 5) ...................................................................................................................................................
Patient liability (line 1 minus line 6) ................................................................................................................................................
$780.00
750.00
609.38
135.00
474.38
379.50
400.50
* The recognized incurred expenses for CY 2013 are 811⁄4 percent.
Example #4: A patient’s Part B expenses
during CY 2014 are for a physician’s services
in connection with the treatment of a mental
disorder that initially required inpatient
hospitalization, with subsequent physician
services furnished on an outpatient basis.
The patient has not satisfied any of the $135
Part B deductible. The physician accepts
assignment and submits a claim for $780.
The Medicare-approved amount is $750.
Since the limitation will be completely
phased out as of January 1, 2014, the entire
$750 Medicare-approved amount is
recognized as the total incurred expenses
because such expenses are no longer
reduced. Also, there is no longer any
distinction between mental health services
the patient receives as an inpatient or
outpatient (see Table 13).
TABLE 13—EXAMPLE #4—CY 2014
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Actual charges .................................................................................................................................................................................
Medicare-approved amount .............................................................................................................................................................
Medicare incurred expenses (1.00 × line 2) * .................................................................................................................................
Unmet deductible .............................................................................................................................................................................
Remainder after subtracting deductible (line 3 minus line 4) .........................................................................................................
Medicare payment (0.80 × line 5) ...................................................................................................................................................
Beneficiary liability (line 2 minus line 6) ..........................................................................................................................................
$780.00
750.00
750.00
135.00
615.00
492.00
258.00
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
* The recognized incurred expenses for CY 2014 are 100 percent.
Section 102 of the MIPPA did not
make any other changes to the
outpatient mental health treatment
limitation. Therefore, other aspects of
the limitation will remain unchanged
during the transition period between
CYs 2010 and 2014. The limitation will
continue to be applied as it has been in
accordance with our regulation at
§ 410.155(b) which specifies that the
limitation applies to outpatient
treatment of a mental, psychoneurotic,
or personality disorder, identified under
the International Classification of
Diseases (ICD) diagnosis code range
290–319. We use the place of service
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
code, and the procedure code to identify
services to which the limitation applies.
Additionally, we are proposing to
make technical corrections to
§ 410.155(b)(2) in order to update and
clarify the services to which the
limitation does not apply. Our proposed
technical changes are as follows:
• Under § 410.155(b)(2)(ii), revise the
regulation to specify the HCPCS code,
M0064 (or any successor code), that
represents the statutory exception to the
limitation for brief office visits for the
sole purpose of monitoring or changing
drug prescriptions used in mental
health treatment.
PO 00000
Frm 00040
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
• At § 410.155(b)(2)(iv), we are
proposing to revise the regulation to add
neuropsychological tests and diagnostic
psychological tests to the examples of
diagnostic services that are not subject
to the limitation when performed to
establish a diagnosis.
• Under § 410.155(b)(2)(v), we are
proposing to revise the regulation to
specify the CPT code 90862 (or any
successor code) that represents
pharmacologic management services to
which the limitation does not apply
when furnished to treat a patient who is
diagnosed with Alzheimer’s disease or a
related disorder.
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
Finally, we are proposing to add a
new paragraph (c) to § 410.155 that
provides a basic formula for computing
the limitation during the phase-out
period from CY 2010 through CY 2013,
as well as after the limitation is fully
removed from CY 2014 onward.
2. Section 131: Physician Payment,
Efficiency, and Quality Improvements—
Physician Quality Reporting Initiative
(PQRI)
a. Program Background and Statutory
Authority
The Physician Quality Reporting
Initiative (PQRI) is a voluntary reporting
program that provides an incentive
payment to eligible professionals who
satisfactorily report data on quality
measures for covered professional
services during a specified reporting
period. Under section 1848(k)(3)(B) of
the Act, the term ‘‘eligible professional’’
means any of the following: (1) A
physician; (2) A practitioner described
in section 1842(b)(18)(C); (3) A physical
or occupational therapist or a qualified
speech-language pathologist; (4) A
qualified audiologist. The PQRI was first
implemented in 2007 as a result of
section 101 of Division B of the Tax
Relief and Health Care Act of 2006—the
Medicare Improvements and Extension
Act of 2006 (Pub. L. 109–432) (MIEA–
TRHCA), which was enacted on
December 20, 2006. The PQRI was
extended and further enhanced as a
result of the Medicare, Medicaid, and
SCHIP Extension Act of 2007 (Pub. L.
110–173) (MMSEA), which was enacted
on December 29, 2007, and the MIPPA,
which was enacted on July 15, 2008.
Changes to the PQRI as a result of these
laws, as well as information about the
PQRI in 2007, 2008, and 2009 are
discussed in detail in the CY 2008 PFS
proposed rule (72 FR 38196 through
38204), CY 2008 PFS final rule with
comment period (72 FR 66336 through
66353), CY 2009 PFS proposed rule (73
FR 38558 through 38575), and CY 2009
PFS final rule with comment period (73
FR 69817 through 69847). In addition,
detailed information about the PQRI is
available on the CMS Web site at
https://www.cms.hhs.gov/PQRI.
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
b. Incentive Payments for the 2010 PQRI
For 2010, section 1848(m)(1)(B) of the
Act authorizes the Secretary to provide
an incentive payment equal to 2.0
percent of the estimated total allowed
charges (based on claims submitted not
later than 2 months after the end of the
reporting period) for all covered
professional services furnished during
the reporting period for 2010. Although
PQRI incentive payments are only
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
authorized through 2010 under section
1848(m)(1)(A) of the Act, section
1848(k)(2)(C) of the Act provides for the
use of consensus-based quality
measures for the PQRI for 2010 and
subsequent years.
The PQRI incentive payment amount
is calculated using estimated allowed
charges for all covered professional
services furnished under the PFS, not
just those charges associated with the
reported quality measures. ‘‘Allowed
charges’’ refers to total charges,
including the beneficiary deductible
and coinsurance, and is not limited to
the 80 percent paid by Medicare or the
portion covered by Medicare where
Medicare is secondary payer. Amounts
billed above the PFS amounts for
assigned and non-assigned claims will
not be included in the calculation of the
incentive payment amount. In addition,
since, by definition under section
1848(k)(3)(A)) of the Act, ‘‘covered
professional services’’ are limited to
services for which payment is made
under, or is based on, the PFS and
which are furnished by an eligible
professional, other Part B services and
items that may be billed by eligible
professionals but are not paid under or
based upon the Medicare Part B PFS are
not included in the calculation of the
incentive payment amount.
Under section 1848(m)(6)(C) of the
Act, the ‘‘reporting period’’ for the 2008
through 2011 PQRI is defined to be the
entire year, but the Secretary is
authorized to revise the reporting period
for years after 2009 if the Secretary
determines such ‘‘revision is
appropriate, produces valid results on
measures reported, and is consistent
with the goals of maximizing scientific
validity and reducing administrative
burden.’’
We are also required by section
1848(m)(5)(F) of the Act to establish
alternative criteria for satisfactorily
reporting and alternative reporting
periods for registry-based reporting and
for reporting measures groups.
Therefore, eligible professionals who
meet the proposed alternative criteria
for satisfactorily reporting for registrybased reporting and for reporting
measures groups for the proposed 2010
alternative reporting periods for
registry-based reporting and for
reporting measures groups would also
be eligible to earn an incentive payment
equal to 2.0 percent of the estimated
total Medicare Part B PFS allowed
charges for all covered professional
services furnished by the eligible
professional during the proposed
alternative reporting periods for 2010
PQRI registry-based reporting or for
reporting measures groups.
PO 00000
Frm 00041
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33559
The proposed PQRI reporting options
for an individual eligible professional
seeking to qualify for a 2010 PQRI
incentive payment (that is, the proposed
PQRI reporting mechanisms, proposed
reporting periods, and proposed criteria
for satisfactory reporting, including the
proposed alternative reporting periods
and alternative criteria for satisfactorily
reporting for registry-based reporting
and for reporting measures groups) are
addressed in sections II.G.2.c. through
II.G.2.f. of this proposed rule. The
proposed 2010 PQRI quality measures
and proposed 2010 PQRI measures
groups are discussed in section II.G.2.i.
of this proposed rule.
Prior to 2010, the PQRI was an
incentive program in which
determination of whether an eligible
professional satisfactorily reported
quality data was made at the individual
professional level, based on the National
Provider Identifier (NPI). Although the
incentive payments were made to the
practice(s) represented by the Tax
Identification Number (TIN) to which
payments are made for the individual
professional’s services, there were no
incentive payments made to the group
practice based on a determination that
the group practice, as a whole,
satisfactorily reported PQRI quality
measures data. To the extent individuals
(based on the individuals’ NPIs)
satisfactorily reported data on PQRI
quality measures that were associated
with more than one practice or TIN, the
determination of whether an eligible
professional satisfactorily reported PQRI
quality measures data was made for
each unique TIN/NPI combination.
Therefore, the incentive payment
amount was calculated for each unique
TIN/NPI combination and payment was
made to the holder of the applicable
TIN.
However, section 1848(m)(3)(C)(i) of
the Act requires that by January 1, 2010,
the Secretary establish and have in
place a process under which eligible
professionals in a group practice (as
defined by the Secretary) shall be
treated as satisfactorily submitting data
on quality measures for the PQRI for
covered professional services for a
reporting period, if, in lieu of reporting
measures under subsection (k)(2)(C), the
group practice reports measures
determined appropriate by the
Secretary, such as measures that target
high-cost chronic conditions and
preventive care, in a form and manner,
and at a time, specified by the Secretary.
Therefore, beginning with the 2010
PQRI, group practices who satisfactorily
submit data on quality measures also
would be eligible to earn an incentive
payment equal to 2.0 percent of the
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33560
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
estimated total allowed charges for all
covered professional services furnished
by the group practice during the
applicable reporting period. As required
by section 1848(m)(3)(C)(iii) of the Act,
payments to a group practice by reason
of the process described above shall be
in lieu of the PQRI incentive payments
that would otherwise be made to
eligible professionals in the group
practice for satisfactorily submitting
data on quality measures. Therefore, an
individual eligible professional who is
participating in the group practice
reporting option as a member of a group
practice would not be able to separately
earn a PQRI incentive payment as an
individual eligible professional.
The process proposed to be used to
determine whether a group practice
satisfactorily submits data on quality
measures for the 2010 PQRI is described
in section II.G.2.g. of this proposed rule.
The proposed measures on which a
group practice would need to report in
order to be treated as satisfactorily
submitting data on quality measures for
the 2010 PQRI are discussed in section
II.G.2.j. of this proposed rule.
c. Proposed 2010 Reporting Periods for
Individual Eligible Professionals
As we indicated above, section
1848(m)(6)(C) of the Act defines
‘‘reporting period’’ for 2010 to be the
entire year. Section 1848(m)(6)(C)(ii) of
the Act, however, authorizes the
Secretary to revise the reporting period
for years after 2009 if the Secretary
determines such revision is appropriate,
produces valid results on measures
reported, and is consistent with the
goals of maximizing scientific validity
and reducing administrative burden. To
be consistent with section 1848(m)(6)(C)
of the Act and with prior years, we
propose the 2010 PQRI reporting period
for the reporting of individual PQRI
quality measures through claims or a
qualified electronic health record (EHR)
(see section II.G.2.d. of this proposed
rule for discussion of proposed 2010
PQRI reporting mechanisms) will be the
entire year (that is, January 1, 2010
through December 31, 2010).
We also considered exercising our
authority to revise the reporting period
for claims-based reporting of individual
measures by proposing to add an
alternative reporting period beginning
July 1, 2010 for claims-based reporting
of individual measures. Doing so would
make the reporting periods for claimsbased reporting of individual measures
consistent with the alternative reporting
periods for reporting measures groups
and for registry-based reporting that
have been in place since the 2008 PQRI.
This would allow an eligible
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
professional to earn a PQRI incentive
payment equal to 2.0 percent of his or
her estimated allowed charges for
covered professional services furnished
for the last half of 2010 if he or she
satisfactorily reports data on individual
PQRI quality measures through claims
during the last half of 2010. We received
input from a few stakeholders in
support of a partial year reporting
period for claims-based reporting of
individual measures to give more
eligible professionals the opportunity to
begin reporting later in the year. Other
stakeholders recommended that we offer
the same reporting periods for all
reporting mechanisms. We agree that
having the same reporting periods for all
reporting mechanisms may be less
complex. We also agree that the
addition of a 6-month reporting period
may facilitate participation in PQRI for
certain eligible professionals. However,
we do not believe that making a 6month reporting period available would
serve to enhance the validity of results
on measures reported or to maximize
scientific validity as required under
section 1848(m)(6)(C)(ii) of the Act. In
addition, given our desire to transition
from the use of the claims-based
reporting mechanism as the primary
reporting mechanism for clinical quality
measures for PQRI after 2010 to rely
more heavily on registry-based reporting
(see section II.G.2.d. of this proposed
rule for further discussion), we do not
believe it appropriate to add a new 6month reporting period for claims-based
reporting of individual measures. Given
the fact that we seek to lessen reliance
on the claims-based reporting
mechanism for the PQRI after 2010, we
believe the cost of adding a 6-month
reporting period for claims-based
reporting of individual measures
outweighs any added flexibility that
eligible professionals may receive in the
short-term.
Nevertheless, we invite comments on
the decision to not propose a 6-month
reporting period for claims-based
reporting of individual PQRI quality
measures.
In addition, section 1848(m)(5)(F) of
the Act requires, for 2008 and
subsequent years, the Secretary to
establish alternative reporting periods
for reporting groups of measures and for
registry-based reporting. To satisfy the
requirements of section 1848(m)(5)(F) of
the Act and to maintain program
stability, we propose to retain the 2
alternative reporting periods from the
2008 and 2009 PQRI for reporting
measures groups and for registry-based
reporting: (1) The entire year; and (2) a
6-month reporting period beginning July
1. Therefore, for 2010, the proposed
PO 00000
Frm 00042
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
alternative reporting periods for
reporting measures groups and for
registry-based reporting are: (1) January
1, 2010 through December 31, 2010; and
(2) July 1, 2010 through December 31,
2010. We note that the 6-month
reporting period, beginning July 1, 2010,
is proposed to be available for reporting
on measures groups and for reporting
using the registry-based reporting
mechanism only. For an eligible
professional who satisfactorily reports
measures groups or through the registrybased reporting mechanism for the 6month reporting period, the eligible
professional would qualify to earn a
PQRI incentive payment equal to 2.0
percent of his or her total estimated
allowed charges for covered
professional services furnished between
July 1, 2010 and December 31, 2010
only. The incentive payment would not
be calculated based on the eligible
professional’s charges for covered
professional services for the entire year.
d. Proposed 2010 PQRI Reporting
Mechanisms for Individual Eligible
Professionals
When the PQRI was first implemented
in 2007, there was only 1 reporting
mechanism available to submit data on
PQRI quality measures. For the 2007
PQRI, the only way that eligible
professionals could submit data on
PQRI quality measures was by reporting
the appropriate quality data codes on
their Medicare Part B claims (claimsbased reporting). For the 2008 PQRI, we
added a second reporting mechanism as
required by section 1848(k)(4) of the
Act, so that eligible professionals could
submit data on PQRI quality measures
to a qualified PQRI registry and request
the registry to submit PQRI quality
measures results and numerator and
denominator data on the 2008 PQRI
quality measures or measures groups on
their behalf (registry-based reporting).
For the 2009 PQRI, we retained the 2
reporting mechanisms used in the 2008
PQRI (that is, claims-based reporting
and registry-based reporting) for
reporting individual PQRI quality
measures and for reporting measures
groups.
To promote the adoption of EHRs, we
also conducted limited testing of a third
reporting mechanism for the 2008 PQRI,
which was the submission of clinical
quality data extracted from an EHR, or
the EHR-based reporting mechanism. No
incentive payment was available to
those eligible professionals who
participated in testing the EHR-based
reporting mechanism. In the CY 2009
PFS proposed rule (73 FR 38564
through 38565), we described our plans
to test the submission of clinical quality
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
data extracted from qualified EHR
products for five 2008 PQRI measures
and proposed to accept PQRI data from
EHRs and to pay PQRI incentive
payments based on that submission for
a limited subset of the proposed 2009
PQRI quality measures. However, as
described in the CY 2009 PFS final rule
with comment period (73 FR 69830), we
did not finalize our proposal to allow
eligible professionals to submit clinical
quality data extracted from EHRs for
purposes of receiving a PQRI incentive
payment for 2009. Since the 2008 EHR
testing process was not complete at the
time of publication of the CY 2009 PFS
final rule, we instead opted to continue
to test the submission of clinical quality
data extracted from EHRs in 2009 and
provide no incentive payment to those
eligible professionals participating in
testing the EHR-based reporting
mechanism in 2009.
For the 2010 PQRI, we are proposing
to retain the claims-based reporting
mechanism and the registry-based
reporting mechanism. In addition, we
are again proposing for the 2010 PQRI
to accept PQRI quality measures data
extracted from a qualified EHR product
for a limited subset of the proposed
2010 PQRI quality measures, as
identified in Table 20, contingent upon
the successful completion of our 2009
EHR data submission testing process
and a determination based on that
testing process that accepting data from
EHRs on quality measures for the 2010
PQRI is practical and feasible. We will
make the determination as to whether
accepting data from EHRs on quality
measures is practical and feasible for the
2010 PQRI prior to publication of the
CY 2010 PFS final rule with comment
period. We will indicate in the CY 2010
PFS final rule with comment period
whether we intend to finalize this
proposal. If we finalize this proposal,
then, unlike in prior years, an eligible
professional would be able to earn a
PQRI incentive payment through the
EHR-based reporting mechanism in
2010.
We seek to offer more reporting
mechanisms because we recognize that
1 mode of quality reporting does not
suit all practices and our experience
with the registry-based reporting
mechanism thus far has been favorable.
While the availability of multiple
reporting mechanisms should increase
opportunities for eligible professionals
to satisfactorily report quality data for
the PQRI, we also recognize that there
are a number of limitations associated
with claims-based reporting. On one
hand, claims submission is available to
nearly all eligible professionals. On the
other hand, submission of quality data
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
on claims has certain drawbacks since
the claims processing system was
developed for billing purposes and not
for the submission of quality data. As
we noted in the CY 2009 PFS final rule
with comment period (73 FR 69833), for
example, measures with complex
specifications, such as those that require
multiple diagnosis codes are not as
conducive to claims-based reporting and
may be associated with a greater number
of invalidly reported quality data codes.
Similarly, when multiple measures
share the same codes it may be difficult
to determine which measure(s) the
eligible professional intended to report
through claims.
We believe that EHR-based reporting
is a viable option for overcoming the
limitations associated with claims-based
reporting of quality measures.
Therefore, we propose to add an EHRbased reporting mechanism for the 2010
PQRI in order to promote the adoption
and use of EHRs and to provide both
eligible professionals and CMS
experience on EHR-based quality
reporting.
Furthermore, on February 17, 2009,
the President signed into law the
American Recovery and Reinvestment
Act (the Recovery Act) (Pub. L. 111–5).
Section 4101(a) of the Health
Information Technology for Economic
and Clinical Health (HITECH) Act (Title
IV of Division B of the Recovery Act,
together with Title XIII of Division A of
the Recovery Act), which amends
section 1848 of the Act to add new
subsection (o), authorizes incentive
payments under Medicare for certain
eligible professionals who are
‘‘meaningful EHR users’’ beginning in
2011. However, the provisions in this
proposed rule do not implement any
HITECH Act statutory provisions. While
our efforts to encourage the adoption
and use of EHRs through testing EHRbased data submission in the 2008 and
2009 PQRI and our proposal to add an
EHR-based reporting mechanism for the
purpose of receiving a PQRI incentive
payment for the 2010 PQRI could
potentially provide invaluable
experience and serve as a foundation for
establishing the capacity for eligible
professionals to send, and for CMS to
receive, data on quality measures via
EHRs, the provisions of the HITECH Act
will be implemented in future notice
and comment rulemaking.
In summary, we propose that for
2010, an eligible professional may
choose to report data on PQRI quality
measures through claims, to a qualified
registry (for the qualification
requirements for registries, see section
II.G.2.i.(4) of this proposed rule), or
through a qualified EHR product (for the
PO 00000
Frm 00043
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33561
qualification requirements for EHR
vendors and their products, see section
II.G.2.i.(5) of this proposed rule).
Depending on which PQRI individual
quality measures or measures groups an
eligible professional selects, however,
one or more of the proposed reporting
mechanisms may not be available for
reporting a particular 2010 PQRI
individual quality measure or measures
group. The proposed 2010 reporting
mechanisms through which each
proposed 2010 PQRI individual quality
measure and measures group could be
reported is identified in Tables 14
through 15. We invite comments on the
proposed reporting mechanisms for the
2010 PQRI, including our proposal to
add an EHR-based reporting mechanism
to the 2010 PQRI, contingent upon the
successful completion of our 2009 EHR
data submission testing process and a
determination that accepting data from
EHRs on quality measures for the 2010
PQRI is practical and feasible.
While we propose to retain the
claims-based reporting mechanism for
2010, we note that we are considering
significantly limiting the claims-based
mechanism of reporting clinical quality
measures for the PQRI after 2010. This
would be contingent upon there being
an adequate number and variety of
registries available and/or EHR
reporting options. Potentially, we would
retain claims-based reporting in years
after 2010 principally for the reporting
of structural measures, such as Measure
#124 Health Information Technology
(HIT): Adoption/Use of Electronic
Health Records (EHR), and
circumstances where claims-based
reporting is the only available
mechanism for certain categories of
eligible professionals to report on PQRI
quality measures.
Reducing our reliance on the claimsbased reporting mechanism after 2010
will allow us and eligible professionals
to devote available resources to
maximizing the potential of registries
and EHRs for quality measurement
reporting. Both mechanisms hold the
promise of more sophisticated and
timely reporting on clinical quality
measures. Clinical data registries allow
the collection of more detailed data,
including outcomes, without the
necessity of a single submission
contemporaneously with claims billing,
which overcomes some of the
limitations of the claims-based reporting
mechanism. Registries can also provide
feedback and quality improvement
information based on reported data.
Finally, clinical data registries can also
receive data from EHRs, and therefore,
serve as an alternative means to
reporting clinical quality data extracted
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33562
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
from an EHR. As we continue to qualify
additional registries, we believe that
there will be a sufficient number of
qualified PQRI registries by 2011 to
make it possible to reduce or even
discontinue the claims-based reporting
mechanism for most measures after
2010. We invite comments on our intent
to lessen our reliance on the claimsbased reporting mechanism for the PQRI
beyond 2010.
Regardless of the reporting
mechanism chosen by an eligible
professional, there is no requirement for
the eligible professional to sign up or
register to participate in the PQRI.
However, there may be some
requirements for participation through a
specific reporting mechanism that are
unique to that particular reporting
mechanism. In addition to the criteria
for satisfactory reporting of individual
measures and measures groups
described in sections II.G.2.e. and
II.G.2.f., respectively, of this proposed
rule, eligible professionals must ensure
that they meet all requirements for their
chosen reporting mechanism.
(1) Requirements for Individual Eligible
Professionals Who Choose the ClaimsBased Reporting Mechanism
For eligible professionals who choose
to participate in the PQRI by submitting
data on individual quality measures or
measures groups through the claimsbased reporting mechanism, the only
requirement associated with claimsbased reporting that we are proposing
apart from the proposed criteria for
satisfactory reporting of individual
measures and measures described below
in sections II.G.2.e. and II.G.2.f.,
respectively, of this proposed rule, is
the submission of the appropriate PQRI
quality data codes on the professionals’
Medicare Part B claims. An eligible
professional would be permitted to
submit the quality data codes for the
eligible professional’s selected
individual PQRI quality measures or
measures group at any time during the
2010 reporting period. Please note,
however, that as required by section
1848(m)(1)(A) of the Act, all claims for
services furnished between January 1,
2010 and December 31, 2010 must be
processed by no later than February 28,
2011 to be included in the 2010 PQRI
analysis.
(2) Requirements for Individual Eligible
Professionals Who Choose the RegistryBased Reporting Mechanism
In order to report quality measures
results and numerator and denominator
data on the 2010 PQRI individual
quality measures or measures group
through a qualified clinical registry, we
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
propose that eligible professionals
would need to enter into and maintain
an appropriate legal arrangement with a
qualified 2010 PQRI registry. Such
arrangements would provide for the
registry’s receipt of patient-specific data
from the eligible professional and the
registry’s disclosure of quality measures
results and numerator and denominator
data on PQRI quality measures or
measures groups on behalf of the
eligible professional to CMS. Thus, the
registry would act as a Health Insurance
Portability and Accountability Act of
1996 (Pub. L. 104–191) (HIPAA)
Business Associate and agent of the
eligible professional. Such agents are
referred to as ‘‘data submission
vendors.’’ The ‘‘data submission
vendors’’ would have the requisite legal
authority to provide clinical quality
measures results and numerator and
denominator data on individual quality
measures or measures groups on behalf
of the eligible professional for the PQRI.
The registry, acting as a data submission
vendor, would submit registry-derived
measures information to the CMS
designated database for the PQRI, using
a CMS-specified record layout. The
record layout will be provided to the
registry by CMS.
To maintain compliance with
applicable statutes and regulations, our
program and its data system must
maintain compliance with the HIPAA
requirements for requesting, processing,
storing, and transmitting data. Eligible
professionals that conduct HIPAA
covered transactions also must maintain
compliance with the HIPAA
requirements.
Eligible professionals choosing to
participate in PQRI by submitting
quality measures results and numerator
and denominator data on PQRI
individual quality measures or measures
groups through the registry-based
reporting mechanism for 2010 would
need to select a qualified PQRI registry
and submit information on PQRI
individual quality measures or measures
groups to the selected registry in the
form and manner and by the deadline
specified by the registry.
The process and requirements that we
propose to use to determine whether a
registry is qualified to submit quality
measures results and numerator and
denominator data on PQRI quality
measures or measures groups on an
eligible professional’s behalf in 2010 are
described in section II.G.2.d. of this
proposed rule. We will post on the PQRI
section of the CMS Web site at https://
www.cms.hhs.gov a list of qualified
registries for the 2010 PQRI, including
the registry name, contact information,
and the 2010 measure(s) and/or
PO 00000
Frm 00044
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
measures group(s) for which the registry
is qualified and intends to report. We
propose to post the names of 2010 PQRI
qualified registries in 2 phases. In either
event, even though a registry is listed as
‘‘qualified,’’ we cannot guarantee or
assume responsibility for the registry’s
successful submission of PQRI quality
measures results and numerator and
denominate data on PQRI quality
measures or measures groups on behalf
of eligible professionals.
In the first phase, we anticipate that
by December 31, 2009, we will be able
to, at minimum, post a list of those
registries qualified for the 2010 PQRI
based on: (1) Being a qualified registry
for the 2008 and 2009 PQRI that
successfully submitted 2008 PQRI
quality measures results and numerator
and denominator data on the quality
measures; (2) having received a letter
indicating their continued interest in
being a PQRI registry for 2010; and (3)
the registry’s compliance with the 2010
PQRI registry requirements. By posting
this first list of qualified registries for
the 2010 PQRI, we seek to make
available the names of registries that can
be qualified at the start of the 2010
reporting period. We do this to
accommodate requests we have received
from eligible professionals who wish to
avoid claims-based reporting pending
knowing whether a particular registry is
qualified for the 2010 PQRI.
In the second phase, we anticipate to
complete posting of the list of qualified
2010 registries as soon as we have
completed vetting the registries
interested in participating in the 2010
PQRI and identified the qualified
registries for the 2010 PQRI, which we
anticipate will be completed by no later
than Summer 2010. An eligible
professional’s ability to report PQRI
quality measures results and numerator
and denominator data on PQRI quality
measures or measures groups using the
registry-based reporting mechanism
should not be impacted by the complete
list of qualified registries for the 2010
PQRI being made available after the start
of the reporting period. First, registries
will not begin submitting eligible
professionals’ PQRI quality measures
results and numerator and denominator
data on the quality measures or
measures groups to CMS until 2011.
Second, if an eligible professional
decides that he or she is no longer
interested in submitting quality
measures results and numerator and
denominator data on PQRI individual
quality measures or measures group
through the registry-based reporting
mechanism after the complete list of
qualified registries becomes available,
this does not preclude the eligible
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
professional from attempting to meet the
criteria for satisfactory reporting
through another 2010 PQRI reporting
mechanism.
In addition to meeting the above
proposed requirements specific to
registry-based reporting, eligible
professionals who choose to participate
in PQRI through the registry-based
reporting mechanism would need to
meet the relevant criteria proposed for
satisfactory reporting of individual
measures or measures groups that all
eligible professionals must meet in
order to qualify to earn a 2010 PQRI
incentive payment. The criteria for
satisfactory reporting of individual
measures and measures groups are
described in sections II.G.2.e. and
II.G.2.f., respectively, of this proposed
rule.
(3) Requirements for Individual Eligible
Professionals Who Choose the EHRBased Reporting Mechanism
For eligible professionals who choose
to participate in the 2010 PQRI by
submitting data on individual quality
measures through the EHR-based
reporting mechanism, the only proposed
requirements associated with EHRbased reporting other than meeting the
criteria for satisfactory reporting of
individual measures described in
section II.G.2.e. of this proposed rule are
to: (1) Select a qualified EHR product
and (2) submit clinical quality data
extracted from the EHR to a CMS
clinical data warehouse. Provided that
our 2009 EHR data submission testing
process is successful, we propose to
begin accepting submission of clinical
quality data extracted from ‘‘qualified’’
EHRs on January 1, 2010, or as soon
thereafter as is technically feasible. We
propose that eligible professionals will
have until March 31, 2011 to complete
data submission through qualified EHRs
for services furnished during the 2010
PQRI reporting period. The process that
was used to determine whether an EHR
vendor and its EHR product(s) are
qualified to submit clinical quality data
extracted from EHRs for the 2010 PQRI
is described in section II.G.2.d.5. of this
proposed rule.
The specifications for the electronic
transmission of the proposed 2010 PQRI
measures identified in Table 20 (section
II.G.2.i.(4) of this proposed rule) as
being under consideration for EHRbased reporting in 2010 will be posted
on a public Web site when available. We
will announce the availability and exact
location of these specifications through
familiar CMS communications
channels, including the PQRI section of
the CMS Web site at https://
www.cms.hhs.gov/PQRI. The posting of
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
specifications for the electronic
transmission of any particular measure
prior to publication of the final rule
does not signify that the measure will
necessarily be selected for the 2010
PQRI measure set, nor that EHR-based
reporting will be accepted for that
measure even if it may otherwise be
included in the 2010 PQRI. However, by
posting the specifications for electronic
transmission of these measures, we seek
to allow sufficient time for EHR vendors
to adapt their products to support EHRbased capture and submission of data
for these measures prior to the start of
any 2010 PQRI reporting periods.
We do not propose any option to
report measures groups through EHRbased reporting on services furnished
during 2010. Because EHR-based
reporting to CMS of data on quality
measures would be new to PQRI for
2010, we propose to make available only
the criteria applicable to reporting of
individual PQRI measures.
We cannot assume responsibility for
the successful submission of data from
eligible professionals’ EHRs. Any
eligible professional who chooses to
submit PQRI data extracted from an
EHR should contact the EHR product’s
vendor to determine if the product is
qualified and has been updated to
facilitate PQRI quality measures data
submission. Such professionals also
should begin attempting submission
promptly after we announce that the
clinical data warehouse is ready to
accept 2010 PQRI quality measures data
through the EHR mechanism in order to
assure the professional has a reasonable
period of time to work with his or her
EHR and/or its vendor to correct any
problems that may complicate or
preclude successful quality measures
data submission through that EHR. As
we indicated above, data submission for
the 2010 PQRI would need to be
completed by March 31, 2011.
(4) Qualification Requirements for
Registries
In order to be ‘‘qualified’’ to submit
quality measures results and numerator
and denominator data on PQRI quality
measures and measures groups on
behalf of eligible professionals pursuing
incentive payment for the 2008 and
2009 PQRI, we required registries to
complete a self-nomination process and
to meet certain technical and other
requirements. For the 2009 PQRI,
registries that were ‘‘qualified’’ for 2008
did not need to be ‘‘re-qualified’’ for
2009 unless they were unsuccessful at
submitting 2008 PQRI data (that is,
failed to submit 2008 PQRI data per the
2008 PQRI registry requirements).
Registries that were ‘‘qualified’’ for 2008
PO 00000
Frm 00045
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33563
and wished to continue to participate in
2009 were only required to
communicate their desire to continue
participation for 2009 by submitting a
letter to CMS indicating their continued
interest in being a PQRI registry for 2009
and their compliance with the 2009
PQRI registry requirements by March
31, 2009.
For the 2010 PQRI, we are again
proposing to require a self-nomination
process for registries wishing to submit
2010 PQRI quality measures or
measures groups on behalf of eligible
professionals for services furnished
during the applicable reporting periods
in 2010. Similar to the 2008 and 2009
PQRI registry self-nomination process,
the proposed registry self-nomination
process for the 2010 PQRI would be
based on a registry meeting specific
technical and other requirements.
In order to be consistent with the
registry requirements from prior
program years, we propose that the 2010
registry requirements be substantially
the same as for 2008 and 2009.
Specifically, to be considered a
qualified registry for purposes of
submitting individual quality measures
and measures groups on behalf of
eligible professionals who choose to
report using this reporting mechanism
under the 2010 PQRI, we propose that
a registry would need to:
• Be in existence as of January 1,
2009.
• Be able to collect all needed data
elements and calculate results for at
least 3 measures in the 2010 PQRI
program (according to the posted 2010
PQRI Measure Specifications).
• Be able to calculate and submit
measure-level reporting rates by TIN/
NPI;
• Be able to calculate and submit, by
TIN/NPI, a performance rate (that is, the
percentage of a defined population who
receive a particular process of care or
achieve a particular outcome) for each
measure on which the TIN/NPI reports;
• Be able to separate out and report
on Medicare Part B FFS patients;
• Provide the name of the registry;
• Provide the reporting period start
date the registry will cover;
• Provide the reporting period end
date the registry will cover;
• Provide the measure numbers for
the PQRI quality measures on which the
registry is reporting;
• Provide the measure title for the
PQRI quality measures on which the
registry is reporting;
• Report the number of eligible
instances (reporting denominator);
• Report the number of instances of
quality service performed (numerator);
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33564
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
• Report the number of performance
exclusions;
• Report the number of reported
instances, performance not met (eligible
professional receives credit for
reporting, not for performance);
• Be able to transmit this data in a
CMS-approved XML format. We expect
that this CMS-specified record layout
will be substantially the same as for the
2008 and 2009 PQRI. This layout will be
provided to registries in 2010;
• Comply with a CMS-specified
secure method for data submission,
such as submitting its data in an XML
file through an Individuals Access to
CMS Systems (IACS) user account;
• Submit an acceptable ‘‘validation
strategy’’ to CMS by March 31, 2010. A
validation strategy ascertains whether
eligible professionals have submitted
accurately and on at least the minimum
number (80 percent) of their eligible
patients, visits, procedures, or episodes
for a given measure. Acceptable
validation strategies often include such
provisions as the registry being able to
conduct random sampling of their
participants’ data, but may also be based
on other credible means of verifying the
accuracy of data content and
completeness of reporting or adherence
to a required sampling method;
• Enter into and maintain with its
participating professionals an
appropriate Business Associate
agreement that provides for the
registry’s receipt of patient-specific data
from the eligible professionals, as well
as the registry’s disclosure of quality
measure results and numerator and
denominator data on behalf of eligible
professionals who wish to participate in
the PQRI program;
• Obtain and keep on file signed
documentation that each holder of an
NPI whose data are submitted to the
registry has authorized the registry to
submit quality measures results and
numerator and denominator data to
CMS for the purpose of PQRI
participation. This documentation must
be obtained at the time the eligible
professional signs up with the registry
to submit PQRI quality measures data to
the registry and must meet any
applicable laws, regulations, and
contractual business associate
agreements;
• Provide CMS access (if requested)
to review the Medicare beneficiary data
on which 2010 PQRI registry-based
submissions are founded;
• Provide the reporting option
(reporting period and reporting criteria)
that the eligible professional has
satisfied or chosen; and
• Provide CMS a signed, written
attestation statement via mail or e-mail
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
which states that the quality measure
results and numerator and denominator
data provided to CMS are accurate and
complete.
With respect to the submission of
2010 measure results and numerator
and denominator data on measures
groups, we propose to retain the
following registry requirements from the
2009 PQRI:
• Indicate the reporting period
chosen for each eligible professional
who chooses to submit data on
measures groups;
• Base reported information on
measures groups only on patients to
whom services were furnished during
the 12-month reporting period of
January through December 2010 or the
6-month reporting period of July 2010
through December 2010;
• Agree that the registry’s data may be
inspected by CMS under our oversight
authority if non-Medicare patients are
included in the patient sample;
• Be able to report data on all of the
measures in a given measures group and
on either 30 patients from January 1
through December 31, 2010 (note this
patient sample must include some
Medicare Part B FFS beneficiaries) or on
80 percent of applicable Medicare Part
B FFS patients for each eligible
professional (with a minimum of 15
patients during the January 1, 2010
through December 31, 2010 reporting
period or a minimum of 8 patients
during the July 1, 2010 through
December 31, 2010 reporting period)
(see criteria for satisfactory reporting of
measures groups described in section
II.G.2.f. of this proposed rule for further
information); and
• Be able to report the number of
Medicare FFS patients and the number
of Medicare Advantage patients that are
included in the patient sample for a
given measures group.
In addition to the above requirements,
we propose the following new
requirements for registries for the 2010
PQRI:
• Registries must have at least 25
participants;
• Registries must provide at least 1
feedback report per year to participating
eligible professionals;
• Registries must not be owned and
managed by an individual locallyowned single-specialty group (in other
words, single-specialty practices with
only 1 practice location or solo
practitioner practices would be
prohibited from self-nominating to
become a qualified PQRI registry);
• Registries must participate in
ongoing 2010 PQRI mandatory support
conference calls hosted by CMS
(approximately 1 call per month);
PO 00000
Frm 00046
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
• Registries must provide a flow and
XML of a measure’s calculation process
for each measure type that the registry
intends to calculate; and
• Registries must use PQRI measure
specifications to calculate reporting or
performance unless otherwise stated.
These proposed new requirements are
intended to improve the registry-based
reporting mechanism by taking
advantage of some of the registries’
existing quality improvement functions,
maximizing the registry’s ability to
successfully submit eligible
professionals’ quality measure results
and numerator and denominator data on
PQRI individual quality measures or
measures groups to CMS, and
discouraging small physician offices or
an individual eligible professional from
self-nominating to become a qualified
registry. We are concerned that an
individual eligible professional or a
small practice does not have the
resources or capabilities to successfully
submit quality measures results and
numerator and denominator data on
PQRI individual measures or measures
groups through the registry data
submission process.
We propose to post the final 2010
PQRI registry requirements, including
the exact date by which registries that
wish to qualify for 2010 must submit a
self-nomination letter and instructions
for submitting the self-nomination
letter, on the PQRI section of the CMS
Web site at https://www.cms.hhs.gov/
PQRI by November 15, 2009. We
anticipate that new registries that wish
to self-nominate for 2010 will be
required to do so by January 31, 2010.
Similar to the 2009 PQRI, we propose
that registries that were ‘‘qualified’’ for
2009 and wish to continue to participate
in 2010 would not need to be ‘‘requalified’’ for 2010 unless they are
unsuccessful at submitting 2009 PQRI
data (that is, fail to submit 2009 PQRI
data per the 2009 PQRI registry
requirements). We further propose that
registries that were ‘‘qualified’’ for 2009,
were successful in submitting 2009
PQRI data, and wish to continue to
participate in 2010 would need to
indicate their desire to continue
participation for 2010 by submitting a
letter to CMS indicating their continued
interest in being a PQRI registry for 2010
and their compliance with the 2010
PQRI registry requirements by no later
than October 31, 2009. Instructions
regarding the procedures for submitting
this letter will be provided to qualified
2009 PQRI registries on the 2009 PQRI
registry support conference calls.
If a qualified 2009 PQRI registry fails
to submit 2009 PQRI data per the 2009
PQRI registry requirements, we propose
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
the registry would be considered
unsuccessful at submitting 2009 PQRI
data and would need to go through the
full self-nomination process again to
participate in the 2010 PQRI. By March
31, 2010, registries that are unsuccessful
submitting quality measures results and
numerator and denominator data for
2009 would need to be able to meet the
2010 PQRI registry requirements and go
through the full vetting process again.
Finally, as discussed further under
section II.G.5.c.(1) of this proposed rule,
we propose that the above registry
requirements would apply not only for
the purpose of a registry qualifying to
report 2010 PQRI quality measure
results and numerator and denominator
data on PQRI individual quality
measures or measures groups, but also
for the purpose of a registry qualifying
to submit the proposed electronic
prescribing measure for the 2010
E-Prescribing Incentive Program.
(5) Qualification Requirements for EHR
Vendors and Their Products
In the CY 2009 PFS final rule with
comment period (73 FR 69830), we
announced our intent to qualify EHR
vendors and their specific products to
submit quality data extracted from their
EHR products to the CMS clinical
quality data warehouse so that we may
potentially begin to accept data via
EHRs for purposes of satisfactorily
reporting data on quality measures in
future PQRI reporting. We stated that we
anticipate posting on the PQRI section
of the CMS Web site at https://
www.cms.hhs.gov/PQRI, by December
31, 2008, a list of requirements that EHR
vendors must be able to meet in order
to self-nominate to have their product
‘‘qualified’’ to potentially be able to
submit quality measures data for the
2010 PQRI to CMS. We also stated that
qualifying EHR vendors ahead of actual
data submission will facilitate the live
data submission process.
On December 31, 2008, the
‘‘Requirements for Electronic Health
Record (EHR) Vendors to Participate in
the 2009 PQRI EHR Testing Program,’’
was posted on the Reporting page of the
PQRI section of the CMS Web site at
https://www.cms.hhs.gov/PQRI/
20_Reporting.asp#TopOfPage, which
described the EHR vendor requirements
and the EHR vendor self-nomination
process.
The vendor’s EHR system must be
updated according to the Draft 2009
EHR specifications posted on the
QualityNet Web site at https://
www.qualitynet.org in order for an EHR
vendor and its product to qualify to
submit test information on 2009 PQRI
measures, and for possible EHR data
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
submission for future PQRI reporting
years. In addition, the 2009 PQRI EHR
test-vendors must meet the following
requirements:
• Be able to collect and transmit all
required data elements according to the
2009 EHR Specifications.
• Be able to separate out and report
on Medicare Part B FFS patients only.
• Be able to include TIN/NPI
information submitted with an eligible
professional’s quality data.
• Be able to transmit this data in the
CMS-approved format.
• Comply with a secure method for
data submission.
• Enter into and maintain with its
participating professionals an
appropriate legal arrangement that
provides for the EHR vendor to receive
patient-specific data from the eligible
professional, as well as the EHR
vendor’s disclosure of protected health
information on behalf of eligible
professionals who wish to participate in
the 2009 PQRI EHR test program.
• Obtain and keep on file signed
documentation that each NPI whose
data is submitted to the EHR vendor has
authorized the EHR vendor to submit
patient data to CMS for the purpose of
PQRI testing. This documentation must
meet the standards of applicable law,
regulations, and contractual or business
associate agreements.
As described in the ‘‘Requirements for
Electronic Health Record (EHR) Vendors
to Participate in the 2009 PQRI EHR
Testing Program,’’ which is posted on
the Reporting page of the PQRI section
of the CMS Web site at https://
www.cms.hhs.gov/PQRI/
20_Reporting.asp#TopOfPage, EHR
vendors who wish to qualify to
participate in the 2009 PQRI EHR test
program were required to submit a selfnomination letter requesting inclusion
in the 2009 EHR testing process by
February 13, 2009. All nominees would
then go through a vetting process. Those
nominees passing this vetting process
would be asked to submit test data (that
is, mock-up data) or to submit live test
data from some of their clients (users)
with their permission. Vendors who
successfully submit their test data
would also need to be able to adapt their
system to any changes in the measure
specifications that may arise due to
Healthcare Information Technology
Standards Panel (HITSP) or Certification
Commission for Healthcare Information
Technology (CCHIT) adoption of quality
measure data reporting criteria.
It is expected that the process for
qualifying self-nominated EHR vendors
may conclude in 2009. At the
conclusion of this process, we propose
that those EHR products that meet all of
PO 00000
Frm 00047
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33565
the EHR vendor requirements will be
listed on the PQRI section of the CMS
Web site at https://www.cms.hhs.gov/
PQRI as a ‘‘qualified’’ EHR product (that
is, the name of the vendor software
product and the version that is
qualified), which indicates that the
product’s users may submit quality data
to CMS (either directly from their
system or through the vendor—which is
yet to be determined) for the 2010 PQRI,
if and when, EHR submission is
included in the 2010 PQRI as a PQRI
reporting mechanism.
As discussed further under section
II.G.5.c.(1) of this proposed rule, we
propose that the above EHR vendor
requirements would apply not only for
the purpose of a vendor’s EHR product
being qualified for the purpose of the
product’s users being able to submit
data extracted from the EHR for the
2010 PQRI, but also for the purpose of
a vendor’s EHR product being qualified
for the purpose of the product’s users
being able to electronically submit data
extracted from the EHR for the
electronic prescribing measure for the
2010 E-Prescribing Incentive Program.
During 2010, we expect to use the
self-nomination process described in the
‘‘Requirements for Electronic Health
Record (EHR) Vendors to Participate in
the 2009 PQRI EHR Testing Program’’
posted on the PQRI section of the CMS
Web site at https://www.cms.hhs.gov/
PQRI/20_Reporting.asp#TopOfPage, to
qualify additional EHR vendors and
their EHR products to submit quality
data extracted from their EHR products
to the CMS clinical quality data
warehouse for program years after 2010.
We anticipate that the requirements will
be similar to those used to qualify EHR
products for the 2009 PQRI EHR testing,
but they may be modified based on the
results of our 2009 EHR testing. At the
conclusion of this process, sometime in
late 2010, those EHR products that meet
all of the EHR vendor requirements will
be listed on the PQRI section of the CMS
Web site at https://www.cms.hhs.gov/
PQRI as a ‘‘qualified’’ EHR product,
which indicates that the product’s users
may submit quality data to CMS (either
directly from their system or through
the vendor—which is yet to be
determined) for the 2011 PQRI or
subsequent years, if and when, EHR
submission is included as a PQRI
reporting mechanism for years after
2010.
e. Proposed Criteria for Satisfactory
Reporting of Individual Quality
Measures for Individual Eligible
Professionals
Under section 1848(m)(3)(A) of the
Act, the criteria for satisfactorily
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33566
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
submitting data on individual quality
measures through claims-based
reporting require the reporting of at least
3 applicable measures in at least 80
percent of the cases in which the
measure is reportable. If fewer than 3
measures are applicable to the services
of the professional, the professional may
meet the criteria by reporting on all
applicable measures (that is, 1 to 2
measures) for at least 80 percent of the
cases where the measures are reportable.
It is assumed that if an eligible
professional submits quality data codes
for a particular measure, the measure
applies to the eligible professional.
In prior program years, when we were
required, under section 1848(m)(5)(F) of
the Act, to establish alternative criteria
for satisfactorily reporting using the
registry-based reporting mechanism, we
decided that the criteria for registrybased reporting of individual measures
should be consistent with the criteria for
claims-based reporting of individual
measures. Thus, we adopted the same
criteria for satisfactory reporting of
individual measures through registrybased reporting as the criteria for
satisfactory reporting of individual
measures through claims-based
reporting except that an eligible
professional could choose to report
through the registry-based reporting
mechanism only if there are at least 3
PQRI quality measures applicable to the
services of the professional. For the
2008 or 2009 PQRI, eligible
professionals could not satisfactorily
report PQRI measures through the
registry-based reporting mechanism by
reporting on fewer than 3 measures.
For years after 2009, section
1848(m)(3)(D) of the Act authorizes the
Secretary, in consultation with
stakeholders and experts, to revise the
criteria for satisfactorily reporting data
on quality measures. Based on this
authority and the input we have
received from stakeholders via the
invitation to submit suggestions for the
2010 PQRI reporting options posted on
the PQRI section of the CMS Web site
at https://www.cms.hhs.gov/PQRI in
April 2009, we propose 3 criteria for
satisfactory reporting of individual PQRI
quality measures for 2010. In an effort
to continue to be consistent with the
criteria of satisfactory reporting used in
prior PQRI program years, we propose
to retain the following 2 criteria with
respect to satisfactorily reporting data
on individual quality measures in
circumstances where 3 or more
individual quality measures apply to the
services furnished by an eligible
professional:
• Report on at least 3 2010 PQRI
measures (unless fewer than 3 2010
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PQRI measures apply to the services
furnished by the eligible professional);
and
• Report each measure for at least 80
percent of the eligible professional’s
Medicare Part B FFS patients for whom
services were furnished during the
reporting period to which the measure
applies.
These criteria would apply to all
proposed 2010 PQRI reporting
mechanisms available for reporting
individual PQRI quality measures (that
is, claims-based reporting, registrybased reporting, and EHR-based
reporting).
If an eligible professional has fewer
than 3 PQRI measures that apply to the
professional’s services, then the
professional would be able to meet the
criteria for satisfactorily reporting data
on individual quality measures by
meeting the following 2 proposed
criteria:
• Reporting on all measures that
apply to the services furnished by the
professional (that is 1 to 2 measures);
and
• Reporting each measure for at least
80 percent of the eligible professional’s
Medicare Part B FFS patients for whom
services were furnished during the
reporting period to which the measure
applies.
We propose that, as in previous years,
these criteria for satisfactorily reporting
data on fewer than 3 individual quality
measures would be available for the
claims-based reporting mechanism only.
An eligible professional who has fewer
than 3 PQRI measures that apply to the
professional’s services would not be
able to meet the criteria for satisfactory
reporting by reporting on all applicable
measures (that is, 1 or 2 measures)
through the registry-based reporting
mechanism.
While we have received input from
several stakeholders requesting that we
permit an eligible professional to report
fewer than 3 measures through the
registry-based reporting mechanism if
fewer than 3 measures apply to him or
her, doing so would be inefficient. First,
in addition to needing to analyze the
data submitted to us by the registry, we
would have to analyze the claims data
to ensure that no additional measures
are applicable to the eligible
professional, much like what we do
under the Measure Applicability
Validation process for claims-based
reporting. Second, we would also have
to analyze the claims data to ensure that
the eligible professional had not
attempted to report additional measures
through claims. For these reasons, we
are not proposing to permit eligible
professionals who choose the registry-
PO 00000
Frm 00048
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
based or EHR-based reporting
mechanism to report on individual
quality measures to report on fewer than
3 measures if only 1 or 2 measures
apply to the services they furnish.
Based on the previously stated
assumption that a measure applies to
the eligible professional if an eligible
professional submits quality data codes
for a particular measure, we propose
that an eligible professional who reports
on fewer than 3 measures through the
claims-based reporting mechanism in
2010 may be subject to the Measure
Applicability Validation process, which
allows us to determine whether an
eligible professional should have
reported quality data codes for
additional measures. This process was
applied in the 2007 and 2008 PQRI.
When an eligible professional reports on
fewer than 3 measures, we propose to
review whether there are other closely
related measures (such as those that
share a common diagnosis or those that
are representative of services typically
provided by a particular type of
professional). If an eligible professional
who reports on fewer than 3 measures
in 2010 reports on a measure that is part
of an identified cluster of closely related
measures and did not report on any
other measure that is part of that
identified cluster of closely related
measures, then the professional would
not qualify to receive a 2010 PQRI
incentive payment. Additional
information on the Measure
Applicability Validation process can be
found on the Analysis and Payment
page of the PQRI section of the CMS
Web site at https://www.cms.hhs.gov/
PQRI.
In addition to the above criteria
related to the number of measures on
which an eligible professional would be
required to report and the frequency of
reporting, we propose a third criterion
for satisfactory reporting of individual
measures. Based on our authority to
revise the criteria for satisfactory
reporting under section 1848(m)(3)(D) of
the Act, we propose that an eligible
professional also be required to report
data on at least one individual measure
on a minimum number of Medicare Part
B FFS patients seen during the reporting
period, as detailed below. Establishing a
minimum patient sample size
requirement would enhance the
scientific validity of eligible
professionals’ performance results and
encourage eligible professionals to
select to report only measures that are
representative of the types of services
they typically provide in their practice.
If, for example, an eligible professional
selects 3 patient-level measures (that is,
measures in which the required
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
reporting frequency is a minimum of
once per reporting period per individual
eligible professional) where only one of
his or her Medicare Part B FFS patients
are eligible for the measures and there
is no minimum patient sample size
requirement, then the eligible
professional currently could qualify to
earn a PQRI incentive payment by
reporting PQRI quality measures data
only 3 times during the entire reporting
period. We believe that information on
such a small sample of cases would be
insufficient to do any meaningful
analysis of the eligible professional’s
performance on the reported measure.
We also believe that a minimum patient
sample size requirement would prevent
an eligible professional from purposely
selecting measures that apply to only a
few of their patients.
Regardless of the reporting
mechanism chosen by the eligible
professional, we propose that the
minimum patient sample size for
reporting individual quality measures
be 15 Medicare Part B FFS patients for
the 12-month reporting period. An
eligible professional would need to meet
this minimum patient sample size
requirement for at least one measure on
which the eligible professional chooses
to report. This proposed number is
based on our experience with the 2007
PQRI and the limited information we
have available regarding the 2008 PQRI
reporting experience. For the 2007 PQRI
measures, where the only reporting
period was a 6-month reporting period
beginning July 1, 2007, the median
number of instances in which an
eligible professional could have
reported a 2007 PQRI measure was, on
average, 9 eligible instances per
measure. If we assume that the number
of eligible instances for the first half of
2007 were similar to the number of
eligible instances in the second half of
2007, then we can assume that the
median number of eligible instances
was an average of 18 instances per
measure for the entire year. Preliminary
information from the 2008 PQRI, based
on data through September 2008,
indicate that the median number of
instances in which an eligible
professional could have reported a 2008
PQRI measure was, on average, 18
eligible instances per measure. Since
eligible professionals are not required to
report a measure for all eligible cases,
we based the proposed minimum
patient sample size threshold on 80
percent of 18 eligible instances, which
is 14.4.
33567
Similarly, for the 6-month reporting
period (available for registry-based
reporting only), we propose that the
minimum patient sample size for
reporting on individual quality
measures be 8 Medicare Part B FFS
patients seen during the 6-month
reporting period. An eligible
professional would need to meet this
minimum patient sample size
requirement for at least one measure on
which the eligible professional chooses
to report. We welcome comments on the
proposal to add a minimum patient
sample size criterion to the criteria for
satisfactory reporting of data on
individual quality measures. In
addition, we invite comments on the
specific thresholds proposed for the 12month reporting period (available for
claims-based, registry-based, and EHRbased reporting) and for the 6-month
reporting period (available for registrybased reporting only) for reporting
individual quality measures.
The proposed 2010 criteria for
satisfactory reporting of data on
individual PQRI quality measures are
summarized in Table 14 and are
arranged by reporting mechanism and
reporting period.
TABLE 14—PROPOSED 2010 CRITERIA FOR SATISFACTORY REPORTING OF DATA ON INDIVIDUAL PQRI QUALITY
MEASURES, BY REPORTING MECHANISM AND REPORTING PERIOD
Reporting
mechanism
Reporting criteria
Claims-based reporting
• Report at least 3 PQRI measures, or 1–2 measures if less than 3
measures apply to the eligible professional;
• Report each measure for at least 80% of the eligible professional’s
Medicare Part B FFS patients seen during the reporting period to
whom the measure applies; and
• Report at least 1 PQRI measure on at least 15 Medicare Part B
FFS patients seen during the reporting period to which the measure applies.
• Report at least 3 PQRI measures;
• Report each measure for at least 80% of the eligible professional’s
Medicare Part B FFS patients seen during the reporting period to
whom the measure applies; and
• Report at least 1 PQRI measure on at least 15 Medicare Part B
FFS patients seen during the reporting period to which the measure applies.
• Report at least 3 PQRI measures;
• Report each measure for at least 80% of the eligible professional’s
Medicare Part B FFS patients seen during the reporting period to
whom the measure applies; and
• Report at least 1 PQRI measure on at least 8 Medicare Part B
FFS patients seen during the reporting period to which the measure applies.
• Report at least 3 PQRI measures;
• Report each measure for at least 80% of the eligible professional’s
Medicare Part B FFS patients seen during the reporting period to
whom the measure applies; and
• Report at least 1 PQRI measure on at least 15 Medicare Part B
FFS patients seen during the reporting period to which the measure applies.
Registry-based reporting
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Registry-based reporting
EHR-based reporting ....
VerDate Nov<24>2008
21:30 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00049
Fmt 4701
Reporting period
Sfmt 4702
January 1, 2010–December 31, 2010.
January 1, 2010–December 31, 2010.
July 1, 2010–December 31, 2010.
January 1, 2010–December 31, 2010.
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33568
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
As illustrated in Table 14, there are a
total of 4 proposed reporting options, or
ways in which an eligible professional
may meet the criteria for satisfactory
reporting on individual quality
measures for the 2010 PQRI. Each
reporting option consists of the criteria
for satisfactorily reporting such data and
results on individual quality measures
relevant to a given reporting mechanism
and reporting period. While eligible
professionals may potentially qualify as
satisfactorily reporting individual
quality measures under more than one
of the proposed reporting criteria,
proposed reporting mechanisms, and/or
for more than one proposed reporting
period, only one incentive payment
would be made to an eligible
professional based on the longest
reporting period for which the eligible
professional satisfactorily reports.
f. Proposed Criteria for Satisfactory
Reporting Measures Groups for
Individual Eligible Professionals
As described above, section
1848(m)(5)(F) of the Act requires that,
for 2008 and subsequent years, the
Secretary establish alternative reporting
periods and alternative criteria for
satisfactorily reporting groups of
measures. In establishing these
alternatives in prior years, we have
labeled these groups of measures
‘‘measures groups.’’ We have previously
defined ‘‘measures groups’’ as a subset
of four or more PQRI measures that have
a particular clinical condition or focus
in common. The denominator definition
and coding of the measures group
identifies the condition or focus that is
shared across the measures within a
particular measures group.
In the 2008 and 2009 PQRI, measures
groups were reportable through claimsbased or registry-based reporting. For
the 2008 and 2009 PQRI, there were 2
basic sets of criteria for satisfactory
reporting measures groups through
claims-based or registry-based reporting:
(1) The reporting of at least 1 measures
group for at least 80 percent of patients
to whom the measures group applies
during the reporting period; or (2) the
reporting of at least 1 measures group
for a specified number of consecutive
patients to whom the measures group
applies during the reporting period. For
registry-based reporting in the 2008 and
2009 PQRI, we allowed eligible
professionals to include some nonMedicare Part B FFS patients in the
consecutive patient sample under the
second set of criteria. For registry-based
reporting quality measures results and
numerator and denominator data on
measures groups in 2009, we also added
to the first set of criteria a requirement
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
to report the measures group on a
minimum number of patients
commensurate with the reporting period
duration.
For the 2010 PQRI, we again propose
2 basic sets of criteria for satisfactory
reporting on measures group. Both sets
of criteria would apply to the claimsbased and registry-based reporting
mechanism. As discussed in section
II.G.2.d.(3) of this proposed rule, we are
not proposing to make the EHR-based
reporting mechanism available for
reporting on measures groups in 2010.
The first set of proposed criteria,
which we propose to make available for
either the 12-month or 6-month
reporting period in 2010, would be
consistent with the 2009 criteria for
satisfactory reporting of measures
groups through registry-based reporting,
which require the reporting of at least 1
measures group for at least 80 percent
of patients to whom the measures group
applies during the applicable reporting
period (with reporting required on a
minimum number of Medicare Part B
FFS patients commensurate with the
reporting period duration). In the 2009
PQRI, there was a requirement under
these criteria to report each measures
group on at least 30 Medicare Part B
FFS patients for the 12-month reporting
period and at least 15 Medicare Part B
FFS patients for the 6-month reporting
period for registry-based reporting of
measures groups. For the 2010 PQRI, we
propose to revise the requirement by
making these criteria applicable to both
registry-based and claims-based
reporting and to change the number of
Medicare Part B FFS patients on which
an eligible professional would be
required to report a measures group. We
propose to require an eligible
professional who chooses to report on
measures groups based on reporting on
80 percent of applicable patients to
report on a minimum of 15 Medicare
Part B FFS patients for the 12-month
reporting period and a minimum of 8
Medicare Part B FFS patients for the 6month reporting period, regardless of
whether the eligible professional
chooses to report the measures group
through claims-based reporting or
registry-based reporting. We propose to
revise the required minimum sample
size to make the proposed 2010 criteria
for satisfactory reporting of measures
groups consistent with the proposed
2010 criteria for satisfactory reporting of
individual measures. We invite
comments on our proposal to make the
criteria for satisfactory reporting of
measures groups more consistent with
those proposed for reporting individual
measures. We especially would be
interested in comments with respect to
PO 00000
Frm 00050
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
our proposal to revise the minimum
sample size requirement related to
satisfactory reporting on measures group
through the registry-based reporting
mechanism so that the criteria for
satisfactory reporting of measures
groups, regardless of reporting
mechanism, would be identical to those
proposed for reporting individual
measures.
The second set of proposed criteria,
which we propose to make available for
the 12-month reporting period only,
would be based on reporting on a
measures group on a specified
minimum number of patients. The
second set of criteria would require
reporting on at least 1 measures group
for at least 30 patients seen between
January 1, 2010 and December 31, 2010
to whom the measures group applies.
Unlike the 2009 PQRI, which required
that eligible professionals report on
consecutive patients (that is, patients
seen in order, by date of service), the 30
patients on which an eligible
professional would need to report a
measures group for 2010 would not
need to be consecutive patients. The
eligible professional would be able to
report on any 30 patients seen during
the reporting period to which the
measures group applies. We propose to
remove the requirement to report on
patients seen consecutively by date of
service because our preliminary analysis
of the 2008 PQRI claims-based reporting
experience through September 2008
suggests that this requirement is
difficult for professionals to apply
accurately to meet the criteria for
satisfactory reporting of measures
groups. In addition, the questions we
receive from eligible professionals
indicate that many eligible professionals
are not clear on how to determine which
patients are ‘‘consecutive’’ and should
be included in the patient sample. We
believe that any adverse effect on the
reliability or validity of the quality
information received as a result of the
removal of the requirement to report on
patients seen consecutively and
allowing eligible professionals to report
on any 30 patients would be minimal.
When eligible professionals report
measures groups, they are required to
report on multiple measures for a given
clinical condition or focus, which
makes it harder for them to selectively
choose patients in an attempt to
improve their performance results. We
invite comments on our proposal to
allow eligible professionals to report on
measures groups on any 30 patients
rather than a consecutive patient
sample.
As in previous years, we propose that
for 2010, the patients, for claims-based
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
reporting, would be limited to Medicare
Part B FFS patients. We receive claims
on Medicare patients only. For registrybased reporting, however, we propose
that the patients could include some,
but not be exclusively, non-Medicare
Part B FFS patients.
The proposed 2010 criteria for
satisfactory reporting on measures
groups are summarized in Table 15,
33569
which is arranged by reporting
mechanism and reporting period.
TABLE 15—PROPOSED 2010 CRITERIA FOR SATISFACTORY REPORTING ON MEASURES GROUPS, BY REPORTING
MECHANISM AND REPORTING PERIOD
Reporting mechanism
Reporting criteria
Reporting period
Claims-based reporting ........
• Report at least 1 PQRI measures group;
Claims-based reporting ........
• Report each measures group for at least 30 Medicare Part B FFS patients.
• Report at least 1 PQRI measures group;
Claims-based reporting ........
• Report each measures group for at least 80% of the eligible professional’s Medicare Part B FFS patients seen during the reporting period to whom the measures
group applies; and
• Report each measures group on at least 15 Medicare Part B FFS patients seen
during the reporting period to which the measures group applies.
• Report at least 1 PQRI measures group;
Registry-based reporting ......
• Report each measures group for at least 80% of the eligible professional’s Medicare Part B FFS patients seen during the reporting period to whom the measures
group applies; and
• Report each measures group on at least 8 Medicare Part B FFS patients seen
during the reporting period to which the measures group applies.
• Report at least 1 PQRI measures group;
Registry-based reporting ......
• Report each measures group for at least 30 patients. Patients may include, but
may not be exclusively, non-Medicare Part B FFS patients.
• Report at least 1 PQRI measures group;
Registry-based reporting ......
• Report each measures group for at least 80% of the eligible professional’s Medicare Part B FFS patients seen during the reporting period to whom the measures
group applies; and
• Report each measures group on at least 15 Medicare Part B FFS patients seen
during the reporting period to which the measures group applies.
• Report at least 1 PQRI measures group;
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
• Report each measures group for at least 80 % of the eligible professional’s Medicare Part B FFS patients seen during the reporting period to whom the measures
group applies; and
• Report each measures group on at least 8 Medicare Part B FFS patients seen
during the reporting period to which the measures group applies.
As illustrated in Table 15, there are a
total of 6 proposed reporting options, or
ways in which an eligible professional
may meet the proposed criteria for
satisfactory reporting of measures
groups for the 2010 PQRI. Each
reporting option consists of the criteria
for satisfactory reporting relevant to a
given reporting mechanism and
reporting period. As stated previously,
while eligible professionals may
potentially qualify as satisfactorily
reporting on measures groups under
more than one of the proposed reporting
criteria, proposed reporting
mechanisms, and/or for more than one
proposed reporting period, only one
incentive payment would be made to an
eligible professional based on the
longest reporting period for which the
eligible professional satisfactorily
reports.
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
g. Proposed Reporting Option for
Satisfactory Reporting on Quality
Measures by Group Practices
As stated previously, section
1848(m)(3)(C)(i) of the Act requires the
Secretary to establish and have in place
a process by January 1, 2010 under
which eligible professionals in a group
practice (as defined by the Secretary)
shall be treated as satisfactorily
submitting data on quality measures
under PQRI if, in lieu of reporting
measures under PQRI, the group
practice reports measures determined
appropriate by the Secretary, such as
measures that target high-cost chronic
conditions and preventive care, in a
form and manner, and at a time
specified by the Secretary. Section
1848(m)(3)(C)(ii) of the Act requires that
this process provide for the use of a
statistical sampling model to submit
data on measures, such as the model
PO 00000
Frm 00051
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
January 1, 2010–December
31, 2010.
January 1, 2010–December
31, 2010.
July 1, 2010–December 31,
2010.
January 1, 2010–December
31, 2010.
January 1, 2010–December
31, 2010.
January 1, 2010–December
31, 2010.
July 1, 2010–December 31,
2010.
used under the Medicare Physician
Group Practice (PGP) demonstration
project under section 1866A of the Act.
In addition, payments to a group
practice under section 1848(m) of the
Act by reason of the process proposed
herein shall be in lieu of the PQRI
incentive payments that would
otherwise be made to eligible
professionals in the group practice for
satisfactorily submitting data on quality
measures (that is, prohibits double
payments). Therefore, in addition to
making incentive payments for 2010 to
group practices based on separately
analyzing whether the individual
eligible professionals within the group
practice (that is, for each TIN/NPI
combination) satisfactorily reported on
PQRI quality measures, we will begin
making incentive payments to group
practices based on the determination
that the group practice, as a whole (that
is, for the TIN), satisfactorily reports on
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33570
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
PQRI quality measures for 2010. In
addition, an individual eligible
professional who is affiliated with a
group practice participating in the group
practice reporting option that
satisfactorily reports under the proposed
group practice reporting option would
not be eligible to earn a separate PQRI
incentive payment for 2010 on the basis
of his or her satisfactorily reporting
PQRI quality measures data at the
individual level.
(1) Definition of ‘‘Group Practice’’
As stated above, section
1848(m)(3)(C)(i) of the Act authorizes
the Secretary to define ‘‘group practice.’’
For purposes of determining whether a
group practice satisfactorily submits
PQRI quality measures data, we propose
that a ‘‘group practice’’ would consist of
a physician group practice, as defined
by a TIN, with at least 200 or more
individual eligible professionals (or, as
identified by NPIs) who have reassigned
their billing rights to the TIN.
Generally, our intent is to build on an
existing quality reporting program that
group practices may already be familiar
with by modeling the PQRI group
practice reporting option after the PGP
demonstration. Since the PGP
demonstration is a demonstration
program for large group practices, one of
the requirements for group practices
participating in the PGP demonstration
is for each practice to have 200 or more
members. To be consistent with the PGP
demonstration, we also propose to limit
initial implementation of the PQRI
group practice reporting option for 2010
to similar large group practices. As we
gain more experience with the group
practice reporting option, we may
consider lowering the group size
threshold in the future. We invite
comments on the proposed definition of
‘‘group practice’’ and our proposal to
limit initial implementation of the PQRI
group practice reporting option in 2010
to practices with 200 or more individual
eligible professionals.
In order to participate in the 2010
PQRI through the group practice
reporting option, we propose to require
group practices to complete a selfnomination process and to meet certain
technical and other requirements. Group
practices interested in participating in
the 2010 PQRI through the group
practice reporting option would be
required to submit a self-nomination
letter to CMS or a CMS designee
requesting to participate in the 2010
PQRI group practice reporting option.
We propose that each group practice
would be required to meet the following
requirements:
• Have an active Individuals Access
to CMS Systems (IACS) user account;
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
• Provide CMS or a CMS designee
with the group practice’s TIN and the
NPI numbers and names of all eligible
professionals who will be participating
as part of the group practice (that is, all
individual NPI numbers associated with
the group practice’s TIN). This
information must be provided in an
electronic format specified by CMS,
such as in an Excel spreadsheet; and
• Agree to have the group practice’s
PQRI quality measurement performance
rates for each measure publicly reported
by posting of the results on a CMS Web
site.
We propose to post the final
participation requirements for group
practices, including the exact date by
which group practices that wish to
participate in the 2010 PQRI through the
group practice reporting option must
submit a self-nomination letter and
other instructions for submitting the
self-nomination letter, on the PQRI
section of the CMS Web site at https://
www.cms.hhs.gov/PQRI by November
15, 2009. We anticipate that group
practices that wish to self-nominate for
2010 will be required to do so by the
end of the first quarter of 2010, but not
later than the end of the second quarter
of 2010. Upon receipt of the selfnomination letters we will assess
whether the participation requirements
proposed above have been met by each
self-nominated group practice.
(2) Process for Physician Group
Practices To Participate as Group
Practices and Criteria for Satisfactory
Reporting Data on Quality Measures by
Group Practices
For physician groups selected to
participate in the PQRI group practice
reporting option for 2010, we propose
the reporting period would be the 12month reporting period beginning
January 1, 2010. We propose that group
practices would be required to submit
information on these measures using a
data collection tool based on the data
collection tool used in CMS’ Medicare
Care Management Performance (MCMP)
demonstration and the quality
measurement and reporting methods
used in CMS’ PGP demonstration. We
propose that physician groups selected
to participate in the 2010 PQRI through
the group practice reporting option
would be required to report on a
common set of 26 NQF-endorsed quality
measures that are based on measures
currently used in the MCMP and/or PGP
demonstration and that target high-cost
chronic conditions and preventive care.
These quality measures are identified in
Table 34. Additional information on the
MCMP and PGP demonstrations is
posted on the Medicare Demonstrations
PO 00000
Frm 00052
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
section of the CMS Web site at https://
www.cms.hhs.gov/
DemoProjectsEvalRpts/MD/
list.asp#TopOfPage. Although our
proposed process for physician groups
to participate in PQRI as a group
practice incorporates some
characteristics and methods from the
PGP demonstration and the MCMP
demonstration, the PQRI group practice
reporting option will be a separate
program with its own specifications and
methodology from the PGP and MCMP
demonstration programs.
The proposed quality measures
identified in Table 34 are based on a
subset of the Doctor’s Office Quality
(DOQ) quality measures set developed
and specified under the direction of
CMS and which are used in the PGP
and/or MCMP demonstration programs.
Contributors to the development of the
DOQ measure set included the
American Medical Association’s
Physician Consortium for Performance
Improvement (AMA-PCPI), the
American College of Cardiology (ACC),
the American Heart Association (AHA),
the National Diabetes Quality
Improvement Alliance, the National
Committee for Quality Assurance
(NCQA), and the Veterans Health
Administration (VA) and, in most
instances, overlap with proposed 2010
PQRI measures. These quality measures
are grouped into four disease modules:
diabetes; heart failure; coronary artery
disease; and preventive care services.
As part of the data submission
process, we propose that, beginning in
2011, each group practice would be
required to report quality measures with
respect to services furnished during the
2010 reporting period (that is, January 1,
2010 through December 31, 2010) on an
assigned sample of Medicare
beneficiaries. We propose to analyze the
January 1, 2010 through October 29,
2010 (that is, the last business day of
October 2010) National Claims History
(NCH) file to assign Medicare
beneficiaries to each physician group
practice using the same patient
assignment methodology used in the
PGP demonstration. Assigned
beneficiaries are limited to those
Medicare FFS beneficiaries with
Medicare Parts A and B for whom
Medicare is the primary payer. Assigned
beneficiaries do not include Medicare
Advantage enrollees. Essentially, a
beneficiary would be assigned to the
physician group that provides the
plurality of a beneficiary’s office or
other outpatient E/M allowed charges
(based on Medicare Part B claims
submitted for the beneficiary for dates of
services between January 1, 2010 and
October 29, 2010). Beneficiaries with
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
only 1 visit to the group practice
between January 1, 2010 and October
29, 2010 would be eliminated from the
group practice’s assigned patient
sample. Once the beneficiary
assignment has been made for each
physician group, each physician group
would be required to report the quality
measures on a random sample of the
assigned beneficiaries per disease
module or preventive care measure. For
each disease module or preventive care
measure, the physician group would be
required to report information on the
assigned patients in the order in which
they appear in the group’s sample (that
is, consecutively). In the fourth quarter
of 2010, we would pull a random
sample of assigned beneficiaries for
each disease module or preventive care
measure and provide the sample to the
physician group consistent with the
methods used in the PGP
demonstration. Identical to the sampling
method used in the PGP demonstration,
the random sample must consist of at
least 411 assigned beneficiaries. If the
pool of eligible assigned beneficiaries is
less than 411, then the group practice
must report on 100 percent of the
assigned beneficiaries to participate in
the group practice reporting option.
We propose a unique reporting
mechanism for the group practice
reporting option that would not be
available to individual eligible
professionals participating in the 2010
PQRI. We propose that each physician
group selected to participate in the
group practice reporting option would
have access to a database (that is, a data
collection tool) that would include the
assigned beneficiary sample and the
quality measures. This data collection
tool was originally developed for use in
the PGP demonstration, updated for use
in the MCMP demonstration, and would
be updated as needed for use in the
PQRI. The assigned beneficiaries’
demographic and utilization
information would be prepopulated
based on claims data. We anticipate
being able to provide the selected
physician groups with access to this
prepopulated database by the fourth
quarter of 2010. The physician group
would be required to populate the
remaining data fields necessary for
capturing quality measure information
on each of the assigned beneficiaries.
Numerators for each of the quality
measures would include all
beneficiaries in the denominator
population who also satisfy the quality
performance criteria for that measure.
Denominators for each quality measure
would include a sample of the assigned
beneficiaries who meet the eligibility
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
criteria for that quality measure module
or preventive care measure.
We invite comments on our proposal
to adopt the PGP demonstration’s
quality measurement and reporting
methods for the PQRI group practice
reporting option. We specifically
request comments on the proposed
patient assignment methodology and
our proposal to use a data collection
tool based on the one used in the MCMP
demonstration as the reporting
mechanism for physician groups
selected to participate in the PQRI group
practice reporting option.
We propose 2 criteria for satisfactory
reporting of quality measures by a
physician group. First, the physician
group would be required to report
completely on all of the proposed
modules and measures listed in Table
34. Second, the physician group would
be required to report on the first 411
consecutively assigned Medicare
beneficiaries per disease module or
preventive care measure. This is
identical to the reporting criteria used in
the PGP demonstration. By building on
an existing demonstration program that
large group practices may already have
experience with, we hope to minimize
burden on both group practices and
CMS. The sample that we pull for and
provide to each physician group would
include more than the 411 assigned
beneficiaries (the sample would include
an over sample of approximately 50
percent). More beneficiaries are
provided in the sample than the group
practice is required to report on in order
to account for beneficiaries included in
the sample who cannot be confirmed
with the diagnosis for a particular
disease module or whose medical
information may not be able to be
located within the physician group’s
systems.
h. Statutory Requirements and Other
Considerations for Measures Proposed
for Inclusion in the 2010 PQRI
(1) Statutory Requirements for Measures
Proposed for Inclusion in the 2010 PQRI
As a result of section 131(b) of the
MIPPA, the statutory requirements with
respect to the use of quality measures
for the 2010 PQRI are different from the
statutory requirements for previous
program years. For the 2007 PQRI,
section 1848(k)(2)(A)(i) of the Act
required the Secretary to generally
select the quality measures identified as
2007 physician quality measures under
the Physician Voluntary Reporting
Program. For the 2008 and 2009 PQRI,
section 1848(k)(2)(B) of the Act required
that the quality measures be measures
that have been adopted or endorsed by
PO 00000
Frm 00053
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33571
a consensus organization (such as the
National Quality Forum or AQA), that
include measures that have been
submitted by a physician specialty, and
that the Secretary identifies as having
used a consensus-based process for
developing such measures. For purposes
of reporting data on quality measures for
covered professional services furnished
during 2010 and subsequent years for
the PQRI, subject to the exception noted
below, section 1848(k)(2)(C)(i) of the
Act, as added by MIPPA, requires that
the quality measures shall be such
measures selected by the Secretary from
measures that have been endorsed by
the entity with a contract with the
Secretary under subsection 1890(a) of
the Act, as added by section 183 of the
MIPPA. On January 14, 2009, the U.S.
Department of Health and Human
Services awarded the contract required
under section 1890(a) of the Act to the
National Quality Forum (NQF).
In the case of a specified area or
medical topic determined appropriate
by the Secretary for which a feasible and
practical measure has not been endorsed
by the NQF, however, section
1848(k)(2)(C)(ii) of the Act authorizes
the Secretary to specify a measure that
is not so endorsed as long as due
consideration is given to measures that
have been endorsed or adopted by a
consensus organization identified by the
Secretary, such as the AQA alliance. In
light of these statutory requirements, we
believe that, except in certain specified
circumstances, each proposed 2010
PQRI quality measure would need to be
endorsed by the NQF by July 1, 2009.
In those circumstances in which a
feasible and practical measure has not
been endorsed by the NQF, we believe
that all other proposed 2010 PQRI
quality measures would need to have at
least been adopted by the AQA or
another organization with comparable
consensus-organization characteristics.
However, in January 2009, the AQA
announced that it will no longer be
adopting measures and we are not aware
of any other organizations with
consensus-organization characteristics
(see 73 FR 38565 through 38566 for
discussion of the considerations applied
in determining whether an entity is a
consensus organization). Therefore, our
policy with respect to identifying
exceptions under section
1848(k)(2)(C)(ii) of the Act would be to
give due consideration to measures that
have been endorsed by the NQF. As a
result, in reviewing measures for
possible inclusion in the 2010 PQRI
quality measure set, we propose that
any new quality measures proposed for
the 2010 PQRI must be NQF-endorsed
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33572
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
by July 1, 2009, while any proposed
2010 PQRI quality measures selected
from the 2009 PQRI quality measure set
would need to have been adopted by the
AQA as of January 31, 2009, if the
measure still is not endorsed by the
NQF by July 1, 2009.
In addition, section 1848(k)(2)(D) of
the Act requires that for each 2010 PQRI
quality measure, ‘‘the Secretary shall
ensure that eligible professionals have
the opportunity to provide input during
the development, endorsement, or
selection of measures applicable to
services they furnish.’’ Measure
developers generally include a public
comment phase in their measure
development process. As part of the
measure development process, measure
developers typically solicit public
comments on measures that they are
testing in order to determine whether
additional refinement of the measure(s)
is needed prior to submission for
consensus endorsement. For example,
information on the measure
development process employed by us
when CMS or a CMS contractor is the
measure developer is available in the
‘‘Measures Management System
Blueprint’’ found on the CMS Web site
at https://www.cms.hhs.gov/apps/QMIS/
mmsBlueprint.asp.
Eligible professionals also have the
opportunity to provide input on a
measure as the measure is being vetted
through the NQF consensus
endorsement process (and previously,
the AQA consensus adoption process).
In particular, the NQF employs a public
comment period for measures vetted
through its consensus endorsement
process (and previously, for the AQA,
its consensus adoption process).
Finally, eligible professionals have an
opportunity to provide input on the
measures proposed for inclusion in the
2010 PQRI through this proposed rule,
which provides a 60-day comment
period. Accordingly, with regard to the
2010 PQRI, we believe we have satisfied
this requirement in multiple ways.
(2) Other Considerations for Measures
Proposed for Inclusion in the 2010 PQRI
Consistent with the statutory
requirements described in section
II.G.2.h.(1) of this proposed rule, we
propose to apply the following
considerations with respect to the
selection of 2009 PQRI quality measures
proposed for inclusion in the 2010 PQRI
quality measure set:
• Where some 2009 PQRI quality
measures have been endorsed by the
NQF and others have not, those 2009
PQRI quality measures that have been
specifically considered by NQF for
possible endorsement, but NQF has
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
declined to endorse it, are not proposed
for inclusion in the 2010 PQRI quality
measure set (that is, we propose to retire
the measure for 2010).
• In circumstances where no NQFendorsed measure is available, we
propose to exercise the exception under
section 1848(k)(2)(C)(ii) of the Act.
Under these circumstances, a 2009 PQRI
quality measure that previously (that is,
prior to January 31, 2009) has been
adopted by the AQA would meet the
requirements under the Act and we
propose that it would be appropriate for
eligible professionals to use the measure
to submit quality measures data and/or
quality measures results and numerator
and denominator data on quality
measures, as appropriate.
• Although we do not propose to
include any 2009 PQRI measures that
have not been endorsed by the NQF or
adopted by the AQA in the final 2010
PQRI quality measure set, we
acknowledge that section 1848(k)(C)(ii)
of the Act provides an exception to the
requirement that the Secretary select
measures that have been endorsed by
the entity with a contract under section
1890(a) of the Act (that is, the NQF) as
long as an area or medical topic for
which a feasible and practical NQFendorsed measure is not available has
been identified and due consideration
has been given to measures that have
been endorsed by the NQF and/or, prior
to January 31, 2009, adopted by the
AQA.
• The statutory requirements under
section 1848(k)(2)(C) of the Act, subject
to the exception noted above, require
only that the measures be selected from
measures that have been endorsed by
the entity with a contract with the
Secretary under section 1890(a) (that is,
the NQF) and are silent with respect to
how the measures that are submitted to
the NQF for endorsement were
developed. The basic steps for
developing measures applicable to
physicians and other eligible
professionals prior to submission of the
measures for endorsement may be
carried out by a variety of different
organizations. We do not believe there
needs to be any special restrictions on
the type or make up of the organizations
carrying out this basic development of
physician measures, such as restricting
the initial development to physiciancontrolled organizations. Any such
restriction would unduly limit the basic
development of quality measures and
the scope and utility of measures that
may be considered for endorsement as
voluntary consensus standards.
• 2009 PQRI measures that were part
of the 2007 and/or 2008 PQRI in which
the 2007 and 2008 PQRI analytics
PO 00000
Frm 00054
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
indicate a lack of significant reporting
and usage were not considered for
inclusion in the 2010 PQRI.
In addition to reviewing the 2009
PQRI measures and previously retired
measures, for purposes of developing
the proposed 2010 PQRI measures, we
have reviewed and considered measure
suggestions including comments
received in response to the CY 2009 PFS
proposed rule and final rule with
comment period. Additionally,
suggestions and input received through
other venues, such as an invitation for
measures suggestions posted on the
PQRI section of the CMS Web site in
February 2009 were also reviewed and
considered for purposes of our
development of the list of proposed
2010 PQRI quality measures.
With respect to the selection of new
measures (that is, measures that have
never been selected as part of a PQRI
quality measure set for 2009 or any prior
year), we propose to apply the following
considerations, which include many of
the same considerations applied to the
selection of 2009 PQRI quality measures
for proposed inclusion in the 2010 PQRI
quality measure set described above:
• High Impact on Healthcare.
• Measures that are high impact and
support CMS and HHS priorities for
improved quality and efficiency of care
for Medicare beneficiaries. These
current and long term priority topics
include: Prevention; chronic conditions;
high cost and high volume conditions;
elimination of health disparities;
healthcare-associated infections and
other conditions; improved care
coordination; improved efficiency;
improved patient and family experience
of care; improved end-of-life/palliative
care; effective management of acute and
chronic episodes of care; reduced
unwarranted geographic variation in
quality and efficiency; and adoption and
use of interoperable HIT.
• Measures that are included in, or
facilitate alignment with, other
Medicare, Medicaid, and CHIP programs
in furtherance of overarching healthcare
goals.
• NQF Endorsement.
+ Measures must be NQF-endorsed
by July 1, 2009 in order to be considered
for inclusion in the 2010 PQRI quality
measure set.
+ Although we do not propose to
include any new measures that are not
endorsed by the NQF by July 1, 2009 in
the final 2010 PQRI quality measure set,
we acknowledge that section (k)(2)(C)(ii)
of the Act provides an exception to the
requirement that the Secretary select
measures that have been endorsed by
the entity with a contract under section
1890(a) of the Act (that is, the NQF). As
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
long as an area or medical topic for
which a feasible and practical NQFendorsed measure is not available has
been identified and due consideration
has been given to measures that have
been adopted by the AQA or other
consensus organization identified by
Secretary.
+ The statutory requirements under
section 1848(k)(2)(C) of the Act, subject
to the exception noted above, require
only that the measures be selected from
measures that have been endorsed by
the entity with a contract with the
Secretary under section 1890(a) (that is,
the NQF) and are silent with respect to
how the measures that are submitted to
the NQF for endorsement were
developed. The basic steps for
developing measures applicable to
physicians and other eligible
professionals prior to submission of the
measures for endorsement may be
carried out by a variety of different
organizations. We do not believe there
needs to be any special restrictions on
the type or make up of the organizations
carrying out this basic development of
physician measures, such as restricting
the initial development to physiciancontrolled organizations. Any such
restriction would unduly limit the basic
development of quality measures and
the scope and utility of measures that
may be considered for endorsement as
voluntary consensus standards. The
requirements under section
1848(k)(2)(C) of the Act pertain only to
the selection of measures and not to the
development of measures.
• Address Gaps in PQRI Measure Set.
+ Measures that increase the scope of
applicability of the PQRI measures to
services furnished to Medicare
beneficiaries and expand opportunities
for eligible professionals to participate
in PQRI. We seek to achieve broad
ability to assess the quality of care
furnished to Medicare beneficiaries, and
ultimately to compare performance
among professionals. We seek to
increase the circumstances where
eligible professionals have at least 3
measures applicable to their practice
and measures that help expand the
number of measures groups with at least
four measures in a group.
• Measures of various aspects of
clinical quality including outcome
measures, where appropriate and
feasible, process measures, structural
measures, efficiency measures, and
measures of patient experience of care.
Other considerations that we propose
to apply to the selection of measures for
2010, regardless of whether the measure
is a 2009 PQRI measure or not, are:
• Measures that are functional, which
is to say measures that can be
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
technically implemented within the
capacity of the CMS infrastructure for
data collection, analysis, and
calculation of reporting and
performance rates. This leads to
preference for measures that reflect
readiness for implementation, such as
those that are currently in the 2009
PQRI program or have been through
testing. The purpose of measure testing
is to reveal the measure’s strengths and
weaknesses so that the limitations can
be addressed and the measure refined
and strengthened prior to
implementation. For new measures,
preference is given to those that can be
most efficiently implemented for data
collection and submission. Therefore,
any measures that have been found to be
technically impractical to report
because they are analytically
challenging due to any number of
factors, including those that are claimsbased, have not been included in the
2010 PQRI. For example, in some cases,
we have proposed to replace existing
2009 PQRI measures with updated and
improved measures that are less
technically challenging to report.
• For some measures that are useful,
but where data submission is not
feasible through all otherwise available
PQRI reporting mechanisms, a measure
may be included for reporting solely
through specific reporting mechanism(s)
in which its submission is feasible. For
example, we are proposing to limit
reporting of some measures that
previously were available for claimsbased reporting and registry-based
reporting to registry-based reporting
only because they were technically
challenging to report and/or analyze
through the claims-based reporting
mechanism. For further discussion of
the proposed reporting mechanisms, see
section II.G.2.d. of this proposed rule.
We also reviewed 33 measures that
have been retired from the PQRI in
previous years using the considerations
for selecting proposed measures for the
2010 PQRI discussed above. None were
found to be eligible for inclusion in the
2010 PQRI quality measure set because
they did not meet the criteria described
above.
We welcome comments on the
implication of including or excluding
any given measure or measures
proposed herein in the final 2010 PQRI
quality measure set and on our
approach in selecting measures. We
recognize that some commenters may
also wish to recommend additional
measures for inclusion in the 2010 PQRI
measures that we have not herein
proposed. While we welcome all
constructive comments and suggestions,
and may consider such recommended
PO 00000
Frm 00055
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33573
measures for inclusion in future
measure sets for PQRI and/or other
programs to which such measures may
be relevant, we will not be able to
consider such additional measures for
inclusion in the 2010 measure set.
As discussed above, section
1848(k)(2)(D) of the Act requires that the
public have the opportunity to provide
input during the selection of measures.
We also are required by other applicable
statutes to provide opportunity for
public comment on provisions of policy
or regulation that are established via
notice and comment rulemaking.
Measures that were not included in this
proposed rule for inclusion in the 2010
PQRI that are recommended to CMS via
comments on this proposed rule have
not been placed before the public with
opportunity for the public to comment
on the selection of those measures
within the rulemaking process. Even
when measures have been published in
the Federal Register, but in other
contexts and not specifically proposed
as PQRI measures, such publication
does not provide true opportunity for
public comment on those measures’
potential inclusion in PQRI. Thus, such
additional measures recommended for
selection for the 2010 PQRI via
comments on this proposed rule cannot
be included in the 2010 measure set.
However, as discussed above, we will
consider comments and
recommendations for measures, which
may not be applicable to the final set of
2010 PQRI measures, for purposes of
identifying measures for possible use in
future years’ PQRI or other initiatives to
which those measures may be pertinent.
In addition, as in prior years, we note
that we do not use notice and comment
rulemaking as a means to update or
modify measure specifications. Quality
measures that have completed the
consensus process have a designated
party (usually, the measure developer/
owner) who has accepted responsibility
for maintaining the measure. In general,
it is the role of the measure owner,
developer, or maintainer to make
changes to a measure. Therefore,
comments requesting changes to a
specific proposed PQRI measure’s title,
definition, and detailed specifications or
coding should be directed to the
measure developer identified in Tables
16 through 34. Contact information for
the 2009 PQRI measure developers is
listed in the ‘‘2009 PQRI Quality
Measures List,’’ which is available on
the PQRI section of the CMS Web site
at https://www.cms.hhs.gov/PQRI.
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33574
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
i. Proposed 2010 PQRI Quality Measures
for Individual Eligible Professionals
As stated previously, individual
eligible professionals have the choice of
reporting PQRI quality measures data on
either individual quality measures or on
measures groups.
Consistent with the statutory
requirements for measures included in
the 2010 PQRI and other considerations
for identifying proposed 2010 quality
measures discussed in section
II.G.2.h.(1) and II.G.2.h.(2), respectively,
of this proposed rule, the individual
quality measures identified for use in
the 2010 PQRI will be selected from
those we propose in this rule and will
be finalized as of the date the CY 2010
PFS final rule with comment period
goes on display at the Office of the
Federal Register. No changes (that is,
additions or deletions of measures) will
be made after publication of the CY
2010 PFS final rule with comment
period. However, as was the case for
2008 and 2009, we may make
modifications or refinements, such as
revisions to measures titles and code
additions, corrections, or revisions to
the detailed specifications for the 2010
measures until the beginning of the
reporting period. Such specification
modifications may be made through the
last day preceding the beginning of the
reporting period. The 2010 measures
specifications for individual quality
measures will be available on the PQRI
section of the CMS Web site at https://
www.cms.hhs.gov/PQRI when they are
sufficiently developed or finalized. We
are targeting finalization and
publication of the detailed
specifications for all 2010 PQRI
measures on the PQRI section of the
CMS Web site by November 15, 2009
and will, in no event, publish these
specifications later than December 31,
2009. The detailed specifications will
include instructions for reporting and
identify the circumstances in which
each measure is applicable.
For 2010, we are proposing that final
PQRI quality measures will be selected
from 153 of the 2009 PQRI measures
and 149 measure suggestions received
in response to the February 2009
invitation to submit suggestions for
measures and measures groups for
possible inclusion in the 2010 PQRI
(that is, the ‘‘Call for 2010 Measure
Suggestions’’). We propose to include a
total of 168 measures (this includes both
individual measures and measures that
are part of a proposed 2010 measures
group) on which individual eligible
professionals can report for the 2010
PQRI. The individual PQRI quality
measures proposed for the 2010 PQRI
are listed in Tables 17 through 20 and
fall into four broad categories as set
forth below in this section. The four
categories are the following:
(1) Proposed 2010 Individual Quality
Measures Selected From the 2009 PQRI
Quality Measures Set Available for
Claims-based Reporting and RegistryBased Reporting;
(2) Proposed 2010 Individual Quality
Measures Selected From the 2009 PQRI
Quality Measures Set Available for
Registry-based Reporting Only;
(3) New Individual Quality Measures
Proposed for 2010; and
(4) Proposed 2010 Measures Available
for EHR-based Reporting.
In addition, we propose 13 measures
groups for 2010. The measures proposed
for inclusion in each of the proposed
2010 measures groups are listed in
Tables 21 through 33.
(1) Proposed 2010 Individual Quality
Measures Selected From the 2009 PQRI
Quality Measures Set Available for
Claims-based Reporting and Registrybased Reporting
After careful consideration of 2009
PQRI measures, we propose to retire 7
measures because they did not meet one
or more of the considerations for
selection of proposed 2010 measures
discussed in section II.G.2.h. of this
proposed rule. The measures, including
their Measure Number and Measure
Title, and the specific reason(s) we are
using as the basis for our proposal to
retire the measures are identified in
Table 16.
TABLE 16—2009 PQRI QUALITY MEASURES NOT PROPOSED FOR INCLUSION IN THE 2010 PQRI
Measure no.
Measure title
11 ..................
34 ..................
Stroke and Stroke Rehabilitation: Carotid Imagining Reporting
Stroke and Stroke Rehabilitation: Tissue Plasminogen Activator.
Otitis Media with Effusion (OME): Diagnostic Evaluation ..........
Otitis Media with Effusion (OME): Hearing Test ........................
Oncology: Medical and Radiation—Pain Intensity Quantified ....
Oncology: Medical and Radiation—Plan of Care for Pain .........
Coronary Artery Disease (CAD): Lipid Profile in Patients with
CAD.
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
94 ..................
95 ..................
143 ................
144 ................
152 ................
We propose to include in the 2010
PQRI quality measure set 116 of the
2009 PQRI measures, which would be
available for either claims-based
reporting or registry-based reporting as
individual quality measures. We note
that one of these proposed measures,
Measure #46 Medication Reconciliation:
Reconciliation After Discharge from an
Inpatient Facility, is reportable through
the registry-based reporting mechanism
only in the 2009 PQRI. However, for the
2010 PQRI, we propose to make this
measure available for either claimsbased reporting or registry-based
reporting. For the 2009 PQRI, registries
have reported difficulty capturing the
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
Reason for retirement
Analytically challenging / Replaced with another measure.
Analytically challenging / Replaced with another measure.
Lack of significant reporting.
Lack of significant reporting.
Analytically challenging.
Analytically challenging.
Declined for NQF Endorsement.
required information since the measure
requires the inpatient discharge to be
correlated to the outpatient visit.
Therefore, for the 2010 PQRI we
propose to make this measure available
for both claims-based and registry-based
reporting.
These 116 proposed measures do not
include any measures that are proposed
to be included as part of the 2010 Back
Pain measures group. Similar to the
2009 PQRI, we propose that any 2010
PQRI measure that is included in the
Back Pain measures group would not be
reportable as individual measures
through claims-based reporting or
registry-based reporting.
PO 00000
Frm 00056
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
The 116 individual 2009 PQRI
measures proposed for inclusion in the
2010 PQRI quality measure set as
individual quality measures for either
claims-based reporting or registry-based
reporting are listed by their Measure
Number and Title in Table 17, along
with the name of the measure’s
developer/owner, their NQF
endorsement status as of May 1, 2009,
and their AQA adoption status as of
January 31, 2009. The PQRI Measure
Number is a unique identifier assigned
by CMS to all measures in the PQRI
measure set. Once a PQRI Measure
Number is assigned to a measure, it will
not be used again to identify a different
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
measure, even if the original measure to
which the number was assigned is
subsequently retired from the PQRI
measure set. A description of the
proposed measures listed in Table 17
can be found in the ‘‘2009 PQRI Quality
Measures List,’’ which is available on
the Measures and Codes page of the
PQRI section of the CMS Web site at
https://www.cms.hhs.gov/PQRI.
33575
The 2009 measures that are proposed
to be available for registry-based
reporting only for the 2010 PQRI are
discussed and identified in section
II.G.2.i.(2) of this proposed rule.
TABLE 17—PROPOSED 2010 MEASURES SELECTED FROM THE 2009 PQRI QUALITY MEASURE SET AVAILABLE FOR
EITHER CLAIMS-BASED REPORTING OR REGISTRY-BASED REPORTING
NQF endorsement status as
of 5/1/09
Measure No.
Measure title
1 ..................
Diabetes Mellitus: Hemoglobin A1c Poor
Control in Diabetes Mellitus.
Diabetes Mellitus: Low Density Lipoprotein
(LDL–C) Control in Diabetes Mellitus.
Diabetes Mellitus: High Blood Pressure
Control in Diabetes Mellitus.
Coronary Artery Disease (CAD): Oral
Antiplatelet Therapy Perscribed for Patients with CAD.
Major
Depressive
Disorder
(MDD):
Antidepressant Medication During Acute
Phase for Patients with MDD.
Stroke and Stroke Rehabilitation: Computed
Tomography (CT) or Magnetic Resonance Imaging (MRI) Reports.
Primary Open Angle Glaucoma (POAG):
Optic Nerve Evaluation.
Age-Related macular Degeneration (AMD):
Dilated Macular Examination.
Diabetic Retinopathy: Documentation of
Presence or Absence of Macular Edema
and Level of Severity of Retinopathy.
Diabetic Retinopathy: Communication with
the Physician Managing On-going Diabetes Care.
Perioperative Care: Timing of Antibiotic Prophylaxis—Ordering Physician.
Perioperative Care: Selection of Prophylactic Antibiotic—First OR Second Generation Cephalosporin.
Perioperative Care: Discontinuation of Prophylactic Antibiotics (Non-Cardiac Procedures).
Perioperative Care: Venous Thromboembolism (VTE) Prophylaxis (When Indicated in ALL Patients).
Osteoporosis: Communication with the Physician Managing On-going Care Post
Fracture.
Aspirin at Arrival for Acute Myocardial Infarction (AMI).
Perioperative Care: Timing of Prophylactic
Antibiotics—Administering Physician.
Stroke and Stroke Rehabilitation: Deep Vein
Thrombosis
Prophylaxis
(DVT)
for
Ischemic Stroke or Intracranial Hemorrhage.
Stroke and Stroke Rehabilitation: Discharged on Antiplatelet Therapy.
Stroke and Stroke Rehabilitation: Screening
for Dysphagia.
Stroke and Stroke Rehabilitation: Consideration for Rehabilitation Services.
Screening or Therapy for Osteoporosis for
Women Aged 65 Years and Older.
Osteoporosis: Management Following Fracture.
Osteoporosis: Pharmacologic Therapy ........
Coronary Artery Bypass Graft (CABG): Use
of Internal Mammary Artery (IMA) in Patients with Isolated CABG Surgery.
2 ..................
3 ..................
6 ..................
9 ..................
10 ................
12 ................
14 ................
18 ................
19 ................
20 ................
21 ................
22 ................
23 ................
24 ................
28 ................
30 ................
31 ................
32 ................
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
35 ................
36 ................
39 ................
40 ................
41 ................
43 ................
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00057
AQA adoption
status as of
1/31/09
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
NCQA.
Yes ...................
No .....................
NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Society of Thoracic Surgeons (STS).
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
Measure developer
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33576
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
TABLE 17—PROPOSED 2010 MEASURES SELECTED FROM THE 2009 PQRI QUALITY MEASURE SET AVAILABLE FOR
EITHER CLAIMS-BASED REPORTING OR REGISTRY-BASED REPORTING—Continued
NQF endorsement status as
of 5/1/09
Measure No.
Measure title
44 ................
Coronary Artery Bypass Graft (CABG): Preoperative Beta-Blocker in Patients with
Isolated CABG Surgery.
Perioperative Care: Discontinuation of Prophylactic Antiobitics (Cardiac Procedures).
Medication Reconciliation: Reconciliation
After Discharge from an Inpatient Facility.
Advance Care Plan .......................................
Urinary Incontinence: Assessment of Presence or Absence of Urinary Incontinence
in Women Aged 6 Years and Older.
Urinary Incontinence: Characterization of
Urinary Incontinence in Women Aged 65
Years and Older.
Urinary Incontinence: Plan of Care for Urinary Incontinence in Women Aged 65
Years and Older.
Chronic Obstructive Pulmonary Disease
(COPD): Spirometry Evaluation.
Chronic Obstructive Pulmonary Disease
(COPD): Bronchodilator Therapy.
Asthma: Pharmacologic Therapy .................
12-Lead Electrocardiogram (ECG) Performed for Non-Traumatic Chest Pain.
12-Lead Electrocardiogram (ECG) Performed for Syncope.
Community-Acquired Pneumonia (CAP):
Vital Signs.
Community-Acquired Pneumonia (CAP): Assessment of Oxygen Saturation.
Community-Acquired Pneumonia (CAP): Assessment of Mental Status.
Community-Acquired Pneumonia (CAP):
Empiric Antibiotic.
Asthma: Asthma Assessment .......................
Treatment for Children with Upper Respiratory Infection (URI): Avoidance of Inappropriate Use.
Appropriate Testing for Children with Pharyngitis.
Myelodysplastic Syndrome (MDS) and
Acute Leukemias: Baseline Cytogenetic
Testing Performed on Bone Marrow.
Myelodysplastic Syndrome (MDS): Documentation of Iron Stores in Patients Receiving Erythropoietin Therapy.
Multiple
Myeloma:
Treatment
with
Bisphosphonates.
Chronic Lymphocytic Leukemia (CLL):
Baseline Flow Cytometry.
Breast Cancer: Hormonal Therapy for Stage
IC–IIIC Estrogen Receptor/Progesterone
Receptor (ER/PR) Positive Breast Cancer.
Colon Cancer: Chemotherapy for Stage III
Colon Cancer Patients.
Prevention of Catheter-Related Bloodstream
Infections (CRBSI): Central Venous Catheter (CVC) Insertion Protocol.
End Stage Renal Disease (ESRD): Influenza Immunization with Patients in ESRD.
Hepatitis C: Ribonucleic Acid (RNA) Testing
Before Initiating Treatment.
Hepatitis C: HCV Genotype Testing Prior to
Treatment.
Hepatitis C: Antiviral Treatment Prescribed
Hepatitis C: HCV Ribonucleic Acid (RNA)
Testing at Week 12 of Treatment.
Hepatitis C: Counseling Regarding Risk of
Alcohol Consumption.
45 ................
46 ................
47 ................
48 ................
49 ................
50 ................
51 ................
52 ................
53 ................
54 ................
55 ................
56 ................
57 ................
58 ................
59 ................
64 ................
65 ................
66 ................
67 ................
68 ................
69 ................
70 ................
71 ................
72 ................
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
76 ................
79 ................
84 ................
85 ................
86 ................
87 ................
89 ................
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00058
AQA adoption
status as of
1/31/09
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
STS.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
No .....................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
No .....................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/American
tology (ASH).
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/ASH.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/ASH.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/ASH.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/American Society of Clinical Oncology (ASCO)/National Comprehensive
Cancer Network (NCCN).
AMA–PCPI/ASCO/NCCN.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
Measure developer
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Society
of
Hema-
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
33577
TABLE 17—PROPOSED 2010 MEASURES SELECTED FROM THE 2009 PQRI QUALITY MEASURE SET AVAILABLE FOR
EITHER CLAIMS-BASED REPORTING OR REGISTRY-BASED REPORTING—Continued
NQF endorsement status as
of 5/1/09
Measure No.
Measure title
90 ................
Hepatitis C: Counseling Regarding Use of
Contraception Prior to Antiviral Therapy.
Acute Otitis Externa (ACE): Topical Therapy
Acute Otitis Externa (ACE): Pain Assessment.
Acute Otitis Externa (ACE): Systemic Antimicrobial Therapy—Avoidance of Inappropriate Use.
Breast Cancer Resection Pathology Reporting: pT Category (Primary Tumor) and pN
Category (Regional Lymph Nodes) with
Histologic Grade.
Colorectal Cancer Resection Pathology Reporting: pT Category (Primary Tumor) and
pN Category (Regional Lymph Nodes)
with Histologic Grace.
Prostate Cancer: Avoidance of Overuse of
Bone Scan for Staging Low-Risk Prostate
Cancer Patients.
Prostate Cancer: Adjuvant Hormonal Therapy for High-Risk Prostate Cancer Patients.
Prostate Cancer: Three-Dimensional (3D)
Radiotherapy.
Major Depressive Disorder (MDD): Diagnostic Evaluation.
Major Depressive Disorder (MDD): Suicide
Risk Assessment.
Rheumatoid Arthritis (RA): Disease Modifying Anti-Rheumatic Drug (DMARD)
Therapy.
Osteoarthritis: Function and Pain Assessment.
Preventive Care and Screening: Influenza
Immunization for Patients ≥50 Years Old.
Preventive Care and Screening: Pneumonia
Vaccination for Patients 65 Years and
Older.
Preventive Care and Screening: Screening
Mammography.
Preventive Care and Screening: Colorectal
Cancer Screening.
Preventive Care and Screening: Inquiry Regarding Tobacco Use.
Preventive Care and Screening: Advising
Smokers to Quit.
Antibiotic Treatment for Adults with Acute
Bronchitis: Avoidance of Inappropriate
Use.
Diabetes Mellitus: Dilated Eye Exam in Diabetic Patient.
Diabetes Mellitus: Urine Screening for
Microalbumin or Medical Attention for
Nephropathy in Diabetic Patients.
Chronic Kidney Disease (CKD): Laboratory
Testing (Calcium, Phosphorous, Intact
Parathyroid Hormone (iPTH) and Lipid
Profile).
Chronic Kidney Disease (CKD): Blood Pressure Management.
Chronic Kidney Disease (CKD): Plan of
Care—Elevated Hemoglobin for Patients
Receiving
Erythropoiesis-Stimulating
Agents (ESA).
Health Information Technology (HIT): Adoption/Use of Electronic Health Records
(EHR).
91 ................
92 ................
93 ................
99 ................
100 ..............
102 ..............
104 ..............
105 ..............
106 ..............
107 ..............
108 ..............
109 ..............
110 ..............
111 ..............
112 ..............
113 ..............
114 ..............
115 ..............
116 ..............
117 ..............
119 ..............
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
121 ..............
122 ..............
123 ..............
124 ..............
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00059
AQA adoption
status as of
1/31/09
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
No .....................
No .....................
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
AMA–PCPI.
No .....................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/College of American Pathologists (CAP).
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/CAP.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
No .....................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
No .....................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
No .....................
NCQA.
Yes ...................
No .....................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
No .....................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
NCQA.
Yes ...................
No .....................
NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
NCQA.
Yes ...................
No .....................
NCQA.
No .....................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
No .....................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
No .....................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
CMS/Quality Insights of Pennsylvania (QIP).
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
Measure developer
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33578
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
TABLE 17—PROPOSED 2010 MEASURES SELECTED FROM THE 2009 PQRI QUALITY MEASURE SET AVAILABLE FOR
EITHER CLAIMS-BASED REPORTING OR REGISTRY-BASED REPORTING—Continued
NQF endorsement status as
of 5/1/09
Measure No.
Measure title
126 ..............
Diabetes Mellitus: Diabetic Foot and Ankle
Care, Peripheral Neuropathy—Neurological Evaluation.
Diabetes Mellitus: Diabetic Foot and Ankle
Care, Ulcer Prevention—Evaluation of
Footwear.
Preventive Care and Screening: Body Mass
Index (BMI) Screening and Follow-Up.
Documentation and Verification of Current
Medications in the Medical Record.
Pain Assessment Prior to Initiation of Patient Therapy and Follow-Up.
Screening for Clinical Depression and Follow-Up Plan.
Chronic Kidney Disease (CKD): Influenza
Immunization.
Age-Related Macular Degeneration (AMD):
Counseling on Antioxidant Supplement.
Osteoarthritis (OA): Assessment for Use of
Anti-Inflammatory or Analgesic Over-theCounter (OTC) Medications.
Radiology: Exposure Time Reported for
Procedures Using Fluoroscopy.
Radiology: Inappropriate Use of ‘‘Probably
Benign’’ Assessment Category in Mammography Screening.
Nuclear Medicine: Correlation with Existing
Imaging Studies for All Patients Undergoing Bone Scintigraphy.
Chronic Kidney Disease (CKD): Referral for
Arteriovenous (AV) Fistula.
Falls: Risk Assessment ................................
Falls: Plan of Care ........................................
Oncology: Radiation Dose Limits to Normal
Tissues.
Thoracic Surgery: Recording of Clinical
Stage for Lung Cancer and Esophageal
Cancer Resection.
Endarterectomy: Use of Patch During Conventional Endarterectomy.
Diabetes Mellitus: Foot Exam .......................
Hemodialysis Vascular Access DecisionMaking by Surgeon to Maximize Placement of Autogenous Arterial Venous (AV)
Fistula.
Preventive Care and Screening: Unhealthy
Alcohol Use—Screening.
Pediatric End Stage Renal Disease (ESRD):
Influenza Immunization.
Rheumatoid Arthritis (RA): Tuberculosis
Screening.
Rheumatoid Arthritis (RA): Periodic Assessment of Disease Activity.
Rhuematoid Arthritis (RA): Functional Status
Assessment.
Rheumatoid Arthritis (RA): Assessment and
Classification of Disease Prognosis.
Rheumatoid Arthritis (RA): Glucocorticoid
Management.
Elder Maltreatment Screen and Follow-Up
Plan.
Functional Outcome Assessment in Chiropractic Care.
Hepatitis C: Hepatitis A Vaccination in Patients with HCV.
Hepatitis C: Hepatatis B Vaccination in Patients with HCV.
127 ..............
128 ..............
130 ..............
131 ..............
134 ..............
135 ..............
140 ..............
142 ..............
145 ..............
146 ..............
147 ..............
153 ..............
154 ..............
155 ..............
156 ..............
157 ..............
158 ..............
163 ..............
172 ..............
173 ..............
175 ..............
176 ..............
177 ..............
178 ..............
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
179 ..............
180 ..............
181 ..............
182 ..............
183 ..............
184 ..............
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00060
AQA adoption
status as of
1/31/09
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
American Podiatric
(APMA).
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
APMA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
CMS/QIP.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
CMS/QIP.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
CMS/QIP.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
CMS/QIP.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
No .....................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
No .....................
No .....................
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
STS.
Yes ...................
No .....................
Society of Vascular Surgeons (SVS).
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
No .....................
No .....................
NCQA.
SVS.
No .....................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
No .....................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
No .....................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
No .....................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
No .....................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
No .....................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
No .....................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
No .....................
Yes ...................
CMS/QIP.
No .....................
Yes ...................
CMS/QIP.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
Measure developer
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Medical
Association
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
33579
TABLE 17—PROPOSED 2010 MEASURES SELECTED FROM THE 2009 PQRI QUALITY MEASURE SET AVAILABLE FOR
EITHER CLAIMS-BASED REPORTING OR REGISTRY-BASED REPORTING—Continued
NQF endorsement status as
of 5/1/09
Measure No.
Measure title
185 ..............
Endoscopy
&
Polyp
Surveillance:
Colonoscopy Interval for Patients with a
History of Adenomatous Polyps—Avoidance of Inappropriate Use.
Wound Care: Use of Compression System
in Patients with Venous Ulcers.
186 ..............
Please note that detailed measure
specifications for 2009 individual PQRI
quality measures may have been
updated or modified during the NQF
endorsement process or for other
reasons prior to 2010. The 2010 PQRI
quality measure specifications for any
given individual quality measure may,
therefore, be different from
specifications for the same quality
measure used for 2009. Specifications
for all 2010 individual PQRI quality
measures, whether or not included in
the 2009 PQRI program, must be
obtained from the specifications
document for 2010 individual PQRI
quality measures, which will be
available on the PQRI section of the
CMS Web site on or before December
31, 2009.
(2) Proposed 2010 Individual Quality
Measures Selected From the 2009 PQRI
Quality Measures Set Available for
Registry-Based Reporting Only
In the 2008 PQRI, all 2008 PQRI
quality measures were reportable
through either claims-based reporting or
registry-based reporting. In the CY 2009
PFS final rule with comment period (73
FR 69833), we noted that some
measures are not as conducive to
claims-based reporting and indicated
that 18 of the 2009 PQRI quality
measures are not currently reportable
through claims-based reporting due to
their complexity. Instead, these 18
AQA adoption
status as of
1/31/09
No .....................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
No .....................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
measures must be reported through a
qualified PQRI registry for the 2009
PQRI. We referred to these measures as
‘‘registry-only’’ measures. As discussed
further in section II.G.2.d. of this
proposed rule, registry-based reporting
overcomes some of the limitations of
claims-based reporting.
For the 2010 PQRI, we again propose
to include registry-only individual
measures. For 2010, we propose to
select 26 registry-only individual
measures from the 2009 PQRI.
As we noted previously, 1 measure
(measure #46) that was a registry-only
measure for the 2009 PQRI is now
proposed to be available for either
claims-based reporting or registry-based
reporting in the 2010 PQRI. Therefore,
this measure is not included among
these 26 proposed registry-only
individual measures. These 26 proposed
measures do include 9 measures that are
available for either claims-based
reporting or registry-based reporting in
the 2009 PQRI and are now proposed to
be included in the 2010 PQRI as
registry-only measures. We are
proposing to make more 2009 measures
registry-only to relieve some analytical
difficulties encountered during the 2009
PQRI.
Although we are designating certain
measures as registry-only measures, we
cannot guarantee that there will be a
registry qualified to submit each
registry-only measure for 2010. We rely
Measure developer
on registries to self-nominate and
identify the types of measures for which
they would like to be qualified to
submit quality measures results and
numerator and denominator data on
quality measures. If no registry selfnominates to submit measure results
and numerator and denominator data on
a particular type of measure for 2010,
then an eligible professional would not
be able to report that particular measure
type. We invite comments on our
proposal to increase the number of
registry-only measures for the 2010
PQRI.
The Measure Number and Measure
Title for these proposed registry-only
measures are listed in Table 18 along
with the name of each measure’s
developer, the measure’s NQF
endorsement status as of May 1, 2009,
and the measure’s AQA adoption status
as of January 31, 2009. A description of
the proposed measures listed in Table
18 can be found in the ‘‘2009 PQRI
Quality Measures List,’’ which is
available on the Measures and Codes
page of the PQRI section of the CMS
Web site at https://www.cms.hhs.gov/
PQRI. Measures that were available for
either claims-based reporting or registrybased reporting in the 2009 PQRI but are
proposed to be available for registrybased reporting only in the 2010 PQRI
are identified by an asterisk (*) in Table
18.
TABLE 18—PROPOSED 2010 MEASURES SELECTED FROM THE 2009 PQRI QUALITY MEASURE SET AVAILABLE FOR
REGISTRY-BASED REPORTING ONLY
NQF endorsement status as
of 5/1/09
Measure title
5 ..................
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Measure No.
Heart Failure: Angiotensin-Converting Enzyme (ACE) Inhibitor or Angiotensin Receptor Blocker (ARB) Therapy for Left
Ventricular Systolic Dysfunction (LVSD)*.
Coronary Artery Disease (CAD): BetaBlocker Therapy for CAD Patients with
Prior Myocardial Infarction (MI).
Heart Failure: Beta-Blocker Therapy for Left
Ventricular Systolic Dysfunction (LVSD)*.
7 ..................
8 ..................
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00061
AQA adoption
status as of
1/31/09
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
Measure developer
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33580
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
TABLE 18—PROPOSED 2010 MEASURES SELECTED FROM THE 2009 PQRI QUALITY MEASURE SET AVAILABLE FOR
REGISTRY-BASED REPORTING ONLY—Continued
NQF endorsement status as
of 5/1/09
Measure No.
Measure title
33 ................
Stroke and Stroke Rehabilitation: Anticoagulant Therapy Prescribed for Atrial Fibrillation at Discharge.
End Stage Renal Disease (ESRD): Plan of
Care for Inadequate Hemodialysis in
ESRD Patients.
End Stage Renal Disease (ESRD): Plan of
Care for Inadequate Peritoneal Dialysis.
Hepatitis C: Testing for Chronic Hepatitis
C—Confirmation of Hepatitis C Viremia*.
Coronary
Artery
Disease
(CAD):
Angiotensin-Converting Enzyme (ACE) Inhibitor or Angiotensin Receptor Blocker
(ARB) Therapy for Patients with CAD and
Diabetes and/or Left Ventricular Systolic
Dysfunction (LSVD)*.
Melanoma: Follow-Up Aspects of Care* ......
Melanoma: Continuity of Care—Recall
System*.
Melanoma: Coordination of Care* ................
Cataracts: Comprehensive Preoperative Assessment for Cataract Surgery with Intraocular Lens (IOL) Placement*.
Primary Open-Angle Glaucoma (POAG):
Reduction of Intraocular Pressure (IOP)
by 15% OR Documentation of a Plan of
Care*.
HIV/AIDS: CD4+ Cell Count or CD4+ Percentage.
HIV/AIDS: Pneumocystis Jiroveci Pneumonia (PCP) Prophylaxis.
HIV/AIDS: Adolescent and Adult Patients
with HIV/AIDS Who Are Prescribed Potent Antiretroviral Therapy.
HIV/AIDS: HIV RNA Control After Six
Months of Potent Antiretroviral Therapy.
Coronary Artery Bypass Graft (CABG): Prolonged Intubation (Ventilation).
Coronary Artery Bypass Graft (CABG):
Deep Sternal Wound Infection Rate.
Coronary Artery Bypass Graft (CABG):
Stroke/Cerebrovascular Accident (CVA).
Coronary Artery Bypass Graft (CABG):
Postoperative Renal Insufficiency.
Coronary Artery Bypass Graft (CABG): Surgical Re-exploration.
Coronary Artery Bypass Graft (CABG):
Antiplatelet Medications at Discharge.
Coronary Artery Bypass Graft (CABG):
Beta-Blockers Administered at Discharge.
Coronary Artery Bypass Graft (CABG): Lipid
Management and Counseling.
Pediatric End Stage Renal Disease (ESRD):
Plan of Care for Inadequate Hemodialysis.
81 ................
82 ................
83 ................
118 ..............
136 ..............
137 ..............
138 ..............
139 ..............
141 ..............
159 ..............
160 ..............
161 ..............
162 ..............
164 ..............
165 ..............
166 ..............
167 ..............
168 ..............
169 ..............
170 ..............
171 ..............
174 ..............
AQA adoption
status as of
1/31/09
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
No .....................
AMA–PCPI.
No .....................
No .....................
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
No .....................
No .....................
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
No .....................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
No .....................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
No .....................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
No .....................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
No .....................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
STS.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
STS.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
STS.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
STS.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
STS.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
STS.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
STS.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
STS.
No .....................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Measure developer
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
* Individual 2009 PQRI measures that were available for both claims-based and registry-based reporting but proposed to be available for registry-based reporting only for the 2010 PQRI.
Please note that detailed measure
specifications for 2009 PQRI quality
measures may have been updated or
modified during the NQF endorsement
process or for other reasons prior to
2010. Therefore, the 2010 PQRI quality
measure specifications for any given
quality measure may be different from
specifications for the same quality
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
measure used for 2009. Specifications
for all 2010 individual PQRI quality
measures, whether or not included in
the 2009 PQRI program, must be
obtained from the specifications
document for 2010 individual PQRI
quality measures, which will be
available on the PQRI section of the
PO 00000
Frm 00062
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
CMS Web site on or before December
31, 2009.
(3) New Individual Quality Measures
Proposed for 2010
We propose to include in the 2010
PQRI quality measure set 22 measures
that were not included in the 2009 PQRI
quality measures provided that each
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33581
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
measure obtains NQF endorsement by
July 1, 2009 and its detailed
specifications are completed and ready
for implementation in PQRI by August
15, 2009. Besides having NQF
endorsement, the development of a
measure is considered complete for the
purposes of the 2010 PQRI if by August
15, 2009—(1) The final, detailed
specifications for use in data collection
for PQRI have been completed and are
ready for implementation, and (2) all of
the Category II Current Procedural
Terminology (CPT II) codes required for
the measure have been established and
will be effective for CMS claims data
submission on or before January 1, 2010.
The titles of these proposed additional,
or new, measures are listed in Table 19
along with the name of the measure
developer and the proposed reporting
mechanism (that is, whether the
measure is proposed to be reportable
using claims, registries, or both). For
these 22 proposed measures, a PQRI
Measure Number will be assigned to a
measure if and when the measure is
included in the final set of 2010 PQRI
measures.
Due to the complexity of their
measure specifications, we propose that
16 of these 22 measures would be
available as registry-only measures for
the 2010 PQRI. We do not believe that
these 16 measures are conducive to the
claims-based reporting mechanism. The
remaining 6 measures would be
available for reporting through either
claims-based reporting or registry-based
reporting.
TABLE 19—NEW INDIVIDUAL QUALITY MEASURES PROPOSED FOR 2010
NQF
endorsement
status as
of 5/1/09
AQA adoption
status as of
1/31/09
Thrombolytic Therapy Administered .....
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Measure title
Yes ........................
No .....................
Referral for Otologic Evaluation for Patients with Visible Congenital or Traumatic Deformity of the Ear.
Referral for Otologic Evaluation for Patients with History of Active Drainage
from the Ear within the Previous 90
days.
Referral for Otologic Evaluation for Patients with a History of Sudden or
Rapidly Progressive Hearing Loss
within the Previous 90 days.
Cataracts: 20/40 or Better Visual Acuity
within 90 days Following Cataract
Surgery.
Cataracts: Complications within 30
Days Following Cataract Surgery Requiring Additional Surgical Procedures.
Perioperative Temperature Management.
Cancer Stage Documented ...................
Stenosis Measurement in Carotid Imaging Studies.
Coronary Artery Disease (CAD): Symptom and Activity Assessment.
Coronary Artery Disease (CAD): Drug
Therapy for Lowering LDL-Cholesterol.
Heart Failure (HF): Left Ventricular
Function Assessment.
Heart Failure (HF): Patient Education ...
Heart Failure (HF): Warfarin Therapy
Patients with Atrial Fibrillation.
Blood Pressure Management: Control ..
Complete Lipid Profile ...........................
Cholesterol Count ..................................
Use of Aspirin or Another Anti-Thrombotic.
HIV/AIDS: Sexually Transmitted Diseases—Chlamydia and Gonorrhea
Screenings.
HIV/AIDS: Screening for High Risk
Sexual Behaviors.
HIV/AIDS: Screening for Injection Drug
Use.
HIV/AIDS: Sexually Transmitted Diseases—Syphilis Screening.
Pending NQF review.
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
Measure developer
Reporting
mechanism(s)
Registry.
No .....................
American Heart Association (AHA)/
American Stroke Association (ASA).
Audiology Quality Consortium (AQC) ...
Pending NQF review.
No .....................
AQC ......................................................
Claims, Registry.
Pending NQF review.
No .....................
AQC ......................................................
Claims, Registry.
Pending NQF review.
Yes ...................
American Academy of Ophthalmology
(AAO)/AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Registry.
Pending NQF review.
Yes ...................
AAO/AMA–PCPI/NCQA ........................
Registry.
Yes ........................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI ............................................
Claims, Registry.
Yes ........................
Yes ........................
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
Claims, Registry.
Claims, Registry.
Yes ........................
No .....................
AMA–PCPI ............................................
American College of Radiology (ACR)/
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
ACC/AHA/AMA–PCPI ...........................
Yes ........................
No .....................
ACC/AHA/AMA–PCPI ...........................
Registry.
Yes ........................
No .....................
ACC/AHA/AMA–PCPI ...........................
Registry.
Yes ........................
Yes ........................
No .....................
No .....................
ACC/AHA/AMA–PCPI ...........................
ACC/AHA/AMA–PCPI ...........................
Registry.
Registry.
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
No
No
No
NCQA
NCQA
NCQA
NCQA
....................................................
....................................................
....................................................
....................................................
Registry.
Registry.
Registry.
Registry.
........................
........................
........................
........................
.....................
.....................
.....................
.....................
Claims, Registry.
Registry.
Yes ........................
No .....................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA ................................
Registry.
Yes ........................
No .....................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA ................................
Registry.
Yes ........................
No .....................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA ................................
Registry.
Yes ........................
No .....................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA ................................
Registry.
Fmt 4701
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
PO 00000
Frm 00063
Sfmt 4702
13JYP2
33582
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
(4) Proposed 2010 Individual Quality
Measures Available for EHR-Based
Reporting
As discussed in section II.G.2.d.(3) of
this proposed rule, we propose to accept
PQRI data from EHRs for a limited
subset of the proposed 2010 PQRI
quality measures, contingent upon the
successful completion of our 2009 EHR
data submission testing process and a
determination that accepting data from
EHRs on quality measures for the 2010
PQRI is practical and feasible. The 10
proposed 2010 PQRI quality measures
on which we propose to accept clinical
quality data extracted from EHRs are
identified in Table 20. We propose to
make these measures available for
electronic submission via an EHR
because these measures target
preventive care or common chronic
conditions. In addition, 4 of these
proposed measures overlap with
measures used in the Medicare Quality
Improvement Organization program’s
9th Statement of Work. Finally, it is
much less burdensome for an eligible
professional to report Measure #124,
which assesses adoption and use of
EHRs, through an EHR than through
claims.
TABLE 20—PROPOSED 2010 MEASURES AVAILABLE FOR EHR-BASED REPORTING
NQF endorsement status as
of 5/1/09
Measure
number
Measure title
1 ..................
Diabetes Mellitus: Hemoglobin A1c Poor
Control in Diabetes Mellitus.
Diabetes Mellitus: Low Density Lipoprotein
(LDL–C) Control in Diabetes Mellitus.
Diabetes Mellitus: High Blood Pressure
Control in Diabetes Mellitus.
Heart Failure: Angiotensin-Converting Enzyme (ACE) Inhibitor or Angiotensin Receptor Blocker (ARB) Therapy for Left
Ventricular Systolic Dysfunction (LVSD).
Coronary Artery Disease (CAD): BetaBlocker Therapy for CAD Patients with
Prior Myocardial Infarction (MI).
Preventive Care and Screening: Influenza
Immunization for Patients ≥ 50 Years Old.
Preventive Care and Screening: Pneumonia
Vaccination for Patients 65 Years and
Older.
Preventive Care and Screening: Screening
Mammography.
Preventive Care and Screening: Colorectal
Cancer Screening.
Health Information Technology (HIT): Adoption/Use of Electronic Health Records
(EHR).
2 ..................
3 ..................
5 ..................
7 ..................
110 ..............
111 ..............
112 ..............
113 ..............
124 ..............
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
(5) Measures Proposed for Inclusion in
2010 Measures Groups
We propose to retain the 7 2009 PQRI
measures groups for the 2010 PQRI: (1)
Diabetes Mellitus; (2) CKD; (3)
Preventive Care; (4) CABG; (5)
Rheumatoid Arthritis; (6) Perioperative
Care; and (7) Back Pain. These measures
groups were selected for inclusion in
the 2010 PQRI because they each
contain at least 4 PQRI quality measures
that share a common denominator
definition.
Except for the CABG measures group,
all 2009 measures groups are reportable
either through claims-based reporting or
registry-based reporting. The CABG
measures group, for the 2009 PQRI, is
reportable through the registry-based
reporting mechanism only since some
measures included in the 2009 CABG
measures group are registry-only
individual PQRI measures. For this
reason, we propose the CABG measures
group would be reportable through the
registry-based reporting mechanism
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
AQA adoption
status as of
1/31/09
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
NCQA
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
NCQA
Yes ...................
No .....................
NCQA
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI
Yes ...................
No .....................
AMA–PCPI
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
NCQA
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
NCQA
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
NCQA
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
CMS/QIP
only for 2010 while the remaining 6
2009 PQRI measures groups would be
reportable through either claims-based
reporting or registry-based reporting for
the 2010 PQRI.
Except for the measures included in
the Back Pain measures group, the
measures included in a 2009 PQRI
measures group are reportable either as
individual measures or as part of a
measures group. As stated in the CY
2009 PFS final rule with comment
period (73 FR 69843 through 69844), as
individual measures, the measures in
the Back Pain measures group are too
basic. However, taken together they are
meaningful indicators of quality of care
for back pain. For this reason, for the
2010 PQRI, we propose that except for
the measures included in the Back Pain
measures group, the measures included
in a 2009 PQRI measures group that we
propose to carry forward for the 2010
PQRI would be reportable either as
individual measures or as part of a
measures group.
PO 00000
Frm 00064
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
Measure developer
The measures proposed for inclusion
in the 2010 measures groups that are
based on the measures groups from 2009
are identified in Tables 21 through 27.
Some measures proposed for inclusion
in some of these measures groups for
2010 were not included in the measures
groups in 2009. The 2009 measures
proposed for inclusion in a 2010
measures group that were not included
in the measures group for 2009 are
identified with an asterisk (*).
As with measures group reporting in
the 2008 and 2009 PQRI, we propose
that each eligible professional electing
to report a group of measures for 2010
must report all measures in the group
that are applicable to each patient or
encounter to which the measures group
applies at least up to the minimum
number of patients required by
applicable reporting criteria (described
above in section II.G.2.f. of this
proposed rule). The individual
measures included in the final 2010
PQRI measures groups will be limited to
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
those measures which will be identified
in the CY 2010 PFS final rule with
33583
comment period as final 2010 PQRI
measures
TABLE 21—MEASURES PROPOSED FOR 2010 DIABETES MELLITUS MEASURES GROUP
NQF endorsement status as
of 5/1/09
Measure
number
Measure title
1 ..................
Diabetes Mellitus: Hemoglobin A1c Poor
Control in Diabetes Mellitus.
Diabetes Mellitus: Low Density Lipoprotein
(LDL–C) Control in Diabetes Mellitus.
Diabetes Mellitus: High Blood Pressure
Control in Diabetes Mellitus.
Diabetes Mellitus: Dilated Eye Exam in Diabetic Patient.
Diabetes Mellitus: Urine Screening for
Microalbumin or Medical Attention for
Nephropathy in Diabetic Patients.
Diabetes Mellitus: Foot Exam * .....................
2 ..................
3 ..................
117 ..............
119 ..............
163 ..............
AQA adoption
status as of
1/31/09
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
NCQA.
Yes ...................
No .....................
NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
NCQA.
Yes ...................
No .....................
NCQA.
Yes ...................
No .....................
NCQA.
Measure developer
* This 2009 PQRI measure was not part of this measures group for 2009, but is proposed for inclusion in this measures group for 2010.
TABLE 22—MEASURES PROPOSED FOR 2010 CKD MEASURES GROUP
NQF endorsement status as
of 5/1/09
Measure
number
Measure title
121 ..............
Chronic Kidney Disease (CKD): Laboratory
Testing (Calcium, Phosphorus, Intact
Parathyroid Hormone (iPTH) and Lipid
Profile).
Chronic Kidney Disease (CKD): Blood Pressure Management.
Chronic Kidney Disease (CKD): Plan of
Care—Elevated Hemoglobin for Patients
Receiving
Erythropoiesis-Stimulating
Agents (ESA).
Chronic Kidney Disease (CKD): Influenza
Immunization.
Chronic Kidney Disease (CKD): Referral for
Arteriovenous (AV) Fistula.
122 ..............
123 ..............
135 ..............
153 ..............
AQA adoption
status as of
1/31/09
No .....................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
No .....................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
No .....................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
No .....................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
No .....................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Measure developer
TABLE 23—MEASURES PROPOSED FOR 2010 PREVENTIVE CARE MEASURES GROUP
NQF endorsement status as
of 5/1/09
Measure
number
Measure title
39 ................
Screening or Therapy for Osteoporosis for
Women Aged 65 Years and Older.
Urinary Incontinence: Assessment of Presence or Absence of Urinary Incontinence
in Women Aged 65 Years and Older.
Preventive Care and Screening: Influenza
Immunization for Patients ≥ 50 Years Old.
Preventive Care and Screening: Pneumonia
Vaccination for Patients 65 Years and
Older.
Preventive Care and Screening: Screening
Mammography.
Preventive Care and Screening: Colorectal
Cancer Screening.
Preventive Care and Screening: Inquiry Regarding Tobacco Use.
Preventive Care and Screening: Advising
Smokers to Quit.
Preventive Care and Screening: Body Mass
Index (BMI) Screening and Follow-Up.
Preventive Care and Screening: Unhealthy
Alcohol Use—Screening *.
48 ................
110 ..............
111 ..............
112 ..............
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
113 ..............
114 ..............
115 ..............
128 ..............
173 ..............
AQA adoption
status as of
1/31/09
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
No .....................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
CMS/QIP.
No .....................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Measure developer
* This 2009 PQRI measure was not part of this measures group for 2009, but is proposed for inclusion in this measures group for 2010.
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00065
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33584
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
TABLE 24—MEASURES PROPOSED FOR 2010 CABG MEASURES GROUP ∂
NQF endorsement status as
of 5/1/09
Measure
number
Measure title
43 ................
Coronary Artery Bypass Graft (CABG): Use
of Internal Mammary Artery (IMA) in Patients with Isolated CABG Surgery.
Coronary Artery Bypass Graft (CABG): Preoperative Beta-Blocker in Patients with
Isolated CABG Surgery.
Coronary Artery Bypass Graft (CABG): Prolonged Intubation (Ventilation).
Coronary Artery Bypass Graft (CABG):
Deep Sternal Wound Infection Rate.
Coronary Artery Bypass Graft (CABG):
Stroke/Cerebrovascular Accident (CVA).
Coronary Artery Bypass Graft (CABG):
Postoperative Renal Insufficiency.
Coronary Artery Bypass Graft (CABG): Surgical Re-exploration.
Coronary Artery Bypass Graft (CABG):
Antiplatelet Medications at Discharge.
Coronary Artery Bypass Graft (CABG):
Beta-Blockers Administered at Discharge.
Coronary Artery Bypass Graft (CABG): Lipid
Management and Counseling.
44 ................
164 ..............
165 ..............
166 ..............
167 ..............
168 ..............
169 ..............
170 ..............
171 ..............
∂ This
AQA adoption
status as of
1/31/09
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
Society of Thoracic Surgeons (STS).
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
STS.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
STS.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
STS.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
STS.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
STS.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
STS.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
STS.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
STS.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
STS.
Measure developer
measures group is proposed to be reportable through registry-based reporting only.
TABLE 25—MEASURES PROPOSED FOR 2010 RHEUMATOID ARTHRITIS MEASURES GROUP
NQF endorsement status as
of 5/1/09
Measure
number
Measure title
108 ..............
Rheumatoid Arthritis (RA): Disease Modifying Anti-Rheumatic Drug (DMARD)
Therapy.
Rheumatoid Arthritis (RA): Tuberculosis
Screening.
Rheumatoid Arthritis (RA): Periodic Assessment of Disease Activity.
Rheumatoid Arthritis (RA): Functional Status
Assessment.
Rheumatoid Arthritis (RA): Assessment and
Classification of Disease Prognosis.
Rheumatoid Arthritis (RA): Glucocorticoid
Management.
176 ..............
177 ..............
178 ..............
179 ..............
180 ..............
AQA adoption
status as of
1/31/09
Yes ...................
No .....................
NCQA.
No .....................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
No .....................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
No .....................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
No .....................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
No .....................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Measure developer
TABLE 26—MEASURES PROPOSED FOR 2010 PERIOPERATIVE CARE MEASURES GROUP
NQF endorsement status as
of 5/1/09
Measure
number
Measure title
20 ................
Perioperative Care: Timing of Antibiotic Prophylaxis—Ordering Physician.
Perioperative Care: Selection of Prophylactic Antibiotic—First OR Second Generation Cephalosporin.
Perioperative Care: Discontinuation of Prophylactic Antibiotics (Non-Cardiac Procedures).
Perioperative Care: Venous Thromboembolism (VTE) Prophylaxis (When Indicated in ALL Patients).
21 ................
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
22 ................
23 ................
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00066
AQA adoption
status as of
1/31/09
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
Measure developer
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
33585
TABLE 27—MEASURES PROPOSED FOR 2010 BACK PAIN MEASURES GROUP
Measure
number
148
149
150
151
..............
..............
..............
..............
NQF endorsement status as
of 5/1/09
Measure title
Back
Back
Back
Back
Pain:
Pain:
Pain:
Pain:
Initial Visit ...................................
Physical Exam ............................
Advice for Normal Activities .......
Advice Against Bed Rest ...........
In addition to the 7 measures groups
that we propose to retain from the 2009
PQRI, we propose 6 new measures
groups for the 2010 PQRI, for a total of
13 CY 2010 measures groups. The 6 new
measures groups proposed for the 2010
PQRI are: (1) Coronary Artery Disease
(CAD); (2) Heart Failure (HF); (3)
Ischemic Vascular Disease (IVD); (4)
Hepatitis C; (5) Human
Immunodeficiency Virus (HIV)/
Acquired Immune Deficiency Syndrome
(AIDS); and (6) Community Acquired
Pneumonia (CAP). Many of the 6 new
measures groups proposed for 2010
contain proposed new registry-only
measures, which would make them
reportable through registry-based
reporting only. Therefore, only 8
proposed 2010 measures groups would
be reportable through either claimsbased reporting or registry-based
reporting: Diabetes Mellitus; CKD;
Preventive Care; Perioperative Care;
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
...................
...................
...................
...................
AQA adoption
status as of 1/
31/09
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Measure developer
...................
...................
...................
...................
Rheumatoid Arthritis; Back Pain;
Hepatitis C; and Community Acquired
Pneumonia. We invite comments on our
proposal to limit claims-based reporting
of measures groups in 2010.
New measures groups are proposed
for the 2010 PQRI in order to address
gaps in quality reporting and are those
that have a high impact on HHS and
CMS priority topics for improved
quality and efficiency for Medicare
beneficiaries (such as prevention,
chronic conditions, high cost/high
volume conditions, improved care
coordination, improved efficiency,
improved patient and family experience
of care, and effective management of
acute and chronic episodes of care).
Groups were identified in topical areas
where: (1) 4 or more proposed 2010
measures are available; (2) the measures
are NQF endorsed; and (3) they address
a gap in quality reporting. The measures
proposed for inclusion in these new
NCQA.
NCQA.
NCQA.
NCQA.
2010 measures groups are identified in
Tables 28 through 33.
Some measures proposed for
inclusion in these 6 measures group are
current 2009 individual PQRI measures.
The title of each such measure is
preceded with its PQRI Measure
Number in Tables 28 through 33. As
stated previously, the PQRI Measure
Number is a unique identifier assigned
by CMS to all measures in the PQRI
measure set. Once a PQRI Measure
Number is assigned to a measure, it will
not be used again, even if the measure
is subsequently retired from the PQRI
measure set. Measures that are not
preceded by a number (in other words,
those preceded by ‘‘TBD’’) in Tables 28
through 33 have never been part of a
PQRI measure set until being proposed
now. A number will be assigned to such
measures if we include them in the final
set of 2010 PQRI measures groups.
TABLE 28—MEASURES PROPOSED FOR 2010 CAD MEASURES GROUP ∂
NQF endorsement status as
of 5/1/09
Measure
number
Measure title
6 ..................
Coronary Artery Disease (CAD): Oral
Antiplatelet Therapy Prescribed for Patients with CAD.
Preventive Care and Screening: Inquiry Regarding Tobacco Use.
Preventive Care and Screening: Advising
Smokers to Quit.
Coronary Artery Disease (CAD): Symptom
and Activity Assessment.
Coronary Artery Disease (CAD): Drug Therapy for Lowering LDL-Cholesterol.
114 ..............
115 ..............
TBD .............
TBD .............
∂ This
AQA adoption
status as of
1/31/09
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
ACC/AHA/AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
ACC/AHA/AMA–PCPI.
Measure developer
measures group is proposed to be reportable through registry-based reporting only.
TABLE 29—MEASURES PROPOSED FOR 2010 HF MEASURES GROUP ∂
NQF endorsement status as
of 5/1/09
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Measure
number
Measure title
5 ..................
Heart Failure: Angiotensin-Converting Enzyme (ACE) Inhibitor or Angiotensin Receptor Blocker (ARB) Therapy for Left
Ventricular Systolic Dysfunction (LVSD).
Heart Failure: Beta-Blocker Therapy for Left
Ventricular Systolic Dysfunction (LVSD).
Preventive Care and Screening: Inquiry Regarding Tobacco Use.
Preventive Care and Screening: Advising
Smokers to Quit.
8 ..................
114 ..............
115 ..............
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00067
AQA adoption
status as of
1/31/09
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
NCQA.
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
Measure developer
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33586
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
TABLE 29—MEASURES PROPOSED FOR 2010 HF MEASURES GROUP ∂—Continued
NQF endorsement status as
of 5/1/09
Measure
number
Measure title
TBD .............
Heart Failure (HF): Left Ventricular Function
Assessment.
Heart Failure (HF): Patient Education ..........
Heart Failure (HF): Warfarin Therapy Patients with Atrial Fibrillation.
TBD .............
TBD .............
∂ This
AQA adoption
status as of
1/31/09
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
ACC/AHA/AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
ACC/AHA/AMA–PCPI.
ACC/AHA/AMA–PCPI.
Measure developer
measures group is proposed to be reportable through registry-based reporting only.
TABLE 30—MEASURES PROPOSED FOR 2010 IVD MEASURES GROUP ∂
NQF endorsement status as
of 5/1/09
Measure
number
Measure title
114 ..............
Preventive Care and Screening: Inquiry Regarding Tobacco Use.
Preventive Care and Screening: Advising
Smokers to Quit.
Blood Pressure Management: Control .........
Complete Lipid Profile ..................................
Cholesterol Control .......................................
Use of Aspirin or Another Anti-Thrombotic ..
115 ..............
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
.............
.............
.............
.............
∂ This
AQA adoption
status as of
1/31/09
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
NCQA.
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
No
No
No
NCQA.
NCQA.
NCQA.
NCQA.
...................
...................
...................
...................
.....................
.....................
.....................
.....................
Measure Developer
measures group is proposed to be reportable through registry-based reporting only.
TABLE 31—MEASURES PROPOSED FOR 2010 HEPATITIS C MEASURES GROUP
NQF endorsement status as
of 5/1/09
Measure No.
Measure title
84 ................
Hepatitis C: Ribonucleic Acid (RNA) Testing
Before Initiating Treatment.
Hepatitis C: HCV Genotype Testing Prior to
Treatment.
Hepatitis C: Antiviral Treatment Prescribed
Hepatitis C: HCV Ribonucleic Acid (RNA)
Testing at Week 12 of Treatment.
Hepatitis C: Counseling Regarding Risk of
Alcohol Consumption.
Hepatitis C: Counseling Regarding Use of
Contraception Prior to Antiviral Therapy.
Hepatitis C: Hepatitis A Vaccination in Patients with HCV.
Hepatitis C: Hepatitis B Vaccination in Patients with HCV.
85 ................
86 ................
87 ................
89 ................
90 ................
183 ..............
184 ..............
AQA adoption
status as of
1/31/09
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Measure developer
TABLE 32—MEASURES PROPOSED FOR 2010 HIV/AIDS MEASURES GROUP ∂
NQF endorsement status as
of 5/1/09
Measure No.
Measure title
159 ..............
HIV/AIDS: CD4+ Cell Count or CD4+ Percentage.
HIV/AIDS: Pneumocystis Jiroveci Pneumonia (PCP) Prophylaxis.
HIV/AIDS: Adolescent and Adult Patients
with HIV/AIDS Who Are Prescribed Potent Antiretroviral Therapy.
HIV/AIDS: HIV RNA Control After Six
Months of Potent Antiretroviral Therapy.
HIV/AIDS: Sexually Transmitted Diseases—
Chlamydia and Gonorrhea Screenings.
HIV/AIDS: Screening for High Risk Sexual
Behaviors.
HIV/AIDS: Screening for Injection Drug Use
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
160 ..............
161 ..............
162 ..............
TBD .............
TBD .............
TBD .............
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00068
AQA adoption
status as of
1/31/09
Yes ...................
No .....................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
No .....................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
No .....................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
Measure developer
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
33587
TABLE 32—MEASURES PROPOSED FOR 2010 HIV/AIDS MEASURES GROUP ∂—Continued
Measure No.
Measure title
NQF endorsement status as
of 5/1/09
AQA adoption
status as of
1/31/09
TBD .............
HIV/AIDS: Sexually Transmitted Diseases—
Syphilis Screening.
Yes ...................
No .....................
∂ This
Measure developer
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
measures group is proposed to be reportable through registry-based reporting only.
TABLE 33—MEASURES PROPOSED FOR 2010 COMMUNITY-ACQUIRED PNEUMONIA MEASURES GROUP
NQF endorsement status as
of 5/1/09
Measure No.
Measure title
56 ................
Community-Acquired Pneumonia (CAP):
Vital Signs.
Community-Acquired Pneumonia (CAP): Assessment of Oxygen Saturation.
Community-Acquired Pneumonia (CAP): Assessment of Mental Status.
Community-Acquired Pneumonia (CAP):
Empiric Antibiotic.
57 ................
58 ................
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
59 ................
We note that the specifications for
measures groups do not necessarily
contain all the specification elements of
each individual measure making up the
measures group. This is based on the
need for a common set of denominator
specifications for all the measures
making up a measures group in order to
define the applicability of the measures
group. Therefore, the specifications and
instructions for measures groups will be
provided separately from the
specifications and instructions for the
individual 2010 PQRI measures. We
will post the detailed specifications and
specific instructions for reporting
measures groups on the PQRI section of
the CMS Web site at https://
www.cms.hhs.gov/PQRI by no later than
December 31, 2008.
Additionally, the detailed measure
specifications and instructions for
submitting data on those proposed 2010
measures groups that were also
included as 2009 PQRI measures groups
may be updated or modified prior to
2010. Therefore, the 2010 PQRI measure
specifications for any given measures
group could be different from
specifications and submission
instructions for the same measures
group used for 2009. These measure
specification changes do not materially
impact the intended meaning of the
measures or the strength of the
measures.
(6) Request for Public Comment on
Measure Suggestions for Future PQRI
Quality Measure Sets
As stated above, on February 1, 2009,
we posted a ‘‘Call for 2010 PQRI
Measure Suggestions’’ on the PQRI
section of the CMS Web site at https://
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
AQA adoption
status as of
1/31/09
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI/NCQA.
www.cms.hhs.gov/PQRI. The ‘‘Call for
2010 PQRI Measure Suggestions’’
invited the public to submit suggestions
for individual quality measures and
measures groups (that is, suggestions for
new measures groups and/or
suggestions for the composition of
existing measures groups) for
consideration for possible inclusion in
the proposed set of quality measure for
use in the 2010 PQRI. To facilitate our
evaluation of the suggested measures,
we asked individuals or organizations
submitting suggestions to provide us
with the following information:
• Requestor contact information, such
as name and title, organization/practice
name, phone number and e-mail
address;
• Measure title;
• Measure description;
• Measure owner/developer;
• NQF endorsement status, including
the date of endorsement or anticipated
endorsement (if not NQF-endorsed) and
type of endorsement (for example, timelimited endorsement);
• AQA adoption status, including
date of AQA adoption or anticipated
AQA adoption;
• Preferred PQRI reporting option for
the suggested measure(s) (that is, claims,
registry, registry-only, measures group,
measures group only, EHRs); and
• The measure specifications.
In lieu of posting a call for 2011 PQRI
measure suggestions on the PQRI
section of the CMS Web site in 2010, we
invite commenters to submit
suggestions for individual quality
measures and measures groups (that is,
suggestions for new measures groups
and/or suggestions for the composition
of proposed 2010 measures groups) for
PO 00000
Frm 00069
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
Measure developer
consideration for possible inclusion in
the proposed set of quality measures for
use in the 2011 PQRI. When submitting
suggestions for future PQRI quality
measure sets as part of the comment
period for this proposed rule,
commenters should submit all the
information requested above for the
‘‘Call for 2010 PQRI Measure
Suggestions.’’
Please note that suggesting individual
measures or measures for a new or
proposed measures group does not
mean that the measure(s) will be
included in the proposed or final sets of
measures of any proposed or final rules
that address the 2011 PQRI. We will
determine what individual measures
and measures group(s) to include in the
proposed set of quality measures, and
after a period of public comment, we
will make the final determination with
regard to the final set of quality
measures for the 2011 PQRI.
j. Proposed 2010 PQRI Quality Measures
for Physician Groups Selected to
Participate in the Group Practice
Reporting Option
As discussed in section II.G.2.g. of
this proposed rule, we propose that
physician groups selected to participate
in the 2010 PQRI group practice
reporting option would be required to
report on 26 measures. These measures
are NQF-endorsed measures currently
collected as part of the PGP and/or
MCMP demonstrations and are
identified in Table 34. To the extent that
a measure is an existing PQRI measure,
the Measure Title is preceded by the
measure’s PQRI Measure Number. If
there is no number in the Measure
Number column of the table, then the
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33588
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
measure is not an existing PQRI
measure and will be added to the 2010
PQRI for purposes of the group practice
reporting option.
TABLE 34—MEASURES PROPOSED FOR PHYSICIAN GROUPS PARTICIPATING IN THE 2010 PQRI GROUP PRACTICE
REPORTING OPTION
NQF endorsement status as
of 5/1/09
Measure No.
Measure title
1 ..................
Diabetes Mellitus: Hemoglobin A1c Poor
Control.
Diabetes Mellitus: Low Density Lipoprotein
Control.
Diabetes Mellitus: High Blood Pressure
Control.
Heart Failure: ACE Inhibitor or ARB Therapy for LVSD.
Coronary Artery Disease: Oral Anti-platelet
Therapy.
Coronary Artery Disease:Beta-blocker Therapy for CAD Patients with Prior MI.
Heart Failure: Beta-blocker Therapy for
LVSD.
Preventive Care: Influenza Vaccination for
Patients > 50 years.
Preventive Care: Pneumonia Vaccination for
Patients 65+ years.
Preventive Care: Screening Mammography
Preventive Care: Screening Colorectal Cancer.
Diabetes Mellitus: Dilated Eye Exam ...........
Coronary Artery Disease: ACE/ARB for Patients with CAD and Diabetes and/or
LVSD.
Diabetes Mellitus: Urine Screening for
Microalbumin or Medical Attention for
Nephropathy.
Diabetes Mellitus: Foot Exam .......................
Diabetes Mellitus: Hemoglobin A1c Testing
Diabetes Mellitus: Lipid Profile .....................
Heart Failure: Left Ventricular Function
Testing.
Heart Failure: Left Ventricular Function Assessment.
Heart Failure: Weight Measurement ............
Heart Failure: Patient Education ..................
Heart Failure: Warfarin Therapy for Patients
with Atrial Fibrillation.
Coronary Artery Disease: Drug Therapy for
Lowering LDL-Cholesterol.
Preventive Care: Blood Pressure Management.
Hypertension: Blood Pressure Control .........
Hypertension: Plan of Care ..........................
2 ..................
3 ..................
5 ..................
6 ..................
7 ..................
8 ..................
110 ..............
111 ..............
112 ..............
113 ..............
117 ..............
118 ..............
119 ..............
163 ..............
TBD .............
TBD .............
TBD .............
TBD .............
TBD .............
TBD .............
TBD .............
TBD .............
TBD .............
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
TBD .............
TBD .............
k. Public Reporting of PQRI Data
Section 1848(m)(5)(G) of the Act, as
added by the MIPPA, requires the
Secretary to post on the CMS Web site,
in an easily understandable format, a
list of the names of eligible
professionals (or group practices) who
satisfactorily submitted data on quality
measures for the PQRI and the names of
the eligible professionals (or group
practices) who are successful electronic
prescribers as defined and discussed
further in section II.G.5. of this
proposed rule. In accordance with
section 1848(m)(5)(G) of the Act, we
indicated in the CY 2009 PFS final rule
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
AQA adoption
status as of
1/31/09
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
NCQA.
Yes ...................
No .....................
NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
No .....................
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
NCQA.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
NCQA.
NCQA/AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
No .....................
NCQA.
AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
No .....................
NCQA.
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
...................
...................
...................
...................
No .....................
No .....................
No .....................
Yes ...................
NCQA.
NCQA.
NCQA.
CMS.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
ACC/AHA/AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
No .....................
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
ACC/AHA/AMA–PCPI.
ACC/AHA/AMA–PCPI.
ACC/AHA/AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
ACC/AHA/AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
No .....................
ACC/AHA/AMA–PCPI.
Yes ...................
Yes ...................
No .....................
No .....................
CMS/NCQA.
ACC/AHA/AMA–PCPI.
with comment period (73 FR 69846
through 69847) our intent, in 2010, to
enhance the current Physician and
Other Health Care Professionals
directory at https://www.medicare.gov
with the names of eligible professionals
that satisfactorily submit quality data for
the 2009 PQRI. In December 2008, we
listed, by State, the names of eligible
professionals who participated in the
2007 PQRI on the Physician and Other
Health Care Professionals Directory.
As required by section 1848(m)(5)(G)
of the Act, we intend to make public the
names of eligible professionals and
group practices that satisfactorily
PO 00000
Frm 00070
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
Measure developer
submit quality data for the 2010 PQRI
on the Physician and Other Health Care
Professionals Directory. We anticipate
that the names of individual eligible
professionals and group practices that
satisfactorily submit quality data for the
2010 PQRI will be available in 2011
after the 2010 incentive payments are
paid.
For purposes of publicly reporting the
names of eligible professionals, on the
Physician and Other Health Care
Professionals Directory, we propose to
post the names of eligible professionals
who: (1) Submit data on the 2010 PQRI
quality measures through one of the
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
reporting mechanisms available for the
2010 PQRI; (2) meet one of the proposed
satisfactory reporting criteria of
individual measures or measures groups
for the 2010 PQRI described above in
section II.G.2.e. and II.G.2.f.,
respectively of this proposed rule; and
(3) qualify to earn a PQRI incentive
payment for covered professional
services furnished during the applicable
2010 PQRI reporting period.
Similarly, for purposes of publicly
reporting the names of group practices,
on the Physician and Other Health Care
Professionals Directory, we propose to
post the names of group practices who:
(1) Submit data on the 2010 PQRI
quality measures through the proposed
group practice reporting option
described in section II.G.2.g. of this
proposed rule; (2) meet the proposed
criteria for satisfactory reporting under
the group practice reporting option; and
(3) qualify to earn a PQRI incentive
payment for covered professional
services furnished during the applicable
2010 PQRI reporting period for group
practices.
In addition to posting the information
required by section 1848(m)(5)(G) of the
Act, for those group practices that are
selected to participate in PQRI under
the group practice reporting option, we
also propose to make the group
practices’ PQRI performance rates
publicly available, for each of the
measures. As we stated in the CY 2009
PFS proposed rule (73 FR 38574
through 38575), it is our goal to make
the quality of care for services furnished
to Medicare beneficiaries publicly
available by making physician quality
measure performance rates, either at the
individual practitioner level or
physician group level, publicly
available. While we currently have Web
pages at https://www.medicare.gov for
the public reporting of performance
results on standardized quality
measures for hospitals (Hospital
Compare), dialysis facilities (Dialysis
Facility Compare), nursing homes
(Nursing Home Compare), and home
health facilities (Home Health
Compare), we do not have a similar
Compare Web site for information on
the quality of care for services furnished
by physicians and other professionals to
Medicare beneficiaries.
Public reporting of group practices’
PQRI performance results at the group
practice level would allow us to move
toward our goal of making information
on physician performance publicly
available. We believe that the way we
have proposed to design the group
practice reporting option (see section
II.G.2.g. of this proposed rule) facilitates
public reporting of the groups’
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
performance results. Group practices
participating in the group practice
reporting option would have already
agreed in advance to have their
performance results publicly reported.
All groups participating in the group
practice reporting option would be
reporting on identical measures, which
facilitate comparison of the results
across groups. In addition, as a result of
the proposed reporting criteria, no
performance results would be calculated
based on small denominator sizes.
Finally, because we intend to modify
the data collection tool will provide
each group practice with numerator,
denominator, and performance rates for
each measure at the time of tool
submission, the group practice will have
had an opportunity to review their
performance results before they are
made public.
In making performance rates for group
practices publicly available, we will
attribute the group practice’s
performance to the entire group. We
will not post information with respect to
the performance of individual
physicians or other eligible
professionals associated with the group.
However, we may identify the
individual eligible professionals who
were associated with the group during
the reporting period. We invite
comments regarding our proposal to
publicly report group practices’ PQRI
performance results.
3. Section 131(c): Physician Resource
Use Measurement and Reporting
Program
33589
b. Background
As we stated in the CY 2009 PFS final
rule with comment period (73 FR
69866), the Program would consist of
multiple phases. We included a
summary of the activities of phase I of
the Program in the CY 2009 PFS final
rule with comment period (73 FR 69866
through 69869). In addition to
discussing phase I of the Program, we
also highlighted the activities of several
other initiatives, including Medicare
Value-Based Purchasing (VBP) programs
and demonstrations and related
activities undertaken by the MedPAC
and the Government Accountability
Office (GAO). We refer readers to the CY
2009 PFS final rule with comment
period (73 FR 69866 through 69869) for
a detailed discussion of these activities.
In the CY 2009 PFS final rule with
comment period (73 FR 69866 through
69869), we finalized, on an interim
basis, the following parameters for
phase I of the Program: (1) Use of both
per capita and episode of care
methodologies for resource use
measurement; (2) cost of service
category analysis (for example, imaging
services or inpatient admissions); (3)
use of 4 calendar years of claims data;
(4) focus on high cost and/or high
volume conditions; (5) reporting to
physician specialties relevant to the
selected focal conditions; (6) focus on
physicians practicing in certain
geographic areas, and (7) low, median,
and high cost benchmarks. We intend to
finalize these parameters in the CY 2010
PFS final rule with comment period.
a. Statutory Authority
c. Summary of Comments From the CY
2009 PFS Final Rule With Comment
Period
As required under section 1848(n) of
the Act, as added by section 131(c) of
the MIPPA, we established and
implemented by January 1, 2009, a
Physician Feedback Program using
Medicare claims data and other data to
provide confidential feedback reports to
physicians (and as determined
appropriate by the Secretary, to groups
of physicians) that measure the
resources involved in furnishing care to
Medicare beneficiaries. Section 1848(n)
of the Act authorizes us, as we
determine appropriate, to include
information on the quality of care
furnished to Medicare beneficiaries by
the physician (or group of physicians) in
the reports. Although we initially called
this effort the Physician Resource Use
Feedback Program, we are renaming this
initiative the ‘‘Physician Resource Use
Measurement and Reporting Program’’
(hereinafter referred to as ‘‘Program’’).
Section 1848(n)(1)(B) of the Act
requires that the Program measures
resources based on the following: (1) An
episode basis; (2) a per capita basis; or
(3) both an episode and a per capita
basis. We solicited public comments on
the use of each of these measurement
methodologies (73 FR 69868).
Comment: Commenters were in favor
of using both the per capita and the per
episode measurement methodologies.
Response: We agree with commenters
that both the per capita and per episode
methodologies are appropriate measures
of cost for the Program. Each
methodology offers distinct advantages.
For a further discussion regarding the
advantages, we refer readers to CMS’
Medicare Resource Use Measurement
Plan Web site at https://
www.cms.hhs.gov/
QualityInitiativesGenInfo/downloads/
ResourceUse_Roadmap_OEA_1–
15_508.pdf. We intend to finalize both
PO 00000
Frm 00071
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33590
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
methodologies as options for use in
future phases of the Program in the CY
2010 PFS final rule with comment
period.
In phase I of the Program, we
included cost of service (COS) category
information from aggregated Medicare
FFS claims data. We solicited public
comment on which COS categories are
most meaningful and actionable (73 FR
69868).
Comment: Commenters were
overwhelmingly in favor of including E/
M services and imaging services as
meaningful and actionable COS
categories. Further, commenters
supported including laboratory services,
outpatient services, procedures, and
post-acute services as COS categories.
No commenters raised specific
categories that should be excluded.
Response: We appreciate the
comments in support of the COS
category analysis. We intend to finalize
the option to include information on all
of these COS categories in future phases
of the Program in the CY 2010 PFS final
rule with comment period.
Section 1848(n)(3) of the Act requires
that, to the extent practicable, the data
for the reports shall be based on the
most recent data available. In phase I of
the Physician Resource Use Feedback
Program, we used Medicare FFS claims
data from CY 2004 through CY 2007. We
solicited public comment on this
approach (73 FR 69868).
Comment: The majority of
commenters stated that 3 calendar years
of data is sufficient for calculating
resource use measures. Further,
commenters emphasized, to the extent
practicable, CMS should use the most
recent three years of data available for
the Program.
Response: We agree with commenters
that 3 years of Medicare FFS claims data
are sufficient for calculating resource
use measures. We intend to finalize the
use of the most recent 3 years of data
available for the Program in the CY 2010
PFS final rule with comment period.
Under section 1848(n)(4)(B) of the
Act, the Secretary may focus the
Program as appropriate, including
focusing on physicians who treat
conditions that are high cost, high
volume, or both. We finalized on an
interim basis for phase I of the Program,
the following conditions: (1) Congestive
heart failure; (2) chronic obstructive
pulmonary disease; (3) prostate cancer;
(4) cholecystitis; (5) coronary artery
disease with acute myocardial
infarction; (6) hip fracture; (7)
community-acquired pneumonia; and
(8) urinary tract infection (73 FR 69868).
We solicited public comments on the
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
use of these high cost/high volume
conditions (73 FR 69868).
Comment: Commenters strongly
supported these conditions as
appropriate for measuring the resources
furnished to Medicare beneficiaries. In
addition, several commenters suggested
that we include diabetes among the
priority conditions for the Program.
Response: We agree with commenters
that diabetes is an important condition
to capture in the Program. We intend to
finalize the option to include: (1)
Congestive heart failure; (2) chronic
obstructive pulmonary disease; (3)
prostate cancer; (4) cholecystitis; (5)
coronary artery disease with acute
myocardial infarction; (6) hip fracture;
(7) community-acquired pneumonia; (8)
urinary tract infection; and (9) diabetes,
in the Program in the CY 2010 PFS final
rule with comment period.
Under section 1848(n)(4)(A) of the
Act, we are permitted to focus reporting
on physician specialties that account for
a certain percentage of spending for
physicians’ services. Based on the high
cost and high volume conditions
selected above, we included the
following physician specialties in phase
I of the Program: General internal
medicine, family practice,
gastroenterology, cardiology, general
surgery, infectious disease, neurology,
orthopedic surgery, physical medicine
and rehabilitation, pulmonology, and
urology (73 FR 69868). We solicited
public comments on the inclusion of
these physician specialties (73 FR
69868).
Comment: Commenters supported
including all of the physician specialties
listed above as appropriate for
measurement and reporting based on
the selected conditions.
Response: We agree with commenters
that the physician specialties listed
above should be included in the
Program. We intend to finalize the
option to include these physician
specialties in the Program in the CY
2010 PFS final rule with comment
period.
Section 1848(n)(4)(D) of the Act
permits us to focus the Program on
physicians practicing in certain
geographic areas. In the CY 2009 PFS
final rule with comment period (73 FR
69866 through 69869) we referenced
two geographic sites (Baltimore, MD and
Boston, MA) for phase I of the Program,
which we generally selected based on
close proximity to the CMS central
office and due to high per capita
Medicare costs, respectively. Since the
final rule was published, we have also
mailed reports to physicians in the
following sites:
• Greenville, SC;
PO 00000
Frm 00072
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
• Indianapolis, IN;
• Northern New Jersey;
• Orange County, CA;
• Seattle, WA;
• Syracuse, NY;
• Boston, MA;
• Cleveland, OH;
• East Lansing, MI;
• Little Rock, AR;
• Miami, FL; and
• Phoenix, AZ.
Comment: Commenters were in favor
of including a limited number of sites
representing a wide range of geographic
locations to facilitate a phased
implementation. No commenters
submitted specific areas that should be
excluded.
Response: We appreciate the
comments in support of including a
limited number of sites. We intend to
continue to include the geographic sites
listed above, and identify a limited
number of new locations, in the
Program in the CY 2010 PFS final rule
with comment period.
Section 1848(n)(4)(C) of the Act also
permits us to focus the program on
physicians who use a high amount of
resources compared to other physicians.
The resource use reports disseminated
in phase I of the Program defined peer
groups of physicians by focusing on one
condition, one specialty, and one of the
geographic locations mentioned above.
Within each peer group, the resource
use reports indicated whether the
physician fell over the 90th percentile
(high cost benchmark), below the 10th
percentile (low cost benchmark), or over
the 50th percentile (median cost
benchmark). We solicited public
comments on which cost benchmarks
make the resource use reports
meaningful, actionable, and fair (73 FR
69869).
Comment: Commenters supported the
use of high, median, and low cost
benchmarks because the benchmarks
highlight useful cost categories within a
given peer group.
Response: We agree with commenters
that the high, median, and low cost
benchmarks are appropriate. We intend
to finalize these cost benchmarks as
options to include in the Program in the
CY 2010 PFS final rule with comment
period.
Comment: A few commenters
expressed support for including small
geographic areas for benchmarking.
Response: Though we recognize that a
small geographic benchmark may
capture a more homogenous beneficiary
population for comparison, smaller
sample sizes may adversely affect the
statistical precision of the comparison.
A larger sample captured through
broader geographic benchmarks makes
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
it less likely that physicians will be
erroneously identified as high or low
cost outliers.
In addition to commenting on specific
statutory parameters, commenters also
provided feedback on other general
topics. Those comments and responses
are included below.
Comment: A few commenters
mentioned the use of proprietary
commercial episode grouper software as
a barrier to transparency within the
Program. These commenters indicated
that in order to understand and validate
the resource use reports, physicians
would need additional information
about how the proprietary commercial
software allocated costs to episodes.
Response: One of the primary goals of
CMS’ VBP initiatives is to implement
performance-based incentive payment
programs with transparent
methodologies. We note that the
Program is currently limited under
section 1848(n)(1)(A) of the Act to
confidential reporting. Use of physician
resource use information for other
purposes, such as payment or public
reporting, would likely require a higher
level of transparency than confidential
reporting.
We note that we have previously
discussed the use of proprietary
products for payment purposes in
previous rules published in the Federal
Register. For example, we discussed the
use of a proprietary product prior to
implementation of the MS–DRGs in the
FY 2007 IPPS final rule (72 FR 47171).
We recognize the efforts of episode
grouper vendors toward improved
transparency. For more information on
episode groupers that is publicly
available, we refer readers to the
following Web sites: https://
www.ingenix.com/ThoughtLeadership/
ETG/EtgRegistration/ and https://
www.thomsonreuters.com/
business_units/healthcare/.
We are soliciting public comment on
the use of proprietary products to
measure episodes of the care in the
Program.
Comment: Some commenters
expressed that the best method for
dissemination of resource use reports is
paper copies distributed via the mail.
Others favored an electronic mechanism
for dissemination. Some commenters
expressed that resource use reports
should be made available in both paper
format and electronically.
Response: For phase I of the Program,
we disseminated reports in paper form
via mail. We agree with commenters
that electronic dissemination would
also be desirable. Pending resource
availability, we will consider this
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
suggestion in a future phase of the
Program.
d. Phase I of the Program
As indicated above, the Program
consists of multiple phases. Under this
approach, each phase of the Program
will inform future phases of the
Program. We refer readers to the CY
2009 PFS final rule with comment
period (73 FR 69866 through 69869) for
a description of phase I Program
activities. Using the parameters that
were finalized on an interim basis, we
have disseminated approximately 230
resource use reports to physicians in
each of the 12 geographic regions listed
above in this section. We refer readers
to the following Web site to review a deidentified sample of the resource use
reports disseminated to physicians:
https://rurinfo.mathematica-mpr.com/.
We are soliciting public comment on the
design and elements of the sample
resource use report used in phase I of
the Program. We are particularly
interested in receiving comment on the
usefulness of the cost of service category
drill-down analysis included on pages
10, 16, 20, 24, 28, 32, and 36 of the
sample resource use report. These
comments will inform future phases of
the Program.
e. Phase II of the Program
For phase II, we are proposing to
expand the Program in ways that will
make the information more meaningful
and actionable for physicians. We are
proposing to add reporting to groups of
physicians recognizing that physicians
practice in various arrangements. Group
level reporting provides a mechanism
for addressing sample size issues that
arise when individual physicians have
too few Medicare beneficiaries with
specific conditions to generate
statistically significant reports. We are
also proposing to add quality
measurement information as context for
interpreting comparative resource use.
These proposals are addressed in greater
detail below in this section.
Phase I of the Program focused on
providing confidential feedback on
resource use measures to individual
physicians. Section 1848(n)(1)(A) of the
Act states that the Secretary may also
provide confidential feedback reports to
groups of physicians. Many physicians
practice in groups. Recognizing groups
of physicians within the Program is
consistent with other CMS VBP
initiatives and demonstrations under
the Medicare program.
We are proposing to provide reports
to groups of physicians, in addition to
providing reports to individual
physicians, for the Program. In
PO 00000
Frm 00073
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33591
December 2008, CMS posted an Issues
Paper on the Development of a
Transition to a Medicare Physician
Value-Based Purchasing Program for
Physician and Other Professional
Services.1 The Issues paper describes
cost of care measurement, the focus of
Phase I of this Program, as one of the
central tenets of Physician Value-Based
Purchasing (see section II.G.4. of this
proposed rule). Further, the Issues Paper
referenced possible groups of physicians
under consideration including: (1)
Formally established single or multispecialty group practices; (2) physicians
practicing in defined geographic
regions; and (3) physicians practicing
within facilities or larger systems of
care. We are soliciting public comments
on the appropriateness of resource use
measurement and reporting for these
and other groups of physicians.
Phase I of the Program focused on
providing confidential feedback on
resource use measures. Section
1848(n)(1)(A) of the Act states that the
Secretary may also include information
on quality of care furnished to Medicare
beneficiaries by the physician.
Providing physicians with feedback on
both quality and cost of care better
captures the value of the care provided.
Including quality measures in the
Program is consistent with the direction
for other CMS VBP initiatives.
We are proposing the use of quality
measures, in addition to resource use
measures, for the Program. Possible
sources of quality measures include the
Physician Quality Reporting Initiative
(PQRI) (see section II.G.2. of this
proposed rule) and the Generating
Medicare Physician Quality
Performance Measurement Results
(referred to as GEM) Project.2 We refer
readers to the Issues Paper, mentioned
above,3 for additional discussion on
how CMS would use quality measures
in this Program and for Physician ValueBased Purchasing (see section II.G.4. of
this proposed rule). We are soliciting
public comments on the use of PQRI,
GEM, and other broader aggregate
quality measures to be used to capture
value for the groups proposed above in
the Physician Resource Use
Measurement and Reporting Program.
1 https://www.cms.hhs.gov/PhysicianFeeSched/
downloads/PhysicianVBP-Plan-Issues-Pape.pdf.
2 https://www.cms.hhs.gov/GEM/.
3 https://www.cms.hhs.gov/PhysicianFeeSched/
downloads/PhysicianVBP-Plan-Issues-Pape.pdf.
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33592
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
4. Section 131(d): Plan for Transition to
Value-Based Purchasing Program for
Physicians and Other Practitioners
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
a. Background
Value-based purchasing uses payment
incentives and transparency to increase
the value of care by rewarding providers
for higher quality and more efficient
services and for publicly reporting
performance information. Section
131(d) of the MIPPA requires the
Secretary to develop a plan to transition
to a value-based purchasing (VBP)
program for Medicare payment for
covered professional services made
under, or based on, the PFS. Section
131(d) of the MIPPA also states that by
May 1, 2010, the Secretary shall submit
a report to the Congress, containing the
plan, together with recommendations
for such legislation and administrative
action as the Secretary determines
appropriate. The Secretary, through the
Physician and Other Health Professional
VBP (PVBP) Workgroup, submitted a
progress letter to Congress on January 8,
2009 detailing the progress made on the
VBP plan for physicians and other
professionals.
Currently, Medicare health
professional payments are based on
quantity of services and procedures
provided, without recognition of quality
or efficiency. Under various authorities,
we have pursued the implementation of
building blocks to support the
establishment of a VBP program for
health professionals. These include
initiatives in the following major topic
areas: Quality and efficiency
measurement and reporting, approaches
for aligning incentives with providing
higher quality care instead of higher
volume of care, care coordination,
prevention, and health information
technology (HIT). The following is a list
of examples of the initiatives
specifically relevant to physicians and
other health professionals:
• Pay for reporting of quality
measurement data instituted under the
Physician Quality Reporting Initiative
(PQRI);
• Resource use reports comparing
overall costs, as well as costs for
treatment across episodes of care, as
part of, as required by the Physician
Resource Use Feedback Program (See
section II.G.3. of this proposed rule);
and
• Demonstration projects, including
the Physician Group Practice
demonstration of a shared savings
model, gainsharing demonstrations,
medical home and other care
coordination and disease management
demonstrations, and the Acute Care
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
Episodes demonstration of a bundled
payment model.
We are fully committed to
implementing VBP incentives to drive
quality improvement and greater
efficiency for services furnished to
Medicare beneficiaries.
b. Approach to Plan Development
We have created an internal crosscomponent team, the PVBP Workgroup,
to lead development of the PVBP Plan.
Four Subgroups were established to
address the major sections of the Plan:
Measures; incentives; data strategy and
infrastructure; and public reporting. The
PVBP Workgroup was tasked with
reviewing the state-of-the-art in
performance-based payment for
physicians, including relevant Medicare
programs and demonstrations and
private sector initiatives; preparing an
Issues Paper to present program
objectives and design principles;
engaging stakeholders and obtaining
input on program design; and
developing the PVBP Plan and Report to
Congress. A similar approach was used
in the development of the CMS Hospital
VBP Plan.
To guide the planning process, the
PVBP Workgroup adopted the following
goal to improve Medicare beneficiary
health outcomes and experience of care
by using payment incentives and
transparency to encourage higher
quality, more efficient professional
services. In pursuit of this goal, the
Workgroup has defined the following
objectives:
• Promote evidence-based medicine
through measurement, payment
incentives, and transparency.
• Reduce fragmentation and
duplication through accountability
across settings, alignment of measures
and incentives across settings, better
care coordination for smoother
transitions, and attention to episodes of
care.
• Encourage effective management of
chronic disease by improving early
detection and prevention, focusing on
preventable hospital readmissions, and
emphasizing the importance of
advanced care planning and appropriate
end-of-life care.
• Accelerate the adoption of effective,
interoperable HIT, including clinical
registries, e-prescribing, and electronic
health records.
• Empower consumers to make valuebased health care choices and encourage
health professionals to improve the
value of care by disseminating
actionable performance information.
The goal and objectives were captured
in an Issues Paper that was posted on
the CMS Web site on November 24,
PO 00000
Frm 00074
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
2008, in preparation for the December 9,
2008 Listening Session which was held
at CMS headquarters. The Issues Paper
included questions seeking public input
on key design considerations. The
Issues Paper is available on the CMS
Web site at https://www.cms.hhs.gov/
PhysicianFeeSched/downloads/
PhysicianVBP-Plan-Issues-Paper.pdf.
Nearly 500 stakeholders participated in
the day-long Listening Session. We
received both verbal and written
comments that are informing the design
of the PVBP Plan.
c. Stakeholder Input From the Listening
Session
Both at the Listening Session, and in
written comments received following
the Session, we obtained input from a
wide range of diverse stakeholders. A
large portion of the comments were
received from physician and other
professional specialty societies.
Commenters also included consumer
advocates, health care consulting firms,
and health IT vendors, and individual
practicing physicians.
(1) Overarching Issues
Commenters generally affirmed the
goal and objectives presented in the
Issues Paper. Commenters encouraged
the consideration of new payment
approaches that cut across settings of
care to align Medicare Part A and Part
B payment incentives. Many
commenters stated that the current
Medicare payment system for health
professionals is flawed in that it fails to
align incentives for high-value care
across providers and settings and that
this cannot be fixed solely by a VBP
program. Commenters agreed with the
Issues Paper assumption that the Plan
will need to contain more than one
approach to accommodate different
practice arrangements. Several
commenters praised the attention given
in the Issues Paper to addressing
disparities and pointed out the necessity
of adequate risk adjustment and proper
use of measures, incentives, and
program evaluation to protect
vulnerable populations. Commenters
also urged careful attention to the
operational transition from the current
payment system to VBP to minimize
care delivery disruptions.
(2) Measurement
Commenters emphasized the
importance of aligning measures across
payment settings and applying measures
consistently across payers. Many
commenters stressed the need for valid,
reliable, nationally-recognized
measures, particularly in the areas of
outcomes, care coordination, patient
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
experience, and the effective use of HIT.
Adequate risk adjustment was raised as
a paramount issue for outcomes and
resource use measures. Regarding
resource use measures, several
commenters noted that quality and cost
measures should be reported together
and that CMS should get experience
with confidential feedback reporting of
resource use before using the
information for incentives or public
reporting (See section II.G.3. of this
proposed rule). A few commenters
suggested avoidable readmission rates
as a good measure of both cost and
quality of care. Commenters emphasized
the importance of CMS working with
health professionals on the selection of
quality and cost measures.
Commenters generally agreed with the
Issues Paper assumption that the Plan
should address multiple levels of
accountability, including individual
health professionals, care teams, group
practices, and accountable care entities.
A few commenters mentioned that
performance measurement at the
regional level could help address
regional variation. Consumer advocates
made strong arguments for individual
accountability, while noting that care
delivery is ultimately a team effort.
Others noted that measurement is more
difficult at the individual level and that
accountability at more aggregated levels
could support promising payment
models like bundled payment,
gainsharing, and shared savings.
(3) Incentives
Commenters noted that incentive
payments should be large enough to be
meaningful, be made timely, and at least
cover the cost of participating in the
program. Commenters encouraged us to
coordinate the incentives, as well as
measures, with other payers. Many
commenters stated that incentives
should reward both improvement and
attainment, and not be based on a
ranking system that rewards only high
attainers; instead, all who perform
above a certain prospective benchmark
should earn the incentive. Several
commenters indicated that use of
incentives could be an effective way to
promote the use of effective HIT. Most
commenters agreed that more than one
incentive structure would be necessary
to address different practice
arrangements and to focus effort on
specific objectives (for example, care
coordination).
(4) Data Strategy and Infrastructure
Commenters emphasized that the
administrative burden of data exchange,
for both health professionals and CMS,
should be minimized. Several
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
commenters noted that clinical data
registries and direct reporting from
electronic health records were superior
approaches to claims-based reporting for
gathering clinical data. Commenters
indicated that feedback on performance
should be timely and detailed enough to
be actionable. Commenters also asked
for the opportunity to review and appeal
the accuracy of their performance
assessments prior to use of that
information for payment incentives or
public reporting.
(5) Public Reporting
Consumer advocates highlighted the
importance of transparency while
professional associations urged caution
to assure that publicly reported
information not be inaccurate or
misleading for consumers. Several
commenters noted that public reporting
should address multiple levels of
accountability, including individual
health professionals, the care delivery
team, group practices, and at the
regional level. All agreed that publicly
reported information should be userfriendly.
d. Next Steps in Plan Development
Building on input from the Listening
Session on the Issues Paper topics, the
PVBP Workgroup has begun to develop
potential recommendations for
inclusion in the Report to Congress. The
first step is to design various approaches
for performance-based payment that
will address the planning goal and
objectives for different practice
arrangements. This design process will
include identifying appropriate
measures and incentive structures,
considering the necessary data
infrastructure, and addressing public
reporting options. Consideration will be
given to approaches that:
(1) Overlay the current PFS, such as
differential fee schedule payments
based on measured performance or for
providing a medical home;
(2) Address multiple levels of
accountability, including individual
health professionals, as well as larger
teams or organizations; and
(3) Promote more integrated care
through shared savings models and
bundled payment arrangements.
We are seeking further public
comment on the development of the
PVBP plan and Report to Congress.
Comments already submitted by
participating in person at the December
9, 2008 Listening Session or as written
comments following the Session, do not
need to be resubmitted. At this time, we
are soliciting original comments that
were not previously submitted.
Particularly, we are interested in the
PO 00000
Frm 00075
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33593
comments further discussing the issues
of the appropriate level of
accountability (for example, group
practice, individual, region), and
appropriate data submission
mechanisms. The PVBP Workgroup will
use public comment to inform its
development of the Plan and Report to
Congress.
5. Section 132: Incentives for Electronic
Prescribing (E-Prescribing)—The EPrescribing Incentive Program
a. Program Background and Statutory
Authority
As defined in § 423.159(a), eprescribing is the transmission using
electronic media, of prescription or
prescription-related information
between a prescriber, dispenser,
pharmacy benefit manager (PBM), or
health plan, either directly or through
an intermediary, including an eprescribing network. E-prescribing
includes, but is not limited to, two-way
transmissions between the point of care
and the dispenser.
As discussed in the CY 2009 PFS final
rule with comment period (73 FR
69847), there are many potential
advantages to e-prescribing. Yet, there
has been limited adoption and use of
electronic prescribing by physicians and
other professionals who prescribe
medications. It is estimated that only 12
percent of office-based prescribers
currently use e-prescribing (Surescripts.
‘‘National Progress Report on EPrescribing.’’ Welcome to the EPrescribing Resource Center. 2008.
Surescripts. 15 May 2009. https://
www.surescripts.com/downloads/NPR/
national-progress-report.pdf).
As described in the CY 2009 PFS final
rule with comment period (73 FR 69847
through 69848), the MMA and the
creation of the Medicare Prescription
Drug Benefit Program (Part D) promoted
the use of e-prescribing by requiring the
adoption of uniform standards for the
Medicare Part D electronic prescribing
(‘‘e-prescribing’’) program. As required
by section 1860D–4(e) of the Act,
‘‘foundation standards’’ were adopted
on November 7, 2005 (70 FR 67568) and
additional Part D e-prescribing
standards were adopted on April 7,
2008, and were implemented April 1,
2009 (73 FR 18918). Section 1848(m) of
the Act, as amended by section 132 of
the MIPPA, further promotes the use of
e-prescribing by authorizing incentive
payments to eligible professionals or
group practices who are ‘‘successful
electronic prescribers.’’ This EPrescribing Incentive Program is
expected to encourage significant
expansion of the use of e-prescribing by
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33594
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
authorizing a combination of financial
incentives and payment adjustment and
is separate from, and in addition to, any
incentive payment that eligible
professionals may earn through the
PQRI program discussed in section
II.G.2. of this proposed rule. Eligible
professionals do not have to participate
in PQRI to participate in the EPrescribing Incentive Program (and vice
versa).
For 2010, which is the second year of
the E-Prescribing Incentive Program, the
Secretary is authorized to provide
successful e-prescribers, as defined in
section 1848(m)(3)(B) of the Act and
further discussed below in this section,
an incentive payment equal to 2.0
percent of the total estimated (based on
claims submitted not later than 2
months after the end of the reporting
period) allowed charges for all covered
professional services furnished during
the 2010 reporting period. Covered
professional services are defined under
the statute to be services for which
payment is made under, or is based on,
the PFS and which are furnished by an
eligible professional. The applicable
electronic prescribing percent (2
percent) authorized for the 2010 EPrescribing Incentive Program is the
same as that authorized for the 2009 EPrescribing Incentive Program.
Subject to section 1848(m)(2)(D) of the
Act, as added by section 4101(f)(2)(B) of
the HITECH Act (Title IV of Division B
of the Recovery Act, together with Title
XIII of Division A of the Recovery Act)
(Pub. L. 111–5), which was enacted on
February 17, 2009, the incentive
payments for successful electronic
prescribers for future years are
authorized under section 1848(b)(2)(C)
of the Act as follows:
• 1.0 percent for 2011.
• 1.0 percent for 2012.
• 0.5 percent for 2013.
Section 1848(m)(2)(D) of the Act, as
added by section 4001(f)(2)(B) of the
Recovery Act, specifies a limitation to
the e-prescribing incentive in relation to
whether the EHR incentive authorized
by the Recovery Act is earned. Section
1848(m)(2)(D) of the Act specifically
provides that the e-prescribing incentive
does not apply to an eligible
professional (or group practice), if, for
the EHR reporting period, the eligible
professional (or group practice) earns an
incentive payment under the new
Health Information Technology (HIT)
incentive program authorized by the
Recovery Act for eligible professionals
who are meaningful EHR users. The
new HIT incentive program for
meaningful EHR users begins in 2011.
Therefore, beginning in 2011, eligible
professionals who earn an incentive
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
under the new HIT incentive program
for meaningful EHR users, with respect
to a certified EHR technology that has eprescribing capabilities, would not be
eligible to earn a separate incentive
payment for being a successful
electronic prescriber under the Eprescribing Incentive Program.
In addition, under section
1848(a)(5)(A) of the Act, as added by
section 132(b) of the MIPPA and
amended by section 4001(f)(1) of the
Recovery Act, a PFS payment
adjustment applies beginning in 2012 to
those who are not successful electronic
prescribers. Specifically, for 2012, 2013,
and 2014, if the eligible professional is
not a successful electronic prescriber for
the reporting period for the year, the fee
schedule amount for covered
professional services furnished by such
professionals during the year shall be
less than the fee schedule amount that
would otherwise apply by:
• 1.0 percent for 2012.
• 1.5 percent for 2013.
• 2.0 percent for 2014.
We note that the criteria for
determination of successful electronic
prescriber proposed herein may not
necessarily be the criteria that will be
used to determine the applicability of
the payment adjustment in the future.
Policy considerations underlying the
application of the incentive payment are
not necessarily the same as those in
applying a payment adjustment. In
general, we believe that an incentive
should be broadly available to
encourage the widest possible adoption
of e-prescribing, even for low volume
prescribers. On the other hand, a
payment adjustment should be applied
primarily to assure that those who have
a large volume of prescribing do so
electronically, without penalizing those
for whom the adoption and use of an eprescribing system may be impractical
given the low volume of prescribing. We
will discuss the application of the
payment adjustment in future notice
and comment rulemaking, but prior to
the beginning of the reporting period
that will be used to determine the
applicability of the payment adjustment.
Under section 1848(m)(6)(A) of the
Act, the definition of ‘‘eligible
professional’’ for purposes of eligibility
for the E-Prescribing Incentive Program
is identical to the definition of ‘‘eligible
professional’’ for the PQRI under section
1848(k)(3)(B) of the Act. In other words,
eligible professionals include
physicians, other practitioners as
described in section 1842(b)(18)(C) of
the Act, physical and occupational
therapists, qualified speech-language
pathologists, and qualified audiologists.
However, for purposes of the E-
PO 00000
Frm 00076
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
prescribing Incentive Program,
eligibility is further restricted by scope
of practice to those professionals who
have prescribing authority. Detailed
information about the types of
professionals that are eligible to
participate in the E-Prescribing
Incentive Program is available on the
‘‘Eligible Professionals’’ page of the EPrescribing Incentive Program section of
the CMS Web site at https://
www.cms.hhs.gov/ERXIncentive.
Similar to the PQRI, the E-Prescribing
Incentive Program, in 2009, is an
incentive program in which
determination of whether an eligible
professional is a successful electronic
prescriber will be made at the
individual professional level, based on
the NPI. Inasmuch as some individuals
(identified by NPIs) may be associated
with more than one practice or TIN, the
determination of whether an eligible
professional is a successful electronic
prescriber will be made to the holder of
each unique TIN/NPI combination.
Then, payment will be made to the
applicable holder of the TIN. For 2010,
the determination of whether an eligible
professional is a successful electronic
prescriber will continue to be made for
each unique TIN/NPI combination.
However, section 1848(m)(3)(C) of the
Act requires the Secretary by January 1,
2010 to establish and have in place a
process under which eligible
professionals in a group practice (as
defined by the Secretary) shall be
treated as meeting the requirements for
submitting data on electronic
prescribing quality measures for covered
professional services for a reporting
period (or, for purposes of the payment
adjustment under section 1848(a)(5) of
the Act, for a reporting period for a year)
if, in lieu of reporting the electronic
prescribing measure, the group practice
reports measures determined
appropriate by the Secretary, such as
measures that target high-cost chronic
conditions and preventive care, in a
form and manner, and at a time
specified by the Secretary. Therefore, in
addition to making incentive payments
for 2010 to group practices based on
separately analyzing whether the
individual eligible professionals within
the group practice are successful
electronic prescribers, we will also
begin making incentive payments to
group practices based on the
determination that the group practice, as
a whole, is a successful electronic
prescriber.
b. The Proposed 2010 Reporting Period
for the E-Prescribing Incentive Program
Section 1848(m)(6)(C)(i)(II) of the Act
defines ‘‘reporting period’’ for the 2010
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
E-Prescribing Incentive Program to be
the entire year. Section 1848(m)(6)(C)(ii)
of the Act, as added by the MIPPA,
however, authorizes the Secretary to
revise the reporting period for years
after 2009 if the Secretary determines
such revision is appropriate, produces
valid results on measures reported, and
is consistent with the goals of
maximizing scientific validity and
reducing administrative burden. We
propose the 2010 E-Prescribing
Incentive Program reporting period will
be the entire year (January 1, 2010–
December 31, 2010). We believe that
keeping the 2010 E-Prescribing
Incentive Program reporting period
consistent with the 2009 E-Prescribing
Incentive Program reporting period will
help to maintain program stability and
be less confusing for eligible
professionals.
Successful electronic prescribers
would be eligible to receive an incentive
payment equal to 2.0 percent of the total
estimated allowed charges (based on
claims submitted by no later than
February 28, 2011) for all covered
professional services furnished January
1, 2010 through December 31, 2010.
c. Proposed Criteria for Determination of
Successful E-Prescriber for Eligible
Professionals
Under section 1848(m)(3)(B) of the
Act, in order to qualify for the incentive
payment, an eligible professional must
be a ‘‘successful electronic prescriber,’’
which the Secretary is authorized to
identify using 1 of 2 possible criteria.
One criterion, under section
1848(m)(3)(B)(ii) of the Act, is based on
the eligible professional’s reporting, in
at least 50 percent of the reportable
cases, on any e-prescribing quality
measures that have been established
under the physician reporting system
under subsection 1848(k) (which, as
noted previously, we have named
‘‘PQRI’’ for ease of reference) and are
applicable to services furnished by the
eligible professional during a reporting
period. The second criterion, under
section 1848(m)(3)(B)(iii) of the Act, is
based on the electronic submission by
the eligible professional of a sufficient
number (as determined by the Secretary)
of prescriptions under Part D during the
reporting period. If the Secretary
decides to use the latter standard, then,
in accordance with section
1848(m)(3)(B)(iv) of the Act, the
Secretary is authorized to use Part D
drug claims data to assess whether a
‘‘sufficient’’ number of prescriptions has
been submitted by eligible
professionals. However, under section
1848(m)(3)(B)(i) of the Act, if the
standard based on a sufficient number
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
(as determined by the Secretary) of
electronic Part D prescriptions is
applied for a particular reporting period,
then the standard based on the reporting
on e-prescribing measures would no
longer apply.
For 2009, as described in the CY 2009
PFS final rule with comment period (73
FR 69847 through 69852), we required
eligible professionals to report on the eprescribing measure that had been
previously used in the 2008 PQRI. For
2010, we propose to continue to require
eligible professionals to report on the
electronic prescribing measure used in
the 2009 E-Prescribing Incentive
Program to determine whether an
eligible professional is a successful eprescriber, but we propose to use
modified reporting criteria.
As we stated in the CY 2009 PFS final
rule with comment period (73 FR
69848), we intend to consider the use of
a certain number of Part D prescribing
events as the basis for the incentive
payment in future years. However, we
do not believe that it is feasible to move
to this substitute requirement in 2010.
The accuracy and completeness of the
Part D data with respect to whether a
prescription was submitted
electronically is unknown. Information
on whether a prescription was
submitted electronically by an
individual eligible professional will not
be collected on the Part D claims, or
prescription drug event (PDE) data, until
2010. Also, prescription drug plan
sponsors were not required to send PDE
data with an individual prescriber’s NPI
until April 1, 2009. We currently have
no information on the accuracy and
completeness of the NPI data that is
submitted with the PDE data. The NPI
is needed in order for us to be able to
link an eligible professional’s PDE data
to his or her Medicare Part B claims to
calculate the incentive payment
amount. During 2010, we expect to
evaluate the adequacy of Part D data to
determine the feasibility of its use for
determining whether an eligible
professional qualifies as a successful eprescriber in future years.
(1) Reporting the Electronic Prescribing
Measure
For 2009, we limited the reporting
mechanism for the electronic
prescribing measure to claims-based
reporting. For 2010, we propose 3
reporting mechanisms for individual
eligible professionals. First, we propose
to retain the claims-based reporting
mechanism that is used in the 2009 EPrescribing Incentive Program. In
addition, similar to the PQRI, for the Eprescribing Incentive Program, we
propose to implement a registry-based
PO 00000
Frm 00077
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33595
reporting mechanism and, depending on
whether we finalize the proposed EHRbased reporting mechanism for PQRI,
we are also proposing that an EHRbased reporting mechanism be available
for the electronic prescribing measure.
In other words, eligible professionals
would be able to choose whether to
submit data on the electronic
prescribing measure through claims, a
qualified registry, or a qualified EHR
product. As we stated in our discussion
of the proposed PQRI reporting
mechanisms for 2010 in section II.G.2.d.
of this proposed rule, we recognize that
one mode of quality reporting does not
suit all practices. Similar to the PQRI,
we believe that having multiple
reporting mechanisms for the reporting
of the electronic prescribing measure
should increase opportunities for
eligible professionals to successfully
report the electronic prescribing
measure. We invite comments on our
proposal to provide alternatives to the
claims-based reporting mechanism for
reporting the electronic prescribing
measure.
We propose that only registries
qualified to submit quality measure
results and numerator and denominator
data on quality measures on behalf of
eligible professionals for the 2010 PQRI
would be qualified to submit measure
results and numerator and denominator
data on the electronic prescribing
measure on behalf of eligible
professionals for the 2010 E-Prescribing
Incentive Program. We note that not all
registries qualified to submit quality
measure results and numerator and
denominator data on quality measures
on behalf of eligible professionals for
the 2010 PQRI would be qualified to
submit quality measure results and
numerator and denominator data on the
e-prescribing measure. PQRI qualified
registries will be qualified to submit
specific types of measures. The
electronic prescribing measure is
reportable by an eligible professional
any time he or she bills for one of the
procedure codes for Part B services
included in the measure’s denominator.
Some registries who self-nominate to
become a qualified registry for PQRI
may not choose to self-nominate to
become a qualified registry for
submitting measures that require
reporting at each eligible visit. Registries
will need to indicate their desire to
qualify to submit measure results and
numerator and denominator data on the
electronic prescribing measure for the
2010 E-Prescribing Incentive Program at
the time that they submit their selfnomination letter for the 2010 PQRI.
The self-nomination process and
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33596
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
requirements for registries for the PQRI,
which also would apply to the registries
for the 2010 E-Prescribing Incentive
Program, are discussed in section
II.G.2.d.(4) of this proposed rule. We
will post a list of qualified registries for
the 2010 E-Prescribing Incentive
Program on the E-Prescribing Incentive
Program section of the CMS Web site at
https://www.cms.hhs.gov/ERXIncentive
when we post the list of qualified
registries for the 2010 PQRI on the PQRI
section of the CMS Web site.
Similarly, we propose that only EHR
products ‘‘qualified’’ to potentially be
able to submit clinical quality data
extracted from the EHR to CMS for the
2010 PQRI would be considered
‘‘qualified’’ for the purpose of an
eligible professional potentially being
able to submit data on the electronic
prescribing measure for the 2010 EPrescribing Incentive Program. The selfnomination process and requirements
for EHR vendors for the PQRI, which
also would apply to the EHR vendors for
the 2010 E-Prescribing Incentive
Program are discussed in section
II.G.2.d.(5) of this proposed rule. EHR
vendors will need to indicate their
desire to have one or more of their EHR
products qualified for the purpose of an
eligible professional potentially being
able to submit data on the electronic
prescribing measure for the 2010 EPrescribing Incentive Program at the
time that they submit their selfnomination letter for the 2010 PQRI. If
we finalize the EHR-based reporting
mechanism for the 2010 PQRI, we will
post a list of qualified EHR vendors and
their products (including the version
that is qualified) for the 2010 EPrescribing Incentive Program, on the EPrescribing Incentive Program section of
the CMS Web site at https://
www.cms.hhs.gov/ERXIncentive when
we post the list of qualified EHR
products for the 2010 PQRI on the PQRI
section of the CMS Web site. We
welcome comments on our proposal to
limit the registries and EHR products
qualified to submit the electronic
prescribing measure for the 2010 EPrescribing Incentive Program to those
that are qualified registries and EHR
products, respectively, for the 2010
PQRI.
(2) The Reporting Denominator for the
Electronic Prescribing Measure
The electronic prescribing measure,
similar to the PQRI measures, has 2
basic elements. These include: (1) A
reporting denominator that defines the
circumstances when the measure is
reportable; and (2) a reporting
numerator.
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
The denominator for the electronic
prescribing measure consists of specific
billing codes for professional services.
The measure becomes reportable when
any one of these procedure codes is
billed by an eligible professional as Part
B covered professional services. For
2009, the codes included in the
measure’s denominator were codes that
are typically billed for services in the
office or outpatient setting furnished by
physicians or other eligible
professionals. There are no diagnosis
codes or age/gender requirements in
order to be included in the measure’s
denominator (that is, reporting of the e–
prescribing measure is not further
limited to certain ages or a specific
gender). However, as discussed further
under section II.G.5.c.(5) of this
proposed rule, eligible professionals are
not required to report this measure in all
cases in which the measure is
reportable. Physicians and other eligible
professionals who do not bill for one of
the procedure codes for Part B covered
professional services included in the
measure’s denominator will have no
occasion to report the electronic
prescribing measure.
Currently, the denominator codes for
the electronic prescribing measure
consist of the following CPT and Gcodes: 90801; 90802; 90804; 90805;
90806; 90807; 90808; 90809; 92002;
92004; 92012; 92014; 96150; 96151;
96152; 99201; 99202; 99203; 99204;
99205; 99211; 99212; 99213; 99214;
99215; 99241; 99242; 99243; 99244;
99245; G0101; G0108; G0109.
As initially required under section
1848(k)(2)(A)(ii) of the Act, and further
established through rulemaking and
under section 1848(m)(2)(B) of the Act,
however, we may modify the codes
making up the denominator of the
electronic prescribing measure. As such,
we propose, in response to public
comments received, to expand the scope
of the denominator codes for 2010 to
professional services outside the
professional office and outpatient
setting, such as professional services
furnished in skilled nursing facilities or
the home care setting. We propose to
add the following CPT codes to the
denominator of the electronic
prescribing measure for 2010: 99304;
99305; 99306; 99307; 99308; 99309;
99310; 99315; 99316; 99341; 99342;
99343; 99344; 99345; 99347; 99348;
99349; 99350; and 90862. The proposed
expansion of the electronic prescribing
measure denominator is expected to
provide more eligible professionals the
opportunity to report the measure, and
thus, provide more opportunities for
eligible professionals to participate in
the E-Prescribing Incentive Program. We
PO 00000
Frm 00078
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
invite comments on the proposed
changes to codes identified for the
electronic prescribing measure
denominator.
By December 31, 2009, we will post
the final specifications of the measure
on the ‘‘E-Prescribing Measure’’ page of
the E-Prescribing Incentive Program
section of the CMS Web site at https://
www.cms.hhs.gov/ERXIncentive.
(3) Qualified Electronic Prescribing
System—Required Functionalities and
Part D E-Prescribing Standards
To report the electronic prescribing
measure in 2010, we propose that the
eligible professional must report 1 of 3
‘‘G’’ codes, as will be discussed below.
However, in reporting any of the Gcodes and thereby qualifying for the
incentive payment for e-prescribing in
2010, the professional must have and
regularly use a ‘‘qualified’’ electronic
prescribing system as defined in the
electronic prescribing measure
specifications. If the professional does
not have general access to an eprescribing system in the practice
setting, there is nothing to report.
Required Functionalities for a
‘‘Qualified’’ Electronic Prescriber
System. What constitutes a ‘‘qualified’’
electronic prescribing system is based
upon certain required functionalities
that the system can perform. As
currently specified in the measure, a
‘‘qualified’’ electronic prescribing
system is one that can:
(a) Generate a complete active
medication list incorporating electronic
data received from applicable
pharmacies and PBMs, if available.
(b) Allow eligible professionals to
select medications, print prescriptions,
electronically transmit prescriptions,
and conduct alerts (written or acoustic
signals to warn the prescriber of
possible undesirable or unsafe
situations including potentially
inappropriate dose or route of
administration of a drug, drug-drug
interactions, allergy concerns, or
warnings and cautions). This
functionality must be enabled.
(c) Provide information related to
lower cost, therapeutically appropriate
alternatives (if any). The ability of an
electronic prescribing system to receive
tiered formulary information, if
available, would suffice for this
requirement for 2010 and until this
function is more widely available in the
marketplace.
(d) Provide information on formulary
or tiered formulary medications, patient
eligibility, and authorization
requirements received electronically
from the patient’s drug plan (if
available).
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
Part D E-Prescribing Standards.
Section 1848(m)(3)(B)(v) of the Act, to
the extent practicable, in determining
whether an eligible professional is a
successful e-prescriber, ‘‘the Secretary
shall ensure that eligible professionals
utilize electronic prescribing systems in
compliance with standards established
for such systems pursuant to the Part D
Electronic Prescribing Program under
section 1860D–4(e)’’ of the Act. The Part
D standards for electronic prescribing
systems establish which electronic
standards Part D sponsors, providers,
and dispensers must use when they
electronically transmit prescriptions
and certain prescription related
information for Part D covered drugs
that are prescribed for Part D eligible
individuals. To be a qualified electronic
prescribing system under the Eprescribing Incentive Program,
electronic systems must convey the
information listed above under (a)
through (d) using the standards
currently in effect for the Part D eprescribing program. Additional Part D
e-prescribing standards were
implemented April 1, 2009. These latest
Part D e-prescribing standards, and
those that had previously been adopted,
can be found on the CMS Web site at
https://www.cms.hhs.gov/eprescribing.
To ensure that eligible professionals
utilize electronic prescribing systems
that meet these requirements, the
electronic prescribing measure requires
that those functionalities required for a
‘‘qualified’’ electronic prescribing
system must utilize the adopted Part D
e-prescribing standards. The Part D eprescribing standards relevant to the
four functionalities for a ‘‘qualified’’
system in the electronic prescribing
measure, described above and listed as
(a), (b), (c), and (d), are:
(a) Generate medication list—Use the
National Council for Prescription Drug
Programs (NCPDP) Prescriber/
Pharmacist Interface SCRIPT Standard,
Implementation Guide, Version 8,
Release 1, October 2005 (hereinafter
‘‘NCPDP SCRIPT 8.1’’) Medication
History Standard;
(b) Transmit prescriptions
electronically—Use the NCPDP SCRIPT
8.1 for the transactions listed at
§ 423.160(b)(2);
(c) Provide information on lower cost
alternatives—Use the NCPDP Formulary
and Benefits Standard, Implementation
Guide, Version 1, Release 0 (Version
1.0), October 2005 (hereinafter ‘‘NCPDP
Formulary and Benefits 1.0’’);
(d) Provide information on formulary
or tiered formulary medications, patient
eligibility, and authorization
requirements received electronically
from the patient’s drug plan—use:
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
(1) NCPDP Formulary and Benefits 1.0
for communicating formulary and
benefits information between
prescribers and plans.
(2) Accredited Standards Committee
(ASC) X12N 270/271—Health Care
Eligibility Benefit Inquiry and Response,
Version 4010, May 2000, Washington
Publishing Company, 004010X092 and
Addenda to Health Care Eligibility
Benefit Inquiry and Response, Version
4010A1, October 2002, Washington
Publishing Company, 004010X092A1
for communicating eligibly information
between the plan and prescribers.
(3) NCPDP Telecommunication
Standard Specification, Version 5,
Release 1 (Version 5.1), September 1999,
and equivalent NCPDP Batch Standard
Batch Implementation Guide, Version 1,
Release 1 (Version 1.1), January 2000 for
communicating eligibility information
between the plan and dispensers.
There are, however, Part D eprescribing standards that are in effect
for functionalities that are not
commonly utilized at this time. Such
functionalities are not currently
required for a ‘‘qualified’’ system under
the electronic prescribing measure. One
example is Rx Fill Notification, which is
discussed in the Part D e-prescribing
final rule (73 FR 18918, 18926). For
purposes of the 2010 Electronic
Prescribing Program and incentive
payments, it is not required that the
electronic prescribing system contain all
functionalities for which there are
available Part D e-prescribing standards.
Rather, the only required functionalities
are those stated in the measure and
described above in the section entitled
‘‘Required Functionalities for a
‘Qualified’ Electronic Prescribing
System.’’ For those required
functionalities described above, we
propose that a ‘‘qualified’’ system must
use the adopted Part D e-prescribing
standards for electronic messaging.
There are other aspects of the
functionalities for a ‘‘qualified’’ system
that are not dependent on electronic
messaging and are part of the software
of the electronic prescribing system, for
which Part D standards for electronic
prescribing do not pertain. For example,
the requirements in qualification (b)
listed above that require the system to
allow professionals to select
medications, print prescriptions, and
conduct alerts are functions included in
the particular software, for which Part D
standards for electronic messaging do
not apply.
We are aware that there are significant
numbers of eligible professionals who
are interested in earning the incentive
payment, but currently do not have an
electronic prescribing system. The
PO 00000
Frm 00079
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33597
electronic prescribing measure does not
require the use of any particular system
or transmission network; only that the
system be a ‘‘qualified’’ system having
the functionalities described above
based on Part D e-prescribing standards.
(4) The Reporting Numerator for the
Electronic Prescribing Measure
Currently, to report for an applicable
case where 1 of the denominator codes
is billed for Part B services, an eligible
professional must report one of 3 Gcodes specified in the electronic
prescribing measure. Currently, the Gcodes are the following:
• One G-code is used to report that all
prescriptions in connection with the
visit billed were electronically
prescribed (G8443);
• Another G-code indicates that no
prescriptions were generated during the
visit (G8445); and
• A third G-code is used when some
or all prescriptions were written or
phoned in due to patient request, State
or Federal law, the pharmacy’s system
being unable to receive the data
electronically or because the
prescription was for a narcotic or other
controlled substance (G8446).
However, for 2010, we propose to
modify the first G-code (G8443) to
indicate that at least 1 prescription in
connection with the visit billed was
electronically prescribed. In addition,
we propose to eliminate the 2 remaining
G-codes from the measure’s numerator:
G8445; and G8446. We believe these
modifications to the electronic
prescribing measure will simplify
reporting of the measure because the
measure will only be reportable when
an eligible professional has
electronically prescribed. We invite
comments on the proposed
modifications to the electronic
prescribing measure numerator.
The e-prescribing quality measure
would not apply unless an eligible
professional furnishes services
indicated by one of the codes included
in the measure’s denominator.
Therefore, for claims-based reporting,
for example, it is not necessary for an
eligible professional to report G-codes
for the electronic prescribing measure
on claims not containing one of the
denominator codes. However, if
reporting a G-code, the G-code data
submission will only be considered
valid if it appears on the same Part B
claim containing one of the eprescribing quality measure’s
denominator codes.
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33598
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
(5) Criteria for Successful Reporting of
the Electronic Prescribing Measure
As discussed above, section
1848(m)(3)(B)(ii) of the Act specifies
that an eligible professional shall be
treated as a successful electronic
prescriber for a reporting period based
on the eligible professional’s reporting
of the electronic prescribing measure in
at least 50 percent of applicable cases.
However, section 1848(m)(3)(D) of the
Act permits the Secretary in
consultation with stakeholders and
experts to revise the criteria for
submitting data on electronic
prescribing measures under section
1848(3)(B)(ii) of the Act for years after
2009. Therefore, we propose to revise
the criteria for submitting data on the
electronic prescribing measure. For
2010, rather than requiring that the
electronic prescribing measure be
reported for a certain proportion of
reportable cases, we propose to make
the determination of whether an eligible
professional is a successful electronic
prescriber based on a count of the
number of times an eligible professional
reports that at least one prescription
created during the encounter was
generated using a qualified e-prescribing
system (that is, reports the modified
G8443 code). We believe that modifying
the criteria for submitting the electronic
prescribing measure in this manner will
bring us closer to our stated intention to
transition to using a certain number of
electronic Part D prescribing events as
the basis for the incentive payment in
future years. In proposing to revise the
criteria for successful reporting of the
electronic prescribing measure in this
manner, we also assume that once an
eligible professional has invested in an
e-prescribing system, integrated the use
of the e-prescribing system into the
practice’s work flows, and has used the
system to some extent, he or she is
likely to continue to use the eprescribing system for most of the
prescriptions he or she generates.
Preliminary data from the 2008 PQRI
through September 2008 indicate that
half of the eligible professionals who
were eligible to report the electronic
prescribing measure under the 2008
PQRI (measure #125) had 132 or more
instances in which they were eligible to
report the measure, with a maximum of
12,655 reporting instances. Therefore, in
order to successfully report the measure
under the 2009 criteria for successful eprescribing (that is, reporting the
measure for at least 50 percent of
applicable cases), half of eligible
professionals would have had to report
measure #125 66 times or more (that is,
50 percent of 132 reporting instances),
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
with a maximum of 6,328 times (that is,
50 percent of 12,655 reporting
instances). For structural measures such
as the electronic prescribing measure,
once an eligible professional has
demonstrated that he or she has
integrated use of an e-prescribing
system into his or her practice’s work
flow, requiring the eligible professional
to continue to report the measure
represents an administrative burden
with little added benefit to the
reliability and validity of the data being
reported. In contrast, for clinical quality
measures, the reliability and validity of
the performance rates depends on the
adequacy of the sample. Therefore, we
propose that an eligible professional
would be required to report that at least
1 prescription for a Medicare Part B FFS
patient created during an encounter that
is represented by 1 of the codes in the
denominator of the electronic
prescribing measure was generated
using a qualified e-prescribing system
for at least 25 times during the 2010
reporting period.
The proposed minimum reporting
threshold of 25 is based on the notion
that an eligible professional would need
to e-prescribe, on average, for
approximately 2 Medicare Part B FFS
patient encounters per month during the
reporting period in order to be
considered a successful e-prescriber.
The proposed reporting threshold of 25
also takes into consideration that
prescriptions are not generated with
every Medicare Part B FFS patient
encounter and some prescriptions, such
as narcotics, cannot be prescribed
electronically.
We welcome comments on the
proposed criteria for determination of
successful electronic prescriber. We are
particularly interested in comments
related to the following:
• Our proposal to change the criteria
for determining whether an eligible
professional is a successful e-prescriber
from requiring reporting of the
electronic prescribing measure in 50
percent of applicable cases to a count of
the number of times the eligible
professional electronically prescribed;
and
• The proposed threshold number of
25 times in which an eligible
professional would be required to report
that he or she electronically prescribed
during the reporting period.
d. Determination of the 2010 Incentive
Payment Amount for Individual Eligible
Professionals Who Are Successful EPrescribers
Section 1848(m)(2)(B) of the Act
imposes a limitation on the Eprescribing incentive payment. The
PO 00000
Frm 00080
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
Secretary is authorized to choose 1 of 2
possible criteria for the limitation. The
first criterion, under section
1848(m)(2)(B)(i) of the Act, is based
upon whether the Medicare Part B
allowed charges for covered
professional services to which the
electronic prescribing quality measure
applies are less than 10 percent of the
total Part B allowed charges for all
covered professional services furnished
by the eligible professional during the
reporting period. The second criterion,
under section 1848(m)(2)(B)(ii) of the
Act, is based on whether the eligible
professional submits (both
electronically and nonelectronically) a
sufficient number (as determined by the
Secretary) of prescriptions under Part D
(which can, again, be assessed using
Part D drug claims data). If the Secretary
decides to use the latter criterion, then,
in accordance with section
1848(m)(2)(B) of the Act, the criterion
based on the reporting on electronic
prescribing measures would no longer
apply. The statutory limitation also
applies to the future application of the
payment adjustment.
As discussed above, for 2010, we
propose to make the determination of
whether an eligible professional is a
‘‘successful e-prescriber’’ based on
submission of the electronic prescribing
measure. As a result, we propose to
apply the criterion under section
1848(m)(2)(B)(i) for the limitation for
the 2010 E-Prescribing Incentive
Program. Therefore, in determining
whether an eligible professional will
receive an e-prescribing incentive
payment for 2010, we would determine
whether the 10 percent threshold is met
based on the claims submitted by the
eligible professional at the TIN/NPI
level. This calculation is expected to
take place in the first quarter of 2011
and would be performed by dividing the
individual’s total 2010 allowed charges
for all such covered professional
services submitted for the measure’s
HCPCS codes by the individual’s total
allowed charges for all covered
professional services (as assessed at the
TIN/NPI level). If the result is 10
percent or more, then the statutory
limitation will not apply and a
successful e-prescriber would earn the
e-prescribing incentive payment. If the
result is less than 10 percent, then the
statutory limitation will apply and the
eligible professional would not earn an
e-prescribing incentive payment—even
if he or she electronically prescribes and
reports G8443 at least 25 times for those
eligible cases that occur during the 2010
reporting period. Although an
individual eligible professional may
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
decide to conduct his or her own
assessment of how likely this statutory
limitation is expected to apply to him or
her before deciding whether or not to
report the electronic prescribing
measure, an individual eligible
professional may report the electronic
prescribing measure without regard to
the statutory limitation for the incentive
payment.
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
e. Proposed Reporting Option for
Satisfactory Reporting of the EPrescribing Measure by Group Practices
As discussed previously, section
1848(m)(3)(C)(i) requires that by January
1, 2010, the Secretary shall establish
and have in place a process under
which eligible professionals in a group
practice (as defined by the Secretary)
shall be treated as meeting the
requirements for submitting data on
electronic prescribing quality measures
for covered professional services for a
reporting period (or, for purposes of the
payment adjustment under subsection
(a)(5), for a reporting period for a year)
if, in lieu of reporting the electronic
prescribing measure, the group practice
reports measures determined
appropriate by the Secretary, such as
measures that target high-cost chronic
conditions and preventive care, in a
form and manner, and at a time
specified by the Secretary.
Section 1848(m)(3)(C)(ii) of the Act
requires that the process established
under section 1848(m)(3)(C)(i) of the Act
provide for the use of a statistical
sampling model to submit data on
measures, such as the model used under
the Physician Group Practice
demonstration project under section
1866A of the Act. In addition, section
1848(m)(3)(C)(iii) of the Act specifies
that payments to a group practice by
reason of the process established under
section 1848(m)(3)(C)(ii) of the Act shall
be in lieu of the payments that would
otherwise be made under this
subsection to eligible professionals in
the group practice for being a successful
e-prescriber. Therefore, while we will be
making incentive payments to group
practices based on the determination
that the group practice, as a whole, is a
successful e-prescriber for 2010, an
individual eligible professional who is
affiliated with a group practice
participating in the group practice
reporting option that successfully meets
the proposed requirements for group
practices would not be eligible to earn
a separate e-prescribing incentive
payment for 2010 on the basis of his or
her successfully reporting the electronic
prescribing measure at the individual
level.
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
(1) Definition of ‘‘Group Practice’’
As stated above, section
1848(m)(3)(C)(i) of the Act authorizes
the Secretary to define ‘‘group practice.’’
For purposes of determining whether a
group practice is a successful eprescriber, we propose that a ‘‘group
practice’’ would consist of a physician
group practice, as defined by a TIN,
with at least 200 or more individual
eligible professionals (or, NPIs) who
have reassigned their billing rights to
the TIN to be consistent with definition
of ‘‘group practice’’ proposed for the
PQRI group practice reporting option.
However, we propose to limit the
group practices eligible to participate in
the 2010 E-Prescribing Incentive
Program through the group practice
reporting option to those group
practices selected to participate in the
PQRI group practice reporting option.
At this time, we would like to limit the
number of groups participating in the
group practice reporting option until we
get further experience with the group
practice reporting option. Therefore,
unlike individual eligible professionals
who are not required to participate in
the PQRI to be eligible to earn an eprescribing incentive and vice versa,
group practices would be required to
participate in both PQRI and the EPrescribing Incentive Program. As
discussed in section II.G.2.g. of this
proposed rule, group practices
interested in participating in the 2010
PQRI through the group practice
reporting option would be required to
submit a self-nomination letter to CMS
or a CMS designee requesting to
participate in the 2010 PQRI group
practice reporting option. Instructions
for submitting the self-nomination letter
will be posted on the PQRI section of
the CMS Web site by November 15,
2009. In addition to meeting the
eligibility requirements proposed in
section II.G.2.g.(1) of this proposed rule,
a group practice would also have to
indicate how they intend to report the
electronic prescribing measure (that is,
which proposed reporting mechanism
the group practice intends to use) for
purposes of participating in the 2010 EPrescribing Incentive Program group
practice reporting option.
(2) Process for Group Practices to
Participate as Group Practices and
Criteria for Successful Reporting of the
E-Prescribing Measure by Group
Practices
For group practices selected to
participate in the e-prescribing group
practice reporting option for 2010, we
propose the reporting period would be
January 1, 2010 to December 31, 2010.
PO 00000
Frm 00081
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33599
We propose that physician groups
selected to participate in the 2010 EPrescribing Incentive Program through
the group practice reporting option
would be able to choose to report the
electronic prescribing measure through
the claims-based, the registry-based, or,
contingent upon us finalizing this
reporting mechanism for the 2010 PQRI,
the EHR-based reporting mechanism. As
we proposed for individual eligible
professionals, only registries and EHR
products qualified to participate in the
2010 PQRI would be qualified for
purposes of the 2010 e-prescribing
group practice reporting option.
In order for a group practice to be
considered a successful e-prescriber, we
propose the group practice would have
to report that at least 1 prescription
during an encounter was generated
using a qualified e-prescribing system in
at least 2,500 instances during the
reporting period.
In the absence of information about
the composition of the group practices
that may wish to participate in the EPrescribing Incentive Program through
the group practice reporting option
rather than as individual eligible
professionals, we assumed that the
average group practice consists of 200
eligible professionals and that as many
as half of the members of an average
group practice do not furnish the
services represented by the electronic
prescribing measure’s denominator
codes, and thus, would not have an
opportunity to report the electronic
prescribing measure. Second, to be
consistent with the proposed reporting
criteria for individual eligible
professionals, we also believe that each
eligible professional in a group practice
should be required to report that at least
1 prescription generated during an
encounter that is represented by 1 of the
electronic prescribing measure’s
denominator codes was generated
electronically at least 25 times. Thus, for
a group of 200 eligible professionals, we
could extrapolate from our assumption
that only half of the eligible
professionals in an average practice of
200 eligible professionals would have
the opportunity to report the electronic
prescribing measure per group practice,
the total number of reporting instances
for the 100 remaining eligible
professionals would be 2,500. We invite
comments on the proposed criteria for
determining whether a group practice is
a successful e-prescriber. We also invite
feedback on our underlying
assumptions.
Section 1848(m)(2)(B) of the Act
specifies that the limitation on the
applicability of the e-prescribing
incentive discussed in section II.G.5.d.
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33600
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
of this proposed rule applies to group
practices as well as individual eligible
professionals. Therefore, in determining
whether a group practice will receive an
e-prescribing incentive payment for
2010 by meeting the proposed reporting
criteria described above, we would
determine whether the 10 percent
threshold is met based on the claims
submitted by the group practice. This
calculation is expected to take place in
the first quarter of 2011 and would be
determined by dividing the group
practice’s total 2010 allowed charges for
all covered professional services
submitted for the measure’s HCPCS
codes by the group practice’s total
Medicare Part B allowed charges for all
covered professional services. If the
result is 10 percent or more, then the
statutory limitation will not apply and
a group practice that is determined to be
a successful e-prescriber would qualify
to earn the e-prescribing incentive
payment. If the result is less than 10
percent, then the statutory limitation
will apply and the group practice would
not qualify to earn the e-prescribing
incentive payment.
f. Public Reporting of Names of
Successful E-Prescribers
As discussed in section II.G.2.k. of
this proposed rule, section
1848(m)(5)(G) of the Act requires the
Secretary to post on the CMS Web site,
in an easily understandable format, a
list of the names of eligible
professionals (or group practices) who
satisfactorily submit data on quality
measures for the PQRI and the names of
the eligible professionals (or group
practices) who are successful eprescribers. In accordance with section
1848(m)(5)(G) of the Act, we indicated
in the CY 2009 PFS final rule with
comment period (73 FR 69851 through
69852) our intent, in 2010, to post the
names of eligible professionals who are
successful e-prescribers for the 2009 EPrescribing Incentive Program at https://
www.medicare.gov.
As required by section 1848(m)(5)(G)
of the Act, we propose to make public
the names of eligible professionals and
group practices who are successful
electronic prescribers for the 2010 EPrescribing Incentive Program on the
Physician and Other Health Care
Professionals Directory. The names of
individual eligible professionals and
group practices who are successful
electronic prescribers for the 2010 EPrescribing Incentive Program will be
available in 2011 after the 2010
incentive payments are paid.
For purposes of publicly reporting the
names of individual eligible
professionals on the Physician and
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
Other Health Care Professionals
Directory, we propose to post the names
of individual eligible professionals: (1)
Whose 2010 PFS allowed charges make
up at least 10 percent of the eligible
professional’s Medicare Part B charges
for 2010; (2) who report that at least 1
prescription generated during an
encounter included in the electronic
prescribing measure denominator was
generated electronically (that is, who
reported the G8443 code) at least 25
times during the 2010 reporting period;
and (3) who receive an e-prescribing
incentive payment for covered
professional services furnished January
1, 2010 through December 31, 2010.
Since the PQRI and the E-Prescribing
Incentive Program are two separate
incentive programs and individual
eligible professionals are not required to
participate in both programs to earn an
incentive under either program, it is
possible for an eligible professional who
participates in both incentive programs
to be listed both as an individual
eligible professional who satisfactorily
submits data on quality measures for the
PQRI and a successful electronic
prescriber if he or she meets the criteria
for both incentive programs.
For purposes of publicly reporting the
names of group practices on the
Physician and Other Health Care
Professionals Directory, we propose to
post the names of group practices who:
(1) Report that at least 1 prescription
generated during an encounter included
in the electronic prescribing measure
denominator was generated
electronically (that is, who reported the
G8443 code) at least 2500 times during
the 2010 reporting period; and (2)
receive an e-prescribing incentive
payment for covered professional
services furnished January 1, 2010
through December 31, 2010. Although
group practices would be required to
participate in both programs to earn an
incentive under either program, the
criteria for satisfactory reporting of PQRI
measures for group practices are
different from the criteria for successful
reporting of the electronic prescribing
measure by group practices. Therefore,
it is possible for a group practice to be
listed as a group practice that
satisfactorily submits data on quality
measures for the PQRI but not as a
successful electronic prescriber or vice
versa.
6. Section 135: Implementation of
Accreditation Standards for Suppliers
Furnishing the Technical Component
(TC) of Advanced Diagnostic Imaging
Services
Section 1834(e) of the Act, as added
by section 135(a) of the MIPPA, requires
PO 00000
Frm 00082
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
that beginning January 1, 2012,
Medicare payment may only be made
for the technical component (TC) of
advanced diagnostic imaging services
for which payment is made under the
fee schedule established in section
1848(b) of the Act to a supplier who is
accredited by an accreditation
organization designated by the
Secretary.
a. Accreditation Requirement
This proposed rule would set forth
the criteria for designating organizations
to accredit suppliers furnishing the
technical component (TC) of advanced
diagnostic imaging services as specified
in section 1834(c) of the Act. In
addition, it would set forth the required
procedures to ensure that the criteria
used by an accreditation organization
meet minimum standards for each
imaging modality. These statutory
requirements would be codified in
§ 414.68 of the payment rules for
physicians and other practitioners.
The CMS-designated accreditation
organization would apply standards that
set qualifications for medical personnel
who are not physicians but who furnish
the TC. The standards would describe
the qualifications and responsibilities of
medical directors and supervising
physicians including the following:
Recognizing whether a particular
medical director or supervising
physician received training in advanced
imaging services in a residency
program; and has attained, through
experience, the necessary expertise to be
a medical director or supervising
physician; has completed any
continuing medical education courses
related to advanced imaging services; or
has met such other standards as the
Secretary determines appropriate. In
addition, the standards would require
suppliers to: (1) Establish and maintain
a quality control program to ensure the
technical quality of diagnostic images
produced by the supplier; (2) ensure the
equipment used meets performance
specifications; and (3) ensure safety of
personnel. While the statute authorizes
the Secretary to establish as criteria for
accreditation any other standards or
procedures the Secretary determines
appropriate, we are not proposing to
establish other standards or procedures
at this time.
We expect to publish a notice to
solicit applications from entities for the
purposes of becoming a designated
accreditation organization the same day
that this proposed rule’s subsequent
final rule is issued, on or before
November 1, 2009. Due to the tight
timeframe, we expect to meet the
January 1, 2010 statutory deadline in
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
order to designate organizations to
accredit suppliers furnishing the TC of
advanced diagnostic imaging services by
waiving the 60-day delay in the imaging
accreditation provisions of the final
rule.
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
b. Accreditation for Suppliers
Section 1834(e) of the Act requires the
Secretary to designate and approve
accreditation organizations to accredit
suppliers of the TC of advanced
diagnostic imaging services. To promote
consistency in accrediting providers and
suppliers throughout the Medicare
program, we are proposing to use
existing procedures for the application,
selection, and oversight of accreditation
organizations detailed at 42 CFR part
488, subparts A and D and apply them
to organizations accrediting suppliers of
the TC of advanced diagnostic imaging
services. We are proposing
modifications to the existing part 488
requirements to meet the specialized
needs of the advanced imaging industry.
These modifications will require an
independent accreditation organization
applying for approval as a designated
accreditation organization to include in
their application:
• A detailed description of how the
organization’s accreditation criteria
satisfy the statutory standards at section
1834(e)(3) of the Act, specifically:
+ Qualifications of medical personnel
who are not physicians and who furnish
the TC of advanced diagnostic imaging
services;
+ Qualifications and responsibilities
of medical directors and supervising
physicians, such as training in advanced
diagnostic imaging services in a
residency program, expertise obtained
through experience, or continuing
medical education courses;
+ Procedures to ensure the safety of
persons who furnish the TC of advanced
diagnostic imaging services and
individuals to whom such services are
furnished;
+ Procedures to ensure the reliability,
clarity, and accuracy of the technical
quality of diagnostic images produced
by the supplier.
• An agreement to conform
accreditation requirements to any
changes in Medicare statutory
requirements in section 1834(e) of the
Act.
• Information to demonstrate the
accreditation organization’s knowledge
and experience in the advanced
diagnostic imaging arena.
• The organization’s proposed fees for
accreditation for each modality in
which the organization intends to offer
accreditation and any plans for reducing
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
the burden and cost of accreditation to
small and rural suppliers.
• Any specific documentation
requirements and attestations requested
by CMS as a condition of designation
under this part.
If, after review of an accreditation
organization’s submission of
information, we determine that
additional information is necessary to
make a determination for approval or
denial of the accreditation
organization’s application to be
designated as an accreditation
organization for suppliers of the TC of
advanced diagnostic imaging services,
the organization will be notified and
afforded an opportunity to provide the
additional information. We may visit
the organization’s offices to verify
representations made by the
organization in its application,
including, but not limited to, review of
documents and interviews with the
organization’s staff. The accreditation
organization will receive a formal notice
from CMS stating whether the request
for designation has been approved or
denied. If approval was denied, the
notice will include the basis for denial
and outline the reconsideration
procedures. We will make every effort to
issue a final decision no more than 30
calendar days from the time the
completed reapplication is received by
CMS. An accreditation organization may
withdraw its application for designation
under section 1834(e) of the Act at any
time before the formal notice of
approval is received. An accreditation
organization that has been notified that
its request for designation has been
denied may request reconsideration in
accordance with § 488.201 through
§ 488.211 in Subpart D. Any
accreditation organization whose
request for designation has been denied
may resubmit its application if the
organization (1) revises its accreditation
program to address the rationale for
denial of its previous request; (2)
provides reasonable assurance that its
accredited companies meet applicable
Medicare requirements; and (3)
resubmits the application in its entirety.
If an accreditation organization has
requested a reconsideration of our
determination that its request for
designation under section 1834(e) of the
Act is denied, it may not submit a new
application for the type of modality that
is at issue in the reconsideration until
the reconsideration is final.
A panel will evaluate all proposals
from accreditation organizations seeking
designation under section 1834(e) of the
Act using existing CMS survey and
certification processes as established in
§ 488.4.
PO 00000
Frm 00083
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33601
c. Payment Rules for Suppliers of the TC
of Advanced Diagnostic Imaging
Services (§ 414.68)
We would specify in § 414.68 the
statutory requirement of section 1834(e)
of the Act that all suppliers of the TC
of advanced diagnostic imaging services
be accredited by a CMS-designated
accreditation organization by January 1,
2012 for payments made under the fee
schedule established under section
1848(b). In § 414.68(a), we are proposing
to define the following:
• ‘‘Accredited supplier’’ as a supplier
that has been accredited by a CMSapproved accreditation organization.
• ‘‘Advanced Diagnostic Imaging
Services’’ as diagnostic magnetic
resonance imaging, computed
tomography, nuclear medicine, and
positron emission tomography. We are
not proposing at this time to include
other diagnostic imaging services in this
definition under section 1834(e)(1)(B)(ii)
of the Act.
• ‘‘CMS-approved accreditation
organization’’ as an independent
accreditation organization designated by
CMS to perform the accreditation
function established in section 1834(e)
of the Act.
d. Ongoing Responsibilities of CMSApproved Accreditation Organizations
We are proposing to require a CMSapproved accreditation organization to
perform the following activities on an
ongoing basis. Provide to CMS in
written form and on an ongoing basis all
of the following:
• Copies of all accreditation surveys
of specific suppliers along with any
survey-related information that we may
require (including corrective action
plans and summaries of CMS
requirements that were not met).
• Notice of all accreditation
decisions.
• Notice of all complaints related to
suppliers of the TC of advanced
diagnostic imaging service.
• Information about any suppliers of
the TC of advanced diagnostic imaging
service for which the accrediting
organization has denied the supplier’s
accreditation status.
• Notice of any proposed changes in
its accreditation standards or
requirements or survey process. If the
organization implemented the changes
before or without CMS approval, we
could withdraw approval of the
accreditation organization.
• Permit its surveyors to serve as
witnesses if CMS takes an adverse
action based on accreditation findings.
• Provide CMS with written notice of
any deficiencies and adverse actions
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33602
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
implemented by the CMS-approved
accreditation organization against an
accredited supplier of the TC of
advanced diagnostic imaging within 2
days of identifying such deficiencies, if
the deficiencies pose immediate
jeopardy to a beneficiary or to the
general public.
• Provide written notice of the
withdrawal to all accredited suppliers
within 10 days of CMS’ notice to
withdraw approval of the accreditation
organization.
• Provide, on an annual basis,
summary data specified by CMS that are
related to the past year’s accreditation
activities and trends.
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
e. Continuing CMS Oversight of CMSApproved Accreditation Organizations
We are proposing to add § 414.68 to
establish specific criteria and
procedures for continuing oversight and
for withdrawing approval of an
approved accreditation organization.
(1) Validation Audits
We are proposing to audit the
accredited organizations in order to
validate the survey accreditation
process of approved accreditation
organizations in the TC of advanced
imaging. The audits would be
conducted on a representative sample of
suppliers who have been accredited by
a particular accrediting organization or
in response to allegations of supplier
noncompliance with the standards.
When conducted on a representative
sample basis, we are proposing that the
audit would be comprehensive and
address all of the standards or would
focus on a specific standard in issue.
When conducted in response to an
allegation, we will specify that the CMS
team or our contractor would audit for
any standard that we determined was
related to the allegations. We are
proposing to require a supplier selected
for a validation audit to authorize the
validation audit to occur and authorize
the CMS team or our contractor to
monitor the correction of any
deficiencies found through the
validation audit. If a supplier selected
for a validation audit failed to comply
with the requirements at § 414.68, the
supplier would no longer meet the
Medicare requirements and, under this
proposal, the supplier’s accreditation for
the TC of the advanced medical imaging
would be revoked.
We are proposing that a CMS team or
our contractor would conduct an audit
of an accredited organization, examine
the results of the accreditation
organization’s own survey procedure
onsite, or observe the accreditation
organization’s survey, in order to
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
validate the organization’s accreditation
process. At the conclusion of the
review, we would identify any
accreditation programs for which
validation audit results indicated the
following:
• A 10 percent rate of disparity
between findings by the accreditation
organization and findings by CMS or
our contractor on standards that did not
constitute immediate jeopardy to patient
health and safety if not met;
• Any disparity between findings by
the accreditation organization and
findings by CMS or our contractor on
standards that constituted immediate
jeopardy to patient health and safety if
not met; or
• There were widespread or systemic
problems in the organization’s
accreditation process such that the
accreditation no longer provided
assurance that suppliers met or
exceeded the Medicare requirements,
irrespective of the rate of disparity.
(2) Notice of Intent To Withdraw
Approval for Designating Authority
If a validation audit, onsite
observation, or our concerns with the
ethical conduct (that impacts the health
and safety of the beneficiary) of an
accreditation organization suggest that
the accreditation organization is not
meeting the requirements of proposed
§ 414.68, we would provide the
organization written notice of its intent
to withdraw approval of the
accreditation organization’s designating
authority.
(3) Withdrawal of Approval for
Designating Authority
We are proposing to withdraw
approval of an accreditation
organization at any time if we determine
that:
• Accreditation by the organization
no longer provides sufficient assurance
that the suppliers of the TC of advanced
imaging meet the requirements of
section 1834(e) of the Act and the
failure to meet those requirements could
pose an immediate jeopardy to the
health and safety of Medicare
beneficiaries;
• Constitutes a significant hazard to
the public health; or
• The accreditation organization
failed to meet its obligations for
application and reapplication
procedures.
(4) Reconsideration
We are proposing to implement
requirements under part 488 without
substantive changes as the requirements
have been utilized for the health care
providers covered under part 488 since
PO 00000
Frm 00084
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
1992. We are proposing that an
accreditation organization dissatisfied
with a determination that its
accreditation requirements did not
provide or do not continue to provide
reasonable assurance that the suppliers
accredited by the accreditation
organization met the applicable
standards would be entitled to a
reconsideration. We are also proposing
to reconsider any determination to
deny, remove, or not renew the approval
of the designating authority to
accreditation organizations if the
accreditation organization filed a
written request for reconsideration
through its authorized officials or
through its legal representative.
We are proposing to require the
accreditation organization to file the
request within 30 calendar days of the
receipt of CMS notice of an adverse
determination or non-renewal. We
propose to require the request for
reconsideration to specify the findings
or issues with which the accreditation
organization disagreed and the reasons
for the disagreement. A requestor could
withdraw its request for reconsideration
at any time before the issuance of a
reconsideration determination. In
response to a request for
reconsideration, we would provide the
accrediting organization the opportunity
for an informal hearing that would be
conducted by a hearing officer
appointed by the CMS Administrator
and provide the accrediting organization
the opportunity to present, in writing
and in person, evidence or
documentation to refute the
determination to deny approval, or to
withdraw or not renew its designating
authority.
We would provide written notice of
the time and place of the informal
hearing at least 10 business days before
the scheduled date. The informal
reconsideration hearing would be open
to CMS and the organization requesting
the reconsideration, including
authorized representatives, technical
advisors (individuals with knowledge of
the facts of the case or presenting
interpretation of the facts), and legal
counsel. The hearing would be
conducted by the hearing officer who
would receive testimony and documents
related to the proposed action.
Testimony and other evidence could be
accepted by the hearing officer.
However, it would be inadmissible
under the usual rules of court
procedures. The hearing officer would
not have the authority to compel by
subpoena the production of witnesses,
papers, or other evidence. Within 45
calendar days of the close of the
hearing, the hearing officer would
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
present the findings and
recommendations to the accrediting
organization that requested the
reconsideration. The written report of
the hearing officer would include
separate numbered findings of fact and
the legal conclusions of the hearing
officer. The hearing officer’s decision
would be final.
We are interested in obtaining
additional information on the role of
radiology assistants (RA) and radiology
practitioner assistants (RPA), including
the level of physician supervision that
would be appropriate when RAs and
RPAs are involved in the performance of
the TC of advanced medical imaging,
whether the role varies by State, and
related information. It would be
particularly helpful for the commenter
to identify specific clinical scenarios
with associated CPT codes that would
represent such services involving RAs
and RPAs.
7. Section 139: Improvements for
Medicare Anesthesia Teaching Programs
Section 139 of the MIPPA establishes
a ‘‘special payment rule for teaching
anesthesiologists’’ and provides a
directive to the Secretary regarding
payments for the services of ‘‘teaching
certified registered nurse anesthetists’’
(teaching CRNAs). It also specifies the
periods when the teaching
anesthesiologist must be present during
the procedure in order to receive
payment for the case at 100 percent of
the fee schedule amount (the regular fee
schedule rate). These provisions are
effective for services furnished on or
after January 1, 2010.
a. Teaching Anesthesiologists: Special
Payment Rule
(2) Methodology for Payment of
Anesthesia Services
Payment for anesthesia services
furnished by a physician is made under
the PFS, under section 1848(b)(2)(B) of
the Act. The methodology for the
calculation of the allowable amount is
unique to anesthesia service only.
Payment is made on the basis of
anesthesia base units and time units,
calculated from the actual anesthesia
time of the case, instead of on the basis
of work, PE, and malpractice RVUs.
Payment for anesthesia services is also
based on the anesthesia CF instead of
the general PFS CF.
(1) Payment for Anesthesia Services
Furnished by a Physician
(3) Section 139(a) of the MIPPA
Section 139(a) of the MIPPA adds a
new paragraph at section 1848(a)(6) of
the Act to establish a ‘‘special payment
rule for teaching anesthesiologists’’.
This provision allows payment to be
made at the regular fee schedule rate for
the teaching anesthesiologist’s
involvement in the training of residents
in either a single anesthesia case or in
two concurrent anesthesia cases
furnished on or after January 1, 2010.
We will refer to anesthesia cases
involving the training of residents as
‘‘resident cases’’ below in this section.
If the physician, usually an
anesthesiologist, is involved in
furnishing anesthesia services to a
patient, the services can be furnished
under one of three different scenarios.
The anesthesiologist may—
• Personally perform the anesthesia
services alone;
(4) Discussion
The Accreditation Council on
Graduate Medical Education (ACGME)
is a branch of the AMA, and it accredits
allopathic residency programs. In order
for a hospital to receive Medicare
graduate medical education payments
for its training programs, the residents
The criteria for the payment of
teaching anesthesiology services and the
special rule for the teaching
anesthesiologist are similar to the
current criteria for payment of teaching
surgeon services and the payment rule
for the teaching surgeon involved in
overlapping resident cases. Thus, there
is a similarity in the payment rules for
these physician specialties who work
closely together.
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
• Be involved in the case as a
teaching anesthesiologist with an
anesthesia resident; or
• Provide medical direction of the
performance of anesthesia services for
two, three or four concurrent cases
involving a qualified individual (who
may be a CRNA, an anesthesiologist
assistant (AA), an anesthesia resident, or
a student nurse anesthetist under
certain circumstances).
Under the statute and CMS policy, if
the anesthesiologist personally performs
the anesthesia service alone or is
involved in the case as a teaching
anesthesiologist with an anesthesia
resident, payment for the
anesthesiologist’s service is made at the
regular fee schedule rate.
If the anesthesiologist furnishes
medical direction for two, three or four
concurrent anesthesia procedures, then
payment for the anesthesiologist’s
service is made, in accordance with
section 1848(a)(4)(B) of the Act, at 50
percent of the otherwise applicable fee
schedule amount.
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00085
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33603
must be in an ‘‘approved medical
residency program’’ Under § 413.75(b),
an approved medical residency program
is one approved by one of the national
organizations listed in § 415.152. One of
the national organizations is the
ACGME.
ACGME’s policies and procedures
require that each accredited residency
program comply with the institutional
requirements and the specialty program
requirements. For approved anesthesia
residency programs, ACGME
requirements for faculty supervision
and training of anesthesia residents
specify that faculty members not direct
anesthesia at more than two
anesthetizing locations in the clinical
setting. (See the ACGME Web site at
https://www.acgme.org.)
Consistent with this requirement, the
American Society of Anesthesiologists
(ASA) has advised us that, when
providing services in two concurrent
cases, a teaching anesthesiologist might
be engaged in two concurrent anesthesia
resident cases, or in two mixed
concurrent cases, one a resident case
and the other a CRNA or AA case.
The statute applies the special
payment rule for teaching
anesthesiologists to the single resident
case or two concurrent cases involving
anesthesia residents as long as the
teaching anesthesiologist meets the
requirements in sections 1848(6)(A) and
1848(6)(B) of the Act. However, the
statute does not directly address a single
resident case that is concurrent to
another case involving a CRNA, AA, or
other qualified individual who can be
medically directed. The issue is whether
the medical direction payment rules
apply to each of these cases or whether
an alternative payment policy may
apply.
One option in implementing this
provision would be to strictly limit the
special payment rule for teaching
anesthesiologists to the single resident
case (which is not concurrent to any
other case) or the two concurrent
resident cases (which are not concurrent
to any other cases). For the mixed
concurrent case, we could continue to
apply our current medical direction
payment policy to both the resident case
and the other concurrent case. This
would represent a continuation of our
current medical direction payment
policy, and would be predicated on the
assumption that this is consistent with
Congressional intent since the medical
direction payment provisions at section
1848(a)(4) of the Act were left largely
unchanged by section 139(a) of the
MIPPA.
The other option would be to apply
the special payment rule for teaching
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33604
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
anesthesiologists to the resident case
when it is concurrent to a medically
directed case, and to apply the medical
direction payment policy to the
medically directed case. While this
represents a broader interpretation, it
still limits the applicability of the
special payment rule for teaching
anesthesiologists to resident cases
consistent with the terms of section 139
of the MIPPA.
The special payment rule under
section 1848(a)(6) of the Act clearly
applies for two concurrent anesthesia
resident cases. The ACGME
requirements also allow the supervision
of two concurrent cases, but are not
specific regarding whether the
requirements relate only to two resident
cases, or also to mixed concurrent cases.
However, both the statute and ACGME
requirements seem amenable to a policy
that would allow the special teaching
payment rule to apply in mixed
concurrent cases, that is, the single
resident case that is concurrent to
another case not involving a resident.
Additionally, we are concerned that if
we continued to apply the medical
direction payment policy to mixed
concurrent cases, then financial
differences in payment policy might
cause teaching anesthesiologists to make
changes in the scheduling of mixed
resident and CRNA cases. This might
limit the utilization of CRNAs in certain
scenarios.
Accordingly, we are proposing to
delete the current regulatory language at
§ 414.46(e) (which is no longer relevant)
and add new language to specify that
the special payment rule for teaching
anesthesiologists applies to resident
cases under the following scenarios:
• The teaching anesthesiologist is
involved in one resident case (which is
not concurrent to any other anesthesia
case);
• The teaching anesthesiologist is
involved in each of two concurrent
resident cases (which are not concurrent
to any other anesthesia case); or
• The teaching anesthesiologist is
involved in one resident case that is
concurrent to another case paid under
medical direction payment rules.
Other than the application of the
special payment rule for teaching
anesthesiologists in the mixed
concurrent case described above, we are
not proposing any other revisions to our
medical direction payment policies.
b. Teaching Anesthesiologists: Criteria
for Payment
(1) Criteria for Payment of Teaching
Anesthesiologists
Currently, the teaching
anesthesiologist can be paid at the
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
regular fee schedule rate for his or her
involvement in a single resident case.
As specified in § 415.178, the teaching
anesthesiologist must be present with
the anesthesia resident during all
critical portions of the anesthesia
procedure and be immediately available
to furnish services during the entire
procedure. Our manual instructions
permit different physicians in the same
anesthesia group to provide parts of the
anesthesia service, and for the group to
bill for the single anesthesia service. We
refer to this practice as an ‘‘anesthesia
handoff.’’ (See Medicare Claims
Processing Manual 100–04, Chapter 12,
Section 50 C.) Of course, the medical
record must document those individual
physicians who furnished the services.
This manual instruction is not limited
in scope to nonteaching hospitals. Thus,
it is possible that teaching
anesthesiologists have interpreted it to
permit handoffs during resident cases.
Our manual instructions state that for
two overlapping surgeries, the teaching
surgeon must be present during the
critical or key portions of both
operations (See Medicare Claims
Processing Manual 100–04, Chapter 12,
Section 100.1.2). It is our understanding
that teaching surgeons do not hand off
to another teaching surgeon during a
key or critical portion of the surgical
resident case.
(2) Section 139(a)(2) of the MIPPA
This section adds a new paragraph at
section 1848(a)(6) of the Act which
requires, in order for the special
payment rule for teaching
anesthesiologists to apply, that the
teaching anesthesiologist is present
during all critical or key portions of the
anesthesia service or procedure and the
teaching anesthesiologist (or another
anesthesiologist with whom the
teaching anesthesiologist has entered
into an arrangement) is immediately
available to furnish anesthesia services
during the entire procedure. The new
MIPPA provision regarding payment for
services of a teaching anesthesiologist
for two concurrent resident cases is
similar to our current policy regarding
payment for services of a teaching
surgeon for two overlapping surgical
resident cases.
(3) Discussion
The ASA has informed us that
teaching anesthesiologists who work in
the same anesthesia group sometimes
provide different parts of the key or
critical portions of a single anesthesia
procedure. This type of a handoff
situation might occur within an
anesthesia group practice when there is
an anesthesia procedure of long
PO 00000
Frm 00086
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
duration, but would not be limited to
that circumstance.
From a quality standpoint, we do not
believe multiple handoffs among
teaching anesthesiologists during a case
that involves the training of an
anesthesia resident would be optimal.
We do not have data on the extent to
which anesthesia handoffs occur during
resident or other cases, or whether
quality of anesthesia care is affected. We
note that section 1848(a)(6)(A) of the
Act refers only to ‘‘the’’ teaching
anesthesiologist, and requires that the
teaching anesthesiologist be present
during all critical or key portions of the
service. However, section 1848(a)(6)(B)
of the Act seems to contemplate some
level of handoffs between teaching
anesthesiologists, at least between those
who have entered into an arrangement
for such handoffs.
One option would be to permit
different anesthesiologists in the same
anesthesia group practice to be
considered ‘‘the teaching physician’’ for
purposes of being present at the key or
critical portions of the anesthesia case.
(These physicians must have reassigned
their benefits to the group practice in
order for the group to bill.) Although
this option would be less disruptive to
the current anesthesia practice
arrangements (as reported by the ASA),
it would establish rules for teaching
anesthesiologists that are different from
those for teaching surgeons.
Another option would be to require
that, in order to meet the requirement of
section 1848(a)(6)(A) of the Act, only
one individual teaching anesthesiologist
must be present during all of the key or
critical portions of the procedure.
However, another teaching
anesthesiologist with whom ‘‘the
teaching anesthesiologist’’ under
subparagraph (A) has an arrangement
could be immediately available to
furnish services during a non-critical or
non-key portion of the procedure in
order to meet the requirement under
subparagraph (B). We believe this is the
most logical reading of the statute and
would be consistent with the way the
teaching surgeon payment policy is
applied for overlapping surgical cases.
In addition to explaining available
options for implementing this provision,
we are also soliciting specific comments
on how the continuity of care and the
quality of anesthesia care are preserved
during handoffs. We are interested in
whether there is an accepted maximum
number of handoffs and whether there
are any industry studies that have
examined this issue. We would like to
hear from anesthesia practices that do
not use handoffs and what procedures
they have implemented to achieve this
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
result. Finally, we would like to know
what factors or variables are
contributing to anesthesia handoffs and
what short term adjustments can be
made to affect these factors.
Although we are interested in
receiving comments on these topics, we
are proposing to more narrowly
interpret the law and require that only
one individual teaching anesthesiologist
be present during all of the key or
critical portions of the anesthesia
procedure. We are also proposing that
another teaching anesthesiologist with
whom the teaching anesthesiologist has
an arrangement could be immediately
available to furnish services during a
non-critical or non-key portion of the
procedure.
c. Teaching CRNAs
(1) Payment for Anesthesia Services
Furnished by a CRNA
Currently, a CRNA who provides
anesthesia services while under the
medical direction of an anesthesiologist
is paid at 50 percent of the regular fee
schedule rate as specified in section
1833(l)(4)(B)(iii) of the Act. A CRNA
who provides anesthesia services
without the medical direction of a
physician is paid the regular fee
schedule rate as specified in section
1833(l)(4)(A) of the Act.
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
(2) Payment for Anesthesia Services
Furnished by a Teaching CRNA With a
Student Nurse Anesthetist
The legislation that created the CRNA
fee schedule payment system (that is,
section 9320 of the Omnibus Budget
Reconciliation Act of 1986 (Pub. L. 99–
509)) did not address payment for
services furnished by teaching CRNAs
involved in the training of student nurse
anesthetists.
In the preamble to the CRNA fee
schedule final rule published in the July
31, 1992 Federal Register (57 FR
33888), we stated that we would pay the
teaching CRNA who is not medically
directed by a physician at the regular fee
schedule rate for his or her involvement
in a single case with a student nurse
anesthetist as long as he or she was
present with the student throughout the
anesthesia case. No payment would be
made if the teaching CRNA divided his
or her time between two concurrent
cases involving student nurse
anesthetists.
In August 2002, based on the
recommendations of the American
Association of Nurse Anesthetists
(AANA), we modified our policy to
allow the teaching CRNA not medically
directed by a physician to be paid a
portion of the regular fee schedule rate
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
for each of two concurrent cases
involving student nurse anesthetists. If
the teaching CRNA is present with the
student nurse anesthetist during the preand post-anesthesia care for each of the
cases involving student nurse
anesthetists, the teaching CRNA can bill
the full base units (comprised of preand post-anesthesia services not
included in the anesthesia time units)
for each case and the actual amount of
anesthesia time per case. The resulting
payment for each of these anesthesia
cases is greater than 50 percent, but less
than 100 percent, of the regular fee
schedule amount because the full base
units plus the actual anesthesia time
units spent by the teaching CRNA in
each of the two cases yields a payment
that is greater than 50 percent of the
regular fee schedule amount.
(3) Comparison of Payment Policies for
Teaching CRNAs and Teaching
Anesthesiologists
For several years, the American
Society of Anesthesiologists (ASA)
requested that we revise our payment
regulations to allow the teaching
anesthesiologist to be paid the regular
fee schedule amount for each of two
concurrent resident cases. In the CY
2004 PFS final rule with comment
period (68 FR 63224), we finalized a
policy to permit the teaching
anesthesiologist to be paid similarly to
a teaching CRNA for each of two
concurrent resident cases. This policy
took effect for services furnished on or
after January 1, 2004.
Thus, the payment policy is the same
for a teaching CRNA for each of two
concurrent student nurse anesthetist
cases, and for a teaching
anesthesiologist for each of two
concurrent resident cases. The policy is
that the anesthesia provider is paid the
full base units plus time units, based on
the actual anesthesia time, relating to
each of two concurrent cases.
(4) Payment Policy for an
Anesthesiologist, or an Anesthesiologist
and CRNA Jointly, With a Student
Nurse Anesthetist
Currently, there are circumstances
where an anesthesiologist may be
involved in the training of student nurse
anesthetists in two concurrent
anesthesia cases. These anesthesia cases
are not paid under the teaching
anesthesiologist payment policy, but are
paid under the usual medical direction
payment policy. Payment can be made
for the physician’s medical direction
(that is, 50 percent of the regular fee
schedule amount) for each of two
concurrent cases.
PO 00000
Frm 00087
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33605
If an anesthesiologist is medically
directing two concurrent cases
involving student nurse anesthetists and
a CRNA is also jointly involved with the
two student nurse anesthetist cases,
then the physician service, in each case,
can be paid under the medical direction
rules at 50 percent of the regular fee
schedule. Payment for the CRNA
services would also be made at the
medically directed rate (that is, 50
percent of the regular fee schedule) for
CRNA services, but the time units used
to compute the anesthesia fee would be
based on the actual time the CRNA is
involved in each case.
(5) Section 139(b) of the MIPPA
Section 139(b) of the MIPPA instructs
the Secretary to make appropriate
adjustments to Medicare teaching CRNA
payment policy so that it—
• Is consistent with the adjustments
made by the special payment rule for
teaching anesthesiologists under section
139(a) of the MIPPA; and
• Maintains the existing payment
differences between teaching
anesthesiologists and teaching CRNAs.
We are proposing to implement the
first directive (under section 139(b)(1) of
the MIPPA) by establishing a new
payment policy for teaching CRNAs that
is similar to the special payment rule for
teaching anesthesiologists, and to limit
applicability of the rule to teaching
CRNAs who are not medically directed.
We are proposing to add a new
regulation at § 414.61 to explain the
conditions under which the special
payment rule will apply and the method
for calculating the amount of payment
for anesthesia services furnished on or
after January 1, 2010, by teaching
CRNAs involved in the training of
student nurse anesthetists. Under this
proposal, we would pay the teaching
CRNA at the regular fee schedule rate
for each of two concurrent student nurse
anesthetist cases. Our medical direction
payment policy would continue to
apply if both an anesthesiologist and a
CRNA are involved in a student nurse
anesthetist case that is concurrent to
other anesthesia cases.
We believe the second directive in
section 139(b)(2) of the MIPPA will be
satisfied as a result of these proposals.
Section 139(b)(1) of the MIPPA instructs
CMS to make appropriate adjustments
to implement a payment policy for
teaching CRNAs that is consistent with
the special payment rule for teaching
anesthesiologists. Section 139(b)(2) of
the MIPPA instructs CMS to maintain
the existing payment differences
between teaching anesthesiologists and
teaching CRNAs. There currently are no
substantive differences in payment
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33606
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
between teaching anesthesiologists and
teaching CRNAs, and there would
continue to be no such differences
under our proposed policies.
(6) Payment for Teaching CRNAs
Involved in Anesthesia Cases With
Student Nurse Anesthetists
Under current policy, when a CRNA
is involved in a single student nurse
anesthetist case, the teaching CRNA
must be present with the student
throughout the case in order to be paid
at the regular fee schedule rate. We are
not proposing any change to this policy.
When the teaching CRNA is involved
in two concurrent student nurse
anesthetist cases, payment is based on
the amount of anesthesia time the
teaching CRNA spends with the student
in each case. For example, if the
teaching CRNA spends 40 percent of his
or her time in concurrent case #1 and
60 percent of his or her time in
concurrent case #2, and the total
anesthesia time in both cases is 3 hours
(or 180 minutes), then we would
currently pay as follows:
• Case #1: (Base units + (0.4 × 180/
15)) × Anesthesia CF
• Case #2: (Base units + (0.6 × 180/
15)) × Anesthesia CF
The current payment policy has been
predicated on paying the teaching
CRNA for his or her actual time spent
in the student nurse anesthetist case.
We are now proposing to pay the
teaching CRNA at the regular fee
schedule rate for his or her involvement
in two concurrent cases. If our goal is to
minimize the effect of this change on
teaching CRNAs’ practice arrangements
and time devoted to cases, then we
would propose that the teaching CRNA
continue to devote 100 percent of his or
her time to the two concurrent cases.
The teaching CRNA would decide how
to allocate his or her time to optimize
patient care in the two cases based on
the complexity of the anesthesia case,
the experience and skills of the student
nurse anesthetist, the patient’s health
status, and other factors.
An alternative to this policy would be
to apply the same criteria for teaching
CRNAs as we use in § 415.178 with
respect to teaching anesthesiologists.
These criteria require the teaching
anesthesiologist to be present during all
critical or key portions of the anesthesia
service. However, we believe these
criteria are relevant and appropriate
only for teaching anesthesiologists due
to significant differences in experience,
education and other qualifications
between anesthesia residents and
student nurse anesthetists. The
anesthesia resident has completed
medical school and is typically a
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
licensed physician. In contrast, the
student nurse anesthetist is an RN who
usually has some clinical experience in
ICU or critical care nursing prior to
starting the CRNA training program.
Thus, we believe the resident is more
qualified through medical training and
education than the student nurse
anesthetist to provide elements of the
anesthesia service without the
immediate presence of the teaching
anesthesiologist. Therefore, we propose
to retain our current policy.
We note that the Congress did not
amend the statutory provisions relating
to medical direction at section
1848(a)(4) of the Act. We do not believe
the directives at section 139(b) of the
MIPPA extend to other arrangements in
which anesthesiologists alone or both
anesthesiologists and CRNAs jointly
supervise student nurse anesthetists
during concurrent anesthesia cases.
Therefore, we are not proposing any
changes to our current payment policies
for anesthesia services furnished under
other circumstances. We are proposing
that when an anesthesia provider
(physician or CRNA) furnishes
anesthesia services in concurrent cases
under other circumstances, the current
policies regarding medical direction
will continue to apply.
8. Section 144(a): Payment and Coverage
Improvements for Patients With Chronic
Obstructive Pulmonary Disease and
Other Conditions—Cardiac
Rehabilitation Services
Section 144(a) of the MIPPA amended
Title XVIII of the Act, in pertinent part,
to provide for coverage of cardiac
rehabilitation (CR) and intensive cardiac
rehabilitation (ICR) under Medicare Part
B. The statute specifies certain
conditions for these services, with
coverage to begin on January 1, 2010.
The addition of the new CR and ICR
programs is designed to improve the
health care of Medicare beneficiaries
with cardiovascular disease. This
proposed rule implements these MIPPA
provisions in order to ensure services
enhance the patient’s clinical outcomes.
a. Background
Intensive cardiac rehabilitation (ICR)
is a relatively new practice that is also
commonly referred to as a ‘‘lifestyle
modification’’ program. These programs
typically involve the same elements as
general CR programs, but are furnished
in highly structured environments in
which sessions of the various
components may be combined for
longer periods of CR and also may be
more rigorous.
PO 00000
Frm 00088
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
b. Cardiac Rehabilitation Coverage
Under Medicare
One mechanism we use to establish
coverage for certain items and services
is the national coverage determination
(NCD) process. An NCD is a
determination by the Secretary with
respect to whether or not a particular
item or service is covered nationally
under Title XVIII.
Since 1982, Medicare has covered,
under an NCD, cardiac rehabilitation for
patients who experience stable angina,
have had coronary artery bypass grafts,
or have had an acute myocardial
infarction within the past 12 months.
The NCD is located in the Medicare
NCD Manual (Pub. 100–03), section
20.10. Effective March 22, 2006, we
modified the NCD language to cover
comprehensive cardiac rehabilitation
programs for patients who experience
one of the following:
• A documented diagnosis of acute
myocardial infarction within the
preceding 12 months.
• A coronary bypass surgery.
• Stable angina pectoris.
• A heart valve repair/replacement.
• A percutaneous transluminal
coronary angioplasty (PTCA) or
coronary stenting.
• A heart or heart-lung transplant.
Comprehensive programs must
include a medical evaluation, a program
to modify cardiac risk factors,
prescribed exercise, education, and
counseling and may last for up to 36
sessions over 18 weeks or no more than
72 sessions over 36 weeks if determined
appropriate by the local Medicare
contractors. Facilities furnishing cardiac
rehabilitation must have immediately
available necessary cardio-pulmonary,
emergency, diagnostic, and therapeutic
life-saving equipment and be staffed
with personnel necessary to conduct the
program safely and effectively who are
trained in advanced life support
techniques and exercise therapy for
coronary disease. The program must
also be under the direct supervision of
a physician. Until section 144(a) of the
MIPPA is effective, ICR programs are
covered under this NCD and are subject
to the same coverage requirements.
We are proposing to implement
section 144(a) of the MIPPA and refine
coverage for CR and ICR through this
rulemaking process. When the
rulemaking is completed, we will take
the necessary steps to withdraw and/or
modify the NCD.
c. Statutory Authority
Section 144(a) of the MIPPA amended
the Medicare Part B program by adding
new sections 1861(s)(2)(CC) and
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
1861(s)(2)(DD) of the Act to include
items and services furnished under a
‘‘cardiac rehabilitation program’’ and an
‘‘intensive cardiac rehabilitation
program,’’ respectively. A cardiac
rehabilitation program is defined in new
section 1861(eee)(1) of the Act and an
intensive cardiac rehabilitation program
is defined in new section
1861(eee)(4)(A) of the Act.
A cardiac rehabilitation program is a
physician-supervised program that
furnishes the following: Physicianprescribed exercise; cardiac risk factor
modification, including education,
counseling, and behavioral intervention;
psychosocial assessment; outcomes
assessment; and other items or services
as determined by the Secretary under
certain conditions. These items and
services must be furnished in a
physician’s office, in a hospital on an
outpatient basis, or in other settings as
determined appropriate by the
Secretary. A physician must be
immediately available and accessible for
medical consultation and emergencies
at all times items and services are being
furnished in a CR program except when
provided in a hospital setting where
such availability is presumed. The items
and services furnished by a CR program
are individualized and set forth in
written treatment plans that describe the
patient’s individual diagnosis; the type,
amount, frequency, and duration of
items and services furnished under the
plan; and the goals set for the individual
under the plan. These written plans
must be established, reviewed, and
signed by a physician every 30 days.
We are proposing that ICR programs
must provide the same items and
services under the same conditions as
CR programs but must demonstrate, as
shown in peer-reviewed published
research, that they have accomplished
one or more of the following: Positively
affected the progression of coronary
heart disease, or reduced the need for
coronary bypass surgery, or reduced the
need for percutaneous coronary
interventions (PCIs). The peer-reviewed
published research must also show that
the ICR program has resulted in a
statistically significant reduction in 5 or
more measures from their levels before
ICR services to their levels after receipt
of such services. These measures
include low density lipoprotein;
triglycerides; body mass index; systolic
blood pressure; diastolic blood pressure;
or the need for cholesterol, blood
pressure, and diabetes medications.
Beneficiaries eligible for ICR must
have experienced the following: An
acute myocardial infarction within the
preceding 12 months; a coronary bypass
surgery; current stable angina pectoris; a
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
heart valve repair or replacement; a
PTCA or coronary stenting; or a heart or
heart-lung transplant. Section
1861(eee)(4)(C) of the Act, as added by
section 144(a)(1)(B) of the MIPPA, states
that an ICR program may be provided in
a series of 72, 1-hour sessions (as
defined in section 1848(b)(5) of the Act),
up to 6 sessions per day, over a period
of up to 18 weeks.
The statute directs the Secretary to
establish standards for the physician(s)
supervising the ICR and/or CR programs
to ensure that the physician has
expertise in the management of
individuals with cardiac
pathophysiology and is licensed by the
State in which the CR program (or ICR
program) is offered. These standards
ensure that the physician is responsible
for the program and, in consultation
with appropriate staff, is involved
substantially in directing the progress of
individuals in the program.
d. Proposals for Implementation
We are proposing to create new
§ 410.49, ‘‘Cardiac Rehabilitation
Program and Intensive Cardiac
Rehabilitation Program: Conditions of
Coverage.’’
(1) Definitions
In this section, we are proposing
several definitions for the terms used
with respect to the programs and
services required by section 144(a) of
the MIPPA. These terms include the
following:
• Cardiac rehabilitation program.
• Individualized treatment plan.
• Intensive cardiac rehabilitation.
• Physician.
• Physician-prescribed exercise
• Psychosocial assessment.
• Outcomes assessment.
(2) Covered Beneficiaries
In § 410.49, we are proposing to
establish coverage for CR and ICR
programs for beneficiaries who have
experienced any of the following: An
acute myocardial infarction within the
preceding 12 months; a coronary bypass
surgery; current stable angina pectoris; a
heart valve repair or replacement; a
PTCA or coronary stenting; or a heart or
heart-lung transplant. We are proposing
to maintain and refine coverage of
general CR programs for beneficiaries
with these six conditions as originally
established in Pub. 100–03, section
20.10 as this coverage was determined
to be reasonable and necessary under
section 1862(a)(1)(A) of the Act due to
a high level of supporting clinical
evidence. We are also proposing
through this rulemaking to use the NCD
process in the future to identify
PO 00000
Frm 00089
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33607
additional medical indications for
patients who could obtain CR under
Medicare Part B. While CR programs
include certain mandatory services, the
written plans are highly individualized,
and we propose to allow some
flexibility in the type, amount,
frequency, and duration of services
provided in each session. However, as
supported by medical literature and
statements of the American Heart
Association (AHA) and the American
Association of Cardiovascular and
Pulmonary Rehabilitation (AACVPR),4
aerobic exercise training using the
muscles of ambulation is a mandatory
component of any CR or ICR program.
We recommend both low- and highintensity exercise to produce optimal
benefits, and suggest a combination of
endurance, strengthening and stretching
exercises. Patients in general CR
programs must participate in a
minimum of 2, 1-hour CR sessions a
week, and a maximum of 2, 1-hour
sessions a day. Patients in ICR programs
may participate in up to 6, 1-hour
sessions per day not to exceed 72, 1hour sessions over an 18-week period.
By a 1-hour session, we mean that each
session must last a minimum of 60
minutes. Each day CR or ICR items and
services are provided to a patient,
aerobic exercises along with other
exercises must be included (that is, a
patient must exercise aerobically every
day he or she attends a CR or ICR
session). Exercise may include the use
of treadmills, bicycles, light weights or
other equipment, and should be
intended to improve cardiovascular
function, strength, endurance, and
flexibility.
Section 144(a) of the MIPPA requires
CR and ICR programs to furnish items
and services including ‘‘cardiac risk
factor modification.’’ This includes
education, counseling, and behavioral
intervention to the extent these services
are closely related to the individual’s
care and treatment and tailored to
patients’ individual needs. We are
proposing that patients must be
provided with the information and tools
to improve their overall cardiovascular
health. Items and services furnished as
part of the risk factor modification
component should be highly
4 Balady G, Williams M, Ades P, et al. Core
Components of Cardiac Rehabilitation/Secondary
Prevention Programs: 2007 Update. A Scientific
Statement From the American Heart Association
Exercise, Cardiac Rehabilitation, and Prevention
Committee, the Council on Clinical Cardiology; the
Councils on Cardiovascular Nursing, Epidemiology
and Prevention, and Nutrition, Physical Activity,
and Metabolism; and the American Association of
Cardiovascular and Pulmonary Rehabilitation.
Journal of Cardiopulmonary Rehabilitation and
Prevention 2007;27:121–129.
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33608
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
individualized as multiple risk factors
contribute to poor cardiovascular
health. For example, these items and
services may include smoking cessation
counseling or referral, nutritional
education and meal planning, stress
management, prescription drug
education and management information,
disease history education in order to
foster a better understanding of disease
origins and disease symptomatology,
and any other education, counseling
and behavioral intervention deemed
appropriate in each patient’s
individualized treatment plan.
The MIPPA provisions require a
psychosocial assessment as part of the
CR and ICR programs defined above. We
are proposing that the initial assessment
by program staff evaluate aspects of the
individual’s family and home situation
that may affect their treatment, and
consider at the outset if referrals to
support groups, community and/or
home care services are necessary. Prior
to each 30-day review of the
individualized treatment plan, the
supervising physician or program staff
will conduct an evaluation of the
individual’s response to, and rate of
progress under, the treatment plan and
make recommendations to the physician
as necessary. While the individualized
treatment plan discussed below will
assist in ensuring that patients begin CR
with a program tailored to their needs,
a periodic re-evaluation is necessary to
ensure that their psychosocial needs are
in fact being met.
The MIPPA provisions also require
that CR and ICR programs include
outcomes assessment. Professional
groups, such as the AHA and AACVPR,
recognize a number of relevant patient
outcomes that may be expected to
accrue from the various components of
cardiac rehabilitation.5 We propose to
define outcomes assessment as an
evaluation of the patient’s progress in
the program using assessments from the
commencement and conclusion of CR
and ICR programs that are based upon
patient centered outcomes. Patient
centered outcomes must be measured at
the beginning of the CR program, prior
to each 30-day review of the
individualized treatment plan, and at
the end of the CR program. All
5 Balady G, Williams M, Ades P, et al. Core
Components of Cardiac Rehabilitation/Secondary
Prevention Programs: 2007 Update. A Scientific
Statement From the American Heart Association
Exercise, Cardiac Rehabilitation, and Prevention
Committee, the Council on Clinical Cardiology; the
Councils on Cardiovascular Nursing, Epidemiology
and Prevention, and Nutrition, Physical Activity,
and Metabolism; and the American Association of
Cardiovascular and Pulmonary Rehabilitation.
Journal of Cardiopulmonary Rehabilitation and
Prevention 2007;27:121–129.
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
assessments are considered part of the
CR program and, as such, are conducted
in the appropriate settings and not
billed separately. These measures
should include resting and exercising
heart rate, resting and exercising
systolic and diastolic blood pressure,
weight, BMI, amount and dosage of
medications required, self-reported
quality of life, and behavioral measures
(for example, smoking cessation,
increased activity levels, change in
exercise levels during CR). As CR
programs must be highly
individualized, alternate or additional
measures may be appropriate. Patients’
individualized treatment plans should
be altered accordingly with changes
and/or progress in each of the outcome
measurements. Programs may also
develop performance standards which
measure the overall quality of the
program, by assessing the group as a
whole.
The MIPPA provisions require that CR
services be provided under written
individualized treatment plans. As CR
programs are highly individualized, we
propose that the physician define and
set the parameters, including the
individual’s diagnosis, the types of
services appropriate, and the treatment
goals. The MIPPA provisions require the
physician to establish the written
individualized treatment plan and
conduct subsequent reviews every 30
days. This plan may initially be
developed by the referring physician or
the CR physician. If the plan is
developed by the referring physician
who is not the CR physician, the CR
physician must also review and sign the
plan prior to initiation of CR. Direct
physician contact is not always required
to meet the 30-day review standards, but
might be necessary depending upon
specific patient factors. Regardless, CR
staff must provide both outcome and
psychosocial assessments to the
supervising physician prior to the 30day deadline and the physician must
evaluate the information provided by
the CR staff. The CR staff may make
recommendations for modifications to
the program, but the physician will still
modify the plan as needed, and review
and sign the plan. The MIPPA
provisions require written specificity
relating to the type, amount, frequency,
and duration of the items and services
furnished under the individual’s plan.
As CR patients have had or may develop
disabling cardiovascular disease, they
require individual attention and
assessments that address their
individualized needs and meet realistic
individualized goals through a
specifically designed treatment plan.
PO 00000
Frm 00090
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
The individualized treatment plan
should specify the combination of
services necessary to address the
patient’s needs, as identified through
the initial assessment and based upon
changes in the patient’s condition. It
must include measurable and expected
outcomes and estimated timetables to
achieve these outcomes. The outcomes
specified in the individualized
treatment plan should be consistent
with current evidence-based
professionally-accepted clinical practice
standards such as those identified by
the AHA and AACVPR.
The MIPPA provisions also authorize
the Secretary to include other
mandatory items and services within
the scope of the CR program under
certain conditions. We are not
proposing to require any other items
and services at the present time. If the
Secretary determines that the addition
of any other items and services is
appropriate, additions will be made and
implemented through future
rulemaking.
Section 144(a) of the MIPPA provides
for coverage of CR and ICR services in
various settings which include a
physician’s office, a hospital on an
outpatient basis or other settings
determined appropriate by the
Secretary. We are not proposing to cover
CR or ICR in other settings at this time.
If the Secretary determines that the
addition of settings is appropriate,
additions will be made through
rulemaking. All settings should have all
equipment and staff necessary,
consistent with cardiac rehabilitation
professional society recommendations,
to provide statutorily-mandated items
and services.
Section 144 of the MIPPA includes
requirements for immediate and
ongoing physician availability and
accessibility for both medical
consultations and medical emergencies
at all times items and services are being
furnished under the program.
Professional groups such as the AHA
and AACVPR recognize the need to
provide appropriate patient supervision
and, where appropriate, monitoring. We
are proposing that such availability be
met through existing definitions for
direct physician supervision in
physician offices and hospital
outpatient departments at § 410.26(a)(2)
(defined through cross reference to
§ 410.32(b)(3)(ii)) and § 410.27(f),
respectively. Direct supervision, as
defined in the regulations, is consistent
with the language of the MIPPA because
the physician must be present and
immediately available where the
services are being furnished. The
physician must also be able to furnish
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
assistance and direction throughout the
performance of the services, which
would include medical consultations
and medical emergencies.
For CR and ICR services provided in
physicians’ offices and other Part B
settings paid under the PFS, the
physician must be present in the office
suite and immediately available to
furnish assistance and direction
throughout the performance of the
service or procedure in accordance with
the § 410.26(b)(5). This does not mean
that the physician must be in the room
when the service or procedure is
performed. For CR and ICR services
provided to hospital outpatients, direct
physician supervision is the standard
set forth in the April 7, 2000 OPPS final
rule with comment period (68 FR 18524
through 18526) for supervision of
hospital outpatient therapeutic services
covered and paid by Medicare in
hospitals and provider-based
departments of hospitals. We currently
define and specify the requirement for
direct supervision for services furnished
in provider-based departments of
hospitals at § 410.27(f). For this
purpose, the physician must be on the
premises of the location (meaning the
provider-based department) and
immediately available to furnish
assistance and direction throughout the
performance of the procedure. This does
not mean that the physician must be
present in the room when the procedure
is furnished. If we were to propose
future changes to the physician office or
hospital outpatient policies for direct
physician supervision, we would
provide our assessment of the
implications of those proposals for the
supervision of cardiac rehabilitation
services at that time.
The MIPPA provisions state that in
the case of items and services furnished
under such a program in a hospital,
physician availability shall be
presumed. As we have stated in the CY
2009 OPPS/ASC final rule with
comment period (73 FR 68702 through
68704), the longstanding presumption
relating to direct physician supervision
for hospital outpatient services means
that direct physician supervision is the
standard for supervision of hospital
outpatient therapeutic services covered
and paid by Medicare in hospitals and
provider-based departments of
hospitals, and we expect that hospitals
are providing services in accordance
with this standard.
New section 1861(eee)(4) of the Act
requires ICR programs, to be qualified
for Medicare coverage, to meet several
standards. To become qualified, an ICR
program must demonstrate through
peer-reviewed, published research that
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
it has accomplished one or more of the
following: (1) Positively affected the
progression of coronary heart disease;
(2) reduced the need for coronary
bypass surgery; or (3) reduced the need
for percutaneous coronary interventions
(PCIs). A qualified ICR program must
also demonstrate through peer-reviewed
published research that the ICR program
accomplished a statistically significant
reduction for patients in 5 or more
specific measures from the individual’s
levels before ICR services to their levels
after receipt of such services. These
measures include: (1) Low density
lipoproteins; (2) triglycerides; (3) body
mass index; (4) systolic blood pressure;
(5) diastolic blood pressure; and (6) the
need for cholesterol, blood pressure,
and diabetes medications. To ensure
that ICR programs in fact meet these
standards, we are proposing that
programs intending to operate as ICR
programs apply to CMS to receive
designation as qualified ICR programs.
Only designated programs would then
be eligible for Medicare coverage and
would be required to undergo regular reevaluation to maintain such status. We
are requesting public comments on
establishing an annual re-evaluation
process.
We are proposing that programs may
apply to CMS to be designated qualified
programs to provide ICR. To meet this
designation, programs must submit to
CMS detailed literature describing the
program and the precise manner in
which the program meets MIPPA
provisions. Each program must also
submit peer-reviewed, published
research specific to the actual program
applying for approval. The research
must clearly demonstrate that the
program under examination
accomplishes at least the minimum
outcomes as defined above. We are
proposing, based on our general
rulemaking authority that each ICR
program must submit a detailed
description of the items and services
available to ICR patients and the
capabilities of the facility in which the
program takes place as well as the
responsibilities of program staff. All
materials shall be submitted to: Director,
Coverage and Analysis Group, Centers
for Medicare & Medicaid Services, 7500
Security Boulevard, Mail Stop C1–09–
06, Baltimore, Maryland 21244.
Following CMS review, ICR programs
will either be notified of any missing
information or inadequacies in their
submissions (so they may resubmit in
the future) or be notified of CMS
designation as an ICR program.
Designated programs will be identified
in a list of ICR programs posted on the
CMS Web site and in the Federal
PO 00000
Frm 00091
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33609
Register. We are proposing that all
designated programs must demonstrate
continued compliance with MIPPA
standards every year in order to
maintain qualified status.
We are proposing that for an ICR
program to maintain its designation by
CMS as a qualified ICR program, the
program must submit specific outcomes
assessment information. Programs shall
submit information for all patients who
initiated and completed the full ICR
program during the initial year-long
CMS designation. For each patient,
programs must identify the following:
(1) The medical condition qualifying the
patient for eligibility to participate in
ICR; (2) the patient’s improvement in
coronary heart disease, reduced need for
coronary bypass surgery, and/or
reduced need for PCIs; and (3) the levels
of the 5 or more measures identified
above at the beginning and end of the
program. Programs must also submit
average beginning and ending levels of
at least those 5 measures for the
program as a whole. If any changes are
made to the ICR program during the
initial year-long CMS designation, such
changes must be documented and
submitted with the outcomes
assessment information. Programs will
have 30 days to submit this information
to CMS following the end of the initial
approval period. In the month following
receipt, we will review the submitted
information and determine whether the
program continues to meet the payment
standards. We believe that reevaluations of designated programs will
assist CMS in ensuring that programs
continue to demonstrate the outcome
measures identified for initial
designation. We are requesting public
comments on annual program reevaluations requirements, the required
information for re-evaluation proposed
above and if an administrative appeals
process should be established for ICR
programs that no longer meet outcomes
standards. We are also asking for public
comments on the time period for reevaluations of ICR programs.
Section 144(a)(1)(B) of the MIPPA
requires CR and ICR programs to be
physician-supervised. In addition,
section 144(a)(5) of the MIPPA requires
the Secretary to establish standards to
ensure that the physician, who has the
appropriate expertise in the
management of individuals with cardiac
pathophysiology and is licensed to
practice medicine in the State in which
the CR or ICR program is offered, is
responsible for the CR or ICR program.
We propose to identify this physician
who oversees or supervises the CR and
ICR program in its entirety as the
Medical Director. As required by
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33610
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
144(a)(5), we are proposing that the
Medical Director must have training and
proficiency in cardiovascular disease
management and exercise training of
heart disease patients. We also propose
that the Medical Director, in
consultation with other staff, must be
involved substantially in directing the
progress of individuals in the program.
We are expressly seeking public
comments on the precise level of
expertise that is necessary for the
Medical Director.
As discussed above, section
144(a)(2)(B) of MIPAA requires that a
physician must be immediately
available and accessible for medical
consultations and medical emergencies
at all times items and services are being
furnished under the program. For
purposes of this proposed rule we are
identifying this physician as the
supervising physician (that is, the
physician that must be immediately
available to furnish assistance and
direction throughout the performance of
CR and ICR services); we believe this
physician also requires expertise in
cardiac pathophysiology resulting from
training or experience in cardiovascular
disease management and exercise
training of heart disease patients. This
includes a physician billing Medicare
Part B for providing services directly to
a patient during a CR or ICR session. We
are proposing standards for these
physicians based on our general
rulemaking authority which include
expertise in the management of
individuals with cardiac
pathophysiology and licensure to
practice medicine in the State in which
the CR or ICR program is offered. We are
expressly inviting public comments
about the precise level of expertise that
is necessary.
Please note that the program Medical
Director may fulfill both roles of
Medical Director and supervising
physician (of individual CR and ICR
services furnished to patients) provided
that the requirements for direct
physician supervision as required in
§§ 410.26 and 410.27 are met when CR
or ICR items and services are furnished,
as discussed above.
We are requesting public comments
regarding whether specific training and
expertise standards are needed for the
cardiac rehabilitation staff.
Section 1861(eee)(4)(C) of the Act
provides for coverage of ICR programs
that are provided in a series of 72 1-hour
sessions (as defined in section
1848(b)(5) of the Act), up to 6 sessions
per day, over a period of up to 18 weeks.
Specific provisions for the number,
duration, and time period for general CR
programs are not identified in the
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
MIPPA; however we propose to
maintain, with slight refinements,
coverage requirements previously
established in Pub. L. 100–03, section
20.10 through this rulemaking process.
For eligible beneficiaries, general CR is
provided for up to 36 1-hour sessions,
up to 2 sessions per day with no fewer
than 2 sessions per week, over up to 18
weeks, with contractor discretion to
expand these limitations to not exceed
72 sessions for 36 weeks. This is based
on section 1862(a)(1)(A) of the Act and
our general rulemaking authority. By 1hour session, we mean that each session
must last a minimum of 60 minutes.
e. Coding and Payment
(1) CR Payment
Currently, the following CPT codes
are used for CR services described in
section 144(a) of the MIPPA: CPT code
93797, Physician services for outpatient
cardiac rehabilitation; without
continuous ECG monitoring (per
session); and CPT code 93798, Physician
services for outpatient cardiac
rehabilitation; with continuous ECG
monitoring (per session). We are not
proposing to revise these codes under
the PFS because the CR program
authorized by the existing NCD is
essentially the same as that included in
the MIPPA.
(2) ICR Payment
The statute requires that the hospital
Outpatient Prospective Payment System
(OPPS) payment amount for CR services
be substituted for ICR under the PFS,
specifically the payment for CPT codes
93797 and 93798 or any succeeding
HCPCS codes for CR. We are proposing
to create two new HCPCS codes for ICR
services. These codes may only be billed
by ICR programs that have been
approved by CMS. The proposed codes
are as follows:
• GXX28, Intensive cardiac
rehabilitation; with or without
continuous ECG monitoring with
exercise, per session.
• GXX29, Intensive cardiac
rehabilitation; with or without
continuous ECG monitoring; without
exercise, per session.
These HCPCS codes will be
recognized under the PFS and the
OPPS. Under the OPPS the existing CR
HCPCS codes, CPT codes 93797 and
93798, are assigned to APC 0095
(Cardiac Rehabilitation) for CY 2009.
Because the payment under the PFS for
the two proposed ICR G-codes is
required to be the same as the payment
for CR services under OPPS, we are
proposing to pay the same amount as
will be established through rulemaking
PO 00000
Frm 00092
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
for CY 2010. The proposed OPPS
payment amount for CR services will be
announced in the CY 2010 OPPS/ASC
proposed rule. We are proposing that
this amount will be adjusted for the
appropriate locality by applying the
GPCI under the PFS. The CY 2010
proposed APC assignments and
payment rates for these two ICR G-codes
will be published in the CY 2010 OPPS/
ASC proposed rule. The proposed
payment rate for the associated APC(s)
will be included in Addendum A to the
CY 2010 OPPS/ASC proposed rule.
We note that when a CR/ICR service
is furnished in a hospital outpatient
department, a physician cannot bill the
Medicare contractor for CR/ICR unless
the physician personally performs the
CR/ICR service. To personally perform
the CR/ICR service, the physician would
provide direct care to a single patient for
the entire session of CR/ICR that is
being reported. In this case, the hospital
would report the CR/ICR service and be
paid the OPPS payment for the facility
services associated with the CR/ICR
session and the physician would report
and be paid the PFS amount for the CR/
ICR service. A physician cannot bill
under the PFS for CR/ICR services
furnished in a hospital for which the
physician furnishes only supervision or
for services furnished in part by others.
If the physician furnishes no direct CR/
ICR services for a given session or on a
given day or provides direct CR/ICR
services for less than the full session,
then only the hospital would report the
CR/ICR services and these services
would be paid under the OPPS.
9. Section 144(a): Payment and Coverage
Improvements for Patients With Chronic
Obstructive Pulmonary Disease and
Other Conditions—Pulmonary
Rehabilitation Services
Section 144 of the MIPPA amended
Title XVIII of the Act to provide for
coverage of pulmonary rehabilitation
(PR) under Part B, under certain
conditions, for services furnished on or
after January 1, 2010. This proposed
rule would implement the new
Medicare pulmonary rehabilitation
program and establish the requirements
for providing such services to Medicare
beneficiaries with a diagnosis of
moderate to severe chronic obstructive
pulmonary disease (COPD). COPD is not
only one of the more common of the
diseases in the category of chronic
respiratory diseases, it is one of the
more severely debilitating, characterized
by chronic bronchitis and emphysema.
Other diseases and conditions in this
category include persistent asthma,
bronchiectasis, primary pulmonary
hypertension, obesity-related respiratory
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
disease, and ventilator dependency.
This rule provides direction in
implementing the MIPPA in order to
ensure services are covered and enhance
the patient’s clinical outcomes.
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
a. Background
A PR program is typically a
multidisciplinary program of care for
patients with chronic respiratory
impairment that is individually tailored
and designed to optimize physical and
social performance and autonomy. The
main goal of an individualized PR
training program is to empower and
facilitate the individuals’ ability to
exercise independently; exercise is the
cornerstone of the PR program. Exercise
is combined with other training and
support mechanisms necessary to
integrate prevention and encourage
long-term adherence to the treatment
plan. The appropriate PR program will
train and motivate the patient to his or
her maximum potential in self-care, and
improve his or her overall quality of life.
b. Provisions of Section 144 of the
MIPPA
In pertinent part, section 144 of the
MIPPA amended section 1861(s)(2) of
the Act to add a new subparagraph (CC)
establishing coverage of items and
services furnished under a ‘‘pulmonary
rehabilitation program.’’ Pulmonary
rehabilitation program is defined in new
subsection (fff)(1) to mean a physician
supervised program that furnishes
several specific items and services.
These include all of the following:
• Physician-prescribed exercise.
• Education or training (to the extent
that the education and training is
closely and clearly related to the
individual’s care and treatment and is
tailored to such individual’s needs).
• Psychosocial assessment.
• Outcomes assessment.
• Other items and services
determined by the Secretary to be
appropriate under certain conditions.
These components are to be provided
in physicians’ offices, hospital
outpatient settings, and other settings
determined appropriate by the
Secretary. A physician must be
immediately available and accessible for
medical consultation and medical
emergencies at all times when PR items
and services are being furnished under
the program. The individual’s treatment
is furnished under a written treatment
plan that is developed by the physician
for each beneficiary participating in a
PR program. A physician must establish
and review the plan and it must be
signed by the physician every 30 days.
This plan must include the individual’s
diagnosis, the scope of services to be
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
provided in terms of type, amount,
frequency and duration, and the goals
set for the individual. To be covered and
paid by Medicare, the PR program must
provide all of the specified mandatory
items and services. With respect to the
Secretary’s authority to require
additional items and services, we are
not proposing any additional services at
the present time; however, we may
propose additional items and services in
the future.
c. Proposals
Under section 144 of the MIPPA, we
are proposing to create a new § 410.47,
‘‘Pulmonary Rehabilitation Program:
Conditions for Coverage’’ under Part B
to add the PR program as a Medicarecovered service. The new section
1861(fff) of the Act outlines the
mandatory components of a PR
program. In accordance with this new
section, any facility providing a PR
program must meet all of the
requirements outlined herein. The
MIPPA provides for coverage of PR
services in two specific settings
(physician’s office, hospital outpatient)
and authorized the agency to consider
the addition of other settings. We are
not proposing any other settings at the
present time.
The PR provisions defined by section
144 of the MIPPA are effective January
1, 2010.
(1) Definitions
We are proposing the following
definitions for the programs and
services required by MIPPA as related to
PR provisions.
• Individualized treatment plan: A
written plan which describes the
individual’s diagnosis; the type,
amount, frequency and duration of the
items and services to be furnished under
the plan, including specifics related to
the individual’s particular needs for
education and training; and the goals set
for the individual under the plan.
• Outcomes assessment: A
physician’s evaluation of the patient’s
progress as it relates to his or her
rehabilitation. The outcomes assessment
is in writing and includes the following:
(1) Pre- and post-assessments, based on
patient-centered outcomes which are
conducted by the physician at the
beginning of the program and at the end
of the program; and (2) objective clinical
measures of exercise performance and
self-reported measures of shortness of
breath and behavior.
• Physician: A doctor of medicine or
osteopathy as defined in section
1861(r)(1) of the Act.
• Physician-prescribed exercise:
Physical activity, including aerobic
PO 00000
Frm 00093
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33611
exercise, prescribed and supervised by a
physician that improves or maintains an
individual’s pulmonary functional level.
• Psychosocial assessment: A written
evaluation of an individual’s mental and
emotional functioning as it relates to the
individual’s rehabilitation or respiratory
condition.
This includes: (1) An assessment of
those aspects of an individual’s family
and home situation that affect the
individual’s rehabilitation treatment;
and (2) a psychosocial evaluation of the
individual’s response to and rate of
progress under the treatment plan.
• Pulmonary rehabilitation: A short
term physician-supervised program for
COPD and certain other chronic
respiratory diseases designed to
optimize physical and social
performance and autonomy.
(2) Coverage
We are proposing that Medicare Part
B would cover PR for beneficiaries with
moderate to severe COPD when ordered
by the physician treating chronic
respiratory diseases. A comprehensive
PR program may be adapted for any
person with chronic respiratory disease.
The medical literature describes
conditions associated with the possible
need for PR including COPD, obesityrelated respiratory disease, lung cancer,
and neuromuscular diseases. However,
the benefits of a PR program most
strongly support its use for patients with
moderate to severe COPD.
(a) Definition of Moderate to Severe
COPD
Moderate to severe COPD is defined
as GOLD classification II and III. The
GOLD classification utilizes indices that
measure airflow limitation and lung
hyperinflation to determine severity of
COPD. Specifically, the measurement of
Forced Expiratory Volume (FEV) in the
first second divided by the Forced
Expiratory Vital Capacity (liters) (FEV1/
FVC) gives a clinically useful index of
airflow limitation. In other words, the
volume of air exhaled that can be forced
out in one second after taking a deep
breath divided by the maximum volume
of air exhaled as rapidly, forcefully and
completely as possible from the point of
maximum inhalation equals a numerical
value used to grade COPD severity.
Moderate and severe COPD are defined
as:
• GOLD classification II (Moderate
COPD)) is defined as FEV1/FVC<70
percent and FEV1 ≥30 percent to <80
percent predicted with or without
chronic symptoms (Cough, sputum
production, dyspnea).
• GOLD classification III (Severe
COPD) is defined as FEV1/FVC < 70
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33612
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
percent and FEV1 < 30 percent
predicted or FEV1 < 50 percent
predicted plus respiratory failure or
clinical signs of right heart failure.
Section 144 of the MIPPA does not
specify the medical conditions for
which coverage and payment are
authorized for a PR program, other than
a reference in the title to ‘‘chronic
obstructive pulmonary disease and
other conditions’’. Although the
spectrum of possible conditions for
which PR may be covered is broad, the
medical guidelines most strongly
supported the benefits of a PR program
for individuals with moderate to severe
COPD. The major national and
international respiratory organizations
(that is, ATS/ERS, the American College
of Chest Physicians (AACP) jointly with
the American Association of
Cardiovascular and Pulmonary
Rehabilitation (AACVPR), and Global
Initiative for Chronic Obstructive Lung
Disease) have recommended PR as the
standard of care in the treatment of
moderate to severe chronic obstructive
pulmonary disease represented by
GOLD classification II or III. Because
there is not data to substantiate
significantly improved outcomes for any
other medical conditions, we are
proposing to allow moderate to severe
COPD as the only covered condition.
We propose to consider expanding
coverage to patients with other medical
conditions, should evidence support
these additional uses. We would
propose in our regulations to use the
national coverage determination process
to consider expanding coverage of PR
for other chronic respiratory.
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
(b) Use of the NCD Process
We are proposing to use the national
coverage determination process as
authorized by section 1871(1) of the Act,
to consider expanding coverage to items
and services furnished by PR programs.
The NCD process is open and
transparent and provides an opportunity
for public comments. Moreover, the
NCD process affords CMS the ability to
conduct a timely assessment of recent
clinical evidence through a flexible and
transparent process. It allows us to make
uniform nationwide coverage
determinations for items and services in
a more flexible manner than
rulemaking. In most circumstances, the
NCD process is required to be
completed within 9 to 12 months of the
time that we accept a formal request for
an NCD on a particular service. The
NCD process will maximize the clinical
benefit of PR for beneficiaries, and
permit more rapid changes in response
to emerging clinical evidence.
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
(3) Physician-Prescribed Exercise
Since the determination of the
optimal time spent on each of the
specific components within a PR
program is highly individualized under
the written plan of care, we are
proposing to give the program medical
director considerable flexibility.
However, aerobic exercise is widely
considered the cornerstone of
pulmonary rehabilitation, and practice
guidelines in the medical literature
suggest exercise training of the muscles
of ambulation as an essential
component of a PR program. Each
session must include some physicianprescribed aerobic exercise. We
recommend both low- and highintensity exercise to produce clinical
benefits. It is suggested that exercise
sessions involving a combination of
endurance and strength training (to
increase muscle strength and muscle
mass) be conducted at least twice per
week to achieve physiological benefits.
Exercise may include use of treadmills,
bicycles or other equipment, and should
provide increased pulmonary function,
strength, endurance, and flexibility.
(4) Education or Training Under the PR
Program
Section 144 requires that education or
training must meet the statutory
requirements that mandate that it must
be closely and clearly related to the
individual’s care and treatment, as well
as meeting the specific needs of the
individual. As part of the written
individualized treatment plan the
physician should evaluate and include
only that education and training which
addresses the needs particular to the
patient that will further their
independence in activities of daily
living. The training and education
prescribed should assist patients in
learning to adapt to their limitations and
improve the quality of their lives.
Patients with COPD often use
respiratory therapy modalities and
equipment to aid their breathing.
Education and training should be
provided as necessary to ensure proper
use and compliance with the
physician’s prescription. Instruction
should include proper use, care, and
cleaning of home respiratory equipment.
Examples of equipment for which
instruction would be appropriate
include nebulizers/compressors,
transtracheal oxygen (TTO), peak flow
meters, and oxygen-conserving devices.
Current medical literature provides for
education as an integral component of
pulmonary rehabilitation. The
supervising physician must ensure the
education or training helps further the
PO 00000
Frm 00094
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
primary objective of understanding and
self-management of the chronic
respiratory disease, specifically focused
on COPD, including educational
information on prevention and
treatment of exacerbations. Examples of
training sessions include those on
respiratory techniques for physical
energy conservation, work
simplification, and relaxation
techniques. Skills training and
education also encourage behavioral
changes by the patient, which can lead
to improved health and long-term
adherence. For example, brief smoking
cessation counseling, as appropriate and
respiratory problem management,
should be included. Other topics for
education may include the proper use of
medications and nutrition counseling.
(5) Psychosocial Assessment
Section 144 of the MIPPA requires a
psychosocial assessment as part of the
PR program; we propose that it should
be a written assessment. The initial
assessment by program staff will
evaluate aspects of the individual’s
family and home situation that may
affect his or her treatment, and consider
at the outset if referrals to support
groups, community and/or home care
services are necessary. Individual
psychological considerations will also
be addressed. For example, smoking is
well known to be a cause of COPD.
Depression and anxiety are commonly
reported concerns for this patient
population. Psychosocial intervention
could help facilitate behavioral changes,
such as smoking cessation, as well as
assist with managing symptoms such as
dyspnea. The assessment should
include a written evaluation of the
patient’s need, as appropriate, for
depression management, stress
reduction, relaxation techniques, and
strategies for coping with lung disease.
This proposed rule does not propose
any changes to the existing NCD (210.4)
for ‘‘Smoking and Tobacco-Use
Cessation Counseling.’’
The psychosocial assessment should
include thorough screening and
evaluation of the individual’s lifestyle
and other behaviors. Prior to each 30day review of the individualized
treatment plan, the program staff will
conduct an evaluation of the
individual’s response to, and rate of
progress under, the treatment plan and
make recommendations to the physician
as necessary. While the individualized
treatment plan discussed below will
assure that patients begin PR with a
program tailored to their needs, periodic
re-evaluations are necessary to ensure
that their psychosocial needs are in fact
being met.
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
(6) Outcomes Assessment
Section 144 of the MIPPA also
requires that the PR program include
outcomes assessment. In this proposed
rule, we define outcomes assessment as
an objective clinical measure of the
effectiveness of the PR program for the
individual patient. Patient-centered
outcomes should be measured at the
beginning of the PR program, prior to
each 30-day review of the
individualized treatment plan, and no
later than at the end of the PR program.
All such assessments are considered
part of the PR program and as such are
conducted in the appropriate settings
and may not be billed separately. These
measures should include clinical
measures such as a 6-minute walk,
weight, exercise performance, selfreported dyspnea (exertional and with
daily activities), behavioral measures
(supplemental oxygen use, smoking
status), and a quality-of-life assessment.
Some of the common program outcome
measures examined in PR are functional
exercise capacity, survival, and ADLs.
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
(7) Individualized Treatment Plan
Section 144 of the MIPPA requires
that the physician develop, sign, and
review an individualized treatment
plan. In recognizing that PR programs
are inherently highly individualized, we
are proposing that the physician shall
define and set the parameters, including
types, amount, frequency and duration
of the services, and goals, for the
individual’s treatment plan that include
each of the four component services
within the maximum duration of the
program. The MIPPA requires the
physician to establish the written
individualized treatment plan at the
start of the program and conduct
subsequent reviews every 30 days. This
plan may initially be developed by the
referring physician or the PR physician.
If the plan is developed by the referring
physician who is not the PR physician,
the PR physician must also review and
sign the plan prior to initiation of PR.
We would expect the supervising
physician to have initial direct contact
with the individual prior to subsequent
treatment by auxiliary personnel. We
would also expect at least one direct
contact with the beneficiary in each 30day period. Regardless, PR staff must
provide both outcome and psychosocial
assessments to the responsible
physician prior to the 30-day deadline.
Even if the PR staff makes
recommendations for modifications to
the program the physician will still be
responsible for modifying the plan as
needed, and reviewing and signing the
plan prior to implementation for the
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
individual. The MIPPA also requires
written specificity relating to the type,
amount, frequency and duration of
items, and services furnished to the
individual. Patients with chronic
respiratory disease require individual
attention, and assessments which
address individualized needs must be
designed to meet realistic individual
goals. Therefore, the individualized
plan of care should specify the mix of
services necessary to address the
patient’s needs, as identified through
the initial assessment, and based upon
changes in the patient’s condition.
Further, it must include measurable and
expected outcomes and estimated
timetables to achieve these outcomes.
The outcomes specified in the patient
plan of care should be consistent with
current evidence-based professionallyaccepted clinical practice standards.
(8) Settings
In the MIPPA, the Congress has
identified 2 appropriate settings for
pulmonary rehabilitation, and also
authorized the agency to provide
additional settings for the PR program.
We considered whether these new
requirements should extend to CORFs,
which are governed by different
statutory provisions in section 1861(cc)
of the Act. Given the differences in the
statutory language, we do not propose
extending the PR program requirements
to CORFs. Individuals requiring PR
program services have a chronic
respiratory disease and are in need of
supervised aerobic exercise, not
physical therapy. Conversely, in the
CORF setting physical therapy is the
cornerstone component and a
mandatory service, while exercise is
not. Thus, the PR program is for an
inherently different patient population,
and allows for the first time, payment
for exercise for COPD patients.
Therefore, we propose not to include
the CORF as a setting for a PR program.
The respiratory therapy services
performed in a CORF are part of a CORF
program of services and not part of a PR
program. We would consider the
inclusion of additional settings through
future rulemaking.
Both physician offices and outpatient
settings must meet the standards as
defined in the rule for safety and
emergency care. These include both the
immediate availability of the physician
during the PR program and certain
equipment requirements. In order to
ensure proper safeguards in the
statutorily-prescribed settings, the
setting must have the cardio-pulmonary,
emergency diagnostic and therapeutic
equipment accepted as medically
necessary by the medical community for
PO 00000
Frm 00095
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33613
emergency treatment related to a
chronic respiratory disease condition.
Some examples of this equipment are
oxygen, defibrillators, and cardiopulmonary resuscitation equipment.
The setting must have all equipment
and staff necessary to provide all of the
statutorily-mandated items and services.
We would expect that any additional
settings which may be added through
future rulemaking would similarly need
to meet all of the aforementioned
requirements.
(9) Physician Supervision
Section 144 of the MIPPA includes
requirements for immediate and
ongoing physician availability and
accessibility for both medical
consultations and medical emergencies
at all times items and services are being
furnished under the program. We are
proposing to define such availability in
accordance with existing definitions for
direct physician supervision in
physician offices and hospital
outpatient departments at § 410.26(a)(2)
(defined through cross reference to
§ 410.32(b)(3)(ii)) and § 410.27(f),
respectively. Direct supervision, as
defined in the regulations, is consistent
with the language of the MIPPA because
a physician must be present and
immediately available where the
services are being furnished. A
physician must also be able to furnish
assistance and direction throughout the
performance of the services, which
would include medical consultations
and medical emergencies.
For PR services furnished in
physicians’ offices and other Part B
settings paid under the PFS, this means
that the physician must be present in
the office suite and immediately
available to furnish assistance and
direction throughout the performance of
the service or procedure in accordance
with § 410.26(b)(5). It does not mean
that the physician must be in the room
when the service or procedure is
performed. For PR services provided to
hospital outpatients, direct physician
supervision is the standard set forth in
the April 7, 2000 OPPS final rule with
comment period (68 FR 18524 through
18526) for supervision of hospital
outpatient therapeutic services covered
and paid by Medicare in hospitals and
provider-based departments of
hospitals. We currently define and
specify the requirement for direct
supervision for services provided in
provider-based departments of hospitals
at § 410.27(f). For this purpose, the
physician must be on the premises of
the location (meaning the providerbased department) and immediately
available to furnish assistance and
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33614
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
direction throughout the performance of
the procedure. This does not mean that
the physician must be present in the
room when the procedure is performed.
If we were to propose future changes to
the physician office or hospital
outpatient policies for direct physician
supervision, we would provide our
assessment of the implications of those
proposals for the supervision of
pulmonary rehabilitation services at that
time.
The MIPAA provisions state that in
the case of items and services furnished
under such a program in a hospital,
physician availability shall be
presumed. As we have stated in the CY
2009 OPPS/ASC final rule with
comment period (73 FR 68702 through
68704), the longstanding presumption of
direct physician supervision for hospital
outpatient services means that direct
physician supervision is the standard
and we expect that hospitals are
providing services in accordance with
this standard.
(10) Physician Standards
The MIPPA authorizes the Secretary
to establish standards to ensure that
only a physician with expertise in the
management of individuals with
respiratory pathophysiology and who is
licensed by the State where the PR
program is offered shall be responsible
for the program and direct the
individual’s progress. We propose to
identify the physician who oversees or
supervises the PR program in its entirety
as the program medical director, and
this may be the same physician
providing, and billing for, the PR
services. We are proposing that the
program medical director must have
training and proficiency in chronic
respiratory disease management and
exercise training of chronic respiratory
disease patients. We further propose
that the standards for program oversight
shall include substantial involvement in
the monitoring and direction of the
patients’ progress, and by implication,
the staff that assists in furnishing the
services. As part of his or her
responsibility and accountability for the
program, the program medical director
will be expected to retain all records
and documentation for each beneficiary
which are ordinarily compiled in their
clinical practice. We propose that the
substantiation of the program medical
director’s expertise in respiratory
pathophysiology would correlate to
experience in the provision of care for
individuals with chronic respiratory
diseases. For purposes of referral for PR
services, we are proposing to use the
definition of ‘‘physician’’ specified in
section 1861(r)(1) of the Act which
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
defines ‘‘physician’’ as ‘‘a doctor of
medicine or osteopathy legally
authorized to practice medicine and
surgery by the State in which he or she
performs such function or action
(including a physician within the
meaning of section 1101(a)(7) of the
Act).’’ We also propose that a
supervising physician must be
immediately available and accessible for
emergencies and consultations.
(11) Sessions
Currently, PR is conducted with a
widely varying number of sessions. We
are unaware of any data that specifies an
exact number of sessions that should be
included in a PR program. However,
published professional guidelines
generally recommend ranges, typically 2
or 3 sessions per week over a period of
12 to 18 weeks for maximum
physiological benefits. This equates to a
range of approximately 24 to 54 sessions
in total; the mean is 39 sessions. Since
the primary goal of PR is to facilitate
and encourage independent exercise at
home, we believe coverage of 36
sessions in the facility setting is
appropriate. Further, the current NCD
(20.10) for cardiac rehabilitation allows
for initial coverage of up to 36 sessions.
Since the goals and objectives of these
two programs are similar with respect to
the patients’ ability to achieve selfmanagement of their diseases, we
believe those limits are appropriate
here. Therefore, we are proposing to
allow up to 36 sessions for services
provided in connection with a PR
program. Patients should generally
receive 2 to 3 sessions per week, which
are a minimum of 60 minutes each. We
propose to allow no more than one
session per day, since these
beneficiaries have significant respiratory
compromise and would not typically be
capable of doing more than one aerobic
exercise session. We are especially
interested in comments regarding the
proposed optimal number of sessions,
while acknowledging that each
individual has a different degree of
need.
(12) Other Items and Services
The MIPPA allows the inclusion of
additional items and services as
required elements of a PR program,
under certain specific conditions. We
are not proposing any additional items
and services at the present time. We
may consider the addition of other items
and services through future rulemaking.
d. Coding
We are proposing to create one
HCPCS code to describe and to bill for
the services of a PR program as specified
PO 00000
Frm 00096
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
in section 144(a) of the MIPPA, GXX30,
Pulmonary rehabilitation, including
aerobic exercise (includes monitoring),
per session per day. This G-code is to
be billed when the patient performs
physician-prescribed aerobic exercises
that are targeted to improve the patient’s
physical functioning and may also
include the other aspects of pulmonary
rehabilitation, such as education and
training. Because the physician’s role in
the PR program is defined in a similar
manner to that in the cardiac
rehabilitation program, we believe that
the physician work component should
be analogous to that of CPT code 93797,
cardiac rehab without telemetry.
Therefore we are proposing work RVUs
of 0.18 RVUs for this new G-code. Using
this same reference code, we are
proposing that the malpractice RVUs be
0.01 RVUs.
To establish the PE RVU payment for
the proposed new PR G-code, we
reviewed the PE inputs of similar
services, particularly those of the
respiratory therapy HCPCS codes,
G0237 and G0238, as well as the cardiac
rehabilitation codes, CPT codes 93797
and 93798. Given the various
individuals, acting under the
supervision of a physician, can make up
the PR multidisciplinary team, we
believe that the clinical labor for the PR
G-code can be best represented by the
following labor types taken from the PE
database: The nurse ‘‘blend’’ (RN/LPN/
MTA), the respiratory therapist (RT), the
social worker/psychologist and the
medical/technical assistant—which we
selected to represent various specialists
involved in furnishing this service;
these are valued at $0.37, $0.42, $0.45,
and $0.26 per minute, respectively.
Using an average of these values, $0.375
per minute, we are proposing to use the
nurse blend labor type found in the
cardiac rehabilitation CPT codes, at
$0.37 per minute, as the typical value
for the PR clinical labor and assigning
28 minutes of clinical labor time for the
new PR G-code based on the various
components of the proposed PR
program.
For the equipment PE inputs, we
reviewed the direct PE inputs for similar
existing codes and are proposing a pulse
oximeter (with printer), a 1-channel
ECG, and a treadmill. Since no typical
supplies were listed for similar existing
codes in the PE database, we have not
proposed any specific supplies for this
proposed new G-code.
10. Section 152(b): Coverage of Kidney
Disease Patient Education Services
Section 152(b) of the MIPPA provides
for coverage of kidney disease education
(KDE) services for patients. The
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
following is an outline of our proposals
to implement the statutory amendments.
a. Background
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
The kidneys have several life-sustaining
functions. Waste and excess fluid is
removed by the kidney through
filtration and the concentration of salt
and minerals in the blood is maintained.
Additionally, the kidneys help regulate
blood pressure, are involved in the
process of red blood cell production,
and are needed for bone health. When
kidneys are damaged, these functions
are impaired.
Kidney damage can occur for a variety
of reasons and may develop quickly
(acute renal failure) or slowly. By
definition, chronic kidney disease
(CKD) is kidney damage for 3 months or
longer, regardless of the cause of kidney
damage. CKD typically evolves over a
long period of time and patients may
not have symptoms until significant,
possibly irreversible, damage has been
done. Complications can develop from
kidneys that do not function properly,
such as high blood pressure, anemia,
and weak bones.
When CKD progresses, it may lead to
kidney failure, which requires artificial
means to perform kidney functions (that
is, dialysis) or a kidney transplant to
maintain life. There are tests to help
detect kidney disease. Currently, the
most important measurement of kidney
function is called glomerular filtration
rate (GFR) and is a measure of how
quickly blood is filtered through the
kidney’s filter, which is called the
glomeruli.
Patients can be classified into 5 stages
based on their GFR, with Stage 1 having
kidney damage with normal or
increased GFR to stage 5 with kidney
failure, also called end-stage renal
disease (ESRD). Once patients with CKD
are identified, treatment is available to
help prevent complications of decreased
kidney function, slow the progression of
kidney disease, and reduce the risk of
other diseases such as heart disease.
While predicting the timing of
progression from stage IV CKD to kidney
failure is difficult due to the lack of
data, anticipatory objective information
for the stage IV CKD patient is critical
for management of comorbidities,
prevention of uremic complications,
and informed decision-making about
renal replacement options and their
respective benefits and risks. Collins
notes from United States Renal Data
System (USRDS) data from 2007 that
‘‘despite the large number of patients
with varying stages of CKD, only
approximately 100,000 reach end-stage
renal disease (ESRD) annually in the
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
United States.’’ 6 CKD primarily affects
the elderly and commonly coexists with
other chronic diseases including
hypertension, diabetes, and
cardiovascular disease. Consequently,
the risk of mortality and morbidity are
increased substantially with advancing
CKD stages.
Individuals with CKD may benefit
from educational interventions due to
the large amount of medical information
that could affect patient outcomes
including the increasing emphasis on
self-care and patients’ desire for
informed, autonomous decision-making.
There is evidence that many pre-dialysis
patients lack knowledge about their
condition and may develop a sense of
despair regarding their condition. Predialysis education can help patients
achieve better understanding of their
illness, dialysis modality options, and
may help delay the need for dialysis.
Education interventions should be
patient-centered, encourage
collaboration, offer support to the
patient, and be delivered consistently.
b. Statutory Authority
Section 152(b) of the MIPPA amended
section 1861(s)(2) of the Act by adding
a new subparagraph (EE) ‘‘kidney
disease education services’’ as a
Medicare-covered benefit under Part B.
This new benefit is available for
Medicare beneficiaries diagnosed with
Stage IV CKD, who in accordance with
accepted clinical guidelines identified
by the Secretary, will require dialysis or
a kidney transplant. KDE services will
be designed to provide comprehensive
information regarding:
• The management of comorbidities,
including delaying the need for dialysis;
• Prevention of uremic
complications;
• Options for renal replacement
therapy (including hemodialysis and
peritoneal dialysis, at home and incenter, as well as vascular access
options and transplantation);
• Ensuring that the beneficiary has
the opportunity to actively participate
in his or her choice of therapy; and
• Tailored to meet the needs of the
beneficiary involved.
c. Public Meetings
Section 1861(ggg)(3), as added by
section 152(b) of the MIPPA, requires
that the Secretary set standards for the
content of the KDE services after
consulting with various stakeholders,
who to the extent possible, had not
6 Collins AJ, et al. ‘‘Who Should be Targeted for
CKD Screening? Impact of Diabetes, Hypertension,
and Cardiovascular Disease.’’ American Journal of
Kidney Diseases, Vol 53, No 3, Suppl 3 (March),
2009: pg. S71.
PO 00000
Frm 00097
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33615
received industry funding from a drug
or biological manufacturer or dialysis
facility. On November 6, 2008, and
December 16, 2008, we held two
feedback sessions to solicit stakeholder
comments regarding the implementation
of section 152(b) of the MIPPA. Both
feedback sessions were open to the
public. In addition to the feedback
sessions, we conducted an internal
review of the available medical
evidence, literature, and currently
available CKD patient education
programs. Transcripts from both events
are available on the CMS Web site at
https://www.cms.hhs.gov/
CoverageGenInfo/
08_CKD.asp#TopOfPage.
(1) The November 6, 2008 Feedback
Session
The first feedback session was
conducted as a Special Open Door
Forum (ODF) at the CMS Headquarters
on November 6, 2008. Approximately
200 people, representing approximately
70 organizations, participated via
teleconference.
The majority of stakeholders cited the
National Kidney Foundation Disease
Outcomes Quality Initiative (NKF
KDOQI) guidelines that define Stage IV
CKD as a GFR measurement of 15–29
ml/min/1.73m2, for purposes of
classification and evaluation of CKD.
Stakeholders recommended a variety of
modalities for providing education
services. One-on-one sessions between
the educator and the patient were
recommended to facilitate
comprehension of the information.
Stakeholders indicated that diagnoses of
CKD can be devastating for some
patients and patient outbursts, crying,
and other disruptions can derail the
educational process for large groups.
Since all patients do not have the same
learning styles or need for information,
one stakeholder recommended that each
individual be assessed by the treating
physician or nonphysician practitioner
(NPP) under the supervision of the
treating physician for their learning
needs and style preferences before or
upon referral for KDE services.
Some stakeholders suggested that
group education sessions would be
appropriate and beneficial for patients,
but did not comment specifically on the
applicability to the Medicare
population. Stakeholders reported that
within existing programs, patients were
going through a shared experience and
group sessions helped facilitate
discussion. Other stakeholders
recommended that initial education
sessions be performed in a group
setting, with one-on-one follow-up
sessions. We received recommendations
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33616
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
regarding session length from 15
minutes to 2 hours, or as long as
deemed necessary by the educator or the
patient.
Some stakeholders recommended
against using the Web or telemedicine
since these modalities may not be
appropriate or facilitate effective
comprehension of material in older
adults. Other stakeholders indicated
that we needed to keep in mind that a
patient’s uremia may impair
comprehension of the materials, that
these patients are sick, and that the
elderly often need to have information
provided in a simplistic, repetitive
manner.
Regarding the clinically appropriate
topics and content standards for KDE
services, various stakeholders indicated
that the following information should be
included in the curriculum:
• Basic overview of kidney functions
and CKD pathophysiology.
• Survival rates based on choice of
treatment or if the patient declines
treatment.
• Quality of life and psychosocial
adjustments.
• Structured, unbiased, uniform
information about all renal replacement
modalities, with no appropriateness
assumptions presented by the educator.
• The right to decline treatment.
• Evidence-based content.
• Prolonging remaining kidney
function.
• Patient participation in
management of kidney disease.
• Sexuality and fertility issues.
• Transplant options.
• Smoking cessation.
• Medication compliance.
• Financial support and insurance
coverage.
• Diet and exercise.
• Vocational rehabilitation.
• Treatment and management of
comorbidities.
(2) The December 16, 2008 Feedback
Session
On December 16, 2008, the second
feedback session was hosted at the
Agency for Healthcare Research and
Quality (AHRQ). Approximately 60
people representing approximately 40
organizations participated. In preparing
for this meeting, we researched and
developed a list of approximately 30
experts and educators that are currently
providing kidney disease education to
individuals or treating patients with
CKD, only 10 of which were able to
participate. To accommodate those
stakeholders that were unable to attend
the AHRQ stakeholders meeting, we
accepted additional feedback at the
following e-mail address:
CKDEducation@cms.hhs.gov.
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
We asked each meeting attendee to fill
out a disclosure statement that
described any industry funding he or
she had received from a drug/biological
manufacturer or dialysis facilities, since
the MIPPA requested that we consult
with various stakeholders, to the extent
possible, that had not received such
industry funding. The majority of the
meeting participants or the
organizations represented had received
industry funding with few exceptions.
When asked about the accepted
clinical criteria for classifying someone
with Stage IV CKD, most stakeholders
stated that Stage IV CKD is best defined
as an individual with an estimated GFR
of between 15 and 29 or 30 ml/min/
1.73m2. One stakeholder suggested that
to decrease variability between
creatinine methodologies, they
recommended using a laboratory that
traces its serum creatinine technique to
IDMS (Isotope dilution mass
spectrometry reference measurement
procedure). This stakeholder also
indicated that the MDRD (modification
of diet in renal disease) study equation
has been slightly modified to account
for labs that are traceable to IDMS.
We asked the stakeholders to report
on the different modalities of education
that would be appropriate for kidney
disease patient education. One
stakeholder indicated that
considerations need to be made
regarding the educational needs of
different communities and cultures.
Several stakeholders indicated that faceto-face or group sessions are the
preferred modalities for providing
education services. One stakeholder
indicated that groups larger than 20 may
make it harder for all participants to ask
questions. Stakeholders recommended
that we allow flexibility to balance the
needs of individual CKD patients that
have varying degrees of need for
information and education. Several
stakeholders indicated that curriculum
content should include information
regarding all renal replacement therapy
options (including no treatment),
vascular access options, available
support services, and management of
co-morbidities including diabetes, blood
pressure management, bone disease, and
mineral metabolism.
Stakeholders recommended numerous
frequency and duration combinations.
One stakeholder recommended a variety
of combinations of six 1-hour classroom
group sessions including one session
per week (over a 6-week period); six
sessions over a weekend (3 sessions on
Saturday; 3 sessions on Sunday); or all
6 sessions on 1 day during a weekend.
This stakeholder also recommended that
sessions should be standardized so that
PO 00000
Frm 00098
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
an individual can take sessions when
they are offered to meet their scheduling
needs. Stakeholders recommended
sessions that lasted between 15 minutes
and 2.5 hours. One stakeholder
indicated that pre- and post-assessments
should be included as part of the
education programs.
When asked what factors in existing
education programs have led to the best
patient outcomes, we received a variety
of responses such as varying the training
format, providing information
repetitively, and presenting information
at the appropriate reading level for the
audience. Stakeholders recommended
that all aspects of the education services
be provided in an objective and neutral
manner, not skewing the information
toward one or more renal replacement
therapy modalities.
d. Implementation
Consistent with section 1861(ggg) of
the Act, we are proposing to amend 42
CFR part 410 to add new § 410.48 for
KDE services as a Medicare Part B
benefit.
(1) Definitions (proposed § 410.48(a))
As related to the implementation of
section 1861(ggg) of the Act, we are
proposing the following definitions in
§ 410.48:
• Kidney Disease Patient Education
Services: Consistent with section
1861(ggg)(1) of the Act, we are
proposing to define Kidney Disease
Patient Education Services as face-toface educational services provided to
patients with Stage IV CKD. We are
proposing that the services be provided
in a face-to-face manner based on
stakeholder feedback received during
the consultation meetings and our
general rulemaking authority. Face-toface education is consistent with
sections 1861(ggg)(C)(ii) and (iii) of the
Act, which provide that the services
should be designed to ensure that the
beneficiary has the opportunity to
actively participate in the choice of
therapy, and that the services be
designed to be tailored to meet the
needs of the beneficiary involved.
Some stakeholders recommended that
sessions be conducted face-to-face due
to varying patient literacy levels. Other
stakeholders recommended against
using Web-based education resources
since the elderly may not be as
comfortable with or lack access to the
Internet. In light of these considerations,
we believe that face-to-face education
services are the most appropriate means
for providing these services.
• Physician: For purposes of KDE
services, a physician will be defined
using the definition in section 1861(r)(1)
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
of the Act; it defines ‘‘physician’’ as ‘‘a
doctor of medicine or osteopathy legally
authorized to practice medicine and
surgery by the State in which he or she
performs such function or action
(including a physician within the
meaning of section 1101(a)(7) [of the
Act].’’
• Qualified Person: Consistent with
section 1861(ggg)(2)(A) of the Act, for
purposes of KDE services, we are
proposing to define a ‘‘qualified person’’
as a physician (as defined in section
1861(r)(1) of the Act); a physician
assistant, nurse practitioner, or clinical
nurse specialist (as defined in section
1861(aa)(5) of the Act, and implemented
in § 410.74, § 410.75, and § 410.76 of
this subpart). A provider of services
located in a rural area is also included
in the statute’s definition of a qualified
person. Section 1861(u) of the Act
defines ‘‘provider of services’’ to be ‘‘a
hospital, critical access hospital, skilled
nursing facility, comprehensive
outpatient rehabilitation facility, home
health agency, hospice program or, for
purposes of sections 1814(g) and section
1835(e) [of the Act], a fund’’. We are
proposing to define a ‘‘qualified person’’
to include a provider of services located
in a rural area and would include each
of these healthcare entities except for a
‘‘fund.’’
We do not believe that it would be
appropriate to recognize a fund
described by sections 1814(g) and
1835(e) of the Act as a ‘‘qualified
person’’. These funds are defined as
providers of services only for the
limited purpose of paying for the
services of faculty physicians when they
furnish certain services under the
authority of sections 1814(g) and
1835(e) of the Act. These funds are not
licensed as hospitals; they do not bill
Medicare and do not receive payment.
Moreover, these funds do not comply
with Medicare conditions of
participation and do not have provider
agreements with Medicare. Because we
do not believe that it would be
appropriate to include ‘‘funds’’ in the
definition of a ‘‘qualified person’’ for
purposes of the KDE benefit, we are
proposing to exclude funds described by
sections 1814(g) and section 1835(e) of
the Act from our definition of a provider
of services located in a rural area as
defined in section 1886(d)(2)(D) of the
Act.
In order for a provider of services to
be a ‘‘qualified person,’’ the entity must
be located in a rural area. We are
proposing to include in the definition of
a ‘‘qualified person’’, only those
hospitals, critical access hospitals
(CAHs), skilled nursing facilities (SNFs),
comprehensive outpatient rehabilitation
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
facilities (CORFs), home health agencies
(HHAs), and hospice programs that are
located in a rural area under section
1886(d)(2)(D) of the Act (as defined in
our regulations at § 412.64(b)(ii)(C)) and
to include hospitals and CAHs that are
reclassified from urban to rural status
pursuant to section 1886(d)(8)(E) of the
Act, as defined in § 412.103.
Specifically, § 412.64(b)(ii)(C) defines
‘‘rural’’ to mean any area outside an
urban area, which § 412.64(b)(ii)(A)
defines as a metropolitan statistical area
(MSA) as defined by the President’s
Office of Management and Budget
(OMB). Therefore, we believe that a
hospital, CAH, SNF, CORF, HHA, or
hospice program that is not physically
located in an MSA should be considered
‘‘rural’’ for this benefit.
Section 1886(d)(8)(E) of the Act,
implemented in § 412.103, requires us
to treat hospitals that meet specified
criteria as geographically rural under
section 1886(d)(2)(D) of the Act even
though they are physically located in an
MSA. Because the statute identifies
these hospitals as rural, we believe that
it is appropriate to consider these
hospitals a qualified person for
purposes of the KDE benefit. The
Conditions of Participation for CAHs in
§ 485.610 also include a provision to
allow a hospital located in an urban area
to reclassify as rural for purposes of
becoming a CAH through section
1886(d)(8)(E) of the Act, as defined in
§ 412.103. Because a hospital or CAH
specified under section 1886(d)(8)(E) of
the Act is treated as being located in a
rural area under section 1886(d)(2)(D) of
the Act, we are proposing to recognize
those hospitals or CAHs as a ‘‘qualified
person’’ for purposes of the KDE benefit.
• Renal Dialysis Facility: The
Congress has provided in section
1861(ggg)(2)(B) of the Act that a ‘‘renal
dialysis facility’’ may not be a ‘‘qualified
person.’’ We are defining this term,
consistent with § 405.2102 of this title,
as ‘‘a unit which is approved to furnish
dialysis service(s) directly to ESRD
patients.’’
• Stage IV Chronic Kidney Disease:
Section 1861(ggg)(1)(A) of the Act states
that KDE services shall be furnished to
beneficiaries diagnosed with Stage IV
CKD, who according to accepted clinical
guidelines identified by the Secretary,
will require dialysis or a kidney
transplant. Based on stakeholder
feedback, we are proposing to define
Stage IV CKD as kidney damage with a
severe decrease in GFR quantitatively
defined by a GFR value of 15–29 ml/
min/1.73 m2, using the Modification of
Diet in Renal Disease (MDRD) Study
PO 00000
Frm 00099
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33617
formula.7 Because there are currently no
agreed upon accepted clinical
guidelines that describe the stage IV
patients who would eventually require
dialysis or a kidney transplant, we are
proposing to cover all stage IV patients.
During both the November 6, 2008,
and the December 16, 2008 feedback
sessions, the majority of stakeholders
indicated that Stage IV CKD is currently
determined as kidney damage with a
severe decrease in the estimated GFR
value (15 to 29 mL/min/1.73 m2). While
there appeared to be agreement among
the stakeholders regarding the estimated
GFR values for the diagnosis of Stage IV
CKD, some stakeholders indicated that
only using the estimated GFR value to
determine the severity of a beneficiary’s
CKD may be insufficient. To decrease
variability between creatinine
methodologies, stakeholders
recommended using a laboratory that
traces its serum creatinine technique to
IDMS and that the MDRD study
equation has been slightly modified to
account for labs that are traceable to
IDMS.
(2) Covered Beneficiaries (Proposed
§ 410.48(b))
Consistent with section
1861(ggg)(1)(A) of the Act, we are
proposing that KDE services be
furnished to beneficiaries with Stage IV
CKD based on the definition of Stage IV
CKD defined in proposed § 410.48(a),
and have been referred for such services
by the physician managing the
beneficiary’s kidney condition.
(3) Standards for Qualified Persons and
Exclusions (Proposed § 410.48(c))
We are proposing to require that a
qualified person be able to properly
receive Medicare payment under 42
CFR part 424 (Conditions for Medicare
Payment). In § 410.48(c), we are
proposing to establish exclusions from
the term ‘‘qualified person.’’ Consistent
with section 1861(ggg)(2)(B) of the Act,
we specifically exclude a hospital, CAH,
SNF, CORF, HHA, or hospice that is
physically located outside of a rural area
under § 412.64(b)(ii)(C), except for a
hospital or CAH that is treated as being
located in a rural area under § 412.103.
In addition, consistent with section
1861(ggg)(2)(B) of the Act, a renal
dialysis facility is not a qualified
person.
While we are not proposing specific
education, experience, training, and/or
certification requirements at this time,
7 Levey, A.S., Greene, T., Kusek, J., and Beck,
G.A. J Am Soc Nephrol. 2000. 11: p. 155A.; Levey,
A.S., Bosch, J.P., Lewis, J.B., Greene, T., Rogers, N.,
and Roth, D. Ann Intern Med. 1999 Mar 16;
130(6):461–70.
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33618
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
we are specifically seeking public
comments on the appropriate level of
education, experience, training, and/or
certification appropriate for a qualified
person to effectively provide KDE
services and may provide such
provisions in the final issuance of this
rule or in future rulemaking. Factors to
consider include specific education and
expertise regarding the topic and ability
to explain these areas for the purpose of
patient education:
• General kidney physiology and test
results that would be associated with
CKD.
• Psychological impact of the disease
on the beneficiary, and impact on
family, social life, work, and finances.
• The management of comorbidities
(such as cardiovascular disease,
diabetes, hypertension, anemia, bone
disease, and impairments in
functioning) common in persons
diagnosed with CKD.
• Renal replacement therapeutic
options, treatment modalities and
settings, and advantages and
disadvantages of each treatment option.
• Diet, fluid restrictions, and
medication usage to include side effects
and informed decisionmaking.
• Encouragement of patient active
participation in decisionmaking and the
ability to tailor educational needs to the
individual beneficiary.
• Other areas of health deemed
important to patients with CKD.
(4) Standards for Content of Kidney
Disease Patient Education Services
(Proposed § 410.48(d))
We believe that patient education
needs vary by severity of the disease,
the age of the patient, the patient’s
comorbid conditions and disabilities,
the patient’s primary language and
culture, and desire to learn more about
the disease and treatment options.
Education services are more effective if
the services are tailored to meet an
individual beneficiary’s needs. We are
proposing that KDE services include the
content as specified in proposed
§ 410.48(d). According to an article by
Paula Ormandy 8 in the Journal of Renal
Care, patients are most interested in
receiving information on the following
topics, which was echoed by many
stakeholders during the feedback
sessions.
• Basic information regarding CKD,
how the kidneys work, what happens
when the kidneys fail, and the
permanence of the disease.
• Survival rates with and without
renal replacement therapy and survival
8 Ormandy, P., ‘‘Information Topics Important to
Chronic Kidney Disease Patients: A Systematic
Review.’’ Journal of Renal Care 34(1), 19–27, 2008.
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
rates if the patient refused treatment for
their CKD.
• The need for kidney
transplantation.
• Unbiased information about renal
replacement therapy (RRT) options
including advantages and disadvantages
for all modalities.
• Adequate information regarding
why some RRT options were not viable
for a patient.
• How different RRT options affected
the patient’s co-morbid conditions.
• Effect of RRT choices on lifestyle,
such as treatment flexibility and
treatment session length.
• Whether a patient will need
assistance based on RRT modality
choice and training requirements for
helpers.
• The right to refuse treatment.
• Effects of the disease, and the
subsequent treatment, on the patient’s
physical appearance.
• Patient recognition of the symptoms
that would empower the patient with
the knowledge to seek help.
• Disease and treatment
complications related to renal
replacement therapy such as
hypertension, catheter migration,
temporary/permanent loss of dialysis
access, and risk of infection at the
access sight.
• How to control and manage
consequences of complications and
symptoms (for example: treatment for
itchy skin or insomnia).
• The ability to travel and organize
holidays depending on RRT choice.
• Maintenance of social relationships,
activities, and commitments.
• How the disease and RRT may
affect the patient’s ability to continue
working.
• Available support services.
• Medication management, including
side effects and risks related to noncompliance to prescribed medication
regimen.
(5) Session Specifications (Proposed
§ 410.48(e))
(a) Limitations on the number of
sessions: Consistent with section
1861(ggg)(4) of the Act, we will limit the
number of KDE sessions to six (6).
(b) Session Length: In the absence of
supporting evidence for session length,
we are proposing to define the session
length as 60 minutes which coincides
with the session length of some
programs in existence and is the
approximate average of stakeholder
suggested session lengths.
(c) Individual and Group Session
Format: Consistent with section
1861(ggg)(C)(iii) of the Act, we are
proposing that the qualified person
PO 00000
Frm 00100
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
tailor the design of the education
services to meet the needs of the
beneficiary based on whether the
beneficiary needs more individualized
education, would benefit more from a
group environment, or a combination;
and consider any communication
accessibility needs based on disability,
language and health literacy.
During the feedback sessions, we
received a variety of recommendations
regarding how education services
should be provided, including a
combination of group sessions, one-onone sessions, and multi-media
presentations. Stakeholders
recommended that one-on-one sessions,
between the beneficiary and the
educator, facilitated quicker
comprehension of the education
materials than group sessions, and
provided the best opportunity to tailor
the sessions to meet the patient’s needs.
Other stakeholders indicated that group
sessions provide patients with the
benefit of responses to questions posed
by different group participants.
Medical services, generally speaking,
are provided to beneficiaries on an
individual basis. Beneficiaries can also
benefit from the interaction in a group
setting. We believe that the beneficiary,
in consultation with the referring
physician, will be able to best determine
the education services modality that
most effectively meets his or her needs.
(6) Outcomes Assessment
The intent of the education services is
for the beneficiary to take the
information he or she has learned
during the educational sessions in order
to facilitate active participation by the
beneficiary in the healthcare
decisionmaking process with the
physician managing his or her kidney
condition. We believe that it is
important that beneficiaries be assessed
at the conclusion of the education
sessions and are proposing that program
assessments be used by the educators
and CMS to assess the effectiveness of
the education services, to help improve
the programs for future participants, and
better facilitate patient understanding of
the material.
During the AHRQ stakeholders
meeting, various stakeholders indicated
that it was important to monitor the
effectiveness of the education services
to improve the content and delivery of
KDE services. Assessing the
effectiveness of the KDE services
through assessments can be an effective
way of measuring how beneficiary
needs are being met. Some existing
education programs have pre- and posteducation session assessments and are
usually administered immediately
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
following the conclusion of the
education sessions.
We are proposing, based on
stakeholder feedback and our general
rulemaking authority, that qualified
persons develop outcomes assessments
and that each beneficiary be assessed
during one of the education sessions.
We are proposing that the outcomes
assessment measure beneficiary
knowledge about CKD and its treatment
for the purpose, and as a contributor to,
the beneficiary’s ability to make
informed decisions regarding their
healthcare and treatment options.
According to an article by Gerald
Devins in the Journal of Clinical
Epidemiology, an outcomes assessment
or test should be able to ‘‘measure the
adaptive value of ESRD-related
knowledge as a contributor to
psychosocial and physical well-being,
* * * reliably and validly assess patient
knowledge about ESRD and its
treatment,’’ * * * ‘‘be easy to
administer and score,’’ and * * *
‘‘require only basic reading skills.’’ 9
After completing the KDE services,
the beneficiary should be able to take
the information learned and use it to
make informed choices about their
healthcare during future consultations
with the physician managing the
beneficiary’s kidney condition. It is
important that the assessments be
tailored to the beneficiary’s reading
level and language if the assessment is
not administered by the qualified
person that provided the education
services, and be made available to CMS
in a summarized format upon request.
We are specifically seeking public
comments regarding the development
and administration of the outcomes
assessments. Factors to consider
include:
• Specific topics that should be
included as part of the assessment;
• Whether standardization of the
outcomes assessment is feasible and/or
should be considered;
• The applicability of any
standardized assessments that may
currently be in existence;
• The feasibility of providing both
pre- and post-education assessments;
and
• Methods for collecting assessments
and disseminating best practices for
KDE services.
e. Payment for KDE Services
Section 152(b) of the MIPPA creates a
new benefit category for KDE services.
9 Devins, G., et al. ‘‘The Kidney Disease
Questionnaire: A Test for Measuring Patient
Knowledge about End-Stage Renal Disease.’’ J Clin
Epidemiol. Vol. 43, No. 3. pp. 297–307, 1990.
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
The MIPPA amends section 1848(j)(3) of
the Act, which allows for payment of
KDE services under the PFS. KDE
services are covered when they are
furnished by a qualified person as
defined in proposed § 410.48(a) and that
meets the requirements of proposed
§ 410.48(c). We note that there is a
possibility that a beneficiary may
receive services from more than one
‘‘qualified person’’; however, payment
should be made to only one qualified
person on the same day for the same
beneficiary.
The ‘‘incident to’’ requirements for
physician services at section
1861(s)(2)(A) of the Act do not apply to
KDE services because the MIPPA
requirements are explicit, in that the
education services must be provided by
a qualified person, which is defined as
a physician, nurse practitioner, clinical
nurse specialist or physician assistant,
and also includes a provider of services
located in a rural area. In the past, we
have taken the position that the
‘‘incident to’’ provision does not apply
to the implementation of a new service
with a distinct benefit category under
the PFS. Therefore, the ‘‘incident to’’
requirements will not apply to KDE
services.
Rural health clinics (RHCs) do not
meet the statutory definition of a
provider of services (as defined in
1861(u) of the Act) and cannot be
separately paid for furnishing KDE
services.
Section 1861(ggg)(4) of the Act limits
the number of KDE services that a
beneficiary may receive to six sessions.
We are proposing to create two HCPCS
codes, GXX26 (individual) and GXX27
(group), to describe and to bill for KDE
services. The two G-codes consist of 1hour face-to-face KDE services for an
individual or group. We are proposing
to pay both GXX26 and GXX27 at the
nonfacility rate. We are also proposing
that GXX26 educational services related
to the care of chronic kidney disease;
individual per session will be
crosswalked to CPT code 97802; and
that GXX27, educational services related
to the care of chronic kidney disease;
group, per session will be crosswalked
to CPT code 97804. The rationale for the
proposed pricing of the G-codes is based
on the similarity of this service to
medical nutrition therapy in the
individual (97802) and group (97804)
setting.
In the CY 2010 OPPS/ASC proposed
rule, we discuss our proposed payment
for KDE to qualified persons who are
hospitals, CAHs, SNFs, CORFs, HHAs,
or hospices. Commenters should submit
specific comments on our payment
proposal for this benefit, including the
PO 00000
Frm 00101
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33619
method and amount of payment, for
qualified hospitals, CAHs, SNFs,
CORFs, HHAs, or hospices in response
to the CY 2010 OPPS/ASC proposed
rule. We will discuss our final payment
policy for these qualified providers in
the CY 2010 OPPS/ASC Final Rule.
f. Effective Date
Medicare Part B coverage of
outpatient kidney disease patient
education services will be effective for
services furnished on or after January 1,
2010.
11. Section 153: Renal Dialysis
Provisions
Section 153 of the MIPPA requires
changes to ESRD facilities for ESRD
services effective January 1, 2010. The
following is a summary of these
changes.
Section 153(a)(1) of the MIPPA
increases the current ESRD composite
rate by 1.0 percent for services
furnished on or after January 1, 2010.
This also requires us to update the
adjusted drug add-on. Since we
compute the drug add-on adjustment as
a percentage of the composite rate, the
drug add-on percentage is decreased to
account for the higher CY 2010
composite payment rate and results in a
15.0 percent drug add-on adjustment for
CY 2010. As a result, the drug add-on
amount of $20.33 per treatment remains
the same for CY 2010, which results in
a 15.0 percent increase to the base
composite payment rate of $135.15. (See
section II.I.6. of this proposed rule for
further discussion.)
The composite rate paid to hospitalbased facilities will be the same as the
composite rate paid to independent
renal dialysis facilities for services
furnished on or after January 1, 2010. In
addition, section 153(a)(2) of the MIPPA
requires that in applying the geographic
index to hospital-based facilities, the
labor share shall be based on the labor
share otherwise applied for renal
dialysis facilities.
These MIPPA provisions are selfimplementing and require no
substantive exercise of discretion on the
part of the Secretary. A detailed
discussion of the MIPPA provisions can
be found in section III. of the CY 2009
PFS final rule with comment period (73
FR 69881).
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33620
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
12. Section 182(b): Revision of
Definition of Medically-Accepted
Indication for Drugs; Compendia for
Determination of Medically-Accepted
Indications for Off-Label Uses of Drugs
and Biologicals in an Anti-cancer
Chemotherapeutic Regimen
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
a. Background
(1) Process for Revising the List of
Statutorily Named Compendia
Generally, compendia are
‘‘pharmacopeia providing information
on drugs, their effectiveness, safety,
toxicity, and dosing—are frequently
used to determine whether a medication
has a role in the treatment of a
particular disease; these roles include
both therapeutic uses approved by the
U.S. Food and Drug Administration
(FDA) and off-label indications’’
(Agency of Healthcare Research and
Quality (AHRQ), Potential Conflict of
Interest in the Production of Drug
Compendia White Paper).10 Compendia
are published by various institutions
and by traditional reference book
publishing houses.
Section 1861(t)(2)(B)(ii)(I) of the Act
lists the following compendia as
authoritative sources for use in the
determination of a ‘‘medically-accepted
indication’’ of drugs and biologicals
used off-label in an anticancer
chemotherapeutic regimen: American
Medical Association Drug Evaluations
(AMA–DE); United States
Pharmacopoeia-Drug Information (USP–
DI) or its successor publication; and
American Hospital Formulary ServiceDrug Information (AHFS–DI). Due to
changes in the pharmaceutical reference
industry, AHFS–DI is the only
statutorily-named compendium that is
currently in publication.
In addition to these compendia, the
statute provides an alternative method
for identifying medically-accepted offlabel uses of drugs and biologicals in an
anti-cancer chemotherapeutic regimen.
Section 1861(t)(2)(B)(ii)(II) of the Act
provides that local contractors may use
‘‘supportive clinical evidence in peerreviewed medical literature’’ to make
such determinations. Thus these
medically-accepted uses could be
identified even if there were no
compendia recognized for this purpose.
We discussed this in our response to
comments in the CY 2008 PFS final rule
with comment period (72 FR 66305).
Section 1861(t)(2)(B) of the Act
provides the Secretary the authority to
10 Agency for Healthcare Research and Quality.
White Paper: Potential Conflict of Interest in the
Production of Drug Compendia. (2009, April 27).
Available online at https://www.cms.hhs.gov/mcd/
viewtechassess.asp?from2=viewtechassess.asp&
where=index&tid=64.
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
revise the list of compendia in section
1861(t)(2)(B)(ii)(I) for determining
medically-accepted indications for offlabel use of drugs and biologicals in an
anti-cancer chemotherapeutic regimen.
Consequently, in § 414.930, we
established an annual process to revise
the list and establish a definition of
‘‘compendium’’ in the CY 2008 PFS
final rule with comment period (72 FR
66222, 66303 through 66306, and
66404).
On March 30, 2006, the Medicare
Evidence Development and Coverage
Advisory Committee or MEDCAC
(formerly the Medicare Coverage
Advisory Committee (MCAC)) met in
public session to advise CMS on the
appropriate criteria for the recognition
of compendia for the identification of
medically-accepted indications of drugs
and biologicals used in an anti-cancer
therapy, and the degree to which the
then listed and other available
compendia displayed those criteria. The
evidence the MEDCAC considered to
derive its recommendations included a
presentation of the technology
assessment (TA) performed for AHRQ
by staff of the Tufts-New England
Medical Center (Tufts-NEMC) and Duke
Evidence-based Practices Centers
(EPCs), scheduled stakeholder
presentations, as well as testimony from
members of the public. As is customary,
the MEDCAC panelists elicited
additional information from the
presenters and discussed the evidence
in preparation for a formal vote. The
MEDCAC recommended that the
following criteria, referred to as
‘‘desirable characteristics,’’ should be
used to recognize compendia for
identification of medically-accepted
indications of drugs and biologicals in
anti-cancer therapy:
• Extensive breadth of listings.
• Quick processing from application
for inclusion to listing.
• Detailed description of the evidence
reviewed for every individual listing.
• Use of pre-specified published
criteria for weighing evidence.
• Use of prescribed published process
for making recommendations.
• Publicly transparent process for
evaluating therapies.
• Explicit ‘‘Not recommended’’ listing
when validated evidence is appropriate.
• Explicit listing and
recommendations regarding therapies,
including sequential use or combination
in relation to other therapies.
• Explicit ‘‘Equivocal’’ listing when
validated evidence is equivocal.
• Process for public identification
and notification of potential conflicts of
interests of the compendia’s parent and
sibling organizations, reviewers, and
PO 00000
Frm 00102
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
committee members, with an
established procedure to manage
recognized conflicts.
We incorporated the MEDCAC
recommended desirable characteristics
into the compendia review process. All
information on this MEDCAC meeting
can be found on the CMS Web site at
https://www.cms.hhs.gov/mcd/
viewmcac.asp?where=index&mid=33.
Although we did not rank these ten
MEDCAC desirable characteristics, the
MEDCAC desirable characteristics that
addressed transparency and conflict of
interest of compendia were considered
to be of high priority (72 FR 66304
through 66305). In addition, we
considered the need to enhance
transparency in the compendia review
process to preserve the integrity of the
review process (72 FR 66222, 66303
through 66306, and 66404).
During the 2008 compendium review
cycle, we considered requests regarding
the following five compendia: The
AMA–DE Compendium; National
Comprehensive Cancer Network Drugs
and Biologics (NCCN) Compendium;
Thomson Micromedex DrugDex
Compendium; Thomson Micromedex
DrugPoints Compendium; and Clinical
Pharmacology Compendium. Our
decisions are posted on the CMS Web
site at https://www.cms.hhs.gov/
CoverageGenInfo/
02_compendia.asp#TopOfPage. In
summary, we issued the following
decisions regarding those compendia
requests:
• NCCN was added to the list of
compendia.
• Thomson Micromedex DrugDex
was added to the list of compendia.
• Clinical Pharmacology was added
to the list of compendia.
• Thomson Micromedex DrugPoints
was not added to the list of compendia.
• AMA–DE was removed from the list
of compendia.
(2) MIPPA Requirement for Compendia
Section 182(b) of the MIPPA amended
section 1861(t)(2)(B) of the Act (42
U.S.C. 1395x(t)(2)(B)) by adding the
sentence, ‘‘On and after January 1, 2010,
no compendia may be included on the
list of compendia under this
subparagraph unless the compendia has
a publicly transparent process for
evaluating therapies and for identifying
potential conflicts of interests.’’ There is
a growing body of literature, including
that from the Institute of Medicine
(IOM),11 that discusses the conflict of
interest between research funding and
11 Institute of Medicine. Conflict of Interest in
Medical Research, Education, and Practice.
Available online at https://www.nap.edu/
catalog.php?record_id=12598.
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
research results. Some authors have
stated that there is a conflict of interest
if an entity has a financial, legal, or
political interest that is
counterproductive to the performance of
their legal or ethical responsibilities.12
Although this widely discussed
correlation depicts a classic
representation of a financial conflict of
interest, we believe nonfinancial
conflicts of interests also deserve
attention. Nonfinancial conflicts of
interests have the potential to interfere
with honest reporting, transparency and
fair review of applications submitted to
compendia publishers.13 Therefore, in
light of such concerns, the existence of
financial and nonfinancial conflicts of
interests would threaten the impartiality
of the recommendations made in the
compendia. We believe that section
182(b) of the MIPPA, ‘‘Revision of
definition of medically-accepted
indication for drugs * * * Conflict of
Interest’’ is designed, in part, to address
this issue in the compendia review
process.
(3) Proposed Revisions of Compendia
Standards
We believe that the implementation of
this statutory provision that compendia
have a ‘‘publicly transparent process for
evaluating therapies and for identifying
potential conflicts of interests’’ is best
accomplished by amending the current
definition of a compendium at
§ 414.930(a) to include the MIPPA
requirements and by defining the key
components of publicly transparent
processes for evaluating therapies and
for identifying potential conflicts of
interests. In order to implement the
MIPPA requirements concerning a
publicly transparent process for
evaluating therapies, we propose that a
compendium could meet this standard
by publishing materials used in its
evaluation process on its Web site. This
mode of publication provides broad
contemporaneous public access to
relevant materials. We believe that
public access to such materials will
increase transparency of the process
used by compendia publishers for
evaluating therapies and facilitate
independent review of
recommendations by interested parties.
In addition, as discussed in the CY 2008
PFS final rule with comment period (72
FR 66305 through 66306), such
12 Resnik, D. (2007, April). Conflicts of Interest in
Scientific Research Related to Regulation and
Litigation. The Journal of Philosophy, Science &
Law. 7:1–16.
13 The PloS Medicine Editors. (2008, September).
Making Sense of Non-Financial Competing
Interests. PloS Medicine. 5(9):1299–1301, Retrieved
March 19, 2009 from https://www.plosmedicine.org.
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
disclosure may assist beneficiaries and
their physicians in choosing among
treatment options.
As expressed in the February 14, 2008
letter from the U.S. Senate Committee
on Finance to the CMS Acting
Administrator Kerry Weems, ‘‘conflicts
of interest have been proven in peerreviewed studies to have a significant
impact on scientific outcomes and
medical care.’’ 14 Since compendia
recommendations are generally
dependent on evidence from peerreviewed studies, we believe that
conflicts of interests may arise from
relationships between individuals who
substantively participate, such as
individuals who contribute more than a
clerical role, in the development of
compendia recommendations and the
applicants (for example, the
manufacturer or seller of the drug or
biological being reviewed by the
compendium) for the inclusion of drug
or biological recommendations in
compendia. These relationships may
involve, for example, publishers of
compendia and peer-reviewed journals,
their editorial or advisory boards, drug
manufacturers, physicians or providers
that derive income from the prescribing
or administration of drugs, researchers
that have a personal or academic
interest in the drug study, or others who
may provide incentives to influence the
prescribing behaviors of physicians.15
As illustrated in the AHRQ Potential
Conflict of Interest in the Production of
Drug Compendia White Paper, these
potential financial and nonfinancial
conflicts exist at the various stages of
the evaluation process. The White Paper
also describes compendia publication
users (for example, the public,
physicians, other caregivers, and public/
private insurers) and the objectives of
each user when referencing the
compendia. Therefore, these potential
financial and nonfinancial conflicts may
be problematic for users of the
compendia to rely on the validity of the
compendia recommendations.16
Section 182(b) of the MIPPA requires
a publicly transparent process for: (1)
Evaluating therapies, and (2) identifying
potential conflicts of interests. In light
14 United States Senate Committee on Finance
Correspondence. (2008, February 14). CMS Process
and Actions Concerning Approval of Anti-Cancer
Drug Compendia.
15 The PloS Medicine Editors. (2008, September).
Making Sense of Non-Financial Competing
Interests. PloS Medicine. 5(9):1299–1301, Retrieved
March 19, 2009 from https://www.plosmedicine.org.
16 Agency for Healthcare Research and Quality.
White Paper: Potential Conflict of Interest in the
Production of Drug Compendia. (2009, April 27).
Available online at https://www.cms.hhs.gov/mcd/
viewtechassess.asp?from2=viewtechassess.asp&
where=index&tid=64&.
PO 00000
Frm 00103
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33621
of these provisions, we are proposing
regulatory safeguards to require that the
publicly transparent process for
evaluating therapies and identifying
potential conflicts of interests include
disclosure of certain relevant
information. All currently listed
compendia will be required to comply
with these provisions, as of January 1,
2010, to remain on the list of recognized
compendia. We view compendia
publishers as generally responsible for
the integrity of their publications.
Therefore, we urge currently listed
compendia publishers to submit
evidence demonstrating compliance
with the MIPPA provisions that ‘‘no
compendia may be included on the list
of compendia’’ unless the compendium
has a publicly transparent process for
therapy evaluation and conflict of
interest identification to CMS no later
than December 31, 2009. In addition,
any compendium that is the subject of
a future request for inclusion on the list
of recognized compendia will be
required to comply with these
provisions. We believe that the statute is
clear that no compendium can be on the
list if it does not fully meet the standard
described in section 1861(t)(2)(B) of the
Act, as revised by section 182(b) of the
MIPPA.
b. Revisions to § 414.930, ‘‘Compendia
for Determination of MedicallyAccepted Indications for Off-Label Uses
of Drugs and Biologicals in an AntiCancer Chemotherapeutic Regimen’’
We are proposing the following
amendments to § 414.930(a):
• To revise the definition of
‘‘compendium’’ by adding an additional
requirement that a compendium have a
publicly transparent process for
evaluating therapies and for identifying
potential conflicts of interests.
• To add the definition of ‘‘publicly
transparent process’’ for evaluating
therapies. We propose that assurance of
a publicly transparent evaluation
process is best achieved by establishing
a process that provides for public
disclosure of the evidence considered
and the review of that evidence leading
to the development of compendia
recommendations.17 By providing for
this disclosure, we hope to ensure
validity in the use of compendia for
identifying medically-accepted uses of
off-label treatments for purposed of
section 1861(t)(2)(B) of the Act. Thus,
we believe that in the interest of
providing a publicly transparent process
17 Resnik, D. (2007, April). Conflicts of Interest in
Scientific Research Related to Regulation and
Litigation. The Journal of Philosophy, Science &
Law. 7:1–16.
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33622
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
for evaluating therapies and maximizing
that transparency, a compendium
should publish the complete application
for inclusion, exclusion, or deletion of
a therapy including criteria used to
evaluate the request, on its Web site. We
believe that in accordance with that
publicly transparent process, a
compendium should similarly publish
the names of the individuals who have
substantively participated in the
development of compendia
recommendations, along with
transcripts of meetings and records of
votes. This provides an opportunity for
the public to consider the process used
by the compendia in evaluating a
specific therapy and independently
reach conclusions about the adequacy of
the application in light of the
compendium’s final recommendation.
We request comments on the
requirement for publication of a
transcript and the suitability of other
alternatives such as minutes or other
documents.
• To add a definition regarding a
‘‘publicly transparent process for
identifying potential conflicts of
interests,’’ and clarify the essential
elements of such a process. We propose
that a publicly transparent process for
identifying potential conflicts of
interests is best demonstrated by a
process that requires public
transparency regarding the competing
financial and nonfinancial interests that
may give rise to such conflicts. Thus, we
believe that a compendium should have
a process for disclosing by publication
on its publicly accessible Web site,
certain information regarding potential
conflicts of interests associated with
individuals who are responsible for the
compendium’s recommendations as
well as their immediate family members
(as defined in § 411.351). A process for
providing disclosure of interests by
immediate family members is necessary
because such interests could represent
potentially competing financial conflicts
that could influence the review and
individuals responsible for the
compendium’s recommendations.18
We believe that the process for
identifying potential conflicts of
interests should include information
regarding ownership and investment
interests of those individuals who are
responsible for the compendium’s
recommendation. Such information
should include the names of those
entities with which the individual has
an ownership or investment
relationship (similar to those
relationships defined in § 411.354), the
nature and length of the relationships,
other financial relationships that may
derive fron either a direct or indirect
relationship (similar to thise
relationships identified in 42 CFR
411.354, and the significance (for
example, dollar value) of those
relationships. By requiring a process for
identification of such relationships, we
are providing a process for the public to
have access to information regarding
potential conflicts of interests. We
believe that information concerning the
value of financial relationships is
necessary because it would permit the
public to assess the degree of influence
that a relationship may have over an
individual’s decisions or judgments.19
We request comments on the suitability
of this process or whether the
compendia should prescribe its own
process. In addition, we request
comments specifically addressing
whether information regarding
immediate family members is necessary
for conflict of interest determinations.
We note that the publishers of the
four compendia that are currently
recognized for this purpose have already
adopted conflict of interest disclosure
policies that are similar to our proposal.
Though there are individual differences
among the publishers, we note that
these policies commonly include
publication on the compendia
publisher’s Web site of the name of the
individuals that participate in the
generation of the compendia
recommendation and the entity with
which there is a relationship, the nature
of the relationship (for example, salary,
ownership, grant support), and the
value of the relationship. Some include
this information as it relates to family
members of the individual.
Additional information with respect
to the conflict of interest policies of
those compendia we reviewed during
the 2008 review cycle can be found on
their Web sites. For the convenience of
the reader we have listed below the Web
sites where these policies may be found
for each of the four currently recognized
compendia.
• AHFS Drug Information: https://
www.ahfsdruginformation.com/
off_label/interest_disclosure.aspx.
• Thomson Micromedex DrugDex:
https://www.micromedex.com/about_us/
editorial/ed_ConflictofInterest.pdf.
• Gold Standard Clinical
Pharmacology: https://
18 The PloS Medicine Editors. (2008, September).
Making Sense of Non-Financial Competing
Interests. PloS Medicine. 5(9):1299-1301, Retrieved
March 19, 2009 from https://www.plosmedicine.org.
19 Resnik, D. (2007, April). Conflicts of Interest in
Scientific Research Related to Regulation and
Litigation. The Journal of Philosophy, Science &
Law. 7:1–16.
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00104
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
www.goldstandard.com/
editorial_conflict.html.
• The National Comprehensive
Cancer Network: https://www.nccn.org/
about/disclosure.asp?p=about.
In general, certain disclosure policies
of the compendia provide for public
disclosure of individuals involved in
the recommendation to ensure against
the appearance of potential conflicts of
interests. We believe that a publicly
transparent process which provides for
the identification of potential conflicts
of interest protects the interests of the
public, as well as those individuals who
participate in the compendia process.
Disclosures of conflicts of interests are
triggered by the recommendation
regarding the use of the drug or
biological rather than by the application
for the recommendation. Disclosures
published in conjunction with
compendia recommendation updates
should remain publicly viewable for a
reasonable period of time. Specifically,
we believe that the disclosures remain
available for a period of not less than 5
years. It is not uncommon that serious
questions about the use of a drug do not
arise until the drug has been used for
several years. Thus the relevance of
information regarding the development
of compendia recommendations may
not be recognized until several years
after the clinical use in question. We
believe that a period of 5 years is a
reasonable balance between the burden
of maintaining this information and the
public’s interest in timely access to this
information. We welcome comments
regarding whether or not a period of not
less than 5 years is an adequate
timeframe for this balance to occur.
We recognize that some individuals
may participate substantively in the
development of more than one
recommendation. For example, an
individual might participate in the
review of several drugs or biologicals for
a single compendia publisher. We
recognize that a single relationship may
present a significant conflict of interest
in some cases but not others. For
example, a process for disclosure by the
compendium publisher would be
required if an individual whose only
conflicted relationship arises from
significant income related to the use of
a particular drug for lung cancer
substantively participated in the
compendia review of that drug for lung
cancer or for a competitor treatment for
lung cancer. If that same individual
substantively participated in the
compendia review of a different drug for
a different disease, the compendia
publisher might determine that there is
no conflict of interest to disclose.
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
In § 414.930(b)(1), we are revising the
CMS process for listing compendia for
determining medically-accepted uses of
drugs and biologicals in anti-cancer
treatment to include consideration of a
compendium’s meeting of the regulatory
definitions. We are also proposing to
renumber the subparagraphs of
§ 414.930(b)(1) to accommodate this
change.
Current § 414.930(b)(2) gives CMS the
authority to generate an internal request
to revise the list of compendia at any
time.
H. Part B Drug Payment
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
1. Average Sales Price (ASP) Issues
a. Immunosuppressive Drugs Period of
Eligibility
Section 9335(c) of the Omnibus
Budget Reconciliation Act of 1986 (Pub.
L. 99–509) (OBRA ’86) added
subparagraph (J) to section 1861(s)(2) of
the Act to define a benefit category for
immunosuppressive drugs furnished to
an individual who receives an organ
transplant for which Medicare payment
is made, for a period not to exceed 1
year after the transplant procedure.
Coverage of these drugs under Medicare
Part B began January 1, 1987.
Section 13565 of the Omnibus Budget
Reconciliation Act of 1993 (Pub L. 103–
66) (OBRA ’93) amended section
1861(s)(2)(J) of the Act to specify that
the benefit category included
immunosuppressive drugs furnished:
During 1995, within 18 months after the
date of the transplant procedure; during
1996, within 24 months after the date of
the transplant procedure; during 1997,
within 30 months after the date of the
transplant procedure; and during any
year after 1997, within 36 months after
the date of the transplant procedure.
Beginning January 1, 2000, section 227
of the Medicare, Medicaid and SCHIP
Balanced Budget Refinement Act of
1999 (Pub. L. 106–113) (BBRA)
extended the benefit period to eligible
beneficiaries whose coverage for drugs
used in immunosuppressive therapy
expired during the calendar year.
Section 113 of the Medicare,
Medicaid and SCHIP Benefits
Improvement and Protection Act of
2000 (Pub. L. 106–554) (BIPA) revised
section 1861(s)(2)(J) of the Act to
eliminate the time limits for coverage of
prescription drugs used in
immunosuppressive therapy under the
Medicare program. Effective with
immunosuppressive drugs furnished to
an individual who receives an organ
transplant for which Medicare payment
is made on or after December 21, 2000,
there is no longer any time limit for
Medicare benefits. Although the
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
statutory benefit category no longer
includes a time limit, our regulations at
§ 410.30(b) continue to reflect the time
limits that applied previously.
Therefore, we are proposing to make
conforming changes to § 410.30(b) to
remove the references to the time limits
that applied under previous iterations of
the statute. This technical change will
reduce the potential for confusion about
the scope of the benefit. We note that
this proposal does not substantively
affect Medicare coverage or benefits
because it merely conforms the
regulations text to the current benefit
category, as specified in section
1861(s)(2)(J) of the Act. As noted above,
under section 113 of the BIPA,
immunosuppressive drugs have not
been subject to a time limit since
December 21, 2000.
b. WAMP/AMP Threshold
Section 1847A(d)(1) of the Act states
that ‘‘the Inspector General of HHS shall
conduct studies, which may include
surveys to determine the widely
available market prices (WAMP) of
drugs and biologicals to which this
section applies, as the Inspector
General, in consultation with the
Secretary, determines to be
appropriate.’’ Section 1847A(d)(2) of the
Act states that, ‘‘Based upon such
studies and other data for drugs and
biologicals, the Inspector General shall
compare the ASP under this section for
drugs and biologicals with—
• The widely available market price
(WAMP) for these drugs and biologicals
(if any); and
• The average manufacturer price
(AMP) (as determined under section
1927(k)(1) of the Act for such drugs and
biologicals).’’
Section 1847A(d)(3)(A) of the Act
states that, ‘‘The Secretary may
disregard the ASP for a drug or
biological that exceeds the WAMP or
the AMP for such drug or biological by
the applicable threshold percentage (as
defined in subparagraph (B)).’’ The
applicable threshold is specified as 5
percent for CY 2005. For CY 2006 and
subsequent years, section
1847A(d)(3)(B) of the Act establishes
that the applicable threshold is ‘‘the
percentage applied under this
subparagraph subject to such
adjustment as the Secretary may specify
for the WAMP or the AMP, or both.’’ In
CY 2006 through CY 2009, we specified
an applicable threshold percentage of 5
percent for both the WAMP and AMP.
We based this decision on the limited
data available to support a change in the
current threshold percentage.
For CY 2010, we propose to specify an
applicable threshold percentage of 5
PO 00000
Frm 00105
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33623
percent for the WAMP and the AMP. At
present, the OIG is continuing its
comparisons of both the WAMP and the
AMP. In April 2008, we implemented a
change in the weighting methodology
for calculating ASP. Information on how
recent changes to the calculation of the
ASP may affect the comparison of ASP
to WAMP or AMP is limited at this
time. Since we do not have sufficient
data that suggest another level is more
appropriate, we believe that continuing
the 5 percent applicable threshold
percentage for both the WAMP and
AMP is appropriate for CY 2010.
Therefore, we are proposing to revise
§ 414.904(d)(3) to include the CY 2010
date.
As we noted in the CY 2009 PFS final
rule with comment period (73 FR
69752), we understand that there are
complicated operational issues
associated with potential payment
substitutions. We will continue to
proceed cautiously in this area and
provide stakeholders, including
providers and manufacturers of drugs
impacted by potential price
substitutions with adequate notice of
our intentions regarding such, including
the opportunity to provide input with
regard to the processes for substituting
the WAMP or the AMP for the ASP. We
welcome comments on our proposal to
continue the applicable threshold at 5
percent for both the WAMP and AMP
for CY 2010.
2. Competitive Acquisition Program
(CAP) Issues
Section 303(d) of the MMA requires
the implementation of a competitive
acquisition program (CAP) for certain
Medicare Part B drugs not paid on a cost
or PPS basis. The provisions for
acquiring and billing drugs under the
CAP were described in the Competitive
Acquisition of Outpatient Drugs and
Biologicals Under Part B proposed rule
(March 4, 2005, 70 FR 10746) and the
interim final rule (July 6, 2005, 70 FR
39022), and certain provisions were
finalized in the CY 2006 PFS final rule
with comment period (70 FR 70236).
The CY 2007 PFS final rule with
comment period (72 FR 66260) then
finalized portions of the July 6, 2005 IFC
that had not already been finalized.
The CAP is an alternative to the ASP
(buy and bill) methodology of obtaining
certain Part B drugs used incident to
physicians’ services. Physicians who
choose to participate in the CAP obtain
drugs from vendors selected through a
competitive bidding process and
approved by CMS. Under the CAP,
participating physicians agree to obtain
all of the approximately 180 drugs on
the CAP drug list from an approved CAP
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33624
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
vendor. The approved CAP vendor
retains title to the drug until it is
administered, bills Medicare for the
drug, and bills the beneficiary for cost
sharing amounts once the drug has been
administered. The participating CAP
physician bills Medicare only for
administering the drug to the
beneficiary. The initial implementation
of the CAP operated with a single CAP
drug category from July 1, 2006 to
December 31, 2008.
After the CAP was implemented,
section 108 of the MIEA-TRHCA made
changes to the CAP payment
methodology. Section 108(a)(2) of the
MIEA-TRHCA requires the Secretary to
establish (by program instruction or
otherwise) a post payment review
process (which may include the use of
statistical sampling) to assure that
payment is made for a drug or biological
only if the drug or biological has been
administered to a beneficiary. The
Secretary is required to recoup, offset, or
collect any overpayments. This statutory
change took effect on April 1, 2007.
Conforming changes were proposed in
the CY 2008 PFS proposed rule (72 FR
38153) and finalized in the CY 2008 PFS
final rule with comment period (72 FR
66260).
In the CY 2009 PFS proposed rule, we
proposed several refinements to the
CAP regarding the annual CAP payment
amount update mechanism, the
definition of a CAP physician, the
restriction on physician transportation
of CAP drugs, and the dispute
resolution process (73 FR 38522).
However, after the publication of the
proposed rule, we announced the
postponement of the CAP for 2009 due
to contractual issues with the successful
bidders. As a result, CAP physician
election for participation in the CAP in
2009 was put on hold, and CAP drugs
have not been available from an
approved CAP vendor for dates of
service after December 31, 2008.
Physicians who participated in the CAP
have transitioned back into the Average
Sales Price (ASP) method of acquiring
part B drugs for dates of service after
December 31, 2008.
After the postponement was
announced, we solicited public
feedback on the CAP from participating
physicians, potential vendors, and other
interested parties. We solicited public
comments on several issues, including,
but not limited to the following: The
categories of drugs provided under the
CAP; the distribution of areas that are
served by the CAP; and procedural
changes that may increase the program’s
flexibility and appeal to potential
vendors and participating physicians.
We also hosted a CAP Open Door Forum
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
(ODF) on December 3, 2008, where
participants had an opportunity to
discuss the postponement and suggest
changes to the program. We appreciate
the comments that we have received.
In the CY 2009 PFS final rule with
comment period, we stated that we
would review the public comments and
consider implementing changes to the
CAP before proceeding with another bid
solicitation for approved CAP vendor
contracts. Based on this information, in
this proposed rule, we are addressing
items that were not finalized in the CY
2009 PFS final rule with comment
period, and making additional proposals
for the CAP. Our approach seeks to
better define certain aspects of the
program based on our experience. We
also seek to continue to increase
participation by minimizing the
administrative burden for physicians
and vendors who choose to participate.
a. Frequency of Drug Payment Amount
Updates
As described in the July 6, 2005 IFC
(70 FR 39070 through 39071) and
§ 414.906(c), payment amounts for drugs
furnished under the CAP are set through
a competitive bidding process, and as
described in § 414.908(b), bids that
exceed a composite bid threshold of 106
percent of the weighted ASP for the
drugs in the CAP category are not
accepted. The CAP payment amounts
that are calculated from successful bids
are updated from the time of the bidding
period to the payment year. During the
2006 through 2008 CAP contract period,
the initial update calculation used the
change in the Producer Price Index (PPI)
for prescription preparations to account
for the time period between the bidding
and the period in which the payment
amounts were to be in effect, which was
the middle of the first year of the three
year CAP contract period (70 FR 39074).
Finally, as specified in § 414.906(c),
CAP payment amounts are updated
again during the second and third year
of the contract period based on the
approved CAP vendor’s reported
reasonable net acquisition costs (RNAC).
The annual updates are limited by
payment amounts described in section
1847A of the Act and codified in
§ 414.906(c).
Section 1847B(c)(7) of the Act gives
the Secretary the discretion to establish
an appropriate schedule for the
approved CAP vendor’s disclosure of
RNAC information to us, provided that
disclosure is not required more
frequently than quarterly. In the July 6,
2005 IFC (70 FR 39075 through 39076),
we specified that each approved CAP
vendor will disclose its RNAC for the
drugs covered under the contract
PO 00000
Frm 00106
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
annually during the period of its
contract and that we would calculate an
annual payment adjustment based on
this information. We specified an
annual disclosure of RNAC because it
imposes the minimal burden on
approved CAP vendors. In 2005, some
commenters suggested that more
frequent updates would be desirable.
Additional feedback about the CAP that
was obtained after the program’s
postponement in 2008, as well as
comments on previous rules, indicated
that potential vendors would like the
frequency of price adjustments to
increase. Various commenters have
suggested a quarterly price adjustment
in order to parallel to the ASP process,
to better match payment amounts with
increases or decreases in drug costs, and
to attract vendor interest. We believe
that quarterly adjustments would also
lower approved CAP vendors’ financial
risks because CAP payment amounts
will be better able to keep up with
unanticipated drug cost increases and
would benefit the Medicare program by
reacting to significant cost decreases
more promptly.
Quarterly price updates also will
eliminate the PPI-based increase that
currently occurs between the time bids
are submitted and the first day of CAP
claims processing. The application of
the PPI-based payment adjustment
described in the July 6, 2005 IFC (70 FR
39074) has resulted in situations where
the ASP+6 percent payment amount has
been exceeded during the first year of
the 3-year approved CAP vendor
contract. We do not believe that CAP
payment amounts should exceed ASP+6
percent. In our discussion of bid
ceilings in the July 6, 2005 IFC, we
stated that the bid ceiling ‘‘ensures that
the CAP will be no more costly to the
Medicare program than the alternative
method of paying for drugs at 106
percent of ASP. This ceiling is thus
consistent with the possibility of
realizing savings to the Medicare
program. It would also serve to maintain
a level of parity between the two
systems, preventing a situation in which
significant payment differentials might
skew incentives and choices (70 FR
39070).’’ For this reason, and to remain
consistent with current regulation text
at § 414.906, we believe that all payment
amounts calculated under the update
process should be limited by the
weighted payment amount established
under section 1847A of the Act. We also
believe that this approach will continue
to provide for an ‘‘appropriate price
adjustment’’ as required under section
1847B(c)(7) of the Act by improving
responsiveness to unexpected price
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
changes, and continuing a prudent
limitation on the magnitude of payment
amount adjustments.
Our approach for implementing
quarterly updates consistent with the
ASP+6 percent limit on payment
amounts would be based on composite
bid price calculations, as described in
the July 6, 2005 IFC (70 FR 39072
through 39073). Additional details
about the process are described in
further detail in section II.H.2.f. of this
proposed rule (Annual CAP Payment
Amount Update Mechanism). Briefly
stated, the ASP+6 percent limit would
be applied by comparing the (weighted)
composite update payment amount,
calculated from participating approved
CAP vendors’ reasonable net acquisition
cost data, to most recent available
weighted ASP prices for the same drugs.
If the composite drug update payment
amount exceeds the weighted ASP+6
percent payment limit, the composite
payment amount for that group of drugs
would be reduced to equal the ASP+6
percent limit by applying an equal
percent reduction to each drug in the
group. By way of example only, if a
quarter’s composite update payment
was calculated as +2.3 percent, based on
the median of all participating approved
CAP vendors’ data, but the calculated
weighted ASP+6 percent limit for that
group of drugs was +2.1 percent, the
payment amounts for all HCPCS codes
in the composite group would be
increased by 2.1 percent in order to
account for reported increases to the
vendor’s acquisition cost, but not to
exceed the ASP+6 percent limit. This
means that a 2.1 percent increase would
be applied to CAP payment amounts for
all HCPCS codes that are in the
composite drug list and are being
supplied under the CAP by one or more
approved CAP vendors. For HCPCS
codes that are priced separately, each
code available through the CAP will be
compared to the most recent ASP+6
percent limit for that code. CAP
payment amounts for codes that exceed
the ASP+6 percent limit will be reduced
to ASP+6 percent. Each ‘‘Not Otherwise
Classified’’ (NOC) drug described in
§ 414.906(f)(2)(iv), would also be
updated on an individual (rather than
composite) basis.
We are proposing to discontinue
annual CAP payment amount updates
and to implement quarterly CAP
payment amount updates at
§ 414.906(c). Because of this proposed
change, the special quarterly
adjustments described at § 414.906(c)(2)
(for the introduction of new drugs,
expiration of drug patents or availability
of generic drugs, material shortages, or
withdrawal of a drug from the market)
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
will no longer be needed, so we propose
deleting those provisions from the
regulation, and instead adding details
about the payment amount update
process described in section II.H.2.f. of
this proposed rule (Annual CAP
Payment Amount Update Mechanism).
A quarterly RNAC reporting and
payment adjustment process would
begin as soon as we entered into
contracts with the approved CAP
vendor(s); that is, beginning with the
first quarter during which CAP claims
are submitted under the contract. Thus,
under this proposal, we would also
eliminate the PPI-based adjustment for
the time period between the time bids
are submitted and the time claims
processing begins under the contract,
because that adjustment would no
longer be necessary. We believe using
one payment update process will be
easier to administer and would
minimize the potential for CAP payment
amounts to exceed ASP+6 percent for
the first contract year. In order to
provide sufficient time for the
calculation of payment amount updates,
we are proposing that approved CAP
vendors report quarterly RNAC data for
drug purchased for use under the CAP
during the previous quarter within 30
days of the close of that quarter. We
have made corresponding changes to
regulation text at § 414.906(c) and we
welcome comments on these proposed
changes.
b. Changes to the CAP Drug List
(1) CAP Drug List
In the July 6, 2005 IFC, we responded
to comments on our proposed approach
for determining the CAP drug categories
and how we select the specific drugs in
the CAP drug list (70 FR 39026 through
39034). As stated in the CY 2006 PFS
final rule with comment period (70 FR
70237), the CAP is intended to provide
beneficiaries with access to Medicare
Part B drugs and maintain physician
flexibility when prescribing
medications. Our approach incorporated
drugs commonly administered by the
range of physician specialties that bill
for Part B drugs (70 FR 39030) and
resulted in a list of about 180 drugs that
were available through the CAP during
the CY 2006 through CY 2008 contract
period. We also developed a number of
methods by which an approved CAP
vendor’s CAP drug list could be
changed (see Table 26 at 70 FR 70242).
We believe that our general approach,
to provide a wide variety of drugs to a
variety of physicians over a large
portion of the United States, is on target.
Although we believe that the CAP is a
means for physicians to minimize their
PO 00000
Frm 00107
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33625
drug inventory costs, we acknowledge
that participation in the CAP cannot
completely eliminate the need for
participating CAP physicians to
maintain at least a minimal drug
inventory at the office. Many physicians
who participate in Medicare also
provide services to non-Medicare
patients, and even physicians with a
predominantly Medicare patient
population may find it useful to keep a
small stock of drugs on hand for
unforeseen situations, such as
emergencies and breakage.
During the CAP postponement, we
became aware that both participating
CAP physicians and potential vendors
supported narrowing the CAP drug list.
Both agreed that low cost drugs should
be removed from the CAP. Although
these items were initially included in
the CAP so that an approved CAP
vendor would be in a position to supply
many of the Part B drugs that an office
might administer, CAP physicians and
the vendor community have stated that
the inclusion of these items in the CAP
creates an accounting, tracking, and
claims submission burden for some
participants. Based on these comments,
we believe that low-cost, frequently
utilized items, such as corticosteroid
injections, could be removed from the
list without significant impact on the
CAP’s utility to participating CAP
physicians. Furthermore, it appears that
physicians would be more interested in
obtaining expensive products, such as
biologicals, through the CAP. However,
we are also mindful that narrowing the
CAP drug list significantly also would
decrease an approved CAP vendor’s
overall purchase volume, and we
believe that this could limit the
approved CAP vendor’s ability to obtain
volume-based discounts from the
manufacturers or distributors from
which it obtains drugs for use in the
CAP. Creating a more tailored CAP drug
category also could limit physician
participation to one or several
specialties, and may create a situation
where sudden supply interruptions and
unexpected changes to distribution
channels could affect a greater
proportion of drugs in the program than
would be the case with a broader CAP
drug category.
Nevertheless, we are proposing to
create a new CAP drug category for the
next round of CAP contracting. Our
approach is intended to address
comments about the administrative
burden of tracking and billing low cost/
high volume items while maintaining
access to a variety of high cost items.
We are proposing to identify the new
CAP drug category using the existing
CAP drug category as a starting point.
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33626
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
The 2008 drug list was compiled based
on Part B drug claims data, the
identification of specialties that
frequently administer drugs under Part
B, and public comment during
rulemaking in 2005 (70 FR 39026
through 39033). We believe that using
the 2008 CAP drug list as a starting
point would maintain prescribing
flexibility for a wide range of specialties
and would also maintain access to a
wide spectrum of drugs that have been
utilized under the program previously.
Furthermore, we do not believe it is
necessary to develop a new approach
because the 2008 CAP drug list was
based on heavily utilized drugs in
Medicare Part B physician practices; we
believe that this approach is on target.
We propose to amend our list based
on CAP physician participation, claims
data, and comments indicating that the
list should be narrowed to higher cost
items. First, we would ‘‘filter’’ the
original CAP drug category (drugs
furnished in 2006 through 2009) by the
specialties that most frequently
prescribe drugs under the CAP, and the
highest dollar volume CAP drugs (top
20 percent of allowed charges) compiled
from 2008 claims data. This filtered list
appears in Table 35, and we are
proposing it as the starting point for the
updated CAP drug category. A filtering
process based on frequency of claims
from a subset of physicians who might
participate in the CAP cannot fully
capture all drugs that may be used by
certain specialties. In other words, the
filtering steps described above narrow
the CAP drug list based on physician
specialties and dollar volume and do
not necessarily preserve groups of drugs
that certain prescribers may utilize,
especially the less frequently utilized
items in such groups. Therefore, we are
also proposing to ‘‘fill in’’ groups of
drugs with related items that do not
appear on our list. We will consider
‘‘filling in’’ any drug or biological
product that is physician-administered,
has a reasonably high utilization in the
Medicare population, is related to drugs
already in the CAP (for example,
because of similar clinical uses), and is
otherwise appropriate for inclusion in
the program.
For example, we could consider
adding a fourth hyaluronan
viscosupplement to the drugs in Table
35, expanding the list of antibiotics, or
antiemetics, or by adding a list of ‘‘new’’
and unweighted drugs as in 2006 by
using simple claims data thresholds (70
FR 70238). The concept of ‘‘filling in’’
drug groups is supported by feedback
from former participating CAP
physicians who suggested that certain
categories of drugs, such as antibiotics,
be more fully represented. We are
seeking comments on specific drugs that
should be added to the draft list in
Table 35.
We also are seeking comment on the
method to assess whether a particular
drug should be ‘‘filled in’’ so that it is
included in the new, narrowed CAP
drug category. For example, one process
that we have considered and would like
comment on is adding drugs from the
2009 through 2011 CAP vendor bidding
list that did not pass the ‘‘filtering’’ step
described above. The 180 item 2009
through 2011 bidding list was used
during the approved CAP vendor
bidding for the 2009–2011 contract, and
includes CMS-approved items added to
the original contract’s bid list, as well as
items approved for addition during the
2006–2008 contract period. (See the
Downloads section at https://
www.cms.hhs.gov/CompetitiveAcquis
forBios/03a_vendorbackground.asp#
TopOfPage). This list’s weighting is
based on claims volume data by HCPCS
code units rather than dollar volume
and provides a different perspective
than a dollar volume sorting. We would
add drugs from the 2009–2011 CAP
Vendor bid list to the CAP drug category
if the drug’s weight is in the top 25
percent of the 2009–2011 CAP vendor
bidding list, indicating frequent claims
submission, and if the drug’s clinical
uses are similar to a drug on the
proposed list in Table 35. This method
would result in the addition of a
number of several commonly used
antibiotics, two antiemetic) and several
chemotherapeutic agents. Potential
additions to our draft list identified by
this method appear in Table 36.
Although this method helps ‘‘fill in’’ the
proposed CAP drug list, this method
still does not fully capture less
frequently used drugs, or newly
approved drugs. We welcome comments
on this method and alternative methods
of filling this proposed list.
In order to provide additional
flexibility for participating CAP
physicians and approved CAP vendors,
and to allow for participants to further
tailor the program to meet their needs,
we are also proposing to add
§ 414.906(f)(2)(v) to allow approved
CAP vendors to submit a request to CMS
to add drugs (or biologicals) to the list
of drugs furnished by the requesting
vendor if there is sufficient demand and
if the drug has therapeutic uses that are
similar to other drugs already available
through the CAP. The request and
approval process would follow the
existing regulations at § 414.906(f), and
HCPCS code additions that are
requested under this process would still
be subject to CMS approval. This
proposed process adds to the process for
adding newly issued HCPCS codes
under § 414.906(f)(2)(iii) and newly
approved drugs without HCPCS codes
(NOC drugs)under § 414.906(f)(2)(iv). It
is intended to facilitate more complete
access to groups of drugs that may be
used by certain specialties, and drugs
used to treat certain disease states
without having to rely on rigid
definitions of classes of drugs that may
not apply well to actual clinical practice
across a large and diverse geographic
area. We believe that this addition to the
methods for changing an approved CAP
vendor’s drug list (see Table 26 in the
November 21, 2006 final rule (70 FR
70242)) will add to the flexibility of the
program. We welcome comments on our
proposal to update the CAP drug list.
TABLE 35—DRAFT CAP DRUG LIST FOR NEXT CONTRACT PERIOD
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Code
J0129
J0215
J0585
J0587
J0696
J0878
J0881
J0885
J0894
J1440
J1441
J1740
Procedure code description
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
VerDate Nov<24>2008
INJECTION, ABATACEPT, 10 MG
INJECTION, ALEFACEPT, 0.5 MG
BOTULINUM TOXIN TYPE A, PER UNIT
BOTULINUM TOXIN TYPE B, PER 100 UNITS
INJECTION, CEFTRIAXONE SODIUM, PER 250 MG
DAPTOMYCIN INJECTION, 1 MG
INJECTION, DARBEPOETIN ALFA, 1 MCG (NON-ESRD USE)
INJECTION, EPOETIN ALPHA, (FOR NON ESRD USE), PER 1000 UNITS
INJECTION, DECITABINE, 1MG
INJECTION, FILGRASTIM (G-CSF), 300 MCG
INJECTION, FILGRASTIM (G-CSF), 480 MCG
INJECTION, IBANDRONATE SODIUM, 1 MG
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00108
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
33627
TABLE 35—DRAFT CAP DRUG LIST FOR NEXT CONTRACT PERIOD—Continued
Code
J1745
J2323
J2353
J2357
J2405
J2469
J2503
J2505
J2778
J2794
J3240
J3315
J3396
J3487
J3488
J7321
J7322
J7324
J9010
J9035
J9041
J9055
J9170
J9201
J9206
J9263
J9305
J9310
J9355
Procedure code description
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
INJECTION INFLIXIMAB, 10 MG
INJECTION, NATALIZUMAB, 1 MG
INJECTION, OCTREOTIDE, DEPOT FORM FOR INTRAMUSCULAR INJECTION, 1 MG
OMALIZUMAB INJECTION, 5 MG
INJECTION, ONDANSETRON HYDROCHLORIDE, PER 1 MG
PALONOSETRON HCL, 25MCG
PEGAPTANIB, 0.3MG
INJECTION, PEGFILGRASTIM, 6 MG
INJECTION, RANIBIZUMAB, 0.1 MG
RISPERIDONE, LONG ACTING, 0.5MG
INJECTION, THYROTROPIN ALPHA, 0.9 MG, PROVIDED IN 1.1 MG VIAL
INJECTION, TRIPTORELIN PAMOATE, 3.75 MG
INJECTION, VERTEPORFIN, 0.1 MG
INJECTION, ZOLEDRONIC ACID, 1 MG
INJECTION, ZOLEDRONIC ACID (RECLAST), 1 MG
HYALURONAN OR DERIVATIVE, HYALGAN OR SUPARTZ, FOR INTRA-ARTICULAR INJECTION, Per Dose
HYALURONAN OR DERIVATIVE, SYNVISC, FOR INTRA-ARTICULAR INJECTION, PER DOSE
HYALURONAN OR DERIVATIVE, ORTHOVISC, FOR INTRA-ARTICULAR INJECTION, PER DOSE
ALEMTUZUMAB, 10 MG
BEVACIZUMAB INJECTION, 10MG
BORTEZOMIB INJECTION, 0.1MG
CETUXIMAB INJECTION, 10MG
DOCETAXEL, 20 MG
GEMCITABINE HCL, 200 MG
IRINOTECAN, 20 MG
INJECTION, OXALIPLATIN, 0.5 MG
PEMETREXED INJECTION, 10MG
RITUXIMAB, 100 MG
TRASTUZUMAB, 10 MG
TABLE 36—POTENTIAL ADDITIONS TO THE DRAFT CAP DRUG LIST FOR NEXT CONTRACT PERIOD (THAT IS, TABLE 35)
Code
J3370
J9264
J0690
J1260
J0692
J1626
J0640
J9265
J9190
J9045
J0290
J9214
Procedure code description
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
.................
INJECTION, VANCOMYCIN HCL, 500 MG
PACLITAXEL PROTEIN BOUND PARTICLES, 1MG
INJECTION, CEFAZOLIN SODIUM, 500 MG
INJECTION, DOLASETRON MESYLATE, 10 MG
INJECTION, CEFEPIME HYDROCHLORIDE, 500 MG
INJECTION, GRANISETRON HYDROCHLORIDE, 100 MCG
INJECTION, LEUCOVORIN CALCIUM, PER 50 MG
PACLITAXEL, 30 MG
FLUOROURACIL, 500 MG
CARBOPLATIN, 50 MG
INJECTION, AMPICILLIN SODIUM, 500 MG
INTERFERON, ALFA–2B, RECOMBINANT, 1 MILLION UNITS
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
2. Removing Drugs From the CAP list
Although there are several methods
under the CAP to add drugs to an
approved CAP vendor’s drug list, the
current regulations do not specify a
process for removing drugs from an
approved CAP vendor’s list. Our
experience has shown that interruptions
in availability can affect an approved
CAP vendor’s ability to supply CAP
drugs during the course of a 3-year
contract. For example, during the first
contract period, we became aware of
long-term and permanent drug
unavailability, sometimes at the HCPCS
level, due to removal of drugs from the
market, or interruption of supply to an
approved CAP vendor for reasons
beyond the approved CAP vendor’s
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
control, such as changes to drug
distribution methods, changes in
agreements between manufacturers and
distributors and/or pharmacies
regarding who may purchase certain
drugs, and direct distribution
arrangements.
In order to better respond to sudden,
long-term changes in drug supply that
are beyond the control of the approved
CAP vendor, we are proposing to allow
an approved CAP vendor to request the
permanent removal from its CAP drug
list of a HCPCS code for which no NDCs
are available. Our proposal is intended
to better manage situations where all
NDCs from an entire HCPCS code
unexpectedly become unavailable to an
approved CAP vendor, and we would
require the approved CAP vendor (1) to
PO 00000
Frm 00109
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
document the situation in writing,
including the unavailability of all NDC
codes in a HCPCS code that is supplied
under the CAP, (2) to describe the
reason for the unavailability and its
anticipated duration, and (3) to attest
that the unavailability is beyond the
approved CAP vendor’s control.
Approval of the deletion would apply
only to the approved CAP vendor or
vendors that requested the deletion. Our
proposal is not intended to be used
frequently, or to permit an approved
CAP vendor to remove a HCPCS code
from its CAP drug list simply because it
has become unprofitable to provide it—
we believe the payment amount
adjustment proposals discussed in
sections II.H.2.a. and f. of this proposed
rule would address that concern.
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33628
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Furthermore, our proposal is also not
intended to be used for managing shortterm unavailability, or unavailability of
a finite duration—we believe the
existing drug substitution policy
described in § 414.906(f) already
addresses those concerns. We are
proposing to add this process as
§ 414.906(g) because those regulations
currently provide for additions and
substitutions to the CAP drug list, and
would therefore require a written
request to CMS, as well as CMS’
approval.
Participating CAP physicians who are
affected by the deletion of a HCPCS
code from an approved CAP vendor’s
drug list would have the option of
remaining with their selected approved
CAP vendor and using the ASP (buy and
bill) methodology for obtaining the drug
that has been deleted, or selecting
another approved CAP vendor under the
exigent circumstances provision at
§ 414.908(a)(2). We believe that the
deletion of an expensive and highly
utilized CAP drug by one approved CAP
vendor in the middle of a physician
election period could cause hardship for
a practice if it had to revert to the ASP
methodology of acquiring and billing for
that drug. Such a situation would
constitute an exigent circumstance.
Given CAP’s goal of improving access to
drugs, allowing the participating CAP
physician to switch approved CAP
vendors outside of a regular election
period in this instance would be
prudent. We welcome comments on our
proposals.
c. Geographic Area Served by the CAP
In the July 6, 2005 IFC (70 FR 39034
through 39036), we established a single,
national competitive acquisition area for
the initial stage of the CAP. This
national distribution area included the
50 States, the District of Columbia,
Puerto Rico, and U.S. territories. We
recognized that designating a single
national area might limit participation
to those vendors that could compete to
bid and supply drugs nationally, but we
indicated this approach was a part of
the phase-in plan for the CAP. We also
discussed potential phase-in options for
the future, stating that smaller areas
might become a solution as the program
expanded.
According to the vendor community,
certain areas of the United States
(especially Alaska, Hawaii, and the
Territories) currently present logistical
challenges and are associated with high
drug shipping costs. Moreover,
physician participation in these areas
has been low; in 2008, physicians from
Alaska, Hawaii, and the Territories
represented less than 2 percent of total
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
participating CAP physicians.
Temporarily limiting the geographic
areas served by the CAP could help
limit costs and risks for approved CAP
vendors associated with shipping drugs
to distant parts of the country. However,
we believe that the CAP is intended to
provide services to all Medicare
physicians (including those in distant
parts of the country), and therefore, we
do not believe that a limitation on the
geographic area in which the CAP is
available should be permanent.
Section 1847B(a)(1)(B) of the Act
specifically requires the Secretary to
phase-in the CAP with respect to the
categories of drugs and biologicals in
the program, in such a manner as the
Secretary determines to be appropriate.
We believe that this provision,
particularly in conjunction with the
statutory definition of a competitive
acquisition area as ‘‘an appropriate
geographic region established by the
Secretary’’ provides broad authority for
the Secretary to phase in the CAP with
respect to the geographical areas in
which the program would be
implemented. As stated in the July 6,
2005 IFC, we considered several factors
when defining geographic areas for the
CAP, including aspects of vendors and
their distribution systems, such as
current geographic service areas, the
density of distribution centers, the
distances drugs and biologicals are
typically shipped, and costs associated
with shipping and handling (70 FR
39035). Taking these factors into
consideration again, and considering
entities who have bid on, or expressed
interest in bidding on approved CAP
vendor contracts, we believe that it is
appropriate to use the authority granted
under the Statute to temporarily narrow
the area served by the CAP during the
program’s re-implementation. We
appreciate the logistical issues
associated with shipping drugs to
remote areas and the uncertainties
associated with transportation costs that
have been described by the potential
vendor community; however, we are
reluctant to significantly reduce the area
served by the CAP because at some
point, the approved CAP vendor’s
volume would be affected and the
likelihood of obtaining volume based
discounts would decrease.
At this time, we are proposing to
designate the CAP competitive
acquisition area as the 48 contiguous
States and the District of Columbia for
the next round of CAP contracting. This
change in the geographic area that is
served by the CAP is meant as an
interim measure under our phase-in
authority and the statutory definition of
a competitive acquisition area. We
PO 00000
Frm 00110
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
believe that omitting Alaska, Hawaii,
and the Territories from the CAP
competitive acquisition area at this time
will balance the need to revise the CAP
to attract more vendors with the need to
offer the maximum number of
physicians a meaningful opportunity to
participate. We believe that this
proposal will encourage potential
vendors to participate in the CAP
because it would temporarily omit areas
associated with low physician
participation, long shipping times, and
high shipping costs. Furthermore, this
measure is unlikely to significantly
decrease CAP drug order volume
relative to historical physician
participation in the CAP. However, we
are aware that our proposal temporarily
eliminates the CAP option for
physicians in the areas not included in
this CAP competitive acquisition area.
Therefore, we are not proposing this
definition of the CAP geographical area
as a permanent solution. We will
continue to assess the CAP and update
plans for phase in activity in future
rulemaking efforts, including
determining the circumstances under
which CAP participation will be offered
to physicians in Alaska, Hawaii, and the
Territories. We will also continue to
consider modifying the definition of
competitive acquisition area on the
basis of regions, States, or some smaller
geographic area, which might expand
the number of vendors that could bid to
participate in the program (70 FR
39036). We welcome comments on our
proposal.
d. CAP Drug Stock at the Physician’s
Office
Our discussion about the CAP
emergency restocking option in the July
6, 2005 IFC indicated that a
participating CAP physician could not
maintain a stock of an approved CAP
vendor’s drug in his or her inventory.
This was done because we had
reservations about potential program
integrity and drug diversion issues (70
FR 39047).
Since that time, we have gained
operational experience with the CAP
and a better understanding of the
ordering and drug delivery process. We
have also received additional public
feedback about the different ways that
the program could be refined. Further,
our experience with the CAP indicates
that our concerns over program integrity
and drug diversion have not come to
pass. For example, we have received no
complaints and have no information
indicating that diversion has been a
concern. Also, we have not received any
negative feedback from the vendor
community indicating a concern about
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
storing CAP drugs in physicians’ offices.
Therefore, we believe at this time it is
appropriate to consider allowing
additional flexibility to encourage CAP
participation.
Our experience with the CAP, and our
increased understanding about the
options approved CAP vendors might
have for furnishing drugs to a
participating CAP physician’s office also
support considering additional
flexibility in this area. For example, we
are aware of electronic inventory control
and charge capture devices that could
be utilized in ways that conform to CAP
regulations and are compliant with
applicable State and Federal laws. Such
devices utilize an electronic transaction
based on a physician’s order to track the
administration of drugs from inventory
to a specific patient and to document
appropriate charges for the drug. We
believe that such systems could fit into
the current CAP framework when
transactions in such systems are based
on a physician’s order, because such
systems can track inventory, and can be
used to capture patient charge data.
For these reasons, we are seeking to
clarify our requirements for the manner
in which CAP drugs are supplied to
participating CAP physicians.
Specifically, we are proposing to allow
approved CAP vendors to utilize
electronic transactions to furnish CAP
drugs from nominal quantities of
approved CAP vendor-owned stock
located at the physician’s office in
response to specific prescription orders
and to capture charges related to such
transactions. Our proposal is also
intended to clarify that entities with
alternative approaches to supplying
drugs that utilize an electronic
transaction are welcome to participate
in the CAP bidding process. We believe
that this will allow for additional
flexibility and efficiency in the ordering
and delivery of drugs within the
program because it allows for more
efficient shipping of approved CAP
vendor-owned stock and provides the
option of CAP participation for
physicians who use or may choose to
use such drug inventory management
platforms. This proposal does not
change our position that a participating
CAP physician shall not take title to or
pay for CAP drugs, nor does it alter the
requirements for information that must
be submitted with a prescription order
under Section 414.908(a) or the
application of HIPAA to such data.
Furthermore, our proposal does not
affect the applicability of State licensing
requirements for an approved CAP
vendor. As stated in the July 6, 2005 IFC
(70 FR 39066), either the approved CAP
vendor, its subcontractor under the
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
CAP, or both, must be licensed
appropriately by each State to conduct
its operations under the CAP. Therefore,
if a State requires it, an approved CAP
vendor would be required to be licensed
as a pharmacy, as well as a distributor.
We are not revising the requirements at
§ 414.908(c) and § 414.914(f)(9), and we
note that sections 1847B(b)(6) and
1847B(b)(2)(B) of the Act continue to
apply. In order to participate in the CAP
successful bidders must continue to
submit proof of pharmacy licensure,
consistent with applicable State
requirements.
Also, this proposal would not modify
our definition of ‘‘emergency delivery’’
or its corresponding requirements at
§ 414.902. As we stated in our July 6,
2005 IFC, the intent of the 1-businessday timeframe for emergency deliveries
is to address the participating CAP
physician’s need for more rapid delivery
of drugs in certain clinical situations
with the approved CAP vendor’s ability
to ship the drug and have it delivered
promptly in a nationwide delivery area
(70 FR 39045). The emergency delivery
timeframe still applies in situations
when CAP drugs are not available in the
office for electronic delivery.
Moreover, this proposal does not seek
to change the CAP inventory
requirements. CAP drugs belong to the
approved CAP vendor, and as indicated
in the July 6, 2005 IFC (70 FR 39048),
participating CAP physicians are
required to maintain a separate
electronic or paper inventory for each
CAP drug obtained. CAP drugs must be
tracked separately in some way (for
example, an electronic spreadsheet).
CAP drugs do not have to be stored
separately from a physician’s own stock;
that is, co-mingling of CAP drug with
drug from a participating CAP
physician’s own private stock is
acceptable as long as a record of
approved CAP vendor-owned drug is
kept in a manner that is consistent with
§ 414.908(a)(3)(x) and the approved CAP
vendor-owned drug can be accounted
for, as needed.
Also, this proposal does not affect the
CAP emergency restocking
requirements. Section 1847B(b)(5) of the
Act and § 414.906(e) provide criteria for
the replacement of drugs taken from a
participating CAP physician’s inventory
in the event of an emergency situation.
When the emergency resupply criteria
are met, a participating CAP physician
can replace the drugs that were used
from his or her own inventory by
submitting a prescription order to the
approved CAP vendor.
Our proposal seeks to clarify the
potential approaches that a bidder may
use (separately or in combination) to
PO 00000
Frm 00111
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33629
supply drugs under the CAP. Our
proposal does not seek to specify a
particular approach that bidders must
use in future responses to CAP bid
solicitations or to strictly define the
types of entities that could bid on CAP
vendor contracts; for example, whether
bidders must be pharmacies, drug
distributors, or a hybrid of the two;
whether bidders must utilize just in
time shipping, or electronic inventory
transactions to supply CAP drugs. We
will consider approving bidders’
approaches that are consistent with the
statutory framework, applicable laws,
and regulations. We welcome comments
on this issue.
e. Exclusion of CAP Sales From ASP
Calculations
In response to the March 4, 2005
proposed rule, many commenters
requested clarification about whether
the prices determined under the CAP
will be taken into account in computing
the ASP under section 1847A of the Act.
In the July 6, 2005 IFC, we responded
that prices offered under the CAP must
be included in ASP calculations (70 FR
39077). This was done because we
initially believed that we did not have
the statutory authority to exclude prices
determined under the CAP from the
computation of ASP under section
1847A of the Act. Section 1847A(c)(2) of
the Act contains a specific list of sales
that are exempt from the ASP
calculation, and sales to approved CAP
vendors operating under CAP are not
included on that list (70 FR 39077).
Comments received in response to the
July 6, 2005 IFC opposed this policy (70
FR 70479).
Ultimately, as stated in the November
21, 2005 IFC, we recognized
commenters’ concerns about the effect
of including CAP prices in the
calculation of ASP and agreed that the
best outcome for both the ASP
methodology and the CAP programs
would be one in which prices under
CAP did not affect payment amounts
under the ASP methodology. In
particular, we found compelling
arguments from commenters about the
separation of the ASP and CAP
programs and that the two programs are
intended to be alternatives to each
other. Therefore, we excluded units of
CAP drugs that are administered to
beneficiaries by participating CAP
physicians from the ASP calculation for
the initial 3-year approved CAP vendor
contract period (70 FR 70479).
Accordingly, the definition of ‘‘Unit’’ at
§ 414.802 was also revised to reflect this
exclusion.
In our August 18, 2006 interim final
rule, we further addressed concerns
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33630
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
pertaining to our definition of Unit. We
published a PRA notice regarding a
proposed modification of the OMBapproved ASP information collection
requirements (CMS Form 10110 (OMB
# 0938–0921) about the collection of the
number of CAP units excluded from the
ASP calculation. In response, a
commenter expressed concern over
manufacturers’ reliance on approved
CAP vendors for information about the
number of units of CAP drugs that are
administered to beneficiaries by
participating CAP physicians (71 FR
48132). Since approved CAP vendors
are the only entities with direct
information on CAP units administered,
the commenter believed that the
requirement to exclude units of CAP
drugs administered to beneficiaries by
participating CAP physicians placed the
manufacturer in the untenable position
of reporting ASP and certifying reports
of ASP based on second-hand
information from approved CAP
vendors. Further, the commenter noted
that manufacturers may not have timely
access to this information and that they
could not independently confirm its
accuracy (71 FR 48132). Additional
feedback received as part of our ongoing
work with manufacturers also indicated
that they were concerned that they
would have difficulty obtaining
information from approved CAP
vendors that would be necessary to
accurately exclude administered CAP
units from the ASP calculation (71 FR
48132).
Therefore, we further revised the
definition of unit to clarify that for the
initial 3-year contract period under the
CAP units of CAP drugs sold to an
approved CAP vendor for use under the
CAP would be excluded from the
calculation of ASP (70 FR 48132).
In the July 6, 2005 and August 18,
2006 IFCs, we stated that we would
examine the effect of this exclusion and,
if necessary, revisit our decision at the
end of the initial 3-year period of the
CAP (70 FR 70480 and 71 FR 48132,
respectively). Since then, operational
experience has not indicated a reason
for changing our policy of excluding
CAP units sold to approved CAP
vendors for use under the CAP from
ASP calculations. Therefore, we are
proposing to permanently exclude drugs
supplied under the CAP from ASP
calculations and make conforming
changes to the definition of unit at
§ 414.802. We believe that this proposal
will continue to promote the separation
and independence of the two drug
payment models. We welcome
comments on this proposal.
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
f. Annual CAP Payment Amount Update
Mechanism
In the July 6, 2005 IFC (70 FR 39076),
we described a two-step process to
calculate RNAC-based price adjustment
if there is a change in the RNAC
reported by a particular approved CAP
vendor. We stated that ‘‘we would
adjust the bid price that the vendor
originally submitted by the percentage
change indicated in the cost information
that the vendor disclosed. Next, we
would recompute the single price for
the drug as the median of all of these
adjusted bid prices.’’ The two-step
process contemplated that there would
be more than one approved CAP vendor
at the time prices were to be adjusted
and that all successful bidders would
participate in the CAP.
However, during the first round of
CAP contracting, after offering more
than one contract, we entered into a
contract with only one successful
bidder. Thus, during the 2008 price
update calculation process, we
developed an approach to account for
the lack of RNAC data for bidders who
chose not to participate in the CAP. In
the CY 2009 PFS proposed rule, we
stated that the approach we used to
adjust prices for the 2008 contract year
is consistent with § 414.906(c) and with
the July 6, 2005 IFC because it retains
a two-step calculation based on the
approved CAP vendor’s RNAC, as well
as the calculation of a median of
adjusted bid prices.
We also posted our approach on the
Approved CAP Vendor page of the CMS
CAP Web site at https://
www.cms.hhs.gov/
CompetitiveAcquisforBios/
15_Approved_Vendor.asp. The percent
change in RNAC for 2008 was
calculated based on data supplied by
the approved CAP vendor. This percent
change in RNAC was used as a proxy for
the percent change in RNAC for
successful bidders that chose not to
become approved CAP vendors.
Then, in the CY 2009 PFS proposed
rule (73 FR 38522 through 38523), we
proposed to continue using this
approach for future CAP payment
amount updates where the number of
approved CAP vendors is less than the
number of successful bidders. We
proposed that the average of the
approved CAP vendor-supplied RNAC
data would be used as a proxy for data
from vendors who bid successfully but
are not participating in the CAP. For
example, if the payment amounts for the
first year of a CAP contract are based on
five successful bidders, but only four
have signed contracts to supply drugs
under the CAP (that is, there are four
PO 00000
Frm 00112
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
approved CAP vendors), only RNAC
data collected from the four approved
CAP vendors would be used to calculate
the percent change in the RNAC. The
average of the four approved CAP
vendors’ adjusted payment amounts
would be used as a proxy for the RNAC
of the successful bidder that is not
participating in the CAP. The updated
CAP payment amount would then be
calculated as the median of the five data
points (one data point for each approved
CAP vendor’s updated payment amount,
and one data point calculated using the
average of the approved CAP vendors’
RNAC). Similarly, if there were five
successful bidders but only three chose
to become approved CAP vendors, the
average of the three approved CAP
vendors’ RNAC would be the proxy for
the RNAC of the two bidders who did
not participate. The median of those five
data points would become the updated
CAP payment amount.
Our approach in the CY 2009 PFS
proposed rule was intended to provide
us with a flexible method for updating
CAP prices, to be consistent with our
original policy as stated in the July 6,
2005 IFC, and to account for bidders or
approved CAP vendors who are not
participating in the program at the time
the price updates are calculated.
However, our approach was limited in
scope because it was made during a
contract period and during bidding for
an upcoming contract and we did not
want to make any significant changes to
the CAP program which could affect
contractual obligations. Furthermore,
we received a comment in response to
the CY 2009 PFS proposed rule that
suggested the elimination of the proxy
procedure so that payments would be
based on actual data from participating
vendors and would better reflect
experience within the program. After
additional consideration, we believe
that it would be prudent to simplify and
update our 2009 proposal in order to
account for successful bidders who
choose not to participate in the CAP,
possible changes in the number of
approved CAP vendors over the life of
a 3-year CAP contract, and to allow for
flexibility in setting the frequency of
payment amount adjustments as
described in section a. above. We
believe that our updated proposal is
easier for the vendor community to
understand and for us to implement.
Furthermore, our revised proposal is not
constrained by concerns about the
impact of changes on an active contract.
We are proposing to clarify that the
RNAC-based adjustment calculations
are intended to apply only to approved
CAP vendors (not all bidders), and that
the most recent CAP payment amount
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
(for example, the previous year’s or the
previous quarter’s payment amount)
will be the starting point for making the
subsequent period’s adjustment. Simply
put, we are proposing to eliminate the
use of proxy data for bidders that are no
longer participating in the program.
Instead, we propose to use RNAC data
only from approved CAP vendors that
are participating in the CAP at the time
that an RNAC-based price update is
being calculated. We are also clarifying
that the starting point for the payment
amount adjustment is the most recent
payment amount. The percent change
calculated from each participating
approved CAP vendor’s RNAC data will
be applied to the most recent payment
amount by recomputing the single price
using the median of all participating
vendors’ adjusted prices.
For example, if quarterly adjustments
beginning at the start of claims
processing approved CAP vendor’s
contract as described in section a. above
are implemented, and the post bid
period’s CAP payment amounts are
calculated based on five successful bids,
but only four approved CAP vendors are
participating when CAP claims
processing begins, the RNAC-based
payment amount adjustment for the first
quarter of CAP claims would be based
on RNAC data provided by the four
approved CAP vendors that will be
furnishing drugs under the CAP. The
four approved CAP vendors would be
required to submit a quarter of RNAC
data within thirty days of the close of
the quarter to which the data applied,
prior to the beginning of CAP claims
processing for the new contract. We
would apply the percentage change in
RNAC reported by each of the four
approved CAP vendors to the CAP
payment amounts calculated from
successful bids, and the adjusted
payment amount would be the median
of those four adjusted amounts.
Assuming that these four vendors are
still furnishing drugs during the second
quarter, calculations for the second
quarter would apply the RNAC-based
adjustment calculated from the four
vendors’ data to the first quarter’s
payment amount.
This process would apply to the
composite bid drug list as amended by
rulemaking, meaning that a single
weighted percent change in RNAC is
calculated for all drugs in the composite
bid list and that single percent change
is applied to all drugs in the list. For
drugs that are bid as separate line items,
such as drugs that were included in
addendum B of the 2006 bidding period
(see 70 FR 39072 and updated as
addendum G in 70 FR 70238) or for
drugs that are added during a contract
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
period, each HCPCS code will be
adjusted as a separate line item. Such
codes will not be included in the
composite, weighted drug list. Our
process will continue to assign a single
payment amount to all approved CAP
vendors that supply a given HCPCS
code; we do not intend to have more
than one payment amount for any
HCPCS code under the CAP or for
individual ‘‘NOC’’ drugs described in
§ 414.906(f)(2)(iv).
This updated approach is flexible,
and we believe it can accommodate a
variety of scenarios, including a
changing number of approved CAP
vendors and changes to the frequency
with which payment amount updates
are made. It provides a straightforward
and accurate clarification of the price
adjustment mechanism described in
regulation text. We believe that this
proposal remains consistent with our
original preamble language and with our
CY 2009 PFS proposal, because it
retains the two-step calculation using
the percent change in RNAC. Finally,
we believe that our approach will
eliminate any perception that
nonparticipating vendors can
significantly affect CAP payment
amount adjustments. We welcome
comments on our proposal and
corresponding regulation text changes at
§ 414.906(c).
g. 2009 PFS Proposals
(1) Definition of a CAP Physician
In the July 6, 2005 IFC, we stated that
section 1847B of the Act most closely
describes a system for the provision of
and the payment for drugs provided
incident to a physician’s service (70 FR
39026). In the November 21, 2005 IFC
(70 FR 70258), we stated that for the
purposes of the CAP, a physician
includes all practitioners that meet the
definition of a ‘‘physician’’ in section
1861(r) of the Act. This definition
includes doctors of medicine,
osteopathy, dental surgery, dental
medicine, podiatry, and optometry, as
well as chiropractors. However, this
definition does not include other health
care professionals, such as nurse
practitioners (NPs), clinical nurse
specialists (CNSs), and other professions
such as physician assistants (PAs) who
may be able to legally prescribe
medications and enroll in Medicare.
Our 2005 CAP definition was not
intended to exclude these practitioners
who are appropriately billing Medicare
for legally prescribed medications
administered in a capacity that would
be classified as incident to a physician’s
services if the medications were
administered by a physician. We are
PO 00000
Frm 00113
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33631
concerned that the existing CAP
definition of a physician is
unnecessarily restrictive and could
potentially affect access to the CAP for
a small segment of providers that should
be eligible for participation in the CAP
in situations where they currently bill
Medicare separately and appropriately.
In the CY 2009 PFS proposed rule (73
FR 38523), we proposed to further
clarify that, for the purposes of the CAP,
the definition of a physician included
all practitioners that meet the definition
of a ‘‘physician’’ in section 1861(r) of
the Act, as well as practitioners (such as
NPs, CNSs and PAs) described in
section 1861(s)(2)(K) of the Act and
other practitioners who legally prescribe
drugs associated with services under
section 1861(s) of the Act if those
services and the associated drugs are
covered when furnished incident to a
physician’s service. While we believed
that most practitioners described in
section 1861(s)(2)(K) of the Act would
bill under specific physician provider
numbers, it was not our intent to
exclude practitioners who are able to
bill independently for drugs associated
with services that are covered when
provided by a physician and legally
authorized to be performed.
In response to our CY 2009 proposed
rule, only a few commenters were
concerned about the inclusion of
inadequately trained practitioners and
risks to patient safety under this
expanded definition. Another
commenter stated that this definition
goes beyond the scope of the provisions
in the MMA and the strict definition of
‘‘physician’’ in the statute. However, the
majority of comments supported this
proposal.
We did not receive any feedback
during the CAP postponement that
would lead us to reconsider this
proposal. Therefore, we are again
proposing to further clarify that, for the
purposes of the CAP, the definition of
a physician included all practitioners
that meet the definition of a ‘‘physician’’
in section 1861(r) of the Act, as well as
practitioners (such as NPs, CNSs and
PAs) described in section 1861(s)(2)(K)
of the Act and other practitioners who
legally prescribe drugs associated with
services under section 1861(s) of the Act
if those services and the associated
drugs are covered when furnished
incident to a physician’s services.
Our proposal is specific to the Part B
Drug CAP and does not affect the
definition of physician in section
1861(r) of the Act, or the definition of
‘‘Medical and Other Health Services’’
described in section 1861(s) of the Act.
This proposal also does not seek to
expand the scope of the CAP beyond
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33632
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
what has been described in previous
rules, other than to clarify that a small
number of providers who are enrolled in
Medicare, and who legally prescribe
drugs associated with services under
section 1861(s) of the Act and can be
paid by Medicare may elect to
participate in the CAP if billing
independently. In short, the CAP
remains a program that provides Part B
drugs furnished incident to a
physician’s services. We welcome
additional comments on the proposal.
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
(2) Easing the Restriction on Physicians
Transporting CAP Drugs
Although section 1847B(b)(4)(E) of the
Act provides for the shipment of CAP
drugs to settings other than a
participating CAP physician’s office
under certain conditions, in initially
implementing the CAP, we did not
propose to implement the CAP in
alternative settings. We implemented
the CAP with a restriction that CAP
drugs be shipped directly to the
participating CAP physician, as stated
in § 414.906(a)(4), and that participating
CAP physicians may not transport CAP
drugs from one location to another, as
stated in § 414.908(a)(3)(xii). However,
we were aware that physicians may
desire to administer drugs in alternative
settings. Therefore, in the July 6, 2005
IFC, we sought comment on how this
could be accommodated under the CAP
in a way that addresses the potential
vendors’ concerns about product
integrity and damage to the approved
CAP vendors’ property (70 FR 39048).
We discussed comments submitted in
response to the July 6, 2005 IFC in the
CY 2008 PFS proposed rule (72 FR
38158). We also requested comments in
the CY 2008 PFS proposed rule (72 FR
38157) on the potential feasibility of
easing the restriction on transporting
CAP drugs where this is permitted by
State law and other applicable laws and
regulations. We responded to submitted
comments in the CY 2008 PFS final rule
with comment period (72 FR 66268).
In the CY 2009 PFS proposed rule (70
FR 38523), we proposed to permit the
transportation of CAP drug between a
participating CAP physician’s practice
locations subject to voluntary
agreements between the approved CAP
vendor and the participating CAP
physician. Because of the 2009 CAP
postponement, we did not address this
issue in the CY 2009 PFS final rule.
However, we did receive the following
comments in response to our proposed
rule on easing transportation restrictions
in the CAP:
• Many commenters indicated that
this change would increase program
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
flexibility and facilitate patient
treatment.
• Some commenters were supportive,
but also raised concerns about drug
integrity and liability, and requested
that appropriate safeguards be in place
before transportation restrictions were
eased.
• Generally, commenters wanted
CMS to explicitly delineate standards
about voluntary agreements that address
concerns about product integrity,
liability, transportation procedures, and
documentation. One commenter
indicated that such standards should be
developed through a separate
rulemaking period to allow for public
comment.
• Several commenters cited State
pedigree laws as possible impediments
to physician transport of drugs.
We also requested and received
feedback about the program during the
2009 postponement period. One
member of the potential vendor
community urged us to be mindful of
increased legal liability for an approved
CAP vendor if this policy were to be
implemented, but also acknowledged
that the proposal might substantially
increase physician interest in the
program.
We continue to be mindful of the
concerns expressed by the commenters,
and have evaluated both the advantages
and disadvantages of easing the
restriction on transportation of CAP
drugs. Thus, we are again proposing to
permit transport of CAP drug between a
participating CAP physician’s practice
locations subject to voluntary
agreements between the approved CAP
vendor and the participating CAP
physician. As indicated in our CY 2009
PFS proposed rule, we continue to
propose that such agreements must
comply with all applicable State and
Federal laws and regulations and
product liability requirements, and be
documented in writing.
We would again like to reiterate the
voluntary nature of these proposed
agreements. Approved CAP vendors
would not be required to offer and
participating CAP physicians would not
be required to accept such agreements
when selecting an approved CAP
vendor. An approved CAP vendor may
not refuse to do business with a
participating CAP physician because the
participating CAP physician has
declined to enter into such an
agreement with the approved CAP
vendor. Furthermore, we are not seeking
to define which CAP drugs may be
subject to the proposed voluntary
agreements. In other words, each
approved CAP vendor could specify
PO 00000
Frm 00114
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
which CAP drug(s) could be
transported.
However, our proposal continues to
contain certain limitations. In previous
rulemaking, we have described
requirements for voluntary agreements
between approved CAP vendors and
participating CAP physicians. In the
July 6, 2005 IFC (70 FR 39050) and the
CY 2006 PFS final rule (70 FR 70251
through 70252), we stated that we will
not dictate the breadth of use or the
specific obligations contained in
voluntary arrangements between
approved CAP vendors and
participating CAP physicians, other
than to note that they must comply with
applicable law and to prohibit approved
CAP vendors from coercing
participating CAP physicians into
entering any of these arrangements.
Parties to such arrangements must also
ensure that the arrangements do not
violate the physician self-referral
(‘‘Stark’’) prohibition (section 1877 of
the Act), the Federal anti-kickback
statute (section 1128B(b) of the Act), or
any other Federal or State law or
regulation governing billing or claims
submission. We are proposing to apply
these standards to any agreement for the
transport of CAP drugs.
We remain concerned about
opportunities for disruption in the
drug’s chain of custody and appropriate
storage and handling conditions that
may ultimately affect patient care or
increase the risk of drug theft or
diversion. Therefore, in order to
maintain safety and drug integrity in the
CAP and to protect against the
fraudulent diversion of CAP drugs, we
are reproposing that any voluntary
agreements between an approved CAP
vendor and a participating CAP
physician regarding the transportation
of CAP drug must include requirements
that drugs are not subjected to
conditions that will jeopardize their
integrity, stability, and/or sterility while
being transported. We again welcome
comments on these issues, including the
identification of who may transport the
drugs, how documentation of
transportation activities could be
accomplished, and how the oversight of
such agreements will be carried out.
In conclusion, we believe that this
proposal to ease the restriction on
transporting CAP drugs between a
participating CAP physician’s practice
locations—when agreed upon by the
participating CAP physician and the
approved CAP vendor—will make the
CAP more flexible and ultimately more
appealing to participating CAP
physicians. Additionally, we believe
that this proposal will facilitate the
participation of CAP physicians who
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
have office locations in rural areas and/
or have satellite offices with limited
hours. Moreover, we believe that this
proposal will promote beneficiary care,
particularly for beneficiaries who live in
rural locations. Since participating CAP
physicians would be able to transport
CAP drugs to another office location in
accordance with a voluntary agreement
with their approved CAP vendor,
beneficiaries would have more
flexibility in scheduling the location of
their appointments. We invite
comments about this proposal.
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
(3) Dispute Resolution Process
In the CY 2009 PFS proposed rule (73
FR 38524 through 38525), we discussed
two changes to the CAP dispute
resolution process. Section
1847B(b)(2)(A)(ii)(II) of the Act requires
an approved CAP vendor to have a
grievance and appeals process for the
resolution of disputes. In the July 6,
2005 IFC (70 FR 39054 through 39058),
we described the process for the
resolution of participating CAP
physicians’ drug quality and service
complaints and approved CAP vendors’
complaints regarding noncompliant
participating CAP physicians. We
encouraged participating CAP
physicians, beneficiaries, and vendors
to use informal communication as a first
step to resolve service-related
administration issues. However, we
recognized that certain disputes would
require a more structured approach, and
therefore, we established processes
under § 414.916 and § 414.917.
(i) Approved CAP Vendor’s Status
During the Reconsideration Process
Section 414.917 outlines the dispute
resolution process for participating CAP
physicians. As discussed in the July 6,
2005 IFC (70 FR 39057 through 39058),
if a participating CAP physician finds
an approved CAP vendor’s service or
the quality of a CAP drug supplied by
the approved CAP vendor to be
unsatisfactory, then the physician may
address the issues first through the
approved CAP vendor’s grievance
process, and second through an
alternative dispute resolution process
administered by the designated carrier
and CMS. In turn, the designated carrier
would gather information about the
issue as outlined in § 414.917(b)(2) and
make a recommendation to CMS on
whether the approved CAP vendor has
been meeting the service and quality
obligations of its CAP contract. We
would then review and act on that
recommendation after gathering any
necessary, additional information from
the participating CAP physician and
approved CAP vendor. If we suspend an
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
approved CAP vendor’s CAP contract
for noncompliance or terminate the CAP
contract in accordance with
§ 414.914(a), the approved CAP vendor
may request a reconsideration in
accordance with § 414.917(c).
In the July 6, 2005 IFC (70 FR 39058),
we indicated that the approved CAP
vendor’s participation in the CAP would
be suspended while the approved CAP
vendor’s appeal of our decision is
pending. This suspended status is also
implied in § 414.917(c)(9), which states
that the ‘‘approved CAP vendor may
resume participation in CAP’’ if the
final reconsideration determination is
favorable to the approved CAP vendor.
In order to improve the clarity of our
regulations, we proposed in the CY 2009
PFS proposed rule that the approved
CAP vendor’s contract will remain
suspended during the reconsideration
period in § 414.917 (73 FR 38525). We
believed that this proposed technical
change is consistent with basic
contracting concepts and with our
current practices for the CAP. This
proposal was not finalized due to the
2009 CAP postponement.
Comments submitted in response to
our CY 2009 PFS proposed rule
supported this proposed clarification
and we did not receive additional
feedback about this issue after the CAP
was postponed. Based on this and our
continued need to improve the clarity of
our regulations, we are reproposing that
the approved CAP vendor’s contract
will remain suspended during the
reconsideration period in § 414.917. We
invite additional comments regarding
this proposed issue.
(ii) Termination of CAP Drug Shipments
to Suspended CAP Physicians
Section 414.916 provides a
mechanism for approved CAP vendors
to address noncompliance problems
with participating CAP physicians. As
stated at § 414.916(a), ‘‘Cases of an
approved CAP vendor’s dissatisfaction
with denied drug claims are resolved
through a voluntary alternative dispute
resolution process delivered by the
designated carrier, and a
reconsideration process provided by
CMS.’’ Once the decision is made to
suspend a participating CAP physician’s
CAP election agreement, the
participating CAP physician will be
suspended from the CAP as described in
§ 414.916(b)(3).
Physicians whose participation in the
CAP has been suspended are not eligible
to receive CAP drugs. This is implied in
§ 414.906(a)(4), which speaks of
approved CAP vendors providing CAP
drugs directly to ‘‘[a] participating CAP
physician.’’ However, we believe that
PO 00000
Frm 00115
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33633
the clarity of our dispute resolution
regulations would be improved if this
drug delivery issue were stated
explicitly. Therefore, in the CY 2009
PFS proposed rule, we proposed to
revise § 414.916 to specify that
approved CAP vendors shall not deliver
CAP drugs to participating CAP
physicians whose participation in the
CAP has been suspended after an initial
determination by CMS. Our proposal
also applied to physicians engaged in
the reconsideration process outlined in
§ 414.916(c) and included a conforming
change at § 414.914(f)(12). We believed
that these changes were in accord with
the underlying intent of § 414.916,
namely to provide a mechanism for
approved CAP vendors to address
noncompliance problems with
participating CAP physicians, and we
believe that these changes will increase
the clarity of our regulations. We also
noted that the participating CAP
physicians who are suspended from
participation in the CAP will be able to
obtain drugs and bill for them under the
ASP payment system provided they
have not been excluded from
participation in Medicare and/or their
billing privileges have not been revoked.
Comments submitted in response to
the CY 2009 PFS proposed rule agreed
with our proposal. Though we did not
finalize this proposal due to the 2009
CAP postponement, we received no
comments from the public in response
to our request for feedback during the
CAP 2009 postponement. Based on
positive public feedback and our
continued belief that the clarity of our
dispute resolution regulations would be
improved by being explicit about this
issue, we are reproposing to revise
§ 414.916 to specify that approved CAP
vendors shall not deliver CAP drugs to
participating CAP physicians whose
participation in the CAP has been
suspended after an initial determination
by CMS. This suspension in drug
shipment would also apply to
physicians engaged in the
reconsideration process outlined in
§ 414.916(c). We have also proposed a
conforming change to § 414.914(f)(12).
Physicians who are suspended from
participation in the CAP will be able to
obtain drugs and bill for them under the
ASP payment system provided they
have not been excluded from
participation in Medicare and/or their
billing privileges have not been revoked.
We welcome comments on this
proposal.
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33634
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
I. Provisions Related to Payment for
Renal Dialysis Services Furnished by
End-Stage Renal Disease (ESRD)
Facilities
Since August 1, 1983, payment for
dialysis services furnished by end-stage
renal disease (ESRD) facilities has been
based on a composite rate payment
system that provides a fixed,
prospectively determined amount per
dialysis treatment, adjusted for
geographic differences in area wage
levels. In accordance with section
1881(b)(7) of the Act, separate
composite rates were established for
hospital-based and independent ESRD
facilities. The composite rate is
designed to cover a package of goods
and services needed to furnish dialysis
treatments that include, but not be
limited to, certain routinely provided
drugs, laboratory tests, supplies, and
equipment. Unless specifically included
in the composite rate, other injectable
drugs and laboratory tests medically
necessary for the care of the dialysis
patient are separately billable. Effective
on August 1, 1983, the base composite
rates per treatment were $123 for
independent ESRD facilities and $127
for hospital-based ESRD facilities. The
Congress has enacted a number of
adjustments to the composite rate since
that time.
Section 623 of the MMA amended
section 1881 of the Act to require
changes to the composite rate payment
methodology, as well as to the pricing
methodology for separately billable
drugs and biologicals furnished by
ESRD facilities. Section 1881(b)(12) of
the Act, as added by section 623(d) of
the MMA, requires the establishment of
a basic case-mix adjusted composite
payment system that includes services
comprising the composite rate and an
add-on to the composite rate component
to account for the difference between
current payments for separately billed
drugs and the revised drug pricing
specified in the statute. In addition,
section 1881(b)(12) of the Act requires
that the composite rate be adjusted for
a number of patient characteristics
(case-mix) and section 1881(b)(12)(D) of
the Act gives the Secretary discretion to
revise the wage indices and the urban
and rural definitions used to develop
them. Finally, section 1881(b)(12)(E) of
the Act imposes a budget neutrality
(BN) adjustment, so that aggregate
payments under the basic case-mix
adjusted composite payment system for
CY 2005 equal the aggregate payments
for the same period if section
1881(b)(12) of the Act did not apply.
Before January 1, 2005, payment to
both independent and hospital-based
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
facilities for the anti-anemia drug,
erythropoietin (EPO) was established
under section 1881(b)(11) of the Act at
$10.00 per 1,000 units. For independent
ESRD facilities, payment for all other
separately billable drugs and biologicals
is based on the lower of actual charges
or 95 percent of the average wholesale
price (AWP). Hospital-based ESRD
facilities were paid based on the
reasonable cost methodology for
separately billed drugs and biologicals
(other than EPO) furnished to dialysis
patients. Changes to the payment
methodology for separately billed ESRD
drugs and biologicals that were
established by the MMA affected
payments in both CY 2005 and CY 2006.
1. CY 2005 Revisions
In the CY 2005 PFS final rule with
comment period (69 FR 66319 through
66334), we implemented section 1881(b)
of the Act, as amended by section 623
of the MMA, and revised payments to
ESRD facilities. These revisions were
effective January 1, 2005, and included
an update of 1.6 percent to the
composite rate component of the
payment system; and a drug add-on
adjustment of 8.7 percent to the
composite rate to account for the
difference between pre-MMA payments
for separately billable drugs and
payments based on revised drug pricing
for 2005 which used acquisition costs.
Effective April 1, 2005, the CY 2005 PFS
final rule with comment period also
implemented case-mix adjustments to
the composite rate for certain patient
characteristics (that is, age, low body
mass index, and body surface area).
In addition, to implement section
1881(b)(13) of the Act, we revised
payments for drugs billed separately by
independent ESRD facilities, paying for
the top 10 ESRD drugs based on
acquisition costs (as determined by the
OIG) and for other separately billed
drugs at the average sales price +6
percent (hereafter referred to as ASP+6
percent). Hospital-based ESRD
providers continued to receive costbased payments for all separately
billable drugs and biologicals except for
EPO which was paid based on average
acquisition cost.
2. CY 2006 Revisions
In the CY 2006 PFS final rule with
comment period (70 FR 70161), we
implemented additional revisions to
payments to ESRD facilities under
section 623 of the MMA. For CY 2006,
we further revised the drug payment
methodology applicable to drugs
furnished by ESRD facilities. All
separately billed drugs and biologicals
furnished by both hospital-based and
PO 00000
Frm 00116
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
independent ESRD facilities are now
paid based on ASP+6 percent.
We recalculated the 2005 drug add-on
adjustment to reflect the difference in
payments between the pre-MMA AWP
pricing and the revised pricing based on
ASP+6 percent. The recalculation did
not affect the actual add-on adjustment
applied to payments in 2005, but
provided an estimate of what the
adjustment would have been had the
2006 payment methodology been in
effect in CY 2005. The drug add-on
adjustment was then updated to reflect
the expected growth in expenditures for
separately billable drugs in CY 2006.
As of January 1, 2006, we also
implemented a revised geographic
adjustment authorized by section
1881(b)(12) of the Act. As part of that
change, we—
• Revised the labor market areas to
incorporate the Core-Based Statistical
Area (CBSA) designations established
by the Office of Management and
Budget (OMB);
• Eliminated the wage index ceiling
and reduced the floor to 0.8500; and
• Revised the labor portion of the
composite rate to which the geographic
adjustment is applied.
We also provided a 4-year transition
from the previous wage-adjusted
composite rates to the current wageadjusted rates. For CY 2006, 25 percent
of the payment was based on the revised
geographic adjustments, and the
remaining 75 percent of payment was
based on the old metropolitan statistical
area-based (MSA-based) payments.
In addition, section 5106 of the DRA
provided for a 1.6 percent update to the
composite rate component of the basic
case-mix adjusted composite payment
system, effective January 1, 2006. As a
result, the base composite rate was
increased to $130.40 for independent
ESRD facilities and $134.53 for hospitalbased providers. For 2006, the drug addon adjustment (including the growth
update) was 14.5 percent.
3. CY 2007 Updates In the CY 2007 PFS
final rule with comment period (71 FR
69681), we implemented the following
updates to the basic case-mix adjusted
composite payment system:
• An update to the wage index
adjustments to reflect the latest hospital
wage data, including a BN adjustment of
1.052818 to the wage index for CY 2007.
• A method to annually calculate the
growth update to the drug add-on
adjustment required by section
1881(b)(12) of the Act, as well as a
growth update to the drug add-on
adjustment of 0.5 percent for CY 2007.
Therefore, effective January 1, 2007 the
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
drug add-on adjustment was increased
to 15.1 percent.
In addition, section 103 of the MIEATRHCA established a 1.6 percent update
to the composite rate portion of the
payment system, effective April 1, 2007.
As a result, the current base composite
rate was $132.49 for independent
facilities and $136.68 for hospital-based
providers. Also, the effect of this
increase in the composite rate portion of
the payment system was a reduction in
the drug add-on adjustment to 14.9
percent, effective April 1, 2007. Since
the statutory increase only applied to
the composite rate, an adjustment to the
drug add-on percent was needed to
maintain the drug add-on amount
constant.
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
4. CY 2008 Updates
In the CY 2008 PFS final rule with
comment period (72 FR 66280), we
implemented the following updates to
the basic case-mix adjusted payment
system:
• A growth update to the drug add-on
adjustment of 0.5 percent. As a result,
the drug add-on adjustment to the
composite payment rate increased from
14.9 percent to 15.5 percent.
• An update to the wage index
adjustments to reflect the latest hospital
wage data, including a wage index BN
adjustment of 1.055473 to the wage
index for CY 2008.
For CY 2008, consistent with the
transition blends announced in the CY
2006 PFS final rule with comment
period (70 FR 70170), we implemented
the third year of the transition to the
CBSA-based wage index. In addition,
the wage index floor was reduced from
0.8000 to 0.7500. After applying the
wage index BN adjustment of 1.055473,
the wage index floor was 0.7916.
5. CY 2009 Updates
Subsequent to the July 7, 2008
publication of the CY 2009 PFS
proposed rule, section 153 of the MIPPA
mandated changes in ESRD payment
including a 1 percent increase to the
composite rate, effective for services
furnished on or after January 1, 2009
and 2010 and before January 1, 2010.
Specifically, section 153(a) of the
MIPPA updated sections 1881(b)(12)(G)
and 1881(b)(12)(A) of the Act to revised
payments to ESRD facilities. The
revisions that were effective January 1,
2009, included the update of 1 percent
to the composite rate component of the
payment system noted above, and the
establishment of a site neutral
composite rate for both hospital-based
and independent dialysis facilities that
reflected the labor share based on the
labor share otherwise applied to
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
independent dialysis facilities. The
labor share for both hospital-based and
independent dialysis facilities was
53.711. In the CY 2009 final rule with
comment period (73 69754 through
69761), we implemented the following
updates to the basic case-mix adjusted
composite payment system:
• As required by updated sections
1881(b)(12)(G) and 1881(b)(12)(A) of the
Act, we applied a 1 percent increase to
the independent dialysis facility’s CY
2008 composite rate of $132.49, which
resulted in a CY 2009 base composite
rate for both hospital-based and
independent dialysis facilities of
$133.81;
• A zero growth update to the drug
add-on adjustment of 15.2 percent to the
composite rates for 2009 as required by
section 1881(b)(1)(F) of the Act (resulted
in a $20.33 per treatment drug add-on
amount);
Prior to MIPPA, the proposed drug
add-on adjustment was 15.5 percent.
Since we compute the drug add-on
adjustment as a percentage of the
weighted average base composite rate,
the effect of the one percent increase in
the composite rate portion of the
payment system, effective January 1,
2009, reduced the drug add-on
adjustment from 15.5 to 15.2 percent.
Since the statutory increase only
applied to the composite rate, this
adjustment to the drug add-on percent
was needed to ensure that the total drug
add-on dollars remained constant.
• An update to the wage index
adjustment to reflect the latest available
wage data, including a wage index BN
adjustment of 1.056672 to the wage
index for CY 2009;
• For CY 2009, the completion of the
4-year transition from the previous
wage-adjusted composite rates to the
CBSA wage-adjusted rates, where
payment is based on 100 percent of the
revised geographic adjustments; and
• A reduction of the wage index floor
from 0.7500 to 0.7000. After applying
the wage index BN adjustment of
1.056672, the wage index floor was
0.7397.
6. CY 2010 Proposals
For CY 2010, we are proposing the
following updates to the composite rate
payment system:
• An update to the drug add-on
adjustment to the composite rate, using
a refined methodology for projecting
growth in drug expenditures;
• An update to the wage index
adjustment to reflect the latest available
wage data, including a revised BN
adjustment; and
• A reduction to the ESRD wage
index floor from 0.7000 to 0.6500.
PO 00000
Frm 00117
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33635
As stated above, section
1881(b)(12)(G)(iv) of the Act, as added
by section 153(a)(1) of the MIPPA,
increased the composite rate by 1.0
percent for ESRD services furnished on
or after January 1, 2010. The 1.0 percent
increases the current composite rate of
$133.81 to $135.15 for services
furnished on or after January 1, 2010.
a. Proposed Update to the Drug Add-on
Adjustment to the Composite Rate
Section 623(d) of the MMA added
section 1881(b)(12)(B)(ii) of the Act
which requires establishing an add-on
to the composite rate to account for
changes in the drug payment
methodology stemming from enactment
of the MMA. Section 1881(b)(12)(C) of
the Act provides that the drug add-on
must reflect the difference in aggregate
payments between the revised drug
payment methodology for separately
billable ESRD drugs and the AWP
payment methodology. In 2005, we
generally paid for ESRD drugs based on
average acquisition costs. Thus the
difference from AWP pricing was
calculated using acquisition costs.
However, in 2006 when we moved to
ASP pricing for ESRD drugs, we
recalculated the difference from AWP
pricing using ASP prices.
In addition, section 1881(b)(12)(F) of
the Act requires that, beginning in CY
2006, we establish an annual increase to
the drug add-on to reflect estimated
growth in expenditures for separately
billable drugs and biologicals furnished
by ESRD facilities. This growth update
applies only to the drug add-on portion
of the case-mix adjusted payment
system. The CY 2009 drug add-on
adjustment to the composite rate was
15.2 percent. The drug add-on
adjustment for CY 2009 reflected a zero
increase. This computation is explained
in detail below and in the CY 2009 PFS
final rule with comment period (73 FR
69755 through 69757).
(i) Estimating Growth in Expenditures
for Drugs and Biologicals for CY 2009
Section 1881(b)(12)(F) of the Act
specifies that the drug add-on increase
must reflect ‘‘the estimated growth in
expenditures for drugs and biologicals
(including erythropoietin) that are
separately billable * * *’’ By referring
to ‘‘expenditures’’, we stated previously
that we believe the statute contemplates
that the update would account for both
increases in drug prices, as well as
increases in utilization of those drugs.
In the CY 2007 PFS final rule with
comment period (71 FR 69682), we
established an interim methodology for
annually estimating the growth in ESRD
drugs and biological expenditures that
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33636
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
uses the Producer Price Index (PPI) for
pharmaceuticals as a proxy for pricing
growth in conjunction with 2 years of
ESRD drug data to estimate per patient
utilization growth. We indicated that
this interim methodology would be used
to update the drug add-on to the
composite rate until such time that we
had sufficient ESRD drug expenditure
data to project the growth in ESRD drug
expenditures.
However, due to the declining ASP
prices, we no longer believed that using
the PPI as a proxy for pricing growth
was appropriate. Accordingly, for CY
2009, we revised the interim
methodology for estimating the growth
in ESRD drug expenditures by using
ASP pricing to estimate the price
component of the update calculation.
Due to the declining trend in ASP
pricing and utilization, we calculated a
decrease in the drug add-on adjustment,
and applied a zero update to the drug
add-on adjustment (73 FR 69755
through 69757).
(ii) Estimating Growth in Expenditures
for Drugs and Biologicals in CY 2010
Since we now have 3 years of drug
expenditure data based on ASP pricing,
we have reevaluated our methodology
for estimating growth in drug
expenditures. We believe that 3 years of
drug expenditure data based on ASP
pricing is sufficient to project drug
expenditure growth based on trend
analysis. Therefore, for CY 2010, we are
proposing to use trend analysis from
drug expenditure data to update the per
treatment drug add-on adjustment. In
the CY 2008 PFS final rule with
comment period, we stated that when
we had 3 consecutive years of ASPbased historical drug expenditure data,
we intended to reevaluate our
methodology for estimating growth in
drug add-on adjustment (72 FR 66281).
We also stated that we expected 2010
would be the earliest we could consider
using trend analysis to update the drug
add-on adjustment (72 FR 66281).
For CY 2010, we propose to estimate
per patient growth in drug expenditures
by removing growth in ESRD enrollment
from growth in total drug expenditures.
To estimate drug expenditure growth
using trend analysis, we looked at the
average annual growth in total drug
expenditures between 2006 and 2008.
First we had to estimate the total drug
expenditures for all ESRD facilities in
CY 2008. For this proposed rule, we
used the final CY 2006 and the final CY
2007 ESRD claims data and the latest
available CY 2008 ESRD facility claims,
updated through December 31, 2008
(that is, claims with dates of service
from January 1 through December 31,
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
2008, that were received, processed,
paid, and passed to the National Claims
History File as of December 31, 2008).
For the CY 2010 PFS final rule, we plan
to use additional updated CY 2008
claims with dates of service for the same
timeframe. This updated CY 2008 data
file will include claims received,
processed, paid, and passed to the
National Claims History File as of June
30, 2009.
While the December 2008 update of
CY 2008 claims used in this proposed
rule is the most current available claims
data, we recognize that it does not
reflect a complete year, as claims with
dates of service towards the end of the
year have not all been processed. To
more accurately estimate the update to
the drug add-on, aggregate drug
expenditures are required. Based on an
analysis of the 2007 claims data, we
inflated the CY 2008 drug expenditures
to estimate the June 30, 2009 update of
the 2008 claims file. We used the
relationship between the December
2007 and the June 2008 versions of 2007
claims to estimate the more complete
2008 claims that will be available in
June 2009 and applied that ratio to the
2008 claims data from the December
2008 claims file. In previous years, we
did this separately for EPO, the other
top 10 Part B separately billable drugs,
and the remaining separately billable
drugs for independent and hospitalbased ESRD facilities. All components
were then combined to estimate
aggregate CY 2008 ESRD drug
expenditures. However, we do not
believe that creating this estimate using
this level of detail (by separately
estimating EPO, the other top 10
separately billable drugs, and the
remaining separately billable drug for
independent and hospital-based ESRD
facilities and then combining these
components) provides more accuracy.
For this reason, we are making this
adjustment in aggregate for all
separately billable drugs for CY 2008
ESRD drug expenditures. The net
adjustment to the CY 2008 claims data
is an increase of 11.1 percent to the
2008 expenditure data. This adjustment
allows us to more accurately compare
the 2007 and 2008 drug expenditure
data to estimate per patient growth. As
stated earlier in this section, we plan to
use additional updated CY 2008 claims
in the CY 2010 PFS final rule with
comment period. We also note that the
top 11 drugs continue to represent 99.7
percent of total expenditures in CY 2008
for separately billable drugs furnished to
ESRD patients.
Using the full-year 2008 drug
expenditure figure, we calculated the
average annual change in drug
PO 00000
Frm 00118
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
expenditures from 2006 through 2008.
This average annual change showed a
decrease of 2.2 percent for this
timeframe. We propose to use this 2.2
percent decrease to project drug
expenditures for both 2009 and 2010.
(iii) Estimating Per Patient Growth
Once we had the projected growth in
drug expenditures from 2009 to 2010,
we then removed growth in enrollment
for the same time period from the
expenditure growth, so that the residual
reflects per patient expenditure growth,
(which includes price and utilization
combined) which is what we believe
that section 1881(b)(12)(F) of the Act
requires us to use to update the drug
add-on adjustment. As we described in
section II.I.6.a.(ii) of this proposed rule,
we now have 3 years of drug
expenditure data based on ASP pricing,
and for CY 2010 we are proposing to use
trend analysis from this data to update
the per treatment drug add-on
adjustment. To calculate the per patient
growth between CYs 2009 and 2010, we
removed the enrollment component by
using the estimated growth in
enrollment data between CY 2009 and
CY 2010. This was approximately 1.3
percent. To do this, we divided the total
drug expenditure change between 2009
and 2010 (1.000–0.222 = 0.978) by
enrollment growth of 1.3 percent (1.013)
for the same timeframe. The result is a
per patient growth factor equal to 0.965,
(0.978/1.013 = 0.965). Thus we are
projecting a 3.5 percent decrease in per
patient growth in drug expenditures
between 2009 and 2010.
b. Applying the Proposed Growth
Update to the Drug Add-On Adjustment
In CY 2006, we applied the projected
growth update percentage to the total
amount of drug add-on dollars
established for CY 2005 to establish a
dollar amount for the CY 2006 growth
update. In addition, we projected the
growth in dialysis treatments for CY
2006 based on the projected growth in
ESRD enrollment. We divided the
projected total dollar amount of the CY
2006 growth by the projected growth in
total dialysis treatments to develop the
per treatment growth update amount.
This growth update amount, combined
with the CY 2005 per treatment drug
add-on amount, resulted in an average
drug add-on amount per treatment of
$18.88 (or a 14.5 percent adjustment to
the composite rate) for CY 2006.
In the CY 2007 PFS final rule with
comment period (71 FR 69684), we
revised our update methodology by
applying the growth update to the per
treatment drug add-on amount. That is,
for CY 2007, we applied the growth
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
update factor of 4.03 percent to the
$18.88 per treatment drug add-on
amount for an updated amount of
$19.64 per treatment (71 FR 69684). For
CY 2008, the per treatment drug add-on
amount was updated to $20.33. In the
CY 2009 PFS final rule with comment
period (73 FR 69755 through 69757), we
applied a zero update to per treatment
drug add-on amount which left it at
$20.33. As discussed in detail below, for
CY 2010, we are again proposing no
update to the per treatment drug add-on
amount of $20.33 established in CY
2008.
c. Proposed Update to the Drug Add-on
Adjustment
As discussed previously in this
section, we estimate a 2.2 percent
reduction in drug expenditures between
CY 2009 and CY 2010. Combining this
reduction with a 1.3 percent increase in
enrollment, as described in section
(a)(iii) above, we are projecting a 3.5
percent decrease in per patient growth
of drug expenditures between CY 2009
and CY 2010. Therefore, we are
projecting that the combined growth in
per patient utilization and pricing for
CY 2010 would result in a negative
update equal to ¥3.5 percent. However,
similar to last year and as indicated
above, we are proposing a zero update
to the drug add-on adjustment.
We believe this approach is consistent
with the language under section
1881(b)(12)(F) of the Act which states in
part that ‘‘the Secretary shall annually
increase’’ the drug add-on amount based
on the growth in expenditures for
separately billed ESRD drugs. Our
understanding of the statute
contemplates ‘‘annually increase’’ to
mean a positive or zero update to the
drug add-on. Therefore, we propose to
apply a zero update, and to maintain the
$20.33 per treatment drug add-on
amount for CY 2010. The current $20.33
per treatment drug add-on reflected a
15.2 percent drug add-on adjustment to
the composite rate in effect for CY 2009.
Given that the MIPPA mandates a 1
percent increase to the composite rate
(effective January 1, 2010), however, as
discussed earlier in this section, this
results in a decrease in the CY 2009
drug add-on adjustment of 15.2 to 15.0
to keep the drug add-on at $20.33.
Therefore, we are proposing that the
drug add-on adjustment to the
composite rate for CY 2010 is 15.0
percent.
d. Proposed Update to the Geographic
Adjustments to the Composite Rate
Section 1881(b)(12)(D) of the Act, as
amended by section 623(d) of the MMA,
gives the Secretary the authority to
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
revise the wage indexes previously
applied to the ESRD composite rate. The
purpose of the wage index is to adjust
the composite rates for differing wage
levels covering the areas in which ESRD
facilities are located. The wage indexes
are calculated for each urban and rural
area. In the CY 2006 PFS final rule with
comment period (70 FR 70167), we
announced our adoption of the OMB
CBSA-based geographic area
designations to develop revised urban/
rural definitions and corresponding
wage index values for purposes of
calculating ESRD composite rates. In
addition, we generally have followed
wage index policies related to these
definitions as used under the inpatient
hospital prospective payment system
(IPPS), but without regard to any
approved geographic reclassification
authorized under sections 1886(d)(8)
and (d)(10) of the Act or other
provisions that only apply to hospitals
paid under the IPPS (70 FR 70167). For
purposes of the ESRD wage index
methodology, the hospital wage data we
use is pre-classified, pre-floor hospital
data and unadjusted for occupational
mix.
e. Proposed Updates to Core-Based
Statistical Area (CBSA) Definitions
In the CY 2006 PFS final rule with
comment period (70 FR 70167), we
announced our adoption of the OMB’s
CBSA-based geographic area
designations to develop revised urban/
rural definitions and corresponding
wage index values for purposes of
calculating ESRD composite rates. The
CBSA-based geographic area
designations are described in OMB
Bulletin 03–04, originally issued June 6,
2003, and is available online at https://
www.whitehouse.gov/omb/bulletins/
b03-04.html. In addition, OMB has
published subsequent bulletins
regarding CBSA changes, including
changes in CBSA numbers and titles.
We wish to point out that this and all
subsequent ESRD rules and notices are
considered to incorporate the CBSA
changes published in the most recent
OMB bulletin that applies to the
hospital wage index used to determine
the current ESRD wage index. The OMB
bulletins may be accessed online at
https://www.whitehouse.gov/omb/
bulletins/.
f. Proposed Updated Wage Index Values
In the CY 2007 PFS final rule with
comment period (71 FR 69685), we
stated that we intended to update the
ESRD wage index values annually. The
ESRD wage index values for CY 2010
were developed from FY 2006 wage and
employment data obtained from the
PO 00000
Frm 00119
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33637
Medicare hospital cost reports. As we
indicated, the ESRD wage index values
are calculated without regard to
geographic classifications authorized
under sections 1886(d)(8) and (d)(10) of
the Act and utilize pre-floor hospital
data that is unadjusted for occupational
mix. We propose to use the same
methodology for CY 2010, with the
exception that FY 2006 hospital data
would be used to develop the CY 2010
wage index values. For a detailed
description of the development of the
proposed CY 2010 wage index values
based on FY 2006 hospital data, see the
FY 2010 IPPS proposed rule (74 FR
24145). Section III.G, of the preamble to
the FY 2010 IPPS proposed rule,
‘‘Method for Computing the Proposed
FY 2010 Unadjusted Wage Index’’,
describes the cost report schedules, line
items, data elements, adjustments, and
wage index computations. The wage
index data affecting the ESRD composite
rate for each urban and rural locale may
also be accessed on the CMS Web site
at https://www.cms.hhs.gov/
AcuteInpatientPPS/WIFN/list.asp. The
wage data are located in the section
entitled, ‘‘FY 2010 Proposed Rule
Occupational Mix Adjusted and
Unadjusted Average Hourly Wage and
Pre-reclassified Wage Index by CBSA.’’
In the CY 2009 final rule with
comment period (73 FR 69758 and
69759), we indicated that the CY 2009
was the final year of the transition
period and each ESRD facility’s
composite payment rate would be based
entirely on its applicable CBSA-based
wage index value.
g. Proposed Reduction to the ESRD
Wage Index Floor
In the CY 2009 PFS final rule with
comment period, we stated our
intention to continue to reassess the
need for a wage index floor (73 FR
63758). We also stated that a gradual
reduction in the floor is needed to
support continuing patient access to
dialysis in areas that have low wage
index values, especially in Puerto Rico
where the wage index values are below
the current wage index floor. For CY
2010, we are proposing to reduce the
wage index floor from 0.70 to 0.65. We
also anticipate that we may reduce the
floor gradually until full
implementation of the ESRD PPS
required by section 1881(b)(14) of the
Act.
h. Proposed Wage index Values for
Areas With No Hospital Data
In CY 2006, while adopting the CBSA
designations, we identified a small
number of ESRD facilities in both urban
and rural geographic areas where there
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33638
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
are no hospital wage data from which to
calculate ESRD wage index values. The
affected areas were rural Puerto Rico,
and the urban area of Hinesville, GA
(CBSA 25980), and rural Massachusetts.
For CY 2006, CY 2007, CY 2008, and CY
2009, we calculated the ESRD wage
index values for those areas as follows:
• For the urban area of Hinesville,
GA, we calculated the CY 2006, CY
2007, CY 2008, and CY 2009 wage index
value based on the average wage index
value for all urban areas within the State
of Georgia.
• For rural Massachusetts, because
we had not determined a reasonable
wage proxy, we used the FY 2005 wage
index value in CY 2006 and CY 2007.
As discussed below, we adopted an
alternative methodology for CYs 2008
and 2009.
• For rural Puerto Rico, because all
geographic areas in Puerto Rico were
subject to the wage index floor in CYs
2006 through 2009, we applied the
ESRD wage index floor to rural Puerto
Rico as well. We note that there are
currently no ESRD facilities located in
rural Puerto Rico.
For CY 2008, we adopted an
alternative methodology for establishing
a wage index value for rural
Massachusetts and continued to apply
this methodology in CY 2009. Because
we used the same wage index value for
2 years with no update, we believed it
was appropriate to establish a
methodology which employed
reasonable proxy data for rural areas
(including rural Massachusetts) and also
permitted annual updates to the wage
index based on that proxy data. For
rural areas without hospital wage data,
we used the average wage index values
from all contiguous CBSAs as a
reasonable proxy for that rural area.
In determining the imputed rural
wage index, we interpreted the term
‘‘contiguous’’ to mean sharing a border.
In the case of Massachusetts, the entire
rural area consists of Dukes and
Nantucket Counties. We determined
that the borders of Dukes and Nantucket
counties are contiguous with CBSA
12700, Barnstable Town, MA and CBSA
39300, Providence-New Bedford-Fall
River, RI–MA. We are proposing to use
the same methodology for CY 2010.
Under this methodology, the CY 2010
proposed wage index values for CBSA
12700 (Barnstable Town, MA—1.2629)
and CBSA 39300 (Providence-New
Bedford-Fall River, RI–MA—1.0792)
averages results in an imputed proposed
wage index value of 1.1711 for rural
Massachusetts in CY 2010.
For rural Puerto Rico, for CY 2010, all
areas in Puerto Rico that have a wage
index are eligible for the proposed ESRD
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
wage index floor of 0.65. Therefore, we
propose to continue applying the
proposed ESRD wage index floor of 0.65
to facilities that are located in rural
Puerto Rico.
For Hinesville-Fort Stewart, GA
(CBSA 25980), which is an urban area
without specific hospital wage data, we
propose to apply the same methodology
used to impute a wage index value that
we used in CY 2009. Specifically, we
utilize the average wage index value for
all urban areas within the State of
Georgia. That results in a proposed CY
2010 wage index value of 0.9029 for the
Hinesville-Fort Stewart GA CBSA.
In the CY 2009 PFS final rule with
comment period (73 FR 69759 through
69760), we stated that we would
continue to evaluate existing hospital
wage data and possibly wage data from
other sources such as the Bureau of
Labor Statistics, to determine if other
methodologies might be appropriate for
imputing wage index values for areas
without hospital wage data for CY 2010
and subsequent years. To date, no data
from other sources, superior to that
currently used in connection with the
IPPS wage index has emerged.
Therefore, for ESRD purposes, we
continue to believe this is an
appropriate policy.
For CY 2010, we are proposing to use
the FY 2010 wage index data (collected
from cost reports submitted by hospital
for cost reporting periods beginning FY
2006) to compute the ESRD composite
payment rates effective beginning
January 1, 2010.
i. Budget Neutrality Adjustment
Section 1881(b)(12)(E)(i) of the Act, as
added by section 623(d) of the MMA,
required that any revisions to the ESRD
composite rate payment system as a
result of the MMA provision (including
the geographic adjustment) be made in
a budget neutral manner. Given our
application of the ESRD wage index,
this means that aggregate payments to
ESRD facilities in CY 2010 would be the
same as aggregate payments that would
have been made if we had not made any
changes to the geographic adjusters. We
note that this BN adjustment only
addresses the impact of changes in the
geographic adjustments. A separate BN
adjustment was developed for the casemix adjustments required by the MMA.
As we are not proposing any changes to
the case-mix measures for CY 2010, the
current case-mix BN adjustment of
0.9116 would remain in effect for CY
2010. As in CY 2009, for CY 2010, we
propose to apply the wage-index BN
adjustment factor of 1.057888 directly to
the ESRD wage index values. Because
the ESRD wage index is only applied to
PO 00000
Frm 00120
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
the labor-related portion of the
composite rate, we computed the BN
adjustment factor based on that
proportion (53.711 percent).
To compute the proposed CY 2010
wage index BN adjustment factor
(1.057888), we used the FY 2006 prefloor, pre-reclassified, non-occupational
mix-adjusted hospital data to compute
the wage index values, 2008 outpatient
claims (paid and processed as of
December 31, 2008), and geographic
location information for each facility
which may be found through Dialysis
Facility Compare Web page on the CMS
Web site at
https://www.cms.hhs.gov/
DialysisFacilityCompare/. The FY 2006
hospital wage index data for each urban
and rural locale by CBSA may also be
accessed on the CMS Web site at https://
www.cms.hhs.gov/AcuteInpatientPPS/
WIFN/list.asp. The wage index data are
located in the section entitled, ‘‘FY 2010
Proposed Rule Occupational Mix
Adjusted and Unadjusted Average
Hourly Wage and Pre-Reclassified Wage
Index by CBSA.’’
Using treatment counts from the 2008
claims and facility-specific CY 2009
composite rates, we computed the
estimated total dollar amount each
ESRD provider would have received in
CY 2009. The total of these payments
became the target amount of
expenditures for all ESRD facilities for
CY 2010. Next, we computed the
estimated dollar amount that would
have been paid for the same ESRD
facilities using the proposed ESRD wage
index for CY 2010. The total of these
payments became the new CY 2010
amount of wage-adjusted composite rate
expenditures for all ESRD facilities.
Section 153(a) of the MIPPA revised
section 1881(b)(12)(G) of the Act and
provided for an update of 1 percent to
the composite rate component of the
payment system effective January 1,
2010. We note that when computing the
new CY 2010 amount, we did not
include this 1 percent increase because
the BN adjustment would negate the
increase.
After comparing these two dollar
amounts (target amount divided by the
new CY 2010 amount), we calculated an
adjustment factor that, when multiplied
by the applicable CY 2010 ESRD wage
index value, would result in aggregate
payments to ESRD facilities that would
remain within the target amount of
composite rate expenditures. When
making this calculation, the ESRD wage
index floor value of 0.6500 is applied
whenever appropriate. The proposed
wage BN adjustment factor is 1.057888.
To ensure BN, we also must apply the
BN adjustment factor to the proposed
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
wage index floor of 0.6500 which results
in a proposed adjusted wage index floor
of 0.6876 (0.6500 x 1.057888) for CY
2010.
j. ESRD Wage Index Tables
The CY 2010 ESRD wage index tables
are located in Addenda F and G of this
proposed rule.
J. Discussion of Chiropractic Services
Demonstration
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
1. Background
Section 651 of the Medicare
Prescription Drug, Improvement, and
Modernization Act of 2003 (MMA) (Pub.
L. 108–173) requires the Secretary to
evaluate the feasibility and advisability
of expanding coverage for chiropractic
services under Medicare. Under
Medicare, coverage for chiropractic
services is limited to manual
manipulation of the spine to correct a
subluxation described in section
1861(r)(5) of the Act. The demonstration
expanded current Medicare coverage to
include ‘‘care for neuromusculoskeletal
conditions typical among eligible
beneficiaries and diagnostic and other
services that a chiropractor is legally
authorized to perform by the State or
jurisdiction in which such treatment is
provided.’’ The 2-year demonstration
was conducted in four geographically
diverse sites, two rural and two urban
regions, with each type including a
Health Professional Shortage Area
(HPSA). The two urban sites were 26
counties in Illinois and Scott County,
Iowa, and 17 counties in Virginia. The
two rural sites were the States of Maine
and New Mexico. The demonstration,
which ended on March 31, 2007, was
required to be budget neutral as section
651(f)(1)(B) of the MMA requires the
Secretary to ensure that ‘‘the aggregate
payments made by the Secretary under
the Medicare program do not exceed the
amount which the Secretary would have
paid under the Medicare program if the
demonstration projects under this
section were not implemented.’’
In the CY 2006, 2007, and 2008 PFS
final rules with comment period (70 FR
70266, 71 FR 69707, 72 FR 66325,
respectively), we included a discussion
of the strategy that would be used to
assess budget neutrality (BN) and how
chiropractor fees would be adjusted
should the demonstration result in costs
higher than those that would occur in
the absence of the demonstration. We
stated we would assess BN by
determining the change in costs based
on a pre-post comparison of costs and
the rate of change for specific diagnoses
that are treated by chiropractors and
physicians in the demonstration sites
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
and control sites. We also stated we
would not limit our analysis to
reviewing only chiropractor claims
because the costs of the expanded
chiropractor services may have an
impact on other Medicare costs. If the
demonstration was not budget neutral,
we anticipated making reductions in the
CY 2010 and CY 2011 physician fee
schedules. We proposed that if we
determined that the adjustment for BN
was greater than 2 percent of spending
for the chiropractor fee schedule codes,
we would implement the adjustment
over a 2-year period. However, if the
adjustment was less than 2 percent of
spending under the chiropractor fee
schedule codes, we would implement
the adjustment over a 1-year period.
2. Analysis of Demonstration
Brandeis University, the
demonstration evaluator, used two
approaches in examining BN. The ‘‘All
Neuromusculoskeletal Analysis (NMS)’’
reflects an intent-to-treat approach
whereby the utilization of all
beneficiaries who received any
Medicare covered services for
neuromusculoskeletal conditions in the
demonstration areas was examined.
This method is potentially subject to
large external forces because of its
inclusion of all beneficiaries including
those who did not use chiropractic
services and who would not become
users of chiropractic services even with
expanded coverage for them. Therefore,
a second analysis, termed the
‘‘Chiropractic User Analysis’’ was
conducted to examine only the subset of
beneficiaries who used chiropractic
services for the treatment of their
neuromusculoskeletal conditions. Both
approaches use hierarchical linear
modeling of costs over 3 years—1 year
prior to the demonstration and the 2
years of the demonstration. We posted
a report describing these analyses on
CMS Web site at https://
www.cms.hhs.gov/reports/downloads/
MMA651_BudgetNeutrality.pdf.
The results of both analyses indicate
that the demonstration was not budget
neutral. In the ‘‘All NMS Analysis,’’
which measured the costs of the
demonstration on all beneficiaries who
received services for a
neuromusculoskeletal condition in the
demonstration areas in comparison to
beneficiaries with similar characteristics
from similar geographic areas that did
not participate in the demonstration, the
total effect of the demonstration to
Medicare was $114 million. In the
‘‘Chiropractic User Analysis,’’ which
measured the costs of the demonstration
among beneficiaries who used expanded
chiropractic services to treat a
PO 00000
Frm 00121
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33639
neuromusculoskeletal condition in the
demonstration areas, in comparison to
beneficiaries with similar characteristics
who used chiropractic services as
currently covered by Medicare to treat a
neuromusculoskeletal condition from
similar geographic areas that did not
participate in the demonstration, the
total effect of the demonstration to
Medicare was $50 million.
Both approaches to assessing BN have
strengths and limitations. The ‘‘All NMS
Analysis’’ provides the broadest view of
the Medicare population that would
have been eligible for the
demonstration’s expanded coverage of
chiropractic services. Because it
includes all beneficiaries with
neuromusculoskeletal conditions, it
guards against validity threats of
selection. However, this approach
creates a large heterogeneous group
which may only include a small
proportion of chiropractic service users.
Basing estimates of BN on such a large
heterogeneous group increases the
potential for changes in the use of
services seldom affected by
chiropractors to be falsely attributed to
the demonstration, which could result
in the costs of the demonstration
appearing to be larger than they actually
were.
We believe the BN estimate should be
based on the ‘‘Chiropractic User
Analysis’’ because of its focus on users
of chiropractic services rather than all
Medicare beneficiaries with
neuromusculoskeletal conditions,
including those who did not use
chiropractic services and who would
not have become users of chiropractic
services even with expanded coverage
for them. Users of chiropractic services
are most likely to have been affected by
the expanded coverage provided by this
demonstration. Cost increases and
offsets, such as reductions in
hospitalizations or other types of
ambulatory care, are more likely to be
observed in this group. Therefore, we
are proposing to adjust the Medicare
PFS for all chiropractors using the
estimate provided in the ‘‘Chiropractic
User Analysis.’’
The CMS Office of the Actuary
(OACT) estimates chiropractic
expenditures in CY 2010 to be
approximately $487 million based on
actual Medicare spending for
chiropractic services for the most recent
available year. Because the costs of this
demonstration were higher than
expected and we did not anticipate a
reduction to the PFS of greater than 2
percent per year, we are proposing to
recoup the $50 million in expenditures
from this demonstration over a 5-year
period rather than over a 2-year period.
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33640
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
This approach reflects a change from
our BN discussion in the CY 2006, 2007,
and 2008 PFS rules, which was
described previously in this section. We
would recoup $10 million each year
through adjustments to the PFS for all
chiropractors in CYs 2010 through 2014.
We believe that spreading this
adjustment over a longer period of time
and in equal increments will minimize
its potential negative impact on
chiropractic practices.
3. Payment Adjustment
To implement the required BN
adjustment, we propose to reduce the
payment amount under the PFS for the
chiropractic CPT codes (that is, CPT
codes 98940, 98941, and 98942).
Payment under the PFS for these codes
would be reduced by 2 percent. As
stated in prior PFS rules, application of
the BN adjustment would be specific to
these three codes which represent the
‘‘chiropractic fee schedule’’ because
they are the only chiropractic codes
recognized under the PFS. We are
proposing to reflect this reduction only
in the payment files used by the
Medicare contractors to process
Medicare claims rather than through
adjusting the RVUs. This would
preserve the integrity of the PFS,
particularly since many private payers
also base payment on the RVUs. The
RVUs published in Addendum B and
posted on our Web site would not show
this reduction but would be annotated
to state that the reduction resulting from
the chiropractic demonstration is not
reflected in the RVUs.
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
K. Comprehensive Outpatient
Rehabilitation Facilities (CORF) and
Rehabilitation Agency Issues
A Comprehensive Outpatient
Rehabilitation Facility (CORF) is a
Medicare provider that furnishes
respiratory therapy services among
other services. In § 485.70, we set forth
the personnel qualifications that must
be satisfied by a CORF as a condition of
participation under § 485.58 and as a
condition of coverage of CORF services,
including personnel qualifications for
respiratory therapists providing CORF
respiratory therapy services.
In the CY 2009 PFS proposed rule (73
FR 38502) and subsequent final rule
with comment period (73 FR 69942), we
revised the definition of a respiratory
therapist under § 485.70(j). The change
in the definition of respiratory therapist
was intended to ensure accuracy in
reference to persons who are qualified
to perform respiratory therapy and to
ensure that language regarding these
professionals is consistent with current
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
industry requirements for education,
training, and practice.
Prior to its modification by the CY
2009 PFS final rule with comment
period, § 485.70(j) reflected the
qualifications for ‘‘Certified Respiratory
Therapists (CRTs)’’ and ‘‘Registered
Respiratory Therapists (RRTs)’’ as terms
commonly used by the professional
industry to identify persons furnishing
respiratory therapy services.
Since publication of the CY 2009 PFS
final rule with comment, we have been
informed by the industry that the
changes made in the definition of
respiratory therapist exclude a category
of professional that has completed the
requirements of a CRT, has completed a
nationally accredited educational
program that confers eligibility for the
National Board for Respiratory Care
(NBRC) registry exam for respiratory
therapists (RTs), and is eligible to sit for
the national registry examination
administered by the National Board for
Respiratory Care (NBRC), but has not yet
passed the examination. These persons
are referred to in the industry as
Certified Respiratory Therapists (CRTs).
Because it is our policy that Medicare
payment is available for respiratory
services provided to Medicare
beneficiaries in a CORF only if provided
by a respiratory therapist meeting the
qualifications set forth in § 485.70(j),
payment is not available for respiratory
services provided by CRTs in the CORF
setting. We note that personnel
qualifications for respiratory therapists
previously set forth at § 485.70(j) prior
to its modification by the CY 2009 PFS
final rule with comment period did not
exclude this category of personnel from
the definition of respiratory therapist.
We have also heard from CRTs and from
CORFs that this change has limited the
availability of respiratory therapy
services to Medicare beneficiaries in
certified CORFs, as many of these
services were provided by CRTs. Thus,
in modifying the definition of
respiratory therapist in the CY 2009 PFS
final rule with comment period, we may
have inadvertently impacted access to
respiratory therapy services for some
Medicare beneficiaries.
Thus, we are proposing to modify the
definition of respiratory therapist and to
clarify the terms that are used to
identify those persons who furnish
respiratory services in CORFs in
§ 485.70(j) to include CRTs, that is those
individuals who have completed a
nationally accredited educational
program for respiratory therapists and
are eligible to sit for the national registry
examination administered by the
National Board for Respiratory Care
(NBRC), but who have not yet passed
PO 00000
Frm 00122
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
the examination. The change in the
definition we are proposing would
permit CRTs to furnish respiratory
therapy services to Medicare
beneficiaries in the CORF setting.
In this proposed rule, we intend to
assure that persons who were qualified
to furnish respiratory therapy services to
patients in CORFs prior to the
finalization of CY 2009 PFS final rule
with comment period (73 FR 69942),
will continue to qualify to furnish RT
services to CORF patients under this
proposed rule.
We invite public comment on the
proposed change to § 485.70(j). We are
also seeking comments from the
industry regarding the difference in
services furnished by the different levels
of professionals who provide RT
services in CORFs. We welcome such
comments to be descriptive and both
quantitative and qualitative in nature to
the extent possible.
L. Ambulance Fee Schedule: Technical
Correction to the Rural Adjustment
Factor Regulations (§ 414.610)
Section 1834(l)(9) of the Act provides
that for ‘‘ground ambulance services
furnished on or after July 1, 2001, and
before January 1, 2004, for which
transportation originates in a rural area
* * * or in a rural census tract of a
metropolitan statistical area * * * the
fee schedule established under this
subsection shall provide that, with
respect to the payment rate for mileage
for a trip above 17 miles, and up to 50
miles, the rate otherwise established
shall be increased by not less than 1⁄2 of
the additional payment per mile
established for the first 17 miles of such
a trip originating in a rural area.’’ Thus,
the statute authorized a rural mileage
bonus for miles 18 through 50 for
ground ambulance services furnished on
or after July 1, 2001 and prior to January
1, 2004. This provision was
implemented in § 414.610(c)(5)(i), but
the regulation text does not currently
specify the statutory time period during
which this rural mileage bonus was
effective. In the ‘‘Medicare Program;
Coverage and Payment of Ambulance
Services; Inflation Update for CY 2004’’
final rule with comment period (68 FR
67960, 67961), we acknowledged that
we inadvertently omitted from the
regulation text the time period during
which this statutory adjustment was
applicable, and stated we were ‘‘revising
§ 414.610(c) to reflect that this bonus
payment applies only for services
furnished during the statutory period.’’
Thus, in the ‘‘Medicare Program;
Coverage and Payment of Ambulance
Services; Inflation Update for CY 2004’’
final rule with comment period, we
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
revised the regulation to include the
time period during which the
adjustment is applicable (68 FR 67963).
However, the revised language
specifying the statutory time period was
dropped inadvertently from the
regulation text when § 414.610(c)(5) was
later republished in the ‘‘Medicare
Program; Medicare Ambulance MMA
Temporary Rate Increases Beginning
July 1, 2004’’ interim final rule (69 FR
40288, 40292).
In this proposed rule, we are
reinstating the language that was
originally finalized in ‘‘Medicare
Program; Coverage and Payment of
Ambulance Services; Inflation Update
for CY 2004’’ final rule with comment
period (68 FR 67963) but then
inadvertently omitted again when
§ 414.610(c)(5) was later republished, so
that § 414.610(c)(5)(i) correctly sets forth
the statutory time period during which
this rural mileage bonus was applicable.
This revision to the regulation is a
technical correction to conform the
regulation to the statute. For further
information, see program instruction,
Transmittal AB–03–110; Date August 1,
2003; Change Request 2767 which was
issued to inform contractors to
discontinue paying such bonuses
effective January 1, 2004 in accordance
with the statute.
M. Clinical Laboratory Fee Schedule:
Signature on Requisition
In the March 10, 2000 Federal
Register, we published the ‘‘Medicare
Program; Negotiated Rulemaking:
Coverage and Administrative Policies
for Clinical Diagnostic Laboratory
Services’’ proposed rule (65 FR 13082)
announcing and soliciting comments on
the results of our negotiated rulemaking
committee tasked to establish national
coverage and administrative policies for
clinical diagnostic laboratory tests
under Part B of Medicare. In our final
rule published in the November 23,
2001 Federal Register (66 FR 58788), we
explained our policy on ordering
clinical diagnostic laboratory services
and amended § 410.32 to make our
policy more explicit. Our regulation at
§ 410.32(a) included the requirement
that ‘‘[a]ll diagnostic x-ray tests,
diagnostic laboratory tests, and other
diagnostic tests must be ordered by the
physician who is treating the
beneficiary.’’ In the November 23, 2001
final rule, we added paragraph (d)(2) to
§ 410.32 to require that the physician or
qualified nonphysician practitioner
(NPP) who orders the service must
maintain documentation of medical
necessity in the beneficiary’s medical
record (66 FR 58809). In the preamble
discussions to the March 10, 2000
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
proposed rule and November 23, 2001
final rule (65 FR 13089 and 66 FR
58802, respectively), we noted that
‘‘[w]hile the signature of a physician on
a requisition is one way of documenting
that the treating physician ordered the
test, it is not the only permissible way
of documenting that the test has been
ordered.’’ In those preambles, we
described the policy of not requiring
physician signatures on requisitions for
clinical diagnostic laboratory tests, but
implicitly left in place the existing
requirements for a written order to be
signed by the ordering physician or NPP
for clinical diagnostic laboratory tests,
as well as other types of diagnostic tests.
We further stated in the preambles of
the proposed and final rules that we
would publish an instruction to
Medicare contractors clarifying that the
signature of the ordering physician is
not required for Medicare purposes on
a requisition for a clinical diagnostic
laboratory test (65 FR 13089 and 66 FR
58802).
On March 5, 2002, we published a
program transmittal implementing the
administrative policies set forth in the
final rule, including the following
instruction: ‘‘Medicare does not require
the signature of the ordering physician
on a laboratory service requisition.
While the signature of a physician on a
requisition is one way of documenting
that the treating physician ordered the
service, it is not the only permissible
way of documenting that the service has
been ordered. For example, the
physician may document the ordering of
specific services in the patient’s medical
record.’’ (Transmittal AB–02–030,
Change Request 1998, dated March 5,
2002).
On January 24, 2003, we published a
program transmittal in order to
manualize the March 5, 2002
Transmittal. (Transmittal 1787, Change
Request 2410, dated January 24, 2003).
The cover note to the transmittal states,
‘‘Section 15021, Ordering Diagnostic
Tests, manualizes Transmittal AB–02–
030, dated March 5, 2002. In accordance
with negotiated rulemaking for
outpatient clinical diagnostic laboratory
services, no signature is required for the
ordering of such services or for
physician pathology services.’’ In the
manual instructions in that transmittal
in a note, we stated: ‘‘No signature is
required on orders for clinical
diagnostic services paid on the basis of
the physician fee schedule or for
physician pathology services.’’ The
manual instructions did not explicitly
reference clinical diagnostic laboratory
tests as the cover note did. Rather, the
transmittal seemed to extend the policy
set forth in the Federal Register (that no
PO 00000
Frm 00123
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33641
signature is required on requisitions for
clinical diagnostic laboratory tests paid
under the Clinical Laboratory Fee
Schedule) to also apply to clinical
diagnostic tests paid on the basis of the
PFS and physician pathology services.
In addition, the manual instructions
used the term ‘‘order’’ instead of
‘‘requisition,’’ which some members of
the industry have asserted caused
confusion.
When we transitioned from paper
manuals to the current electronic
Internet Only Manual system, these
manual instructions were inadvertently
omitted from the new Benefit Policy
Manual (BPM).
In August 2008, we issued a program
transmittal (Transmittal 94, Change
Request 6100, dated August 29, 2008) to
update the BPM to incorporate language
that was previously contained in section
15021 of the Medicare Carriers Manual.
The reissued language states, ‘‘No
signature is required on orders for
clinical diagnostic tests paid on the
basis of the clinical laboratory fee
schedule, the physician fee schedule, or
for physician pathology services.’’ Based
on further review, we have determined
that there are no clinical laboratory tests
paid under the PFS. After Transmittal
94 was published, we received
numerous inquiries from laboratory,
diagnostic testing, and hospital
representatives who had questions
about whether the provision applied to
all diagnostic services, including x-rays,
MRIs, and other nonclinical laboratory
fee schedule diagnostic services.
To resolve any existing confusion
surrounding the implementation of the
policy in 2001 and subsequent
transmittals, we are restating and
seeking public comments on our policy.
We may further clarify our policy in the
final rule, taking into consideration
public comments. Our policy is that a
physician’s signature is not required on
a requisition for clinical diagnostic
laboratory tests paid on the basis of the
Clinical Laboratory Fee Schedule;
however, it must be evident, in
accordance with our regulations at
§ 410.32(d)(2) and (3), that the physician
ordered the services. The policy that
signatures are not required on
requisitions applies to requisitions for
clinical diagnostic laboratory tests paid
under the Clinical Laboratory Fee
Schedule.
We note that we solicited and
received comments on this signature
requirement during the notice and
comment period for the March 10, 2000
proposed rule in the context of our
proposal to add paragraph (d)(2)(i) to
§ 410.32 to require that the practitioner
who orders a diagnostic laboratory test
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33642
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
must maintain documentation of
medical necessity in the beneficiary’s
medical record. The majority of
comments supported the adoption of a
policy that the signature of the
practitioner on a requisition for a
clinical diagnostic laboratory test paid
under the Clinical Laboratory Fee
Schedule is not the only way of
documenting that the test has been
ordered and, thus, should not be
required provided such documentation
exists in an alternate form.
This policy regarding requisitions for
clinical diagnostic laboratory tests does
not supersede other applicable Medicare
requirements (such as those related to
hospital Conditions of Participation
(CoPs)) which require the medical
record to include an order signed by the
physician who is treating the
beneficiary. Nor do we believe that
anything in our policy regarding
signatures on requisitions for clinical
diagnostic lab tests supersedes other
requirements mandated by professional
standards of practice or obligations
regarding orders and medical records
promulgated by Medicare, the Joint
Commission, or State law; nor do we
believe the policy would require
providers to change their business
practices. Because of the confusion
surrounding the implementation of the
policy in 2001 and subsequent
transmittals, we invite the general
public to comment on this policy and its
impacts on operations.
We also are restating and seeking
public comment on our long-standing
policy consistent with the principle in
§ 410.32(a) that a written order for
diagnostic tests including those paid
under the clinical laboratory fee
schedule and those that are not paid
under the clinical laboratory fee
schedule (for example, that are paid
under the PFS or under the OPPS), such
as X-rays, MRIs, and the TC of physician
pathology services, must be signed by
the ordering physician or NPP. That is,
the policy that signatures are not
required on requisitions for clinical
diagnostic laboratory tests paid based on
the Clinical Laboratory Fee Schedule
applies only to requisitions (as opposed
to written orders).’’ While there may be
additional questions about the policy for
physician pathology servicess, we are
not addressing these issues in
rulemaking at this time.
Additionally, we welcome comments
from the public about the distinction
between an order and a requisition. We
note that an ‘‘order’’ as defined in our
IOM, 100–02, Chapter 15, Section 80.6.1
is a communication from the treating
physician/practitioner requesting that a
diagnostic test be performed for a
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
beneficiary. The order may
conditionally request an additional
diagnostic test for a particular
beneficiary if the result of the initial
diagnostic test ordered yields to a
certain value determined by the treating
physician/practitioner (for example, if
test X is negative, then perform test Y).
An order may be delivered via the
following forms of communication:
• A written document signed by the
treating physician/practitioner, which is
hand-delivered, mailed, or faxed to the
testing facility.
• A telephone call by the treating
physician/practitioner or his or her
office to the testing facility; or
• An electronic mail, or other
electronic means, by the treating
physician/practitioner or his or her
office to the testing facility.
If the order is communicated via
telephone, both the treating physician/
practitioner, or his or her office, and the
testing facility must document the
telephone call in their respective copies
of the beneficiary’s medical records.
A ‘‘requisition’’, conversely, as we
understand it, is the actual paperwork,
such as a form, which is provided to a
clinical diagnostic laboratory that
identifies the test or tests to be
performed for a patient. It may contain
patient information, ordering physician
information, referring institution
information, information about where to
send reports, billing information,
specimen information, shipping
addresses for specimens or tissue
samples, and checkboxes for test
selection. We believe it is ministerial in
nature, assisting labs with billing and
handling of results, and serves as an
administrative convenience to providers
and patients. We believe that a written
order, which may be part of the medical
record, and the requisition are two
different documents; although a
requisition that is signed may serve as
an order. We welcome comments from
the public about the distinction between
requisitions and orders.
N. Physician Self-Referral
1. General Background
Section 1877 of the Act, also known
as the physician self-referral law,
prohibits the following: (1) A physician
from making referrals for certain
designated health services (‘‘DHS’’)
payable by Medicare to an entity with
which he or she (or an immediate family
member) has a direct or indirect
financial relationship (an ownership/
investment interest or a compensation
arrangement), unless an exception
applies; and (2) The entity from
presenting or causing a claim to be
PO 00000
Frm 00124
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
presented to Medicare (or billing
another individual, entity, or third party
payor) for those referred services. The
statute establishes a number of
exceptions and grants the Secretary the
authority to create regulatory exceptions
for financial relationships that pose no
risk of program or patient abuse.
Determining whether an entity
furnishing DHS and a physician have a
direct or indirect compensation
arrangement is a key step in applying
the statute because it affects which
compensation exceptions may apply to
the arrangement. Section 411.354(c)
governs when a physician ‘‘stands in the
shoes’’ of his or her physician
organization and may therefore,
depending on the circumstances, have a
direct, rather than an indirect,
compensation arrangement with an
entity furnishing DHS.
Our proposal seeks to clarify one
aspect of the physician stand in the
shoes provisions at § 411.354(c).
Specifically, we are proposing to clarify
the second sentence of § 411.354(c)(3)(i)
to provide that, ‘‘[w]hen applying the
exceptions in § 411.355 and § 411.357 to
arrangements in which a physician
stands in the shoes of his or her
physician organization, the relevant
referrals and other business generated
‘‘between the parties’ are referrals and
other business generated between the
entity furnishing DHS and the physician
organization (including all members,
employees, and independent contractor
physicians).’’ A detailed discussion of
this proposed clarification may be found
in section II.N.2.b. of this proposed rule.
2. Physician Stand in the Shoes
a. Background
One of the first significant physician
stand in the shoes provisions was
finalized in the ‘‘Medicare Program;
Physicians’ Referrals to Health Care
Entities With Which They Have
Financial Relationships (Phase II),’’
interim final rule with comment period
published in the March 26, 2004
Federal Register (69 FR 16054) (‘‘Phase
II’’). In Phase II, we revised the
definition of ‘‘referring physician’’ at
§ 411.351 to clarify that a referring
physician is treated as ‘‘standing in the
shoes’’ of his or her professional
corporation (69 FR 16058, 16060). Our
revision to the definition of ‘‘referring
physician’’ clarified that it was not
necessary to treat a referring physician
as separate from his or her whollyowned professional corporation. We
noted that the revised regulations
should make it simpler for physicians
and others to evaluate their financial
relationships and to apply exceptions
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
under section 1877 of the Act. We also
solicited comments on whether to
permit a physician to stand in the shoes
of a group practice of which he or she
is a member (69 FR 16060).
We addressed certain provisions of
section 1877 of the Act, including
provisions relating to direct and indirect
compensation arrangements, in the
‘‘Medicare Program; Physicians’
Referrals to Health Care Entities With
Which They Have Financial
Relationships (Phase III),’’ final rule
published in the September 5, 2007
Federal Register (72 FR 51012) (‘‘Phase
III’’). Phase III extended the Phase II rule
that treated referring physicians as
standing in the shoes of their whollyowned professional corporations only
(72 FR 51026). Specifically, we
amended § 411.354(c) to add a provision
under which all referring physicians
will be treated as ‘‘standing in the
shoes’’ of their physician organizations
for purposes of applying the rules that
describe direct and indirect
compensation arrangements in
§ 411.354 (72 FR 51026 through 51029).
Phase III defined a ‘‘physician
organization’’ at § 411.351 to be ‘‘a
physician (including a professional
corporation of which the physician is
the sole owner), a physician practice, or
a group practice that complies with the
requirements of § 411.352.’’ Under
Phase III, when determining whether a
direct or indirect compensation
arrangement existed between a
physician and an entity to which the
physician refers Medicare patients for
DHS, the referring physician would
stand in the shoes of: (1) Another
physician who employs the referring
physician; (2) his or her wholly-owned
professional corporation; (3) a physician
practice (that is, a medical practice) that
employs or contracts with the referring
physician; or (4) a group practice of
which the referring physician is a
member or independent contractor. We
specified in § 411.354(c)(3)(i) that a
physician who stands in the shoes of his
or her physician organization would be
considered to have the same
compensation arrangements (with the
same parties and on the same terms) as
the physician organization in whose
shoes the referring physician stands. In
addition, we specified in the second
sentence of § 411.354(c)(3)(i) that ‘‘[f]or
purposes of applying the exceptions in
§ 411.355 and § 411.357 to arrangements
in which a physician stands in the shoes
of his or her physician organization, the
‘parties’ to the arrangements are
considered to be the entity furnishing
DHS and the physician organization
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
(including all members, employees, or
independent contractor physicians).’’
The Phase III stand in the shoes rules
were made in an effort to address two
issues. First, industry representatives
had asserted that resorting to the
indirect compensation definition and
exception added an unnecessary step
when determining compliance with the
physician self-referral prohibition.
These representatives believed that it
would be easier, more efficient, and
consistent with the intent of the
physician self-referral law to examine
the relationship between the hospital
and the group practice for compliance
with a physician self-referral exception.
The representatives urged that a
referring physician should stand in the
shoes of his or her group practice,
which acts on behalf of its physician
members and contractors. Depending on
the circumstances, this would enable
the parties to analyze the arrangement
between the entity furnishing DHS and
the group practice (for example, a lease
of office space, a personal service
arrangement, or a fair market value
compensation arrangement) to
determine its compliance with one of
the various direct compensation
arrangement exceptions, rather than the
indirect compensation arrangements
exception at § 411.357(p). We agreed
and permitted a physician to stand in
the shoes of his or her group practice,
thereby permitting physicians and
entities furnishing DHS to use a direct
compensation arrangement exception in
some circumstances.
Second, we were informed that
parties may have construed the
definition of an indirect compensation
arrangement too narrowly, resulting in
erroneous determinations that some
arrangements involving financial
incentives for referring physicians
would fall outside the ambit of the
physician self-referral law. In particular,
we were concerned that some
arrangements between entities
furnishing DHS and group practices
were viewed as outside the application
of the statute. The stand in the shoes
provisions set forth in Phase III were
designed to address this concern by
treating compensation arrangements
between entities furnishing DHS and
group practices as if the arrangements
were with the group’s referring
physicians.
In response to concerns raised by
some industry representatives, we
published a final rule in the November
15, 2007 Federal Register (72 FR 64161)
delaying the date of applicability of the
Phase III stand in the shoes provisions
with respect to certain compensation
arrangements involving physician
PO 00000
Frm 00125
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33643
organizations and academic medical
centers or certain integrated 501(c)(3)
health care systems, from December 4,
2007 until December 4, 2008.
We finalized revisions to
§ 411.354(c)(1)(ii) to deem (so as to
require) a physician who has an
ownership or investment interest in a
physician organization to stand in the
shoes of that physician organization in
the ‘‘Medicare Program; Changes to the
Hospital Inpatient Prospective Payment
Systems and Fiscal Year 2009 Rates;
Payments for Graduate Medical
Education in Certain Emergency
Situations; Changes to Disclosure of
Physician Ownership in Hospitals and
Physician Self-Referral Rules; Updates
to the Long-Term Care Prospective
Payment System; Updates to Certain
IPPS-Excluded Hospitals; and
Collection of Information Regarding
Financial Relationships Between
Hospitals’’ final rule (‘‘FY 2009 IPPS
final rule’’) published in the August 19,
2008 Federal Register (73 FR 48434).
Physicians with only a titular
ownership interest (that is, physicians
without the ability or right to receive the
financial benefits of ownership or
investment, including, but not limited
to, the distribution of profits, dividends,
proceeds of sale, or similar returns on
investment) are not deemed to stand in
the shoes of their physician
organizations. We also added
§ 411.354(c)(1)(iii) to permit (but not
require) a titular owner and a physician
who does not have an ownership or
investment interest in a physician
organization to stand in the shoes of his
or her physician organization. This rule
became effective October 1, 2008.
b. Proposed Clarification to
§ 411.354(c)—Applying Exceptions in
§ 411.355 and § 411.357 to
Arrangements in Which a Physician
Stands in the Shoes of His or Her
Physician Organization
Section 411.354(c)(3)(i) addresses the
application of the general exceptions to
the referral prohibition related to both
ownership/investment and
compensation (§ 411.355) and the
exceptions to the referral prohibition
related to compensation arrangements
(§ 411.357), to arrangements in which a
physician stands in the shoes of his or
her physician organization. Many of
these exceptions require the
arrangement to be in writing and signed
by the parties and prohibit the
compensation from taking into account
the volume or value of referrals or other
business generated by the referring
physician.
Under § 411.354(c)(3)(i), a physician
who stands in the shoes of his or her
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33644
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
physician organization is deemed to
have the same compensation
arrangements with the same parties and
on the same terms as the physician
organization. The second sentence of
§ 411.354(c)(3)(i) provides that ‘‘[f]or
purposes of applying the exceptions in
§ 411.355 and § 411.357 to arrangements
in which a physician stands in the shoes
of his or her physician organization, the
‘parties’ to the arrangements are
considered to be the entity furnishing
DHS and the physician organization
(including all members, employees, or
independent contractor physicians).’’
After the publication of Phase III,
some members of the industry
questioned whether the second sentence
of § 411.354(c)(3)(i) defined the term
‘‘parties’’ everywhere it appears in the
physician self-referral regulations,
including the requirement in many
exceptions that a compensation
arrangement be in writing and ‘‘signed
by the parties.’’ Specifically, these
members believed it was necessary for
everyone within a physician
organization (that is, all members,
employees, and independent contractor
physicians) to sign a myriad of different
arrangements with an entity furnishing
DHS. This was not our intent. In January
2008, we posted a frequently asked
question (FAQ) on our Web site to
address this issue (see question #8885 at
https://questions.cms.hhs.gov/cgi-bin/
cmshhs.cfg/php/enduser/
std_adp.php?p_faqid=8885.) In the
FAQ, we explained that a physician
who stands in the shoes of his or her
physician organization need not become
a signatory to a written agreement
between the physician organization and
an entity furnishing DHS because ‘‘we
consider a physician who is standing in
the shoes of his or her physician
organization to have signed the written
agreement when the authorized
signatory of the physician organization
has signed the agreement.’’ After the FY
2009 IPPS final rule, under which only
physician owners are deemed to stand
in the shoes of their physician
organizations, some industry
representatives questioned whether
physicians who did not stand in the
shoes remained ‘‘parties’’ under
§ 411.354(c)(3)(i) and would therefore
need to become signatories to any
compensation arrangement that was
required to be in writing and ‘‘signed by
the parties.’’
We are proposing to clarify the second
sentence of § 411.354(c)(3)(i) to provide
that, ‘‘[w]hen applying the exceptions in
§ 411.355 and § 411.357 to arrangements
in which a physician stands in the shoes
of his or her physician organization, the
relevant referrals and other business
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
generated ‘between the parties’ are
referrals and other business generated
between the entity furnishing DHS and
the physician organization (including
all members, employees, and
independent contractor physicians).’’
We believe this proposed language
clarifies the regulation text and is
consistent with our intent to minimize
the potential for abuse without
imposing undue burden on the provider
community.
Our proposed change clarifies that we
are not defining the term ‘‘parties’’ and
should eliminate any possible public
misconception that all physicians in a
physician organization (whether or not
they stand in the shoes of the physician
organization) must sign the writing(s)
memorializing a compensation
arrangement between their physician
organization and an entity furnishing
DHS. Furthermore, we note that some
members of the industry have
erroneously applied the second
sentence of § 411.354(c)(3)(i) by
analyzing whether the compensation
takes into account the referrals between
the entity furnishing DHS and the
physician who stands in the shoes of the
physician organization only, not the
referrals of all members, employees, and
independent contractor physicians in
the physician organization. As we
indicated in the Phase III final rule (72
FR at 51028), the second sentence of
§ 411.354(c)(3)(i) was intended to
require (where applicable) an analysis of
whether a compensation arrangement
takes into account referrals or other
business generated by the physician
organization as a whole and not merely
referrals or other business generated by
the physicians who stand in its shoes.
Thus, we reiterate that the relevant
referrals and other business generated
between the physician organization and
the entity furnishing DHS are the
referrals of all physicians in the
physician organization (including all
members, employees, and independent
contractors), not simply the referrals
made by each physician who stands in
the shoes of the physician organization.
We welcome public comments
regarding alternative approaches to
address this issue.
PO 00000
Frm 00126
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
O. Durable Medical Equipment-Related
Issues
1. Damages to Suppliers Awarded a
Contract under the Acquisition of
Certain Durable Medical Equipment,
Prosthetics, Orthotics, and Supplies
(Medicare DMEPOS Competitive
Bidding Program) Caused by the Delay
of the Program
Section 1847 of the Act, as amended
by section 302(b)(1) of the MMA,
requires the Secretary to establish and
implement a Medicare Durable Medical
Equipment, Prosthetics, Orthotics, and
Supplies Competitive Bidding Program
(DMEPOS CBP). On July 15, 2008, the
MIPPA was enacted. Section 154 of the
MIPPA amended section 1847 of the Act
to make certain limited changes to the
competitive bidding program, including
adding a new subsection (a)(1)(D) to
section 1847 of the Act. Section
1847(a)(1)(D) terminates retroactively
the competitive bidding contracts that
were awarded to suppliers in 2008 for
the Round 1 of competitive bidding and
prohibits payment based on such
contracts. Section 154 of the MIPPA
effectively reinstated payment for
competitively bid items and services to
the Medicare fee schedule amounts, as
set forth in section 1834 of the Act and
42 CFR part 414, subpart D of our
regulations.
Section 1847(a)(1)(D)(i)(I) of the Act,
as amended by the MIPPA, stipulates
that to the extent any damages may be
applicable as a result of the termination
of contracts, payment is to be made from
the Federal Supplementary Medical
Insurance Trust Fund under section
1841 of the Act. Section 1847(a)(1)(D) of
the Act also states that nothing in
section 1847(a)(1)(D)(i)(I) of the Act,
which includes the reference to
damages, shall be construed to provide
an independent cause of action or right
to administrative or judicial review with
the regard to the termination of the
Round 1 contracts.
For further discussion of the
Competitive Bidding Program and the
bid evaluation process, see the Medicare
Program; Competitive Acquisition for
Certain Durable Medical Equipment,
Prosthetics, Orthotics, and Supplies
(DMEPOS) and Other Issues final rule
published in the April 10, 2007 Federal
Register (72 FR 17992) and the
Medicare Program; Changes to the
Competitive Acquisition of Certain
Durable Medical Equipment,
Prosthetics, Orthotics and Supplies
(DMEPOS) by Certain Provisions of the
Medicare Improvements for Patients and
Providers Act of 2008 (MIPPA) interim
final rule with comment period (IFC)
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
published on January 16, 2009 Federal
Register (74 FR 2873).
In this proposed rule, we are
proposing to add new § 414.425 to
establish a process to evaluate any
claims for damages caused by the
termination of contracts awarded in
2008 under the DMEPOS CBP that were
terminated as a result of section
154(a)(1)(A)(iv) of the MIPPA.
We offered contracts in March of 2008
to selected suppliers for the first round
of the DMEPOS CBP. The contracts that
were accepted were terminated by the
MIPPA retroactive to June 30, 2008. We
considered the terms of the contracts
and other processes of the DMEPOS
CBP as we developed this proposed
process to determine, on a case-by-case
basis, whether to award damages and,
where applicable, the amount of
damages to be awarded for the
termination of these contracts.
When considering whether to submit
a claim for damages, suppliers may
consider the following factors:
• Each contract stipulated that the
contract is subject to any changes to the
statute or regulations that affect the
Medicare program.
• Each contract indicated CMS does
not guarantee any amount of business or
profits.
• Each contract stipulated that CMS
shall not pay for any expenses incurred
by the supplier for the work performed
under the contract other than for
payment of Medicare claims authorized
under the contract.
• Upon termination of the contracts
by the MIPPA, payments reverted to the
CY 2008 fee schedule amount, which
was on average 26 percent higher than
payment amounts under the DMEPOS
CBP.
• We will review a supplier’s
estimated and historic capacity and any
expansion plans that were submitted as
part of a supplier’s bid.
• We will review a supplier’s action
to meet its obligation to mitigate its
damages.
• We listed the winning suppliers on
the Medicare.gov Web site in the
supplier locator tool; a supplier is
allowed to keep any new customers they
may have obtained because of being
listed on the supplier locator tool.
• This list is not intended to suggest
that there are not legitimate claims for
damages. However, these are factors that
a supplier may consider when deciding
whether to submit a claim for damages.
The provisions of this proposed rule
outline the information that we are
proposing suppliers provide when
submitting claims for damages and the
process that we will follow to review
these claims. The information we
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
propose to collect from suppliers is
necessary for us to make a reasonable
decision on whether damages are
warranted and how much in damages
should be awarded. We believe the
process is not overly burdensome to
those suppliers choosing to participate
in this review process and will ensure
a thorough review of a supplier’s claim
for damages.
The proposed process to file a claim
for damage claims includes the
following provisions:
a. Eligibility To File a Claim
Any aggrieved supplier that was
awarded a contract in 2008 for the
Round 1 DMEPOS CBP and believes it
has suffered damages is eligible to
submit a claim. The supplier must be
able to demonstrate how its company
was damaged. These damages must be
substantiated and be as a direct result of
the termination by MIPPA of their
Round I DMEPOS CBP contract. Only a
contract supplier, and not a
subcontractor of a contract supplier, is
eligible to submit a claim for damages.
b. Timeframes for Filing a Claim
A completed claim, including all
documentation described below in
section II.O.1.c., must be filed within 90
days of the effective date of the
finalization of these damages
provisions, unless the 90th day is a
weekend or Federal holiday. In that
case, the last date to file a claim will be
the day following the weekend or
Federal holiday. The date of filing is the
actual date of receipt by the CBIC of a
completed claim from the supplier that
includes all of the information required
by this rule. We strongly urge claimants
to use a tracking method such as with
the United States Postal Service or a
carrier that requires a return receipt that
indicates the date on which the claim
was delivered.
c. Information That Must Be Included in
a Claim
At a minimum, a claim should
include all of the following:
• Supplier’s name and bidding
number.
• Supplier’s current contact
information (Name of authorized
official, U.S. Post Office mailing
address, phone number and e-mail
address).
• A copy of the DMEPOS CBP Round
I contract(s) the supplier signed with
CMS.
• A detailed explanation of the
damages incurred by the supplier. The
explanation must document the
supplier’s damages through receipts and
records that establish the claimant’s
PO 00000
Frm 00127
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33645
damages directly related to meeting the
terms of the DMEPOS CBP Round I
contract.
• The supplier must also explain how
it would be damaged if not reimbursed.
• A detailed explanation of the steps
of all attempts to use for other purposes,
return, or dispose of equipment or other
assets purchased or rented for use in the
Round I DMEPOS CBP contract
performance.
Damages claimed must be specifically
related to carrying out the terms of the
contract, and may include, but are not
limited to, the following:
• Items or equipment purchased or
rented.
• Additional employee costs.
• Additional inventory costs.
• Additional facility costs.
The supplier must include a separate
justification for any of these items for
which it is claiming damages and
explain how they were necessary in
terms of meeting the requirements of the
Round 1 DMEPOS CBP contract. This
does not include expenses that would
have occurred if the supplier had not
been awarded a contract but only those
expenses that were incurred for the
Round 1 DMEPOS CBP contract
performance. The claim must also detail
steps taken by the supplier to mitigate
damages that they may have incurred
due to the contract termination.
d. Items That Will Not Be Considered in
a Claim
CMS will not award damages for the
following:
• Cost of submitting a bid.
• Cost of preparing or submitting a
claim for damages under this section.
• Fees or costs incurred for
consulting or marketing.
• Cost of accreditation or licensure.
• Costs incurred before March 20,
2008.
• Costs incurred after July 14, 2008
except for costs incurred to mitigate
damages.
• Any profits a supplier may have
expected from performance of the
contract.
• Costs that would have occurred
without the supplier having been
awarded a contract.
• Costs for items such as inventory,
delivery vehicles, office space and
equipment, personnel, which the
supplier did not purchase specifically to
perform the contract.
• Costs already recouped by use of
personnel, material, supplies, or
equipment in the supplier’s business
operations.
We are not considering claims for
expenses incurred prior to March 20,
2008 including the purchase or rental of
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33646
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
items or equipment before that date,
because a supplier would not have
known that it was going to be offered a
contract. We are not considering claims
for most expenses incurred after July 14,
2008, including the purchase or rental
of items or equipment, because this is
the date on which MIPPA terminated all
of the Round 1 contracts.
e. Filing a Claim
Suppliers should submit claims, with
all supporting documentation, with the
CMS Competitive Bidding
Implementation Contractor (CBIC) at the
following address: CBIC; Bldg 200, Suite
400; 2743 Perimeter Parkway; Augusta,
Georgia 30909. The authorized official
for the supplier must certify the
accuracy of the information on the claim
and all supporting documentation. The
authorized official is appointed by the
supplier and has the legal authority
granted by the supplier to submit the
claim for damages. This person may be
the supplier’s general partner, chairman
of the board, chief financial officer,
chief executive officer, president, direct
owner of the supplier organization, or
must hold a position of similar status
and authority within the supplier’s
organization. The CBIC will not accept
electronic submissions of claims for
damages.
f. Review of Claim
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
(1) Role of the CBIC
The CBIC will conduct the first level
of review and make recommendations to
CMS, hereafter referred to as the
Determining Authority regarding:
• Whether the claim is complete and
was filed in a timely manner. The CBIC
may seek further information from the
claimant when making its
recommendation. The CBIC may set a
deadline for receipt of additional
information.
• When the claim is incomplete or
was not filed in a timely manner, the
CBIC will make a recommendation to
the Determining Authority not to
process the claim further.
• Whether the government owes
damages because of the MIPPA. The
CBIC will include an explanation
supporting its recommendation. The
CBIC will recommend a reasonable
amount of damages, if any, based on the
claim submitted, including all
accompanying documentation. The
CBIC will consider the language of the
contract, as well as both costs incurred
and the contract supplier’s attempts and
actions to limit the damages.
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
(2) CMS’ Role as the Determining
Authority
CMS is the Determining Authority
because we are responsible for the final
review and final determination
regarding claims for damages.
• The Determining Authority shall
review the recommendation of the CBIC.
• The Determining Authority may
seek further information from the
claimant or the CBIC in making a
concurrence or non-concurrence
determination.
• The Determining Authority may set
a deadline for receipt of additional
information. A claimant’s failure to
respond timely may result in a denial of
the claim.
• If the Determining Authority
concurs with the CBIC recommendation,
the Determining Authority shall submit
a final signed decision to the CBIC and
direct the CBIC to notify the claimant of
the determination and the reasons for
the final determination.
• If the Determining Authority
nonconcurs with the CBIC
recommendation, the Determining
Authority may:
+ Write a determination granting (in
whole or in part) a claim for damages or
denying a claim in its entirety; or direct
the CBIC to write said determination for
the Determining Authority’s signature.
+ Return the claim to the CBIC with
further instructions.
• The Determining Authority’s
determination is final and binding; it is
not subject to administrative or judicial
review under section 1847(a)(1)(D) of
the Act, as amended by section 154(a)(1)
of the MIPPA.
g. Timeframe for Final Determinations
Every effort will be made to make a
final determination within 120 days of
initial receipt of the claim for damages
by the CBIC or the receipt of additional
information that was requested by the
CBIC, whichever is later. In the case of
more complex cases, or in the event of
a large workload, a decision will be
issued as soon as practicable.
h. Notification to Claimant of Damage
Determination
The CBIC shall mail the final
determination to the claimant by
certified mail return receipt requested. If
CMS determines that money is due to a
claimant, this notification will indicate
when and how the money will be
transmitted. If a monetary award is due,
the supplier will be required to provide
banking information for electronic
deposit.
PO 00000
Frm 00128
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
2. Notification to Beneficiaries for
Suppliers Regarding Grandfathering
Section 1847(a)(4) of the Act requires
that in the case of covered durable
medical equipment (DME) items for
which payment is made on a rental
basis under section 1834(a) of the Act,
and in the case of oxygen for which
payment is made under section
1834(a)(5) of the Act, the Secretary shall
establish a ‘‘grandfathering’’ process
under which rented DME items that
were furnished prior to the start of the
Competitive Bidding Program (CBP)
may be continued to be rented to the
beneficiary by a noncontract supplier.
Agreements for those covered items and
supplies that were rented by the
supplier to the beneficiary before the
start of a CBP may be continued,
regardless of whether the existing
supplier participates in the CBP.
In the April 10, 2007 final rule (72 FR
17992), in § 414.408(j), we established
the grandfathering process described
below for rented DME and oxygen and
oxygen equipment when these items are
included under the Medicare DMEPOS
CBP. A supplier that is furnishing DME
or is furnishing oxygen or oxygen
equipment on a rental basis to a
beneficiary prior to the implementation
of a CBP in the competitive bidding area
(CBA) where the beneficiary maintains
a permanent residence may elect to
continue furnishing the item as a
grandfathered supplier. This process
only applies to suppliers that began
furnishing the competitive bid items
described above before the start of the
CBP to beneficiaries who maintain a
permanent residence in a CBA.
In the case of the rented DME and
oxygen and oxygen equipment
identified in this section, we established
in § 414.408(j)(4) that Medicare
beneficiaries have the choice of
deciding whether they would like to
continue receiving the rented item from
a grandfathered supplier or if they
would like to receive the item from a
contract supplier.
Suppliers that agree to be a
grandfathered supplier for an item must
agree to be a grandfathered supplier for
all current beneficiaries who request to
continue to rent that item from them.
The beneficiary’s decision to use a
grandfathered supplier depends on the
decision of the noncontract supplier
that is currently renting the competitive
bidding item to continue renting the
item as a grandfathered supplier after
the start of the CBP in accordance with
the terms we have specified. The
payment rules for grandfathered
suppliers are specified in existing
§ 414.408(j)(2).
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
In addition, the beneficiary may elect,
at any time, to transition from a
noncontract supplier to a contract
supplier. The contract supplier would
be required to accept the beneficiary as
a customer regardless of how many
rental months had already been paid for
the beneficiary to receive this item. If
the grandfathered supplier is not willing
to continue furnishing the item, a
beneficiary must select a contract
supplier to furnish the item in order to
receive Medicare payment for that item.
The grandfathered supplier is paid
based on the payment rules outlined in
the final rule on Competitive Bidding at
§ 414.408(j).
As a result of what we learned from
Round 1 of the CBP, we are proposing
changes to the ‘‘grandfathering’’ rules by
establishing notification requirements
for noncontract suppliers that are
furnishing rented DME competitive bid
items at the time a CBP begins to
beneficiaries residing in a CBA. We are
also proposing a new definition for a
grandfathered item to include all rented
item(s) in a competitive bidding product
category that a supplier currently
provides to its beneficiaries. Under the
current regulation, suppliers may
choose the items within a product
category for which they want to become
a grandfathered supplier. Under this
proposed rule, a noncontract supplier
would have to choose to be either a
grandfathered supplier for all or for
none of the rented DME items within a
product category that the supplier
currently provides.
For further discussion of the CBP and
the bid evaluation process, see the April
10, 2007 final rule and the January 16,
2009 interim final rule with comment
period.
We are proposing to revise the
definition of ‘‘grandfathered item’’ in
§ 414.402 so that the term would refer
to all rented items within a competitive
bid product category that the supplier
currently rents to beneficiaries. In
addition, we are proposing to
redesignate the current § 414.408(j)(5) as
§ 414.408(j)(7) and add new
§ 414.408(j)(5)and (j)(6). The new
§ 414.408(j)(5)and (j)(6) will specify the
notification requirements that apply to
noncontract suppliers that are renting
DME competitive bid items in a CBA at
the time of implementation of the CBP.
a. Definition of a Grandfathered Item
We are proposing to revise the
definition of a ‘‘grandfathered item’’ in
§ 414.402 to avoid confusion, on the
part of beneficiaries, regarding rented
DME items for which a noncontract
supplier is willing or not willing to be
a grandfathered supplier. Under the
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
current regulations, a supplier may
make separate choices regarding
grandfathering for each individual
HCPCS code. For example, a supplier
may choose to be a grandfathered
supplier for a particular type of walker
within the product category instead of
all of the walkers included in that
product category that are furnished on
rental basis.
Under the revised definition, a
noncontract supplier would have to
choose to be either a grandfathered
supplier for all or for none of the DME
rented items within a product category
that the supplier currently provides. We
believe that it would be easier for
beneficiaries to recognize which items a
supplier is grandfathering or not
grandfathering if the supplier’s election
concerning grandfathering was made by
product category rather than making
separate choices for each individual
HCPCS code. In addition, this proposed
revision would prevent suppliers from
choosing to be a grandfathered supplier
for only the more profitable items,
which could disadvantage certain
beneficiaries.
b. Notification of Beneficiaries and CMS
by Suppliers That Choose To Become
Grandfathered Suppliers
We are proposing to add a new
§ 414.408(j)(5) to require suppliers
furnishing items to be included in a CBP
that are eligible for grandfathering to
notify beneficiaries in the CBA and CMS
regarding their decision whether to
become grandfathered suppliers.
The notification requirements we are
proposing will prohibit certain
inappropriate practices of noncontract
suppliers. These inappropriate practices
include: (1) Suppliers attempting to
receive additional monthly rental
payments from Medicare by
circumventing the grandfathering
requirements; and (2) suppliers not
formally notifying beneficiaries before
picking up the rented item from the
beneficiary’s home. We are also
proposing to require a notification
process to protect beneficiaries and to
ensure less confusion during the
transition period prior to
implementation of the CBP. The
proposed requirements will help ensure
that beneficiaries are contacted and
informed about the grandfathering
process and what choices they have
concerning their choice of supplier.
Moreover, the notice will help to ensure
that beneficiaries do not have medically
necessary DME equipment taken from
them unexpectedly by a noncontract
supplier.
PO 00000
Frm 00129
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33647
(1) Notification of Beneficiaries by
Suppliers That Choose to Become
Grandfathered Suppliers
We are proposing to add
§ 414.408(j)(5)(i) which requires a
noncontract supplier that elects to
become a grandfathered supplier in a
CBA to provide a written notification to
each Medicare beneficiary in that CBA
who is currently renting a grandfathered
item from that supplier. The notification
must state that the supplier is willing to
continue to rent the grandfathered
item(s) to the beneficiary as a
grandfathered supplier. The notice must
identify the DME grandfathered rented
items for which the supplier will be a
grandfathered supplier.
To ensure that beneficiaries are
sufficiently informed and prepared for
competitive bidding changes that affect
rented DME, we are proposing in
§ 414.408(j)(5) to require that the
notification of the beneficiary must meet
the following requirements. The
notification must:
• Be sent by the supplier to the
beneficiary at least 30 business days
before the start date of the
implementation of the CBP in the CBA
in which the beneficiary resides. The
30-day notice is necessary to give the
beneficiary sufficient time before the
start of the CBP to consider whether to
continue to use their current supplier.
Suppliers will be given sufficient time
to meet the 30-day notification
requirement.
• Identify the grandfathered items
that the supplier is willing to continue
to rent to the beneficiary.
• Be in writing (for example, by letter
or postcard) and the supplier must
maintain proof of delivery.
• State that the supplier is offering to
continue to furnish certain rented DME,
oxygen and oxygen equipment, and
supplies that the supplier is currently
furnishing to the beneficiary (that is,
before the start of the CBP) and is
willing to continue to provide these
items to the beneficiary for the
remaining rental months.
• State that the beneficiary has the
choice to continue to receive a
grandfathered item(s) from the
grandfathered supplier or may elect to
receive the item(s) from a contract
supplier after the end of the last month
for which a rental payment is made to
the noncontract supplier.
• Provide the supplier’s telephone
number and instruct the beneficiaries to
call the supplier with questions
regarding grandfathering and to notify
the supplier of his or her election.
• State that the beneficiary can obtain
information about the CBP by calling
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33648
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
1–800–MEDICARE or accessing https://
www.medicare.gov on the Internet.
In § 414.408(j)(i)(B), we propose that
the supplier should obtain an election
from the beneficiary and maintain a
record of its attempts to communicate
with the beneficiary to obtain the
beneficiary’s election regarding
grandfathering. We are also proposing
that the supplier maintain a record of
the beneficiary’s choice, the date on
which the choice was made, and how
the beneficiary communicated his or her
choice to the supplier. The 30-day
notice to the beneficiary must be in
writing to ensure that there is a record
that the notification was made.
We are proposing to add paragraphs
§ 414.408(j)(5)(i)(C)(1) through (3) which
state if the beneficiary chooses not to
continue to receive a grandfathered
item(s) from the noncontract supplier,
the supplier must provide the
beneficiary with 2 additional notices
prior to picking up its equipment. These
notices are described below as the 10Day Notification and the 2-Day
Notification.
(i) 10-Day Notification
Ten business days prior to picking up
the item, the supplier should have
direct contact (for example, a phone
call) with the beneficiary or the
beneficiary’s caregiver and receive
acknowledgement that the beneficiary
understands their equipment will be
picked up and that this should occur on
the first anniversary date after the start
of the CBP or another date agreed to by
the beneficiary. The noncontract
supplier must bill and will be paid for
the furnishing of the equipment up to
the first anniversary date after the start
of the CBP and the new supplier cannot
bill for furnishing the equipment prior
to this anniversary date. This
requirement still applies if a date other
than the anniversary date is chosen.
The beneficiary’s anniversary date
occurs every month on the date of the
month on which the item was first
delivered to the beneficiary by the
current supplier. The anniversary date
marks the date of every month on which
a new monthly rental period begins. For
example, using July 1 as the beginning
date of the Medicare DMEPOS CBP:
• If a beneficiary’s last anniversary
date before the beginning of the CBP is
June 29, the noncontract supplier must
submit a claim for the rental month
beginning June 29 and ending July 28.
The noncontract supplier should not
pick up the equipment prior to July 29.
In this case, the noncontract supplier
has been paid up to July 29 and
therefore should pick up its equipment
on July 29, and the contract supplier
would deliver its equipment on July 29
and begin billing for the next month’s
rental as of that date.
• If a beneficiary’s anniversary date is
July 1, also the beginning date for the
CBP, the noncontract supplier should
not pick up the equipment before July
1 and should not submit a claim for the
July rental period. The contract supplier
should deliver the equipment to the
beneficiary on July 1 and submit a claim
for this month.
When a DME supplier submits a
monthly bill for capped rental DME
items, the date of delivery (‘‘from’’ date)
on the first claim must be the ‘‘from’’ or
anniversary date on all subsequent
claims for the item. For example, if the
first claim for a wheelchair is dated
September 15, all subsequent bills must
be dated for the 15th of the following
months (October 15, November 15, etc.).
In cases where the anniversary date falls
at the end of the month (for example,
January 31) and a subsequent month
does not have a day with the same date
(for example, February), the final date in
the calendar month (for example,
February 28) will be used.
(ii) 2-Day Notification
Two business days prior to picking up
the item, the supplier must contact the
beneficiary by phone to remind the
beneficiary of the date the supplier will
pick up the item. This supplier should
not pick up the item before the
beneficiary’s first anniversary date that
occurs after the start of the CBP.
There may be unusual circumstances
that make it difficult to contact certain
beneficiaries. However, we do not
expect this to occur often because these
suppliers have been submitting monthly
rental claims for providing services to
these beneficiaries. Therefore, the
supplier should have an ongoing
relationship with the beneficiary and be
aware of how to contact them and any
changes in their circumstances.
However, under no circumstance should
a supplier pick up a rented item prior
to the supplier’s receiving
acknowledgement from the beneficiary
that they are aware of the date on which
the supplier is picking up the item and
that arrangements have been made to
have the item replaced on that date by
a contract supplier. The pickup of the
noncontract supplier’s equipment and
the delivery of the new contract
supplier’s equipment should occur on
the same date. The pick up by the
noncontract supplier and the delivery
by the contract supplier should occur on
the first rental anniversary date of the
equipment that occurs after the start of
the CBP. When a beneficiary chooses to
switch to a new contract supplier, the
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00130
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
current noncontract supplier and the
new contract supplier must make
arrangements that are suitable to the
beneficiary. This provides some
latitude, for the pickup and the delivery
date but not in terms of billing. The new
equipment cannot be billed for until the
anniversary date and the old equipment
cannot be taken from the beneficiary
before the anniversary date.
c. Notification to CMS for Suppliers
That Choose To Become Grandfathered
We are proposing to add
§ 414.408(j)(5)(ii) to state that suppliers
that have chosen to become
grandfathered suppliers must also notify
CMS of that decision at least 30
business days before the start of the
CBP. We believe that 30 business days
is a reasonable period to allow us to
compile a list of grandfathered suppliers
and to answer questions about the
availability of these suppliers. Unless
the supplier notifies CMS consistent
with this subsection, the supplier will
not be considered a grandfathered
supplier. Having a list of grandfathered
suppliers is important to assist CMS in
administering the grandfathering
process. The list will be used to answer
questions from beneficiaries concerning
which suppliers have chosen the
grandfathering option. The notification
requirement will also help us to ensure
that suppliers are not offering the
grandfathering option to only a select
number of beneficiaries. Also, having a
list of suppliers that have chosen to be
grandfathered suppliers will assist us in
reviewing whether only noncontract
suppliers that have elected to be
grandfathered suppliers have received
Medicare payment for rented
competitive bid items in a CBA.
The notice that a noncontract supplier
must provide to CMS if it elects to
become a grandfathered supplier must
meet the following requirements:
• State that the supplier agrees to
continue to furnish certain rented DME,
oxygen and oxygen equipment that it is
currently furnishing to beneficiaries
(that is, before the start of the CBP) in
a CBA and will continue to provide
these grandfathered items to these
beneficiaries for the remaining months
of the rental period.
• Include all of the following: Name
and address of the supplier; 6-digit NSC
number of the supplier; and product
category(s) by CBA for which the
supplier is willing to be a grandfathered
supplier.
• Suppliers with multiple locations
must submit one notification for the
company rather than for each individual
location.
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
• State that the supplier agrees to
meet all the terms and conditions
applicable to grandfathered suppliers.
• Be provided by the supplier to CMS
in writing at least 30 business days
before the start date of the
implementation of a CBP.
d. Notifications of Beneficiaries by
Suppliers That Choose Not To Become
Grandfathered Suppliers
We propose to clarify under
§ 414.408(j)(6) that a noncontract
supplier that elects not to become a
grandfathered supplier is required to
pick up the item it is currently renting
to the beneficiary from the beneficiary’s
home after proper notice to the
beneficiary. A noncontract supplier that
decides not to become a grandfathered
supplier does not have the option of
leaving its equipment in the
beneficiary’s home. The noncontract
supplier is responsible for picking up
the item from the beneficiary.
Proper notification by a supplier who
chooses not to become a grandfathered
supplier must include a 30-day, a 10day, and a 2-day notice of its decision
not to be a grandfathered supplier.
These notifications must meet all of the
requirements listed above for the 30day, 10-day and 2-day notices that must
be sent by suppliers who decide to be
grandfathered suppliers, except for the
following differences for the 30-day
notice.
• The 30-day notice must indicate the
items for which the supplier has
decided not to become a grandfathered
supplier and indicate the date upon
which the equipment will be picked up.
• It must state that the supplier will
only continue to rent these
competitively bid item(s) up to the
beneficiary’s first anniversary date, as
defined in § 414.408(j)(5), that occurs
after the start of the Medicare DMEPOS
CBP.
• It must also state that the
beneficiary must select a contract
supplier for Medicare to continue to pay
for these items.
• It must state that the beneficiary can
obtain information about the CBP by
calling 1–800–MEDICARE or accessing
https://www.medicare.gov on the
Internet.
• It must also refer him or her to the
supplier locator tool on https://
www.medicare.gov.
The supplier must also provide the
beneficiary with the 10-day and the 2day notices prior to picking up their
equipment.
When a beneficiary chooses to switch
to a new contract supplier, the current
noncontract supplier and the new
contract supplier must make
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
arrangements that are suitable to the
beneficiary. This provides some
latitude, but the new equipment may
not be billed by the contract supplier
until the first anniversary date following
the start of the CBP. Also, the old
equipment may not be taken from the
beneficiary before proper arrangements
are made and the date of service cannot
occur before the anniversary date.
As discussed above, under no
circumstance should a supplier pick up
the rented item prior to the supplier
making an arrangement with the new
contract supplier for the delivery of the
new equipment at a time suitable to
meet the beneficiary’s medical needs.
The noncontract supplier has been
furnishing services to the beneficiary
and receiving payments from the
program. To ensure that the beneficiary
has continued access to medically
necessary equipment, the noncontract
supplier is expected to assist the
beneficiary in locating a contract
supplier. The noncontract supplier
should communicate with the
beneficiary the urgency of arranging to
have the new equipment delivered as
soon as possible.
P. Physician Fee Schedule Update for
CY 2010
Since 1999, PFS rates have been
updated under the sustainable growth
rate (SGR) system. The general concept
under the SGR system is that growth in
total expenditures for physicians’
services should be limited to sustainable
levels. If expenditures exceed a
statutorily determined percentage
increase amount, the PFS update for the
following year is reduced. If
expenditures are less than the
percentage increase amount, the PFS
update is increased in the following
year. There is a recognized tendency for
physicians to increase the volume and
intensity of their services over time.
Incentives under SGR system were
intended to encourage physicians to
regulate their collective behavior in that
regard in order to avoid decreases in
future updates. The SGR is also a
cumulative system. The update is
adjusted based on a comparison of
cumulative actual spending to target
spending from a base period through the
current year. Thus, if spending exceeds
the target in a single year, the following
year’s update must be adjusted to
reduce annual expenditures, as well as
recoup the difference between target
and actual spending in the prior year.
Under a cumulative system, deviations
between target and actual spending have
the potential to result in significantly
more payment rate adjustments when
actual spending exceeds target spending
PO 00000
Frm 00131
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33649
even in a single year. 20 Further, under
a cumulative system, past increases in
spending levels above the target will
continue to affect future PFS updates
until there have been sufficient
adjustments to make target and actual
spending equal.
Despite the intended incentives,
actual spending under the SGR system
has deviated significantly from target
spending. In the CY 2004 PFS final rule
with comment period (68 FR 63248), we
estimated CY 2003 allowed
expenditures at $71.7 billion and CY
2003 actual expenditures at $77.8
billion for a difference of $6.1 billion (or
8.5 percent of allowed spending). The
cumulative difference between target
and actual expenditures estimated at the
time was $7.8 billion (that is, the $6.1
billion plus an additional $1.7 billion
for past differences between target and
actual spending since the 1996/1997
base year not previously accounted for
through adjustments to the PFS update).
Under the statutory formula, CMS was
required to announce a reduction in PFS
rates of 4.5 percent for CY 2004:
[T]he negative physician fee schedule
update gives us no alternative to reducing
physician fee schedule rates. Only Congress
can change the law and avert a reduction in
2004 physician fee schedule rates. (68 FR
63239)
On November 25, 2003, the Congress
enacted the Medicare Prescription Drug,
Improvement, and Modernization Act of
2003 (MMA) (Pub. L. 108–173). The
President signed the MMA into law on
December 8, 2003. Section 601 of MMA
amended section 1848(d) of the Act to
specify that the update to the single
conversion factor (CF) for CYs 2004 and
2005 shall not be less than 1.5 percent.
Thus, instead of applying an update of
¥4.5 percent in 2004, we applied an
increase of 1.5 percent to PFS rates. The
Congress took similar actions to avert
reductions to PFS rates for CYs 2006
through 2009. Because the legislation
did not affect the computation of the
levels of allowed and actual
expenditures for these years, there is
now a substantial difference between
cumulative target and actual spending
that must be accounted for through
future reductions to PFS rates. In a
March 1, 2009 letter from CMS to the
MedPAC, we estimated the difference
between cumulative target and actual
spending from the 1996/1997 base year
through December 2009 at $69.7 billion.
We estimated the PFS update would be
20 The adjustments to equate allowed and actual
spending do not occur in a single year. The
Balanced Budget Refinement Act of 1999 specifies
a formula that makes the adjustment to account for
differences between target and actual spending over
multiple years.
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33650
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
¥21.5 percent for CY 2010. As there are
limits to how much PFS rates can be
reduced in a single year and the
estimated ¥21.5 percent PFS update
will not fully account for the difference
between target and actual spending, we
are estimating further reductions of
between 5 and 6.5 percent for the next
several years.
Although the Congress has acted to
avert reductions in the past several
years, these projections have led us to
reexamine administrative actions that
the Secretary could take to lessen the
potential for repeated further reductions
in the PFS update. The Administration
believes that the current Medicare
physician payment system, while
having served to limit spending to a
degree, needs to be reformed to give
physicians appropriate incentives to
improve the quality and efficiency of
the care provided to Medicare
beneficiaries. As part of health care
reform, the Administration supports
comprehensive, but fiscally responsible,
reforms to the physician payment
formula. Consistent with this goal, the
Administration announced in the FY
2010 President’s Budget that it would
explore the breadth of options available
under current authority to facilitate
such reforms, including an assessment
of whether the cost of physicianadministered drugs should continue to
be included in the payment formula.
The statutory formula for calculating
the update adjustment factor, which
includes the SGR, was designed to
establish reasonable limits on the
growth of expenditures on physicians’
services, and to provide incentives for
physicians to keep the growth in
expenditures within those limits. The
SGR system was created by section 4503
of the Balanced Budget Act of 1997
(BBA) (Pub. L. 105–33). It replaced the
predecessor system, the Medicare
Volume Performance System (MVPS).
However, the statutory definition of
‘‘physicians’ services’’ for purposes of
the SGR (section 1848(f)(4)(A) of the
Act) is the same as that used for the
MVPS (no longer in existence, but
previously at section 1848(f)(5)(A) of the
Act):
The term ‘‘physicians’ services’’ includes
other items and services (such as clinical
diagnostic laboratory tests and radiology
services), specified by the Secretary, that are
commonly performed by a physician or in a
physician’s office.
Under the MVPS, we defined
‘‘physicians’ services’’ to include
physician-administered drugs.
Therefore, we adopted the same
regulatory definition at the outset of the
SGR system:
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
Because the scope of physicians’ services
covered by the SGR is the same as the scope
of services that was covered by the Medicare
volume performance standards, we are using
the same definition of physicians’ services
for the SGR in this notice as we did for the
Medicare volume performance standards.
* * * (63 FR 59188)
Physician-administered drugs are
covered under section 1861(s)(2)(A) of
the Act as ‘‘services and supplies
(including drugs and biologicals which
are not usually self-administered by the
patient) furnished as an incident to a
physician’s professional services, of
kinds which are commonly furnished in
physicians’ offices.’’ Physicianadministered drugs are not paid for
under the PFS (56 FR 25800). However,
in identifying items and services to be
included in the definition of
‘‘physicians’ services’’ our ‘‘practice has
been to make adjustments to the SGR for
medical and other health services * * *
that meet the criterion of being
‘‘commonly performed by a physician or
in a physician’s office’’ (66 FR 55316).
Because ‘‘incident to’’ drugs are
commonly furnished in physicians’
offices, we elected to continue to
include them in the definition of
‘‘physicians’ services’’ for the SGR.
Similarly, clinical diagnostic laboratory
tests, which are not paid for under the
PFS, have always been included in the
definition of ‘‘physicians’ services’’ for
purposes of the SGR.
Historically, growth in the cost of
prescription drugs has far outpaced
growth in the cost of other physicians’
services. From the 1st quarter of 1997
through the 1st quarter of 2005, the
average annual growth in Medicare
spending on drugs included in the SGR
was 22 percent compared to 6 percent
for all services (including drugs)
included in the SGR. As a result, since
the inception of the SGR methodology,
prescription drugs have accounted for
an increasingly disproportionate
amount of the growth in spending on
physicians’ services. At the time, we
made the decision to include physicianadministered drugs in the definition of
‘‘physicians’ services’’ used to compute
the SGR, these drugs represented a
much smaller volume of Medicare
spending than they have in subsequent
years. In the CY 2003 PFS final rule
with comment period, we estimated that
drugs would represent 7.3 percent of
2001 SGR spending (67 FR 80031). In
the CY 2006 PFS final rule with
comment period, we estimated that
drugs would represent 9.9 percent of
2004 SGR spending. In the CY 2007 PFS
final rule with comment period, we
stated that ‘‘commenters noted that
expenditures on these drugs increased
PO 00000
Frm 00132
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
from $1.8 billion in 1996, to $8.6 billion
in 2004’’ (71 FR 69755). These figures
clearly demonstrate that spending on
physician-administered drugs has been
growing at much higher rates than
spending for all other PFS services and
has contributed significantly to the
deviation between target and actual
spending, as well as to the large
projected reductions in future PFS
updates. There could be many reasons
for the disproportionate growth in
expenditures for drugs—many of which
we could not have anticipated when we
decided to include drugs in the SGR. In
the CY 2006 PFS final rule with
comment period (70 FR 70307), we
summarized public comments on the
proposed rule that stated that growth in
Medicare spending on drugs is driven
primarily by the introduction of
expensive new drugs to the Medicare
population and extensive marketing
(including direct-to-consumer
advertising). Given the significant and
disproportionate impact that the
inclusion of drugs has had on the SGR
system, we believe it would be
appropriate to revise the definition of
physicians’ services for purposes of the
SGR.
As previously noted, the statutory
definition of ‘‘physicians’ services’’ for
purposes of determining allowed
expenditures and the SGR (section
1848(f)(4)(A) of the Act) states:
The term ‘‘physicians’ services’’ includes
other items and services (such as clinical
diagnostic laboratory tests and radiology
services), specified by the Secretary, that are
commonly performed by a physician or in a
physician’s office.
The statute clarifies that the term
‘‘physicians’ services’’ includes items
and services ‘‘specified by the
Secretary.’’ Therefore, we believe the
statute provides the Secretary with clear
discretion to decide whether physicianadministered drugs should be included
or excluded from the definition of
‘‘physicians’ services.’’ As the statute
affords the Secretary clear discretion,
we are proposing, in anticipation of
enactment of legislation to provide
fundamental reforms to Medicare
physician payments, to remove
physician-administered drugs from the
definition of ‘‘physicians’ services’’ in
section 1848(f)(4)(A) of the Act for
purposes of computing the SGR and
levels of allowed expenditures and
actual expenditures in all future years.
Moreover, given the past effect of
spending growth for physicianadministered drugs on future PFS
updates, in order to effectuate fully the
Secretary’s policy decision to remove
drugs from the definition of
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
‘‘physicians’ services’’ in section
1848(f)(4)(A) of the Act, it is reasonable
to remove drugs from the calculation of
allowed and actual expenditures for all
prior years.
We note the term ‘‘actual
expenditures’’ is not defined in the
statute nor are there any statutory
limitations on the Secretary’s ability to
recompute actual expenditures to reflect
changes in the amount of actual
expenditures. On several occasions, we
have made revisions to the amount of
actual expenditures to reflect new
information regarding spending on
physicians’ services. For instance, in the
CY 2002 PFS final rule with comment
period (66 FR 55314), we indicated that
a number of new procedures were
inadvertently not included in the
measurement of actual expenditures
beginning in 1998. We determined that
spending for these codes must be
included in actual expenditures for
historical, current, and future periods.
Similarly, in the CY 2009 PFS final rule
with comment period, we discovered
that fifteen procedure codes were
inadvertently omitted from the
measurement of actual expenditures
beginning in 1998 (73 FR 69902). Again,
we stated that spending for these codes
must be included in actual expenditures
for historical, current, and future
periods.
Under section 1848(d)(3)(C)(i) of the
Act, the level of allowed expenditures
during the base year (April 1, 1996
through March 31, 1997) is equal to the
actual expenditures for this period.
Thus, as there are no statutory
restrictions on the Secretary’s ability to
recompute actual expenditures to
remove the costs associated with
physician-administered drugs, the
Secretary also has authority to remove
these drugs from the calculation of
allowed expenditures during the base
year. Allowed expenditures in a year are
based on the allowed expenditures in
the prior year, updated by the SGR as
specified in section 1848(d)(3)(C)(ii) of
the Act for FY 1998 through FY 2000,
and section 1848(d)(4)(C)(iii) for all
subsequent years. Thus, once the
Secretary has revised the level of
allowed expenditures during the base
year (as is authorized under the statute),
it is reasonable to carry this revision
through into all subsequent years. As
the statute affords the Secretary
flexibility to remove drugs from the
calculation of allowed expenditures
retrospectively to the base year, we are
proposing to remove drugs from the
calculation of allowed and actual
expenditures under sections
1848(d)(3)(C) and 1848(d)(4) of the Act
retrospectively to the 1996/1997 base
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
year in order to eliminate the
disproportionate impact that the large
past increases in the costs attributable to
physician-administered drugs would
otherwise have upon future PFS
updates. Further, the proposal would
remove drugs from the calculation of the
SGR beginning with 2010.
We note that the Secretary may
choose not to finalize the proposal
described above or may choose to
modify the proposal in the final rule,
consistent with rulemaking principles,
in light of new policy developments,
new information, or changed
circumstances.
We currently estimate that the
statutory formula used to determine the
physician update will result in a CY
2010 conversion factor of $28.3208 and
a PFS update of ¥21.5 percent. Under
this proposal, removing physicianadministered drugs from allowed and
actual expenditures for all prior years
will not change the projected ¥21.5
percent physician payment rate update
for services furnished on or after
January 1, 2010. This proposal would,
however, reduce the past discrepancy
between actual and target expenditures.
As a result, it would reduce the number
of years in which physicians are
projected to experience a negative
update. We note that this proposal does
not mean that we are making any
changes to PFS rates applicable in prior
years. Rather, we are proposing to
remove drugs from the calculation of
allowed and actual expenditures since
the 1996/1997 base year so that past
year increases in drug spending would
have no affect on the determination of
future PFS rates.
III. Collection of Information
Requirements
Under the Paperwork Reduction Act
of 1995, we are required to provide 60day notice in the Federal Register and
solicit public comment before a
collection of information requirement is
submitted to the Office of Management
and Budget (OMB) for review and
approval. In order to fairly evaluate
whether an information collection
should be approved by OMB, section
3506(c)(2)(A) of the Paperwork
Reduction Act of 1995 requires that we
solicit comment on the following issues:
• The need for the information
collection and its usefulness in carrying
out the proper functions of our agency.
• The accuracy of our estimate of the
information collection burden.
• The quality, utility, and clarity of
the information to be collected.
• Recommendations to minimize the
information collection burden on the
PO 00000
Frm 00133
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33651
affected public, including automated
collection techniques.
We are soliciting public comment on
each of these issues for the following
sections of this document that contain
information collection requirements
(ICRs):
A. ICRs Regarding Pulmonary
Rehabilitation Program: Conditions for
Coverage (§ 410.47)
Section 410.47(c) lists the
components of a pulmonary
rehabilitation program. Specifically,
§ 410.47(c)(3) through (c)(5) discuss
psychosocial assessments, outcome
assessments and individualized
treatment plans, respectively, and the
role of these tools in pulmonary
rehabilitation programs. The burden
associated with meeting the
requirements for conducting
psychosocial assessments, outcome
assessments, and individualized
treatment plans is the time and effort
necessary for providers to document the
necessary information in the patient
record. While these requirements are
subject to the PRA, we believe the
associated burden is exempt as stated
under 5 CFR 1320.3(b)(2). Psychosocial
assessments, outcome assessments and
individualized treatment plans are
routine tools used in pulmonary
rehabilitation programs and the practice
of using these tools is generally
recognized as an industry standard as
part of usual and customary business
practices.
B. ICRs Regarding Kidney Disease
Education Services (§ 410.48)
Proposed § 410.48(f) states qualified
persons will develop outcomes
assessments designed to:
• Measure beneficiary knowledge
about chronic kidney disease (CKD) and
its treatment;
• Assess program effectiveness of
preparing the beneficiary to make
informed decisions about their
healthcare options related to CKD; and
• Assess program effectiveness in
meeting the communication needs of
underserved populations, including
persons with disabilities, persons with
limited English proficiency, and persons
with health literacy needs.
We are proposing that the assessment
will be administered to the beneficiary
during one of the kidney disease
education (KDE) sessions prescribed by
the referring physician. The assessments
will be made available to CMS upon
request.
The burden associated with these
requirements is the time and effort
necessary to conduct an outcomes
assessment, maintain record of the
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33652
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
assessment, and to make the
documentation available to CMS upon
request. At this time, CMS is not able to
accurately quantify the burden because
we cannot estimate the number of
entities that must comply with these
requirements. Additionally, we are
trying to determine if the use and
maintenance of outcome assessments in
KDE services is a standard industry
business practice. Our preliminary
research gathered during a CMS Open
Door Forum held on November 6, 2008
and a stakeholders meeting hosted by
the Agency for Healthcare Research and
Quality (AHRQ) on December 16, 2008
indicates that outcome assessments are
used by most but not all of the entities
bound by the proposed requirements in
§ 410.48. We welcome comments
pertaining to this issue and will
reevaluate all related PRA burden issues
in the final rule stage of rulemaking.
C. ICRs Regarding Cardiac
Rehabilitation Program and Intensive
Cardiac Rehabilitation Program:
Conditions of Coverage (§ 410.49)
Proposed § 410.49(b)(2) lists the
required components of a cardiac
rehabilitation program. Four of the five
required components, including cardiac
risk factor modification, psychosocial
assessments, outcomes assessments and
individualized treatment plans, impose
information collection burdens. The
burden associated with these
requirements is the time and effort
necessary to providers to customize
each patient’s cardiac risk modification
program. Additionally, there is burden
associated with conducting
psychosocial assessments and outcome
assessments and drafting individualized
treatment plans. Although section
144(a) of the MIPPA sets forth these
information collection requirements, we
believe the associated information
collection burden is exempt as stated
under 5 CFR 1320.3(b)(2). Performing
cardiac risk modification, psychosocial
assessments, outcome assessments, and
individualized treatment plans are
routine tools used in cardiac
rehabilitation programs. As stated
earlier in the preamble of this proposed
rule, intensive cardiac rehabilitation
programs typically involve the same
elements as general cardiac
rehabilitation programs, but are
furnished in highly structured
environments in which sessions of the
various components may be combined
for longer periods of cardiac
rehabilitation and also may be more
rigorous. The ICRs and associated
burden are generally recognized as an
industry standard as part of usual and
customary business practices.
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
Proposed § 410.49(c)(1) states that to
be designated an intensive cardiac
rehabilitation program, a program in an
approved setting must apply for
designation. To be designated as an
intensive cardiac rehabilitation
program, the program must demonstrate
through peer-reviewed, published
research that it accomplishes one or
more of the requirements listed in
§ 410.49(c)(1)(i) through (iv). As
required by § 410.49(c)(3), sites must
demonstrate that patients enrolled
continue to achieve beneficial outcomes
by submitting outcomes data annually
from the date of approval as an
intensive cardiac rehabilitation site to
ensure that intensive cardiac
rehabilitation programs maintain the
designated quality of rehabilitation.
The burden associated with the
requirements in § 410.49(c) is the time
and effort necessary for a program to
demonstrate through peer-reviewed,
published research that it accomplishes
one or more of the requirements listed
in § 410.49(c)(1)(i) through (iv) and the
time and effort necessary to annually
submit outcomes data. At this time,
CMS is not able to accurately quantify
the burden because we cannot estimate
the number of entities that will seek
designation as intensive cardiac
rehabilitation programs. We welcome
comments pertaining to this issue and
will reevaluate all related PRA burden
issues in the final rule stage of
rulemaking.
D. ICRs Regarding Imaging
Accreditation (§ 414.68)
Proposed § 414.68(b) contains the
application and reapplication
procedures for accreditation
organizations. Specifically, an
independent accreditation organization
applying for approval or reapproval of
authority to survey suppliers for
purposes of accrediting suppliers
furnishing the technical component
(TC) of advanced diagnostic imaging
services must furnish CMS with all of
the information listed in proposed
§ 414.68(b)(1) through (14). The
requirements include but are not limited
to reporting, notification,
documentation, and survey
requirements.
The burden associated with the
proposed collection requirements in
§ 414.68(b) is the time and effort
necessary to develop, compile and
submit the information listed in
§ 414.68(b)(1) through (14). We believe
that 3 entities will choose to comply
with these requirements. We estimate
that it will take each of the 3 entities,
80 hours to submit a complete
application for approval or reapproval
PO 00000
Frm 00134
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
authority to become an accrediting
organization approved by CMS.
Proposed § 414.68(c) contains the
information collection requirements
pertaining to CMS approved accrediting
organizations. An accrediting
organization approved by CMS must
undertake all of the activities listed in
§ 414.68(c)(1) through (6). The burden
associated with the proposed collection
requirements in § 414.68(c) is the time
and effort necessary to develop, compile
and submit the information listed in
§ 414.68(c)(1) through (6). We believe
that 3 entities will choose to comply
with these requirements. We estimate
that it will take each of the 3 entities,
80 hours to submit the required
information on an ongoing basis.
Proposed § 414.68(d)(1) states that
CMS or its contractor may conduct an
audit of an accredited supplier, examine
the results of a CMS approved
accreditation organization’s survey of a
supplier, or observe a CMS approved
accreditation organization’s onsite
survey of a supplier, in order to validate
the CMS approved accreditation
organizations accreditation process. The
burden associated with this requirement
is the time and effort necessary for an
accrediting organization to comply with
the components of the validation audit.
While this requirement is subject to the
PRA, we believe the associated burden
is exempt as stated in 5 CFR
1320.3(h)(6). The burden associated
with a request for facts addressed to a
single person, as defined in 5 CFR
1320.3(j), is not subject to the PRA.
As stated in proposed § 414.68(e)(1),
an accreditation organization
dissatisfied with a determination that its
accreditation requirements do not
provide or do not continue to provide
reasonable assurance that the suppliers
accredited by the organization meet the
applicable quality standards is entitled
to a reconsideration. CMS reconsiders
any determination to deny, remove, or
not to renew the approval of deeming
authority to an accreditation
organization if the accrediting
organization files a written request for
reconsideration by its authorized
officials or through its legal
representative. The written request must
be filed within 30 calendar days of the
receipt of CMS’ notice of an adverse
determination or nonrenewal. In
addition, the request must also specify
the findings or issues with which the
accreditation organization disagrees and
the reasons for the disagreement.
The burden associated with this
requirement is the time and effort
necessary for an accrediting
organization to file develop and file
written request for reconsideration.
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
While this requirement is subject to the
PRA, the associated burden is exempt
under 5 CFR 1320.4. The information in
question is being collected as a result of
an administrative action; accrediting
organizations are submitting requests for
reconsideration after receiving a notice
of an adverse determination or
nonrenewal.
E. ICRs Regarding Payment Rules
(§ 414.408)
Proposed § 414.408(j)(5) contains the
notification requirements for suppliers
electing to become grandfathered
suppliers. Specifically, § 414.408(j)(5)(i)
states that a noncontract supplier that
elects to become a grandfathered
supplier must provide a 30-day written
notification to each Medicare
beneficiary that resides in a competitive
bidding area and is currently renting a
competitively bid item from that
supplier. The 30-day notification to the
beneficiary must meet the requirements
as listed in § 414.408(j)(5)(i)(A) through
(G).
Subsequent to the initial 30-day
notice to the beneficiary, as required by
§ 414.408(j)(5)(ii), suppliers must also
obtain and maintain a record of the
beneficiary’s election choice, the date
the choice was made, and the manner
through which the beneficiary
communicated his or her choice.
Additionally, § 414.408(j)(5)(iii) states
that if a beneficiary chooses not to
continue to receive a grandfathered
item(s) from his or her current supplier,
the supplier must provide the
beneficiary with two more notices prior
to the supplier picking up its
equipment. The supplier must provide a
10-day notification and a 2-day
notification. These notification
requirements must meet the criteria
listed in § 414.408(j)(5)(iii)(A) through
(C).
Section § 414.408(j)(5)(iv) requires
suppliers that elect to become
grandfathered suppliers to provide a
written notification to CMS of its
election decision. The notification must
meet the requirements as specified in
§ 414.408(j)(5)(iv)(A) through (D).
The burden associated with the
information collection requirements
contained in proposed § 414.408(j)(5) is
the time and effort necessary for a
noncontract supplier to make the
aforementioned notifications to both
beneficiaries and CMS. We estimate that
1,305 suppliers will elect to become
grandfathered suppliers. Similarly, we
estimate that each grandfathered
supplier will need to make an average
of 53 notifications based on an average
of 52 beneficiaries per supplier and one
notice to CMS. We estimate that it will
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
take 2 hours to develop the notification
to the beneficiary and 2 hours to
develop the notification to CMS.
Similarly, we estimate that each
notification will take 15 minutes to
send. The total estimated burden
associated with each of the 1305
suppliers complying with the
requirements in proposed § 414.408(j)(5)
is 17.25 hours per supplier for a total of
22,511 hours.
Proposed § 414.408(j)(6) contains the
information collection requirements
pertaining to suppliers that choose not
to become grandfathered suppliers. A
noncontract supplier that elects not to
become a grandfathered supplier is
required to pick up the item it is
currently renting to the beneficiary from
the beneficiary’s home after proper
notification. Proper notification
includes a 30-day, a 10-day, and a 2-day
notice of the supplier’s decision not to
become a grandfathered supplier to its
Medicare beneficiaries who are
currently renting certain DME
competitively bid item(s) and who
reside in a CBA. These notifications
must meet all of the requirements listed
in proposed § 414.408(j)(5)(i) and (ii) for
the 30-day, 10-day and 2-day notices
that must be sent by suppliers who
decide to be grandfathered suppliers.
However, there are exceptions regarding
the 30-day notice for noncontract
suppliers electing not to become
grandfathered suppliers. The exceptions
are listed in proposed
§ 414.408(j)(6)(iii)(A) through (C). In
addition, suppliers must also comply
with the criteria listed in proposed
§ 414.408(j)(6)(iv).
The burden associated with the
proposed information collection
requirements in § 414.408(j)(6) is the
time and effort necessary for a supplier
to make the required notifications to
beneficiaries. We estimate that 145
suppliers will not elect to become
grandfathered suppliers. Similarly, we
estimate that each nongrandfathered
supplier will need to make an average
of 156 notifications based on an average
of 52 beneficiaries per supplier. We
estimate that it will take 2 hours to
develop the 30-day notification to the
beneficiary and 15 minutes to send out
each notification. The 10-day
notification will take approximately 15
minutes and the 2-day will take
approximately 15 minutes. We estimate
to send out all 3 notifications it will take
a total of approximately 45 minutes. The
total burden associated with the
requirements in proposed § 414.408(j)(6)
is approximately 5,945 hours.
PO 00000
Frm 00135
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33653
F. ICRs Regarding Claims for Damages
(§ 414.425)
Proposed § 414.425(a) states that any
aggrieved supplier, including a member
of a network that was awarded a
contract for the Round 1 Durable
Medical Prosthetics, Orthotics, and
Supplies Competitive Bidding Program
(DMEPOS CBP), may file a claim under
this section for certain alleged damages
arising out of MIPPA’s termination of
the Round 1 DMEPOS CBP contracts.
Section 414.425(b) states that a
completed claim, including all
documentation, must be filed within 90
days of the effective date of the final
rule on damages, unless that day is a
holiday or Sunday in which case it will
revert to the next business day. Section
414.425(c) lists the required
documentation for submitting a claim.
The burden associated with this
requirement is the time and effort
necessary to gather required
documentation as specified in
§ 414.425(c) and submit a claim for
damages. This requirement is for a onetime process that will only impact those
suppliers who were awarded a contract
and were potentially damaged by the
termination of their contracts by MIPPA.
We awarded contracts to 329 suppliers.
We expect that it will take
approximately 3 hours for a supplier to
gather the necessary documents and to
file a claim. We anticipate that
anywhere between 5 and 250 suppliers
may submit a claim for damages.
While this requirement is subject to
the PRA, we believe the associated
burden is exempt under 5 CFR 1320.4.
The information in question is being
collected as a result of an administrative
action; suppliers are submitting claims
for damages caused by the termination
of contracts awarded in 2008 under the
DMEPOS Competitive Bidding program
that were terminated as a result of
section 154(a)(1)(A)(iv) of the MIPPA.
G. ICRs Dispute Resolution and Process
for Suspension or Termination of
Approved CAP Contract and
Termination of Physician Participation
Under Exigent Circumstances
(§ 414.917)
As stated in proposed § 414.97, an
approved CAP vendor may appeal that
termination by requesting a
reconsideration. A determination must
be made as to whether the approved
CAP vendor has been meeting the
service and quality obligations of its
CAP contract. The approved CAP
vendor’s contract will remain
suspended during the reconsideration
process.
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33654
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
The burden associated with this
requirement is the time and effort
necessary for a CAP vendor to request
a reconsideration of the termination.
While this requirement is subject to the
PRA, we believe the associated burden
is exempt under 5 CFR 1320.4. The
burden associated with collecting
information subsequent to an
administrative action is not subject to
the PRA.
H. ICRs Regarding Compendia for
Determination of Medically-Accepted
Indications for Off-Label Uses of Drugs
and Biologicals in an Anti-Cancer
Chemotherapeutic Regimen (§ 414.930)
As stated in the definition for a
publicly transparent process for
evaluating therapies in proposed
§ 414.930(a), a compendium must make
the following materials available to the
public on its Web site, coincident with
the compendium’s publication of the
related recommendation:
(i) The application for inclusion of a
therapy including criteria used to
evaluate the request.
(ii) A listing of all the evidentiary
materials reviewed or considered by the
compendium pursuant to the
application.
(iii) A listing of all individuals (and
their affiliations and sources of financial
support) who have substantively
participated in the development of
compendia recommendations.
(iv) Transcripts of meetings and
records of the votes, including
abstentions, related to the therapeutic
recommendation on the application.
The definition for a publicly
transparent process for identifying
conflicts of interests in proposed
§ 414.930(a), states that a compendium
must make the following materials
available to the public, coincident with
the compendium’s publication of the
related recommendation:
(i) Direct or indirect financial
relationships that exist between
individuals who have substantively
participated in the development of
compendia recommendations and the
applicant (for example, the
manufacturer or seller of the drug or
biological being reviewed by the
compendium). This may include
compensation arrangements such as
salary, grant, contract, or collaboration
agreements between individuals who
have substantively participated in the
development of compendia
recommendations.
(ii) Ownership or investment interests
of individuals who have substantively
participated in the development of
compendia recommendations and the
applicant (for example, the
manufacturer or seller of the drug or
biological being reviewed by the
compendium).
The requirements in proposed
§ 414.930(a) constitute third-party
disclosures. While third-party
disclosures are subject to the PRA, we
believe the associated burden is exempt
under 5 CFR 1320.3(c)(4). Less than 10
persons or entities within a 12-month
period will be required to comply.
TABLE 37—ESTIMATED ANNUAL REPORTING AND RECORDKEEPING BURDEN
Regulation section(s)
OMB control No.
§ 414.68(b) ......................................................
§ 414.68(c) ......................................................
§ 414.408(j)(5) .................................................
§ 414.408(j)(6) .................................................
Total .........................................................
0938–New ...........................
0938–New ...........................
0938–New ...........................
0938–New ...........................
........................................
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
If you comment on these information
collection and recordkeeping
requirements, please do either of the
following:
1. Submit your comments
electronically as specified in the
ADDRESSES section of this proposed rule;
or
2. Submit your comments to the
Office of Information and Regulatory
Affairs, Office of Management and
Budget, Attention: CMS Desk Officer,
[CMS–1413–P]; Fax: (202) 395–6974; or
E-mail: OIRA_submission@omb.eop.gov.
Additional Information Collection
Requirements
This proposed rule imposes collection
of information requirements as outlined
in the regulation text and specified
above. However, this proposed rule also
makes reference to several associated
Respondents
Responses
3
3
1305
145
information collections that are not
discussed in the regulation text
contained in this document. The
following is a discussion of these
information collections, some of which
have already received OMB approval.
Part B Drug Payment
The discussion of average sales price
(ASP) issues in section II.H.1 of this
proposed rule does not contain any new
information collection requirements
with respect to payment for Medicare
Part B drugs and biologicals under the
ASP methodology. Drug manufacturers
are required to submit ASP data to us
on a quarterly basis. The ASP reporting
requirements are set forth in section
1927(b) of the Act. The burden
associated with this requirement is the
time and effort required by
3
3
69,165
22,620
Burden per
response
(hours)
80
80
17.25
41
Total annual
burden
(hours)
240
240
22,511
5,945
28,936
manufacturers of Medicare Part B drugs
and biologicals to calculate, record, and
submit the required data to CMS. While
the burden associated with this
requirement is subject to the PRA, it is
currently approved under OMB control
number 0938–0921. A revision of the
currently approved information
collection request is currently under
review at OMB.
Competitive Acquisition Program (CAP)
Section II.H.2. of this proposed rule
discusses issues related to the
competitive acquisition program for Part
B drug payment. There are no new
information collection requirements
associated with the CAP; however, there
are several previously approved
information collection requests (ICR)
associated with the CAP.
TABLE 38—OMB CONTROL NUMBERS
OMB control
number
Program component
Medicare Part B Drug and Biological CAP .............................................................................................................
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00136
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
0938–0954
Expiration date
06/30/2011
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
33655
TABLE 38—OMB CONTROL NUMBERS—Continued
OMB control
number
Program component
Medicare Part B Drug and Biological Competitive Acquisition Program Applications 1 .........................................
Competitive Acquisition Program (CAP) for Medicare Part B Drugs: CAP Physician Election Agreement ...........
0938–0955
0938–0987
Expiration date
08/31/2009
12/31/2011
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
1 An extension of the currently approved ICR is currently in the middle of the mandatory 60-day Federal Register notice and comment period.
The ICR will be submitted to OMB for review and approval prior to the expiration date.
Physician Quality Reporting Initiative
(PQRI)
Section II.G.2. of this proposed rule
discusses the background of the PQRI,
provides information about the
measures proposed to be available to
eligible professionals who choose to
participate in the 2010 PQRI, and the
proposed criteria for satisfactory
reporting in 2010. Beginning on January
1, 2010, the Secretary is also required by
section 1848(m)(3)(C) of the Act, to
establish and have in place a process
under which eligible professionals in a
group practice (as defined by the
Secretary) shall be treated as
satisfactorily submitting data on quality
measures under the PQRI.
With respect to satisfactory
submission of data on quality measures
by eligible professionals, eligible
professionals include physicians, other
practitioners as described in section
1842(b)(18)(c) of the Act, physical and
occupational therapists, qualified
speech-language pathologists, and
qualified audiologists. Eligible
professionals may choose whether to
participate and, to the extent they
satisfactorily submit data on quality
measures for covered professional
services, they can qualify to receive an
incentive payment. To qualify to receive
an incentive payment for 2010, the
eligible professional must meet one of
the criteria for satisfactory reporting
described in sections II.G.2.e. and
II.G.2.f. of this proposed rule.
For individual eligible professionals,
the burden associated with the
requirements of this voluntary reporting
initiative is the time and effort
associated with eligible professionals
identifying applicable PQRI quality
measures for which they can report the
necessary information. We believe it is
difficult to accurately quantify the
burden because it would vary with each
eligible professional by the number of
measures applicable to the eligible
professional, the eligible professional’s
familiarity and understanding of the
PQRI, and experience with participating
in the PQRI. In addition, eligible
professionals may employ different
methods for incorporating the use of
quality data codes into the office work
flows.
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
We believe the burden associated
with participating in PQRI has declined
for those familiar with the program and
who have satisfactorily participated in
the 2007 PQRI and/or the 2008 PQRI.
However, because we anticipate even
greater participation in the 2010 PQRI,
including participation by eligible
professionals who are participating in
PQRI for the first time in 2010, we will
assign 3 hours as the amount of time
needed for eligible professionals to
review the list of PQRI quality
measures, identify the applicable
measures for which they can report the
necessary information, review the
measure specifications for those
measures applicable to the eligible
professional, and incorporate the use of
quality data codes for the measures on
which the eligible professional plans to
report into the office work flows.
Information from the Physician
Voluntary Reporting Program (PVRP),
which was a predecessor to the PQRI,
indicated an average labor cost of $50
per hour. To account for salary increases
over time, we will use an average
practice labor cost of $55 per hour in
our estimates based on an assumption of
an average annual increase of
approximately 3 percent. Thus, we
estimate the cost for an eligible
professional to review the list of PQRI
quality measures, identify the
applicable measures for which they can
report the necessary information, review
the measure specifications for those
measures applicable to the eligible
professional, and incorporate the use of
quality data codes for the measures on
which the eligible professional plans to
report into the office work flows to be
approximately $165 per eligible
professional ($55 per hour × 3 hours).
We continue to expect the ongoing
costs associated with PQRI participation
to decline based on an eligible
professional’s familiarity with and
understanding of the PQRI, experience
with participating in the PQRI, and
increased efforts by CMS and
stakeholders to disseminate useful
educational resources and best
practices.
In addition, for claims-based
reporting, eligible professionals must
gather the required information, select
PO 00000
Frm 00137
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
the appropriate quality data codes, and
include the appropriate quality data
codes on the claims they submit for
payment. The PQRI will collect quality
data codes as additional (optional) line
items on the existing HIPAA transaction
837–P and/or CMS Form 1500. We do
not anticipate any new forms and no
modifications to the existing transaction
or form. We also do not anticipate
changes to the 837–P or CMS Form 1500
for CY 2010.
Because this is a voluntary program,
it is impossible to estimate with any
degree of accuracy how many eligible
professionals will opt to participate in
the PQRI in CY 2010. Information from
the ‘‘PQRI 2007 Reporting Experience
Report,’’ which is available on the PQRI
section of the CMS Web site at https://
www.cms.hhs.gov/PQRI, indicates that
nearly 110,000 unique TIN/NPI
combinations attempted to submit PQRI
quality measures data via claims for the
2007 PQRI. Therefore, for purposes of
conducting a burden analysis for the
2010 PQRI, we will assume that all
eligible professionals who attempted to
participate in the 2007 PQRI will also
attempt to participate in the 2010 PQRI.
Moreover, the time needed for an
eligible professional to review the
quality measures and other information,
select measures applicable to his or her
patients and the services he or she
furnishes to them, and incorporate the
use of quality data codes into the office
work flows is expected to vary along
with the number of measures that are
potentially applicable to a given
professional’s practice. Since eligible
professionals are generally required to
report on at least 3 measures to earn a
PQRI incentive, we will assume that
each eligible professional who attempts
to submit PQRI quality measures data is
attempting to earn a PQRI incentive
payment and that each eligible
professional reports on an average of 3
measures for this burden analysis.
Based on our experience with the
PVRP, we continue to estimate that the
time needed to perform all the steps
necessary to report each measure (that
is, reporting the relevant quality data
code(s) for a measure) on claims ranges
from 15 seconds (0.25 minutes) to over
12 minutes for complicated cases and/
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33656
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
or measures, with the median time
being 1.75 minutes. Information from
the PVRP indicates that the cost
associated with this burden ranges from
$0.21 in labor time to about $10.06 in
labor time for more complicated cases
and/or measures, with the cost for the
median practice being $0.90.
The total estimated annual burden for
this requirement will also vary along
with the volume of claims on which
quality data is reported. Since we
propose to require eligible professionals
to report at least one of their selected
measures for at least 15 Medicare Part
B FFS patients in order to satisfactorily
report, then, for this burden analysis, we
will assume that for each measure, the
eligible professional reports the quality
data codes on 15 cases. The actual
number of cases on which an eligible
professional would be required to report
quality measures data will vary,
however, with the eligible professional’s
patient population and the types of
measures on which the eligible
professional chooses to report (each
measure’s specifications includes a
required reporting frequency).
Based on the assumptions discussed
above, we estimate the total annual
burden per eligible professional
associated with claims-based reporting
to range from 191.25 minutes, or 3.2
hours [(0.25 minutes per measure × 3
measures × 15 cases per measure) + 3
hours] to 720 minutes, or 12 hours [(12
minutes per measure × 3 measures × 15
cases per measure) + 3 hours]. We
estimate the total annual cost per
eligible professional associated with
claims-based reporting to range from
$174.45 [($0.21 per measure × 3
measures × 15 cases per measure) +
$165] to $617.70 [($10.06 per measure ×
3 measures × 15 cases per measure) +
$165].
For registry-based reporting, there
would be no additional burden for
eligible professionals to report data to a
registry as eligible professionals opting
for registry-based reporting would more
than likely already be reporting data to
the registry. Little, if any, additional
data would need to be reported to the
registry for purposes of participation in
the 2010 PQRI. However, eligible
professionals would need to authorize
or instruct the registry to submit quality
measures results and numerator and
denominator data on quality measures
to CMS on their behalf. We estimate that
the time and effort associated with this
would be approximately 5 minutes for
each eligible professional that wishes to
authorize or instruct the registry to
submit quality measures results and
numerator and denominator data on
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
quality measures to CMS on their
behalf.
Registries interested in submitting
quality measures results and numerator
and denominator data on quality
measures to CMS on their participants’
behalf in 2010 would need to complete
a self-nomination process in order to be
considered ‘‘qualified’’ to submit on
behalf of eligible professionals unless
the registry was qualified to submit on
behalf of eligible professionals for the
2009 PQRI and did so successfully. We
estimate that the proposed selfnomination process for qualifying
additional registries to submit on behalf
of eligible professionals for the 2010
PQRI involves approximately 1 hour per
registry to draft the letter of intent for
self-nomination. It is estimated that
each self-nominated entity will also
spend 2 hours for the interview with
CMS officials and 2 hours for the
development of a measure flow.
However, the time it takes to complete
the measure flow could vary depending
on the registry’s experience.
Additionally, part of the selfnomination process involves the
completion of an XML submission by
the registry, which is estimated to take
approximately 5 hours, but may vary
depending on the registry’s experience.
We estimate that the registry staff
involved in the registry self-nomination
process have an average labor cost of
$50 per hour. Therefore, assuming the
total burden hours per registry
associated with the registry selfnomination process is 10 hours, we
estimate the total cost to a registry
associated with the registry selfnomination process to be approximately
$500 ($50 per hour × 10 hours per
registry).
The burden associated with the
registry-based reporting requirements of
this voluntary reporting initiative is the
time and effort associated with the
registry calculating quality measure
results from the data submitted to the
registry by its participants and
submitting the quality measures results
and numerator and denominator data on
quality measures to CMS on behalf of
their participants. The time needed for
a registry to review the quality measures
and other information, calculate the
measures results, and submit the
measures results and numerator and
denominator data on the quality
measures on their participants behalf is
expected to vary along with the number
of eligible professionals reporting data
to the registry and the number of
applicable measures. However, we
believe that registries already perform
many of these activities for their
participants. The number of measures
PO 00000
Frm 00138
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
that the registry intends to report to
CMS and how similar the registry’s
measures are to CMS’ PQRI measures
will determine the time burden to the
registry.
For EHR-based reporting, the eligible
professional must review the quality
measures on which we will be accepting
PQRI data extracted from EHRs, select
the appropriate quality measures,
extract the necessary clinical data from
his or her EHR, and submit the
necessary data to the CMS-designated
clinical data warehouse. Because this
manner of reporting quality data to CMS
would be new to PQRI for 2010 and
participation in this reporting initiative
is voluntary, we believe it is difficult to
estimate with any degree of accuracy
how many eligible professionals will
opt to participate in the PQRI through
the EHR mechanism in CY 2010. The
time needed for an eligible professional
to review the quality measures and
other information, select measures
applicable to his or her patients and the
services he or she furnishes to them is
expected to be similar for EHR-based
reporting and claims-based reporting
(that is, 3 hours). Once the EHR is
programmed by the vendor to allow data
submission to CMS, the burden to the
eligible professional associated with
submission of data on PQRI quality
measures should be minimal.
An EHR vendor interested in having
their product(s) be used by eligible
professionals to submit quality
measures results and numerator and
denominator data on quality measures
to CMS were required to complete a
self-nomination process in order for the
vendor’s product(s) to be considered
‘‘qualified’’ for 2010. We are unable to
accurately quantify the burden
associated with the EHR selfnomination process as there is variation
regarding the technical capabilities and
experience among vendors. For
purposes of this burden analysis,
however, we estimate that the time
required for an EHR vendor to complete
the self-nomination process will be
similar to the time required for registries
to self-nominate that is approximately
10 hours at $50 per hour for a total of
$500 per EHR vendor ($50 per hour ×
10 hours per EHR vendor).
The burden associated with the EHRbased reporting requirements of this
voluntary reporting initiative is the time
and effort associated with the EHR
vendor programming its EHR product(s)
to extract the clinical data that the
eligible professional needs to submit to
CMS for purposes of reporting 2010
PQRI quality measures. The time
needed for an EHR vendor to review the
quality measures and other information
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
and program each qualified EHR
product to enable eligible professionals
to submit PQRI quality measures data to
the CMS-designated clinical data
warehouse will be dependent on the
EHR vendor’s familiarity with PQRI, the
vendor’s system capabilities, as well as
the vendor’s programming capabilities.
Some vendors already have these
necessary capabilities and for such
vendors, we estimate the total burden
hours to be 40 hours at a rate of $50 per
hour for a total burden estimate of
$2,000 ($50 per hour × 40 hours per
vendor). However, given the variability
in the capabilities of the vendors, we
believe a more conservative estimate for
those vendors with minimal experience
would be approximately 200 hours at
$50 per hour, for a total estimate of
$10,000 per vendor ($50 per hour × 200
hours per EHR vendor).
With respect to the proposed process
for group practices to be treated as
satisfactorily submitting quality
measures data under the 2010 PQRI
discussed in section II.G.2. of this
proposed rule, group practices
interested in participating in the 2010
PQRI through the group practice
reporting option would need to
complete a self-nomination process
similar to the self-nomination process
required of registries and EHR vendors.
Therefore, we estimate that the
proposed self-nomination process for
the group practices for the 2010 PQRI
involves approximately 2 hours per
group practice to draft the letter of
intent for self-nomination, gather the
requested TIN and NPI information, and
provide this requested information. It is
estimated that each self-nominated
entity will also spend 2 hours
undergoing the vetting process with
CMS officials. We assume that the group
practice staff involved in the group
practice self-nomination process have
an average practice labor cost of $55 per
hour. Therefore, assuming the total
burden hours per group practice
associated with the group practice selfnomination process is 4 hours, we
estimate the total cost to a group
practice associated with the group
practice self-nomination process to be
approximately $220 ($55 per hour × 4
hours per group practice).
The burden associated with the group
practice reporting requirements of this
voluntary reporting initiative is the time
and effort associated with the group
practice submitting the quality measures
data. For physician group practices, this
would be the time associated with the
physician group completing the
proposed data collection tool. The
information collection components of
this data collection tool have been
VerDate Nov<24>2008
21:30 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
reviewed by OMB and are currently
approved under OMB control number
0938–0941, with an expiration date of
December 31, 2011, for use in the
Physician Group Practice, Medicare
Care Management Performance (MCMP),
and EHR demonstrations. Based on
burden estimates for the PGP
demonstration, which uses the same
data submission methods as what we
have proposed, we estimate the burden
associated with a physician group
completing the data collection tool
would be approximately 79 hours per
physician group. Therefore, we estimate
the total annual burden hours per
physician group would be
approximately 83 hours (4 hours for
self-nomination + 79 hours for data
submission). Based on an average labor
cost of $55 per physician group, we
estimate the cost per physician group
associated with participating in the
proposed PQRI group practice reporting
option would be $4,565 ($55 per hour
× 83 hours per group practice).
We invite comments on this burden
analysis, including the underlying
assumptions used in developing our
estimates.
The Electronic Prescribing (EPrescribing) Incentive Program
We believe it is difficult to estimate
with any degree of accuracy how many
eligible professionals will opt to
participate in the E-Prescribing
Incentive Program in CY 2010.
Information from the ‘‘PQRI 2007
Reporting Experience Report,’’ which is
available on the PQRI section of the
CMS Web site at https://
www.cms.hhs.gov/PQRI, indicates that
nearly 110,000 unique TIN/NPI
combinations attempted to submit PQRI
quality measures data via claims for the
2007 PQRI. Therefore, for purposes of
conducting a burden analysis for the
2010 E-Prescribing Incentive Program,
we will assume that as many eligible
professionals who attempted to
participate in the 2007 PQRI will
attempt to participate in the 2010 EPrescribing Incentive Program. As such,
we can estimate that nearly 110,000
unique TIN/NPI combinations will
participate in the 2010 E-Prescribing
Incentive Program.
Section II.G.5. of this proposed rule
discusses the background of the EPrescribing Incentive Program. Section
II.G.5.c. of this proposed rule provides
information on how we propose eligible
professionals can qualify to be
considered a successful e-prescriber in
2010 in order to earn an incentive
payment. Similar to the PQRI, the EPrescribing Incentive Program is a
voluntary initiative. Eligible
PO 00000
Frm 00139
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33657
professionals may choose whether to
participate and, to the extent they meet
(1) certain thresholds with respect to the
volume of covered professional services
furnished and (2) the criteria to be
considered a successful e-prescriber
described in section II.G.5.c. of this
proposed rule, they can qualify to
receive an incentive payment for 2010.
For the 2010 E-Prescribing Incentive
Program, as discussed in section II.G.5.
of this proposed rule, we propose that
each eligible professional would need to
report the G-code indicating that at least
one prescription generated during an
encounter was electronically submitted
at least 25 instances during the
reporting period. Similar to PQRI, this
measure would be reportable through
claims-based reporting, registry-based
reporting, or through EHRs, if we
finalize the proposed EHR-based
reporting mechanism for PQRI.
Similar to claims-based reporting for
the PQRI, we estimate that the burden
associated with the requirements of this
new incentive program is the time and
effort associated with eligible
professionals determining whether the
electronic prescribing quality measure
applies to them, gathering the required
information, selecting the appropriate
quality data codes, and including the
appropriate quality data codes on the
claims they submit for payment. We
expect the ongoing costs associated with
participation in the E-Prescribing
Incentive Program to decline based on
an eligible professional’s familiarity
with and understanding of the EPrescribing Incentive Program,
experience with participating in the EPrescribing Incentive Program, and
increased efforts by CMS and
stakeholders to disseminate useful
educational resources and best
practices. Since the E-Prescribing
Incentive Program consists of only 1
quality measure, we will assign 1 hour
as the amount of time needed for
eligible professionals to review the eprescribing measure and incorporate the
use of quality data codes into their
office work flows. At an average cost of
approximately $55 per hour, we
estimate the total cost to eligible
professionals for reviewing the eprescribing measure and incorporating
the use of quality data codes into the
office work flows to be approximately
$55 ($55 per hour × 1 hour).
For claims-based reporting, the
quality data codes will be collected as
additional (optional) line items on the
existing HIPAA transaction 837–P and/
or CMS Form 1500. We do not
anticipate any new forms and no
modifications to the existing transaction
or form. We also do not anticipate
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33658
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
changes to the 837–P or CMS Form 1500
for CY 2010.
Based on our experience with the
PVRP described in section II.G.5. of this
proposed rule, we estimate that the time
needed to perform all the steps
necessary to report the e-prescribing
measure to be 1.75 minutes. We also
estimate the cost to perform all the steps
necessary to report the e-prescribing
measure to be $0.90 based on the
experience with the PVRP described
above.
Based on our proposed criteria for
determination of whether an eligible
professional is a successful e-prescriber,
we estimate that each eligible
professional would report the electronic
prescribing measure in 25 instances
during the reporting period.
Therefore, we estimate the total
annual burden per eligible professional
who chooses to participate in the 2010
E-Prescribing Incentive Program through
claims-based reporting of the electronic
prescribing measure to be 104 minutes,
or 1.73 hours [(1.75 minutes per
measure × 1 measure × 25 cases per
measure) + 1 hour]. The total estimated
cost per eligible professional to report
the electronic prescribing measure is
estimated to be $77.50 [($0.90 per
measure × 1 measure × 25 cases per
measure) + $55].
Because registry-based reporting of
the electronic prescribing measure to
CMS would be new for 2010 and
participation in this reporting initiative
is voluntary, it is impossible to estimate
with any degree of accuracy how many
eligible professionals will opt to
participate in the E-Prescribing
Incentive Program through the registrybased reporting mechanism in CY 2010.
We do not anticipate, however, any
additional burden for eligible
professionals to report data to a registry
as eligible professionals opting for
registry-based reporting would more
than likely already be reporting data to
the registry. Little, if any, additional
data would need to be reported to the
registry for purposes of participation in
the 2010 E-Prescribing Incentive
Program. However, eligible
professionals would need to authorize
or instruct the registry to submit quality
measures results and numerator and
denominator data on the electronic
prescribing measure to CMS on their
behalf. We estimate that the time and
effort associated with this would be
approximately 5 minutes for each
eligible professional that wishes to
authorize or instruct the registry to
submit quality measures results and
numerator and denominator data on the
electronic prescribing measure to CMS
on their behalf.
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
Based on our proposal to consider
only registries qualified to submit
quality measures results and numerator
and denominator data on quality
measures to CMS on their participants’
behalf for the 2010 PQRI to be qualified
to submit results and numerator and
denominator data on the electronic
prescribing measure for the 2010 EPrescribing Incentive Program, there
would be no need for a registry to
undergo a separate self-nomination
process for the E-Prescribing Incentive
Program and therefore, no additional
burden associated with the registry selfnomination process.
The burden associated with the
registry-based reporting requirements of
this voluntary reporting initiative is the
time and effort associated with the
registry calculating results for the
electronic prescribing measure from the
data submitted to the registry by its
participants and submitting the quality
measures results and numerator and
denominator data on the electronic
prescribing quality measure to CMS on
behalf of their participants. The time
needed for a registry to review the
electronic prescribing measure and
other information, calculate the
measure’s results, and submit the
measure’s results and numerator and
denominator data on the measure on
their participants behalf is expected to
vary along with the number of eligible
professionals reporting data to whom
the measure applies. However, we
believe that registries already perform
many of these activities for their
participants. Since the E-Prescribing
Incentive Program consists of only one
measure, we believe that the burden
associated with the registry reporting
the measure’s results and numerator and
denominator to CMS on behalf of their
participants would be minimal.
For EHR-based reporting, the eligible
professional must review the electronic
prescribing measure, extract the
necessary clinical data from his or her
EHR, and submit the necessary data to
the CMS-designated clinical data
warehouse. Because this manner of
reporting quality data to CMS would be
new for 2010 and participation in this
reporting initiative is voluntary, it is
impossible to estimate with any degree
of accuracy how many eligible
professionals will opt to participate in
the E-Prescribing Incentive Program
through the EHR-based reporting
mechanism in CY 2010. The time
needed for an eligible professional to
review the electronic prescribing
measure and other information and
determine whether the measure is
applicable to his or her patients and the
services he or she furnishes to them is
PO 00000
Frm 00140
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
expected to be similar for EHR-based
reporting and claims-based reporting
(that is, 1 hour). Once the EHR is
programmed by the vendor to allow data
submission to CMS, the burden to the
eligible professional associated with
submission of data on the electronic
prescribing measure should be minimal.
Based on our proposal to consider
only EHR products qualified for the
2010 PQRI to be qualified for the 2010
E-Prescribing Incentive Program, there
would be no need for EHR vendors to
undergo a separate self-nomination
process for the E-Prescribing Incentive
Program and therefore, no additional
burden associated with the selfnomination process.
The burden associated with the EHRbased reporting requirements of this
voluntary reporting initiative is the time
and effort associated with the EHR
vendor programming its EHR product(s)
to extract the clinical data that the
eligible professional needs to submit to
CMS for purposes of reporting the 2010
electronic prescribing measure. The
time needed for an EHR vendor to
review the measure and other
information and program each qualified
EHR product to enable eligible
professionals to submit data on the
measure to the CMS-designated clinical
data warehouse will be dependent on
the EHR vendor’s familiarity with the
electronic prescribing measure, the
vendor’s system capabilities, as well as
the vendor’s programming capabilities.
Since only EHR products qualified for
the 2010 PQRI would be qualified for
the 2010 E-Prescribing Incentive
Program and the E-Prescribing Incentive
Program consists of only one measure,
we believe that any burden associated
with the EHR vendor to program its
product(s) to enable eligible
professionals to submit data on the
electronic prescribing measure to the
CMS-designated clinical data warehouse
would be minimal.
Finally, with respect to the proposed
process for group practices to be treated
as successful e-prescribers under the
2010 E-Prescribing Incentive Program
discussed in section II.G.5. of this
proposed rule, a group practice would
be required to report the electronic
prescribing measure in at least 2500
instances. Group practices have the
same options as individual eligible
professionals in terms of the form and
manner for reporting the electronic
prescribing measure (that is, group
practices have the option of reporting
the measure through claims, a qualified
registry, or a qualified EHR product).
The only difference between an
individual eligible professional and
group practice reporting of the
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
electronic prescribing measure is the
number of times that a group practice is
required to report the electronic
prescribing measure. For group
practices who are selected to participate
in the 2010 E-Prescribing Incentive
Program group practice reporting option
and choose to do so through claimsbased reporting of the electronic
prescribing measure, we estimate the
total annual burden to be 73.92 hours
[(1.75 minutes per measure × 1 measure
× 2500 cases per measure) + 1 hour].
The total estimated cost per group
practice to report the electronic
prescribing measure through claimsbased reporting is estimated to be
$2,305 [($0.90 per measure × 1 measure
× 2500 cases per measure) + $55].
For group practices who are selected
to participate in the 2010 E-Prescribing
Incentive Program group practice
reporting option and choose to do so
through registry-based reporting of the
electronic prescribing measure, we do
not anticipate any additional burden to
report data to a registry as group
practices opting for registry-based
reporting would more than likely
already be reporting data to the registry.
Little, if any, additional data would
need to be reported to the registry for
purposes of participation in the 2010 EPrescribing Incentive Program.
However, group practices would need to
authorize or instruct the registry to
submit quality measures results and
numerator and denominator data on the
electronic prescribing measure to CMS
on their behalf. We estimate that the
time and effort associated with this
would be approximately 5 minutes for
each group practice that wishes to
authorize or instruct the registry to
submit quality measures results and
numerator and denominator data on the
electronic prescribing measure to CMS
on their behalf.
For group practices who are selected
to participate in the 2010 E-Prescribing
Incentive Program group practice
reporting option and choose to do so
through EHR-based reporting of the
electronic prescribing measure, once the
EHR is programmed by the vendor to
allow data submission to CMS, the
burden to the group practice associated
with submission of data on the
electronic prescribing measure should
be minimal.
In addition to the burden associated
with group practices reporting the
electronic prescribing measure, group
practices would also be required to selfnominate in order to participate in the
2010 E-Prescribing Incentive Program
under the group practice reporting
option. Since we propose to limit
participation in the E-Prescribing
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
Incentive Program group practice
reporting option to those group
practices selected to participate in the
PQRI group practice reporting option,
there would not be a separate group
practice self-nomination process for the
E-Prescribing Incentive Program and,
thus, no additional burden.
We invite comments on this burden
analysis, including the underlying
assumptions used in developing our
burden estimates.
IV. Response to Comments
Because of the large number of public
comments we normally receive on
Federal Register documents, we are not
able to acknowledge or respond to them
individually. We will consider all
comments we receive by the date and
time specified in the DATES section of
this preamble, and, when we proceed
with a subsequent document, we will
respond to the comments in the
preamble to that document.
V. Regulatory Impact Analysis
We have examined the impacts of this
rule as required by Executive Order
12866 on Regulatory Planning and
Review (September 30, 1993, as further
amended), the Regulatory Flexibility
Act (RFA) (September 19, 1980, Pub. L.
96–354), section 1102(b) of the Social
Security Act, section 202 of the
Unfunded Mandates Reform Act of 1995
(Pub. L. 104–4), Executive Order 13132
on Federalism (August 4, 1999), and the
Congressional Review Act (5 U.S.C.
804(2)).
Executive Order 12866 (as amended
by Executive Order 13258) directs
agencies to assess all costs and benefits
of available regulatory alternatives and,
if regulation is necessary, to select
regulatory approaches that maximize
net benefits (including potential
economic, environmental, public health
and safety effects, distributive impacts,
and equity). A regulatory impact
analysis (RIA) must be prepared for
major rules with economically
significant effects ($100 million or more
in any 1 year). We estimate, as
discussed below in this section, that the
PFS provisions included in this
proposed rule will redistribute more
than $100 million in 1 year. Therefore,
we estimate that this rulemaking is
‘‘economically significant’’ as measured
by the $100 million threshold, and
hence also a major rule under the
Congressional Review Act. Accordingly,
we have prepared a Regulatory Impact
Analysis that to the best of our ability
presents the costs and benefits of the
rulemaking.
The RFA requires agencies to analyze
options for regulatory relief of small
PO 00000
Frm 00141
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33659
businesses and other small entities, if a
rule has a significant impact on a
substantial number of small entities. For
purposes of the RFA, we estimate that
most hospitals and most other providers
are small entities as that term is used in
the RFA (including small businesses,
nonprofit organizations, and small
governmental jurisdictions). The great
majority of hospitals and most other
health care providers and suppliers are
small entities, either by being nonprofit
organizations or by meeting the Small
Business Administration (SBA)
definition of a small business (having
revenues of $7 million to $34.5 million
in any 1 year) (for details see the SBA’s
Web site at https://sba.gov/idc/groups/
public/documents/sba_homepage/serv_
sstd_tablepdf.pdf (refer to the 620000
series).
Individuals and States are not
included in the definition of a small
entity. The RFA requires that we
analyze regulatory options for small
businesses and other entities. We
prepare a regulatory flexibility analysis
unless we certify that a rule would not
have a significant economic impact on
a substantial number of small entities.
The analysis must include a justification
concerning the reason action is being
taken, the kinds and number of small
entities the rule affects, and an
explanation of any meaningful options
that achieve the objectives with less
significant adverse economic impact on
the small entities.
For purposes of the RFA, physicians,
NPPs, and suppliers including IDTFs
are considered small businesses if they
generate revenues of $7 million or less
based on SBA size standards.
Approximately 95 percent of physicians
are considered to be small entities.
There are over 1 million physicians,
other practitioners, and medical
suppliers that receive Medicare
payment under the PFS.
For purposes of the RFA
approximately 85 percent of suppliers of
durable medical equipment, prosthetics,
orthotics, and supplies (DMEPOS) are
considered small businesses according
to the SBA size standards. We estimate
that approximately 66,000 entities bill
Medicare for DMEPOS each year. Total
annual estimated Medicare revenues for
DMEPOS suppliers are approximately
$10.8 billion in 2007 for which $8.3
billion was for fee-for-service (FFS) and
$2.5 billion was for managed care.
For purposes of the RFA,
approximately 80 percent of clinical
diagnostic laboratories are considered
small businesses according to the SBA
size standards.
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33660
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
Ambulance providers and suppliers
for purposes of the RFA are also
considered to be small entities.
In addition, most ESRD facilities are
considered small entities for purposes of
the RFA, either based on nonprofit
status or by having revenues of $7
million to $34.5 million or less in any
year. We note that a considerable
number of ESRD facilities are owned
and operated by large dialysis
organizations (LDOs) or regional chains,
which would have total revenues more
than $34.5 million in any year if
revenues from all locations are
combined. However, the claims data we
use to estimate payments for this RFA
and RIA does not identify which
dialysis facilities are parts of an LDO,
regional chain, or other type of
ownership. Each individual dialysis
facility has its own provider number
and bills Medicare using this number.
Therefore, we consider each ESRD to be
a small entity for purposes of the RFA.
We consider a substantial number of
entities to be significantly affected if the
proposed rule has an annual average
impact on small entities of 3 to 5
percent or more. The majority of ESRD
facilities will experience impacts of less
than 2 percent of total revenues. There
are 929 nonprofit ESRD facilities with a
combined increase of 0.9 percent in
overall payments relative to current
overall payments. We note that although
the overall effect of the wage index
changes is budget neutral, there are
increases and decreases based on the
location of individual facilities. The
analysis and discussion provided in this
section and elsewhere in this proposed
rule complies with the RFA
requirements.
Because we acknowledge that many of
the affected entities are small entities,
the analysis discussed throughout the
preamble of this proposed rule
constitutes our regulatory flexibility
analysis for the remaining provisions
and addresses comments received on
these issues.
In addition, section 1102(b) of the Act
requires us to prepare a regulatory
impact analysis, if a rule may have a
significant impact on the operations of
a substantial number of small rural
hospitals. Any such regulatory impact
analysis must conform to the provisions
of section 603 of the RFA. For purposes
of section 1102(b) of the Act, we define
a small rural hospital as a hospital that
is located outside of a metropolitan
statistical area and has fewer than 100
beds. We do not believe this proposed
rule has impact on significant
operations of a substantial number of
small rural hospitals because most
dialysis facilities are freestanding.
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
While there are 177 rural hospital-based
dialysis facilities, we do not know how
many of them are based at hospitals
with fewer than 100 beds. However,
overall, the 177 rural hospital-based
dialysis facilities will experience an
estimated 1.1 percent increase in
payments. As a result, this rule will not
have a significant impact on small rural
hospitals. Therefore, the Secretary has
determined that this proposed rule will
not have a significant impact on the
operations of a substantial number of
small rural hospitals.
Section 202 of the Unfunded
Mandates Reform Act of 1995 (UMRA)
also requires that agencies assess
anticipated costs and benefits before
issuing any rule whose mandates
require spending in any 1 year of $100
million in 1995 dollars, updated
annually for inflation. In 2009, that
threshold is approximately $133
million. This proposed rule will not
mandate any requirements for State,
local, or Tribal governments. Medicare
beneficiaries are considered to be part of
the private sector and as a result a more
detailed discussion is presented on the
Impact of Beneficiaries in section V. of
this regulatory impact analysis.
We have examined this proposed rule
in accordance with Executive Order
13132 and have determined that this
regulation would not have any
substantial direct effect on State or local
governments, preempt States, or
otherwise have a Federalism
implication.
We have prepared the following
analysis, which together with the
information provided in the rest of this
preamble, meets all assessment
requirements. The analysis explains the
rationale for and purposes of this
proposed rule; details the costs and
benefits of the rule; analyzes
alternatives; and presents the measures
we will use to minimize the burden on
small entities. As indicated elsewhere in
this rule, we are implementing a variety
of changes to our regulations, payments,
or payment policies to ensure that our
payment systems reflect changes in
medical practice and the relative value
of services. We provide information for
each of the policy changes in the
relevant sections of this proposed rule.
We are unaware of any relevant Federal
rules that duplicate, overlap, or conflict
with this proposed rule. The relevant
sections of this rule contain a
description of significant alternatives if
applicable.
PO 00000
Frm 00142
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
A. RVU Impacts
1. Resource-Based Work PE and MP
RVUs
Section 1848(c)(2)(B)(ii) of the Act
requires that increases or decreases in
RVUs may not cause the amount of
expenditures for the year to differ by
more than $20 million from what
expenditures would have been in the
absence of these changes. If this
threshold is exceeded, we make
adjustments to preserve BN.
Our estimates of changes in Medicare
revenues for PFS services compare
payment rates for CY 2009 with
proposed payment rates for CY 2010
using CY 2008 Medicare utilization for
all years. To the extent that there are
year-to-year changes in the volume and
mix of services provided by physicians,
the actual impact on total Medicare
revenues will be different than those
shown in Table 39. The payment
impacts reflect averages for each
specialty based on Medicare utilization.
The payment impact for an individual
physician would be different from the
average, based on the mix of services the
physician provides. The average change
in total revenues would be less than the
impact displayed here because
physicians furnish services to both
Medicare and non-Medicare patients
and specialties may receive substantial
Medicare revenues for services that are
not paid under the PFS. For instance,
independent laboratories receive
approximately 80 percent of their
Medicare revenues from clinical
laboratory services that are not paid
under the PFS.
Table 39 shows only the payment
impact on PFS services. The following
is an explanation of the information
represented in Table 39
• Specialty: The physician specialty
or type of practitioner/supplier.
• Allowed charges: Allowed charges
are the Medicare Fee Schedule amounts
for covered services and include
coinsurance and deductibles (which are
the financial responsibility of the
beneficiary.) These amounts have been
summed across all services furnished by
physicians, practitioners, or suppliers
within a specialty to arrive at the total
allowed charges for the specialty.
• Impact of Proposed Work RVU
changes for the CY 2010 PFS.
• Impact of Proposed PE RVU
changes for the CY 2010 PFS.
• Impact of Proposed MP RVU
changes for the CY 2010 PFS.
• Combined Impact of all Proposed
Changes. The impact shown is a
combined impact that incorporates all
proposed changes to Work RVUs, PE
RVUs, and MP RVUs, prior to the
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33661
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
application of the CY 2010 negative PFS
CF update under the current statute.
TABLE 39—CY 2010 TOTAL ALLOWED CHARGE IMPACT FOR WORK, PRACTICE EXPENSE, AND MALPRACTICE CHANGES *
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
(A)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
Allowed
charges (mil)
Impact of work
RVU changes
(%)
(B)
TOTAL ..........................................................................
ALLERGY/IMMUNOLOGY ...........................................
ANESTHESIOLOGY ....................................................
CARDIAC SURGERY ..................................................
CARDIOLOGY ..............................................................
COLON AND RECTAL SURGERY ..............................
CRITICAL CARE ..........................................................
DERMATOLOGY ..........................................................
EMERGENCY MEDICINE ............................................
ENDOCRINOLOGY ......................................................
FAMILY PRACTICE .....................................................
GASTROENTEROLOGY .............................................
GENERAL PRACTICE .................................................
GENERAL SURGERY .................................................
GERIATRICS ................................................................
HAND SURGERY ........................................................
HEMATOLOGY/ONCOLOGY ......................................
INFECTIOUS DISEASE ...............................................
INTERNAL MEDICINE .................................................
INTERVENTIONAL PAIN MANAGEMENT ..................
INTERVENTIONAL RADIOLOGY ................................
NEPHROLOGY ............................................................
NEUROLOGY ...............................................................
NEUROSURGERY .......................................................
NUCLEAR MEDICINE ..................................................
OBSTETRICS/GYNECOLOGY ....................................
OPHTHALMOLOGY .....................................................
ORTHOPEDIC SURGERY ...........................................
OTOLARNGOLOGY .....................................................
PATHOLOGY ...............................................................
PEDIATRICS ................................................................
PHYSICAL MEDICINE .................................................
PLASTIC SURGERY ....................................................
PSYCHIATRY ...............................................................
PULMONARY DISEASE ..............................................
RADIATION ONCOLOGY ............................................
RADIOLOGY ................................................................
RHEUMATOLOGY .......................................................
THORACIC SURGERY ................................................
UROLOGY ....................................................................
VASCULAR SURGERY ...............................................
AUDIOLOGIST .............................................................
CHIROPRACTOR*** ....................................................
CLINICAL PSYCHOLOGIST ........................................
CLINICAL SOCIAL WORKER ......................................
NURSE ANESTHETIST ...............................................
NURSE PRACTITIONER .............................................
OPTOMETRY ...............................................................
ORAL/MAXILLOFACIAL SURGERY ............................
PHYSICAL/OCCUPATIONAL THERAPY ....................
PHYSICIAN ASSISTANT .............................................
PODIATRY ...................................................................
DIAGNOSTIC TESTING FACILITY .............................
INDEPENDENT LABORATORY ..................................
PORTABLE X-RAY SUPPLIER ...................................
$77,744
171
1,713
371
7,179
129
221
2,504
2,395
370
5,055
1,779
719
2,213
167
89
1,888
549
10,061
352
227
1,789
1,417
586
72
615
4,736
3,257
926
985
64
816
278
1,071
1,753
1,799
5,254
494
389
1,989
685
35
700
533
353
772
1,004
834
35
1,857
749
1,656
1,044
960
85
Impact of PE
RVU
changes**
(%)
Impact of MP
RVU changes
(%)
Combined
impact
(%)
(C)
Specialty
(D)
(E)
0
0
0
¥1
0
¥1
0
0
0
¥1
2
¥1
1
¥1
1
¥1
0
¥1
1
¥1
0
0
¥2
¥1
0
0
0
0
¥1
0
1
0
¥1
0
¥1
0
0
0
¥1
0
¥1
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
¥1
0
0
1
0
0
0
1
0
5
¥1
¥10
5
3
2
2
3
5
1
5
4
6
4
¥5
4
4
7
¥10
1
6
3
¥12
1
11
4
3
¥1
4
7
5
2
3
¥17
¥10
0
0
¥6
¥1
¥4
4
¥7
¥6
2
5
11
3
10
4
7
¥19
¥4
¥8
0
¥2
1
3
¥1
1
1
0
0
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
¥1
1
1
0
0
1
0
1
¥2
0
0
0
¥1
0
0
0
1
1
1
¥1
¥1
0
3
0
0
¥7
1
0
1
0
1
0
¥1
0
0
¥1
¥5
¥1
¥2
1
¥3
6
¥2
¥11
5
3
3
2
3
8
0
6
4
8
3
¥6
3
6
6
¥10
2
3
2
¥13
1
11
3
1
0
4
7
5
3
3
¥19
¥11
¥1
2
¥7
¥1
¥10
5
¥7
¥6
2
7
12
1
10
5
6
¥24
¥5
¥11
* Does not include the impact of the current law CY 2010 negative update. Rows may not sum to total due to rounding.
** Note: The law caps the MFS imaging payment amount at the comparable payment amount in the hospital outpatient payment system (OPPS
cap). In the absence of the negative current law CY 2010 MFS update, the proposed PE change to the equipment utilization rate for expensive
equipment from 50 percent to 90 percent would increase expenditures by approximately 1 percent due to a loss of savings from the OPPS cap.
*** Does not reflect the BN reduction in payments resulting from the chiropractic demonstration.
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00143
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33662
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
2. Resource-Based Work, PE, and MP
RVUs Impacts
a. Work RVU Impacts
The work RVU impacts are almost
entirely attributable to the proposed
changes for consultation services. As
described earlier in this proposed rule,
we are proposing to no longer recognize
the BILLING CODEs for consultation
services so we are budget neutrally
eliminating the use of all consultation
codes (except for telehealth) and have
allocated the work RVUs that were
allotted to these services to the work
RVUs for new and established office
visit services, initial hospital visits, and
initial nursing facility visits to reflect
this change.
b. PE RVUs Impacts
The PE RVU impacts are primarily
attributable to the proposed
incorporation of PE data from the
Physician Practice Information Survey
(PPIS). For a discussion of the use of
this updated survey data, see section
II.A.2. of this proposed rule.
For two specialties, IDTFs and
Radiation Oncology, the impact of our
proposed change in the utilization rate
for expensive equipment is also
significant. We estimate that for these
two specialties, the utilization rate
change will result in impacts of ¥2
percent and ¥5 percent (respectively).
These impacts are included in the ¥19
percent and ¥17 percent PE RVU
impacts shown in Table 39 for these
specialties. After taking into account the
OPPS payment cap, the change in the
utilization rate for expensive equipment
does not substantially reduce overall
payments for other specialties.
Our proposals on consultation codes
(see section II.E.4. of this proposed rule)
and dominant specialty (see section
II.C.2. of this proposed rule) do not have
a significant impact on PE payments to
specialties.
c. Malpractice RVU Impacts
The PE RVU impacts are attributable
to the changes proposed for the FiveYear Review of MP RVUs described
earlier in this proposed rule. Of
particular note are the impacts on the
specialties of Audiology (¥7 percent),
and IDTFs (¥5 percent). These impacts
are primarily driven by the expansion of
the MP premium data collection and the
proposed changes to the methodology
for TC services.
d. Combined Impact
Column E of Table 39 displays the
proposed combined impact of all RVU
changes by specialty. These changes
range from increases of +12 percent for
optometry to decreases of ¥24 percent
for IDTFs. The effect of our proposals on
primary care specialties such as General
Practice, Family Practice, Internal
Medicine, and Geriatrics are positive
with increases ranging from +6 percent
to +8 percent. Again, these impacts are
prior to the application of the negative
CY 2010 CF update under the current
statute.
Table 40 shows the estimated impact
on total payments for selected highvolume procedures of all of the changes
discussed previously, including the
effect of the CY 2010 negative PFS CF
update. We selected these procedures
because they are the most commonly
furnished by a broad spectrum of
physician specialties. There are separate
columns that show the change in the
facility rates and the nonfacility rates.
For an explanation of facility and
nonfacility PE, refer to Addendum A of
this proposed rule.
TABLE 40—IMPACT OF PROPOSED RULE AND ESTIMATED PHYSICIAN UPDATE ON 2010 PAYMENT FOR SELECTED
PROCEDURES
Facility
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
CPT 1/
HCPCS
11721
17000
27130
27244
27447
33533
35301
43239
66821
66984
67210
71010
71010
77056
77056
77057
77057
77427
78465
88305
90801
90862
90935
92012
92014
92980
93000
93010
93015
93307
93510
98941
.......
.......
.......
.......
.......
.......
.......
.......
.......
.......
.......
.......
.......
.......
.......
.......
.......
.......
.......
.......
.......
.......
.......
.......
.......
.......
.......
.......
.......
.......
.......
.......
VerDate Nov<24>2008
MOD
Description
2009
..........
..........
..........
..........
..........
..........
..........
..........
..........
..........
..........
..........
26
..........
26
..........
26
..........
26
26
..........
..........
..........
..........
..........
..........
..........
..........
..........
26
26
..........
Debride nail, 6 or more ........................................
Destruct premalg lesion .......................................
Total hip arthroplasty ...........................................
Treat thigh fracture ..............................................
Total knee arthroplasty ........................................
CABG, arterial, single ..........................................
Rechanneling of artery .........................................
Upper GI endoscopy, biopsy ...............................
After cataract laser surgery .................................
Cataract surg w/iol, 1 stage .................................
Treatment of retinal lesion ...................................
Chest x-ray ...........................................................
Chest x-ray ...........................................................
Mammogram, both breasts ..................................
Mammogram, both breasts ..................................
Mammogram, screening ......................................
Mammogram, screening ......................................
Radiation tx management, x5 ..............................
Heart image (3d), multiple ...................................
Tissue exam by pathologist .................................
Psy dx interview ...................................................
Medication management ......................................
Hemodialysis, one evaluation ..............................
Eye exam established pat ...................................
Eye exam & treatment .........................................
Insert intracoronary stent .....................................
Electrocardiogram, complete ...............................
Electrocardiogram report .....................................
Cardiovascular stress test ...................................
Tte w/o doppler, complete ...................................
Left heart catheterization .....................................
Chiropractic manipulation ....................................
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00144
Fmt 4701
2010 2
$27.77
48.69
1,359.71
1,144.39
1,456.37
1,892.05
1,067.93
165.55
251.38
638.74
561.56
NA
9.02
NA
44.36
NA
35.71
188.27
78.99
37.15
128.04
45.08
66.36
45.80
70.33
847.93
20.92
9.02
100.27
49.77
248.86
30.30
Non-facility
Percent
change
$19.82
40.50
1,113.00
944.21
1,187.76
1,524.78
879.63
130.27
225.15
568.96
502.12
NA
6.80
NA
33.98
NA
27.47
155.48
56.92
29.45
96.01
35.40
54.09
41.35
62.59
587.08
13.03
6.80
61.74
35.97
169.36
24.36
Sfmt 4702
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
¥29
¥17
¥18
¥17
¥18
¥19
¥18
¥21
¥10
¥11
¥11
NA
¥25
NA
¥23
NA
¥23
¥17
¥28
¥21
¥25
¥21
¥18
¥10
¥11
¥31
¥38
¥25
¥38
¥28
¥32
¥20
13JYP2
2009
$40.39
69.97
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
323.16
266.53
NA
580.67
23.80
9.02
107.48
44.36
81.51
35.71
188.27
78.99
37.15
152.92
55.18
NA
70.69
103.15
NA
20.92
9.02
100.27
49.77
248.86
33.90
2010 2
32.29
57.21
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
243.84
237.89
NA
517.13
16.14
6.80
80.15
33.98
57.49
27.47
155.48
56.92
29.45
118.95
45.31
NA
62.87
91.76
NA
13.03
6.80
61.74
35.97
169.36
28.04
Percent
change
¥20
¥18
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
¥25
¥11
NA
¥11
¥32
¥25
¥25
¥23
¥29
¥23
¥17
¥28
¥21
¥22
¥18
NA
¥11
¥11
NA
¥38
¥25
¥38
¥28
¥32
¥17
33663
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
TABLE 40—IMPACT OF PROPOSED RULE AND ESTIMATED PHYSICIAN UPDATE ON 2010 PAYMENT FOR SELECTED
PROCEDURES—Continued
Facility
CPT 1/
HCPCS
MOD
99203 .......
99213 .......
99214 .......
99222 .......
99223 .......
99231 .......
99232 .......
99233 .......
99236 .......
99239 .......
99283 .......
99284 .......
99291 .......
99292 .......
99348 .......
99350 .......
G0008 ......
..........
..........
..........
..........
..........
..........
..........
..........
..........
..........
..........
..........
..........
..........
..........
..........
..........
1 CPT
Description
2009
Office/outpatient visit, new ...................................
Office/outpatient visit, est .....................................
Office/outpatient visit, est .....................................
Initial hospital care ...............................................
Initial hospital care ...............................................
Subsequent hospital care ....................................
Subsequent hospital care ....................................
Subsequent hospital care ....................................
Observ/hosp same date .......................................
Hospital discharge day ........................................
Emergency dept visit ...........................................
Emergency dept visit ...........................................
Critical care, first hour ..........................................
Critical care, add "l 30 min ................................
Home visit, est patient .........................................
Home visit, est patient .........................................
Admin influenza virus vac ....................................
2010 2
68.17
44.72
69.25
122.63
180.33
37.15
66.72
95.58
207.38
96.30
61.31
114.33
212.07
106.04
NA
NA
NA
Non-facility
Percent
change
¥12
¥11
¥12
¥13
¥13
¥17
¥16
¥16
¥18
¥15
¥19
¥19
¥18
¥18
NA
NA
NA
60.04
39.93
61.17
106.77
156.05
30.87
56.07
80.43
170.77
81.85
49.84
92.89
173.89
86.94
NA
NA
NA
2009
91.97
61.31
92.33
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
253.91
114.69
79.35
160.86
20.92
2010 2
81.00
54.09
80.15
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
206.74
93.74
65.42
137.92
16.99
Percent
change
¥12
¥12
¥13
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
¥19
¥18
¥18
¥14
¥19
codes and descriptions are copyright 2009 American Medical Association. All Rights Reserved. Applicable FARS/DFARS apply.
upon projected ¥21.5 reduction in the conversion factor.
2 Based
B. Geographic Practice Cost Indices
(GPCIs)
budgetary impact on the Medicare
program.
As discussed in section II.C. of this
proposed rule, the application of the
1.000 work GPCI floor, as extended by
section 134(a) of the MIPPA, expires
effective January 1, 2010. As a result, 54
(out of 89) PFS localities will receive a
decrease in their work GPCI. Puerto
Rico receives the largest decrease (¥9.6
percent), followed by South Dakota
(¥5.8 percent), North Dakota (¥5.3
percent), Rest of Missouri (¥5.1
percent), and Montana (¥5.0 percent).
D. MIPPA Provisions
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
C. Medicare Telehealth Services
In section II.D. of this proposed rule,
we are proposing to add individual
health behavior and assessment services
(as described by HCPCS codes 96150
through 96152) to the list of telehealth
services. We are also proposing to revise
§ 410.78 to specify that the G-codes for
follow-up inpatient telehealth
consultations (as described by HCPCS
codes G0406 through G0408) include
follow-up telehealth consultations
furnished to beneficiaries in hospitals
and skilled nursing facilities.
The total annual Medicare payment
amount for telehealth services
(including the originating site facility
fee) is approximately $2 million.
Previous additions to the list of
telehealth services have not resulted in
a significant increase in Medicare
program expenditures. While we believe
that these proposals will provide more
beneficiaries with access to these
services, we do not anticipate that these
proposed changes will have a significant
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
1. Section 102: Elimination of
Discriminatory Copayment Rates for
Medicare Outpatient Psychiatric
Services
This section of the MIPPA will have
a positive impact on Medicare patients
because coinsurance payment
percentages for outpatient mental health
services will be gradually reduced from
January 1, 2010 through January 1, 2014.
At the conclusion of this 5-year period,
Medicare patients will pay the same
coinsurance payment percentage for
outpatient mental health services as
they currently pay for other health
services under the Medicare Part B
program.
Since the inception of the Medicare
Part B program, Medicare patients have
been required to pay for a greater
percentage of the cost of outpatient
mental health treatment services than
for other health services because of the
Medicare payment limitation (the
outpatient mental health treatment
limitation). While a dollar cap that
previously applied to mental health
services was eliminated January 1, 1991,
the statute maintained the 621⁄2 percent
limitation on the recognition of incurred
expenses. This limitation of 621⁄2
percent reduces the program’s payment
for mental health services to 50 percent,
leaving a Medicare patient responsible
for paying the other half of these
expenses through coinsurance. The 621⁄2
PO 00000
Frm 00145
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
percent limitation will remain in effect
until December 31, 2009.
During the transition, the Medicare
Part B program will incur increased
expenditures as Medicare patients pay
less out-of-pocket for outpatient mental
health services until, in 2014, patients
will pay only the deductible (if
applicable) and 20 percent coinsurance.
Section 102 of the MIPPA will shift
cost-sharing for mental health services
from Medicare patients to the program.
This provision will result in a cost
impact, to the Medicare program, of
approximately $100 million for CY
2010. As section 102 of the MIPPA is
implemented, the impact of the changes
to the coinsurance payment percentages
(that is, recognized incurred expenses)
for Medicare patients and the program
is as shown in Table 41.
TABLE 41—IMPACT OF THE CHANGES
TO THE COINSURANCE PAYMENT
PERCENTAGES UNDER SECTION 102
OF THE MIPPA
CY 2009 and prior calendar years—Medicare
limitation, 62.50 percent of recognized incurred expenses.
Medicare Patient pays—50%.
Medicare Part B pays—50%.
CY 2010 and CY 2011—Medicare limitation,
68.75 percent of recognized incurred expenses.
Medicare Patient pays—45%.
Medicare Part B pays—55%.
CY 2012—Medicare limitation, 75 percent of
recognized incurred expenses.
Medicare Patient pays—40%.
Medicare Part B pays—60%.
CY 2014—No limitation, 100.00 percent of
recognized incurred expenses.
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33664
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
TABLE 41—IMPACT OF THE CHANGES
TO THE COINSURANCE PAYMENT
PERCENTAGES UNDER SECTION 102
OF THE MIPPA—Continued
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Medicare Patient pays—20%.
Medicare Part B pays—80%.
2. Section 131 b: Physician Payment,
Efficiency, and Quality Improvements—
Physician Quality Reporting Initiative
(PQRI)
As discussed in section II.G.2. of this
proposed rule, the proposed 2010 PQRI
measures satisfy the requirement of
section 1848(k)(2)(D) of the Act that the
Secretary shall ensure that eligible
professionals have the opportunity to
provide input during the development,
endorsement, or selection of measures
applicable to services they furnish. As
discussed in section II.G.2.d. of this
proposed rule, we also propose to offer
options in 2010 for reporting the
proposed 2010 PQRI measures via
submission of data to a clinical registry,
options for reporting some of the
proposed 2010 PQRI measures via
submission of data extracted from an
EHR, options for reporting on measures
groups rather than individual measures,
and options for group practices to be
treated as satisfactorily submitting
quality data under the PQRI.
Although there may be some cost
incurred for maintaining the measures
used in the PQRI and their associated
code sets, and for expanding an existing
clinical data warehouse to accommodate
registry-based reporting and EHR-based
reporting for the PQRI, we do not
anticipate a significant cost impact on
the Medicare program.
Participation in the PQRI by eligible
professionals is voluntary and eligible
professionals and group practices may
have different processes for integrating
the PQRI into their practices’ work
flows. Therefore, it is not possible to
estimate with any degree of accuracy the
impact of the PQRI on providers.
With respect to satisfactory
submission of data on quality measures
by eligible professionals, one factor that
influences the cost to eligible
professionals is the time and effort
associated with eligible professionals
identifying applicable PQRI quality
measures for which they can report the
necessary information. We have no way
to accurately quantify the burden
because it would vary with each eligible
professional by the number of measures
applicable to the eligible professional,
the eligible professional’s familiarity
and understanding of the PQRI, and
experience with participating in the
PQRI. In addition, eligible professionals
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
may employ different methods for
incorporating the use of quality data
codes into the office work flows.
Therefore, we will continue to assign 3
hours as the amount of time needed for
eligible professionals to review the PQRI
quality measures, identify the
applicable measures for which they can
report the necessary information, and
incorporate the use of quality data codes
into the office work flows. Information
from the Physician Voluntary Reporting
Program (PVRP), which was a
predecessor to the PQRI, indicated an
average labor cost of approximately $50
per hour. To account for salary increases
over time, we will use an average
practice labor cost of $55 per hour for
our estimates based on an assumption of
an average annual increase of
approximately 3 percent. Thus, we
continue to estimate the cost for an
eligible professional to review the PQRI
quality measures, identify the
applicable measures for which they can
report the necessary information, and
incorporate the use of quality data codes
into the office work flows to be
approximately $165 per eligible
professional ($55 per hour × 3 hours).
For claims-based PQRI reporting, one
factor in the cost to eligible
professionals is the time and effort
associated with gathering the required
information, selecting the appropriate
quality data codes, and including the
appropriate quality data codes on the
Medicare Part B claims an eligible
professional submits for payment.
Information from the PVRP estimates
the cost to physicians to perform all the
steps necessary to report 1 quality
measure ranges from $0.21 in labor time
to about $10.06 in labor time for more
complicated cases and/or measures. For
the median practice, the cost was about
$0.90 in labor time per measure. Eligible
professionals generally would be
required to report at least 3 measures to
satisfactorily report PQRI quality
measures data. Therefore, for purposes
of this impact analysis we will assume
that eligible professionals participating
in the 2010 PQRI will report an average
of 3 measures each.
The cost of implementing claimsbased reporting of PQRI quality
measures data also varies with the
volume of claims on which quality data
is reported. Since we propose to require
eligible professionals to report at least
one of their selected measures for at
least 15 Medicare Part B FFS patients in
order to satisfactorily report, then, for
this burden analysis, we will assume
that for each measure, the eligible
professional reports the quality data
codes on 15 cases. The actual number of
cases on which an eligible professional
PO 00000
Frm 00146
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
would be required to report quality
measures data will vary, however, with
the eligible professional’s patient
population and the types of measures on
which the eligible professional chooses
to report (each measure’s specifications
includes a required reporting
frequency).
Based on the assumptions discussed
above, we estimate the total annual cost
per eligible professional associated with
claims-based reporting to range from
$174.45 [($0.21 per measure × 3
measures × 15 cases per measure) +
$165] to $617.70 [($10.06 per measure ×
3 measures × 15 cases per measure) +
$165].
For registry-based reporting, eligible
professionals must generally incur a
cost to submit data to registries.
Estimated fees for using a qualified
registry range from a nominal charge for
an eligible professional to use the
registry to costing eligible professionals
several thousand dollars. Thus, we
conservatively estimate the cost
incurred by an eligible professional to
participate in PQRI via registry-based
reporting to be approximately $500 per
eligible professional.
In addition, an eligible professional
who chooses to submit PQRI quality
measures results and numerator and
denominator data on quality measures
through a registry more than likely is
already reporting data to the registry.
Little, if any, additional data would
need to be reported to the registry for
purposes of participation in the 2010
PQRI. Therefore, there should be little
additional cost to the eligible
professional associated with submitting
data to the registry.
Registries interested in submitting
quality measures results and numerator
and denominator data on quality
measures to CMS on their participants’
behalf would need to complete a selfnomination process in order to be
considered ‘‘qualified’’ to submit on
behalf of eligible professionals. We
estimate the registry self-nomination
process to cost approximately $500 per
registry ($50 per hour × 10 hours per
registry). This cost estimate includes the
cost of submitting the self-nomination
letter to CMS and completing the CMS
vetting process. Our estimate of a $50
per hour average labor cost for registries
is based on the assumption that registry
staff include IT professionals whose
average hourly rates range from $36 to
$84 per hour depending on experience,
with an average rate of nearly $50 per
hour for a mid-level programmer.
The cost to the registry associated
with the registry-based reporting
requirements of this voluntary reporting
initiative is the time and effort
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
associated with the registry calculating
quality measure results from the data
submitted to the registry by its
participants and submitting the quality
measures results and numerator and
denominator data on quality measures
to CMS on behalf of their participants.
The time needed for a registry to review
the quality measures and other
information, calculate the measures
results, and submit the measures results
and numerator and denominator data on
the quality measures on their
participants behalf is expected to vary
along with the number of eligible
professionals reporting data to the
registry and the number of applicable
measures. However, we believe that
registries already perform many of these
activities for their participants.
For EHR-based reporting, an eligible
professional generally would incur a
cost associated with purchasing an EHR
product. We estimate that it costs
between $1,500 to over $5,000 to
purchase an EHR product. Therefore, we
conservatively estimate the average total
cost to an eligible professional to be
approximately $2,750.
An EHR vendor interested in having
their product(s) be used by eligible
professionals to submit quality
measures results and numerator and
denominator data on quality measures
to CMS were required to complete a
self-nomination process in order for the
vendor’s product(s) to be considered
‘‘qualified’’ for 2010. Therefore, one
factor in the cost to EHR vendors is the
cost associated with completing the selfnomination process in order for the
vendor’s EHR product(s) to be
considered ‘‘qualified.’’ Similar to the
estimated cost to the registry associated
with the registry self-nomination
process, the estimated cost for an EHR
vendor to complete the self-nomination
process, including the vetting process
with CMS officials, is conservatively
estimated to be $500 ($50 per hour × 10
hours per EHR vendor). Our estimate of
a $50 per hour average labor cost for
registries is based on the assumption
that registry staff include IT
professionals whose average hourly
rates range from $36 to $84 per hour
depending on experience, with an
average rate of nearly $50 per hour for
a mid-level programmer.
Another factor in the cost to EHR
vendors is the time and effort associated
with the EHR vendor programming its
EHR product(s) to extract the clinical
data that the eligible professional needs
to submit to CMS for purposes of
reporting 2010 PQRI quality measures.
The cost associated with the time and
effort needed for an EHR vendor to
review the quality measures and other
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
information and program each qualified
EHR product to enable eligible
professionals to submit PQRI quality
measures data to the CMS-designated
clinical warehouse will be dependent
on the EHR vendor’s familiarity with
PQRI, the vendor’s system capabilities,
as well as the vendor’s programming
capabilities. Some vendors already have
these necessary capabilities and for such
vendors, we estimate the total cost to be
approximately $2,000 ($50 per hour ×
40 hours per vendor). However, given
the variability in the capabilities of the
vendors, we believe a more conservative
estimate for those vendors with minimal
experience would be approximately
$10,000 per vendor ($50 per hour × 200
hours per EHR vendor).
With respect to the proposed process
for group practices to be treated as
satisfactorily submitting quality
measures data under the 2010 PQRI
discussed in section II.G.2.g. of this
proposed rule, group practices
interested in participating in the 2010
PQRI through the group practice
reporting option would need to
complete a self-nomination process
similar to the self-nomination process
required of registries and EHR vendors.
We estimate that the group practice staff
involved in the group practice selfnomination process have an average
labor cost of $55 per hour. Therefore,
assuming the total burden hours per
group practice associated with the group
practice self-nomination process is 4
hours, we estimate the total cost to a
group practice associated with the group
practice self-nomination process to be
approximately $220 ($55 per hour × 4
hours per group practice).
The cost associated with the group
practice reporting requirements of this
voluntary reporting initiative is the time
and effort associated with the group
practice submitting the quality measures
data. For physician group practices, this
would be the time associated with the
physician group completing the
proposed data collection tool. The
information collection components of
this data collection tool have been
reviewed by OMB and are currently
approved under OMB control number
0938–0941, with an expiration date of
December 31, 2011. Based on cost
estimates for the Physician Group
Practice (PGP) demonstration, which
uses the same data submission methods
as what we have proposed, we estimate
the cost associated with a physician
group completing the data collection
tool would be approximately 79 hours
per physician group. Therefore, we
estimate the total annual burden hours
per physician group would be
approximately 83 hours (4 hours for
PO 00000
Frm 00147
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33665
self-nomination + 79 hours for data
submission). Based on an average labor
cost of $55 per physician group, we
estimate the cost per physician group
associated with participating in the
proposed PQRI group practice reporting
option would be $4,565 ($55 per hour
× 83 hours per group practice).
3. Section 131(c): Physician Resource
Use Measurement and Reporting
Program
As discussed in section II.G.3. of this
proposed rule, section 131(c) of the
MIPPA amends section 1848 of the Act
by adding subsection (n), which
requires the Secretary to establish and
implement by January 1, 2009, a
Physician Feedback Program using
Medicare claims data and other data to
provide confidential feedback reports to
physicians (and as determined
appropriate by the Secretary, to groups
of physicians) that measure the
resources involved in furnishing care to
Medicare beneficiaries. If determined
appropriate by the Secretary, the
Secretary may also include information
on quality of care furnished to Medicare
beneficiaries by the physician (or group
of physicians) in the reports. We
anticipate the impact of this section to
be negligible for the work completed in
the phased pilot physician feedback
program to date.
4. Section 132: Incentives for Electronic
Prescribing (E-Prescribing)—The EPrescribing Incentive Program
Section II.G.5. of this proposed rule
describes the proposed 2010 EPrescribing Incentive Program. To be
considered a successful e-prescriber in
2010, an eligible professional would
need to meet the requirements proposed
in section II.G.5.c. of this proposed rule.
We anticipate that the cost impact of
the E-Prescribing Incentive Program on
the Medicare program would be the cost
incurred for maintaining the electronic
prescribing measure and its associated
code set, and for expanding an existing
clinical data warehouse to accommodate
registry-based reporting and,
potentially, EHR-based reporting for the
electronic prescribing measure. We,
however, do not anticipate a significant
cost impact on the Medicare program
since much of this infrastructure had
already been established for the PQRI.
Participation in the E-Prescribing
Incentive Program by eligible
professionals is voluntary and eligible
professionals may have different
processes for integrating the EPrescribing Incentive Program into their
practices’ work flows. Therefore, it is
not possible to estimate with any degree
of accuracy the impact of the E-
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33666
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
Prescribing Incentive Program on
eligible professionals. Similar to claimsbased reporting for PQRI, one factor in
the cost to eligible professionals, for
those eligible professionals who choose
to report the electronic prescribing
measure through claims, is the time and
effort associated with eligible
professionals determining whether the
quality measure is applicable to them,
gathering the required information,
selecting the appropriate quality data
codes, and including the appropriate
quality data codes on the claims they
submit for payment. Since the EPrescribing Incentive Program consists
of only 1 quality measure, we will
assign 1 hour as the amount of time
needed for eligible professionals to
review the e-prescribing measure and
incorporate the use of quality data codes
into their office work flows. At an
average cost of approximately $55 per
hour, we estimate the total cost to
eligible professionals for reviewing the
e-prescribing measure and incorporating
the use of quality data codes into the
office work flows to be approximately
$55 ($55 per hour × 1 hour).
Another factor in the cost to eligible
professionals is the time and effort
associated with gathering the required
information, selecting the appropriate
quality data codes, and including the
appropriate quality data codes on the
claims an eligible professional submits
for payment. Information from the PVRP
estimates the cost to physicians to
perform all of the steps necessary to
report 1 quality measure ranges from
$0.21 in labor time to about $10.06 in
labor time for more complicated cases
and/or measures. For the median
practice, the cost was about $0.90 in
labor time per measure. Therefore, we
estimate the costs to eligible
professionals to perform all the steps
necessary to report the electronic
prescribing measure on a claim to be
approximately $0.90.
The cost for this requirement will also
vary along with the volume of claims on
which quality data is reported. Based on
our proposal to require an eligible
professional to report the G8443 code
for the electronic prescribing measure
for at least 25 instances, we estimate the
total annual estimated cost per eligible
professional to report the electronic
prescribing measure to be $77.50 [($0.90
per measure × 1 measure × 25 cases per
measure) + $55].
Because registry-based reporting of
the electronic prescribing measure to
CMS would be new for 2010 and
participation in this reporting initiative
is voluntary, it is impossible to estimate
with any degree of accuracy how many
eligible professionals will opt to
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
participate in the E-Prescribing
Incentive Program through the registrybased reporting mechanism in CY 2010.
We do not anticipate, however, any
additional cost for eligible professionals
to report data to a registry as eligible
professionals opting for registry-based
reporting would more than likely
already be reporting data to the registry.
Little, if any, additional data would
need to be reported to the registry for
purposes of participation in the 2010 EPrescribing Incentive Program.
One potential cost to some eligible
professionals associated with either
claims-based reporting or registry-based
reporting would be the cost of
purchasing and using an e-prescribing
system. There are currently many
commercial packages available for eprescribing. One study indicated that a
mid-range complete electronic medical
record with electronic prescribing
functionality costs $2500 per license
with an annual fee of $90 per license for
quarterly updates of the drug database
after setup costs while a standalone
prescribing, messaging, and problem list
system costs $1200 per physician per
year after setup costs. Hardware costs
and setup fees substantially add to the
final cost of any software package.
(Corley, S.T. (2003). ‘‘Electronic
prescribing: a review of costs and
benefits.’’ Topics in Health Information
Management 24(1): 29–38.). The cost to
an eligible professional of obtaining and
utilizing an e-prescribing system varies
not only by the commercial software
package selected but also by the level at
which the professional currently
employs information technology in his
or her practice and the level of training
needed.
Based on our proposal to consider
only registries qualified to submit
quality measures results and numerator
and denominator data on quality
measures to CMS on their participants’
behalf for the 2010 PQRI to be qualified
to submit results and numerator and
denominator data on the electronic
prescribing measure for the 2010 EPrescribing Incentive Program, we do
not anticipate any cost to the registry
associated with becoming a registry
qualified to submit the electronic
prescribing measure for 2010.
The cost associated with the registrybased reporting requirements of this
voluntary reporting initiative for the
registry would be the time and effort
associated with the registry calculating
results for the electronic prescribing
measure from the data submitted to the
registry by its participants and
submitting the quality measures results
and numerator and denominator data on
the electronic prescribing quality
PO 00000
Frm 00148
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
measure to CMS on behalf of their
participants. The time needed for a
registry to review the electronic
prescribing measure and other
information, calculate the measure’s
results, and submit the measure’s results
and numerator and denominator data on
the measure on their participants behalf
is expected to vary along with the
number of eligible professionals
reporting data to whom the measure
applies. However, we believe that
registries already perform many of these
activities for their participants. Since
the E-Prescribing Incentive Program
consists of only one measure, we believe
that the cost associated with the registry
reporting the measure’s results and
numerator and denominator to CMS on
behalf of their participants would be
minimal.
For EHR-based reporting (if we
finalize an EHR-based reporting
mechanism for the E-Prescribing
Incentive Program), the eligible
professional must review the electronic
prescribing measure, extract the
necessary clinical data from his or her
EHR, and submit the necessary data to
the CMS-designated clinical data
warehouse. Because this manner of
reporting quality data to CMS would be
new for 2010 and participation in this
reporting initiative is voluntary, it is
impossible to estimate with any degree
of accuracy how many eligible
professionals will opt to participate in
the E-Prescribing Incentive Program
through the EHR-based reporting
mechanism in CY 2010. The cost
associated with an eligible professional
reviewing the electronic prescribing
measure and other information and
determining whether the measure is
applicable to his or her patients and the
services he or she furnishes to them is
expected to be similar for EHR-based
reporting and claims-based reporting
(that is, $55 at a rate of $55 per hour).
Once the EHR is programmed by the
vendor to allow data submission to
CMS, the cost to the eligible
professional associated with the time
and effort to submit data on the
electronic prescribing measure should
be minimal.
Based on our proposal to consider
only EHR products qualified for the
2010 PQRI to be qualified to submit
results and numerator and denominator
data on the electronic prescribing
measure for the 2010 E-Prescribing
Incentive Program, there would be no
need for EHR vendors to undergo a
separate self-nomination process for the
E-Prescribing Incentive Program and
therefore, no additional cost associated
with the self-nomination process.
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
The cost to the EHR vendor associated
with the EHR-based reporting
requirements of this voluntary reporting
initiative is the time and effort
associated with the EHR vendor
programming its EHR product(s) to
extract the clinical data that the eligible
professional needs to submit to CMS for
purposes of reporting the 2010
electronic prescribing measure. The
time needed for an EHR vendor to
review the measure and other
information and program each qualified
EHR product to enable eligible
professionals to submit data on the
measure to the CMS-designated clinical
data warehouse will be dependent on
the EHR vendor’s familiarity with the
electronic prescribing measure, the
vendor’s system capabilities, as well as
the vendor’s programming capabilities.
Since only EHR products qualified for
the 2010 PQRI would be qualified for
the 2010 E-Prescribing Incentive
Program and the E-Prescribing Incentive
Program consists of only one measure,
we believe that any burden associated
with the EHR vendor to program its
product(s) to enable eligible
professionals to submit data on the
electronic prescribing measure to the
CMS-designated clinical data warehouse
would be minimal.
With respect to the proposed process
for group practices to be treated as
successful e-prescribers under the 2010
E-Prescribing Incentive Program
discussed in section II.G.5.e. of this
proposed rule, a group practice would
be required to report the electronic
prescribing measure in at least 2500
instances. Group practices have the
same options as individual eligible
professionals in terms of the form and
manner for reporting the electronic
prescribing measure (that is, group
practices have the option of reporting
the measure through claims, a qualified
registry, or a qualified EHR product).
The only difference between an
individual eligible professional and
group practice reporting of the
electronic prescribing measure is the
number of times a group practice is
required to report the electronic
prescribing measure. For group
practices who are selected to participate
in the 2010 E-Prescribing Incentive
Program group practice reporting option
and choose to do so through claimsbased reporting of the electronic
prescribing measure, we estimate the
total annual estimated cost per group
practice to be $2,305 [($0.90 per
measure × 1 measure × 2500 cases per
measure) + $55].
For group practices who are selected
to participate in the 2010 E-Prescribing
Incentive Program group practice
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
reporting option and choose to do so
through registry-based reporting of the
electronic prescribing measure, we do
not anticipate any additional burden to
report data to a registry as group
practices opting for registry-based
reporting would more than likely
already be reporting data to the registry.
Little, if any, additional data would
need to be reported to the registry for
purposes of participation in the 2010 EPrescribing Incentive Program.
However, group practices would need to
authorize or instruct the registry to
submit quality measures results and
numerator and denominator data on the
electronic prescribing measure to CMS
on their behalf. We estimate that the
time and effort associated with this
would be approximately 5 minutes for
each group practice that wishes to
authorize or instruct the registry to
submit quality measures results and
numerator and denominator data on the
electronic prescribing measure to CMS
on their behalf.
For group practices who are selected
to participate in the 2010 E-Prescribing
Incentive Program group practice
reporting option and choose to do so
through EHR-based reporting of the
electronic prescribing measure, once the
EHR is programmed by the vendor to
allow data submission to CMS, the
burden to the group practice associated
with submission of data on the
electronic prescribing measure should
be minimal.
In addition to the burden associated
with group practices reporting the
electronic prescribing measure, group
practices would also be required to selfnominate in order to participate in the
2010 E-Prescribing Incentive Program
under the group practice reporting
option. Since we propose to limit
participation in the E-Prescribing
Incentive Program group practice
reporting option to those group
practices selected to participate in the
PQRI group practice reporting option,
there would be no additional burden
associated with the group practice selfnomination process for the EPrescribing Incentive Program.
5. Section 135: Implementation of
Accreditation Standards for Suppliers
Furnishing the Technical Component
(TC) of Advanced Diagnostic Imaging
Services.
As discussed in section II.G.6. of this
proposed rule, suppliers that provide
the TC of advanced diagnostic imaging
services will have to be accredited by an
approved accreditation organization in
order to receive Medicare
reimbursement for advanced diagnostic
imaging services described in section
PO 00000
Frm 00149
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33667
1848(b)(4)(B) furnished to beneficiaries.
This section of the rule will impact the
suppliers that provide the TC of
advanced diagnostic imaging services
and the organizations that accredit
suppliers of such services. Suppliers
that provide the TC of advanced
diagnostic imaging services will incur
costs for becoming accredited.
Accreditation organizations will incur
costs to accredit suppliers. To estimate
the impact on suppliers, we calculate
the total cost of accreditation as the sum
of accreditation fees and other
accreditation costs, and we multiply
this cost by the number of providers of
care requiring accreditation.
Factors Affecting the Cost Impact
According to CMS’ Services Tracking
and Reporting System (STARS) database
for 2008, there are a total of 1,137,278
physicians, IDTFs, hospitals and others
billing Part B for the TC of advanced
diagnostic imaging. This total includes
both suppliers and providers that
furnish items under Medicare Part B as
suppliers.
Currently, there are suppliers
accredited by one of three of the
nationally recognized accreditation. We
anticipate that the following
accreditation organizations will seek
approval from CMS to accredit suppliers
that provide the TC of advanced
diagnostic imaging services:
• American College of Radiology;
• Intersocietal Accreditation
Commission; and
• The Joint Commission.
Accreditation Fees
Fees vary between accreditation
organizations and, in general, currently
cover all of the following items:
Application fee, manuals, initial
accreditation fee, onsite surveys or other
auditing (generally once every 3 years),
and travel, when necessary for survey
personnel. Accreditation costs also vary
by the size of the supplier seeking
accreditation, its number of locations,
and the number of services it provides.
Because of these factors, it is sometimes
difficult to compare fees across
accreditation organizations. We
obtained information on total
accreditation fees from the three
accreditation organizations that
currently accredit suppliers who
provide the TC of advanced diagnostic
imaging services. Based on all
information we obtained, we estimate
accreditation fees for each review cycle
will be approximately $ 5,000 for an
advanced diagnostic imaging supplier.
Because accreditation is for a 3-year
period, the estimated average cost per
year would be approximately $1,666.
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33668
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
We recognize that becoming
accredited may impose a burden on
suppliers that provide the TC of
advanced diagnostic imaging services,
especially small suppliers. We have
attempted to minimize that burden. We
have implemented the following options
to minimize the burden of accreditation
on suppliers, including small
businesses:
• Multiple accreditation
organizations: We expect that more than
one accrediting organization will apply
to become and be designated as an
advanced diagnostic imaging
accrediting organization. We believe
that selection of more than one
accreditation organization will
introduce competition resulting in
reductions in accreditation costs.
• Required plan for small businesses:
During the application process we will
require accreditation organizations to
include a plan that details their
methodology to reduce accreditation
fees and burden for small or specialty
suppliers. This will need to include that
the accreditation organization’s fees are
based on the size of the organization.
• Reasonable quality standards: The
quality standards that will be used to
evaluate the services rendered for each
imaging modality are industry
standards. Many suppliers that provide
the TC of advanced diagnostic imaging
services already comply with the
standards and have incorporated these
practices into their daily operations. We
have been told that that those suppliers
with private insurance contracts must
be accredited, thus our requirements
would not be duplicative. It is our belief
and has been stated by those suppliers
already accredited that compliance with
the quality standards will result in more
efficient and effective business practices
and will assist suppliers in reducing
overall costs.
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Other Accreditation Costs
It is difficult to precisely estimate the
costs of preparing for accreditation. We
do recognize there is cost to the supplier
in order to come into compliance
initially and thus prepare for the
accreditation survey. This should result
in minimal preparation and cost.
Additional Considerations
There are at least two important
sources of uncertainty in estimating the
impact of accreditation on suppliers that
provide the TC of advanced diagnostic
imaging services. First, our estimates
assume that all current suppliers with
positive Medicare payments will seek
accreditation. We assume that suppliers
who currently receive no Medicare
allowed charges will choose not to seek
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
accreditation. It is also possible that
many of the suppliers with allowed
charges between $1 and $10,000 may
decide not to incur the costs of
accreditation.
Second, it is unclear what
accreditation fees will be in the future.
However, we are requiring the
accreditation organization to submit
their fees that are based on the size of
the supplier, or on the amount billed.
Our experience with another
accreditation program has lead us to
believe that the accreditation rates will
go up, although minimally, if travel
costs continue to rise.
In summary, suppliers of the TC of
advanced diagnostic imaging services
for which payment is made under the
fee schedule established under section
1848(b) of the Act must become
accredited by an accreditation
organization designated by the Secretary
beginning January 1, 2012. In the
options we have proposed we have
attempted to minimize the burden of
accreditation on suppliers, which
include approving multiple
accreditation organizations that
consider the small suppliers. Also, the
fact that the surveys will be either
performed as a desk review or
unannounced deletes the time and cost
for the accreditation organization in
travel, if required.
6. Section 139: Improvements for
Medicare Anesthesia Teaching Programs
As discussed in section II.G.7., this
proposed rule would provide for
increased payments under the Medicare
PFS for certain cases involving teaching
anesthesiologists with anesthesia
residents or for teaching CRNAs with
student nurse anesthetists. This
provision of the MIPPA is anticipated to
have a minimal budgetary impact.
7. Section 144(a): Payment and Coverage
Improvements for Patients With Chronic
Obstructive Pulmonary Disease and
Other Conditions: Cardiac
Rehabilitation Services
Current levels of coverage for CR
programs will continue under this rule,
and new ICR programs will likely
develop and request designation by
CMS to receive Medicare payments.
Because section 144(a) of the MIPPA
requires higher payments for ICR
programs than for CR programs, this
expansion of coverage will result in
greater costs to the Medicare program.
The requirements for ICR programs, also
required in section 144(a) of the MIPPA,
are extensive and will likely limit the
number of programs that request
designation as ICR programs by CMS.
As a result, significantly fewer ICR
PO 00000
Frm 00150
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
programs than CR programs will
function throughout the country;
however, we currently do not know how
many ICR programs may request
designation.
We believe that the proposed
expansion of coverage for ICR programs
will enable beneficiaries to take
advantage of more focused and rigorous
programs that will more quickly lead to
improved cardiovascular health. Having
the choice of CR and ICR programs,
beneficiaries eligible for coverage will
be able to determine the best manner in
which to achieve improved
cardiovascular health, through
traditional CR or more rigorous ICR
programs. We also expect this proposed
expansion of coverage to bring more
attention to the importance of cardiac
rehabilitation and the extensive benefits
these programs provide to beneficiaries.
As a result, the number of beneficiaries
participating in CR programs may
increase. We estimate that the proposed
provisions for establishing coverage of
cardiac rehabilitation and intensive
cardiac rehabilitation programs, as
discussed in section II.G.8. of this
proposed rule, will have a minimal
budgetary impact on the Medicare
program.
8. Section 144(a): Payment and Coverage
Improvements for Patients With Chronic
Obstructive Pulmonary Disease and
Other Conditions: Pulmonary
Rehabilitation Services
As discussed in section II.G.9. of this
proposed rule, the implementation of
the Medicare pulmonary rehabilitation
program will allow Medicare, for the
first time, to provide for payment for
exercise and other services as part of a
comprehensive treatment plan for
beneficiaries with moderate to severe
COPD. We believe this program has the
potential of not only improving the
quality of life for beneficiaries who
engage in it, but also reducing Medicare
costs in the long range by decreasing the
chances of exacerbations and further
rehabilitation related to their chronic
respiratory disease. We estimate this
provision will have a minimal
budgetary impact on the Medicare
program.
9. Section 152(b): Coverage of Kidney
Disease Patient Education Services
The implementation of Medicare
coverage of kidney disease patient
education services as discussed in
section II.G.10. of this proposed rule
will allow Medicare to provide for
payment for kidney disease education
services for beneficiaries with Stage IV
chronic kidney disease. We believe this
program can help patients achieve better
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
understanding of their illness, dialysis
modality options, and may help delay
the need for dialysis. We believe this
program has the potential of improving
the quality of life for beneficiaries since
they will be better equipped to make
informed decisions. We estimate a cost
to the Medicare program of
approximately $10 million for CY 2010,
because the statute limits the number of
kidney disease education sessions to 6,
as a lifetime maximum.
10. Section 153: Renal Dialysis
Provisions
A discussion of the impact of section
153 of the MIPPA is addressed in
section V.F. of this regulatory impact
analysis in conjunction with the other
ESRD provisions of this rule.
11. Section 182(b): Revision of
Definition of Medically-Accepted
Indication for Drugs; Compendia for
Determination of Medically-Accepted
Indications for Off-Label Uses of Drugs
and Biologicals in an Anti-Cancer
Chemotherapeutic Regimen
We anticipate that the proposals
related to the compendia discussed in
section II.G.12. of this proposed rule
will have a negligible cost to the
Medicare program and to the public.
The information that is required to be
collected and published on the
compendia Web sites is information that
is already collected in the normal course
of business by the compendia
publishers, which all have Web sites.
The proposed changes will enable CMS
to efficiently implement the provisions
of section 182(b) of the MIPPA that
require transparent evaluative and
conflict of interest policies and practices
for current and future listed compendia
on and after January 1, 2010.
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
E. Payment for Covered Outpatient
Drugs and Biologicals
1. Average Sales Price (ASP) Issues
The proposed changes discussed in
section II.F.1. of this proposed rule with
respect to payment for covered
outpatient drugs and biologicals, are
estimated to have no impact on
Medicare expenditures as we are not
proposing any change to the AMP/
WAMP threshold and the proposed
change concerning the
immunosuppressive drug period of
eligibility is a comforming change to
reflect the statute.
2. Competitive Acquisition Program
(CAP) Issues
As discussed in section II.F.2., this
proposed rule contains proposals and
seeks comment on certain aspects of the
CAP, specifically the frequency of drug
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
payment amount updates, changes to
the CAP drug list, the geographic area
served by the CAP, CAP drug stock at
the physician’s office, exclusion of CAP
sales from ASP calculations, the annual
CAP payment amount update
mechanism, and updates to proposals
made in the 2009 PFS rule. Our changes
and refinements may improve
compliance, promote program
flexibility, improve the quality, and
maintain the availability of services for
participating CAP physicians. We
anticipate that these changes associated
with the CAP will not result in
significant additional cost savings or
increases relative to the ASP payment
system for two reasons. First, in 2006
through 2008, the dollar volume of
claims paid under the CAP was small
compared to the volume of claims paid
under section 1847A of the Act, and
although we anticipate that the CAP
will continue to grow, we do not
anticipate a significant change in the
proportion of claims paid under these
payment systems. Second, because CAP
payment amounts are limited to prices
calculated under section 1847A of the
Act, we expect payment rates for the
two programs to remain very similar.
F. Provisions Related to Payment for
Renal Dialysis Services Furnished by
End-Stage Renal Disease (ESRD)
Facilities
The ESRD-related provisions are
discussed in sections II.G.11. and II.I. of
this proposed rule. To understand the
impact of the changes affecting
payments to different categories of
ESRD facilities, it is necessary to
compare estimated payments under the
current year (CY 2009 payments) to
estimated payments under the revisions
to the composite rate payment system
(CY 2010 payments) as discussed in
section II.I. of this proposed rule. To
estimate the impact among various
classes of ESRD facilities, it is
imperative that the estimates of current
payments and estimates of proposed
payments contain similar inputs.
Therefore, we simulated payments only
for those ESRD facilities that we are able
to calculate both current 2009 payments
and proposed 2010 payments.
ESRD providers were grouped into the
categories based on characteristics
provided in the Online Survey and
Certification and Reporting (OSCAR)
file and the most recent cost report data
from the Healthcare Cost Report
Information System (HCRIS). We also
used the December 2008 update of CY
2008 National Claims History file as a
basis for Medicare dialysis treatments
and separately billable drugs and
biologicals. Since the December 2008
PO 00000
Frm 00151
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33669
update of the CY 2008 National Claims
History File is incomplete, we updated
the data. The description of the updates
for the separately billable drugs is
described in section II.I. of this
proposed rule. To update the treatment
counts we used the ratio of the June
2008 to the December 2007 updates of
the CY 2007 National Claims History
File figure for treatments. This was an
increase of 11.3 percent. Due to data
limitations, we are unable to estimate
current and proposed payments for 57
of the 5048 ESRD facilities that bill for
ESRD dialysis treatments.
Table 42 shows the impact of this
year’s proposed changes to CY 2010
payments to hospital-based and
independent ESRD facilities. The first
column of Table 42 identifies the type
of ESRD provider, the second column
indicates the number of ESRD facilities
for each type, and the third column
indicates the number of dialysis
treatments.
The fourth column shows the effect of
all proposed changes to the ESRD wage
index for CY 2010 as it affects the
composite rate payments to ESRD
facilities. The fourth column compares
aggregate ESRD wage adjusted
composite rate payments in CY 2010 to
aggregate ESRD wage adjusted
composite rate payments in CY 2009. In
CY 2009, ESRD facilities receive 100
percent of the CBSA wage adjusted
composite rate and 0 percent of the
MSA wage adjusted composite rate,
ending a 4-year transition period in
which they had received an increasing
percent of payments based on the CBSA
wage adjusted composite rate. The
overall effect to all ESRD providers in
aggregate is zero because the CY 2010
ESRD wage index has been multiplied
by a Budget Neutrality adjustment factor
to comply with the statutory
requirement that any wage index
revisions be done in a manner that
results in the same aggregate amount of
expenditures as would have been made
without any changes in the wage index.
The fifth column shows the effect of
proposed changes to the ESRD wage
index in CY 2010 and the effect of the
MIPPA provisions on ESRD facilities.
Section 153(a) of the MIPPA amended
section 1881(b)(12)(G) of the Act to
revise payments to ESRD facilities.
Effective January 1, 2010, there is an
update of 1 percent to the composite
rate component of the payment system.
The sixth column shows the overall
effect of the proposed changes in
composite rate payments to ESRD
providers including the drug add-on.
The overall effect is measured as the
difference between the proposed CY
2010 payment with all changes as
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33670
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
proposed in this rule and current CY
2009 payment. This payment amount is
computed by multiplying the wage
adjusted composite rate with the drug
add-on for each provider times the
number of dialysis treatments from the
CY 2008 claims. The CY 2010 proposed
payment is the composite rate for each
provider (with the proposed 15.0
percent drug add-on) times dialysis
treatments from CY 2008 claims. The
CY 2009 current payment is the
composite rate for each provider (with
the current 15.2 percent drug add-on)
times dialysis treatments from CY 2008
claims.
The overall impact to ESRD providers
in aggregate is 0.8 percent as shown in
Table 42. Most ESRD facilities will see
an increase in payments as a result of
the MIPPA provision. While the MIPPA
provision includes a 1 percent increase
to the ESRD composite rate, this 1
percent increase does not apply to the
drug add-on to the composite rate. For
this reason, the impact of all changes in
this proposed rule is a 0.8 percent
increase for all ESRD providers. Overall,
payments to independent ESRD
facilities will increase by 0.8 percent
and payments to hospital-based ESRD
facilities will increase by 1.0 percent.
TABLE 42—IMPACT OF CY 2010 CHANGES IN PAYMENTS TO HOSPITAL BASED AND INDEPENDENT ESRD FACILITIES
[Percent change in composite rate payments to ESRD facilities]
Number of
facilities
All Providers .........................................................................
Independent ..................................................................
Hospital Based ..............................................................
By Facility Size:
Less than 5,000 treatments ..........................................
5,000 to 9,999 treatments ............................................
Greater than 9,999 treatments .....................................
Type of Ownership:
Profit ..............................................................................
Nonprofit .......................................................................
By Geographic Location:
Rural .............................................................................
Urban ............................................................................
By Region:
New England ................................................................
Middle Atlantic ..............................................................
East North Central ........................................................
West North Central .......................................................
South Atlantic ................................................................
East South Central .......................................................
West South Central ......................................................
Mountain .......................................................................
Pacific ...........................................................................
Puerto Rico & Virgin Islands ........................................
Effect of
changes in
wage index 1
(percent)
Effect of
changes in
wage index
and of MIPPA
provision 2
(percent)
Overall effect
of wage index
MIPPA & drug
add-on 3
(percent)
2
1
Number of
dialysis treatments
(in millions)
3
4
5
6
4,991
4,432
559
37.1
33.5
3.6
0.0
0.0
0.2
1.0
1.0
1.2
0.8
0.8
1.0
1,807
1,998
1,186
5.3
14.6
17.2
0.1
0.0
¥0.1
1.1
1.0
0.9
0.9
0.9
0.8
4,062
929
30.5
6.5
0.0
0.1
1.0
1.1
0.8
0.9
1,093
3,898
6.0
31.0
0.2
0.0
1.2
1.0
1.0
0.8
156
571
808
382
1,129
388
679
279
562
37
1.3
4.6
5.8
2.0
8.5
2.8
5.3
1.6
4.8
0.4
0.3
¥0.2
¥0.1
0.3
0.1
0.2
0.0
0.9
¥0.1
¥2.4
1.3
0.8
0.9
1.3
1.1
1.2
1.0
1.9
0.9
¥1.4
1.1
0.6
0.7
1.1
0.9
1.0
0.8
1.7
0.7
¥1.6
1 This column shows the overall effect of wage index changes on ESRD providers. Composite rate payments are computed using the proposed CY 2010 wage indexes which are compared to composite rate payments using the current CY 2009 wage indexes.
2 This column shows the effect of the changes in the Wage Indexes and the MIPPA provision which includes a 1 percent increase to the composite rate. This provision is effective January 1, 2010.
3 This column shows the percent change between CY 2010 and CY 2009 composite rate payments to ESRD facilities. The CY 2010 payments
include the CY 2010 wage adjusted composite rate, a 1 percent increase due to MIPPA effective January 1, 2010 and the drug add-on of 15.0
percent. The CY 2009 payments include the CY 2009 wage adjusted composite rate, a 1 percent increase and site neutral rates effective January 1, 2009 and the drug add-on of 15.2 percent. This column shows the effect of wage index, MIPPA, and drug add-on changes.
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
G. Chiropractic Demonstration—
Application of Budget Neutrality
codes 98940, 98941, and 98942) by 2
percent.
As discussed in section II.J. of this
proposed rule, we are proposing to
recoup the $50 million in expenditures
from this demonstration over a 5-year
period rather than over a 2-year period.
We would recoup $10 million each year
through adjustments to the PFS for all
chiropractors in CYs 2010 through 2014.
To implement this required BN
adjustment, we would reduce the
payment amount under the PFS for the
chiropractic CPT codes (that is, CPT
H. Comprehensive Outpatient
Rehabilitation Facilities (CORF) and
Rehabilitation Agency Issues
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
The revisions to the conditions of
participation (CoP) discussed in section
II.K. of this proposed rule make
technical corrections and update the
regulations to reflect current industry
standards for respiratory therapists. The
revisions to the regulations will clarify
the qualifications necessary for
respiratory therapists’ to continue to
PO 00000
Frm 00152
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
qualify to furnish respiratory therapy
services to CORF patients. These
changes are similar to prior rules and
will have no impact on CORFs cost.
I. Physician Self-Referral Provisions
As discussed in section II.N. of this
proposed rule, we expect that our
proposed clarification of the physician
stand in the shoes provisions will assist
designated health services entities in
structuring legitimate compensation
arrangements. Furthermore, like other
physician self-referral policies, we
anticipate that this clarification will
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
result in savings to the Medicare
program by reducing overutilization and
anti-competitive business arrangements.
We cannot gauge with any certainty the
extent of these savings to the program.
K. Durable Medical Equipment Related
Issues
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
1. Damages Process
In section II.O.1. of this proposed
rule, we propose to establish a one-time
process that will only impact those
suppliers who were awarded a contract
and were potentially damaged by the
termination of their supplier contracts
by MIPPA. The DMEPOS Competitive
Bidding Program that was implemented
on July 1st, 2008, awarded contracts to
329 suppliers. The following factors
may be considered by a contract
supplier before deciding to submit a
claim:
• The contract itself stipulated that
the contract is subject to any changes to
the statute or regulations that affect the
Medicare program;
• The contract does not guarantee any
amount of business or profits, therefore,
an efficient business would not be
expected to incur large expenses
without any guaranteed increase in
business and profits;
• The contract stipulates that CMS
shall not pay for any expenses incurred
by the supplier for the work performed
under the contract other than for
payment of Medicare claims authorized
pursuant to the contract;
• Upon termination of the contracts
by MIPPA, payments reverted back to
the fee schedule amount, which was on
average 26 percent higher than under
the DMEPOS Competitive Bidding
Program.
• There is a required responsibility
under contract law for a company to
take action to mitigate expenses to any
stop work order.
• CMS listed the winning suppliers
on the Medicare Web site at https://
www.Medicare.gov in the supplier
locator tool, a supplier is allowed to
keep any new customers they may have
obtained as a result of being listed on
the supplier locator tool.
By mentioning the list above, we are
not suggesting that there would not be
legitimate claims for damages. However,
these are factors that a supplier may
consider when deciding whether to
submit a claim for damages.
Based on these reasons and because
there have been so few inquiries or
responses to the reference in the MIPPA
to damages (fewer than 7 suppliers), we
believe that as few as 1 percent of the
329 winning suppliers may make a
claim for damages. However, as a high
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
estimate, we would estimate that
approximately 76 percent of the
suppliers (250) may submit a claim. We
anticipate that it will take
approximately 3 hours at $34/hour (3 ×
$34 = $102) for an accountant and a
company official to review and gather
the necessary documents to file a claim
for a total of $25,500 (250 × $102). The
hourly accountant rate was based on the
Bureau of Labor Statistics data collected
for June 2006 which was then adjusted
to account for inflation. We estimate
that this regulation will not have a large
budgetary impact. The total cost range
of $408 to $25,500 for potential claims
from contract suppliers will not result
in expenditures of $133 million or more
annually. An analysis of the damage
payments that may result would be
dependent upon an evaluation of the
actual claims once they are received.
2. Grandfathering Process
In section II.O.2. of this proposed
rule, we are proposing to revise the
definition of a grandfathered item to
refer to all rented items within a
competitively bid product category that
the supplier currently rents. The
proposed definition of a grandfathered
item would avoid confusion, on the part
of beneficiaries, regarding rented DME
items for which a noncontract supplier
is willing or not willing to be a
grandfathered supplier. Under the
revised definition, a noncontract
supplier would have to choose to be
either a grandfathered supplier for all or
for none of the DME rented items within
a product category that the supplier
currently provides. We believe that it
would be easier for beneficiaries to
recognize which items a supplier is
grandfathering or not grandfathering if
the supplier’s election concerning
grandfathering was made by product
category rather than making separate
choices for each individual HCPCS
code.
We also believe the revision of this
definition would have a negligible
impact on suppliers as product
categories consist of related items
routinely provided by suppliers. We are
only requiring a supplier to provide
those rented items within a product
category that the supplier was currently
furnishing at the start of the competitive
bidding program.
While difficult to estimate, we believe
that based on 2008 data, there were
approximately 1,850 suppliers in the 9
CBAs, for which we will be doing the
Round 1 rebid that rented competitively
bid items, on average at different points
in time during 2008. Therefore, we are
using this number to indicate how many
suppliers would be renting a DME
PO 00000
Frm 00153
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33671
competitively bid item at the start of the
competitive bid program. We believe
some suppliers may decide not to bid
because of the cost of bidding and
accreditation requirements while other
suppliers may not qualify for a contract.
Since not all suppliers will be awarded
contracts and some may not choose to
submit a bid, we estimate that in the
worst case scenario there will be 1,450
suppliers that will not be awarded
contracts, would be renting DME
competitive bid items at the time the
program is implemented.
Based on our experience from the
competitive bidding demonstrations, of
the 1,450 suppliers who are not
awarded a contract, we expect 90
percent or 1,305 of these noncontract
suppliers will offer to be grandfathered
suppliers (0.90 × 1,450 = 1,305) and 10
percent or 145 (0.10 × 1,450 = 145) of
the suppliers will choose not to
grandfather. We believe most suppliers
will not want to pick up their items
before the end of the full rental period.
Based on 2008 data, we estimate that
there will be 96,000 beneficiaries who
reside in a CBA and are renting
competitively bid items from suppliers
at the start of the round 1 rebid. Based
on the 2007 round 1 of the competitive
bidding program, we estimate that there
would be 74,880 (96,000 × 0.78 =
74,880) beneficiaries who would be
renting items from a noncontract
supplier.
Notification Requirement for Suppliers
That Choose to Grandfather
a. Notification to CMS
For those suppliers that choose to
grandfather (1,305), we estimate that it
would take the supplier on average 2
hours to develop the 30-day notification
that it is required to send to CMS. We
estimate that the cost to the supplier to
develop the 30-day notification to CMS
would be $89.60 for skilled
administrative staff (2 hours × $44.80
per hour). The $44.80 is based on 2009
data from the Bureau of Labor Statistics
plus an increase for overhead of 40
percent. We estimate that the cost to the
supplier to send the notification to CMS
would be $5.51 for clerical staff (0.25
hour to send the notification × $22.02
per hour = $5.51). The $22.02 is based
on 2009 data from the Bureau of Labor
Statistics plus an increase for overhead
of 40 percent. We estimate the cost of
supplies necessary to send the
notification would be $2.00. The total
cost for sending the notification would
be $7.51 which includes the cost of
clerical staff ($5.51) and supplies
($2.00). The individual costs for all
suppliers to notify CMS would be
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33672
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
$97.11 ($89.60 for development of the
letter + $7.51 for preparing and sending
each notification = $97.11). The overall
cost for suppliers to notify CMS would
be approximately $126,728.55 ($97.11
per supplier × 1,305 suppliers =
$126,728.55).
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
b. Notification to the Beneficiary
We estimate based on 2008 data, we
expect that there will be 74,880
beneficiaries who would have been
renting competitive bid items from a
noncontract supplier at the start of the
round 1 rebid of the CBP. Of the 74,880,
we believe that approximately 100
percent of these beneficiaries will
accept the offer to continue to rent
competitively bid items from the
noncontract supplier that offers to be a
grandfathered supplier. We believe that
the beneficiaries will choose to continue
to rent from a grandfathered supplier if
given the choice because it would be
more convenient, assure continuity of
care, and eliminate the need to have
equipment taken from their home.
Based upon the number of suppliers
and beneficiaries, we estimate that there
would be an average of 52 beneficiaries
per supplier that was not awarded a
contract (74,880 beneficiaries/1,450
suppliers = 52). Therefore, we estimate
that each noncontract supplier that
chooses to grandfather would send the
30-day notification on average to 52
beneficiaries.
We expect that the cost of developing
the 30-day notification to a beneficiary
would be equivalent to the cost of
developing the 30-day notification to
CMS ($89.60 per notification). We also
expect the cost of sending the 30-day
notification per beneficiary to be
equivalent to sending the 30-day
notification to CMS ($7.51 per
notification). The total costs for the 30day notification to beneficiaries for
suppliers that choose the grandfathering
option would be $89.60 for
development of the letter, and $7.51 for
preparing and sending each notification.
To calculate the total cost we multiplied
$7.51 × 52 beneficiaries and added the
development cost for the letter of $89.60
for a total of $480.12 per supplier. The
overall cost for these suppliers to
provide the 30-day notification to their
beneficiaries would be approximately
$626,556.60 ($480.12 per supplier ×
1,305 suppliers = $626,556.60).
Notification Requirement for Suppliers
That Choose Not to Grandfather
a. 30-Day Notification to the Beneficiary
We expect that suppliers who choose
not to grandfather will incur costs
equivalent to the cost of developing and
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
sending the 30-day notification to a
beneficiary by those suppliers that
choose to grandfather. The overall cost
for all suppliers who choose not to
grandfather to provide the 30-day
notification to the beneficiary is
approximately $69,617.40 ($480.12 total
cost per supplier × 145 nongrandfathered suppliers = $69,617.40).
The estimate of 145 suppliers not
choosing to be grandfathered suppliers
represents 10 percent of the total
number of noncontract suppliers.
While the cost for the 30-day
notification to beneficiaries will be
exactly the same for all suppliers, those
who choose not to become a
grandfathered supplier will also incur
the cost of the 10-day and 2-day
notification.
because small suppliers will have fewer
beneficiaries to furnish notifications to.
As an alternative, we considered
relying on suppliers to develop their
own schedule for informing
beneficiaries regarding grandfathering.
This alternative would have left the
beneficiaries vulnerable to having
equipment removed from the home
before new equipment was delivered.
The process proposed in this regulation
ensures the beneficiaries can make an
informed decision about the transition
policy that works best for them. The
alternative we selected ensures the
beneficiaries will have continued access
to medically necessary items and be
properly informed about the steps they
must take so that their services will not
be interrupted.
b. 10-Day and 2-Day Notification
For the 10-day notification to a
beneficiary, we estimate the supplier
would make at least 1 phone call that
would take an average of 15 minutes to
discuss that the beneficiary must switch
to a contract supplier, the schedule for
picking up the current equipment by the
noncontract supplier, and the delivery
of new equipment by the contract
supplier. For the 2-day notification to
the beneficiary, we estimate that the
supplier would make at least 1 phone
call that would take an average of 15
minutes to ensure that all of the
arrangements are finalized and to
answer any last minute questions. We
anticipate that clerical staff would
perform both of these tasks.
The estimated cost of the 10-day
notification totals $5.51 (.25 of an hour
× $22.02 per hour for clerical staff based
on the 2009 Bureau of Labor Statistics
including overhead = $5.51). The
estimated cost of the 2-day notification
totals $5.51 (.25 of an hour × $22.02 per
hour for clerical staff based on the 2009
Bureau of Labor Statistics including
overhead = $5.51). Therefore, the 10-day
and 2-day notifications for each supplier
would cost approximately $11.02. The
total cost for each supplier would be
approximately $573.04 ($11.02 × 52
beneficiaries = $573.04). The overall
impact for all suppliers to make the 10day and 2-day notifications would be
approximately $83,090.80 (145
suppliers × $573.04 per supplier =
$83,090.80).
We anticipate that this proposed
process will not place a greater burden
on the overall small supplier
community. This process is only going
to affect those small suppliers that were
renting items when the competitive
bidding program begins and who did
not win a contract. The burden on these
suppliers would generally be less
U. Alternatives Considered
This proposed rule contains a range of
policies, including some provisions
related to specific MIPPA provisions.
The preceding preamble provides
descriptions of the statutory provisions
that are addressed, identifies those
policies when discretion has been
exercised, responds to comments on our
proposals, presents rationale for our
decisions and, where relevant,
alternatives that were considered.
PO 00000
Frm 00154
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
V. Impact on Beneficiaries
There are a number of changes in this
proposed rule that would have an effect
on beneficiaries. In general, we believe
these changes, including the
refinements of the PQRI with its focus
on measuring, submitting, and
analyzing quality data, the coding
provisions related to the IPPE and
consultation services, the changes with
respect to telehealth services, the kidney
disease patient education, pulmonary
rehabilitation and intensive cardiac
rehabilitation proposals will have a
positive impact and improve the quality
and value of care provided to Medicare
beneficiaries. Additionally, the
proposed grandfathering process for
DME suppliers will help ensure that
beneficiaries are contacted and
informed about this process and the
choices they have concerning whether
or not to use a grandfathered supplier.
Moreover, the notice will help to ensure
that beneficiaries do not have necessary
DME equipment taken from them
unexpectedly by a noncontact supplier.
As explained in more detail
subsequently in this section, the
regulatory provisions may affect
beneficiary liability in some cases. Most
changes aggregate in beneficiary liability
due to a particular provision would be
a function of the coinsurance (20
percent if applicable for the particular
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
provision after the beneficiary has met
the deductible). Beneficiary liability
would also be impacted by the effect of
the aggregate cost (savings) of the
provision on the standard calculation of
the Medicare Part B premium rate
(generally 25 percent of the provision’s
cost or savings). In 2010, total cost
sharing (coinsurance and deductible)
per Part B enrollee associated with PFS
services is estimated to be $399. In
addition, the portion of the 2010
standard monthly Part B premium
attributable to PFS services is estimated
to be $25.00.
To illustrate this point, as shown in
Table 39, the 2009 national payment
amount in the nonfacility setting for
CPT code 99203 (Office/outpatient visit,
new), is $91.97 which means that in
2009 a beneficiary is responsible for 20
percent of this amount, or $18.39. Based
on this rule, the 2010 national payment
amount in the nonfacility setting for
CPT code 99203, as shown in Table 39,
is $81.00 which means that, in 2010, the
beneficiary coinsurance for this service
would be $16.20.
Policies discussed in this rule, such as
the coding changes with respect to the
RVUs for IPPE and the changes to
consultation services, would similarly
impact beneficiaries’ coinsurance.
33673
W. Accounting Statement
As required by OMB Circular A–4
(available at https://
www.whitehouse.gov/omb/circulars/
a004/a-4.pdf), in Table 43, we have
prepared an accounting statement
showing the classification of the
expenditures associated with this
proposed rule. This estimate includes
the incurred benefit impact associated
with the estimated CY 2010 PFS update
based on the 2009 Trustees Report
baseline, as well as certain MIPPA
provisions. All estimated impacts are
classified as transfers.
TABLE 43—ACCOUNTING STATEMENT: CLASSIFICATION OF ESTIMATED EXPENDITURES CY 2010
Category
Transfers
Annualized Monetized Transfers ........................
From Whom To Whom? .....................................
Estimated decrease in expenditures (from CY 2009 to CY 2010) of $13.3 Billion.
Federal Government to physicians, other practitioners and providers and suppliers who receive
payment under Medicare.
Estimated increase in expenditures of $110 Million for MIPPA Provisions (sections 102 and
152(b)).
Federal Government to providers.
Annualized Monetized Transfers ........................
From Whom To Whom? .....................................
In accordance with the provisions of
Executive Order 12866, this proposed
rule was reviewed by the Office of
Management and Budget.
List of Subjects
42 CFR Part 410
Health facilities, Health professions,
Kidney diseases, Laboratories,
Medicare, Reporting and recordkeeping
requirements, Rural areas, X-rays.
42 CFR Part 411
Kidney diseases, Medicare, Physician
Referral, Reporting and record keeping
requirements.
Administrative practice and
procedure, Health facilities, Health
professions, Kidney diseases, Medicare,
Reporting and recordkeeping.
42 CFR Part 415
Health facilities, Health professions,
Medicare, Reporting and recordkeeping
requirements.
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
42 CFR Part 485
Grant programs—health, Health
facilities, Medicaid, Medicare,
Reporting and recordkeeping
requirements.
Authority: Secs. 1102, 1834, 1871, and
1893 of the Social Security Act (42 U.S.C.
1302, 1395m, 1395hh, and 1395ddd).
Subpart B—Medical and Other Health
Services
2. Section 410.30 is amended by
revising paragraph (b) to read as follows:
§ 410.30 Prescription drugs used in
immunosuppressive therapy.
Jkt 217001
*
*
*
*
(b) Eligibility. For drugs furnished on
or after December 21, 2000, coverage is
available only for prescription drugs
used in immunosuppressive therapy,
furnished to an individual who received
an organ or tissue transplant for which
Medicare payment is made, provided
the individual is eligible to receive
Medicare Part B benefits.
*
*
*
*
*
3. Section 410.47 is added to read as
follows:
§ 410.47 Pulmonary rehabilitation
program: Conditions for coverage.
For the reasons set forth in the
preamble, the Centers for Medicare &
Medicaid Services would amend 42 CFR
chapter IV as set forth below:
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
1. The authority citation for part 410
continues to read:
*
42 CFR Part 414
VerDate Nov<24>2008
PART 410—SUPPLEMENTARY
MEDICAL INSURANCE (SMI)
BENEFITS
(a) Definitions.
Individualized treatment plan means
a written plan established, reviewed,
and signed by a physician every 30
days, that describes all of the following:
(i) The individual’s diagnosis.
PO 00000
Frm 00155
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
(ii) The type, amount, frequency, and
duration of the items and services under
the plan.
(iii) The goals set for the individual
under the plan.
Outcomes assessment means a written
evaluation of the patient’s progress as it
relates to the individual’s rehabilitation
which includes the following:
(i) Beginning and end evaluations,
based on patient-centered outcomes,
which are conducted by the physician at
the start and end of the program.
(ii) Objective clinical measures of
effectiveness of the PR program for the
individual patient, including exercise
performance and self-reported measures
of shortness of breath and behavior.
Physician means a doctor of medicine
or osteopathy as defined in section
1861(r)(1) of the Act.
Physician-prescribed exercise means
physical activity, including aerobic
exercise, prescribed and supervised by a
physician that improves or maintains an
individual’s pulmonary functional level.
Psychosocial assessment means a
written evaluation of an individual’s
mental and emotional functioning as it
relates to the individual’s rehabilitation
or respiratory condition.
Pulmonary rehabilitation means a
physician-supervised program for COPD
and certain other chronic respiratory
diseases designed to optimize physical
and social performance and autonomy.
(b) Beneficiaries who may be covered.
(1) Medicare covers pulmonary
rehabilitation for beneficiaries with
moderate to severe COPD (defined as
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33674
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
GOLD classification II and III), when
referred by the physician treating the
chronic respiratory disease.
(2) Additional medical indications for
coverage for pulmonary rehabilitation
program services may be established
through a national coverage
determination (NCD).
(c) Components. Pulmonary
rehabilitation includes all of the
following components:
(1) Physician-prescribed exercise.
This physical activity includes
techniques such as exercise
conditioning, breathing retraining, step
and strengthening exercises. Some
aerobic exercise must be included in
each pulmonary rehabilitation session.
(2) Education or training. (i)
Education or training closely and clearly
related to the individual’s care and
treatment which is tailored to the
individual’s needs.
(ii) Education includes information on
respiratory problem management and, if
appropriate, brief smoking cessation
counseling.
(iii) Any education or training
prescribed must assist in achievement of
individual goals towards independence
in activities of daily living, adaptation
to limitations and improved quality of
life.
(3) Psychosocial assessment. The
psychosocial assessment must meet the
criteria as defined in paragraph (a) of
this section and includes:
(i) An assessment of those aspects of
an individual’s family and home
situation that affects the individual’s
rehabilitation treatment.
(ii) A psychosocial evaluation of the
individual’s response to and rate of
progress under the treatment plan.
(4) Outcomes assessment. The
outcomes assessment must meet the
criteria as defined in paragraph (a) of
this section.
(5) Individualized treatment plan. The
individualized treatment plan must be
established, reviewed, and signed by a
physician every 30 days.
(d) Settings. (1) Medicare Part B pays
for a pulmonary rehabilitation in the
following settings:
(i) Physician’s offices.
(ii) Hospital outpatient settings.
(2) All settings must have the
following available for immediate use
and accessible at all times:
(i) The necessary cardio-pulmonary,
emergency, diagnostic, and therapeutic
life-saving equipment accepted by the
medical community as medically
necessary (for example, oxygen,
cardiopulmonary resuscitation
equipment, and defibrillator) to treat
chronic respiratory disease.
(ii) A physician must be immediately
available and accessible for medical
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
consultations and emergencies at all
times when services are being provided
under the program. This provision is
satisfied if the physician meets the
requirements for direct supervision for
physician office services at
§ 410.26(b)(5) of this subpart as
described in § 410.26(a)(2) of this
subpart (defined through cross
references to § 410.32(b)(3)(ii) of this
subpart); and for hospital outpatient
services at § 410.27(f) of this subpart.
(e) Physician standards. Medicare
Part B pays for pulmonary rehabilitation
services provided by a physician only if
the physician meets all of the following
requirements:
(1) Has expertise in the management
of individuals with respiratory
pathophysiology.
(2) Is licensed to practice in the State
in which the pulmonary rehabilitation
program is offered.
(3) Is responsible and accountable for
the pulmonary rehabilitation program.
(4) Is involved substantially in
consultation with staff in directing the
progress of the individual in the
program.
(f) Limitations on coverage: Sessions.
Medicare Part B pays for services
provided in connection with a
pulmonary rehabilitation exercise
program for up to 36 sessions, no more
than one session per day.
(g) Effective date. Coverage for
pulmonary rehabilitation program
services is effective January 1, 2010.
4. Section 410.48 is added to read as
follows:
§ 410.48 Kidney disease education
services.
(a) Definitions.
Kidney disease patient education
services means face-to-face educational
services provided to patients with Stage
IV chronic kidney disease.
Physician means a physician as
defined in section 1861(r)(1) of the Act.
Qualified person means either of the
following healthcare entities that meets
the qualifications and requirements
specified in this section to provide
kidney disease patient education
services—
(i) One of the following healthcare
professionals who furnishes services for
which payment may be made under the
physician fee schedule:
(A) Physician (as defined in section
1861(r)(1) of the Act).
(B) Physician assistant (as defined in
section 1861(aa)(5) of the Act and
§ 410.74 of this subpart).
(C) Nurse practitioner (as defined in
section 1861(aa)(5) of the Act and
§ 410.75 of this subpart).
PO 00000
Frm 00156
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
(D) Clinical nurse specialist (as
defined in section 1861(aa)(5) of the Act
and § 410.76 of this subpart),
(ii)(A) Hospital, critical access
hospital, skilled nursing facility,
comprehensive outpatient rehabilitation
facility, home health agency, or hospice
that is located in a rural area as defined
in § 412.64(b)(ii)(C); or
(B) A hospital or critical access
hospital that is treated as being rural
under § 412.103 of this chapter.
Renal dialysis facility means a unit
which is approved to furnish dialysis
service(s) directly to end-stage renal
disease (ESRD) patients, as defined in
§ 405.2102 of this chapter.
Stage IV chronic kidney disease
means kidney damage with a severe
decrease in glomerular filtration rate
(GFR) quantitatively defined by a GFR
value of 15–29 ml/min/1.73m2, using
the Modification of Diet in Renal
Disease (MDRD) Study formula.
(b) Covered beneficiaries. Medicare
Part B covers outpatient kidney disease
patient education services if the
beneficiary meets all of the conditions
and requirements of this subpart,
including all of the following:
(1) Is diagnosed with Stage IV chronic
kidney disease.
(2) Obtains a referral from the
physician (as defined in section
1861(r)(1) of the Act) managing the
beneficiary’s kidney condition.
(c) Qualified person. (1) Medicare Part
B covers outpatient kidney disease
patient education services provided by
a qualified person as defined in
paragraph (a) of this section and must be
able to properly receive Medicare
payment under part 424 of this chapter.
(2) A qualified person does not
include either of the following:
(i) A hospital, critical access hospital,
skilled nursing facility, comprehensive
outpatient rehabilitation facility, home
health agency or hospice if kidney
disease patient education services are
provided outside of a rural area as
defined in § 412.64(b)(ii)(C) of this
chapter unless the services are
furnished in a hospital or critical access
hospital that is treated as being in a
rural area under § 412.103 of this
chapter.
(ii) A renal dialysis facility, as defined
in § 405.2102 of this chapter.
(d) Standards for content of kidney
disease patient education services. The
content of the kidney disease patient
education services includes the
following:
(1) The management of comorbidities
including for the purpose of delaying
the need for dialysis which includes,
but not limited to, the following topics:
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
(i) Prevention and treatment of
cardiovascular disease.
(ii) Prevention and treatment of
diabetes.
(iii) Hypertension management.
(iv) Anemia management.
(v) Bone disease and disorders of
calcium and phosphorus metabolism
management.
(vi) Symptomatic neuropathy
management.
(vii) Impairments in functioning and
well-being.
(2) The prevention of uremic
complications which includes, but not
limited to, the following topics:
(i) Information on how the kidneys
work and what happens when the
kidneys fail.
(ii) Understanding if remaining
kidney function can be protected,
preventing disease progression, and
realistic chances of survival.
(iii) Diet and fluid restrictions.
(iv) Medication review, including
how each medication works, possible
side effects and minimization of side
effects, the importance of compliance,
and informed decision-making if the
patient decides not to take a specific
drug.
(3) Therapeutic options, treatment
modalities and settings, including a
discussion of the advantages and
disadvantages of each treatment option
and how the treatments replace the
kidney:
(i) Hemodialysis, both at home and infacility.
(ii) Peritoneal dialysis (PD), including
intermittent PD, continuous ambulatory
PD, and continuous cycling PD, both at
home and in-facility.
(iii) All vascular access options.
(iv) Transplantation.
(4) Opportunities for beneficiaries to
actively participate in the choice of
therapy and be tailored to meet the
needs of the individual beneficiary
involved which includes, but not
limited to, the following topics:
(i) Physical symptoms.
(ii) Impact on family and social life.
(iii) Exercise.
(iv) The right to refuse treatment.
(v) Impact on work and finances.
(vi) The meaning of test results.
(vii) Psychological impact.
(5) Qualified persons must develop
outcomes assessments designed to
measure beneficiary knowledge about
chronic kidney disease and its
treatment.
(i) The outcomes assessments serve to
assess program effectiveness of
preparing the beneficiary to make
informed decisions about their
healthcare options related to chronic
kidney disease.
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
(ii) The outcomes assessments serve
to assess the program’s effectiveness in
meeting the communication needs of
underserved populations, including
persons with disabilities, persons with
limited English proficiency, and persons
with health literacy needs.
(iii) The assessment must be
administered to the beneficiary during a
kidney disease education session.
(iv) The outcomes assessments must
be made available to CMS upon request.
(e) Limitations for coverage of kidney
disease education services. (1) Medicare
Part B makes payment for up to 6
sessions of kidney disease patient
education services.
(2) A session is 60 minutes long and
may be provided individually or in
group settings of 2 to 20 individuals
who need not all be Medicare
beneficiaries.
(f) Effective date. Medicare Part B
covers kidney disease patient education
services for dates of service on or after
January 1, 2010.
5. Section 410.49 is added to read as
follows:
§ 410.49 Cardiac rehabilitation program
and intensive cardiac rehabilitation
program: Conditions of coverage.
(a) Definitions.
Cardiac rehabilitation (CR) means a
physician-supervised program that
furnishes physician prescribed exercise,
cardiac risk factor modification,
psychosocial assessment, and outcomes
assessment.
Individualized treatment plan means
a written plan tailored to each
individual patient that includes all of
the following:
(i) A description of the individual’s
diagnosis.
(ii) The type, amount, frequency, and
duration of the items and services
furnished under the plan.
(iii) The goals set for the individual
under the plan.
Intensive cardiac rehabilitation (ICR)
means a physician-supervised program
that furnishes cardiac rehabilitation and
has shown, in peer-reviewed published
research that it improves patients’
cardiovascular disease through specific
outcome measurements described in
paragraph (c) of this section.
Physician means a doctor of medicine
or osteopathy as defined in section
1861(r)(1) of the Act.
Outcomes assessment means an
evaluation of progress as it relates to the
individual’s rehabilitation which
includes all of the following:
(i) Minimally, assessments from the
commencement and conclusion of
cardiac rehabilitation and intensive
cardiac rehabilitation, based on patient-
PO 00000
Frm 00157
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33675
centered outcomes which must be
measured by the physician immediately
at the beginning of the program and at
the end of the program.
(ii) Objective clinical measures of
exercise performance and self-reported
measures of exertion and behavior.
Physician-prescribed exercise means
aerobic exercise combined with other
types of exercise (that is, strengthening,
stretching) as determined to be
appropriate for individual patients by a
physician.
Psychosocial assessment means an
evaluation of an individual’s mental and
emotional functioning as it relates to the
individual’s rehabilitation which
includes an assessment of those aspects
of an individual’s family and home
situation that affects the individual’s
rehabilitation treatment, and
psychosocial evaluation of the
individual’s response to and rate of
progress under the treatment plan.
(b) General rule. (1) Covered
beneficiary rehabilitation services.
Medicare part B covers cardiac
rehabilitation and intensive cardiac
rehabilitation programs, as defined in
this section, for beneficiaries who have
experienced one or more of the
following:
(i) An acute myocardial infarction
within the preceding 12 months.
(ii) A coronary artery bypass surgery.
(iii) Current stable angina pectoris.
(iv) Heart valve repair or replacement.
(v) Percutaneous transluminal
coronary angioplasty (PTCA) or
coronary stenting.
(vi) A heart or heart-lung transplant.
(vii) For cardiac rehabilitation only,
other conditions as specified through a
national coverage determination.
(2) Components of a cardiac
rehabilitation program. Cardiac
rehabilitation programs must include all
of the following:
(i) Physician-prescribed exercise each
day cardiac rehabilitation items and
services are furnished.
(ii) Cardiac risk factor modification,
including education, counseling, and
behavioral intervention, tailored to the
patients’ individual needs.
(iii) Psychosocial assessment.
(iv) Outcomes assessment.
(v) An individualized treatment plan
detailing how components are utilized
for each patient.
(3) Settings. (i) Medicare Part B pays
for cardiac rehabilitation and intensive
cardiac rehabilitation in one of the
following settings:
(A) A physician’s office.
(B) A hospital outpatient setting.
(ii) All settings must have a physician,
as defined in this section, immediately
available and accessible for medical
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33676
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
consultations and emergencies at all
times when items and services are being
furnished under the program. This
provision is satisfied if the physician
meets the requirements for direct
supervision for physician office services
at § 410.26(b)(5) of this subpart as
described in § 410.26(a)(2) of this
subpart (defined through cross
references to § 410.32(b)(3)(ii) of this
subpart); and for hospital outpatient
services at § 410.27 of this subpart.
(c) Standards for an intensive cardiac
rehabilitation program. (1) To be
designated an intensive cardiac
rehabilitation program, a program in an
approved setting must apply for
designation. To be designated as an
intensive cardiac rehabilitation
program, the program must demonstrate
through peer-reviewed, published
research that it accomplishes one or
more of the following for its patients:
(i) Positively affected the progression
of coronary heart disease.
(ii) Reduces the need for coronary
bypass surgery.
(iii) Reduces the need for
percutaneous coronary interventions.
(iv) A statistically significant
reduction in 5 or more of the following
measures for patients from their levels
before cardiac rehabilitation services to
after cardiac rehabilitation services:
(A) Low density lipoprotein.
(B) Triglycerides.
(C) Body mass index.
(D) Systolic blood pressure.
(E) Diastolic blood pressure.
(F) The need for cholesterol, blood
pressure, and diabetes medications.
(2) A list of designated intensive
cardiac rehabilitation programs will be
posted to the CMS Web site and listed
in the Federal Register.
(3) To ensure that intensive cardiac
rehabilitation programs maintain the
designated quality of rehabilitation,
sites must demonstrate that patients
enrolled continue to achieve beneficial
outcomes by submitting outcomes data
annually from the date of approval as an
intensive cardiac rehabilitation site.
(i) Sites will be notified of continued
compliance via a re-evaluation date
posted to the CMS Web site.
(ii) Sites that are no longer designated
as approved intensive cardiac
rehabilitation programs, due to poor
outcomes data resulting in
noncompliance, will be notified in
writing and removed from the CMS Web
site.
(d) Standards for physicians
responsible for cardiac rehabilitation
programs. A physician who serves as
the program Medical Director
responsible for general or intensive
cardiac rehabilitation programs, and
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
who, in consultation with staff, is
involved in directing the progress of
individuals in the program must possess
all of the following:
(1) Expertise in the management of
individuals with cardiac
pathophysiology.
(2) Be licensed to practice medicine in
the State in which the cardiac
rehabilitation program is offered.
(e) Standards for supervisingphysicians. Physicians acting as the
supervising-physician must possess all
of the following:
(1) Expertise in the management of
individuals with cardiac
pathophysiology.
(2) Be licensed to practice medicine in
the State in which the cardiac
rehabilitation program is offered.
(f) Limitations for coverage of cardiac
rehabilitation programs. (1) General
cardiac rehabilitation. The number of
general cardiac rehabilitation program
sessions are limited to a minimum of 2
1-hour sessions per week and a
maximum of 2 1-hour sessions per day
for up to 36 sessions over up to 18
weeks. Medicare contractors have
discretion to expand these limitations to
not exceed 72 sessions for 36 weeks.
(2) Intensive cardiac rehabilitation:
Intensive cardiac rehabilitation program
sessions are limited to 72 1-hour
sessions (as defined in section
1848(b)(5) of the Act), up to 6 sessions
per day, over a period of up to 18 weeks.
6. Section 410.78 is amended by—
A. Revising the introductory text of
paragraph (b).
B. Revising paragraph (e).
The revisions read as follows:
§ 410.78
Telehealth services.
*
*
*
*
*
(b) General rule. Medicare Part B pays
for office and other outpatient visits,
professional consultation, psychiatric
diagnostic interview examination,
individual psychotherapy,
pharmacologic management, end-stage
renal disease-related services included
in the monthly capitation payment
(except for one visit per month to
examine the access site), individual
medical nutrition therapy, the
neurobehavioral status exam, follow-up
inpatient telehealth consultations
furnished to beneficiaries in hospitals
and SNFs, and individual health and
behavior assessment and intervention
services furnished by an interactive
telecommunications system if the
following conditions are met:
*
*
*
*
*
(e) Limitations. (1) A clinical
psychologist and a clinical social
worker may bill and receive payment for
individual psychotherapy via a
PO 00000
Frm 00158
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
telecommunications system, but may
not seek payment for medical evaluation
and management services.
(2) The physician visits required
under § 483.40(c) of this title may not be
furnished as telehealth services.
*
*
*
*
*
Subpart I—Payment of SMI Benefits
7. Section 410.155 is amended by—
A. Revising paragraphs (a), (b)(2)(i),
(b)(2)(ii), (b)(2)(iv), (b)(2)(v), and (c).
B. Adding paragraph (b)(3).
The revisions and addition read as
follows:
§ 410.155 Outpatient mental health
treatment limitation.
(a) Limitation. For services subject to
the limitation as specified in paragraph
(b) of this section, the percentage of the
expenses incurred for such services
during a calendar year that is
considered incurred expenses under
Medicare Part B when determining the
amount of payment and deductible
under § 410.152 and § 410.160,
respectively, is as follows:
(1) For expenses incurred in years
before 2010, 621⁄2 percent.
(2) For expenses incurred in 2010 and
2011, 683⁄4 percent.
(3) For expenses incurred in 2012, 75
percent.
(4) For expenses incurred in 2013,
811⁄4 percent.
(5) For expenses incurred in CY 2014
and subsequent years, 100 percent.
(b) * * *
(2) Services not subject to the
limitation. Services not subject to the
limitation include the following:
(i) Services furnished to a hospital
inpatient.
(ii) Brief office visits for the sole
purpose of monitoring or changing drug
prescriptions used in the treatment of
mental, psychoneurotic, or personality
disorders billed under HCPCS code
M0064 (or its successor).
(iii) * * *
(iv) Diagnostic services, such as
diagnostic psychological and
neuropsychological testing, that are
performed to establish a diagnosis.
(v) Medical management services
billed under CPT code 90862 (or its
successor), as opposed to
psychotherapy, when furnished to a
patient diagnosed with Alzheimer’s
disease or a related disorder.
(3) Payment amounts. The Medicare
payment amount and the patient
liability amounts for outpatient mental
health services subject to the limitation
for each year during which the
limitation is phased out are as follows:
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
Recognized
incurred expenses
(%)
Calendar year
CY 2009 and prior calendar years ............................................................................
CYs 2010 and 2011 ...................................................................................................
CY 2012 .....................................................................................................................
CY 2013 .....................................................................................................................
CY 2014 .....................................................................................................................
(c) General formula. A general
formula for calculating the amount of
Medicare payment and the patient
liability for outpatient mental health
services subject to the limitation is as
follows:
(1) Multiply the Medicare approved
amount by the percentage of incurred
expenses that is recognized as incurred
expenses for Medicare payment
purposes for the year involved;
(2) Subtract from this amount the
amount of any remaining Part B
deductible for the patient and year
involved; and,
(3) Multiply this amount by 0.80 (80
percent) to obtain the Medicare payment
amount.
(4) Subtract the Medicare payment
amount from the Medicare-approved
amount to obtain the patient liability
amount.
PART 411—EXCLUSIONS FROM
MEDICARE AND LIMITATIONS ON
MEDICARE PAYMENT
8. The authority citation for Part 411
continues to read as follows:
Authority: Secs. 1102, 1860D–1 through
1860D–42, 1871, and 1877 of the Social
Security Act (42 U.S.C. 1302, 1395w–101
through 1395w–152, 1395hh, and 1395nn).
Subpart J—Financial Relationships
Between Physicians and Entities
Furnishing Designated Health Services
9. Section 411.354 is amended by
revising paragraph (c)(3)(i) to read as
follows:
§ 411.354 Financial relationship,
compensation, and ownership or
investment interest.
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
*
*
*
*
*
(c) * * *
(3)(i) For purposes of paragraphs
(c)(1)(ii) and (c)(2)(iv), a physician who
‘‘stands in the shoes’’ of his or her
physician organization is deemed to
have the same compensation
arrangements (with the same parties and
on the same terms) as the physician
organization. When applying the
exceptions in § 411.355 and § 411.357 of
this part to arrangements in which a
physician stands in the shoes of his or
her physician organization, the relevant
referrals and other business generated
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
62.50
68.75
75.00
81.25
100.00
‘‘between the parties’’ are referrals and
other business generated between the
entity furnishing DHS and the physician
organization (including all members,
employees, and independent contractor
physicians).
*
*
*
*
*
PART 414—PAYMENT FOR PART B
MEDICAL AND OTHER HEALTH
SERVICES
10. The authority citation for part 414
continues to read as follows:
Authority: Secs. 1102, 1871, and 1881(b)(l)
of the Social Security Act (42 U.S.C. 1302,
1395hh, and 1395rr(b)(l)).
Subpart A—General Provisions
§ 414.1
[Amended]
11. Amend § 414.1 by adding
‘‘1834(e)—Implementation of
accreditation standards for suppliers
furnishing the technical component of
advanced imaging services’’ in
numerical order.
Subpart B—Physicians and Other
Practitioners
12. Section 414.46 is amended by
revising paragraphs (d)(2) and (e) to read
as follows:
§ 414.46 Additional rules for payment of
anesthesia services.
*
*
*
*
*
(d) * * *
(2) The rules for medical direction
differ for certain time periods
depending on the nature of the qualified
individual who is directed by the
physician. If more than two procedures
are directed on or after January 1, 1994,
the qualified individuals could be AAs,
CRNAs, interns, or residents. The
medical direction rules apply to student
nurse anesthetists only if the physician
directs two concurrent cases, each of
which involves a student nurse
anesthetist or the physician directs one
case involving a student nurse
anesthetist and the other involving a
CRNA, AA, intern, or resident. For
services furnished on or after January 1,
2010, the medical direction rules do not
apply to a single anesthesia resident
case that is concurrent to another case
which is paid under the medical
PO 00000
Frm 00159
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
Patient pays
(%)
33677
Medicare pays
(%)
50
45
40
35
20
50
55
60
65
80
direction payment rules as specified in
paragraph (e) of this section.
*
*
*
*
*
(e) Special payment rule for teaching
anesthesiologist involved in a single
resident case or two concurrent cases.
For physicians’ services furnished on or
after January 1, 2010, if the teaching
anesthesiologist is involved in the
training of physician residents in a
single anesthesia case or two concurrent
anesthesia cases, the fee schedule
amount must be 100 percent of the fee
schedule amount otherwise applicable if
the anesthesia services were personally
performed by the teaching
anesthesiologist and the teaching
anesthesiologist fulfilled the criteria in
§ 415.178 of this chapter. The single
anesthesia resident case is the only case
or concurrent to one other anesthesia
case that is being medically directed by
the physician.
*
*
*
*
*
13. Section 414.61 is added to read as
follows:
§ 414.61 Payment for anesthesia services
furnished by a teaching CRNA.
(a) Basis for payment. Beginning
January 1, 2010, anesthesia services
furnished by a teaching CRNA may be
paid under one of the following
conditions:
(1) The teaching CRNA, who is not
under medical direction of a physician,
is present with the student nurse
anesthetist for the pre and post
anesthesia services included in the
anesthesia base units payment and is
continuously present during anesthesia
time in a single case with a student
nurse anesthetist.
(2) The teaching CRNA, who is not
under the medical direction of a
physician, is involved with two
concurrent anesthesia cases with
student nurse anesthetists. The teaching
CRNA must be present with the student
nurse anesthetist for the pre and post
anesthesia services included in the
anesthesia base unit. For the anesthesia
time of the two concurrent cases, the
teaching CRNA can only be involved
with those two concurrent cases and
may not perform services for other
patients.
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33678
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
(b) Level of payment. The allowance
for the service of the teaching CRNA,
furnished under paragraph (a) of this
section, is determined in the same way
as for a physician who personally
performs the anesthesia service alone as
specified in 414.46(c) of this subpart.
14. Section 414.65 is amended by
revising paragraph (a)(1) to read as
follows:
§ 414.65
Payment for telehealth services.
(a) * * *
(1) The Medicare payment amount for
office or other outpatient visits,
consultation, individual psychotherapy,
psychiatric diagnostic interview
examination, pharmacologic
management, end-stage renal disease
related services included in the monthly
capitation payment (except for one visit
per month to examine the access site),
individual medical nutrition therapy,
and individual health and behavior
assessment and intervention services
furnished via an interactive
telecommunications system is equal to
the current fee schedule amount
applicable for the service of the
physician or practitioner. The Medicare
payment amount for follow-up inpatient
telehealth consultations furnished via
an interactive telecommunications
system is equal to the current fee
schedule amount applicable to
subsequent hospital care provided by a
physician or practitioner.
*
*
*
*
*
15. Section 414.68 is added to read as
follows:
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
§ 414.68
Imaging accreditation.
(a) Scope and purpose. Section
1834(e) of the Act, requires the
Secretary to designate and approve
independent accreditation organizations
for purposes of accrediting suppliers
furnishing the technical component
(TC) of advanced diagnostic imaging
services and establish procedures to
ensure that the criteria used by an
accreditation organization is specific to
each imaging modality. Suppliers of the
TC of advanced diagnostic imaging
services for which payment is made
under the fee schedule established in
section 1848(b) of the Act must become
accredited by an accreditation
organization designated by the Secretary
beginning January 1, 2012.
(b) Definitions. As used in this
section, the following definitions are
applicable:
Accredited supplier means a supplier
that has been accredited by a CMSdesignated accreditation organization as
specified in this part.
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
Advanced diagnostic imaging service
means any of the following diagnostic
services:
(i) Magnetic resonance imaging.
(ii) Computed tomography.
(iii) Nuclear medicine.
(iv) Positron emission tomography.
CMS-approved accreditation
organization means an accreditation
organization designated by CMS to
perform the accreditation functions
specified in section 1834(e) of the Act
(c) Application and reapplication
procedures for accreditation
organizations. An independent
accreditation organization applying for
approval or reapproval of authority to
survey suppliers for purposes of
accrediting suppliers furnishing the TC
of advanced diagnostic imaging services
is required to furnish CMS with all of
the following:
(1) A detailed description of how the
organization’s accreditation criteria
satisfy the statutory standards at section
1834(e)(3) of the Act, specifically—
(i) Qualifications of medical
personnel who are not physicians and
who furnish the TC of advanced
diagnostic imaging services;
(ii) Qualifications and responsibilities
of medical directors and supervising
physicians, such as their training in
advanced diagnostic imaging services in
a residency program, expertise obtained
through experience, or continuing
medical education courses;
(iii) Procedures to ensure the
reliability, clarity, and accuracy of the
technical quality of diagnostic images
produced by the supplier; and
(iv) Procedures to ensure the safety of
persons who furnish the TC of advanced
diagnostic imaging services and
individuals to whom such services are
furnished.
(2) An agreement to conform
accreditation requirements to any
changes in Medicare statutory
requirements in section 1834(e) of the
Act.
(3) Information that demonstrates the
accreditation organization’s knowledge
and experience in the advanced
diagnostic imaging arena.
(4) The organization’s proposed fees
for accreditation for each modality in
which the organization intends to offer
accreditation, including any plans for
reducing the burden and cost of
accreditation to small and rural
suppliers.
(5) Any specific documentation
requirements and attestations requested
by CMS as a condition of designation
under this part.
(6) A detailed description of the
organization’s survey process, including
the following:
PO 00000
Frm 00160
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
(i) Type and frequency of the surveys
performed.
(ii) The ability of the organization to
conduct timely reviews of accreditation
applications, to include the
organizations national capacity.
(iii) Description of the organizations
audit procedures including random site
visits, site audits, or other strategies for
ensuring suppliers maintain compliance
during the duration of accreditation.
(iv) Procedures for performing
unannounced site surveys.
(v) Copies of the organization’s survey
forms.
(vi) A description of the accreditation
survey review process and the
accreditation status decision-making
process, including the process for
addressing deficiencies identified with
the accreditation requirements, and the
procedures used to monitor the
correction of deficiencies found during
an accreditation survey.
(vii) Procedures for coordinating
surveys with another accrediting
organization if the organization does not
accredit all products the supplier
provides.
(viii) Detailed information about the
individuals who perform evaluations for
the accreditation organization,
including all of the following
information:
(A) The number of professional and
technical staff that are available for
survey.
(B) The education, current
employment and experience
requirements surveyors must meet.
(C) The content and length of the
orientation program.
(ix) The frequency and types of inservice training provided to survey
personnel.
(x) The evaluation systems used to
monitor the performance of individual
surveyors and survey teams.
(xi) The policies and procedures
regarding an individual’s participation
in the survey or accreditation decision
process of any organization with which
the individual is professionally or
financially affiliated.
(xii) The policies and procedures used
when an organization has a dispute
regarding survey findings or an adverse
decision.
(7) Detailed information about the size
and composition of survey teams for
each category of advanced medical
imaging service supplier accredited.
(8) A description of the organization’s
data management and analysis system
for its surveys and accreditation
decisions, including the kinds of
reports, tables, and other displays
generated by that system.
(9) The organization’s procedures for
responding to and for the investigation
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
of complaints against accredited
facilities, including policies and
procedures regarding coordination of
these activities with appropriate
licensing bodies and CMS.
(10) The organization’s policies and
procedures for the withholding or
removal of accreditation status for
facilities that fail to meet the
accreditation organization’s standards or
requirements, and other actions taken
by the organization in response to
noncompliance with its standards and
requirements. These policies and
procedures must include notifying CMS
of facilities that fail to meet the
requirements of the accrediting
organization.
(11) A list of all currently accredited
suppliers, the type and category of
accreditation currently held by each
supplier, and the expiration date of each
supplier’s current accreditation.
(12) The accreditation organization
must also submit the following
supporting documentation:
(i) A written presentation that
demonstrates the organization’s ability
to furnish CMS with electronic data in
ASCII comparable code.
(ii) A resource analysis that
demonstrates that the organization’s
staffing, funding, and other resources
are adequate to perform the required
surveys and related activities.
(iii) A statement acknowledging that,
as a condition for approval of
designation, the organization agrees to
the following activities:
(A) Prioritize surveys for those
suppliers needing to be accredited by
January 1, 2012.
(B) In the case of a supplier that is
accredited before January 1, 2010, the
supplier must be considered accredited
as of January 1, 2012.
(C) Notify CMS, in writing, of any
supplier that had its accreditation
revoked, withdrawn, revised, or any
other remedial or adverse action taken
against it by the accreditation
organization within 30 calendar days of
any such action taken.
(D) Notify all accredited suppliers
within 10 calendar days of the
organization’s removal from the list of
designated accreditation organizations.
(E) Notify CMS, in writing, at least 30
calendar days in advance of the effective
date of any proposed changes in
accreditation requirements.
(F) Permit its surveyors to serve as
witnesses if CMS takes an adverse
action based on accreditation findings.
(G) Notify CMS, in writing,
(electronically or hard copy) within 2
calendar days of a deficiency identified
in any accreditation supplier where the
deficiency poses an immediate jeopardy
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
to the supplier’s beneficiaries or a
hazard to the general public.
(H) Provide, on an annual basis,
summary data specified by CMS that
relates to the past years’ accreditations
and trends.
(I) Attest that the organization will not
perform any accreditation surveys of
Medicare participating suppliers with
which it has a financial relationship
with or interest in.
(J) Conform accreditation
requirements to changes in Medicare
requirements.
(iv) If CMS determines that additional
information is necessary to make a
determination for approval or denial of
the accreditation organization’s
application for designation, the
organization is notified and afforded an
opportunity to provide the additional
information.
(v) CMS may visit the organization’s
offices to verify representations made by
the organization in its application,
including, but not limited to, review of
documents and interviews with the
organization’s staff.
(vi) The accreditation organization
will receive a formal notice from CMS
stating whether the request for
designation has been approved or
denied. If approval was denied the
notice includes the basis for denial and
reconsideration and reapplication
procedures.
(d) Ongoing responsibilities of a CMSapproved accreditation organization.
An accreditation organization approved
by CMS must undertake the following
activities on an ongoing basis:
(1) Provide to CMS all of the
following in written format (either
electronic or hard copy):
(i) Copies of all accreditation surveys,
together with any survey-related
information that CMS may require
(including corrective action plans and
summaries of findings with respect to
unmet CMS requirements).
(ii) Notice of all accreditation
decisions.
(iii) Notice of all complaints related to
suppliers.
(iv) Information about any supplier
furnishing the TC of advanced
diagnostic imaging service against
which the CMS approved accreditation
organization has taken remedial or
adverse action, including revocation,
withdrawal, or revision of the supplier’s
accreditation.
(v) Notice of any proposed changes in
its accreditation standards or
requirements or survey process. If the
organization implements the changes
before or without CMS’ approval, CMS
may withdraw its approval of the
accreditation organization.
PO 00000
Frm 00161
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33679
(2) Within 30 calendar days of a
change in CMS requirements, an
acknowledgment of CMS’ notification of
the change must be submitted to CMS.
(3) Permit its surveyors to serve as
witnesses if CMS takes an adverse
action based on accreditation findings.
(4) Within 2 calendar days of
identifying a deficiency of an accredited
supplier that poses immediate jeopardy
to a beneficiary or to the general public,
provide CMS with written notice of the
deficiency and any adverse action
implemented by the accreditation
organization.
(5) Within 10 calendar days after
CMS’ notice to a CMS approved
accreditation organization that CMS
intends to withdraw approval of the
accreditation organization, provide
written notice of the withdrawal to all
the CMS approved accreditation
organization’s accredited suppliers.
(6) Provide, on an annual basis,
summary data specified by CMS that
relate to the past year’s accreditation
activities and trends.
(d) Continuing Federal oversight of
approved accreditation organizations.
This paragraph establishes specific
criteria and procedures for continuing
oversight and for withdrawing approval
of a CMS approved accreditation
organization.
(1) Validation audits. CMS or its
contractor may conduct an audit of an
accredited supplier to validate the
survey accreditation process of
approved accreditation organizations in
the TC of advanced diagnostic imaging
services. The audits must be conducted
on a representative sample of suppliers
who have been accredited by a
particular accrediting organization or in
response to allegations of supplier
noncompliance with the standards.
When conducted on a representative
sample basis, we are proposing that the
audit would be comprehensive and
address all of the standards or would
focus on a specific standard in issue.
When conducted in response to an
allegation, we would specify that the
CMS team or our contractor would audit
for any standard that we determined
was related to the allegations. At the
conclusion of this audit, if CMS
identifies any accreditation programs for
which validation audit results
indicate—
(i) A 10 percent rate of disparity
between findings by the accreditation
organization and findings by CMS or its
designated survey team on standards
that do not constitute immediate
jeopardy to patient health and safety if
unmet.
(ii) Any disparity between findings by
the accreditation organization and
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33680
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
findings by CMS on standards that
constitute immediate jeopardy to patient
health and safety if unmet.
(iii) That, irrespective of the rate of
disparity, there are widespread or
systemic problems in an organization’s
accreditation process such that
accreditation by that accreditation
organization no longer provides CMS
with adequate assurance that suppliers
meet or exceed the Medicare
requirements.
(2) Notice of intent to withdraw
approval. CMS provides the
organization written notice of its intent
to withdraw approval if an equivalency
review, validation review, onsite
observation, or CMS’ daily experience
with the accreditation organization
suggests that the accreditation
organization is not meeting the
requirements of this section.
(3) Withdrawal of approval. CMS may
withdraw its approval of an
accreditation organization at any time if
CMS determines that—
(i) Accreditation by the organization
no longer adequately assures that the
suppliers furnishing the technical
component of advanced diagnostic
imaging service are meeting the
established industry standards for each
modality and that failure to meet those
requirements could jeopardize the
health or safety of Medicare
beneficiaries and could constitute a
significant hazard to the public health;
or
(ii) The accreditation organization has
failed to meet its obligations with
respect to application or reapplication
procedures.
(f) Reconsideration. An accreditation
organization dissatisfied with a
determination that its accreditation
requirements do not provide or do not
continue to provide reasonable
assurance that the suppliers accredited
by the accreditation organization meet
the applicable quality standards is
entitled to a reconsideration. CMS
reconsiders any determination to deny,
remove, or not renew the approval of
designation to accreditation
organizations if the accreditation
organization files a written request for
reconsideration by its authorized
officials or through its legal
representative.
(1) Filing requirements.
(i) The request must be filed within 30
calendar days of the receipt of CMS
notice of an adverse determination or
non renewal.
(ii) The request for reconsideration
must specify the findings or issues with
which the accreditation organization
disagrees and the reasons for the
disagreement.
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
(iii) A requestor may withdraw its
request for reconsideration at any time
before the issuance of a reconsideration
determination.
(2) CMS response to a filing request.
In response to a request for
reconsideration, CMS provides the
accreditation organization with—
(i) The opportunity for an informal
hearing to be conducted by a hearing
officer appointed by the Administrator
of CMS and provide the accreditation
organization the opportunity to present,
in writing and in person, evidence or
documentation to refute the
determination to deny approval, or to
withdraw or not renew designation; and
(ii) Written notice of the time and
place of the informal hearing at least 10
business days before the scheduled date.
(3) Hearing requirements and rules.
(i) The informal reconsideration
hearing is open to all of the following:
(A) CMS.
(B) The organization requesting the
reconsideration including—
(1) Authorized representatives;
(2) Technical advisors (individuals
with knowledge of the facts of the case
or presenting interpretation of the facts);
and
(3) Legal counsel.
(ii) The hearing is conducted by the
hearing officer who receives testimony
and documents related to the proposed
action.
(iii) Testimony and other evidence
may be accepted by the hearing officer
even though it is inadmissible under the
rules of court procedures.
(iv) The hearing officer does not have
the authority to compel by subpoena the
production of witnesses, papers, or
other evidence.
(v) Within 45 calendar days of the
close of the hearing, the hearing officer
presents the findings and
recommendations to the accreditation
organization that requested the
reconsideration.
(vi) The written report of the hearing
officer includes separate numbered
findings of fact and the legal
conclusions of the hearing officer.
(vii) The hearing officer’s decision is
final.
Subpart F—Competitive Bidding for
Certain Durable Medical Equipment,
Prosthetics, Orthotics, and Supplies
(DMEPOS)
16. Section 414.402 is amended by
revising the definition ‘‘Grandfathered
item’’ to read as follows:
§ 414.402
Definitions.
*
*
*
*
*
Grandfathered Item means all rented
items within a product category for
PO 00000
Frm 00162
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
which payment was made prior to the
implementation of a competitive
bidding program to a grandfathered
supplier that chooses to continue to
furnish the items in accordance with
§ 414.408(j) of this subpart and that fall
within the following payment categories
for competitive bidding:
(1) An inexpensive or routinely
purchased item described in § 414.220
of this part.
(2) An item requiring frequent and
substantial servicing, as described in
§ 414.222 of this part.
(3) Oxygen and oxygen equipment
described in § 414.226 of this part.
(4) Other DME described in § 414.229
of this part.
*
*
*
*
*
17. Section 414.408 is amended by—
(A) Redesignating paragraph (j)(5) as
(j)(7).
(B) Adding a new paragraphs (j)(5)
and (j)(6).
§ 414.408
Payment rules.
*
*
*
*
*
(j) * * *
(5) Notification of beneficiaries and
CMS by suppliers that choose to become
grandfathered suppliers.
(i) Notification of beneficiaries by
suppliers.
(A) Requirements of notification. A
noncontract supplier that elects to
become a grandfathered supplier must
provide a 30-day written notification to
each Medicare beneficiary that resides
in a competitive bidding area and is
currently renting a competitively bid
item from that supplier. The 30-day
notification to the beneficiary must meet
the following requirements:
(1) Be sent by the supplier to the
beneficiary at least 30 business days
before the start date of the
implementation of the competitive
bidding program for the CBA in which
the beneficiary resides.
(2) Identify the grandfathered items
that the supplier is willing to continue
to rent to the beneficiary.
(3) Be in writing (for example, by
letter or postcard) and the supplier must
maintain proof of delivery.
(4) State that the supplier is willing to
continue to furnish certain rented
Durable Medical Equipment (DME),
oxygen and oxygen equipment, and
supplies that the supplier is currently
furnishing to the beneficiary (that is,
before the start of the competitive
bidding program) and is willing to
continue to provide these items to the
beneficiary for the remaining rental
months.
(5) State that the beneficiary has the
choice to continue to receive a
grandfathered item(s) from the
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
grandfathered supplier or may elect to
receive the item(s) from a contract
supplier after the end of the last month
for which a rental payment is made to
the noncontract supplier.
(6) Provide the supplier’s telephone
number and instruct the beneficiary to
call the supplier with any questions and
to notify the supplier of his or her
decision to use or not use the supplier
as a grandfathered supplier.
(7) State that the beneficiary can
obtain information about the
competitive bidding program by calling
1–800–MEDICARE or accessing https://
www.medicare.gov on the Internet.
(B) Record of beneficiary’s choice. The
supplier should obtain an election from
the beneficiary regarding whether to use
or not use the supplier as a
grandfathered supplier. The supplier
must maintain a record of its attempts
to communicate with the beneficiary to
obtain the beneficiary’s election
regarding grandfathering. When the
suppier obtains such an election, the
supplier must maintain a record of the
beneficiary decision including the date
the choice was made, and how the
beneficiary communicated his or her
choice to the supplier.
(C) Notification. If the beneficiary
chooses not to continue to receive a
grandfathered item(s) from their current
supplier, the supplier must provide the
beneficiary with 2 more notices in
addition to the 30-day notice prior to
the supplier picking up its equipment.
(1) 10-day notification: Ten business
days prior to picking up the item, the
supplier should have direct contact (for
example, a phone call) with the
beneficiary or the beneficiary’s caregiver
and receive acknowledgement that the
beneficiary understands their
equipment will be picked up. This
should occur on the first anniversary
date after the start of the CBP or on
another date agreed to by the beneficiary
or the beneficiary’s caregiver. The
beneficiary’s anniversary date occurs
every month and is the date of the
month on which the item was first
delivered to the beneficiary by the
current supplier. When a date other
than the anniversary date is chosen by
the beneficiary or the beneficiary’s
caregiver, the noncontract supplier will
still receive payment up to the
anniversary date after the start of the
CBP, and the new contract supplier may
not bill for any period of time before the
anniversary date.
(2) 2-day notification: Two business
days prior to picking up the item the
supplier should contact the beneficiary
of the beneficiary’s caregiver by phone
to notify the beneficiary of the date the
supplier will pick up the item. This date
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
should not be before the beneficiary’s
first anniversary date that occurs after
the start of the competitive bidding
program unless an alternative
arrangement has been made with the
beneficiary and the new contract
supplier.
(D) Pickup procedures.
(1) The pickup of the noncontract
supplier’s equipment and the delivery
of the new contract supplier’s
equipment should occur on the same
date, that is, the first rental anniversary
date of the equipment that occurs after
the start of the competitive bidding
program unless an alternative
arrangement has been made with the
beneficiary and the new contract
supplier.
(2) Under no circumstance should a
supplier pick up a rented item prior to
the supplier’s receiving
acknowledgement from the beneficiary
that the beneficiary is aware of the date
on which the supplier is picking up the
item and the beneficiary has made
arrangements to have the item replaced
on that date by a contract supplier.
(3) When a beneficiary chooses to
switch to a new contract supplier, the
current noncontract supplier and the
new contract supplier must make
arrangements that are suitable to the
beneficiary.
(4) The contract supplier may not
submit a claim with a date of delivery
for the new equipment that is prior to
the first anniversary date that occurs
after the beginning of the CBP, and the
contract supplier may not begin billing
until the first anniversary date that
occurs after the beginning of the CBP.
(5) The noncontract supplier must
submit a claim to be paid up to the first
anniversary date that occurs after the
beginning of the CBP. Therefore, they
should not pick up the equipment
before that date unless an alternative
arrangement has been made with the
beneficiary and the new contract
supplier.
(ii) Notification to CMS by suppliers.
A noncontract supplier that elects to
become a grandfathered supplier must
provide a written notification to CMS of
this decision. This notification must
meet the following requirements:
(A) State that the supplier agrees to
continue to furnish certain rented DME,
oxygen and oxygen equipment that it is
currently furnishing to beneficiaries
(that is, before the start of the
competitive bidding program) in a CBA
and will continue to provide these items
to these beneficiaries for the remaining
months of the rental period.
(B) Include the following information:
(1) Name and address of the supplier.
PO 00000
Frm 00163
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33681
(2) The 6-digit NSC number of the
supplier.
(3) Product category(s) by CBA for
which the supplier is willing to be a
grandfathered supplier.
(C) State that the supplier agrees to
meet all the terms and conditions
pertaining to grandfathered suppliers.
(D) Be provided by the supplier to
CMS in writing at least 30 business days
before the start date of the
implementation of the Medicare
DMEPOS Competitive Bidding Program.
(6) Suppliers that choose not to
become grandfathered suppliers.
(i) Requirement for non-grandfathered
supplier. A noncontract supplier that
elects not to become a grandfathered
supplier is required to pick up the item
it is currently renting to the beneficiary
from the beneficiary’s home after proper
notification.
(ii) Notification. Proper notification
includes a 30-day, a 10-day, and a 2-day
notice of the supplier’s decision not to
become a grandfathered supplier to its
Medicare beneficiaries who are
currently renting certain DME
competitively bid item(s) and who
reside in a CBA.
(iii) Requirements of notification.
These notifications must meet all of the
requirements listed in paragraph (j)(5)(i)
of this section for the 30-day, 10-day
and 2-day notices that must be sent by
suppliers who decide to be
grandfathered suppliers, with the
following exceptions for the 30-day
notice.
(A) State that, for those items for
which the supplier has decided not to
be a grandfathered supplier, the
supplier will only continue to rent these
competitively bid item(s) to its
beneficiaries up to the first anniversary
date that occurs after the start of the
Medicare DMEPOS Competitive Bidding
Program.
(B) State that the beneficiary must
select a contract supplier for Medicare
to continue to pay for these items.
(C) Refer the beneficiary to the
contract supplier locator tool on
https://www.medicare.gov and to 1–800–
MEDICARE to obtain information about
the availability of contract suppliers for
the beneficiary’s area.
(iv) Pickup procedures.
(A) The pick-up of the noncontract
supplier’s equipment and the delivery
of the new contract supplier’s
equipment should occur on the same
date, that is, the first rental anniversary
date of the equipment that occurs after
the start of the competitive bidding
program unless an alternative
arrangement has been made with the
beneficiary and the new contract
supplier.
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33682
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
(B) Under no circumstance should a
supplier pick up a rented item prior to
the supplier’s receiving
acknowledgement from the beneficiary
that the beneficiary is aware of the date
on which the supplier is picking up the
item and the beneficiary has made
arrangements to have the item replaced
on that date by a contract supplier.
(C) When a beneficiary chooses to
switch to a new contract supplier, the
current noncontract supplier and the
new contract supplier must make
arrangements that are agreeable to the
beneficiary.
(D) The contract supplier cannot
submit a claim with a date of delivery
for the new equipment that is prior to
the first anniversary date that occurs
after the beginning of the CBP.
*
*
*
*
*
18. Section 414.425 is added to read
as follows:
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
§ 414.425
Claims for damages.
(a) Eligibility for filing a claim for
damages as a result of the termination
of supplier contracts by the Medicare
Improvements for Patients and
Providers Act of 2008 (MIPPA). (1) Any
aggrieved supplier, including a member
of a network that was awarded a
contract for the Round 1 Durable
Medical Prosthetics, Orthotics, and
Supplies Competitive Bidding Program
(DMEPOS CBP) that believes it has been
damaged by the termination of its
competitive bid contract, may file a
claim under this section.
(2) A subcontractor of a contract
supplier is not eligible to submit a claim
under this section.
(b) Timeframe for filing a claim. (1) A
completed claim, including all
documentation, must be filed within 90
days of the effective date of this
paragraph, unless that day is a Federal
holiday or Sunday in which case it will
fall to the next business day.
(2) The date of filing is the actual date
of receipt by the CBIC of a completed
claim that includes all the information
required by this rule.
(c) Information that must be included
in a claim. (1) Supplier’s name, name of
authorized official, U.S. Post Office
mailing address, phone number, e-mail
address and bidding number, and
National Supplier Clearinghouse
Number;
(2) A copy of the signed contract
entered into with CMS for the Round 1
DMEPOS Competitive Bidding Program;
(3) A detailed explanation of the
damages incurred by this supplier as a
direct result of the termination of the
Round 1 competitive bid contract by
MIPPA. The explanation must include
all of the following:
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
(i) Documentation of the supplier’s
damages through receipts.
(ii) Records that substantiate the
supplier’s damages and demonstrate
that the damages are directly related to
performance of the Round 1 contract
and are consistent with information the
supplier provided as part of their bid.
(4) The supplier must explain how it
would be damaged if not reimbursed.
(5) The claim must document steps
the supplier took to mitigate any
damages they may have incurred due to
the contract termination, including a
detailed explanation of the steps of all
attempts to use for other purposes,
return or dispose of equipment or other
assets purchased or rented for the use in
the Round 1 DMEPOS CBP contract
performance.
(d) Items that will not be considered
in a claim. The following items will not
be considered in a claim:
(1) The cost of submitting a bid.
(2) Any fees or costs incurred for
consulting or marketing.
(3) Costs associated with accreditation
or licensure.
(4) Costs incurred before March 20,
2008.
(5) Costs incurred for contract
performance after July 14, 2008 except
for costs incurred to mitigate damages.
(6) Any profits a supplier may have
expected from the contract.
(7) Costs that would have occurred
without a contract having been
awarded.
(8) Costs for items such as inventory,
delivery vehicles, office space and
equipment, personnel, which the
supplier did not purchase specifically to
perform the contract.
(9) Costs that the supplier has
recouped by any means, and may
include use of personnel, material,
suppliers, or equipment in the
supplier’s business operations.
(e) Filing a claim. (1) A claim, with all
supporting documentation, must be
filed with the CMS Competitive Bidding
Implementation Contractor (CBIC).
(2) Claims must include a statement
from a supplier’s authorized official
certifying the accuracy of the
information provided on the claim and
all supporting documentation.
(3) The CBIC does not accept
electronic submissions of claims for
damages.
(f) Review of claim. (1) Role of the
CBIC.
(i) The CBIC will review the claim to
ensure it is submitted timely, complete,
and by an eligible claimant. When the
CBIC identifies that a claim is
incomplete or not filed timely, it will
make a recommendation to the
Determining Authority not to process
PO 00000
Frm 00164
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
the claim further. Incomplete or
untimely claims may be dismissed by
the Determining Authority without
further processing.
(ii) For complete, timely claims, the
CBIC will review the claim on its merits
to determine if damages are warranted
and may seek further information from
the claimant when making its
recommendation to the Determining
Authority. The CBIC may set a deadline
for receipt of additional information. A
claimant’s failure to respond timely may
result in a denial of the claim.
(iii) The CBIC will make a
recommendation to the Determining
Authority for each claim filed and
include an explanation that supports its
recommendation.
(iv) The recommendation must be
either to award damages for a particular
amount (which may not be the same
amount requested by the claimant) or
that no damages should be awarded.
(A) If the CBIC recommends that
damages are warranted, the CBIC will
calculate a recommended reasonable
amount of damages based on the claim
submitted.
(B) The reasonable amount will
consider both costs incurred and the
contractor’s attempts and action to limit
the damages;
(v) The recommendation will be sent
to the Determining Authority for a final
determination.
(2) CMS’ role as the Determining
Authority.
(i) The Determining Authority shall
review the recommendation of the CBIC.
(ii) The Determining Authority may
seek further information from the
claimant or the CBIC in making a
concurrence or non-concurrence
determination.
(iii) The Determining Authority may
set a deadline for receipt of additional
information. A claimant’s failure to
respond timely may result in a denial of
the claim.
(iv) If the Determining Authority
concurs with the CBIC recommendation,
the Determining Authority shall submit
a final signed decision to the CBIC and
direct the CBIC to notify the claimant of
the decision and the reasons for the
final decision.
(v) If the Determining Authority nonconcurs with the CBIC recommendation,
the Determining Authority may return
the claim for further processing or the
Determining Authority may:
(A) Write a determination granting (in
whole or in part) a claim for damages or
denying a claim in its entirety;
(B) Direct the CBIC to write said
determination for the Determining
Authority’s signature; or
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
(C) Return the claim to the CBIC with
further instructions.
(vi) The Determining Authority’s
determination is final and not subject to
administrative or judicial review.
(g) Timeframe for determinations. (1)
Every effort will be made to make a
determination within 120 days of initial
receipt of the claim for damages by the
CBIC or the receipt of additional
information that was requested by the
CBIC, whichever is later.
(2) In the case of more complex cases,
or in the event of a large workload, a
decision will be issued as soon as
practicable.
(h) Notification to claimant of damage
determination. The CBIC must mail the
Determining Authority’s determination
to the claimant by certified mail return
receipt requested, at the address
provided in the claim.
Subpart H—Fee Schedule for
Ambulance Services
19. Section 414.610 is amended by
revising paragraph (c)(5)(i) to read as
follows:
§ 414.610
Basis of payment.
*
*
*
*
*
(c) * * *
(5) * * *
(i) For ground ambulance services
where the point of pickup is in a rural
area, the mileage rate is increased by 50
percent for each of the first 17 miles
and, for services furnished before
January 1, 2004, by 25 percent for miles
18 through 50. The standard mileage
rate applies to every mile over 50 miles
and, for services furnished after
December 31, 2003, to every mile over
17 miles. For air ambulance services
where the point of pickup is in a rural
area, the total payment is increased by
50 percent; that is, the rural adjustment
factor applies to the sum of the base rate
and the mileage rate.
*
*
*
*
*
Subpart J—Submission of
Manufacturer’s Average Sales Price
Data
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
20. Section 414.802 is amended by
revising the definition of ‘‘unit’’ to read
as follows:
§ 414.802
Definitions.
*
*
*
*
*
Unit means the product represented
by the 11-digit National Drug Code. The
method of counting units excludes units
of CAP drugs (as defined in § 414.902)
sold to an approved CAP vendor (as
defined in § 414.902) for use under the
CAP (as defined in § 414.902).
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
Subpart K—Payment for Drugs and
Biologicals Under Part B
§ 414.904
[Amended]
21. Amend § 414.904(d)(3) by
removing the phrase ‘‘and 2009’’ and
adding in its place the phrase ‘‘2009,
and 2010.’’
22. Section 414.906 is amended by—
B. Revising the introductory text of
paragraph (c) and paragraph (c)(1).
C. Redesignating paragraph (c)(2) as
(c)(3).
D. Adding new paragraph (c)(2).
E. Adding paragraphs (f)(2)(v),
(f)(3)(iv), and (g).
The revision and additions read as
follows:
§ 414.906 Competitive acquisition program
as the basis for payment.
*
*
*
*
*
(c) Computation of payment amount.
Except as specified in paragraph (c)(2)
of this section, payment for CAP drugs
is based on bids submitted as a result of
the bidding process as described in
§ 414.910.
(1) Single payment amount.
(i) A single payment amount for each
CAP drug in the competitive acquisition
area is determined on the basis of the
bids submitted and accepted and
updated from the bidding period to the
beginning of the payment year.
(ii) The single payment amount is
then updated quarterly based on the
approved CAP vendor’s reasonable net
acquisition costs for that category as
determined by CMS, and limited by the
weighted payment amount established
under section 1847A of the Act across
all drugs for which a composite bid is
required in the category.
(iii) The payment amount for each
other drug for which the approved CAP
vendor submits a bid in accordance
with § 414.910 of this subpart and each
other drug that is approved by CMS for
the approved CPA vendor to furnish
under the CAP is also updated quarterly
based on the approved CAP vendor’s
reasonable net acquisition costs for each
HCPCS code and limited by the
payment amount established under
section 1847A of the Act.
(2) Updates to payment amount.
(i) The first update is effective on the
first day of claims processing for the
first quarter of an approved CAP
vendor’s contract. The first quarterly
contract update is based on the
reasonable net acquisition cost (RNAC)
data reported to CMS or its designee for
any purchases of drug before the
beginning of CAP claims processing for
the contract period and reported to CMS
no later than 30 days before the
beginning of CAP claims processing.
PO 00000
Frm 00165
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33683
(ii) For subsequent quarters, each
approved CAP vendor must report to
CMS or its designee RNAC data for a
quarter of CAP drug purchases within
30 days of the close of that quarter.
(iii) For all quarters, only RNAC data
from approved CAP vendors that are
supplying CAP drugs under their CAP
contract at the time updates are being
calculated must be used to calculate
updated CAP payment amounts.
(iv) CMS excludes such RNAC data
submitted by an approved CAP vendor
if, during the time calculations are being
done, CMS knows that the approved
CAP vendor will not be under contract
for the applicable quarterly update.
(v) The payment amount weights
must be calculated based on the more
recent of the following:
(A) Contract bidding weights.
(B) CAP claims data.
(vi) The payment limit must be
determined using the most recent
payment limits available to CMS under
section 1847A of the Act.
(vii) The following payment amount
update calculation must be applied for
the group of all drugs for which a
composite bid is required.
(A) The most recent previous
composite payment amount for the
group is updated by—
(1) Calculating the percent change in
reasonable net acquisition costs for each
approved CAP vendor;
(2) Calculating the median of all
participating approved CAP vendors’
adjusted CAP payment amounts; and
(3) Limiting the payment as described
in paragraph (c)(1) of this section.
(B) The median percent change,
subject to the limit described in
paragraph (c)(1) of this section, must be
the update percentage for that quarter.
(C) The single update percentage must
be applied to the payment amount for
each drug in the group of drugs for
which a composite bid is required in the
category.
(viii) The following payment amount
update calculation must be applied for
each of the following items: each
HCPCS code not included in the
composite bid list; each HCPCS code
added to the drug list during the
contract period; and each drug that has
not yet been assigned a HCPCS code,
but for which a HCPCS code will be
established.
(A) The most recent previous payment
amount for each drug must be updated
by calculating the percent change in
reasonable net acquisition costs for each
approved CAP vendor, then calculating
the median of all participating approved
CAP vendors’ adjusted CAP payment
amounts.
(B) The median percent change
calculated for each drug, subject to the
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33684
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
limit described in paragraph (c)(1) of
this section, must be applied to the
payment amount for each drug.
*
*
*
*
*
(f) * * *
(2) * * *
(v) On or after January 1, 2010, the
proposed addition of drugs with similar
therapeutic uses to drugs already
supplied under the CAP by the
approved CAP vendor(s).
(3) * * *
(iv) In the case of additions requested
under paragraph (f)(2)(v) of this section,
address and document the need for such
an expansion based on demand for the
product(s).
*
*
*
*
*
(g) Deletion of drugs on an approved
CAP vendor’s CAP drug list due to
unavailability requires a written request
and approval as described in paragraphs
(f)(3)(i) through (iii) and (f)(4).
23. Section 414.908 is amended by
revising paragraph (a)(3)(xii) to read as
follows:
§ 414.908
program.
Competitive acquisition
(a) * * *
(3) * * *
(xii) Agrees not to transport CAP
drugs from one practice location or
place of service to another location
except in accordance with a written
agreement between the participating
CAP physician and the approved CAP
vendor that requires that drugs are not
subjected to conditions that will
jeopardize their integrity, stability, and/
or sterility while being transported.
*
*
*
*
*
24. Section 414.914 is amended by
revising paragraph (f)(12) to read as
follows:
§ 414.914
Terms of contract.
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
*
*
*
*
*
(f) * * *
(12) Supply CAP drugs upon receipt
of a prescription order to all
participating CAP physicians who have
selected the approved CAP vendor,
except when the conditions of
paragraph (h) of this section or
§ 414.916(b) are met;
*
*
*
*
*
25. Section 414.916 is amended by —
A. Redesignating paragraph (b)(4) as
(b)(5).
B. Adding new paragraph (b)(4).
The addition reads as follows:
§ 414.916 Dispute resolution for vendors
and beneficiaries.
*
*
*
*
*
(b) * * *
(4) Upon notification from CMS of a
participating CAP physician’s
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
suspension from the program, the
approved CAP vendor must cease
delivery of CAP drugs to the suspended
participating CAP physician until the
suspension has been lifted.
*
*
*
*
*
26. Section 414.917 is amended by
revising paragraph (b)(4) to read as
follows:
§ 414.917 Dispute resolution and process
for suspension or termination of approved
CAP contract and termination of physician
participation under exigent circumstances.
*
*
*
*
*
(b) * * *
(4) The approved CAP vendor may
appeal that termination by requesting a
reconsideration. A determination must
be made as to whether the approved
CAP vendor has been meeting the
service and quality obligations of its
CAP contract. The approved CAP
vendor’s contract will remain
suspended during the reconsideration
process.
*
*
*
*
*
27. Section 414.930 is amended by—
A. Revising paragraph (a).
B. Redesignating paragraphs (b)(1)(v)
as (vi).
C. Adding new paragraphs (b)(1)(v).
The revision and addition read as
follows:
§ 414.930 Compendia for determination of
medically-accepted indications for off-label
uses of drugs and biologicals in an anticancer chemotherapeutic regimen.
(a) Definitions. For the purposes of
this section:
Compendium means a comprehensive
listing of FDA-approved drugs and
biologicals or a comprehensive listing of
a specific subset of drugs and
biologicals in a specialty compendium,
for example a compendium of anticancer treatment. A compendium—
(i) Includes a summary of the
pharmacologic characteristics of each
drug or biological and may include
information on dosage, as well as
recommended or endorsed uses in
specific diseases.
(ii) Is indexed by drug or biological.
(iii) Has a publicly transparent
process for evaluating therapies and for
identifying potential conflicts of
interests.
Publicly transparent process for
evaluating therapies means that the
following materials are available to the
public on the compendium’s Web site
coincident with the compendium’s
publication of the related
recommendation:
(i) The application for inclusion of a
therapy including criteria used to
evaluate the request.
PO 00000
Frm 00166
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
(ii) A listing of all the evidentiary
materials reviewed or considered by the
compendium pursuant to the
application.
(iii) A listing of all individuals who
have substantively participated in the
development of compendia
recommendations.
(iv) Transcripts of meetings and
records of the votes, including
abstentions, related to the therapeutic
recommendation on the application.
Publicly transparent process for
identifying potential conflicts of
interests means that the following
materials are identified and available to
the public coincident with the
compendium’s publication of the
related recommendation:
(i) Direct or indirect financial
relationships that exist between
individuals who have substantively
participated in the development of
compendia recommendations and the
applicant (for example, the
manufacturer or seller of the drug or
biological being reviewed by the
compendium). This includes
compensation arrangements such as
salary, grant, contract, or collaboration
agreements between individuals who
have substantively participated in the
development of compendia
recommendations and the applicant.
(ii) Ownership or investment interests
of individuals who have substantively
participated in the development of
compendia recommendations and the
applicant (for example, the
manufacturer or seller of the drug or
biological being reviewed by the
compendium).
(b) * * *
(1) * * *
(v) Considers whether the publication
that is the subject of the request meets
the definition of a compendium in this
section.
*
*
*
*
*
PART 415—SERVICES FURNISHED BY
PHYSICIANS IN PROVIDERS,
SUPERVISING PHYSICIANS IN
TEACHING SETTINGS, AND
RESIDENTS IN CERTAIN SETTINGS
28. The authority citation for part 415
continues to read as follows:
Authority: Secs. 1102 and 1871 of the
Social Security Act (42 U.S.C. 1302 and
1395(hh)).
Subpart D—Physician Services in
Teaching Settings
29. Section 415.178 is revised to read
as follows:
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
§ 415.178
Anesthesia services.
(a) General rule. (1) For services
furnished prior to January 1, 2010, an
unreduced physician fee schedule
payment may be made if a physician is
involved in a single anesthesia
procedure involving an anesthesia
resident. In the case of anesthesia
services, the teaching physician must be
present during all critical portions of the
procedure and immediately available to
furnish services during the entire
service or procedure. The teaching
physician cannot receive an unreduced
fee if he or she performs services
involving other patients during the
period the anesthesia resident is
furnishing services in a single case.
Additional rules for payment of
anesthesia services involving residents
are specified in § 414.46(c)(1)(iii) of this
chapter.
(2) For services furnished on or after
January 1, 2010, payment may be made
under § 414.46(e) of this chapter if the
teaching anesthesiologist is present
during all critical or key portions of the
anesthesia service or procedure
involved; and the teaching
anesthesiologist (or another
anesthesiologist with whom the
teaching anesthesiologist has entered
into an arrangement) is immediately
available to furnish anesthesia services
during the entire procedure.
(b) Documentation. Documentation
must indicate the physician’s presence
during all critical or key portions of the
anesthesia procedure and the immediate
availability of another teaching
anesthesiologist.
PART 485—CONDITIONS OF
PARTICIPATION: SPECIALIZED
PROVIDERS
30. The authority citation for part 485
continues to read as follows:
Authority: Secs. 1102 and 1871 of the
Social Security Act (42 U.S.C. 1302 and
1395(hh)).
Subpart B—Conditions of
Participation: Comprehensive
Outpatient Rehabilitation Facilities
31. Section 485.70 is amended by
revising paragraph (j) to read as follows:
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
§ 485.70
Personnel qualifications.
*
*
*
*
*
(j) A respiratory therapist must
complete one the following criteria:
(1) Criterion 1. All of the following
must be completed:
(i) Be licensed by the State in which
practicing, if applicable.
(ii) Have successfully completed a
nationally-accredited educational
program for respiratory therapists.
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
(iii)(A) Be eligible to take the registry
examination administered by the
National Board for Respiratory Care for
respiratory therapists; or
(B) Have passed the registry
examination administered by the
National Board for Respiratory Care for
respiratory therapists.
(2) Criterion 2: All of the following
must be completed:
(i) Be licensed by the State in which
practicing, if applicable.
(ii) Have equivalent training and
experience as determined by the
National Board for Respiratory Care.
*
*
*
*
*
Authority: Catalog of Federal Domestic
Assistance Program No. 93.773, Medicare—
Hospital Insurance; and Program No. 93.774,
Medicare—Supplementary Medical
Insurance Program.
Dated: June 15, 2009.
Charlene Frizzera,
Acting Administrator, Centers for Medicare
& Medicaid Services.
Approved: June 30, 2009.
Kathleen Sebelius,
Secretary.
Note: These addenda will not appear in the
Code of Federal Regulations.
Addendum A: Explanation and Use of
Addenda B
The addenda on the following pages
provide various data pertaining to the
Medicare fee schedule for physicians’
services furnished in CY 2010. Addendum B
contains the RVUs for work, nonfacility PE,
facility PE, and malpractice expense, and
other information for all services included in
the PFS.
In previous years, we have listed many
services in Addendum B that are not paid
under the PFS. To avoid publishing as many
pages of codes for these services, we are not
including clinical laboratory codes or the
alphanumeric codes (Healthcare Common
Procedure Coding System (HCPCS) codes not
included in CPT) not paid under the PFS in
Addendum B.
Addendum B contains the following
information for each CPT code and
alphanumeric HCPCS code, except for:
Alphanumeric codes beginning with B
(enteral and parenteral therapy), E (durable
medical equipment), K (temporary codes for
nonphysicians’ services or items), or L
(orthotics); and codes for anesthesiology.
Please also note the following:
• An ‘‘NA’’ in the ‘‘Non-facility PE RVUs’’
column of Addendum B means that CMS has
not developed a PE RVU in the nonfacility
setting for the service because it is typically
performed in the hospital (for example, an
open heart surgery is generally performed in
the hospital setting and not a physician’s
office). If there is an ‘‘NA’’ in the nonfacility
PE RVU column, and the contractor
determines that this service can be performed
in the nonfacility setting, the service will be
paid at the facility PE RVU rate.
PO 00000
Frm 00167
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
33685
• Services that have an ‘‘NA’’ in the
‘‘Facility PE RVUs’’ column of Addendum B
are typically not paid using the PFS when
provided in a facility setting. These services
(which include ‘‘incident to’’ services and
the technical portion of diagnostic tests) are
generally paid under either the outpatient
hospital prospective payment system or
bundled into the hospital inpatient
prospective payment system payment.
1. CPT/HCPCS code. This is the CPT or
alphanumeric HCPCS number for the service.
Alphanumeric HCPCS codes are included at
the end of this addendum.
2. Modifier. A modifier is shown if there
is a technical component (modifier TC) and
a professional component (PC) (modifier-26)
for the service. If there is a PC and a TC for
the service, Addendum B contains three
entries for the code. A code for: The global
values (both professional and technical);
modifier-26 (PC); and, modifier TC. The
global service is not designated by a modifier,
and physicians must bill using the code
without a modifier if the physician furnishes
both the PC and the TC of the service.
Modifier-53 is shown for a discontinued
procedure, for example a colonoscopy that is
not completed. There will be RVUs for a code
with this modifier.
3. Status indicator. This indicator shows
whether the CPT/HCPCS code is in the PFS
and whether it is separately payable if the
service is covered.
A = Active code. These codes are
separately payable under the PFS if covered.
There will be RVUs for codes with this
status. The presence of an ‘‘A’’ indicator does
not mean that Medicare has made a national
coverage determination regarding the service.
Carriers remain responsible for coverage
decisions in the absence of a national
Medicare policy.
B = Bundled code. Payments for covered
services are always bundled into payment for
other services not specified. If RVUs are
shown, they are not used for Medicare
payment. If these services are covered,
payment for them is subsumed by the
payment for the services to which they are
incident (an example is a telephone call from
a hospital nurse regarding care of a patient).
C = Carriers price the code. Carriers will
establish RVUs and payment amounts for
these services, generally on an individual
case basis following review of
documentation, such as an operative report.
D* = Deleted/discontinued code.
E = Excluded from the PFS by regulation.
These codes are for items and services that
CMS chose to exclude from the fee schedule
payment by regulation. No RVUs are shown,
and no payment may be made under the PFS
for these codes. Payment for them, when
covered, continues under reasonable charge
procedures.
F = Deleted/discontinued codes. (Code not
subject to a 90-day grace period.) These codes
are deleted effective with the beginning of
the year and are never subject to a grace
period. This indicator is no longer effective
beginning with the 2005 fee schedule as of
January 1, 2005.
G = Code not valid for Medicare purposes.
Medicare uses another code for reporting of,
and payment for, these services. (Codes
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33686
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
subject to a 90-day grace period.) This
indicator is no longer effective with the 2005
PFS as of January 1, 2005.
H* = Deleted modifier. For 2000 and later
years, either the TC or PC component shown
for the code has been deleted and the deleted
component is shown in the database with the
H status indicator.
I = Not valid for Medicare purposes.
Medicare uses another code for the reporting
of, and the payment for these services. (Codes
not subject to a 90-day grace period.)
L = Local codes. Carriers will apply this
status to all local codes in effect on January
1, 1998 or subsequently approved by central
office for use. Carriers will complete the
RVUs and payment amounts for these codes.
M = Measurement codes, used for reporting
purposes only. There are no RVUs and no
payment amounts for these codes. Medicare
uses them to aid with performance
measurement. No separate payment is made.
These codes should be billed with a zero
(($0.00) charge and are denied) on the
MPFSDB.
N = Non-covered service. These codes are
non-covered services. Medicare payment may
not be made for these codes. If RVUs are
shown, they are not used for Medicare
payment.
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
R = Restricted coverage. Special coverage
instructions apply. If the service is covered
and no RVUs are shown, it is carrier-priced.
T = There are RVUs for these services, but
they are only paid if there are no other
services payable under the PFS billed on the
same date by the same provider. If any other
services payable under the PFS are billed on
the same date by the same provider, these
services are bundled into the service(s) for
which payment is made.
X = Statutory exclusion. These codes
represent an item or service that is not within
the statutory definition of ‘‘physicians’
services’’ for PFS payment purposes. No
RVUs are shown for these codes, and no
payment may be made under the PFS.
(Examples are ambulance services and
clinical diagnostic laboratory services.)
4. Description of code. This is an
abbreviated version of the narrative
description of the code.
5. Physician work RVUs. These are the
RVUs for the physician work for this service
in CY 2010.
6. Nonfacility practice expense RVUs.
These are the 2010 resource-based PE RVUs
for nonfacility settings.
7. Facility practice expense RVUs. These
are the 2010 resource-based PE RVUs for
facility settings.
PO 00000
Frm 00168
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
8. Malpractice expense RVUs. These are
the RVUs for the malpractice expense for the
service for 2010.
Note: The budget neutrality reduction
resulting from the chiropractic demonstration
is not reflected in the RVUs for CPT codes
98940, 98941 and 98942. The required
reduction will only be reflected in the files
used for Medicare payment.
9. Global period. This indicator shows the
number of days in the global period for the
code (0, 10, or 90 days). An explanation of
the alpha codes follows:
MMM = Code describes a service furnished
in uncomplicated maternity cases including
antepartum care, delivery, and postpartum
care. The usual global surgical concept does
not apply. See the 1999 Physicians’ Current
Procedural Terminology for specific
definitions.
XXX = The global concept does not apply.
YYY = The global period is to be set by the
carrier (for example, unlisted surgery codes).
ZZZ = Code related to another service that
is always included in the global period of the
other service. (Note: Physician work and PE
are associated with intra service time and in
some instances in the post service time.
*Codes with these indicators had a 90-day
grace period before January 1, 2005.
BILLING CODE 4210–01–P
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00169
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33687
EP13JY09.000
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00170
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.001
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33688
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00171
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33689
EP13JY09.002
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00172
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.003
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33690
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00173
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33691
EP13JY09.004
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00174
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.005
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33692
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00175
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33693
EP13JY09.006
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00176
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.007
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33694
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00177
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33695
EP13JY09.008
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00178
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.009
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33696
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00179
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33697
EP13JY09.010
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00180
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.011
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33698
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00181
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33699
EP13JY09.012
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00182
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.013
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33700
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00183
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33701
EP13JY09.014
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00184
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.015
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33702
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00185
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33703
EP13JY09.016
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00186
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.017
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33704
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00187
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33705
EP13JY09.018
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00188
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.019
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33706
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00189
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33707
EP13JY09.020
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00190
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.021
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33708
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00191
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33709
EP13JY09.022
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00192
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.023
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33710
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00193
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33711
EP13JY09.024
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00194
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.025
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33712
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00195
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33713
EP13JY09.026
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00196
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.027
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33714
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00197
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33715
EP13JY09.028
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00198
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.029
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33716
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00199
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33717
EP13JY09.030
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00200
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.031
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33718
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00201
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33719
EP13JY09.032
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00202
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.033
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33720
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00203
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33721
EP13JY09.034
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00204
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.035
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33722
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00205
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33723
EP13JY09.036
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00206
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.037
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33724
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00207
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33725
EP13JY09.038
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00208
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.039
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33726
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00209
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33727
EP13JY09.040
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00210
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.041
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33728
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00211
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33729
EP13JY09.042
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00212
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.043
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33730
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00213
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33731
EP13JY09.044
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00214
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.045
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33732
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00215
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33733
EP13JY09.046
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00216
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.047
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33734
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00217
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33735
EP13JY09.048
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00218
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.049
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33736
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00219
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33737
EP13JY09.050
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00220
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.051
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33738
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00221
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33739
EP13JY09.052
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00222
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.053
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33740
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00223
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33741
EP13JY09.054
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00224
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.055
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33742
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00225
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33743
EP13JY09.056
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00226
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.057
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33744
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00227
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33745
EP13JY09.058
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00228
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.059
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33746
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00229
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33747
EP13JY09.060
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00230
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.061
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33748
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00231
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33749
EP13JY09.062
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00232
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.063
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33750
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00233
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33751
EP13JY09.064
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00234
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.065
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33752
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00235
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33753
EP13JY09.066
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00236
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.067
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33754
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00237
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33755
EP13JY09.068
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00238
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.069
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33756
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00239
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33757
EP13JY09.070
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00240
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.071
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33758
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00241
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33759
EP13JY09.072
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00242
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.073
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33760
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00243
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33761
EP13JY09.074
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00244
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.075
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33762
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00245
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33763
EP13JY09.076
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00246
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.077
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33764
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00247
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33765
EP13JY09.078
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00248
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.079
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33766
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00249
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33767
EP13JY09.080
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00250
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.081
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33768
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00251
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33769
EP13JY09.082
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00252
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.083
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33770
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00253
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33771
EP13JY09.084
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00254
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.085
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33772
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00255
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33773
EP13JY09.086
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00256
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.087
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33774
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00257
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33775
EP13JY09.088
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00258
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.089
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33776
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00259
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33777
EP13JY09.090
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00260
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.091
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33778
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00261
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33779
EP13JY09.092
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00262
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.093
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33780
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00263
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33781
EP13JY09.094
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00264
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.095
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33782
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00265
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33783
EP13JY09.096
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00266
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.097
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33784
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00267
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33785
EP13JY09.098
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00268
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.099
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33786
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00269
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33787
EP13JY09.100
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00270
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.101
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33788
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00271
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33789
EP13JY09.102
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00272
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.103
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33790
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00273
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33791
EP13JY09.104
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00274
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.105
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33792
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00275
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33793
EP13JY09.106
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00276
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.107
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33794
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00277
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33795
EP13JY09.108
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00278
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.109
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33796
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00279
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33797
EP13JY09.110
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00280
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.111
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33798
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00281
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33799
EP13JY09.112
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00282
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.113
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33800
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00283
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33801
EP13JY09.114
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00284
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.115
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33802
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00285
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33803
EP13JY09.116
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00286
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.117
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33804
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00287
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33805
EP13JY09.118
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00288
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.119
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33806
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00289
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33807
EP13JY09.120
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00290
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.121
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33808
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00291
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33809
EP13JY09.122
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00292
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.123
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33810
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00293
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33811
EP13JY09.124
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00294
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.125
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33812
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00295
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33813
EP13JY09.126
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00296
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.127
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33814
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00297
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33815
EP13JY09.128
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00298
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.129
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33816
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00299
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33817
EP13JY09.130
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00300
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.131
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33818
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00301
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33819
EP13JY09.132
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00302
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.133
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33820
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00303
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33821
EP13JY09.134
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00304
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.135
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33822
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00305
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
33823
EP13JY09.136
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
VerDate Nov<24>2008
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00306
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4725
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.137
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
33824
33825
[FR Doc. E9–15835 Filed 7–1–09; 11:15 am]
BILLING CODE 4120–01–C
VerDate Nov<24>2008
18:43 Jul 10, 2009
Jkt 217001
PO 00000
Frm 00307
Fmt 4701
Sfmt 4702
E:\FR\FM\13JYP2.SGM
13JYP2
EP13JY09.138
mstockstill on DSKH9S0YB1PROD with PROPOSALS2
Federal Register / Vol. 74, No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 / Proposed Rules
Agencies
[Federal Register Volume 74, Number 132 (Monday, July 13, 2009)]
[Proposed Rules]
[Pages 33520-33825]
From the Federal Register Online via the Government Printing Office [www.gpo.gov]
[FR Doc No: E9-15835]
[[Page 33519]]
-----------------------------------------------------------------------
Part II
Department of Health and Human Services
-----------------------------------------------------------------------
Centers for Medicare & Medicaid Services
-----------------------------------------------------------------------
42 CFR Parts 410, 411, 414, et al.
Medicare Program; Payment Policies Under the Physician Fee Schedule and
Other Revisions to Part B for CY 2010; Proposed Rule
Federal Register / Vol. 74 , No. 132 / Monday, July 13, 2009 /
Proposed Rules
[[Page 33520]]
-----------------------------------------------------------------------
DEPARTMENT OF HEALTH AND HUMAN SERVICES
Centers for Medicare & Medicaid Services
42 CFR Parts 410, 411, 414, 415, and 485
[CMS-1413-P]
RIN 0938-AP40
Medicare Program; Payment Policies Under the Physician Fee
Schedule and Other Revisions to Part B for CY 2010
AGENCY: Centers for Medicare & Medicaid Services (CMS), HHS.
ACTION: Proposed rule.
-----------------------------------------------------------------------
SUMMARY: This proposed rule would address proposed changes to Medicare
Part B payment policy. We are proposing these changes to ensure that
our payment systems are updated to reflect changes in medical practice
and the relative value of services. This proposed rule discusses:
Refinements to resource-based work, practice expense and malpractice
relative value units (RVUs); geographic practice cost indices (GPCIs);
telehealth services; several coding issues; physician fee schedule
update for CY 2010; payment for covered part B outpatient drugs and
biologicals; the competitive acquisition program (CAP); payment for
renal dialysis services; the chiropractic services demonstration;
comprehensive outpatient rehabilitation facilities; physician self-
referral; the ambulance fee schedule; the clinical laboratory fee
schedule; durable medical equipment, prosthetics, orthotics, and
supplies (DMEPOS); and certain provisions of the Medicare Improvements
for Patients and Providers Act of 2008. (See the Table of contents for
a listing of the specific issues.)
DATES: To be assured consideration, comments must be received at one of
the addresses provided below, no later than 5 p.m. on Monday, August
31, 2009.
ADDRESSES: In commenting, please refer to file code CMS-1413-P. Because
of staff and resource limitations, we cannot accept comments by
facsimile (FAX) transmission.
You may submit comments in one of four ways (please choose only one
of the ways listed):
1. Electronically. You may submit electronic comments on this
regulation to https://www.regulations.gov. Follow the instructions under
the ``More Search Options'' tab.
2. By regular mail. You may mail written comments to the following
address ONLY: Centers for Medicare & Medicaid Services, Department of
Health and Human Services, Attention: CMS-1413-P, P.O. Box 8013,
Baltimore, MD 21244-8013.
Please allow sufficient time for mailed comments to be received
before the close of the comment period.
3. By express or overnight mail. You may send written comments to
the following address only: Centers for Medicare & Medicaid Services,
Department of Health and Human Services, Attention: CMS-1413-P, Mail
Stop C4-26-05, 7500 Security Boulevard, Baltimore, MD 21244-1850.
4. By hand or courier. If you prefer, you may deliver (by hand or
courier) your written comments before the close of the comment period
to either of the following addresses:
a. For delivery in Washington, DC--Centers for Medicare & Medicaid
Services, Department of Health and Human Services, Room 445-G, Hubert
H. Humphrey Building, 200 Independence Avenue, SW., Washington, DC
20201.
(Because access to the interior of the Hubert H. Humphrey Building
is not readily available to persons without Federal government
identification, commenters are encouraged to leave their comments in
the CMS drop slots located in the main lobby of the building. A stamp-
in clock is available for persons wishing to retain a proof of filing
by stamping in and retaining an extra copy of the comments being
filed.)
b. For delivery in Baltimore, MD--Centers for Medicare & Medicaid
Services, Department of Health and Human Services, 7500 Security
Boulevard, Baltimore, MD 21244-1850.
If you intend to deliver your comments to the Baltimore address,
please call telephone number (410) 786-9994 in advance to schedule your
arrival with one of our staff members.
Comments mailed to the addresses indicated as appropriate for hand
or courier delivery may be delayed and received after the comment
period.
FOR FURTHER INFORMATION CONTACT:
Rick Ensor, (410) 786-5617, for issues related to practice expense
methodology.
Craig Dobyski, (410) 786-4584, for issues related to geographic
practice cost indices.
Esther Markowitz, (410) 786-4595, for issues related to telehealth
services.
Ken Marsalek, (410) 786-4502, for issues related to the physician
practice information survey and the multiple procedure payment
reduction.
Cathleen Scally, (410) 786-5714, for issues related to the initial
preventive physical examination or consultation services.
Regina Walker-Wren, (410) 786-9160, for issues related to the phasing
out of the outpatient mental health treatment limitation.
Diane Stern, (410) 786-1133, for issues related to the physician
quality reporting initiative and incentives for e-prescribing.
Lisa Grabert, (410) 786-6827, for issues related to the Physician
Resource Use Feedback Program.
Colleen Bruce, (410) 786-5529, for issues related to value-based
purchasing.
Sandra Bastinelli, (410) 786-3630, for issues related to the
implementation of accreditation standards.
Jim Menas, (410) 786-4507, for issues related to teaching anesthesia
services.
Sarah McClain, (410) 786-2994, for issues related to the coverage of
cardiac rehabilitation services.
Dorothy Shannon, (410) 786-3396, for issues related to payment for
cardiac rehabilitation services.
Roya Lofti, (410) 786-4072, for issues related to the coverage of
pulmonary rehabilitation.
Jamie Hermansen, (410) 786-2064, for issues related to kidney disease
patient education programs.
Terri Harris, (410) 786-6830 for issues related to payment for kidney
disease patient education.
Henry Richter, (410) 786-4562, or Lisa Hubbard, (410) 786-5472, for
issues related to renal dialysis provisions and payments for end-stage
renal disease facilities.
Cheryl Gilbreath, (410) 786-5919, for issues related to payment for
covered outpatient drugs and biologicals.
Edmund Kasaitis, (410) 786-0477, or Bonny Dahm, (410) 786-4006, for
issues related to the Competitive Acquisition Program (CAP) for Part B
drugs.
Pauline Lapin, (410) 786-6883, for issues related to the chiropractic
services demonstration budget neutrality issue.
Monique Howard, (410) 786-3869, for issues related to CORF conditions
of coverage.
Roechel Kujawa, (410) 786-9111, for issues related to ambulance
services.
Anne Tayloe Hauswald, (410) 786-4546, for clinical laboratory issues.
Troy Barsky, (410) 786-8873, or Roy Albert, (410) 786-1872, for issues
related to physician self-referral.
Michelle Peterman, (410) 786-2591, or Iffat Fatima, (410) 786-6709 for
issues related to the grandfathering
[[Page 33521]]
provisions of the durable medical equipment, prosthetics, orthotics,
and supplies (DMEPOS) Competitive Acquisition Program.
Ralph Goldberg, (410) 786-4870, or Heidi Edmunds, (410) 786-1781, for
issues related to the damages process caused by the termination of
contracts awarded in 2008 under the DMEPOS Competitive Bidding program.
Diane Milstead, (410) 786-3355, or Gaysha Brooks, (410) 786-9649, for
all other issues.
SUPPLEMENTARY INFORMATION:
Inspection of Public Comments: All comments received before the
close of the comment period are available for viewing by the public,
including any personally identifiable or confidential business
information that is included in a comment. We post all comments
received before the close of the comment period on the following Web
site as soon as possible after they have been received: https://www.regulations.gov. Follow the search instructions on that Web site to
view public comments.
Comments received timely will also be available for public
inspection as they are received, generally beginning approximately 3
weeks after publication of a document, at the headquarters of the
Centers for Medicare & Medicaid Services, 7500 Security Boulevard,
Baltimore, Maryland 21244, Monday through Friday of each week from 8:30
a.m. to 4 p.m. To schedule an appointment to view public comments,
phone 1-800-743-3951.
Table of Contents
To assist readers in referencing sections contained in this
preamble, we are providing a table of contents. Some of the issues
discussed in this preamble affect the payment policies, but do not
require changes to the regulations in the Code of Federal Regulations
(CFR). Information on the regulation's impact appears throughout the
preamble, and therefore, is not exclusively in section V. of this
proposed rule.
I. Background
A. Development of the Relative Value System
1. Work RVUs
2. Practice Expense Relative Value Units (PE RVUs)
3. Resource-Based Malpractice RVUs
4. Refinements to the RVUs
5. Adjustments to RVUs Are Budget Neutral
B. Components of the Fee Schedule Payment Amounts
C. Most Recent Changes to Fee Schedule
II. Provisions of the Proposed Regulation
A. Resource-Based Practice Expense (PE) Relative Value Units
(RVUs)
1. Current Methodology
a. Data Sources for Calculating Practice Expense
b. Allocation of PE to Services
c. Facility and Nonfacility Costs
d. Services With Technical Components (TCs) and Professional
Components (PCs)
e. Transition Period
f. PE RVU Methodology
2. PE Proposals for CY 2010
a. SMS and Supplemental Survey Background
b. Physician Practice Information Survey (PPIS)
c. Equipment Utilization Rate
d. Miscellaneous PE Issues
e. AMA RUC PE Recommendations for Direct PE Inputs
B. Geographic Practice Cost Indices (GPCIs): Locality Discussion
1. Update--Expiration of 1.0 Work GPCI Floor
2. Payment Localities
C. Malpractice RVUs
1. Background
2. Proposed Methodology for the Revision of Resource-Based
Malpractice RVUs
D. Medicare Telehealth Services
1. Requests for Adding Services to the List of Medicare
Telehealth Services
2. Submitted Requests for Addition to the List of Telehealth
Services
E. Specific Coding Issues Related to Physician Fee Schedule
1. Canalith Repositioning
2. Payment for an Initial Preventive Physical Examination (IPPE)
3. Audiology Codes: Policy Clarification of Existing CPT Codes
4. Consultation Services
F. Potentially Misvalued Codes Under the Physician Fee Schedule
1. Valuing Services Under the Physician Fee Schedule
2. High Cost Supplies
3. Review of Services Often Billed Together and the Possibility
of Expanding the Multiple Procedure Payment Reduction (MPPR) to
Additional Nonsurgical Services
4. AMA RUC Review of Potentially Misvalued Services
a. Site of Service Anomalies
b. ``23-Hour'' Stay
5. Establishing Appropriate Relative Values for Physician Fee
Schedule Services
G. Issues Related to the Medicare Improvements for Patients and
Providers Act of 2008 (MIPPA)
1. Section 102: Elimination of Discriminatory Copayment Rates
for Medicare Outpatient Psychiatric Services
2. Section 131(b): Physician Payment, Efficiency, and Quality
Improvements--Physician Quality Reporting Initiative (PQRI)
3. Section 131(c): Physician Resource Use Measurement and
Reporting Program
4. Section 131(d): Plan for Transition to Value-Based Purchasing
Program for Physicians and Other Practitioners
5. Section 132: Incentives for Electronic Prescribing (E-
Prescribing)--The E-Prescibing Incentive Program
6. Section 135: Implementation of Accreditation Standards for
Suppliers Furnishing the Technical Component (TC) of Advanced
Diagnostic Imaging Services
7. Section 139: Improvements for Medicare Anesthesia Teaching
Programs
8. Section 144(a): Payment and Coverage Improvements for
Patients With Chronic Obstructive Pulmonary Disease and Other
Conditions--Cardiac Rehabilitation Services
9. Section 144(a): Payment and Coverage Improvements for
Patients With Chronic Obstructive Pulmonary Disease and Other
Conditions--Pulmonary Rehabitation Services
10. Section 152(b): Coverage of Kidney Disease Patient Education
Services
11. Section 153: Renal Dialysis Provisions
12. Section 182(b): Revision of Definition of Medically-Accepted
Indication for Drugs; Compendia for Determination of Medically-
Accepted Indications for Off-Label Uses of Drugs and Biologicals in
an Anti-Cancer Chemotherapeutic Regimen
H. Part B Drug Payment
1. Average Sales Price (ASP) Issues
2. Competitive Acquisition Program (CAP) Issues
I. Provisions Related to Payment for Renal Dialysis Services
Furnished by End-Stage Renal Disease (ESRD) Facilities
J. Discussion of Chiropractic Services Demonstration
1. Background
2. Analysis of Demonstration
3. Payment Adjustment
K. Comprehensive Outpatient Rehabilitation Facilities (CORF) and
Rehabilitation Agency Issues
L. Ambulance Fee Schedule: Technical Correction to the Rural
Adjustment Factor Regulations (414.610)
M. Clinical Laboratory Fee Schedule: Signature on Requisition
N. Physician Self-Referral
1. General Background
2. Physician Stand in the Shoes
O. Durable Medical Equipment-Related Issues
1. Damages to Suppliers Awarded a Contract Under the Acquisition
of Certain Durable Medical Equipment, Prosthetics, Orthotics, and
Supplies (Medicare DMEPOS Competitive Bidding Program) Caused by the
Delay of the Program
2. Notification to Beneficiaries for Suppliers Regarding
Grandfathering
P. Physician Fee Schedule Update for CY 2010
III. Collection of Information Requirements
IV. Response to Comments
V. Regulatory Impact Analysis
Regulation Text
Addendum A--Explanation and Use of Addendum B
Addendum B--Proposed Relative Value Units and Related Information
Used in Determining Medicare Payments for CY 2010
Addendum C--[Reserved]
Addendum D--Proposed 2010 Geographic Adjustment Factors (GAFs)
Addendum E--Proposed 2010 Geographic Practice Cost Indices (GPCIs)
by State and Medicare Locality
[[Page 33522]]
Addendum F--Proposed CY 2010 ESRD Wage Index for Urban Areas Based
on CBSA Labor Market Areas
Addendum G--Propsoed CY 2010 ESRD Wage Index Based on CBSA Labor
Market Areas for Rural Areas
Acronyms
In addition, because of the many organizations and terms to which
we refer by acronym in this final rule with comment period, we are
listing these acronyms and their corresponding terms in alphabetical
order below:
AACVPR American Association of Cardiovascular and Pulmonary
Rehabilitation
ACC American College of Cardiology
ACGME Accreditation Council on Graduate Medical Education
ACR American College of Radiology
AFROC Association of Freestanding Radiation Oncology Centers
AHA American Heart Association
AHRQ [HHS'] Agency for Healthcare Research and Quality
AIDS Acquired immune deficiency syndrome
AMA American Medical Association
AMP Average manufacturer price
AOA American Osteopathic Association
APA American Psychological Association
APTA American Physical Therapy Association
ASC Ambulatory surgical center
ASP Average sales price
ASRT American Society of Radiologic Technologists
ASTRO American Society for Therapeutic Radiology and Oncology
ATA American Telemedicine Association
AWP Average wholesale price
BBA Balanced Budget Act of 1997 (Pub. L. 105-33)
BBRA [Medicare, Medicaid and State Child Health Insurance Program]
Balanced Budget Refinement Act of 1999 (Pub. L. 106-113)
BIPA Medicare, Medicaid, and SCHIP Benefits Improvement Protection
Act of 2000 (Pub. L. 106-554)
BLS Bureau of Labor Statistics
BN Budget neutrality
CABG Coronary artery bypass graft
CAD Coronary artery disease
CAH Critical access hospital
CAHEA Committee on Allied Health Education and Accreditation
CAP Competitive acquisition program
CBSA Core-Based Statistical Area
CCHIT Certification Commission for Healthcare Information Technology
CEAMA Council on Education of the American Medical Association
CF Conversion factor
CfC Conditions for Coverage
CFR Code of Federal Regulations
CKD Chronic kidney disease
CLFS Clinical laboratory fee schedule
CMA California Medical Association
CMHC Community mental health center
CMP Civil money penalty
CMS Centers for Medicare & Medicaid Services
CNS Clinical nurse specialist
CoP Condition of participation
COPD Chronic obstructive pulmonary disease
CORF Comprehensive Outpatient Rehabilitation Facility
COS Cost of service
CPEP Clinical Practice Expert Panel
CPI Consumer Price Index
CPI-U Consumer price index for urban customers
CPT [Physicians'] Current Procedural Terminology (4th Edition, 2002,
copyrighted by the American Medical Association)
CR Cardiac rehabilitation
CRNA Certified registered nurse anesthetist
CRP Canalith repositioning
CRT Certified respiratory therapist
CSW Clinical social worker
CY Calendar year
DHS Designated health services
DME Durable medical equipment
DMEPOS Durable medical equipment, prosthetics, orthotics, and
supplies
DOQ Doctor's Office Quality
DRA Deficit Reduction Act of 2005 (Pub. L. 109-171)
DSMT Diabetes self-management training
E/M Evaluation and management
EDI Electronic data interchange
EEG Electroencephalogram
EHR Electronic health record
EKG Electrocardiogram
EMG Electromyogram
EMTALA Emergency Medical Treatment and Active Labor Act
EOG Electro-oculogram
EPO Erythropoietin
ESRD End-stage renal disease
FAX Facsimile
FDA Food and Drug Administration (HHS)
FEV Forced expiratory volume
FFS Fee-for-service
FR Federal Register
FVC Forced expiratory vital capacity (liters)
GAF Geographic adjustment factor
GAO General Accountability Office
GEM Generating Medicare [Physician Quality Performance Measurement
Results]
GFR Glomerular filtration rate
GPO Group purchasing organization
GPCI Geographic practice cost index
HAC Hospital-acquired conditions
HBAI Health and behavior assessment and intervention
HCPAC Health Care Professional Advisory Committee
HCPCS Healthcare Common Procedure Coding System
HCRIS Healthcare Cost Report Information System
HDRT High dose radiation therapy
HH PPS Home Health Prospective Payment System
HHA Home health agency
HHRG Home health resource group
HHS [Department of] Health and Human Services
HIPAA Health Insurance Portability and Accountability Act of 1996
(Pub. L. 104-191)
HIT Health information technology
HITECH Health Information Technology for Economic and Clinical
Health Act (Title IV of Division B of the Recovery Act, together
with Title XIII of Division A of the Recovery Act)
HITSP Healthcare Information Technology Standards Panel
HIV Human immunodeficiency virus
HOPD Hospital outpatient department
HPSA Health Professional Shortage Area
HRSA Health Resources Services Administration (HHS)
ICD International Classification of Diseases
IACS Individuals Access to CMS Systems
ICF Intermediate care facilities
ICR Intensive cardiac rehabilitation
ICR Information collection requirement
IDTF Independent diagnostic testing facility
IFC Interim final rule with comment period
IMRT Intensity-Modulated Radiation Therapy
IPPE Initial preventive physical examination
IPPS Inpatient prospective payment system
IRS Internal Revenue Service
ISO Insurance services office
IVD Ischemic Vascular Disease
IVIG Intravenous immune globulin
IWPUT Intra-service work per unit of time
JRCERT Joint Review Committee on Education in Radiologic Technology
JUA Joint underwriting association
KDE Kidney disease education
MA Medicare Advantage
MA-PD Medicare Advantage-Prescription Drug Plans
MCMP Medicare Care Management Performance
MedCAC Medicare Evidence Development and Coverage Advisory Committee
(formerly the Medicare Coverage Advisory Committee (MCAC))
MedPAC Medicare Payment Advisory Commission
MEI Medicare Economic Index
MIEA-TRHCA Medicare Improvements and Extension Act of 2006 (that is,
Division B of the Tax Relief and Health Care Act of 2006 (TRHCA)
(Pub. L. 109-432)
MIPPA Medicare Improvements for Patients and Providers Act of 2008
(Pub. L. 110-275)
MMA Medicare Prescription Drug, Improvement, and Modernization Act
of 2003 (Pub. L. 108-173)
MMSEA Medicare, Medicaid, and SCHIP Extension Act of 2007 (Pub. L.
110-173)
MNT Medical nutrition therapy
MP Malpractice
MPPR Multiple procedure payment reduction
MQSA Mammography Quality Standards Act of 1992 (Pub. L. 102-539)
MRA Magnetic resonance angiography
MRI Magnetic resonance imaging
MS-DRG Medicare Severity-Diagnosis related group
MSA Metropolitan statistical area
NCD National Coverage Determination
NCH National Claims History
NCPDP National Council for Prescription Drug Programs
NCQDIS National Coalition of Quality Diagnostic Imaging Services
NDC National drug code
NF Nursing facility
NISTA National Institute of Standards and Technology Act
NP Nurse practitioner
NPDB National Practitioner Data Bank
NPI National Provider Identifier
[[Page 33523]]
NPP Nonphysician practitioner
NPPES National Plan and Provider Enumeration System
NQF National Quality Forum
NRC Nuclear Regulatory Commission
NTTAA National Technology Transfer and Advancement Act of 1995 (Pub.
L. 104-113)
NUBC National Uniform Billing Committee
OACT [CMS'] Office of the Actuary
OBRA Omnibus Budget Reconciliation Act
ODF Open door forum
OIG Office of Inspector General
OMB Office of Management and Budget
ONC [HHS'] Office of the National Coordinator
OPPS Outpatient prospective payment system
OSA Obstructive Sleep Apnea
OSCAR Online Survey and Certification and Reporting
P4P Pay for performance
PA Physician assistant
PBM Pharmacy benefit manager
PC Professional component
PCF Patient compensation fund
PCI Percutaneous coronary intervention
PDE Prescription drug event
PDP Prescription drug plan
PE Practice expense
PE/HR Practice expense per hour
PEAC Practice Expense Advisory Committee
PECOS Provider Enrollment, Chain, and Ownership System
PERC Practice Expense Review Committee
PFS Physician Fee Schedule
PGP [Medicare] Physician Group Practice
PHP Partial hospitalization program
PIM [Medicare] Program Integrity Manual
PLI Professional liability insurance
POA Present on admission
POC Plan of care
PPI Producer price index
PPIS Physician Practice Information Survey
PPS Prospective payment system
PPTA Plasma Protein Therapeutics Association
PQRI Physician Quality Reporting Initiative
PRA Paperwork Reduction Act
PSA Physician scarcity areas
PSG Polysomnography
PT Physical therapy
PTCA Percutaneous transluminal coronary angioplasty
RA Radiology assistant
Recovery Act American Recovery and Reinvestment Act (Pub. L. 111-5)
ResDAC Research Data Assistance Center
RFA Regulatory Flexibility Act
RIA Regulatory impact analysis
RN Registered nurse
RNAC Reasonable net acquisition cost
RPA Radiology practitioner assistant
RRT Registered respiratory therapist
RUC [AMA's Specialty Society] Relative (Value) Update Committee
RVU Relative value unit
SBA Small Business Administration
SGR Sustainable growth rate
SLP Speech-language pathology
SMS [AMA's] Socioeconomic Monitoring System
SNF Skilled nursing facility
SOR System of record
SRS Stereotactic radiosurgery
TC Technical Component
TIN Tax identification number
TRHCA Tax Relief and Health Care Act of 2006 (Pub. L. 109-432)
TTO Transtracheal oxygen
UPMC University of Pittsburgh Medical Center
USDE United States Department of Education
VBP Value-based purchasing
WAMP Widely available market price
I. Background
Since January 1, 1992, Medicare has paid for physicians' services
under section 1848 of the Social Security Act (the Act), ``Payment for
Physicians' Services.'' The Act requires that payments under the
physician fee schedule (PFS) be based on national uniform relative
value units (RVUs) based on the relative resources used in furnishing a
service. Section 1848(c) of the Act requires that national RVUs be
established for physician work, practice expense (PE), and malpractice
expense. Before the establishment of the resource-based relative value
system, Medicare payment for physicians' services was based on
reasonable charges.
A. Development of the Relative Value System
1. Work RVUs
The concepts and methodology underlying the PFS were enacted as
part of the Omnibus Budget Reconciliation Act (OBRA) of 1989 (Pub. L.
101-239), and OBRA 1990, (Pub. L. 101-508). The final rule, published
on November 25, 1991 (56 FR 59502), set forth the fee schedule for
payment for physicians' services beginning January 1, 1992. Initially,
only the physician work RVUs were resource-based, and the PE and
malpractice RVUs were based on average allowable charges.
The physician work RVUs established for the implementation of the
fee schedule in January 1992 were developed with extensive input from
the physician community. A research team at the Harvard School of
Public Health developed the original physician work RVUs for most codes
in a cooperative agreement with the Department of Health and Human
Services (DHHS). In constructing the code-specific vignettes for the
original physician work RVUs, Harvard worked with panels of experts,
both inside and outside the Federal government, and obtained input from
numerous physician specialty groups.
Section 1848(b)(2)(B) of the Act specifies that the RVUs for
anesthesia services are based on RVUs from a uniform relative value
guide, with appropriate adjustment of the conversion factor (CF), in a
manner to assure that fee schedule amounts for anesthesia services are
consistent with those for other services of comparable value. We
established a separate CF for anesthesia services, and we continue to
utilize time units as a factor in determining payment for these
services. As a result, there is a separate payment methodology for
anesthesia services.
We establish physician work RVUs for new and revised codes based on
our review of recommendations received from the American Medical
Association's (AMA) Specialty Society Relative Value Update Committee
(RUC).
2. Practice Expense Relative Value Units (PE RVUs)
Section 121 of the Social Security Act Amendments of 1994 (Pub. L.
103-432), enacted on October 31, 1994, amended section
1848(c)(2)(C)(ii) of the Act and required us to develop resource-based
PE RVUs for each physician's service beginning in 1998. We were to
consider general categories of expenses (such as office rent and wages
of personnel, but excluding malpractice expenses) comprising PEs.
Section 4505(a) of the Balanced Budget Act of 1997 (BBA) (Pub. L.
105-33), amended section 1848(c)(2)(C)(ii) of the Act to delay
implementation of the resource-based PE RVU system until January 1,
1999. In addition, section 4505(b) of the BBA provided for a 4-year
transition period from charge-based PE RVUs to resource-based RVUs.
We established the resource-based PE RVUs for each physicians'
service in a final rule, published November 2, 1998 (63 FR 58814),
effective for services furnished in 1999. Based on the requirement to
transition to a resource-based system for PE over a 4-year period,
resource-based PE RVUs did not become fully effective until 2002.
This resource-based system was based on two significant sources of
actual PE data: The Clinical Practice Expert Panel (CPEP) data; and the
AMA's Socioeconomic Monitoring System (SMS) data. The CPEP data were
collected from panels of physicians, practice administrators, and
nonphysicians (for example, registered nurses (RNs)) nominated by
physician specialty societies and other groups. The CPEP panels
identified the direct inputs required for each physician's service in
both the office setting and out-of-office setting. We have since
refined and revised these inputs based on recommendations from the RUC.
The AMA's SMS data provided aggregate
[[Page 33524]]
specialty-specific information on hours worked and PEs.
Separate PE RVUs are established for procedures that can be
performed in both a nonfacility setting, such as a physician's office,
and a facility setting, such as a hospital outpatient department. The
difference between the facility and nonfacility RVUs reflects the fact
that a facility typically receives separate payment from Medicare for
its costs of providing the service, apart from payment under the PFS.
The nonfacility RVUs reflect all of the direct and indirect PEs of
providing a particular service.
Section 212 of the Balanced Budget Refinement Act of 1999 (BBRA)
(Pub. L. 106-113) directed the Secretary of Health and Human Services
(the Secretary) to establish a process under which we accept and use,
to the maximum extent practicable and consistent with sound data
practices, data collected or developed by entities and organizations to
supplement the data we normally collect in determining the PE
component. On May 3, 2000, we published the interim final rule (65 FR
25664) that set forth the criteria for the submission of these
supplemental PE survey data. The criteria were modified in response to
comments received, and published in the Federal Register (65 FR 65376)
as part of a November 1, 2000 final rule. The PFS final rules published
in 2001 and 2003, respectively, (66 FR 55246 and 68 FR 63196) extended
the period during which we would accept these supplemental data through
March 1, 2005.
In the Calendar Year (CY) 2007 PFS final rule with comment period
(71 FR 69624), we revised the methodology for calculating PE RVUs
beginning in CY 2007 and provided for a 4-year transition for the new
PE RVUs under this new methodology.
3. Resource-Based Malpractice (MP) RVUs
Section 4505(f) of the BBA amended section 1848(c) of the Act
requiring us to implement resource-based malpractice (MP) RVUs for
services furnished on or after 2000. The resource-based MP RVUs were
implemented in the PFS final rule published November 2, 1999 (64 FR
59380). The MP RVUs were based on malpractice insurance premium data
collected from commercial and physician-owned insurers from all the
States, the District of Columbia, and Puerto Rico.
4. Refinements to the RVUs
Section 1848(c)(2)(B)(i) of the Act requires that we review all
RVUs no less often than every 5 years. The first 5-Year Review of the
physician work RVUs was published on November 22, 1996 (61 FR 59489)
and was effective in 1997. The second 5-Year Review was published in
the CY 2002 PFS final rule with comment period (66 FR 55246) and was
effective in 2002. The third 5-Year Review of physician work RVUs was
published in the CY 2007 PFS final rule with comment period (71 FR
69624) and was effective on January 1, 2007. (Note: Additional codes
relating to the third 5-Year Review of physician work RVUs were
addressed in the CY 2008 PFS final rule with comment period (72 FR
66360).)
In 1999, the AMA's RUC established the Practice Expense Advisory
Committee (PEAC) for the purpose of refining the direct PE inputs.
Through March 2004, the PEAC provided recommendations to CMS for over
7,600 codes (all but a few hundred of the codes currently listed in the
AMA's Current Procedural Terminology (CPT) codes). As part of the CY
2007 PFS final rule with comment period (71 FR 69624), we implemented a
new methodology for determining resource-based PE RVUs and are
transitioning this over a 4-year period. (Note: In section II.A.2. of
this proposed rule, we are proposing to use new survey data under the
PE methodology.)
In the CY 2005 PFS final rule with comment period (69 FR 66236), we
implemented the first 5-Year Review of the MP RVUs (69 FR 66263).
(Note: In section II.C. of this proposed rule, we are proposing to
update the malpractice RVUs with the use of new data.)
5. Adjustments to RVUs are Budget Neutral
Section 1848(c)(2)(B)(ii)(II) of the Act provides that adjustments
in RVUs for a year may not cause total PFS payments to differ by more
than $20 million from what they would have been if the adjustments were
not made. In accordance with section 1848(c)(2)(B)(ii)(II) of the Act,
if adjustments to RVUs cause expenditures to change by more than $20
million, we make adjustments to ensure that expenditures do not
increase or decrease by more than $20 million.
As explained in the CY 2009 PFS final rule with comment period (73
FR 69730), as required by section 133(b) of the Medicare Improvements
for Patients and Providers Act of 2008 (MIPPA) (Pub. L. 110-275), the
separate budget neutrality (BN) adjustor resulting from the third 5-
Year Review of physician work RVUs is being applied to the CF beginning
with CY 2009 rather than the work RVUs.
B. Components of the Fee Schedule Payment Amounts
To calculate the payment for every physicians' service, the
components of the fee schedule (physician work, PE, and MP RVUs) are
adjusted by a geographic practice cost index (GPCI). The GPCIs reflect
the relative costs of physician work, PE, and malpractice expense in an
area compared to the national average costs for each component.
RVUs are converted to dollar amounts through the application of a
CF, which is calculated by CMS' Office of the Actuary (OACT).
The formula for calculating the Medicare fee schedule payment
amount for a given service and fee schedule area can be expressed as:
Payment = [(RVU work x GPCI work) + (RVU PE x GPCI PE) + (RVU
malpractice x GPCI malpractice)] x CF
C. Most Recent Changes to the Fee Schedule
The CY 2009 PFS final rule with comment period (73 FR 69726)
implemented changes to the PFS and other Medicare Part B payment
policies finalized the CY 2008 interim RVUs and implemented interim
RVUs for new and revised codes for CY 2009 to ensure that our payment
systems are updated to reflect changes in medical practice and the
relative value of services.
The CY 2009 PFS final rule with comment period also addressed other
policies, as well as certain provisions of the MIPPA.
As required by the statute, and based on section 131 of the MIPPA,
the CY 2009 PFS final rule with comment period also announced that the
PFS update is 1.1 percent for CY 2009, the initial estimate for the
sustainable growth rate for CY 2009 is 7.4 percent, and the conversion
factor (CF) for CY 2009 is $36.0666.
II. Provisions of the Proposed Regulation
A. Resource-Based Practice Expense (PE) Relative Value Units (RVUs)
Practice expense (PE) is the portion of the resources used in
furnishing the service that reflects the general categories of
physician and practitioner expenses, such as office rent and personnel
wages but excluding malpractice expenses, as specified in section
1848(c)(1)(B) of the Act.
Section 121 of the Social Security Amendments of 1994 (Pub. L. 103-
432), enacted on October 31, 1994, required CMS to develop a
methodology for a resource-based system for determining
[[Page 33525]]
PE RVUs for each physician's service. Until that time, PE RVUs were
based on historical allowed charges. This legislation stated that the
revised PE methodology must consider the staff, equipment, and supplies
used in the provision of various medical and surgical services in
various settings beginning in 1998. The Secretary has interpreted this
to mean that Medicare payments for each service would be based on the
relative PE resources typically involved with furnishing the service.
The initial implementation of resource-based PE RVUs was delayed
from January 1, 1998, until January 1, 1999, by section 4505(a) of the
BBA. In addition, section 4505(b) of the BBA required that the new
payment methodology be phased in over 4 years, effective for services
furnished in CY 1999, and fully effective in CY 2002. The first step
toward implementation of the statute was to adjust the PE values for
certain services for CY 1998. Section 4505(d) of the BBA required that,
in developing the resource-based PE RVUs, the Secretary must--
Use, to the maximum extent possible, generally-accepted
cost accounting principles that recognize all staff, equipment,
supplies, and expenses, not solely those that can be linked to specific
procedures and actual data on equipment utilization.
Develop a refinement method to be used during the
transition.
Consider, in the course of notice and comment rulemaking,
impact projections that compare new proposed payment amounts to data on
actual physician PE.
In CY 1999, we began the 4-year transition to resource-based PE
RVUs utilizing a ``top-down'' methodology whereby we allocated
aggregate specialty-specific practice costs to individual procedures.
The specialty-specific PEs were derived from the American Medical
Association's (AMA's) Socioeconomic Monitoring Survey (SMS). In
addition, under section 212 of the BBRA, we established a process
extending through March 2005 to supplement the SMS data with data
submitted by a specialty. The aggregate PEs for a given specialty were
then allocated to the services furnished by that specialty on the basis
of the direct input data (that is, the staff time, equipment, and
supplies) and work RVUs assigned to each CPT code.
For CY 2007, we implemented a new methodology for calculating PE
RVUs. Under this new methodology, we use the same data sources for
calculating PE, but instead of using the ``top-down'' approach to
calculate the direct PE RVUs, under which the aggregate direct and
indirect costs for each specialty are allocated to each individual
service, we now utilize a ``bottom-up'' approach to calculate the
direct costs. Under the ``bottom up'' approach, we determine the direct
PE by adding the costs of the resources (that is, the clinical staff,
equipment, and supplies) typically required to provide each service.
The costs of the resources are calculated using the refined direct PE
inputs assigned to each CPT code in our PE database, which are based on
our review of recommendations received from the AMA's Relative Value
Update Committee (RUC). For a more detailed explanation of the PE
methodology, see the Five-Year Review of Work Relative Value Units
Under the PFS and Proposed Changes to the Practice Expense Methodology
proposed notice (71 FR 37242) and the CY 2007 PFS final rule with
comment period (71 FR 69629).
Note: In section II.A.1 of this proposed rule, we discuss the
current methodology used for calculating PE. In section II.A.2. of
this proposed rule, which contains PE proposals for CY 2010, we are
proposing to use data from the AMA Physician Practice Information
Survey (PPIS) in place of the AMA's SMS survey data and supplemental
survey data that is currently used in the PE methodology.
1. Current Methodology
a. Data Sources for Calculating Practice Expense
The AMA's SMS survey data and supplemental survey data from the
specialties of cardiothoracic surgery, vascular surgery, physical and
occupational therapy, independent laboratories, allergy/immunology,
cardiology, dermatology, gastroenterology, radiology, independent
diagnostic testing facilities (IDTFs), radiation oncology, and urology
are used to develop the PE per hour (PE/HR) for each specialty. For
those specialties for which we do not have PE/HR, the appropriate PE/HR
is obtained from a crosswalk to a similar specialty.
The AMA developed the SMS survey in 1981 and discontinued it in
1999. Beginning in 2002, we incorporated the 1999 SMS survey data into
our calculation of the PE RVUs, using a 5-year average of SMS survey
data. (See the CY 2002 PFS final rule with comment period (66 FR
55246).) The SMS PE survey data are adjusted to a common year, 2005.
The SMS data provide the following six categories of PE costs:
Clinical payroll expenses, which are payroll expenses
(including fringe benefits) for nonphysician clinical personnel.
Administrative payroll expenses, which are payroll
expenses (including fringe benefits) for nonphysician personnel
involved in administrative, secretarial, or clerical activities.
Office expenses, which include expenses for rent, mortgage
interest, depreciation on medical buildings, utilities, and telephones.
Medical material and supply expenses, which include
expenses for drugs, x-ray films, and disposable medical products.
Medical equipment expenses, which include depreciation,
leases, and rent of medical equipment used in the diagnosis or
treatment of patients.
All other expenses, which include expenses for legal
services, accounting, office management, professional association
memberships, and any professional expenses not previously mentioned in
this section.
In accordance with section 212 of the BBRA, we established a
process to supplement the SMS data for a specialty with data collected
by entities and organizations other than the AMA (that is, those
entities and organizations representing the specialty itself). (See the
Criteria for Submitting Supplemental Practice Expense Survey Data
interim final rule with comment period (65 FR 25664).) Originally, the
deadline to submit supplementary survey data was through August 1,
2001. In the CY 2002 PFS final rule (66 FR 55246), the deadline was
extended through August 1, 2003. To ensure maximum opportunity for
specialties to submit supplementary survey data, we extended the
deadline to submit surveys until March 1, 2005 in the Revisions to
Payment Policies Under the Physician Fee Schedule for CY 2004 final
rule with comment period (68 FR 63196) (hereinafter referred to as CY
2004 PFS final rule with comment period).
The direct cost data for individual services were originally
developed by the Clinical Practice Expert Panels (CPEP). The CPEP data
include the supplies, equipment, and staff times specific to each
procedure. The CPEPs consisted of panels of physicians, practice
administrators, and nonphysicians (for example, RNs) who were nominated
by physician specialty societies and other groups. There were 15 CPEPs
consisting of 180 members from more than 61 specialties and
subspecialties. Approximately 50 percent of the panelists were
physicians.
The CPEPs identified specific inputs involved in each physician's
service provided in an office or facility setting.
[[Page 33526]]
The inputs identified were the quantity and type of nonphysician labor,
medical supplies, and medical equipment. The CPEP data has been
regularly updated by various RUC committees on PE.
b. Allocation of PE to Services
The aggregate level specialty-specific PEs are derived from the
AMA's SMS survey and supplementary survey data. To establish PE RVUs
for specific services, it is necessary to establish the direct and
indirect PE associated with each service.
(i) Direct costs. The direct costs are determined by adding the
costs of the resources (that is, the clinical staff, equipment, and
supplies) typically required to provide the service. The costs of these
resources are calculated from the refined direct PE inputs in our PE
database. These direct inputs are then scaled to the current aggregate
pool of direct PE RVUs. The aggregate pool of direct PE RVUs can be
derived using the following formula: (PE RVUs x physician CF) x
(average direct percentage from SMS /(Supplemental PE/HR data)).
(ii) Indirect costs. The SMS and supplementary survey data are the
source for the specialty-specific aggregate indirect costs used in our
PE calculations. We then allocate the indirect costs to the code level
on the basis of the direct costs specifically associated with a code
and the greater of either the clinical labor costs or the physician
work RVUs. For calculation of the 2010 PE RVUs, we use the 2008
procedure-specific utilization data crosswalked to 2010 services. To
arrive at the indirect PE costs--
We apply a specialty-specific indirect percentage factor
to the direct expenses to recognize the varying proportion that
indirect costs represent of total costs by specialty. For a given
service, the specific indirect percentage factor to apply to the direct
costs for the purpose of the indirect allocation is calculated as the
weighted average of the ratio of the indirect to direct costs (based on
the survey data) for the specialties that furnish the service. For
example, if a service is furnished by a single specialty with indirect
PEs that were 75 percent of total PEs, the indirect percentage factor
to apply to the direct costs for the purposes of the indirect
allocation would be (0.75/0.25) = 3.0. The indirect percentage factor
is then applied to the service level adjusted indirect PE allocators.
We use the specialty-specific PE/HR from the SMS survey
data, as well as the supplemental surveys for cardiothoracic surgery,
vascular surgery, physical and occupational therapy, independent
laboratories, allergy/immunology, cardiology, dermatology, radiology,
gastroenterology, IDTFs, radiation oncology, and urology. (Note: For
radiation oncology, the data represent the combined survey data from
the American Society for Therapeutic Radiology and Oncology (ASTRO) and
the Association of Freestanding Radiation Oncology Centers (AFROC)). As
discussed in the CY 2008 PFS final rule with comment period (72 FR
66233), the PE/HR survey data for radiology is weighted by practice
size. We incorporate this PE/HR into the calculation of indirect costs
using an index which reflects the relationship between each specialty's
indirect scaling factor and the overall indirect scaling factor for the
entire PFS. For example, if a specialty had an indirect practice cost
index of 2.00, this specialty would have an indirect scaling factor
that was twice the overall average indirect scaling factor. If a
specialty had an indirect practice cost index of 0.50, this specialty
would have an indirect scaling factor that was half the overall average
indirect scaling factor.
When the clinical labor portion of the direct PE RVU is
greater than the physician work RVU for a particular service, the
indirect costs are allocated based upon the direct costs and the
clinical labor costs. For example, if a service has no physician work
and 1.10 direct PE RVUs, and the clinical labor portion of the direct
PE RVUs is 0.65 RVUs, we would use the 1.10 direct PE RVUs and the 0.65
clinical labor portions of the direct PE RVUs to allocate the indirect
PE for that service.
c. Facility and Nonfacility Costs
Procedures that can be furnished in a physician's office, as well
as in a hospital or facility setting have two PE RVUs: Facility and
nonfacility. The nonfacility setting includes physicians' offices,
patients' homes, freestanding imaging centers, and independent
pathology labs. Facility settings include hospitals, ambulatory
surgical centers (ASCs), and skilled nursing facilities (SNFs). The
methodology for calculating PE RVUs is the same for both facility and
nonfacility RVUs, but is applied independently to yield two separate PE
RVUs. Because the PEs for services provided in a facility setting are
generally included in the payment to the facility (rather than the
payment to the physician under the PFS), the PE RVUs are generally
lower for services provided in the facility setting.
d. Services With Technical Components (TCs) and Professional Components
(PCs)
Diagnostic services are generally comprised of two components: A
professional component (PC) and a technical component (TC), both of
which may be performed independently or by different providers. When
services have TCs, PCs, and global components that can be billed
separately, the payment for the global component equals the sum of the
payment for the TC and PC. This is a result of using a weighted average
of the ratio of indirect to direct costs across all the specialties
that furnish the global components, TCs, and PCs; that is, we apply the
same weighted average indirect percentage factor to allocate indirect
expenses to the global components, PCs, and TCs for a service. (The
direct PE RVUs for the TC and PC sum to the global under the bottom-up
methodology.)
e. Transition Period
As discussed in the CY 2007 PFS final rule with comment period (71
FR 69674), the change to the PE methodology was implemented over a 4-
year period. In CY 2010, the transition period is concluded and PE RVUs
will be calculated based entirely on the current methodology.
f. PE RVU Methodology
The following is a description of the PE RVU methodology.
(i) Setup File
First, we create a setup file for the PE methodology. The setup
file contains the direct cost inputs, the utilization for each
procedure code at the specialty and facility/nonfacility place of
service level, and the specialty-specific survey PE per physician hour
data.
(ii) Calculate the Direct Cost PE RVUs
Sum the Costs of Each Direct Input
Step 1: Sum the direct costs of the inputs for each service. The
direct costs consist of the costs of the direct inputs for clinical
labor, medical supplies, and medical equipment. The clinical labor cost
is the sum of the cost of all the staff types associated with the
service; it is the product of the time for each staff type and the wage
rate for that staff type. The medical supplies cost is the sum of the
supplies associated with the service; it is the product of the quantity
of each supply and the cost of the supply. The medical equipment cost
is the sum of the cost of the equipment associated with the service; it
is the product of the number of minutes each piece of equipment is used
in the
[[Page 33527]]
service and the equipment cost per minute. The equipment cost per
minute is calculated as described at the end of this section.
Apply a BN Adjustment to the Direct Inputs
Step 2: Calculate the current aggregate pool of direct PE costs. To
do this, multiply the current aggregate pool of total direct and
indirect PE costs (that is, the current aggregate PE RVUs multiplied by
the CF) by the average direct PE percentage from the SMS and
supplementary specialty survey data.
Step 3: Calculate the aggregate pool of direct costs. To do this,
for all PFS services, sum the product of the direct costs for each
service from Step 1 and the utilization data for that service.
Step 4: Using the results of Step 2 and Step 3 calculate a direct
PE BN adjustment so that the aggregate direct cost pool does not exceed
the current aggregate direct cost pool and apply it to the direct costs
from Step 1 for each service.
Step 5: Convert the results of Step 4 to an RVU scale for each
service. To do this, divide the results of Step 4 by the Medicare PFS
CF.
(iii) Create the indirect PE RVUs.
Create indirect allocators.
Step 6: Based on the SMS and supplementary specialty survey data,
calculate direct and indirect PE percentages for each physician
specialty.
Step 7: Calculate direct and indirect PE percentages at the service
level by taking a weighted average of the results of Step 6 for the
specialties that furnish the service. Note that for services with TCs
and PCs, we are calculating the direct and indirect percentages across
the global components, PCs, and TCs. That is, the direct and indirect
percentages for a given service (for example, echocardiogram) do not
vary by the PC, TC and global component.
Step 8: Calculate the service level allocators for the indirect PEs
based on the percentages calculated in Step 7. The indirect PEs are
allocated based on the three components: The direct PE RVU, the
clinical PE RVU, and the work RVU.
For most services the indirect allocator is: indirect percentage *
(direct PE RVU/direct percentage) + work RVU.
There are two situations where this formula is modified:
If the service is a global service (that is, a service
with global, professional, and technical components), then the indirect
allocator is: Indirect percentage * (direct PE RVU/direct percentage) +
clinical PE RVU + work RVU.
If the clinical labor PE RVU exceeds the work RVU (and the
service is not a global service), then the indirect allocator is:
Indirect percentage * (direct PE RVU/direct percentage) + clinical PE
RVU.
Note: For global services, the indirect allocator is based on
both the work RVU and the clinical labor PE RVU. We do this to
recognize that, for the professional service, indirect PEs will be
allocated using the work RVUs, and for the TC service, indirect PEs
will be allocated using the direct PE RVU and the clinical labor PE
RVU. This also allows the global component RVUs to equal the sum of
the PC and TC RVUs.
For presentation purposes in the examples in the Table 1, the
formulas were divided into two parts for each service. The first part
does not vary by service and is the indirect percentage * (direct PE
RVU/direct percentage). The second part is either the work RVU,
clinical PE RVU, or both depending on whether the service is a global
service and whether the clinical PE RVU exceeds the work RVU (as
described earlier in this step.)
Apply a BN Adjustment to the Indirect Allocators
Step 9: Calculate the current aggregate pool of indirect PE RVUs by
multiplying the current aggregate pool of PE RVUs by the average
indirect PE percentage from the physician specialty survey data. This
is similar to the Step 2 calculation for the direct PE RVUs.
Step 10: Calculate an aggregate pool of indirect PE RVUs for all
PFS services by adding the product of the indirect PE allocators for a
service from Step 8 and the utilization data for that service. This is
similar to the Step 3 calculation for the direct PE RVUs.
Step 11: Using the results of Step 9 and Step 10, calculate an
indirect PE adjustment so that the aggregate indirect allocation does
not exceed the available aggregate indirect PE RVUs and apply it to
indirect allocators calculated in Step 8. This is similar to the Step 4
calculation for the direct PE RVUs.
Calculate the Indirect Practice Cost Index
Step 12: Using the results of Step 11, calculate aggregate pools of
specialty-specific adjusted indirect PE allocators for all PFS services
for a specialty by adding the product of the adjusted indirect PE
allocator for each service and the utilization data for that service.
Step 13: Using the specialty-specific indirect PE/HR data,
calculate specialty-specific aggregate pools of indirect PE for all PFS
services for that specialty by adding the product of the indirect PE/HR
for the specialty, the physician time for the service, and the
specialty's utilization for the service.
Step 14: Using the results of Step 12 and Step 13, calculate the
specialty-specific indirect PE scaling factors as under the current
methodology.
Step 15: Using the results of Step 14, calculate an indirect
practice cost index at the specialty level by dividing each specialty-
specific indirect scaling factor by the average indirect scaling factor
for the entire PFS.
Step 16: Calculate the indirect practice cost index at the service
level to ensure the capture of all indirect costs. Calculate a weighted
average of the practice cost index values for the specialties that
furnish the service.
Note: For services with TCs and PCs, we calculate the indirect
practice cost index across the global components, PCs, and TCs.
Under this method, the indirect practice cost index for a given
service (for example, echocardiogram) does not vary by the PC, TC
and global component.
Step 17: Apply the service level indirect practice cost index
calculated in Step 16 to the service level adjusted indirect allocators
calculated in Step 11 to get the indirect PE RVU.
(iv) Calculate the Final PE RVUs
Step 18: Add the direct PE RVUs from Step 6 to the indirect PE RVUs
from Step 17.
Step 19: Calculate and apply the final PE BN adjustment by
comparing the results of Step 18 to the current pool of PE RVUs. This
final BN adjustment is required primarily because certain specialties
are excluded from the PE RVU calculation for ratesetting purposes, but
all specialties are included for purposes of calculating the final BN
adjustment. (See ``Specialties excluded from ratesetting calculation''
below in this section.)
(v) Setup File Information
Specialties excluded from ratesetting calculation: For the
purposes of calculating the PE RVUs, we exclude certain specialties
such as midlevel practitioners paid at a percentage of the PFS,
audiology, and low volume specialties from the calculation. These
specialties are included for the purposes of calculating the BN
adjustment.
Crosswalk certain low volume physician specialties:
Crosswalk the utilization of certain specialties with relatively low
PFS utilization to the associated specialties.
Physical therapy utilization: Crosswalk the utilization
associated with all physical therapy services to the specialty of
physical therapy.
Identify professional and technical services not
identified under the usual
[[Page 33528]]
TC and 26 modifiers: Flag the services that are PC and TC services, but
do not use TC and 26 modifiers (for example, electrocardiograms). This
flag associates the PC and TC with the associated global code for use
in creating the indirect PE RVU. For example, the professional service
code 93010 is associated with the global code 93000.
Payment modifiers: Payment modifiers are accounted for in
the creation of the file. For example, services billed with the
assistant at surgery modifier are paid 16 percent of the PFS amount for
that service; therefore, the utilization file is modified to only
account for 16 percent of any service that contains the assistant at
surgery modifier.
Work RVUs: The setup file contains the work RVUs from this
proposed rule.
(vi) Equipment cost per minute
The equipment cost per minute is calculated as:
(1/(minutes per year * usage)) * price * ((interest rate/(1-(1/((1 +
interest rate) ** life of equipment)))) + maintenance)
Where:
minutes per year = maximum minutes per year if usage were continuous
(that is, usage = 1); 150,000 minutes.
usage = equipment utilization assumption; 0.9 for certain equipment
(see section II.A.2. of this proposed rule) and 0.5. for others.
price = price of the particular piece of equipment.
interest rate = 0.11.
life of equipment = useful life of the particular piece of
equipment.
maintenance = factor for maintenance; 0.05.
Note: To illustrate the PE calculation, in Table 1 we have used
the conversion factor (CF) of $36.0666 which is the CF effective
January 1, 2009 as published in CY 2009 PFS final rule with comment
period.
BILLING CODE 4120-01-P
[[Page 33529]]
[GRAPHIC] [TIFF OMITTED] TP13JY09.139
[[Page 33530]]
BILLING CODE 4120-01-C
Note: Proposed PE RVU in Table 1, row 27, may not match Addendum
B due to rounding.
* The direct adj = [current PE RVUs * CF * avg dir pct] / [sum
direct inputs] = [Step 2] / [Step 3]
** The indirect adj = [current PE RVUs * avg ind pct] / [sum of
ind allocators] = [Step 9] / [Step 10]
2. PE Proposals for CY 2010
a. SMS and Supplemental Survey Background
Currently, we use PE/HR obtained from the SMS surveys from 1995-
1999. For several specialties that collected additional PE/HR data
through a more recent supplemental survey, we accepted and incorporated
these data in developing current PE/HR values.
While the SMS survey was not specifically designed for the purpose
of establishing PE RVUs, we found these data to be the best available
at the time. The SMS was a multi-specialty survey effort conducted
using a consistent survey instrument and method across specialties. The
survey sample was randomly drawn from the AMA Physician Masterfile to
ensure national representativeness. The AMA discontinued the SMS survey
in 1999.
As required by the BBRA, we also established a process by which
specialty groups could submit supplemental PE data. In the May 3, 2000
interim final rule entitled, Medicare Program; Criteria for Submitting
Supplemental Practice Expense Survey Data, (65 FR 25664), we
established criteria for acceptance of supplemental data. The criteria
were modified in the CY 2001 and CY 2003 PFS final rules with comment
period (65 FR 65380 and 67 FR 79971, respectively). We currently use
supplemental survey data for the following specialties: Cardiology;
dermatology; gastroenterology; radiology; cardiothoracic surgery;
vascular surgery; physical and occupational therapy; independent
laboratories; allergy/immunology; independent diagnostic testing
facilities (IDTFs); radiation oncology; medical oncology; and urology.
Because the SMS data and the supplemental survey data are from
different time periods, we have historically inflated them by the MEI
to help put them on as comparable a time basis as we can when
calculating the PE RVUs. This MEI proxy has been necessary in the past
due to the lack of contemporaneous, consistently collected, and
comprehensive multispecialty survey data.
b. Physician Practice Information Survey (PPIS)
The AMA has conducted a new survey, the PPIS, which was expanded
(relative to the SMS) to include nonphysician practitioners (NPPs) paid
under the PFS. The PPIS, administered in CY 2007 and CY 2008, was
designed to update the specialty-specific PE/HR data used to develop PE
RVUs.
The AMA and our contractor, The Lewin Group (Lewin), analyzed the
PPIS data and calculated the PE/HR for physician and nonphysician
specialties, respectively. The AMA's summary worksheets and Lewin's
final report are available on the CMS Web site at https://www.cms.gov/PhysicianFeeSched/. (See AMA PPIS Worksheets 1-3 and Lewin Group Final
Report PPIS.) Table 2 shows the current indirect PE/HR based on SMS and
supplemental surveys, the PPIS indirect PE/HR, and the indirect cost
percentages of total costs.
Table 2--Indirect PE/HR and Indirect Percentages
[Current and PPIS]
----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Current PPIS
Specialty indirect indirect Current PPIS Current crosswalk
PE/HR PE/HR indirect % indirect %
----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
All Physicians............... $59.04 $86.36 67 74
Allergy and Immunology....... 153.29 162.68 62 67
Anesthesiology............... 19.76 29.37 56 82
Audiology.................... 59.04 72.17 67 85 All Physicians.
Cardiology................... 131.02 88.04 56 65
Cardiothoracic Surgery....... 61.75 67.83 68 83
Chiropractor................. 49.60 65.33 69 86 Internal Medicine.
Clinical Laboratory (Billing 66.46 71.01 37 37
Independently) *.
Clinical Psychology.......... 29.07 20.07 90 93 Psychiatry.
Clinical Social Work......... 29.07 17.80 90 97 Psychiatry.
Colon & Rectal Surgery....... 53.93 90.85 77 80
Dermatology.................. 158.49 184.62 70 70
Emergency Medicine........... 36.85 38.36 88 94
Endocrinology................ 49.60 84.39 69 73
Family Medicine.............. 52.79 90.15 62 76
Gastroenterology............. 101.30 96.78 70 75
General Practice............. 52.79 78.59 62 69
General Surgery.............. 53.93 82.74 77 82
Geriatrics................... 49.60 54.14 69 74
Hand Surgery................. 98.56 148.78 72 77
Independent Diagnostic 466.16 501